1.

[]
[figure]
[]

ARCTIC ZOOLOGY.

VOL. I.

INTRODUCTION.

CLASS I. QUADRUPEDS.

[figure]

LONDON: PRINTED BY HENRY HUGHS. M.DCC.LXXXIV.

ADVERTISEMENT.

[]

THIS Work was begun a great number of years paſt, when the empire of Great Britain was entire, and poſſeſſed the northern part of the New World with envied ſplendor. At that period I formed a deſign of collecting materials for a partial Hiſtory of its Animals; and with true pains, by various correſpondencies, made far greater progreſs in my plan than my moſt ſanguine expectations had framed. Above a century ago, an illuſtrious predeceſſor in the line of Natural Hiſtory, who as greatly exceeded me in abilities as he did in zeal, meditated a voyage to the New World, in purſuance of a ſimilar deſign. The gentleman alluded to was FRANCIS WILLUGHBY, Eſq who died in 1672, on the point of putting his deſign in execution. Emulous of ſo illuſtrious an example, I took up the object of his purſuit; but my many relative duties forbade me from carrying it to the length conceived by that great and good man. What he would have performed, from an actual inſpection in the native country of the ſeveral ſubjects under conſideration, I muſt content myſelf to do, in a leſs perfect manner, from preſerved ſpecimens tranſmitted to me; and offer to the world their Natural Hiſtory, taken from gentlemen or writers who have paid no ſmall attention to their manners.

Let me repeat, that this Work was deſigned as a ſketch of the Zoology of North America. I thought I had a right to [] the attempt, at a time I had the honor of calling myſelf a fellow-ſubject with that reſpectable part of our former great empire; but when the fatal and humiliating hour arrived, which deprived Britain of power, ſtrength, and glory, I felt the mortification which muſt ſtrike every feeling individual at loſing his little ſhare in the boaſt of ruling over half of the New World. I could no longer ſupport my clame of entitling myſelf its humble Zoologiſt: yet, unwilling to fling away all my labors, do now deliver them to the Public under the title of the ARCTIC ZOOLOGY. I added to them a deſcription of the Quadrupeds and Birds of the north of Europe and of Aſia, from latitude 60 to the fartheſt known parts of the Arctic World, together with thoſe of Kamtſchatka, and the parts of America viſited in the laſt voyage of the illuſtrious COOK. Theſe additional parts I have flung into the form of an Appendix to each genus, and diſtinguiſhed by a fleur de lis; and the ſpecies by literal inſtead of numeral marks, which diſtinguiſh thoſe of North America. Theſe will, in a great meaſure, ſhew the dilatation of Quadrupeds and Birds, and the migrations of the feathered tribe, within part of the northern hemiſphere.

I have, whenever I could get information, given their reſpective reſidences, as well as migrations to far more northern parts, to ſhew to what very remote places the Author of Nature hath impelled them to retire, to breed in ſecurity. This wiſe proviſion preſerves the ſpecies entire, and enables them to return by myriads, to contribute to the food or luxuries of ſouthern climates. Whatever is wanting in the American part, I may foreſee, will in time be amply ſupplied. The powers of literature will ſoon ariſe, with the other ſtrengths of the new empire, and ſome native Naturaliſt give perfection to that [] part of the undertaking, by obſervations formed on the ſpot, in the uſes, manners, and migrations. Should, at preſent, no one be inclined to take the pen out of my hand, remarks from the other ſide of the Atlantic, from any gentlemen of congenial ſtudies, will add peculiar pleaſure to a favorite purſuit, and be gratefully received.

I muſt reckon among my moſt valued correſpondents on the New Continent, Doctor ALEXANDER GARDEN*, who, by his long reſidence in South Carolina, was enabled to communicate to me variety of curious remarks and ſubjects, as will appear in the following pages.

To the rich muſeum of American Birds, preſerved by Mrs. ANNA BLACKBURN, of Orford, near Warrington, I am indebted for the opportunity of deſcribing almoſt every one known in the provinces of Jerſey, New York, and Connecticut. They were ſent over to that Lady by her brother, the late Mr. Aſhton Blackburn; who added to the ſkill and zeal of a ſportſman, the moſt pertinent remarks on the ſpecimens he collected for his worthy and philoſophical ſiſter.

In the foremoſt rank of the philoſophers of the Old Continent, from whoſe correſpondence I have benefited, I muſt place Doctor PETER SIM. PALLAS, at preſent Profeſſor of Natural Hiſtory in the ſervice of the illuſtrious EMPRESS of Ruſſia: he not only favored me with the fulleſt remarks on the Zoological part of that vaſt empire, moſt of which he formed from actual travel and obſervation, but collected for my uſe various other remarks from the manuſcripts of his predeceſſors; eſpecially what related to Kamtſchatka from thoſe [] of STELLER; which have aſſiſted me in the hiſtory of parts hitherto but very ſlightly underſtood.

From the correſpondency and labors of Mr. EBERH. AUG. WILLIAM ZIMMERMAN, Profeſſor of Mathematics at Brunſwic, I have collected moſt uncommon inſtruction. His Specimen Zoologiae Geographicae Quadrupedum * is a work which gives a full view of the claſs of Quadrupeds, and the progreſs they have made in ſpreading over the face of the earth, according to climates and latitudes. Their limits are deſcribed, in general, with uncommon accuracy. Much is ſaid of the climates themſelves; of the varieties of mankind; of the effects of heat and cold on them and other animals. A moſt curious map is joined to the work, in which is given the name of every animal in its proper climate; ſo that a view of the whole Quadruped creation is placed before one's eyes, in a manner perfectly new and inſtructive.

To the following foreigners, diſtinguiſhed for their literary knowlege, I muſt pay my beſt acknowlegement for variety of moſt uſeful communications: Doctor ANDERS SPARMAN, of Stockholm; Doctor CHARLES P. THUNBERG, of Upſal; Mr. AND. J. RETZIUS, Profeſſor of Natural Hiſtory at Lund; Mr. MARTIN THRANE BRUNNICH, Profeſſor of Natural Hiſtory, and Mr. OTHO MULLER, Author of the Zoologia Danica, both of Copenhagen: and let me add my great obligations to the labors of the Reverend Mr. OTTO FABRICIUS, for his moſt finiſhed Fauna of Greenland.

[]To many of my countrymen my beſt thanks are due for literary aſſiſtances. Sir JOSEPH BANKS, Baronet, will, I hope, accept my thanks for the free admittance to thoſe parts of his cabinet which more immediately related to the ſubject of the following ſheets.

To Sir ASHTON LEVER, Knight, I am highly indebted, for the more intimate and cloſer examination of his treaſures than was allowed to the common viſitors of his moſt magnificent muſeum.

To Mr. SAMUEL HEARN, the great explorer by land of the Icy Sea, I cannot but ſend my moſt particular thanks, for his liberal communication of many zoological remarks, made by him on the bold and fatiguing adventure he undertook from Hudſon's Bay to the ne plus ultra of the north on that ſide.

Mr. ANDREW GRAHAM, long a reſident in Hudſon's Bay, obliged me with numbers of obſervations on the country, and the uſe of multitudes of ſpecimens of animals tranſmitted by him to the late muſeum of the Royal Society, at the inſtance of that liberal patron of ſcience, my reſpected friend the Honorable DAINES BARRINGTON.

Let me cloſe the liſt with acknowleging the great aſſiſtance I have found in the Synopſis of Birds by Mr. JOHN LATHAM; a work now brought almoſt to a concluſion, and which contains a far greater number of deſcriptions than any which has gone before. This is owing not only to the aſſiduity of the Author, but alſo to the peculiar ſpirit of the Engliſh nation, which has, in its voyages to the moſt remote and moſt oppoſite parts of the globe, payed attention to every branch of ſcience. The advantages are pointed out by the able pen of the Reverend Doctor DOUGLAS, in his Introduction to the laſt Voyage of [] our great navigator, publiſhed (under the auſpices of the Lords of the Admiralty) in a manner which reflects honor on our country in general, and will prove a moſt laſting monument to the memory of the great Officer who ſo unfortunately periſhed by ſavage hands, and his two able conſorts, who at length ſunk beneath the preſſure of fatigue, in carrying the glory of diſcovery far beyond the attempts of every preceding adventurer.

THOMAS PENNANT.

PLATES.

[]
VOL. I.
  • FRONTISPIECE, a winter ſcene in Lapland, with Aurora Borealis: the Arctic Fox, No 10: Ermine, No 26: Snowy Owl, No 121: and White Grous, No 183.
  • Title-page, with the head of the Elk, No 3, before it was arrived at full age.
  • Tab. I. The caves of Cauſſie in Murray, Introd. page XVIII
  • II. Rocks of ſingular forms near Sandſide, XX
  • III. The Doreholm, a ſmall iſle, one of the Schetlands, perforated with a vaſt arch XXVII
  • IV. Bird-catching in one of the Orkney iſles XXX
  • V. Antiquities XXXIII
    • No I. A Burgh of the ſmalleſt kind, with a ſingle cell.
    • II. The Burgh of Culſwick in Schetland, and a ſection of the wall.
    • III. The Burgh of Burrowfirth on Helinſta Voe, a holme or ſmall iſle among the Schetlands. It contains eleven cells.
    • IV. Burgh of Snaburgh in Unſt, one of the Schetlands.
    • V. Burgh of Hog ſeter.
    • VI. Roman camp in Felther.
    • For the drawings from which theſe Antiquities were engraven, I am indebted to the Reverend Mr. Low, Miniſter of Birſa in Orkney, who, at my requeſt, made the voyage of the Orkney and Schetland iſles in 1778. He hath prepared his journal for the preſs: it is to be hoped, that the liberality of the public will enable him to give this addition to my labors, which will complete the account of the northern part of the Britiſh dominions.
  • Tab. VI. The Bow deſcribed p. CXLIV. The place it came from is uncertain; but doubtleſsly from the part of the weſtern coaſt of America frequented by the Walrus page CXLIV
  • []Tab. VII. The Muſk Cow, with the head of the Bull. See the Zoological part page 8
  • VIII. A full-grown male Elk or Mooſe, with the velvet, or young horns; and a full-grown pair on the ground. From a painting by Mr. Stubbs, communicated to me by the late Dr. Hunter 17
VOL. II.
  • Title-page, the Pied Duck, No 488.
  • IX. St. John's Falcon: Chocolate-colored Falcon 200
  • X. Swallow-tailed Falcon 210
  • XI. Red Owl, No 117: Mottled Owl, No 118: Barred Owl, No 122 234
  • XII. Male and Female Baltimore Orioles, No 142; with the neſt 258
  • XIII. Ferruginous Woodpecker, No 159: Nuthatch, No 170 271
  • XIV. Paſſenger Pigeon, No 187: Carolina Pigeon, No 188 326
  • XV. Varied Thruſh, No 197 337
  • XVI. Spotted Groſbeak, No 213: White-crowned Bunting, No 221 355
  • XVII. Black-throated Bunting, No 228: Cinereous Bunting, No 333 364
  • XVIII. Aculeated Swallow, No 335: Long-winged Goat-ſucker, No 337 436
  • XIX. Eſkimaux Curlew, No 364: Little Woodcock, No 365 463
  • XX. Clapper Rail, No 407: Semipalmated Snipe, No 380 490
  • XXI. American Avoſet, No 421 502
  • XXII. Pied-billed Grebe, No 418: Marbled Guillemot, No 438 517
  • XXIII. Falcated Duck, p. 574: Weſtern Duck, No 497 574

The Bookbinder is deſired to obſerve, that the Second Volume begins at p. 187, CLASS II. BIRDS.

INTRODUCTION. OF THE ARCTIC WORLD.

[]

AKNOWLEGE of the geography, climate, and ſoil, and a general view of the productions of the countries, whoſe Zoologic Hiſtory is to be treated of, are points ſo neceſſary, that no apology need be made for introducing them into a prefatory diſcourſe.

It is worthy human curioſity to trace the gradual increaſe of the animal world, from the ſcanty pittance given to the rocks of Spitzbergen, to the ſwarms of beings which enliven the vegetating plains of Senegal: to point out the cauſes of the local niggardneſs of certain places, and the prodigious plenty in others. The Botaniſt ſhould attend the fancied voyage I am about to take, to explain the ſcanty herbage of the Arctic regions; or, ſhould I at any time hereafter deſcend into the lower latitudes, to inveſtigate the luxuriancy of plants in the warmer climates.

The Foſſiliſt ſhould join company, and point the variations of primaeval creation, from the ſolid rock of Spitzbergen through all the degrees of terreſtrial matter: the ſteps it makes to perfection, from the vileſt earth to the precious diamond of Golconda. The changes in the face of the globe ſhould be attended to; the deſtructions by vulcanoes; the ravages of the ſea on ſome coaſts, and the recompence it may have made to others, by the retreat of its waters.

The purſuit of theſe enquiries will alſo have a farther and more important object. Hiſtory ſhould be called in, and a brief account given of the population of the more remote countries—the motives which induced mankind to ſeek retreats in climates ſeemingly deſtitute of incitements to migration. Particular attention ſhould be paid to the means of peopling the new world, and of ſtocking it with animals, to contribute to the ſupport of mankind, after the firſt colonization—the increaſe of thoſe animals, and their ceſſation, and giving place in a certain latitude to genera entirely different.

[II]Here the fine ſtudy of Geography ſhould ſtep in to our aſſiſtance. The outline of the terreſtrial globe ſhould be traced; the ſeveral approximations between part and part ſhould be attended to; the nature of the oceans obſerved; the various iſlands pointed out, as the ſteps, the baiting-places where mankind might have reſted in its paſſage from an overcharged continent.

The manners of the people ought not leſs to be attended to; and their changes, both mental and corporeal, by compariſon of the preſent ſtate of remote people with nations with whom they had common anceſtors, and who may have been diſcovered ſtill to retain their primaeval ſeats. Some leading cuſtoms may ſtill have been preſerved in both; or ſome monuments of antiquity, proofs of congenial habitudes, poſſibly no longer extant in the ſavage than in the cultivated branches of the common ſtock.

Let me take my departure northward, from the narrow ſtreights of Dover, STREIGHTS OF DOVES. the ſite of the iſthmus of the once peninſulated Britain. No certain cauſe can be given for the mighty convulſion which tore us from the continent: whether it was rent by an earthquake, or whether it was worn through by the continual daſhing of the waters, no Pythagoras is left to ſolve the Fortuna locorum:

Vidi ego, quod ſuerat quondam ſolidiſſima tellus
Eſſe fretum

But it is moſt probable, that the great philoſopher alluded to the partial deſtruction of the Atlantica inſula, mentioned by Plato as a diſtant tradition in his days*. It was effected by an earthquake and a deluge, which might have rent aſunder the narrow iſthmus in queſtion, and left Britain, large as it ſeems at preſent, the mere wreck of its original ſize. The Scilly iſles, the Hebrides, Orknies, Schetlands, and perhaps the Feroe iſlands, may poſſibly be no more than fragments of the once far-extended region. I have no quarrel about the word iſland. The little iſthmus, compared to the whole, might have been a junction never attended to in the limited navigations of very early times. The peninſula had never been wholly explored, and it paſſed with the antients for a genuine iſland. The correſpondency of ſtrata on part of the oppoſite ſhores of Britain and France, leaves no room to doubt but that they were once united.CHALKY STRATA. The chalky cliffs of Blanc-nez, between Calais and Bologne, and thoſe to the weſtward of Dover, exactly tally: the laſt are vaſt and continued; the former ſhort, and the termination of the immenſe bed. Between Bologne and Folkſtone (about ſix miles from [III] the latter) is another memorial of the junction of the two countries; a narrow ſubmarine hill, called the Rip-raps, RIP-RAPS. about a quarter of a mile broad, and ten miles long, extending eaſtwards towards the Goodwin Sands. Its materials are boulder-ſtones, adventitious to many ſtrata. The depth of water on it, in very low ſpring-tides, is only fourteen feet. The fiſhermen from Folkſtone have often touched it with a fifteen feet oar; ſo that it is juſtly the dread of navigators. Many a tall ſhip has periſhed on it, and ſunk inſtantly into twenty-one fathoms water. In July 1782, the Belleiſle of ſixty-four guns ſtruck, and lay on it during three hours; but, by ſtarting her beer and water, got clear off.

Theſe celebrated ſtreights are only twenty-one miles wide in the narroweſt part.WIDTH OF THE STREIGHTS. From the pier at Dover to that at Calais is twenty-four. It is conjectured, that their breadth leſſens, and that they are two miles narrower than they were in antient times. An accurate obſerver of fifty years, remarks to me, that the encreaſed height of water, from a decreaſe of breadth, has been apparent even in that ſpace. The depth of the channel, at a medium, in higheſt ſpring-tides, is about twenty-five fathoms. The bottom, either coarſe ſand or rugged ſcars, which have for ages unknown reſiſted the attrition of the currents.DEPTH. From the ſtreights, both eaſtward and weſtward, is a gradual increaſe of depth thorough the channel to a hundred fathoms, till ſoundings are totally loſt or unattended to.

The ſpring-tides in the ſtreights riſe, on an average, twenty-four feet; the neap-tides fifteen. The tide flows from the German ſea, paſſes the ſtreights, and meets, with a great rippling, the weſtern tide from the ocean, between Fairleigh, near Haſtings, and Bologne *; a proof, that if the ſeparation of the land was effected by the ſeas, it muſt have been by the overpowering weight of thoſe of the north.

It is moſt certain, that Britain was peopled from Gaul. Similar cuſtoms,BRITAIN, WHENCE PEOPLED. as far as can be collected, evince this fact. The period is beyond the reach of hiſtory.

[IV]
Beyond the meaſure vaſt of thought,
The works, the wizard TIME hath wrought!
The Gaul, it's held of antique ſtory,
Saw Britain link'd to his now adverſe ſtrand;
No ſea between, nor cliff ſublime and hoary,
He paſs'd with unwet feet through all our land.
To the blown Baltic then, they ſay,
The wild waves found another way. &c.
COLLINS'S Ode to Liberty.

If, after the event by which our iſland was torn from the continent, the migration over ſo narrow a ſtreight might, in the earlier ages, have been very readily effected in the vitilia navigia or coracles, or the monoxyla or canoes in uſe in the remote periods; but the numerous ſpecies of Quadrupeds never could have ſwam into our iſland, even over ſuch a contracted water, which at all times muſt have been poſſeſſed by tides ſo rapid, as to baffle their utmoſt efforts: their paſſage, therefore, muſt have been over the antient iſthmus; for it is contrary to common ſenſe to ſuppoſe, that our anceſtors would have been at the trouble of tranſporting ſuch gueſts as wolves and bears, and the numerous train of leſſer rapacious animals, even had it been practicable for them to have introduced the domeſtic and uſeful ſpecies.

Would they on board or Bears or Lynxes take,
Feed the She-adder, and the brooding Snake?
PRIOR.

Men and beaſts found their way into Great Britain from the ſame quarter.QUADRUPEDS. We have no Quadrupeds but what are alſo found in France; and among our loſt animals may be reckoned the Urus, p. 2; Wolf, No 9; Bear, No 20; Wild Boar; and the Beaver, No 40: all which were once common to both countries. The Urus continued among us in a ſtate of nature as late at leſt as the year 1466*: and I have ſeen ſome of their deſcendants, ſcarcely to be called tame, in confinement in the parks of Drumlanrig and Chillingham . The Caledonian Bears were exported to Rome, and eſteemed for their fierceneſs. They continued in Scotland till the year 1057. They exiſted in Wales, perhaps, till the ſame period; for our antient laws ranked them among the beaſts of chace§. Wolves infeſted even the middle counties of England as late as the year 1281, and continued their ravages in North Britain in the reign of Queen Elizabeth; nor were they wholly extirpated till the year 1680. The Wild [V] Boars were common in the neighborhood of London in the reign of Henry II. and continued in our kingdom, in a wild ſtate, till 1577: they were then only to be found in the woods of Lord Latimer, who, we are informed by Doctor Moufet, took great delight in their chace*. Let me add, from the ſame authority, that Roebucks were found at the ſame period in Wales, and among the Cheviot hills; they are now confined to the Highlands of Scotland. Finally, Beavers inhabited Wales in 1188, when our hiſtorian, Giraldus, made his progreſs through the principality. Every one of theſe animals are at this time to be found in France, the Urus excepted. Theodebert, king of France, periſhed in the chace of one about the year 548; but it is probable that the ſpecies muſt have exiſted in that vaſt kingdom long after that event.

The Elk, No 3; Genet, Hiſt. Quad. No 224; Lynx, No 150; Fat Dormouſe, Hiſt. Quad. No 287; Garden Dormouſe, Hiſt. Quad. No 288; and the Bats Serotine, Pipiſtrelle, and Barbaſtelle, Hiſt. Quad. Nris 408, 409, 410, either never reached our iſland, or if they did, periſhed ſo early, that even their very names in the Britiſh tongue, have periſhed with them. The Ibex, Hiſt. Quad. No 13, and the Chamois, Hiſt. Quad. No 17, inhabitants only of the remote Gauliſh Alps and Pyreneans, probably never reached us. France, therefore, poſſeſſes forty-nine ſpecies of Quadrupeds; we only thirty-nine. I exclude two ſpecies of Seals in both reckonings; being animals which had at all times powers of making themſelves inhabitants of the coaſts of each kingdom.

Birds,BIRDS. which have the ready means of wafting themſelves from place to place, have notwithſtanding, in numbers of inſtances, their limits. Climate confines ſome within certain bounds, and particular ſorts of food induce others to remain within countries not very remote from us; yet, by wonderful inſtinct, birds will follow cultivation, and make themſelves denizens of new regions. The CROSSBILL has followed the apple into England. Glenco, in the Highlands of Scotland, never knew the Partridge, till its farmers of late years introduced corn into their lands: nor did Sparrows ever appear in Sibiria, till after the Ruſſians had made arable the vaſt waſtes of thoſe parts of their dominions. Finally, the Rice Buntings, p. 360, natives of Cuba, after the planting of rice in the Carolinas, annually quit the iſland in myriads, and fly over ſea and land, to partake of a harveſt introduced there from the diſtant India.

[VI]FRANCE, as it exceeds in variation of climate, ſo it exceeds us in the number of ſpecies of birds. We can boaſt of only one hundred and thirty-one kinds of land-birds, and one hundred and twenty-one of water-fowl. France, on the contrary, has one hundred and fifty-ſix of the firſt, and one hundred and thirteen of the laſt. This computation may not be quite accurate; for no one has as yet attempted its Fauna, which muſt be very numerous, in a kingdom which extends from Calais, in about lat. 51, to Collioure in the ſouth of Rouſſillon, on the Mediterranean ſea, in about lat. 42. The northern parts poſſeſs the birds in common with England: and in all probability the provinces in the Mediterranean annually are viſited by various ſpecies from northern Africa.

COASTS OF BRITAIN.Stupendous and precipitous ranges of chalky cliffs attend the coaſt, from Dover eaſtward, and, from their color, gave the name of Albion to our iſland. Beneath one of them anchored Ceſar, fifty-five years before CHRIST, and ſo near as to be capable of being annoyed by the darts of the Britons. After weighing anchor, he ſailed up a bay, now occupied by meadows, and landed at Rutupium, Richborough, oppoſite to the preſent Sandwich. The walls of the former ſtill evince its antient ſtrength; and the veſtiges of a quay, now bounded by a ditch, points out the anchorage of the Roman commerce. The adjacent Thanet, the Thanatos of the antients, at preſent indiſtinguiſhable from the main land, was in old times an iſland, ſeparated by a deep channel, from a mile and a half to four miles in width, the ſite of Roman ſettlements; and, in 449, celebrated for having been the firſt landing-place of the invading Saxons; to whom it was aſſigned as a place of ſecurity by the imprudent Vortigern. But ſuch a change has time effected, that Thanet no more exiſts as an iſland; and the Britanniarum Portus, in which rode the Roman navies, is now filled with marſhy meads.

After paſſing the lofty chalky promontory, the North Foreland, opens the eſtuary of the Thames, bounded on each ſide by low ſhores, and its channels divided by numerous ſand-banks; ſecurely paſſed, by reaſon of the perfection of navigation, by thouſands of ſhips frequenting annually London, our emporium, envied nearly to impending decline.

On the projecting coaſts of Suffolk and Norfolk, SUFFOLK AND NORFOLK. ariſe, in certain intervals, eminences of different matter. Loamy cliffs appear about Leoſtoffe, Dunwich, &c. The Crag-pits about Woodbridge, are prodigious pits of ſea-ſhells, many of them perfect and quite ſolid; an inexhauſtible fund of manure for arable lands. About Yarmouth, and from thence beyond Wintertoneſs, the coaſt is low, flat, and compoſed of ſhingle, backed by ſand. From Hapſburgh to Cromer are a range of lofty clayey precipices, riſing from the height of forty to a hundred feet perpendicular; a prey to the ocean, which has effected great changes in theſe parts. About Sherringham and Cley, it riſes into pretty and gentle hills, ſloping down into a [VII] rough ſhore, of little rocks and ſtones. At Holkham, Wells, and Wareham, the ſandy ſhores terminate in little hillocks of ſand, kept together by the Arundo Arenaria, or Bent, the great preſervative againſt the inundations of ſand, which would otherwiſe deſtroy whole tracts of country, and in particular ſoon render uſeleſs the range of ſalt-marſhes which theſe are backed with. Hunſtanton cliff riſes a diſtinguiſhed feature in this flat tract. The ſurface is the uſual vegetable mould, about a foot deep; beneath that are two feet of ſmall broken pieces of chalk: the ſolid ſtratum of the ſame, after having been loſt for numbers of miles, here again makes its appearance, and forms a ſolid bed thirty feet in thickneſs, reſting on a hard red ſtone four feet deep, which is often ground and made into a red paint. Seven feet of looſe friable dirty yellow ſtone ſucceeds, placed on a baſe of iron-colored plumb-pudding-ſtone, projecting into the ſea, with vaſt fragments ſcattered over the beach. This cliff is about eighty feet high, lies on the entrance of the waſhes, the Metaris Eſtuarium of Ptolemy. From hence, all the coaſt by Snettiſham to Lynn is low, flat, and ſhingly.

From Holm, the northern promontory of Norfolk, the ſea advances deeply weſtward, and forms the great bay called the Waſhes, filled with vaſt ſand-banks, the ſummits of which are dry at low water; but the intervening channels are the means of prodigious commerce to Lynn in Norfolk, ſeated on the Ouze, which is circulated into the very inland parts of our iſland, through the various rivers which fall into its long courſe. Lynn is mentioned in the Doomſday Book; but became conſiderable for its commerce with Norway as early as the year 1284.

The oppoſite ſhore is that of Lincolnſhire. LINCOLNSHIRE. Its great commercial town, Boſton, ſtands on the Witham, a few miles from the head of the bay. Spring-tides riſe at the quay fourteen feet, and convey there veſſels of above a hundred tons; but greater ſhips lie at the Scap, the opening of the eſtuary. Such is the caſe at Lynn; for the ſluggiſh rivers of theſe tame tracts want force to form a depth of water.

Lincolnſhire, and part of ſix other counties, are the Pais-bas, the Low Countries of Britain; the former bounded on the weſtern part by a range of elevated land, which, in this humble county, overlooks, as Alps would the ocean, the remaining part. This very extenſive tract, from the Scap to the northern headland oppoſite to Hull, preſents to the ſea a bow-like and almoſt unindented front; and ſo low as to be viſible from ſea only at a ſmall diſtance; and churches, inſtead of hills, are the only landmarks to ſeamen. The whole coaſt is fronted with ſalt-marſhes or ſand-hills, and ſecured by artificial banks againſt the fury of the ſea. Old Holinſhead gives a long liſt of ports on this now inhoſpitable coaſt. Waynfleet, once a noted haven, is at preſent a mere creek. Skegneſs, once a large walled town, with a good harbour, is now an inconſiderable place a mile from the ſea: and the port of [VIII] Grimeſby, which in the time of Edward III. furniſhed him with eleven ſhips, is now totally choaked with ſand.

The Great Level, which comprehends Holland in this county, with part of Northamptonſhire, Norfolk, Suffolk, Cambridge, and Huntingdon, a tract of ſixty computed miles in length, and forty in breadth, had been originally a wooded country. Whole foreſts of firs and oaks have been found in digging, far beneath the moor, on the ſolid ground; oaks fifteen feet in girth, and ſixteen yards long, moſtly burnt at the bottoms, the antient method of falling them: multitudes of others entirely rooted up, as appears, by the force of the ſea burſting in and overwhelming this whole tract, and covering it with ſilt, or the mud which it carried with it from time to time. Ovid's beautiful account of the deluge was here verified; for under Conington Down, in Huntingdonſhire, was found the ſkeleton of a whale near twenty feet long, which had once ſwam ſecure to this diſtance from its native reſidence.

Et modo quâ graciles gramen carpſere capellae,
Nunc ibi deformes ponunt ſua corpora phocae.
— ſylvaſque tenent delphines, et altis
Incurſant ramis, agitataque robora pulſant.

In proceſs of time this tract underwent another revolution. The ſilt or mud gained ſo conſiderably as to leave vaſt ſpaces dry, and other parts ſo ſhallow as to encourage the Romans to regain theſe fertilized countries from the ſea. Thoſe ſenſible and indefatigable people firſt taught us the art of embanking, and recovered the valuable lands we now poſſeſs. It was the complaint of Galgacus, that they exhauſted the ſtrength of the Britons, in ſylvis et paludibus emuniendis *, 'in clearing woods and draining marſhes.' After the Romans deſerted our iſland, another change took place. Neglect of their labors ſucceeded: the drains were neglected, and the whole became fen and ſhallow lake, reſembling the preſent eaſt fen; the haunt of myriads of water-fowl, or the retreat of banditti. Ely and many little tracts which had the advantage of elevation, were at that period literally iſlands. Several of theſe in early times became the retreat of religious. Ely, Thorney, Ramſey, Spiney, and others, roſe into celebrated abbies, and by the induſtry of their inhabitants firſt began to reſtore the works of the Romans. The country above Thorney is repreſented by an old hiſtorian as a paradiſe. Conſtant viſitations, founded on wholeſome laws, preſerved this vaſt recovered country: but on the rapid and rapacious diſſolution, the removal of numbers of the inhabitants, and the neglect of the laws of the Sewers, the drains were filled, the cultivated land overflowed, and [IX] the country again reduced to a uſeleſs moraſs*. In the twentieth of Elizabeth the ſtate of the country was taken into conſideration; no great matters were done till the time of Francis, and William his ſon, earls of Bedford, who attempted this Herculean work, and reclamed this vaſt tract of more than three hundred thouſand acres; and the laſt received, under ſanction of parlement, the juſt reward of ninety thouſand acres. I ſpeak not of the reliques of the antient banks which I have ſeen in Holland, Lincolnſhire, now remote from the ſea, nor yet of the Roman tumuli, the coins, and other evidences of the reſidence of that nation in theſe parts; they would ſwell a mere preface to too great a length: and, it is to be hoped, will be undertaken by the pen of ſome native, who will perform it from his actual ſurvey.

The vaſt fenny tracts of theſe counties were in old times the haunts of multitudes of water-fowl; but the happy change, by attention to draining, has ſubſtituted in their place thouſands of ſheep; or, inſtead of reeds, made thoſe tracts laugh with corn. The Crane, which once abounded in theſe parts, has even deſerted our iſland. The Common Wild Duck ſtill breeds in multitudes in the unreclamed parts; and thouſands are ſent annually to the London markets, from the numerous decoys. The Grey Lag Gooſe, Br. Zool. ii. No 266, the origin of the Tame, breeds here, and is reſident the whole year: a few others of the Duck kind breed here. Ruffs, Redſhanks, Lapwings, Red-breaſted Godwits, and Whimbrels, are found here during ſummer; but, with their young, in autumn, diſperſe about the iſland. The Short-eared Owl migrates here with the Woodcock, and is a welcome gueſt to the farmer, by clearing the fields of mice. Knots ſwarm on the coaſts in winter: are taken in numbers in nets: yet none are ſeen during ſummer. The moſt diſtant north is probably the retreat of the multitude of water-fowl of each order which ſtock our ſhores, driven ſouthward by the extreme cold: moſt of them regularly, others, whoſe nature enables them to brave the uſual winters of the frigid zone, are with us only accidental gueſts, and in ſeaſons when the froſt rages in their native land with unuſual ſeverity.

From Clea Neſs, the land retires weſtward, and, with the oppoſite ſhore of Yorkſhire, bounds the great eſtuary of the Humber, which, winding deep into the country, is the receptacle of the Trent, and all the conſiderable rivers of that vaſt province; ſome of which ariſe in its moſt remote parts. All theſe coaſts of Lincolnſhire are flat, and have been gained from the ſea. Barton and Barrow have not at preſent the leaſt appearance of ports; yet by Holinſhed were ſtyled good ones§. Similar [X] accidents have befallen the upper part of the low tract of Holderneſs, which faces the congruent ſhores. Hedon, a few miles below Hull, ſeveral hundred years ago a port of great commerce, is now a mile and a half from the water, and has long given way to the riſing fortune of the latter (a creation of Edward I. in 1296) on account of the excellency of its port. But in return, the ſea has made moſt ample repriſals on the lands of this hundred: the ſite, and even the very names of ſeveral places, once towns of note upon the Humber, are now only recorded in hiſtory: and Ravenſper was at one time a rival to Hull *; and a port ſo very conſiderable in 1332, that Edward Baliol and the confederated Engliſh barons ſailed from hence with a great fleet to invade Scotland; and Henry IV. in 1399, made choice of this port to land at, to effect the depoſal of Richard II. yet the whole of it has long ſince been devoured by the mercileſs ocean: extenſive ſands, dry at low water, are to be ſeen in their ſtead; except Sunk Iſland, which, till about the year 1666, appeared among them like an elevated ſhoal, at which period it was regained, by embankments, from the ſea; and now forms a conſiderable eſtate, probably reſtored to its priſtine condition.

Spurn Head, SPURN HEAD. the Ocelum Promontorium of Ptolemy, terminates this ſide of the Humber, at preſent in form of a ſickle, near which the wind-bound ſhips anchor ſecurely. The place on which the lighthouſes ſtand is a vaſt beach near two miles long, mixed with ſand-hills flung up by the ſea within the laſt ſeventy years.

The land from hence for ſome miles is compoſed of very lofty cliffs of brown clay, perpetually preyed on by the fury of the German ſea, which devours whole acres at a time, and expoſes on the ſhores conſiderable quantities of beautiful amber. Fine wheat grows on the clay, even to the edge of the cliffs. A country of the ſame fertility reaches from Kilnſey, near this place, as far as the village of Sprottly, extending, in a waved form, for numbers of miles; and, when I ſaw it, richly cloathed with wheat and beans.

From near Kilnſey the land bends very gently inward, as far as the great promontory of Flamborough; and is a continuance of high clayey cliff, till about the village of Hornſey. Near it is a mere, noted for its Eels and Pikes, at preſent ſeparated from the ſea by ſo ſmall a ſpace as to render its ſpeedy deſtruction very probable. A ſtreet, called Hornſey Beck, has long ſince been ſwallowed: and of Hide, a neighboring town, only the tradition is left.

The country grows conſiderably lower; and, near the baſe of the promontory, retires ſo far in as to form Bridlington bay,BRIDLINGTON BAY. antiently called Gabrantovicorum Sinus, to which the Geographer adds [...], on account of the excellency and [XI] ſafety of its port, where veſſels ride in full ſecurity under the ſhelter of the lofty head-land. Smithie ſand, the only one between Flamborough and Spurn Head, ſtretches acroſs the entrance into Bridlington bay, and, in hard gales from the north and north-eaſt, adds to the ſecurity of that noble aſylum for the coaſting veſſels. Sureby, an adjacent village, ſeems no more than a tranſlation from the old appellation. The Romans, in all probability, had a naval ſtation here; for here ends the road, viſible in many places between this place and York, and named, from its founders, the Roman ridge.

The head is formed of lime-ſtone, of a ſnowy whiteneſs*,FLAMBOROUGH HEAD. of a ſtupendous height, and vaſt magnificence, viſible far at ſea. If we may depend on Richard of Cirenceſter, the Romans named it Brigantum Extrema, and the bay Portus Felix. The Saxons ſtyled the cape Fleamburg, perhaps from the lights which directed the great Ida, founder of the Northumberland kingdom, to land here, in 547, with a great body of their countrymen.

The vaſt height of the precipices, and the amazing grandeur of the caverns which open on the north ſide, giving wide and ſolemn admiſſion, through moſt exalted arches, into the body of the mountain; together with the gradual decline of light, the deep ſilence of the place unleſs interrupted by the ſtriking of the oar, the colliſion of a ſwelling wave againſt the ſides, or the loud flutter of the pigeons affrighted from their neſts in the diſtant roof; afford pleaſures of ſcenery which ſuch formations as this alone can yield. Theſe alſo are wonderfully diverſified. In ſome parts the caverns penetrate far, and end in darkneſs; in others are pervious, and give a romantic paſſage by another opening equally ſuperb. Many of the rocks are inſulated, of a pyramidal form, and ſoar to a great height. The baſes of moſt are ſolid; but in ſome pierced through and arched. All are covered with the dung of the innumerable flocks of migratory birds which reſort here annually to breed, and fill every little projection, every hole, which will give them leave to reſt. Multitudes were ſwimming about; others ſwarmed in the air, and ſtunned us with [XII] the variety of their croaks and ſcreams. Kittiwakes and Herring Gulls, Guillemots and Black Guillemots, Auks, Puffins, Shags, and Corvorants, are among the ſpecies which reſort hither. The notes of all ſea-fowl are moſt harſh and inharmonious. I have often reſted under rocks like theſe, attentive to the various founds over my head; which, mixed with the deep roar of the waves ſlowly ſwelling, and retiring from the vaſt caverns beneath, have produced a fine effect. The ſharp voice of the Gulls, the frequent chatter of the Guillemots, the loud notes of the Auks, the ſcream of the Herons, together with the deep periodical croak of the Corvorants, which ſerves as a baſs to the reſt, have often furniſhed me with a concert; which, joined to the wild ſcenery ſurrounding me, afforded in an high degree that ſpecies of pleaſure which reſults from the novelty and the gloomy majeſty of the entertainment.

ROCKY COASTS BEGIN.At Flamborough head commence the hard or rocky coaſts of this ſide of Great Britain, which continue, with the interruption of a few ſandy bays and low land, to the extremity of the kingdom. It often happens, that the bottom of the ſea partakes of the nature of the neighboring element: thus, about the head, and a few miles to the northward (in places) the ſhores are rocky, and the haunts of lobſters and other cruſtaceous animals. From theſe ſtrata a tract of fine ſand, from one to five miles in breadth, extends ſloping eaſtward, and from its edge to that of the Dogger-bank is a deep bottom, rugged, rocky, and cavernous, and in moſt parts overgrown with corallines and ſubmarine plants.

This diſpoſition of ſhore gives to the inhabitants of this coaſt the advantageous fiſhery which they poſſeſs; for the ſhore on one hand, and the edges of the Dogger-bank on the other, like the ſides of a decoy, give a direction to the immenſe ſhoals of the Cod genus, which annually migrate from the northern ocean, to viſit, reſide, and ſpawn, in the parts adjacent to our coaſts. They find plenty of food from the plants of the rocks, and the worms of the ſand, and ſecure ſhelter for their ſpawn in the cavernous part of the ſcarry bottom. It is in the channel between the banks and the ſhores, in which the Cod are taken, or in the hollows between the Doggers and Well-bank; for they do not like the agitation of the water on the ſhallows. On the contrary, the Skates, the Holibuts, Flounders, and other flat fiſh, bury themſelves in the ſand; and ſecure themſelves from the turbulence of the waves.

An amazing ſhoal of Haddocks viſit this coaſt periodically, generally about the tenth of December, and extend from the ſhore near three miles in breadth, and in length from Flamborough head to Tinmouth caſtle, perhaps further north. An army of a ſmall ſpecies of Shark, the PICKED, Br. Zool. iii. No 40, flanks the outſide of this ſhoal to prey upon it; for when the fiſhermen caſt their lines [XIII] beyond the diſtance of three miles from land, they never catch any but thoſe voracious fiſh.*

Between Flamborough head and Scarborough projects Filey Brig, FILEY BRIG. a ledge of rocks running far into the ſea, the cauſe of frequent ſhipwrecks. Scarborough caſtle, ſeated on a vaſt rock projecting into the water, ſucceeds. The ſpring-tides, at the time of the equinoxes, riſe here twenty-four feet; but at other times only twenty: the neap-tides from twelve to ſixteen. Then Whitby, noted for its neighboring allum-works, and more for its fine harbour, the only one on the whole coaſt: the admittance into which is a narrow channel between two high hills: it expands largely within, and is kept clean by the river Eſk. From hence to the mouth of the Tees, the boundary between this county and that of Durham, is a high and rude coaſt, indented with many bays, and varied with little fiſhing villages, built ſtrangely among the cliffs, filling every projecting ledge, in the ſame manner with thoſe of the peaſants in the pictureſque and rocky parts of China.

The Tees, TEES. the northern limit of this great county, opens with a wide mouth and mudded bottom into the ſea. This was the Dunum Eſtuarium of Ptolemy; and ſerves as a brief entrance for navigators into the country. Almoſt all the northern rivers deſcend with a rapid courſe, from their mountanous riſe and ſupply; and afford but a ſhort navigation. From hence the lead of the mineral parts of Durham, and the corn of its more level parts, are imported. In the mud of this eſtuary, more particularly, abounds the Myxine Glutinoſa of Linnaeus, the Hag of the neighboring fiſhermen; a worm, which enters the mouths of the fiſh taken on hooks, that remain a tide under water, and devours the whole, leaving only the ſkin and bones. This alſo is the worm which converts water into a ſort of glue.

From Seaton Snook, in the biſhoprick of Durham, DURHAM. to Hartlepool, is a ſeries of ſand-banks, and the ſhore a long-continued ſandy ſhallow. From the Neſs Point of Hartleppol to Blackhalls is a rocky lime-ſtone coaſt, with frequent intervals of ſand-bank, and a ſtony beach; but Seham and Hartlepool is ſo very rugged, that no enemy could land, or even ſtand off the ſhore, without the moſt imminent danger: in particular, the coaſts about Hawthorn Hive are bold, excavated, and formed into groteſque figures, for ſeveral miles, and the ſhores rough with a broken and heavy ſea, by reaſon of the hidden rocks and ſpits of ſands which run out far [XIV] from land. From Seham to Sunderland are ſand-hills and ſhallow ſandy beaches. From Weremouth to near Cleadon, low rocks of lime-ſtone form the coaſt, here and there interſected with ſand-hills and ſtony beaches. From thence to the mouth of the Tyne, and even to Dunſtanbrough in Northumberland; NORTHUMBERLAND. the ſhore is ſandy, and the land in a few places rocky; but from thence to Bamborough, the coaſts are high and rocky, in many places run far into the ſea, and at low tides ſhew their heads above water.

Bamborough caſtle ſtands on the laſt of the range of rocky cliffs. This fortreſs was founded by the Saxon monarch Ida. After various fortunes it, has proved in its diſmantled ſtate of more uſe to mankind than when it boaſted ſome potent lord and fierce warders. A charitable prelate of the fee of Durham purchaſed the eſtate, and left it for the uſe of the diſtreſſed ſeamen who might ſuffer ſhipwreck on this dangerous coaſt, and to unconfined charitable purpoſes, at the diſcretion of certain truſtees. The poor are, in the deareſt ſeaſons, ſupplied with corn at a cheap rate; the wrecked, found ſenſeleſs and benumbed with cold, are taken inſtantly into theſe hoſpitable walls, and reſtored to life by the aſſiſtance of food, medicine, and warm beds; and if the ſhip is capable of relief, that alſo is ſaved, by means of machines always ready for the purpoſe*.

The Farn iſlands, FARN ISLES. or rather rocks, form a group at no great diſtance from ſhore; the neareſt a mile and ſixty-eight chains; the fartheſt about ſeven. Theſe probably, at ſome remote period, have been convulſed from the land, but now divided from it by a furious tide, ruſhing through a channel from five to twelve fathoms in depth. The original ſea, to the eaſt of the Staples, the remoteſt rocks, ſuddenly deepens to forty or fifty. St. Cuthbert firſt made theſe rocks of note: he occaſionally made the largeſt of them the ſeat of his devotion and ſecluſion from the world; expelling, ſays ſuperſtition, the malignant ſpirits, the pre-occupants. Some remains of a chapel are ſtill to be ſeen on it. For ages paſt, the ſole tenants are a few cows, wafted over from the main land in the little cobles, or boats of the country; and the Eider Ducks, Arct. Zool. ii. No 480, ſtill diſtinguiſhed here by the name of the Saint. Numberleſs ſea-fowls, and of great variety of kinds, poſſeſs the remoter rocks, on which they find a more ſecure retreat than on the low-cliffed ſhores. To the marine feathered tribe the whole coaſt from Flamborough head to that of St. Ebb's is inhoſpitable. They ſeek the loftieſt promontories. Where you hear of the haunts of the Razor-bills and Guillemots, Corvorants and Shags, you may be well aſſured, that [XV] the cliffs ſoar to a diſtinguiſhed height. Where thoſe are wanting, they retire to ſea-girt rocks, as ſpots the leſt acceſſible to mankind. The five ſpecies of Auks and Guillemots appear in ſpring, and vaniſh in autumn: the other birds preſerve their native haunts, or ſpread along the neighboring ſhores.

From Bamborough to the mouth of the Tweed is a ſandy ſhore, narrowing as it approaches our ſiſter kingdom. Lindesfarn, or the Holy iſland, with its ruined cathedral and caſtle, lie remote from ſhore, acceſſible at every receſs of tide, and poſſibly divided from Northumberland by the power of the waves in diſtant ages. The tides do not ſwell over this tract in the uſual manner of apparent flowing and gradual approach; but ooze gently out of every part of the ſand, which at firſt appears a quaggy extent, then, to the terror of the traveller, ſurrounds him with a ſhining plain of ſmooth unruffled water, reflecting the varied landſcapes of the adjoining ſhores*.

The Tweed, the antient Alaunus, SCOTLAND. a narrow geographical boundary between us and our fellow-ſubjects the Scottiſh nation, next ſucceeds. After a ſhort continuance of low land, St. Ebb's head, ST. EBB'S HEAD. a lofty promontory, projects into the ſea (frequented in the ſeaſon by Razor-bills, Guillemots, and all the birds of the Baſs, excepting the Gannet) and its lower part is hollowed into moſt auguſt caverns. This, with Fifeneſs, about thirty miles diſtant, forms the entrance into that magnificent eſtuary the firth of Forth, FIRTH OF FORTH. which extends inland ſixty miles; and, with the canal from Carron to the firth of Clyde, intirely inſulates the antient Caledonia. The iſle of May appears near the northern ſide of the entrance; the vaſt towering rock, the Baſs, lies near the ſouthern. This lofty iſland is the ſummer reſort of birds innumerable, which, after diſcharging the firſt duty of nature, ſeek, with their young, other ſhores or other climates. This is one of the few ſpots in the northern hemiſphere on which the Gannets neſtle. Their ſize, their ſnowy plumage, their eaſy flight, and their precipitate plunge after their prey, diſtinguiſh them at once from all the reſt of the feathered tenants of the iſle, the Corvorants and Auks, the flights of whom are rapid, and the Gulls, which move with ſluggiſh wing.

Near the Baſs the entrance narrows, then opens, and bending inwards, forms on each ſide a noble bay. The Firth contracts to a very narrow ſtreight at Queensferry; then winds beautifully, till it terminates beyond Alloa, in the river to which it owes its name. The ſhores are low, in part rocky, in part a pleaſant beach; but every where of matchleſs beauty and population. Edinburgh, the capital, riſes with true grandeur near the ſhore, with its port, the great emporium, [XVI] Leith, beneath, where the ſpring-tides ſometimes riſe fifteen and ſixteen feet, and to ſeventeen or eighteen when the water is forced up the firth by a violent wind from the north-eaſt. Almoſt every league of this great eſtuary is terminated with towns or villages, the effects of trade and induſtry. The elegant deſcription of the coaſt of Fife, left us by Johnſton *, is far from being exaggerated; and may, with equal juſtice, be applied to each ſhore.

FIFESHIRE, bounded by the firths of Forth and Tay, projects far into the ſea; a country flouriſhing by its induſtry, and happy in numbers of ports, natural, artificial, or improved. Coal and lime, the native productions of the county, are exported in vaſt quantities. Excepting the unimportant colliery in Sutherland, thoſe at Largo Wood, midway between the bay and St. Andrews, are the laſt on this ſide of North Britain. The coaſts in general of this vaſt province are rocky and precipitous; but far from being lofty. The bays, particularly the beautiful one of Largo, are finely bounded by gravelly or ſandy ſhores; and the land, in moſt parts, riſes high to the middle of the county. Towards the northern end, the river Edin; and its little bay, by ſimilarity of ſound point out the Tinna of the old geographer.

FIRTH OF TAY.The eſtuary of the Tay limits the north of Fifeſhire. Before the mouth extends the ſand retaining the Britiſh name of Aber-tay, or the place where the Tay diſcharges itſelf into the ſea. The Romans preſerved the antient name, and Latinized it into Tava. The entrance, at Brough-tay caſtle, is about three quarters of a mile wide; after which it expands, and goes about fourteen miles up the country before it aſſumes the form of a river. At the receſs of the tides there appears a vaſt extent of ſands, and a very ſhallow channel; but the high tides waft, even as high as Perth, veſſels of a hundred and twenty tons. The ſhores are low, and the ground riſes gently inland on the ſouthern ſide: on the north it continues low, till it arrives at the foot of the Grampian hills, many miles diſtant. In ſome remote age the ſea extended on the north ſide far beyond its preſent bounds. At a conſiderable diſtance above the flouriſhing port of Dundee, and remote inland, anchors have been found deep in the ſoil. When theſe parts were deſerted by the ſea, it is probable that ſome oppoſite country was devoured by an inundation, which occaſioned this partial deſertion.

From thence to Aberbrothic, in the ſhire of Angus, noted for the venerable remains of its abbey, is a low and ſandy ſhore. From Aberbrothic almoſt to Montroſe, ariſes a bold rocky coaſt, lofty and precipitous, except where interrupted by the beautiful ſemicircular bay of Lunan. Several of the cliffs are penetrated by [XVII] moſt amazing caverns; ſome open into the ſea with a narrow entrance, and internally inſtantly riſe into high and ſpacious vaults, and ſo extenſively meandring, that no one as yet has had the courage to explore the end. The entrance of others ſhame the work of art in the nobleſt of the Gothic cathedrals. A magnificent portal appears divided in the middle by a great column, the baſis of which ſinks deep in the water. Thus the voyager may paſs on one ſide in his boat, ſurvey the wonders within, and return by the oppoſite ſide.

The cavern called the Geylit-pot, almoſt realiſes in form a fable in the Perſian Tales. The hardy adventurer may make a long ſubterraneous voyage, with a pictureſque ſcenery of rock above and on every ſide. He may be rowed in this ſolemn ſcene till he finds himſelf ſuddenly reſtored to the ſight of the heavens: he finds himſelf in a circular chaſm, open to the day, with a narrow bottom and extenſive top, widening at the margin to the diameter of two hundred feet. On attaining the ſummit, he finds himſelf at a diſtance from the ſea, amidſt cornfields or verdant paſtures, with a fine view of the country, and a gentleman's ſeat near to the place from which he had emerged. Such may be the amuſement of the curious in ſummer calms! but when the ſtorms are directed from the eaſt, the view from the edge of this hollow is tremendous; for, from the height of above three hundred feet, they may look down on the furious waves, whitened with foam, and ſwelling from their confined paſſage.

Peninſulated rocks often jut from the face of the cliff's, precipitous on their ſides, and waſhed by a great depth of water. The iſthmus which joins them to the land, is often ſo extremely narrow as to render it impaſſable for more than two or three perſons a-breaſt; but the tops ſpread into verdant areas, containing veſtiges of rude fortifications, in antient and barbarous times the retreat of the neighboring inhabitants from the rage of a potent invader*.

Montroſe, MONTROSE. peninſulated by the ſea, and the baſon its beautiful harbour, ſtands on a bed of ſand and gravel. The tide ruſhing furiouſly through a narrow entrance twice in twenty-four hours, fills the port with a depth of water ſufficient to bring in veſſels of large burden. Unfortunately, at the ebb they muſt lie dry; for none exceeding ſixty tons can at that period float, and thoſe only in the channel of the South Eſk, which, near Montroſe, diſcharges itſelf into the ſea.

A ſandy coaſt is continued for a ſmall diſtance from Montroſe. Rude rocky cliffs re-commence in the county of Merns, and front the ocean. Among the higheſt is Fowls-heugh, noted for the reſort of multitudes of ſea-birds. Bervie and Stonehive are two ſmall ports overhung with rocks; and on the ſummit of a [XVIII] moſt exalted one, are the vaſt ruins of Dunnoter, once the property of the warlike family of the Keiths. The rocks adjacent to it, like the preceding, aſſume various and groteſque forms.

A little farther the antient Deva, or Dee, opens into the ſea, after forming a harbour to the fine and flouriſhing town of Aberdeen. A ſandy coaſt continues for numbers of miles, part of which is ſo moveable as almoſt totally to have overwhelmed the pariſh of Furvie: two farms only exiſt, out of an eſtate, in 1600, valued at five hundred pounds a year.

A majeſtic rocky coaſt appears again. The Bullers of Buchan, BULLERS OF BUCHAN. and the noble arched rock, ſo finely repreſented by the pencil of the Reverend Mr. Cordiner *, are juſtly eſteemed the wonders of this country. The former is an amazing harbour, with an entrance through a moſt auguſt arch of great height and length. The inſide is a ſecure baſon, environed on every ſide by mural rocks: the whole projects far from the main land, and is bounded on each ſide by deep creeks; ſo that the traveller who chuſes to walk round the narrow battlements, ought firſt to be well aſſured of the ſtrength of his head.

A little farther is Peterhead, PETERHEAD. the moſt eaſtern port of Scotland, the common retreat of wind-bound ſhips; and a port which fully merits the attention of government, to render it more ſecure. Kinnaird-head, the Taizalum promontorium, lies a little farther north, and, with the north-eaſtern extremity of Cathneſs, forms the firth of Murray, the Tua Aeſtuarium, a bay of vaſt extent. Troup-head is another vaſt cape,CAVERNS AND SINGULAR ROCKS: to the weſt of the former. The caverns and rocks of that promontory yield to none in magnificence and ſingularity of ſhape: of the latter, ſome emulate the form of lofty towers, others of inclining pyramids with central arches,HOW FORMED. pervious to boats. The figures of theſe are the effect of chance, and owing to the colliſion of the waves, which wearing away the earth and crumbly parts, leave them the juſt ſubjects of our admiration. Sea-plants, ſhells, and various ſorts of marine exſanguious animals, cloath their baſes, waſhed by a deep and clear ſea; and their ſummits reſound with the various clang of the feathered tribe.

From hence the bay is bounded on the ſouth by the extenſive and rich plains of Murray. The ſhore wants not its wild beauties. The view of the noble cavern, called the rocks of Cauſſie, on the ſhore between Burgh-head and Loſſie mouth, drawn by Mr. Cordiner, fully evinces the aſſertion. The bottom of the bay cloſes with the firth of Inverneſs, from whence to the Atlantic ocean is a chain of rivers, lakes, and bays, with the interruption only of two miles of land between Loch-oich and Lochlochy. Unite thoſe two lakes by a canal, and the reſt of North Britain would be completely inſulated.

[figure]

[XIX]To the north the firth of Cromartie, and the firth of Tayne, the Vara Aeſtuarium, penetrate deep into the land. From Dornoch, the coaſt of Sutherland is low and ſandy, except in a few places: one, at the water of Brora, is diſtinguiſhed by the beauty of the rocky ſcenery; in the midſt of which the river precipitates itſelf into the ſea, down a lofty precipice. The Scottiſh Alps, which heretofore kept remote from the ſhore, now approach very near; and at the great promontory, the Ripa Alta of Ptolemy, the Ord, i. e. Aird of Cathneſs, ORD OF CATHNESS. or the Height of Cathneſs, terminate in a moſt ſublime and abrupt manner in the ſea. The upper part is covered with gloomy heath; the lower is a ſtupendous precipice, excavated into vaſt caverns, the haunt of Seals and different ſea-fowl. On the eaſtern ſide of the kingdom, this is the ſtriking termination of the vaſt mountains of Scotland, which form its Highlands, the habitation of the original inhabitants,HIGHLAND ALPS. driven from their antient ſeats by the anceſtors of Lowland Scots, deſcendants of Saxons, French, and Normans, congenerous with the Engliſh, yet abſurdly and invidiouſly diſtinguiſhed from them. Language, as well as ſtriking natural boundaries, mark their place. Their mountains face on the weſt the Atlantic ocean; wind along the weſt of Cathneſs; among which Morvern and Scaraben, Ben-Hop and Ben-Lugal ariſe pre-eminent. Sutherland is entirely Alpine, as are Roſs-ſhire and Inverneſs-ſhire. Their Summae Alpes are, Meal Fourvounich, the Coryarich, Benewiſh, and Beneviſh near Fort William; the laſt of which is reported to be fourteen hundred and fifty yards in height. Great part of Aberdeenſhire lies in this tract. It boaſts of another Morvern, ſoaring far beyond the others: this is in the centre of the Grampian hills, and perhaps the higheſt from the ſea of any in Great Britain. They again comprehend the eaſtern part of Perthſhire, and finiſh on the magnificent ſhores of Loch-lomond, on the weſtern ſide of which Ben-lomond riſes, diſtinguiſhed among its fellows. From hence the reſt of North Britain forms a chain of humbler hills; but in Cumberland, ENGLISH. part of Weſtmoreland, Yorkſhire, Lancaſhire, and Derbyſhire, CAMBRIAN. the Alps reſume their former majeſty. A long and tame interval ſucceeds. The long ſublime tract of Wales ariſes, the antient poſſeſſion of the antient Britiſh race. From the Ord, the great mountains recede inland, and leave a vaſt flat between their baſes and the ſea, fronting the waves with a ſeries of lofty rocky precipices, as far as the little creek of Staxigo; the whole a bold, but moſt inhoſpitable ſhore for ſhipping. Wick and Staxigo have indeed their creeks, or rather chaſms, which open between the cliffs, and may accidentally prove a retreat, unleſs in an eaſtern gale.

Sinclair and Freſwick bays are ſandy, and afford ſafe anchorage: from the laſt the country riſes into lofty cliffs, many compoſed of ſmall ſtrata of ſtones, as regular as a maſon could lay them; and before them riſe inſulated ſtacks or columns [XX] of ſimilar materials, ſome hollowed into arches; others, pillar-like, aſpire in heights equal to the land* Theſe are animated with birds. All their oeconomy may be viewed with eaſe from the neighboring cliffs; their loves, incubation, excluſion, and nutrition.

Dungſby-head, the antient Berubium, terminates the eaſtern ſide of this kingdom, as Far-out-head, the old Tarvedum, does the weſtern. Strathy-head, the Vervedrum of Ptolemy, lies intermediate. The whole tract faces the north, and conſiſts of various noted headlands, giving ſhelter to numerous bays, many of which penetrate deep into the country. Let me make this general remark,—that nature hath, with a niggardly hand, dealt out her harbours to the eaſtern coaſts of the Britiſh iſles; but ſhewn a profuſion on their weſtern ſides. What numberleſs lochs, with great depth of water, wind into the weſtern counties of Scotland, over-ſhadowed and ſheltered by lofty mountains! and what multitudes of noble harbours do the weſtern provinces of Ireland open into the immenſe Atlantic ocean!

[figure]

But fortunately, to the north of theſe,SAND-BANKS. this ſea is much more remarkable for ſand-banks of utility than of danger, and would never have been obſerved but for the multitudes of fiſhes which, at different ſeaſons, according to their ſpecies, reſort to their ſides, from the great northern deeps, either for the ſake of variety of food which they yield, or to depoſe their ſpawn in ſecurity. The firſt to be taken notice of does not come within the deſcription, yet ſhould not be paſſed over in ſilence, as it comes within the natural hiſtory of the North ſea. An anonymous ſand runs acroſs the channel between Buchan-neſs and the north end of Juts-riff: the left depth of water over it is forty fathoms; ſo that it would ſcarcely be thought of, did not the water ſuddenly deepen again, and form that place which is ſtyled the Buchan deeps.

The Long Bank, or the Long Fortys, LONG FORTYS. bears E. S. E. from Buchan-neſs, about forty-five miles diſtant, and extends ſouthward as far as oppoſite to Newcaſtle; is about fifty leagues in length, and ſeven in breadth; and has on it from thirty-two to forty-five fathoms of water. The ground is a coarſe gravel, mixed with marine plants, and is eſteemed a good fiſhing bank.

The Mar Bank lies between the former and the ſhore oppoſite to Berwick; is oval, about fifteen miles long, and has about twenty-ſix fathom of water, and round it about forty.

The bank called Montroſe Pits lies a little to the eaſt of the middle of the Long Fortys. It is about fifty miles long,MONTROSE PITS. and moſt remarkable for five great pits or hollows, from three to four miles in diameter: on their edges is only forty fathom water; yet they ſuddenly deepen to ſeventy, and even a hundred fathom, on a ſoft muddy bottom: the margins on the contrary are gravelly. I enquired whether the [XXII] ſurface of this wonderful bank appeared in any way agitated, as I had ſuſpicion that the pits might have been productive of whirlpools; but was informed, that the ſea there exhibited no uncommon appearance.

The noted Doggers Bank next ſucceeds.DOGGERS BANK. It commences at the diſtance of twelve leagues from Flamborough Head, and extends acroſs the ſea, nearly eaſt, above ſeventy-two leagues, joining Horn-riff, a very narrow ſtrip of ſand which ends on the coaſt of Jutland. The greateſt breadth is twenty leagues; and in parts it has only on it ten or eleven fathoms of water, in others twenty-four or five. To the ſouth of the Dogger is a vaſt extent of ſand-bank, named, in different parts, the Well Bank, WELL BANK. the Swart Bank, and the Brown Bank, all covered with ſufficient depth of water; but between them and the Britiſh coaſts are the Ower and the Lemon, dreaded by mariners, and numbers of others infamous for ſhipwrecks. The channel between the Dogger Bank and the Well Bank deepens even to forty fathoms. This hollow is called the Silver Pits, and is noted for the cod-fiſhery which ſupplies the London markets. The cod-fiſh love the deeps: the flat-fiſh the ſhallows. I will not repeat what I have, in another place, ſo amply treated ofSee Br. Zool. iii. Articles Haddock, Ling, and Turbot.. I muſt only lament, that the fiſheries of this bank are only ſubſervient to the purpoſes of luxury. Was (according to the plan of my humane friend, Mr. Travis of Scarborough) a canal formed from any part of the neighboring coaſt to that at Leeds, thouſands of manufacturers would receive a cheap and wholeſome food; inſurrections in times of ſcarcity of grain be prevented; our manufactures worked at an eaſy rate; our rivals in trade thereby underſold; and, in defiance of the probably approaching decreaſe of the Newfoundland fiſhery (ſince the loſs of America) contribute to form a nurſery of ſeamen ſufficient to preſerve the ſmall remnant we have left of reſpect from foreign nations.

I have, to the beſt of my abilities, enumerated the Britiſh fiſh, in the third volume of the Britiſh Zoology. The Faunula which I have prefixed to Mr. Light-foot's Flora Scotica, contains thoſe which frequent the northern coaſts of Great Britain; in which will be found wanting many of thoſe of South Britain. The Reverend Mr. LIGHTFOOT, in that work, hath given a moſt elaborate account of the ſubmarine plants of our northern ſea.

I will now purſue my voyage from the extreme ſhores of North Britain through a new ocean.CALEDONIAN OCEAN. Here commences the Oceanus Caledonius, or Deucaledonius, of Ptolemy; a vaſt expanſe, extending to the weſt as far as Greenland, and northward to the extreme north. This I ſhould call the NORTHERN OCEAN, diſtinguiſhing its parts by other names ſuitable to the coaſts. From Dungſby Head the Orkney iſlands [XXIII] ‘appear ſpreading along the horizon, and yield a moſt charming proſpect.ORKNEY ISLANDS. Some of them are ſo near as diſtinctly to exhibit the rocky fronts of thoſe bold promontories which ſuſtain the weight of the vaſt currents from the Atlantic. Others ſhew more faint: their diſtances finely expreſſed as they retire from the eye, until the mountains of the more remote have ſcarcely a deeper azure than the ſky, and are hardly diſcernible riſing over the ſurface of the ocean*.’

Between theſe and the main land, about two miles from the Cathneſs ſhore, lies Stroma, STROMA. the Ocetis of Ptolemy, a little iſland, an appertenance to that county, fertile by the manual labor of about thirty families; pleaſant, and lofty enough for the reſort of the Auk tribe. The noted mummies are now loſt, occaſioned by the doors of the caverns in which they were depoſited being broken down, and admiſſion given to cattle, which have trampled them to pieces. This catacomb ſtands on a neck of land bounded by the ſea on three ſides. The ſalt air and ſpray expels all inſects, and is the only preſervation the bodies have; ſome of which had been lodged here a great number of years. In many of the iſles, the inhabitants uſe no other method for preſerving their meat from putrefaction than hanging it in caves of the ſea, and the method is vindicated by the ſucceſs.

This iſland lies in the Pentland Firth, noted for the violence of the tides;TIDES. tremendous to the ſight, but dangerous only when paſſed at improper times. They ſet in from the north-weſt: the flood, on the contrary, on the coaſts of Lewis, pours in from the ſouth. The tide of flood upon Stroma (and other iſlands ſimilarly ſituated in mid-ſtream) divides or ſplits before it reaches it. A current runs with great violence on both ſides, then unites, at ſome diſtance from the oppoſite end, and forms a ſingle current, running at ſpring-tides at the rate of nine knots an hour; at neap, at that of three only. The ſpace between the dividing tides, at different ends of an iſland, is quite ſtagnant, and is called the eddy. Some of them are a mile or two long, and give room for a ſhip to tack to and fro, till the tides are ſo far ſpent as to permit it to purſue its voyage.

The moſt boiſterous parts of the ſtreams are at the extremities of the iſland,THE SWELCHIE OF STROMA. and a little beyond the top of the eddy, where they unite. The colliſion of theſe oppoſite ſtreams-excite a circular motion, and, when the tide is very ſtrong, occaſion whirlpools in form of an inverted bell, the largeſt diameter of which may be about three feet. In ſpring-tides they have force enough to turn a veſſel round, but not to do any damage: but there have been inſtances of ſmall boats being ſwallowed up. Theſe whirlpools are largeſt when firſt formed; are carried away with the ſtream, and diſappear, but are quickly followed by others. The ſpiral motion or ſuction [XXIV] does not extend far beyond the cavity: a boat may paſs within twenty yards of theſe whirlpools with ſafety. Fiſhermen who happen to find themſelves within a dangerous diſtance, fling in an oar, or any bulky body, which breaks the continuity of the ſurface, and interrupts the vertiginous motion, and forces the water to ruſh ſuddenly in on all ſides and fill up the cavity. In ſtormy weather, the waves themſelves deſtroy this phaenomenon. A ſunk rock near the concourſe of theſe rapid tides occaſions a moſt dreadful appearance. The ſtream meeting with an interruption, falls over with great violence, reaches the bottom, and brings up with it ſand, ſhells, fiſhes, or whatſoever elſe it meets with; which, with boats, or whatſoever it happens to meet, is whirled from the centre of the eruption towards the circumference with amazing velocity, and the troubled ſurface boils and bubbles like a great cauldron, then darts off with a ſucceſſion of whirlpools from ſucceſſive ebullitions. Theſe are called Rouſts, ROUSTS. and are attended with the utmoſt danger to ſmall boats, which are agitated to ſuch a degree, that (even ſhould they not be overſet) the men are flung out of them, to periſh without any chance of redemption. It is during the ebb that they are tremendous, and moſt ſo in that of a ſpring-tide with a weſt wind, and that in the calmeſt weather; for during flood they are paſſed with the greateſt ſafety. Veſſels in a calm are never in danger of touching on an iſland or viſible rock, when they get into a current, but are always carried ſafe from all danger.

Swona, SWONA. a little iſland, the moſt ſouthern of the Orknies, is about four miles beyond Stroma, and is noted for its tremendous ſtreams, and in particular the whirlpools called the Wells of Swona, which in a higher degree exhibit all the appearances of the former. What contributes to encreaſe the rage of the tides, beſides their confinement between ſo many iſlands, is the irregular poſition of the ſounds, and their little depth of water.DEPTH OF WATER. The ſame ſhallowneſs extends to every ſide of the Orknies; an evidence that they had once been part of the mother iſle, rent from it by ſome mighty convulſion. The middle of the channel, between Stroma and the main land, has only ten fathom water: the greateſt depth around that iſland is only eighteen. The ſounds are from three to forty-ſix fathom deep: the greater depths are between South Ronaldſha and South Wales; for in general the other ſounds are only from three to thirteen; and the circumambient depth of the whole group very rarely exceeds twenty-five.

TIDES.About theſe iſlands commences a decreaſe of the tides. They lie in a great ocean, in which the waters have room to expand; therefore never experience that height of flood which is conſtant in the contracted ſeas. Here ordinary ſpring-tides do not exceed eight feet; and very extraordinary ſpring-tides fourteen, even when acted on by the violence of the winds*.

[XXV]The time of the diſcovery and population of the Orknies is unknown. Probably it was very early; for we are told that they owe their name to the Greeks. ‘Orcades has memorant dictas a nomine Graeco *.’ Mela and Pliny take notice of them; and the laſt deſcribes their number and cluſtered form with much accuracy The fleet of Agricola ſailed round them, and made a conqueſt of them; but the Romans probably never retained any part of Caledonia. I found no marks of them beyond Orrea or Inchtuthel , excepting at Fortingal in Breadalbine, where there is a ſmall camp, poſſibly no more than a temporary advanced poſt. Notwithſtanding this, they muſt have had, by means of ſhipping, a communicated knowlege of the coaſts of North Britain even to the Orcades. Ptolemy hath, from information collected by thoſe means, given the names of every nation, conſiderable river, and head-land, on the eaſtern, northern, and weſtern coaſt. But the Romans had forgotten the navigation of theſe ſeas, otherwiſe the poet would never have celebrated the courage of his countrymen, in ſailing in purſuit of the plundering Saxons through unknown ſtreights, and a naval victory obtained off theſe iſlands by the forces ſent to the relief of the diſtreſſed Britons by Honorius.

Quid Sidera proſunt?
Ignotumque fretum? Maduerunt Saxone fuſo
Orcades§.

The Orkney iſles in after times became poſſeſſed by the Picts; and again by the Scots. The latter gave way to the Norwegian pirates, who were ſubdued by Harold Harfargre about the year 875, and the iſlands united to the crown of Norway. They remained under the Norwegians till the year 1203, accepted their laws, and uſed their language. The Norſe, LANGUAGE. or Norwegian language was generally uſed in the Orkney and Schetland iſlands even to the laſt century: but, except in Foula, where a few words are ſtill known by the aged people, it is quite loſt. The Engliſh tongue, with a Norwegian accent, is that of the iſlands; but the appearance of the people, their manners and genius, evidently ſhew their northern origin. The iſlands vary in their form and height. Great part of Hoy is mountanous and lofty. The noted land-mark, the hill of Hoy, ROCKS OF THE ORKNIES. is ſaid to be five hundred and forty yards high. The ſides of all theſe hills are covered with long heath, in which breed multitudes of Curlews, Green Plovers, Redſhanks, and other Waders. The Short-eared Owl is alſo very frequent here, and neſtles in the ground. It is [XXVI] probable that it is from hence, as well as from Norway, that it migrates, in the beginning of winter, to the more ſouthern parts of Britain. Moſt of the Waders migrate; but they muſt receive conſiderable reinforcements from the moſt diſtant parts of the north, to fill the numbers which cover our ſhores. The cliffs are of a moſt ſtupendous height, and quite mural to the very ſea. The Berry Head is an exalted precipice,BIRDS. with an auguſt cave at the bottom, opening into the ſea. The Ern Eagles poſſeſs, by diſtant pairs, the upper part of the rocks: neither theſe nor any other Falcons will bear ſociety; but, as Pliny elegantly expreſſes it, Adultos perſequitur parens et longè fugat, aemulos ſcilicet rapinae. Et alioquin unum par aquilarum magno ad populandum tractu, ut ſatietur, indiget *. Auks, Corvorants, and all the tribes which love exalted ſituations, breed by thouſands in the other parts. The Tyſte, or Black Guillemot, No 236, ſecures itſelf in a crack in the rock, or by ſcraping a burrow in the little earth it may find; there it lays a ſingle egg, of a dirty olive blotched with a darker. This ſpecies never migrates from the Orknies. The Fooliſh Guillemot, No 436, continues till November. The Little Auk, No 429, a rare bird in other parts of Britain, breeds in the holes of the lofty precipices. And the Lyre, or the Sheerwater, No 462, burrows in the earth among the rocks of Hoy and Eda, and forms an article of commerce with its feathers, and of food with its fleſh, which is ſalted and kept for the proviſion of the winter. In that ſeaſon they are ſeen ſkimming the ocean at moſt ſurprizing diſtances from land. The Stormy Petrel, No 464, breeds frequently among the looſe ſtones; then takes to ſea and affrights the ſuperſtitious ſailor with its appearance. Woodcocks ſcarcely ever appear here. Fieldfares make this a ſhort baiting-place: and the Snow Bunting, No 122, often alights and covers whole tracts of country, driven by the froſt from the fartheſt north.

A few Wild Swans breed in ſome lochs in Mainland; but the greateſt part of theſe birds, all the Bernacles, Brent Geeſe, and ſeveral other palmated birds, retire in the ſpring to more northern latitudes. But to the Swallow-tailed Duck, the Pintail, and a few others, this is a warm climate; for they retire here to paſs their winters in the ſheltered bays. Any other remarks may be intermixed with thoſe on Schetland; for there is great ſimiliarity of ſubjects in both the groups.

The laſt lie about ſixty miles to the north-eaſt of the moſt northern Orkney. Midway is Fair Iſland, FAIR ISLE. a ſpot about three miles long, with high and rocky ſhores, inhabited by about a hundred and ſeventy people: an induſtrious race; the men fiſhers; the women knitters and ſpinners. The depth of water round varies to twenty-ſix fathoms. The tide divides at the north end, runs with great velocity, and forms on the eaſt ſide a conſiderable eddy.

Figure 1. The DOREHOLM.

[XXVII] Schetland conſiſts of ſeveral iſlands. Mainland, SCHETLAND. the principal, extends from ſouth to north twenty-eight leagues, and is moſt ſingularly formed; conſiſting of an infinite number of peninſulae connected by very narrow iſthmuſes. That called Maviſgrind, which unites the pariſh of North Maven, is only eighty yards broad. But the irregular ſhape of this iſland occaſions it to abound with the fineſt and moſt ſecure ports, called here voes; a moſt providential diſpenſation in a ſea which ſwarms with fiſhes of the moſt general uſe. The adjacent iſlands are in general ſo near to the mother iſland, and their headlands point ſo exactly to its correſponding capes, that it is highly probable that they once made a part of the Mainland. The rocks and ſtacks aſſume great variety of forms, ſuch as ſteeples and Gothic cathedrals riſing out of the water, fleets of ſhips, and other fancied ſhapes. The Doreholm, in the pariſh of North Maven, is very ſingular: part is rounded, the reſt ſeems a ruin, compoſed of a ſingle thin fragment of rock, with a magnificent arch within, ſeventy feet in height.

To uſe the words of Captain Thomas Preſton, to whom we are indebted for an excellent chart of this group, ‘the land is wild, barren, and mountanous; nor is there ſo much as a buſh or a tree to be ſeen. The ſhores are difficult, and in many parts inacceſſible; rude, ſteep, and iron-like; the ſight of which ſtrikes the mind with dread and horror; and ſuch monſtrous precipices and hideous rocks as bring all Brobdingnag before your thoughts. Theſe iſlands lie between lat. 60 to 61. In winter the ſun ſets ſoon after it riſes, and in ſummer riſes ſoon after it ſets; ſo that in that ſeaſon the nights are almoſt as light as the day; as on the contrary, in December the day is nearly as dark as the night. About the ſolſtice, we ſee every night the aurora borealis, or, as they are called by the natives, the merry dancers, which ſpread a broad glaring appearance over the whole northern hemiſphere*.’

They are the conſtant attendants of the clear evenings in all theſe northern iſlands, and prove great reliefs amidſt the gloom of the long winter nights.AURORA BOREALIS. They commonly appear at twilight near the horizon, of a dun color, approaching to yellow: ſometimes continuing in that ſtate for ſeveral hours without any ſenſible motion; after which they break out into ſtreams of ſtronger light, ſpreading into columns, and altering ſlowly into ten thouſand different ſhapes, varying their colors from all the tints of yellow to the obſcureſt ruſſet. They often cover the whole hemiſphere, and then make the moſt brilliant appearance. Their motions at theſe times are moſt amazingly quick; and they aſtoniſh the ſpectator with the rapid change of their form. They break out in places where none were ſeen before, ſkimming [XXVIII] briſkly along the heavens: are ſuddenly extinguiſhed, and leave behind an uniform duſky tract. This again is brilliantly illuminated in the ſame manner, and as ſuddenly left a dull blank. In certain nights they aſſume the appearance of vaſt columns, on one ſide of the deepeſt yellow, on the other declining away till it becomes undiſtinguiſhed from the ſky. They have generally a ſtrong tremulous motion from end to end, which continues till the whole vaniſhes. In a word, we, who only ſee the extremities of theſe northern phoenomena, have but a faint idea of their ſplendor, and their motions. According to the ſtate of the atmoſphere they differ in colors. They often put on the color of blood, and make a moſt dreadful appearance. The ruſtic ſages become prophetic, and terrify the gazing ſpectators with the dread of war, peſtilence, and famine. This ſuperſtition was not peculiar to the northern iſlands; nor are theſe appearances of recent date. The antients called them Chaſmata, and Trabes, and Bolides, according to their forms or colors*. In old times they were extremely rare, and on that account were the more taken notice of. From the days of Plutarch to thoſe of our ſage hiſtorian Sir Richard Baker, they were ſuppoſed to have been portentous of great events: and timid imagination ſhaped them into aerial conflicts.

Fierce fiery warriors fight upon the clouds
In ranks and ſquadrons and right form of war.

After, I ſuppoſe, a very long intermiſſion, they appeared with great brilliancy in England, on March 6rh, 1715-16. The philoſophers paid a proper attention. The vulgar conſidered them as marking the introduction of a foreign race of princes. The novelty is now ceaſed, and their cauſe perhaps properly attributed to the greater abundance of electrical matter.

STORMS.The tempeſts which reign over theſe iſlands during winter is aſtoniſhing. The cold is moderate; the fogs great and frequent; but the ſtorms agitate the water even to the bottom of theſe comparatively ſhallow ſeas.HERRINGS. The fiſh ſeek the bottom of the great deeps: and the Herrings, which appear off the Schetlands in amazing columns in June, perform the circuit of our iſland, and retire beyond the knowlege of man. When the main body of theſe fiſh approaches from the north, it alters the very appearance of the ocean. It is divided into columns of five or ſix miles in length, and three or four in breadth, and they drive the water before them with a ſort of rippling current. Sometimes they ſink for a ſmall ſpace, then riſe again; and in bright weather reflect a variety of ſplendid colors, like a field of moſt [XXIX] precious gems. Birds and fiſh of prey attend and mark their progreſs. The Whales of ſeveral kinds keep on the outſide, and, deliberately opening their vaſt mouths, take them in by hundreds. Gannets and Gulls dart down upon them; and the diving tribe aid their perſecution, with the cetaceous fiſhes*. Mankind joins in the chace; for this uſeful ſpecies gives food to millions, mediately and immediately. Dutch, French, Flemings, Danes, and Engliſh, rendezvous in Braſſa ſound to meet theſe treaſures of the ocean: and return to diſtribute their booty even to the diſtant Antilles.

Cod, Ling, and Torſk furniſh cargoes to other adventurers.COD-FISH. I wiſh I could ſpeak with the ſame ſatisfaction of this as of the free fiſhery of the Herring; but in theſe diſtant iſlands, the hand of oppreſſion reigns uncontrolled. The poor vaſſals (in defiance of laws ſtill kept in bondage) are compelled to ſlave, and hazard their lives in the capture, to deliver their fiſh to their lords for a trifling ſum, who ſell them to adventurers from different parts at a high price.

Among other ſcarcer fiſhes the Opah,OPAH. Br. Zool. iii. No 101. is found in abundance. It ſeems a fiſh of the north as well as the Torſk; the laſt is not found ſouth of the Orknies; the former extends even to the banks of Newfoundland.

The birds of theſe iſlands are the ſame with thoſe of the Orknies, BIRDS. except the Skua, p. 531, which breeds only in Foula and Unſt. Among the few land-birds which migrate to them in ſummer, is the Golden-creſted Wren, No 153. Its ſhorteſt flight muſt be ſixty miles, except it ſhould reſt midway on Fair iſland; a ſurpriſing flight for ſo diminutive a bird!

Multitudes of the inhabitants of each cluſter of iſlands feed, during the ſeaſon,FOWLING. on the eggs of the birds of the cliffs. The method of taking them is ſo very hazardous, as to ſatisfy one of the extremity to which the poor people are driven for want of food. Copinſha, Hunda, Hoy, Foula, and Noſs head, are the moſt celebrated rocks; and the neighboring natives the moſt expert climbers and adventurers after the game of the precipice. The height of ſome is above fifty fathoms; their faces roughened with ſhelves or ledges, ſufficient only for the birds to reſt and lay their eggs. To theſe the dauntleſs fowlers will aſcend, paſs intrepidly from one to the other, collect the eggs and birds, and deſcend with the ſame indifference. In moſt places, the attempt is made from above: they are lowered from the ſlope contiguous to the brink, by a rope, ſometimes made of ſtraw, ſometimes of the briſtles of the hog: they prefer the laſt, even to ropes of hemp, as it is not liable to be cut by the ſharpneſs of the rocks; the former is apt to untwiſt. They truſt themſelves to a ſingle aſſiſtant, who lets his companion down, and holds the rope, depending on his ſtrength alone; which [XXX] often fails, and the adventurer is ſure to be daſhed to pieces, or drowned in the ſubjacent ſea. The rope is often ſhifted from place to place, with the impending weight of the fowler and his booty. The perſon above receives ſignals for the purpoſe, his aſſociate being far out of ſight; who, during the operation, by help of a ſtaff, ſprings from the face of the rocks, to avoid injury from the projecting parts.

In Foula, they will truſt to a ſmall ſtake driven into the ground, or to a ſmall dagger, which the natives uſually carry about them; and which they will ſtick into the ground, and, twiſting round it a fiſhing cord, deſcend by that to climbing places, and, after finiſhing their buſineſs, ſwarm up by it without fear. Few who make a practice of this come to a natural death. They have a common ſaying, ‘Such a one's Gutcher went over the Sneak; and my father went over the Sneak too.’ It is a pity that the old Norwegian law was not here in force. It conſidered this kind of death as a ſpecies of ſuicide. The next of kin (in caſe the body could be ſeen) was directed to go the ſame way; if he refuſed, the corpſe was not to be admitted into holy ground*.

But the moſt ſingular ſpecies of fowling is on the holm of Noſs, a vaſt rock ſevered from the iſle of Noſs by ſome unknown convulſion, and only about ſixteen fathoms diſtant. It is of the ſame ſtupendous height as the oppoſite precipice, with a raging ſea between; ſo that the intervening chaſm is of matchleſs horror. Some adventurous climber has reached the rock in a boat, gained the height, and faſtened ſeveral ſtakes on the ſmall portion of earth which is to be found on the top: correſpondent ſtakes are placed on the edge of the correſpondent cliffs. A rope is fixed to the ſtakes on both ſides, along which a machine, called a cradle, is contrived to ſlide; and, by the help of a ſmall parallel cord faſtened in like manner, the adventurer wafts himſelf over, and returns with his booty, which is the eggs or young of the Black-backed Gull, No 451, and the Herring Gull, No 452.

QUADRUPEDS.The number of wild Quadrupeds which have reached the Orkney and Schetland iſlands are only five; the Otter, Brown Rat, Common Mouſe, Fetid Shrew, and Bat. Rabbets are not of Britiſh origin, but naturalized in every part. In the ſandy iſles of Orkney, they are found in myriads, and their ſkins are a great article of commerce; but the injury they do in ſetting the unſtable ſoil in motion, greatly counter-vales the profit.

Figure 2. BIRD CATCHING at ORKNEY

The great quantity of turf which Providence hath beſtowed on all theſe iſlands, excepting Sanda, is another proof of the abundance of trees and other vegetables, long ſince loſt from the ſurface. The application of this humus vegetabilis for the purpoſe of fuel, is ſaid to have been firſt taught the natives by Einar, a Norwegian, ſurnamed, from that circumſtance, Torf einar, Einar de Ceſpite *. Had he lived in Greece, he could not have eſcaped deification for ſo uſeful a diſcovery.

Before I quit the laſt of Britiſh iſles, I ſhall,ANTIQUITIES. as ſupplemental to the antiquities mentioned in my Tours in Scotland, give a brief account of others found in theſe groups.

The Orknies, the Schetlands, Cathneſs, Sutherland, and Roſs-ſhire, with the Hebrides, were, for centuries, poſſeſſed by the Norwegians; and, in many inſtances, they adopted their cuſtoms. Of the antient monuments ſtill remaining, ſeveral are common to Scandinavia and the old inhabitants of Britain: others ſeem peculiar to their northern conquerors. Among thoſe are the circular buildings, known by the names of Pictiſh houſes, Burghs, and Duns: the firſt are of modern date, and to be exploded, as they never were the work of the Picts; the ſecond are aſſuredly right, and point out the founders, who at the ſame time beſtowed on them their natal name of Borg, a defence or caſtle, a Sueo-Gothic word; and the Highlanders univerſally apply to theſe places the Celtic name Dun, ſignifying a hill defended by a tower. This alſo furniſhes the proof of their uſe, was there no other to be diſcovered. They are confined to the counties once ſubject to the crown of Norway. With few exceptions, they are built within ſight of the ſea, and one or more within ſight of the other; ſo that on a ſignal by fire, by flag, or by trumpet, they could give notice of approaching danger, and yield a mutual ſuccour. In the Schetland and Orkney [XXXII] iſlands, they are moſt frequently called Wart or Wardhills, which ſhews that they were garriſoned. They had their wardmadher *, or watchman, a ſort of centinel, who ſtood on the top, and challenged all who came in ſight. The gackman was an officer of the ſame kind, who not only was on the watch againſt ſurprize; but was to give notice if he ſaw any ſhips in diſtreſs. He was allowed a large horn of generous liquor, which he had always by him, to keep up his ſpirits. Along the Orkney and Schetland ſhores, they almoſt form a chain; and by that means not only kept the natives in ſubjection, but were ſituated commodiouſly for covering the landing of their countrymen, who were perpetually roving on piratical expeditions. Theſe towers were even made uſe of as ſtate-priſons; for we learn from Torfaeus, that after Sueno had ſurprized Paul, count of Cathneſs, he carried him into Sutherland, and confined him there in a Norwegian tower§. So much has been ſaid on this ſubject by the Reverend Mr. Cordiner and myſelf, that I ſhall only refer to the pages, after ſaying, that out of our kingdom, no buildings ſimilar to theſe are to be found, except in Scandinavia. On the mountain Swalberg in Norway is one; the Stir-biſkop , at Upſal in Sweden, is another; and Umſeborg, in the ſame kingdom, is a third**.

Figure 3. Antiquities in the ORKNEY &c SHETLAND Isles.

After the expulſion of the Norwegians, the coaſts of Scotland, which they poſſeſſed, were ſtill protected by caſtles; many of which, ſuch as Oldwick, exhibit very ſmall improvements on the model left by the antient Scandinavian architects: a few deviated from the original manner, were ſquare, had great thickneſs of wall, furniſhed with cells like thoſe in the round towers or burghs. Borve caſtle,BORVE CASTLE. in Cathneſs, is a little more advanced. This was the reſidence of Thorkel, a famous freebooter in the tenth century. It is a ſmall ſquare building, on a rock projecting into the ſea, adjoined to the main land by an iſthmus not ten feet wide; and beneath the caſtle is a magnificent paſſage for boats, which pierces the rock from ſide to ſide, and is covered by a matchleſs natural arch.

I cannot but revert to the former ſubject, to mention the Snaburgh in Tetlor, one of the moſt remote of the Schetland iſles. It is in the form of a Roman camp;ROMAN CAMP: and when entire, had in the middle a rectangular area ſurrounded by a wall, and that by an earthen rampart of the ſame figure, at ſome diſtance from it. Two ſides of the walled area have the additional defence of another rampart of earth; which commences on the inſide of one of the narrower ſides, and, preſerving the ſame diſtance from the leſſer area as the two other ſides of the outward fence do, terminates at the latter, near an artificial well. That this was Roman, I greatly ſuſpect. The care for water was a peculiar object with that wiſe nation; but neglected by barbarians. This is incloſed within the rampart, and at a ſmall diſtance on the outſide, had the protection of a mount, which once probably had its caſtellet, garriſoned for the further ſecurity. The regular portae are wanting; in other reſpects it reſembles a Roman camp. The ſea, over which it impends, has deſtroyed one half: the entire part is given in the plate, and the reſt ſupplied with dotted lines.

I know but of two periods in which the Romans viſited theſe iſlands: one at the time when the fleet of Agricola ſubdued them; the other, when the fleet of Honorius defeated the Saxons in the ſeas of Orkney. A copper medal of Veſpaſian, with Judaea devicta on the reverſe, was found on the ſouth ſide of Main-land, probably loſt there by the firſt invaders, who might venerate Veſpaſian, under whom many of them had ſerved, and who might naturally carry with them ſuch honorable memorials of his reign. The only antiquities found near [XXXIV] this place, were ſix pieces of braſs, caſt into a form the neareſt reſembling fetters. They were wrapped in a piece of raw hide; but we cannot pretend to ſay that they belonged to the occupiers of the camp.

STONE WEAPONS.Flint heads of arrows, flint axes, ſwords made of the bones of a whale, ſtones, beads, and antiquities, muſt be referred to the earlieſt inhabitants, at a period in which theſe kingdoms were on a level with the natives of new-diſcovered iſlands in the South Sea. CIRCLES. Druidical circles of ſtones, the temples of primaeval religion of our iſland, are not uncommon. The fineſt and moſt entire are thoſe at Stennis, in one of the Orkney iſles. The diameter of the circle is about a hundred and ten yards. The higheſt ſtone fourteen feet. The whole is ſingularly ſurrounded with a broad and deep ditch, probably to keep at a diſtance the unhallowed vulgar.

SEMICIRCLES.At the ſame place is a noble ſemicircle, conſiſting of four vaſt ſtones entire, and one broken. The higheſt are twenty feet high above ground. Behind them is a mound of earth, conformable to their poſition. If there never was a number of ſtones to complete a circle, this antiquity was one of the kind which the learned Doctor Borlaſe calls a theatre, and ſuppoſes was deſigned for the exhibition of dramatical performances*. I ſuſpect them to have been either for the purpoſes of religion, or judicial tranſactions; for the age was probably not ſufficiently refined for the former amuſements. Upright ſtones, either memorials of the dead,PLAIN COLUMNS. or victories obtained on the ſpot, are very numerous. The moſt remarkable is the ſtone of Sator, in the iſle of Eda. It is a flag, fifteen feet high, five and a half broad, and only nine inches thick. Its ſtory is quite unknown; but it probably reſts over a hero of that name. Notwithſtanding the long reſidence of the Norwegians in theſe iſlands, I find only one ſtone with a Runic inſcription, which runs along the ſides. The reſt of the ſtone is plain, and deſtitute of the ſculptures ſo frequent on thoſe found in Scandinavia.

SCULPTURED COLUMNS.In the wall of the church at Sandneſs, is a ſtone with three circles, a ſemicircle, and a ſquare figure, engraven on it. This is the only one which bears any reſemblance to the elegant carved columns at Meigle and Glames, and which extend, after a very long interval, as far as the church-yard of Far, on the extreme northern coaſt of Cathneſs. Several of theſe have been before attended to. I can only remark, that they are extremely local, and were, by their ſimilarity, only the work of a ſhort period. We imagine that the firſt, about which we can form any conjecture, was erected in 994, on the defeat of Camus, the Dane: the laſt in 1034, on the murder of Malcolm the Second.

[XXXV]In the iſle of Unſt are two ſingular circles, near each other.SEPULCHRAL ANTIQUITIES. The largeſt is fifty feet in diameter, to the outmoſt ring; for it conſiſts of three, concentrical; the outmoſt is formed of ſmall ſtones, the two inner of earth; through all of which is a ſingle narrow entrance to a tumulus which riſes in the centre. The other circle is only twenty-two feet in diameter, and has only two rings, formed of earth:CIRCULAR. in the centre is a barrow, the ſides of which are fenced with ſtones. No marks of their having been places of interment have been found, yet moſt probably that was their uſe.

The links or ſands of Skail, in Sandwich, one of the Orknies, abound in round barrows. BARROWS. Some are formed of earth alone, others of ſtone covered with earth. In the former was found a coffin, made of ſix flat ſtones. They are too ſhort to receive a body at full length: the ſkeletons found in them lie with the knees preſſed to the breaſt, and the legs doubled along the thighs. A bag, made of ruſhes, has been found at the feet of ſome of theſe ſkeletons, containing the bones, moſt probably, of another of the family. In one were to be ſeen multitudes of ſmall beetles. Whether they were placed there by deſign, or lodged there by accident, I will not determine; but, as I have diſcovered ſimilar inſects in the bag which incloſed the ſacred Ibis, we may ſuppoſe that the Egyptians, and the nation to whom theſe tumuli did belong, might have had the ſame ſuperſtition reſpecting them. On ſome of the corpſes interred in this iſland, the mode of burning was obſerved. The aſhes, depoſited in an urn which was covered on the top with a flat ſtone, have been found in the cell of one of the barrows. This coffin or cell was placed on the ground, then covered with a heap of ſtones, and that again caſed with earth and ſods. Both barrow and contents evince them to be of a different age from the former. Theſe tumuli were in the nature of family vaults: in them have been found two tiers of coffins*. It is probable, that on the death of any one of the family, the tumulus was opened, and the body interred near its kindred bones.

The violence of the winds have,GRAVES OF WESTRA. by blowing away the ſands in a certain part of Weſtra, one of the Schetlands, diſcovered an extenſive burying-place, once covered with the thickneſs of twenty feet. This ſeems to have belonged to different nations. One is marked by the tumuli conſiſting of ſtones and rubbiſh; ſome rounded, others flat at top like truncated cones. Near them are multitudes of graves, which are diſcoverable only by one, two, three, four, and ſometimes even more ſhort upright ſtones, ſet in the level ſand. The corpſe was interred a few feet deep, and covered with a layer of fine clay, to keep the ſand from touching it. [XXXVI] Not only human bones, but thoſe of oxen, horſes, dogs, and ſheep, have been found in theſe graves. Beſides, were ſeveral ſorts of warlike inſtruments, battle-axes, two-handed ſwords, broad ſwords, brazen daggers and ſcull-caps, and ſwords made of the bones of the whale: knives and combs: beads, brotches, and chains of ornament: a metal ſpoon, and a neat glaſs cup greatly corroded: ſmall flat circular pieces of marble: ſtones ſhaped like whetſtones, and ſpherical ſtones perforated, ſuch as were in former uſe in Scotland for turning of ſpindles: but the moſt ſingular thing was a thigh-bone cloſely incircled by a ring of gold. The tumuli ſeem to have been the places of ſepulture of the inhabitants of the iſles: the graves, thoſe of ſome foreign nation who had landed here, had a conflict, and proved victorious. I found my conjecture on the arms and other matters found in them. The braſs were Norwegian *, the iron belonging to the natives; but the weapons of conquerors and conquered were, with ceremonies reſembling thoſe at the funeral of Pallas, flung into the graves of the victorious party.

Hinc alii ſpolia oeciſis direpta Latinis
Conjiciunt igni, galeas enſeſque decoros,
Frenaque, ferventeſque rotas; pars munera nota,
Ipſorum clypeos; et non felicia tela:
Multa boum circa mactantur corpora morti.

The antiquities of this claſs found in Scandinavia are very numerous,IN SCANDINAVIA. and of a magnitude which evince the extreme population of the country. I diſcover only three kinds. The firſt may be exemplified in the vaſt rounded earthen tumulus in Smaland, with a rude monumental upright ſtone at top; and near it a ſpherical ſtone, beautifully carved, flung up in honor of Ingo King of Sweden, in the latter end of the ninth century: others in honor of Humblus, and Laudur brother to King Angantyr; the laſt ſurrounded at its baſe with a circle of rude ſtones. The Rambora Rolle is a mount of earth, with three upright pillars, placed ſo as to form a triangular ſpace. Other tumuli conſiſt entirely of vaſt heaps of ſtones. Several of the ſepulchral memorials are formed of ſtones diſpoſed in a circular form: ſome of low ſtones, like that of the Daniſh King Harald Hyldeland, placed round the edge of the flat area of a low mount. He was ſlain in battle by Ringo King of Sweden §, who paid him all funeral honors, burnt his body with great pomp, and placed around his tumulus the numerous bodies of his faithful followers who were ſlain around their prince; and their places of reſt are marked by multitudes of ſmall earthen barrows, with a ſingle ſtone at the top of each. On [XXXVII] the regal mount is a flat ſtone, with five hollows in it, baſons to receive the blood of the victims*. Others conſiſt of ſmall ſtones with Maen-hirion, as the Welsh ſtyle them, lofty rude pillars, intermixed. In ſome the leſſer ſtones depart from the circular form, are oval or oblong: their edges are often contiguous, and thoſe parts are often marked with a lofty pillar. Two pillars are ſometimes found, with an enormous ſtone ſet from top to top, ſo as to form the reſemblance of a gateway. Columns of great height are alſo found, ſurrounded at their baſe with two circles of ſmall ſtones. Finally, the ſtones are diſpoſed ſo as to form wedges, ſquares, long rows, as well as circles. The firſt denoted that armies of foot and horſe had prevaled: the ſecond, troops of warriors: the third, duels of champions: and the laſt, the burials of families§. Multitudes of ſingle obeliſcs are ſcattered over the country: ſome quite plain; others inſcribed with Runic characters, memorial of the dead, intermixed with well-fancied ornaments.

In many of the tumuli are found the weapons and other matters which had been depoſited with the burnt bones of the deceaſed. In thoſe of the earlieſt ages are the ſtone weapons, ſuch as axes and ſpears heads made of flint. In others have been met with a ſmall lamp, a key, and ſwords of braſs of the ſame form with ſome of the Roman ſwords**. A ſuperſtition attending the ſwords was ſingular: thoſe of higheſt temper were ſuppoſed to have been made by Duergi, dwarfs or fairies, and were thought to have been irreſiſtible. The reader will not be diſpleaſed with the elegant verſion †† of a Runic poem, deſcribing the incantations of a fair heroine, to obtain the magical ſword out of the tomb of her deceaſed father.

The Runic INVOCATION of HERVOR, the Daughter of ANGANTYR, Who demands, at her Father's Tomb, a certain Sword, called Tirfing, which was buried with him.

HERVOR.
Awake, Angantyr! To thy tomb,
With ſleep-expelling charms, I come.
Break thy drowſy fetters, break!
'Tis Hervor calls—Awake! awake!
Tirfing, made by fairy hands,
Hervor from thy tomb demands.
Hervardur, Hiorvardur, hear!
Liſt, oh liſt, my father dear!
[XXXVIII]Each from his ſilent tomb I call;
Ghoſts of the dead, awaken all!
With helmet, ſhield, and coat of mail,
With ſword and ſpear, I bid ye hail!
Where twiſted roots of oak abound,
And undermine the hollow ground,
Each from his narrow cell I call;
Ghoſts of the dead, awaken all!
In what darkſome cavern deep,
Do the ſons of Angrym ſleep?
Duſt and aſhes tho' ye be,
Sons of Angrym, anſwer me.
Liſt'ning in your clay-cold beds,
Sons of Eyvor, lift your heads.
Riſe, Hiorvardur, riſe and ſpeak;
Hervardur, thy long ſilence break.
Duſt and aſhes tho' ye be,
One and all, oh anſwer me.
Never, oh never may ye reſt;
But rot and putrefy unbleſs'd,
If ye refuſe the magic blade,
And belt, by fairy fingers made!
ANGANTYR.
Ceaſe, oh daughter, ceaſe to call me;
Didſt thou know what will befall thee,
Thou hadſt never hither ſped,
With Runic ſpells to wake the dead:
Thou, that in evil hour art come
To brave the terrors of the tomb.
Nor friend, nor weeping father, gave
Angantyr's reliques to the grave;
And Tirfing, that all-conqu'ring ſword,
No longer calls Angantyr lord.
A living warrior wears it now—
HERVOR.
'Tis falſe, Angantyr; only thou.
So may great Odin ever keep
In peace the turf where thou doſt ſleep;
As Tirfing ſtill beſide thee lies,
Th' attendant of thy obſequies!
My juſt inheritance I claim;
Conjure thee by a daughter's name,
Thy only child!
ANGANTYR.
Too well I knew
Thou wouldſt demand what thou ſhalt rue.
By Tirfing's fatal point ſhall die
The braveſt of thy progeny.
A warlike ſon ſhall Hervor bear,
Hervor's pride, and Tirfing's heir;
Already, daughter, I foreſee
Heidrek the hero's name will be:
To him, the young, the bold, the ſtrong,
Tirfing hereafter will belong.
HERVOR.
Ne'er ſhall my inchantments ceaſe,
Nor you, ye ſpirits, reſt in peace,
Until ye grant what I demand,
And Tirfing glitters in my hand.
ANGANTYR.
Oh Virgin, more than woman bold!
Of warlike mien, and manly mould!
What has induc'd thy feet to tread
The gloomy manſions of the dead,
At this lone hour, devoid of fear,
With ſword, and ſhield, and magic ſpear?
HERVOR.
The cauſe thou know'ſt, why to thy tomb
I've wander'd thro' the midnight gloom:
Yield then the Fairies work divine;
Thou art no father elſe of mine;
But goblin damn'd.
ANGANTYR.
Then hear me, Maid,
That art not ev'n of death afraid!
Hialmar's bane thou ſhalt command;
The fatal ſword is in my hand:
But ſee the flames that round it riſe!
Doſt thou the furious fire deſpiſe?
HERVOR.
Yes; I dare ſeize, amidſt the fire,
The object of my ſoul's deſire;
Nor do theſe eyes behold with dread,
The flame that plays around the dead.
ANGANTYR.
Raſh Maid! will nothing then controul
The purpoſe of thy daring ſoul?
[XXXIX]But hold—ere thou ſhouldſt fall a prey
To theſe fierce flames that round it play,
The ſword from out the tomb I'll bring;
Go, and the ſong of triumph ſing.
HERVOR.
Offspring of kings! I know thee now,
And thus before thy preſence bow;
Father, Hero, Prince, and Friend!
To thee my grateful knees I bend.
Not half ſo happy had I been,
Tho' Scandinavia hail'd me queen.
ANGANTYR.
How art thou to thy int'reſt blind,
Weak woman, tho' of dauntleſs mind!
Tirfing, the object of thy joy,
Thy future offspring ſhall deſtroy.
HERVOR.
My ſeamen call; I muſt away:
Adieu, O King! I cannot ſtay.
Fate, do thy worſt! in times to come
Be what it may, my children's doom!
ANGANTYR.
Take then, and keep Hialmar's bane,
Dy'd in the blood of heroes ſlain.
Long ſhall the fatal pledge be thine,
Hervor, if truly I divine;
The fell, devouring, poiſon'd blade,
For death and for deſtruction made.
HERVOR.
With joy the two-edg'd ſword I take,
Nor reck the havock it will make;
Poſſeſſing which, I little rue
Whate'er my frantic ſons may do.
ANGANTYR.
Daughter, farewell! as thou doſt live,
To thee the death of twelve I give:
To thee, O maid of warlike mind,
What Angrym's ſons have left behind.
HERVOR.
Angantyr, reſt in peace! and all
Ye ghoſts, who have obey'd my call;
Reſt in your mould'ring vaults below!
While from this houſe of death I go,
Where, burſting from the vap'rous ground,
Meteors ſhoot, and blaze around.

I ſhall juſt mention, that the antient Scandinavians had alſo their Cromlehs *. I can trace but one inſtance, and that on the top of a tumulus in Zealand; which, with two other barrows, is included in a ſquare of ſtones.

Circles, for the purpoſe of religious rites, were not wanting here. The Etteſtupa, or circle of lofty rude columns in Weſt Gothland, was celebrated for the ſacrifices of the heathens; and the great ſtones at Finſtad, diſpoſed in form of a cell, and called St. Birgitta's Oratory , was no other than a temple of worſhip, analogous, probably, to that of the Druids.

The next ſtep is to the FEROE iſlands,FEROE ISLES. a group about two hundred and ten miles to the north-weſt of the northern Schetland, between lat. 61, 15. and 62, 30. There are ſeventeen which are habitable, each of which is a lofty mountain ariſing out of the waves, divided from the others by deep and rapid currents. Some of them are deeply indented with ſecure harbours; providence ſeeming to have favored mankind with the ſafeſt retreats in the moſt boiſterous ſeas. All are very ſteep, and moſt of [XL] them faced with moſt tremendous precipices. The ſurface of the mountains conſiſts of a ſhallow ſoil of remarkable fertility; for barley, the only corn ſown here, yields above twenty for one; and the graſs affords abundant paſturage for ſheep. The exports are ſalted mutton and tallow, gooſe quils, feathers, and Eider down; and, by the induſtry of the inhabitants, knit woollen waiſtcoats, caps, and ſtockings. No trees beyond the ſize of juniper, or ſtunted willows, will grow here: nor are any wild quadrupeds to be met with, except rats and mice, originally eſcaped from the ſhipping.

The liſt of land birds is very ſmall:LAND BIRDS.—The Cinereous Eagle, p. 214. B; the Lanner, p. 225. K; the Sparrow Hawk, p. 226. N*; a ſpecies of Owl; the Raven, No 134; and Hooded Crow, p. 251. B. are the pernicious ſpecies. Ravens were ſo deſtructive to the Lambs and Sheep, that in old times every boatman was obliged to bring into the ſeſſions-houſe, on St. Olaus's day, the beak of one of thoſe birds, or pay one ſkin, which was called the Raven-fine, in caſe of neglect. The remaining land fowl are Wild Pigeons and Stares, White Wagtails, Wrens, and ſometimes the Swallow. The Snow Bunting only reſts here in ſpring, on its paſſage northward. The Heron is ſometimes met with. The Spoon-Bill is Common. The Sea Pie, Water Rail, and Lapwing, are ſeen here. The birds of the rocks, ſuch as Puffins, Razor Bills, and Little Auks, Fooliſh and Black Guillemots, ſwarm here; and the Geyir-fugl, or Great Auk, at certain periods viſits theſe iſlands. The laſt, by reaſon of its ſhort wing incapable of flight, neſtles at the foot of the cliffs. The Skua, Arctic, Black-backed, and Herring Gulls, Fulmars, Manks, Stormy Petrels, Imber and Northern Divers, Wild Swans and Geeſe, (the Swans only vernal paſſengers towards the north) Eider Ducks, Havelda or Long-tailed Ducks, Corvorants, and the Sula Gannet, form the ſum of the palmated fowl of theſe inhoſpitable ſpots.

FOWLING.The manner of fowling is ſo very ſtrange and hazardous that the deſcription ſhould by no means be omitted. Neceſſity compels mankind to wonderful attempts. The cliffs which contain the objects of their ſearch are often two hundred fathoms in height,FROM ABOVE. and are attempted from above and below. In the firſt caſe, the fowlers provide themſelves with a rope eighty or a hundred fathoms in length. The fowler faſtens one end about his waiſt and between his legs, recommends himſelf to the protection of the Almighty, and is lowered down by ſix others, who place a piece of timber on the margin of the rock, to preſerve the rope from wearing againſt the ſharp edge. They have beſides a ſmall line faſtened to the body of the adventurer, by which he gives ſignals that they may lower or raiſe him, or ſhift him [XLI] from place to place. The laſt operation is attended with great danger, by the looſening of the ſtones, which often fall on his head, and would infallibly deſtroy him, was it not protected by a ſtrong thick cap; but even that is found unequal to ſave him againſt the weight of the larger fragments of rock. The dexterity of the fowlers is amazing; they will place their feet againſt the front of the precipice, and dart themſelves ſome fathoms from it, with a cool eye ſurvey the places where the birds neſtle, and again ſhoot into their haunts. In ſome places the birds lodge in deep receſſes. The fowler will alight there, diſengage himſelf from the rope, fix it to a ſtone, and at his leiſure collect the booty, faſten it to his girdle, and reſume his pendulous ſeat. At times he will again ſpring from the rock, and in that attitude, with a fowling net placed at the end of a ſtaff, catch the old birds which are flying to and from their retreats. When he hath finiſhed his dreadful employ, he gives a ſignal to his friends above, who pull him up, and ſhare the hard-earned profit. The feathers are preſerved for exportation: the fleſh is partly eaten freſh: but the greater portion dried for winter's proviſion.

The fowling from below has its ſhare of danger.FROM BELOW. The party goes on the expedition in a boat; and when it has attained the baſe of the precipice, one of the moſt daring, having faſtened a rope about his waiſt, and furniſhed himſelf with a long pole with an iron hook at one end, either climbs, or is thruſt up by his companions, who place a pole under his breech, to the next footing ſpot he can reach*. He, by means of the rope, brings up one of the boats crew; the reſt are drawn up in the ſame manner, and each is furniſhed with his rope and fowling-ſtaff. They then continue their progreſs upwards in the ſame manner, till they arrive at the region of birds; and wander about the face of the cliff in ſearch of them. They then act in pairs; one faſtens himſelf to the end of his aſſociate's rope, and, in places where birds have neſtled beneath his footing, he permits himſelf to be lowered down, depending for his ſecurity to the ſtrength of his companion, who is to haul him up again; but it ſometimes happens that the perſon above is overpowered by the weight, and both inevitably periſh. They fling the fowl down to the boat, which attends their motions, and receives the booty. They often paſs ſeven or eight days in this tremendous employ, and lodge in the crannies which they find in the face of the precipice.

The ſea which ſurrounds theſe iſlands is extremely turbulent. The tides vary greatly on the weſtern and eaſtern ſides. On the firſt, where is received the uninterrupted flood of the ocean from the remote Greenland, the tide riſes ſeven fathoms: on the eaſtern ſide it riſes only three. Dreadful whirlwinds, called by the Danes, oes, agitate the ſea to a ſtrange degree; catch up a vaſt quantity of water, [XLII] ſo as to leave a great temporary chaſm in the ſpot on which it falls, and carries away with it, to an amazing diſtance, any fiſhes which may happen to be within reach of its fury. Thus great ſhoals of Herrings have been found on the higheſt mountains of Feroe. It is equally reſiſtleſs on land, tearing up trees, ſtones, and animals, and carrying them to very diſtant places. We muſt no longer laugh at the good archbiſhop*, who gravely tells us, that at times, the Rats called Lemming are poured down from the clouds in great ſhowers on the Alps of Norway. We aſſent to the fact; but muſt ſolve the phoenomenon by aſcribing it to a whirlwind, as he does in one place; yet immediately ſuppoſes they may be bred in the upper regions out of feculent matter.

Among the numerous whirlpools of theſe ſeas, that of Suderoe, near the iſland of the ſame name, is the moſt noted. It is occaſioned by a crater, ſixty-one fathoms in depth in the centre, and from fifty to fifty-five on the ſides. The water forms four fierce circumgirations. The point they begin at is on the ſide of a large baſon, where commences a range of rocks running ſpirally, and terminating at the verge of the crater. This range is extremely rugged, and covered with water from the depth of twelve to eight fathoms only. It forms four equidiſtant wreaths, with a channel from thirty-five to twenty fathoms in depth between each. On the outſide, beyond that depth, the ſea ſuddenly ſinks to eighty and ninety. On the ſouth border of the baſon is a lofty rock, called Sumboe Munk, noted for the multitude of birds which frequent it. On one ſide, the water is only three or four fathoms deep; on the other fifteen. The danger at moſt times, eſpecially in ſtorms, is very great. Ships are irreſiſtibly drawn in: the rudder loſes its power, and the waves beat as high as the maſts; ſo that an eſcape is almoſt miraculous: yet at the reflux, and in very ſtill weather, the inhabitants will venture in boats, for the ſake of fiſhing. Mr. Debes omits the times of greateſt danger. It is to be hoped that attention will be paid to the various periodical appearances of a phoenomenon, the cauſe of which is very ſatisfactorily explained by the worthy paſtor.

Mankind found their way to theſe iſlands ſome time before the diſcovery of Iceland. Naddodd, a Norwegian pirate, had retired here, as the only place of ſecurity he could find. About this time, Harold Harfagre poſſeſſed himſelf of Norway, and flung off the Daniſh yoke. A party was formed againſt him; but it was ſoon ſubdued, and the malecontents quitting the kingdom, retired to the Hebrides, Orknies, Schetland, and Feroe, and gave riſe to the Norwegian reign in all thoſe iſlands.

ICELAND.From the Feroe iſlands, the hardy Scandinavians made the next ſtep, in their northern migrations, to ICELAND. I muſt premiſe, that there is the higheſt probability that this iſland was diſcovered in an age moſt remote to theirs: and that it was the Thule of Pytheas, an illuſtrious Marſeillian, at leſt cotemporary with [XLIII] Ariſtotle *, and who puſhed his diſcoveries towards the north, as his countryman Euthymenes did beyond the line. Pytheas arrived at Thule, an iſland, ſays he, ſix days ſailing northward from Britain, where, he informs us, was continual day and night for ſix months alternately. He does not exactly hit on the length of day and night; but he could have been at no other, at that diſtance from Britain, but Iceland, in which there was a moſt remarkable abſence of light. As to Naddodd, in 861, he was accidentally driven by a tempeſt to the eaſtern ſide of Iceland, to a place now called Reidarfiall. He found the country covered with ſnow, and therefore named it Snoeland; yet he returned home full of its praiſes. Soon after, Gardar, a Swede, experienced the ſame fortune. On a voyage to the Hebrides, he was tempeſt-driven to the ſame iſland; on which, by the advice of his mother, who was a ſort of diviner, he landed at Horn. At this period Iceland was cloathed with wood from the ſhore to the very tops of the mountains. He wintered there, and likewiſe returned full of its praiſes.

FLOKE, a celebrated pirate, was the next adventurer. He took with him three Ravens, and, like another Noah, made them the augury of the land. Before he ſailed, he performed a great ſacrifice for the ſucceſs, upon a vaſt pile of ſtones, which he raiſed for the purpoſe. This points out another origin of the vaſt tumuli we ſo frequently ſee. He made the Schetland and the Feroe iſles his firſt ſteps; and looſed from the laſt for Iceland, the neareſt point of which is about five hundred and forty miles diſtant. His firſt Raven returned to Feroe: the ſecond flew back to the ſhip: the third directed him to the wiſhed-for land§. He wintered there. The cattle he brought with him periſhed through want. The ſpring proved unuſually cold, and the ſea appeared full of ice; for which reaſon he beſtowed on the iſland the name it at preſent bears. Floke was ſick of his voyage: returned full of diſpraiſes of the country. This did not diſcourage other adventurers, all of them Scandinavians, thruſt out of the exuberant northern hive. The reſt of the world, which their countrymen ravaged, was aſſuredly too ſmall for them, otherwiſe they never would have colonized almoſt the moſt wretched ſpot in the northern hemiſphere. Ambition poſſibly actuated the leaders, who might think it ‘Better to reign in hell than ſerve in heaven.’ Colony after colony arrived. They confederated, and formed a republic, which exiſted near four hundred years; but with as many feuds and ſlaughters as could [XLIV] happen in a climate where luxury might pamper and corrupt the inhabitants. In 1261, wearied with their diſſenſions, they voluntarily re-united themſelves to their mother-country, Norway, under the reign of its monarch Haquin. It is remarkable, that the poetic genius of their aboriginal country flouriſhed with equal ſublimity in every climate. The Scalds, or bards, retained their fire in the inhoſpitable climate of Iceland, as vigorouſly as when they attended on their chieftains to the mild air of Spain, or Sicily, and ſung their valiant deeds.

Every thing which furniſhed topics to the poets of other countries, was, in the moſt remote period, wanting here. Groves, verdant meadows, purling ſtreams, and gentle zephyrs, were totally unknown; and in their ſtead, ſtunted ſhrubs, a thin herbage, rude torrents, and fierce gales, reign in every part. We admit the apology of the learned Torfoeus for the preſent ſtate of his country*. Violent tempeſts might cover whole tracts with the unſtable ſand, eruptions of water from the mountains deſolate ſome parts, earthquakes bury vaſt extents of fertile land with fragments of rocks, and inundations of the ſea change the face of others. But ſoft ſcenery was not requiſite to inſpire poets who were to ſing only the preparations for warlike exploits, the ſlaughter of a battle, the deeds of their heroes, and the magic ſolemnities of ſuperſtitions.

The iſland, at preſent, exhibits to the traveller amazing ſlopes of lava, which once ſtreamed from the vulcanoes, and terminated in the ſea. Such is the appearance, about three miles from Hafnaifoird, in lat. 64. 4. of vaſt maſſes of lava piled to a montanous height upon each other, broken, vitrified, ſharp, rude, and black. In parts, ſandy tracts intervene: in others, a ſoil peculiar to the place, a tufa, originated from the violent eruptions of impure water which ruſh from the mountains, attendant on the fiery eruptions. Vallies compoſed of a very thin ſoil, afford graſs for a numerous breed of cattle and ſheep. Here is found variety of ſpecies of the beſt graſſes; of the aira, poa, feſtuca, and carex. Part is harveſted againſt winter; but not in ſuch plenty, but that the farmer is obliged often to feed his ſtock with the wolf-fiſh, or the heads of cod-fiſh beaten ſmall, and mixed with a quarter part of hay. To what food will not neceſſity compel both man and beaſt to recur!

WOODS LONG LOST.The woods of Iceland have long ſince vaniſhed, unleſs we except a few ſtunted birch, ſcarcely ten feet high, and four inches in diameter; and a few ſpecies of willow,DRIFT-WOOD. ſo ſmall and ſo rare as ſcarcely to be of uſe to the inhabitants. But they are abundantly ſupplied with drift-wood from Europe and America, as appears by the ſpecies found on the ſhores, eſpecially on all the northern coaſt, as Langaneſs on the north-eaſt and Hornſtrandt on the north-weſt. That woods were found here [XLV] in very remote periods, is very evident, from the quantity of ſuturbrand met with in ſeveral parts; which ſtill retains traces of its vegetable origin; the marks of branches, and circles of the annual growth of the wood: ſome pieces are even capable of being planed. It is found in the fiſſures of the rocks, much compreſſed by their weight, and in pieces ſometimes big enough to make a middle-ſized table. This is ſometimes uſed as fuel; but the want of it is ſupplied, in ſome meaſure, by the drift-wood, by peat, and by ſeveral ſtrange ſubſtitutes, the effect of neceſſity. Smiths prefer the ſuturbrand to ſea-coal in their buſineſs. The beds of this foſſil ſtrongly refute the notion of Iceland having been entirely formed by vulcanic violence, ſince the original creation; and raiſed out of the ſea in later times, as others have been known to have done. Delos and Rhodos, in very remote ages; Thera, the modern Santorini, and Theraſia, in the 135th Olympiad; Thia, in the time of Pliny *; and in the beginning of this century another ſprung from the ſea, by the force of ſubterraneous fires, near to Santorini : and, while I am now writing, an iſland is forming by the ſame cauſe, not remote from the Reickenes, part of the very iſland in queſtion. But theſe ſutur or ſorte brands are certainly the remains of antient foreſts, overturned and buried by earthquakes, after the golden age of the iſland. Let me add to this another proof, from the number of its vegetables:PLANTS, NUMBER OF. there being found on it not fewer than three hundred and nine perfect, and two hundred and thirty-three cryptogamous plants. On the iſle of Aſcenſion, which is totally and aboriginally vulcanic, a Flora of not more than ſeven plants is to be ſeen.

THIS vaſt iſland extends from 63. 15. to about 67. 18. north latitude: is reckoned to be five hundred and ſixty Engliſh miles long, and about two hundred and fifty broad. It has a rugged coaſt, indented deeply with ſecure bays; but faced with very few iſles. It lies in the Hyperborean ocean, divided from Greenland by a ſea about thirty-five leagues wide§. The whole is traverſed with great ridges of mountains; the higheſt naked, and uſually free from ſnow, by reaſon of the ſaline and ſulphurous particles with which they abound. The lower, called Jokkeler, are caſed with eternal ice and ſnow; and are the glacieres of Iceland. Of theſe, Snaefiaell Jokkel, which hangs over the ſea in the weſt part of the iſland, is far the higheſt. Out of theſe, at different periods, have been tremendous eruptions of fire and water, the burſt of which is attended with a moſt terrific noiſe: flames and balls of fire iſſue out with the ſmoke: and ſhowers of ſtones are vomited up; of which there has been an inſtance of one weighing near three hundred pounds being flung to the [XLVI] diſtance of four miles. The heights of the mountains have not been taken; but that of the Hecla-fiall is not far ſhort of ſeventeen hundred yards. Of this ſpecies of mountain, Hecla has been moſt celebrated: the records of Iceland enumerate ten of its eruptions ſince the arrival of the Norwegians. It was the hell of the northern nations; but they ſeem divided in their opinions, whether the pains of the damned aroſe from fire, or, what was more tremendous to the natives of theſe countries, from the cold*.

To bathe in fiery floods, or to reſide
In thrilling regions of thick-ribbed ice.

Hecla has been known to have had only ten eruptions between the years 1104 and 1693; from the laſt to 1766, when it burſt out in flames and lava. It emitted flames in 1771 and 1772; but did not overflow with Stenna, or a ſtone flood. But other vulcanoes have, in the preſent century, proved the ſpiracles to the internal fires of Iceland. The vallies between the mountains are in general ſandy and ſterile. Fiery eruptions are not confined to the mountains. Laſt year they burſt out of the fulphureous ſoil of the low parts of Skaftafield Syſſel or province; and the lava has overflown the country for the ſpace of thirty miles, and has at laſt reached the ſea, deſtroying every thing in its progreſs. It dries up the rivers, and fills their beds with lava. Moors in ſome places ſtop its courſe; but it totally changes their nature. It has taken to the deſerts of the ſame province, and begins to ſpread to the eaſt, or Mulé Syſſel, the moſt populous and fruitful part of the iſland; nor were there any ſigns of its ceaſing at the time when this account was ſent to me.

HUERS, OR BOILING JETS D'EAUX.THE FOUNTAINS of many of the vallies are of a moſt extraordinary nature; are called Huers, and form at times jets d'eaux of ſcalding water, ninety-four feet high, and thirty in diameter, creating the moſt magnificent gerbes in nature! eſpecially when backed by the ſetting ſun. They ariſe out of cylindrical tubes of unknown depths: near the ſurface they expand into apertures of a funnel ſhape, and the mouths ſpread into large extent of ſtalactitical matter, formed of ſucceſſive ſcaly concentric undulations. The playing of theſe ſtupendous ſpouts is foretold by noiſes roaring like the cataract of Niagara. The cylinder begins to fill: it riſes gradually to the ſurface, and gradually encreaſes its height, ſmoking amazingly, and flinging up great ſtones. After attaining its greateſt height, it gradually ſinks, till it totally diſappears. Boiling jets d'eaux, and boiling ſprings, are frequent in moſt parts of the iſland. In many parts they are applied to the culinary uſes of the natives. The moſt capital is that which is [XLVII] called Geyer, in a plain riſing into ſmall hills, and in the midſt of an amphitheatre, bounded by the moſt magnificent and various-ſhaped icy mountains; among which the three-headed Hecla ſoars pre-eminent.

Theſe Huers are not confined to the land. They riſe in the very ſea,IN THE SEA. and form ſcalding fountains amidſt the waves. Their diſtance from the land is unknown; but the new vulcanic iſle, twelve-miles off the point of Reickenes, emitting fire and ſmoke, proves that the ſubterraneous fires and waters extend to that ſpace; for thoſe aweful effects ariſe from the united fury of theſe two elements*. The depth of water between this new creation and the Geir-fugl Skier, is forty-four fathoms; ten leagues to the weſt, two hundred and five: and the bottom compoſed of black ſand; doubtleſs no other than the Pumex arenaceus, the frequent evomition of vulcanoes. How much paſt human comprehenſion muſt the powers have been, that could force up materials for an iſland, even from the medium depth I have given! and how deep beneath the bottom of the ocean muſt have been the cauſes which could ſupply ſtone, or pumice, or lava, to fill the ſpace which this iſland occupies, many miles in circumference, and poſſibly above a hundred fathoms in depth!

If ſome iſlands ſpring out of theſe ſeas, others are ſwallowed by the force of earthquakes. Their foundations are undermined by the fury of the ſubterraneous elements, which carries off the materials of their baſis, and diſcharges it in lava, or different forms, through the vulcanic ſpiracula. The earthquakes ſhatter the cruſt on which they ſtand, and they tumble into the great abyſs. Such was the fate of the nine iſles of Gouberman, which lay about four leagues from Sandaneſs, between Patrixfiord and Cape Nort, all which ſuddenly diſappeared. Their names ſtill exiſt in ſeveral maps; but their place is only diſtinguiſhable by the ſuperior depth of water in the ſpot on which they ſtood.

The number of inhabitants in Iceland is computed not to exceed ſixty thouſand.PEOPLE, NUMBER OF. Conſidering the ungenial ſurface of this vaſt iſland, probably the number is equal to the means of ſupport. Writers apologize for the fewneſs of inhabitants, by attributing it to the almoſt depopulation of the place by the ſorte diod, PESTILENCE. or black death, a peſtilence which commenced in Cathay, or China, in 1346, ſpread over all Aſia, and Africa, reached the ſouth of Europe in 1347, and in 1348 ſpread itſelf over Britain, Germany, and northern Europe, even to the extremity of the inhabited north. The ſmall-pox, and other epidemics, are mentioned as contributing to thin the iſland. During the time of the plague, tradition relates, [XLVIII] in terms moſt graphically horrid, that the perſons who eſcaped to the mountains, ſaw the whole low country covered with a thick peſtiferous fog. A gueſs may be made at the number of inhabitants in the eleventh century; for a biſhop of Schalholt cauſed, in 1090, all who were liable to pay tribute to be numbered: four thouſand of that rank were found; ſo that, giving five to a family, the ſum is twenty thouſand*. Much of the labor in the northern world falls to the female part of the family; and in thoſe patriarchal times, the ſons alſo ſhared the toil. I cannot therefore under-rate the number of commonalty, or untaxable people, heads of families, at ten thouſand; which, by the ſame rule, will give fifty thouſand of the lower rank. Beſides the dearth of food in this rude iſland, other cauſes contribute to prevent the increaſe of inhabitants. Neceſſity forces the men to ſeek from the ſea ſubſiſtence, denied by their niggardly land. Conſtant wet, cold, and hard labor, abridge the days of thouſands; and that labor is increaſed tenfold, to ſupply the rapacity of their maſters. Incredible as it may ſeem, a late king of Denmark ſold the whole iſland, and its inhabitants, to a company of merchants, for the annual rent of one thouſand pounds. This company enſlave the poor natives; who are bound to ſell their fiſh, the ſtaple of the iſland, at a low price to theſe monopolizers; who, dreading reſiſtance, even have taken from them the uſe of fire-arms! Here is given a ſtronger cauſe of depopulation, perhaps, than the others; for Hymen can have but faint votaries in the land from whence liberty is baniſhed. But for theſe cauſes, here ought to be found the genuine ſpecies of the Norman race, unmixed with foreign blood; as muſt be the caſe with every place remote from the reſt of the world. Here are to be ſought the antient cuſtoms and diet of their original ſtock, which are now probably worn out in the land of their diſtant anceſtors. The luxury of food has ſo little crept in among them, that their meat and drink in general is peculiar to themſelves; and much of the former compoſed of herbs neglected in other places.

DRESS.The dreſs of the natives ſeems unchanged for a very conſiderable time: that of the men is ſimple, not unlike that of the Norwegian peaſants; that of the females is graceful, elegant, and peculiar to them, and perhaps ſome very old-faſhioned Norwegian lady. They ornament themſelves with ſilver chains and rich plates of ſilver, beautifully wrought. On their head is a lofty ſlender dreſs, not unlike a Phrygian bonnet. I cannot compare this to any antient European faſhion. Iſabel of France, queen to Edward II. wore a head-dreſs of an enormous [XLIX] height, of a ſlender conic form*; but which, for want of the flexure at top, gave place in elegance to the taſte of the Icelandic fair.

Mr. Troil awakens our curioſity about the Icelandic antiquities; ſpeaks of caſtles, and heathen temples, and burying-places, and upright ſtones, and mounts. Of the firſt I am ſolicitous to gain ſome further knowlege, for poſſibly they might direct to the origin of the round buildings in the Hebrides, Orknies, Schetland, and the north of Scotland : others ſeem to me the various Scandinavian antiquities, admirably exemplified in Baron Dahlberg's Suecia Antiqua et Moderna.

The ſpecies of quadrupeds of this iſland are very few.DOMESTIC QUADRUPEDS. Small horſes of a hardy kind; cows in great abundance, and moſtly hornleſs, the fleſh and hides of which are conſiderable articles of exportation. Sheep are met with in great flocks in every farm; the wool is manufactured at home, the meat ſalted, and, with the ſkins, much of it is ſold to the Company, at the twenty-two ports allotted for the purpoſes of traffic. It is remarkable, that the climate diſpoſes their horns to grow very large, and even to exceed the number of thoſe of the ſheep of other countries; examples of three, four, and five, being extremely frequent. Goats and ſwine are very ſcarce; the firſt, for want of ſhrubs to brouze, the laſt through deficiency of their uſual food, and the ſupply which the farm-yards of other countries afford.

The dogs are ſharp-noſed, have ſhort and ſharp upright ears, buſhy tails, and are full of hair. Here are domeſtic cats; but numbers are grown wild, and multiply among the rocks, ſo as to become noxious. The reader need not be reminded, that theſe, and every ſpecies of domeſtic animals, were originally introduced into Iceland by the Norwegians.

An attempt has been made to introduce the Rein Deer, Arct. Zool. No 4. Thoſe which ſurvived the voyage have bred frequently. There can be little doubt of their ſucceeding, as Iceland has, in common with Lapland, moſt of the plants for their ſummer food, and abundance of the Rein Deer lichen for their winter proviſion.

Rats and Mice ſeem to have been involuntarily tranſported.RATS. Both the domeſtic ſpecies are found here; and the white variety of the Mouſe, called in the Icelandic, Skogar Mys, is common in the buſhes. I ſuſpect that there is a native ſpecies, allied, as Doctor PALLAS imagines, to the Oeconomic, Arct. Zool. p. 134, A.; for, like that, it lays in a great magazine of berries by way of winter-ſtores. This ſpecies is particularly plentiful in the wood of Huſafels. In a country where [L] berries are but thinly diſperſed, theſe little animals are obliged to croſs rivers to make their diſtant forages. In their return with the booty to their magazines, they are obliged to repaſs the ſtream; of which Mr. Olaffen gives the following account:— "The party, which conſiſts of from ſix to ten, ſelect a flat piece of dried cow-dung, on which they place the berries in a heap in the middle; then, by their united force, bring it to the water's edge, and after launching it, embark, and place themſelves round the heap, with their heads joined over it, and their backs to the water, their tails pendent in the ſtream, ſerving the purpoſe of rudders*." When I conſider the wonderful ſagacity of Beavers, and think of the management of the Squirrel, which, in caſes of ſimilar neceſſity, make a piece of bark their boat, and tail their ſail, I no longer heſitate to credit the relation.

FOXES.The Common Fox, Arct. Zool. No 11, and the Arctic, No 10, are frequent; are proſcribed, and killed for the ſake of a reward, in order to prevent the havock they would make among the ſheep.

BEARS.The Polar Bear, No 18, is often tranſported from Greenland, on the iſlands of ice; but no ſooner is its landing diſcovered, than a general alarm is ſpread, and purſuit made till it is deſtroyed. The Icelanders are very intrepid in their attack on this animal; and a ſingle man, armed only with a ſpear, frequently enters the liſts with this tremendous beaſt, and never fails of victory. A perſon who lived near Langeneſs, the extreme northern point, where the Bears moſt frequently land, is ſtill celebrated for having ſlain not fewer than twenty in ſingle combat. There is a reward for every ſkin, which muſt be delivered to the next magiſtrate.

The Common Bat, p. 185, A. is ſometimes found in this iſland, and finiſhes the liſt of the land-animals of the country.

The amphibious quadrupeds, or Seals, are very numerous. Iceland, being bleſſed with domeſtic animals, has leſs uſe of this race than other Arctic countries; yet they are of conſiderable advantage. The ſkins are uſed for cloathing; a good one is equal in value to the ſkin of a ſheep, or the hide of a cow; and the fat ſupplies the lamps in the long nights with oil. The Common, during winter, is exceſſively fat, and will yield ſixty pounds.

SEALS. The Icelanders have two ſpecies of native Seals: the Common, No 72, called by them Land Saelur, becauſe it keeps near the coaſt; the other, the Great, No 73, or Ut-Saelur. They are taken in nets placed in the creeks and narrow bays, which they paſs through to get on ſhore. When it begins to grow dark the hunters make a fire, and fling into it the ſhavings of horns, or any thing that ſmells ſtrong; this allures the Seals, who ſtrike into the nets, and are taken. [LI] At other times, a koder or lure is tied to a rope, and placed before the nets; to which the Seals, ſuppoſing it to be ſome ſtrange animal, will eagerly ſwim, and ſtrike into the nets, paying with their lives for their curioſity. This carries them ſometimes ſo far, that they will ſtray to a conſiderable diſtance inland, attracted by a candle, or the fire in a ſmith's forge. If they are taken young, they are capable of being tamed: they will follow their maſter, and come to him like a dog, when called by the name which is given them. The Icelanders have a ſtrange ſuperſtition about theſe animals: they believe they reſemble the human ſpecies more than any other, and that they are the offspring of Pharaoh and his hoſt, who were converted into Seals when they were overwhelmed in the Red Sea.

Other ſpecies of Seals are migratory. Among them is the Harp, No 77, or Vade-Selur. Theſe quit the ſeas of Iceland in March, and ſwim through the ſtreights of Davies, by ſome unknown opening, to the fartheſt north; bring forth their young, and return, by the north of Greenland, in May, extremely lean, to the north of Iceland; continue their route, and return to that iſland about Chriſtmas, chiefly upon the drift-ice, on which they are either ſhot, or harpooned. The Hooded Seal, No 76, or Bladru Seal, is rarely taken here. The Walrus, No 71, or Roſt-unger, is ſometimes wafted here from Greenland on the ice.

It cannot be expected,BIRDS. that many of the feathered tribe ſhould inhabit an iſland ſo very ſevere in its climate, and ſo remote from the more ſouthern continent and iſlands. It is, like all other Arctic countries, the aſylum to water-fowl, to breed and educate their young; but, being an inhabited place, fewer reſort here than to the untrodden waſtes of the more diſtant north. The Guland Duck, p. 572. E. may poſſibly be a local bird. The reſt, whether land or water, are common to Norway, and many other parts of Europe. The Great Auks, No 428, are found here in greater numbers than elſewhere: they inhabit and breed on the rocks, called from them Geir-fugl Skier, off the point of Raekenes, the moſt ſouthern part of the iſland. Notwithſtanding they are ſurrounded with a ſwelling ſea, and tremendous breakers, the Icelanders venture there annually, in order to collect the eggs, to contribute to the proviſion of the year. I can only reckon ſixteen land-birds*: twenty cloven-footed water-fowl; four with pinnated [LII] feet, and forty-three with webbed feet, natives or frequenters of the iſland. I have omitted, in the Zoologic part, the Leſſer Guillemot, Br. Zool. ii. No 235, which is a native of Iceland, and called there Ringuia. It ought to have had a place in an appendage to the Guillemots, p. 517.

The Raven holds the firſt rank among the land-birds in the Scandinavian mythology. We ſee the uſe made of them by the chieftain Floke. The Bards, in their ſongs, give them the claſſical attribute of the power of preſage. Thus they make Thromundr and Thorbiorn, before a feudal battle, explain the foreboding voice of this bird, and its intereſt in the field of battle*.

THR.
Hark! the Raven's croak I hear,
Lo! the bird of Fate is near.
In the dawn, with duſky wings,
Hoarſe the ſong of death ſhe ſings.
Thus in days of yore ſhe ſang,
When the din of battle rang;
When the hour of death drew nigh,
And mighty chiefs were doom'd to die.
THOR.
The Raven croaks: the warriors ſlain,
With blood her duſky wings diſtain;
Tir'd her morning prey ſhe ſeeks,
And with blood and carnage reeks.
Thus, perch'd upon an aged oak,
The boding bird was heard to croak;
When all the plain with blood was ſpread,
Thirſting for the mighty dead.
R. W.

The Raven had ſtill higher honors in the northern nations. It was ſacred to Odin, the hero and god of the north. On the ſacred flag of the Danes was embroidered this bird. Odin was ſaid to have been always attended by two, which ſate on his ſhoulders; whence he was called the God of Ravens: one was ſtyled Huginn, or Thought; the other Muninn, or Memory. They whiſpered in his ear all they ſaw or heard. In the earlieſt dawn, he ſent them to fly round the world, and they returned before dinner, fraught with intelligence. Odin thus ſang their importance:

Huginn and Muninn, my delight!
Speed thro' the world their daily flight:
From their fond lord they both are flown,
Perhaps eternally are gone.
Tho' Huginn's loſs I ſhould deplore
Yet Muninn's would afflict me more.
R. W.

I have already ſpoken of the excellent Falcons of this iſland: let me add, that Falcons were among the animals ſacrificed to Odin , being birds of the firſt courage, and which delighted in blood.

[LIII]The ſea which ſurrounds Iceland is ſaid to be more ſalt than uſual in other countries. It leaves great ſaline incruſtations on the rocks,SEA. which the natives ſcrape off and uſe. I can, with no certainty, give the depth of the water, except where Mr. Kerguelin ſounded, ten leagues to the weſt of Geir-fugl Skier, where he found it to be two hundred and five fathoms*. The equinoctial tides riſe as high as ſixteen feet: the ordinary tides twelve. The coaſts almoſt univerſally bold, thoſe of the inlets excepted, where there appears a ſmall ſtrand.

The bays, eſpecially thoſe of the ſouth,BAYS FROZEN. which lie under the influence of the cold of Greenland, are annually frozen over; that of Patrixfiord was ſhut up even as late as the 14th of May : but the ſea near the coaſts never feels the influence of the froſt. It is in thoſe places deep, and agitated by a moſt turbulent motion. The dreaded ice is what floats from Greenland and Spitzbergen, and often fills,FLOATING ICE. during the whole ſummer, the ſtreight between the former and this iſland, and even extends along the northern coaſt, covering the ſea to a vaſt diſtance from land. It conſiſts of the two ſpecies, the mountanous ice, called Fiael-jakar; and the ſmooth ice of inconſiderable thickneſs, ſtyled Hellu-is. Theſe arrive generally in January, and go away in March. Sometimes it does not touch the land till April, when it fixes for a conſiderable time, and brings to the Icelanders the moſt tremendous evils; a multitude of polar bears, which ſpread their ravages far and wide among the cattle; and a cold of incredible violence, which chills the air for many miles, and even cauſes the horſes and ſheep to drop down dead§. To this is attributed the ſtunted ſtate of the miſerable woods of the country; which cauſe muſt have exiſted from the commencement of its iron age; for there ſeems to have been a period in which there had been conſiderable wooded tracts.

The bottom of the ſea is probably rocky; for it abounds with greater variety of fuci than Great Britain, which give ſhelter to fiſhes innumerable; a ſource of wealth to the natives (were they permitted the free uſe) as they are of food to diſtant nations, the veſſels of which annually reſort here to fiſh, but without any commerce with the Icelanders, which is ſtrictly prohibited. In 1767, two hundred Dutch, and eighty French doggers, of about a hundred tons each, were employed, thoſe of each nation under the orders and protection of a frigate. They keep from four to ſix leagues from ſhore, and fiſh with hooks baited commonly with large muſſels, in forty or fifty fathoms water. Others go to the diſtance of fifteen leagues, and fiſh in the depth of a hundred fathoms. The great capture [LIV] is Cod. As ſoon as the fiſhermen take one, they cut off the head, waſh, gut, and ſalt it in caſks, with either rock-ſalt or that of Liſbon. The fiſhery commences in March, and ends in September. It begins at the point of Brederwick, and extends round the North Cape, by the iſle of Grim, to the point of Langeneſs.

The Engliſh have entirely deſerted this fiſhery ſince they have been in poſſeſſion of Newfoundland. It had been, in very early times, the reſort of our veſſels, as is evident by the proclamation of Henry V. in order to give ſatisfaction for the ill conduct of ſome of his ſubjects, in 1415, on the coaſts of this iſland*, in which he forbids them to reſort to the iſles of Denmark and Norway, eſpecially to Iceland, otherwiſe than had been antiently cuſtomary. In 1429, the Engliſh parlement enforced this order, by making it penal for any of our ſubjects to trade in the Daniſh ports, except in North Earn or Bergen. At length, the Daniſh monarch wiſely reſolved to reſerve the benefits of the fiſheries to his own ſubjects; and in 1465 made it capital for any Engliſhman to trade in the ports of Iceland . Even thoſe of Helgeland and Finmark were ſhut againſt them, unleſs they were driven in by a ſtorm. I imagine that this ſeverity muſt have ariſen from ſome glaring inſolence of our countrymen. But the antient treaties were revived, which were renewable by a freſh grant every ſeven years. In later times, even Queen Elizabeth deigned to aſk leave of Chriſtian IV. to fiſh in thoſe ſeas; but afterwards inſtructed her ambaſſador to inſiſt on the right of a free and univerſal fiſhery. The anſwer does not appear: but in the reign of her ſucceſſor, we had not fewer than a hundred and fifty veſſels employed in this fiſhery. Poſſibly we might comply with the regulations inſiſted on by the king of Denmark; or perhaps a greater indulgence was given, by reaſon of the marriage of James with his ſiſter Anne. I obſerve, that the Daniſh prince excepts the port of Weſtmony, it being reſerved for the peculiar ſupply of the royal court.

The oppreſſed natives fiſh in the bays in boats, containing one, and never more than four men. If they venture to ſea, which they ſeldom do to above eight miles diſtance, they have larger boats, manned with twelve or ſixteen hands; in theſe they ſlave for the benefit of the monopoliſts, to whom they are compelled to ſell their fiſh at a trifling price. How weak muſt be the feelings of that government which can add miſery to miſery; and not attempt rather to beſtow comforts on ſubjects condemned to ſuch a dreadful abode!

The ſpecies of fiſh in theſe ſeas are few; but the multitudes, under ſeveral of the moſt uſeful kinds, are amazing; thoſe of Cod in particular. Herrings paſs by [LV] this iſland in their annual migrations from the north, and for a ſhort ſpace fill every bay. Poverty and want of ſalt make theſe riches of other nations a tantalizing appearance to the unfortunate natives. This is the moſt northern place in which the Herring is ſeen: they are not found in the ſhallow water of Spitzbergen; neither is it probable that they double Greenland, and retire to the frozen ocean, equally wanting in depth of water;VAST DEPTHS OF WATER.—are they not rather loſt in the vaſt profundity of theſe very ſeas, in the depth of ſix hundred and eighty-three fathoms, in lat. 65, between this iſland and the north of Norway; or in the unfathomable depths a little farther north, where the water was found bottomleſs with ſeven hundred and eighty fathoms*? The other fiſhes of Iceland are in general common to Greenland: my remarks reſpecting them ſhall be deſerred till I treat of that icy region.

In order to view the correſpondent ſhores of the tract I have paſſed over,STREIGHTS OF DOVER. I ſhall return to the ſtreights of Dover. Calais is ſeated in a low wet tract; and the whole coaſt, from thence to the extremity of Holland, is ſandy, and fronted with ſand-hills; providentially higheſt in that loweſt of countries, in which the ſtrongeſt protection againſt the fury of the ſea is neceſſary. The coaſt of Flanders, SAND-BANKS OFF FLANDERS AND HOLLAND. the rich bait of ambition, ſtained with blood, is dangerous by reaſon of frequent narrow ſand-banks, diſpoſed in parallel rows, according to the direction of the land. The coaſts of Holland are alſo greatly infeſted with ſands; but between them and the land is a clear channel. From between Dunkirk and Calais, even to the Scar, at the extremity of Jutland, is low land, not to be ſeen but at a ſmall diſtance, unleſs at Camperden in Holland; Heilegeland, off the mouths of the Elbe and Weſer; and Robſnout, and Hartſhal, in Jutland. While the oppoſite coaſts of England are comparatively high, and the channel deep, theſe are univerſally obſtructed with ſand: the great German rivers bring down by their floods amazing quantities of ſand and mud, the courſe of which is impeded at ſea by the violence of the winds, blowing at ſouth and weſt two-thirds of the yearYarranton's England's Improvement, 4, 5.. Theſe, with the help of the tides, arreſt the progreſs of the ſand into the open ſea, and form the numerous banks which, fatal as they may be to mariners, are the ſecurity of Holland, in particular, from naval invaſions. The ſpring-tides at Calais riſe twenty feet; at the pier head at Dover, TIDES. to twenty-five; the cauſe of the variation is ſuppoſed, by Mr. Cowley, to be the different diſtances of the two piers from low-water mark, the firſt being half a mile, the laſt only a hundred yards; at Oſtend it riſes to eighteen; at Fluſhing, ſixteen and a half; at Helvoetſluys and the Texel, twelve; and on the coaſts of Holſtein and Jutland, where the ſea expands to a more conſiderable breadth, the tides grow more irregular, and weaken both in height and ſtrength; at the Elbe they do not exceed [LVI] ſeven or eight feet; on the coaſt of Jutland only two or three; a ſingular phoenomenon, as they are ſo greatly higher on the correſpondent eoaſts of England. The flood on the weſt coaſt of Holland ſets to the northward, contrary to the courſe of the tides on the eaſt coaſts of England and Scotland.

ANTIENT FLANDERS AND HOLLAND. Flanders and Brabant formed part of the Gallia Belgica of Ceſar; and Holland the Batavorum Inſula. The rivers are the Scaldis, Moſa, and Rhenus, the modern Scheld, Maeſe, and Rhine. The two firſt probably do not vary greatly in their diſcharge into the ſea: the laſt has experienced a moſt conſiderable change. The right branch of this river runs, for ſome ſpace, as it did in antient times, when it formed the lake Flevo, then reſumed the form of a ſtream, and diſcharged itſelf into the ſea at a place ſtill called the Flie-ſtroom, between the iſles of Flie-landt and Schelling, at the mouth of the Zuyder-zee. Long after that period the country was dry, firm, and well inhabited; a mighty inundation totally changed the face of it, and enlarged the Flevo lacus into the preſent Zuyder-zee, and broke the coaſt into the chain of iſlands which now front the ſhore, even as far as the mouth of the Weſer. The Dutch hiſtorians date this accident in 1421: it ſeems to have been the operation of a length of time; for the paſſage through the Texel was forced open in 1400, and gave riſe to the proſperity of Amſterdam *. This country was firſt peopled by the Catti, a German nation; theſe were thinned almoſt to extirpation by the ſwarms from the great northern hive, in their expeditions by land to other parts of Europe. For a very long ſpace Flanders and Holland were a ſeat of banditti: the vaſt foreſt of Ardennes gave protection to them in one country; the moraſſes ſecured them in the other. Government at length took place, in Holland under its counts, in Flanders under its foreſters. Theſe provinces fell at laſt under the dominion of the dukes of Burgundy; from them to the houſe of Auſtria and crown of Spain. The revolutions from that are well known. Holland received its ſecond population from Germany, happily (for a country whoſe exiſtence depends on induſtry) a moſt induſtrious race. The Rhine annually brings down multitudes of people, to repair the loſs of men occaſioned by diſtant voyages, and by the moſt unwholeſome colonies in the Eaſt and Weſt Indies. Holland is, from its climate, unfavorable to the encreaſe of mankind: it cannot depend on itſelf for the reparation of the loſs of people, but muſt look elſewhere for ſupplies.

ANIMALS.FLANDERS has many of the ſame ſpecies of animals with Great Britain; but, from the nature of its coaſt, wants moſt of the water-fowl, a few cloven-footed birds excepted, which breed on ſandy ſhores. Holland has ſtill fewer quadrupeds and birds. Of the quadrupeds which we want, are a few Beavers in the Rhine and Maeſe. The Wolf is common in Flanders, and is found [LVII] in the parts of Holland bordering on Germany. Both countries have a few birds which never appear in Britain, except forced by the violence of weather or purſuit of ſome bird of prey.

The antient Germany next ſucceeds. Holland was a ſort of neutral country, a retreat of the German Catti, and not Germany itſelf. As at preſent, the bordering parts were divided into petty ſtates. The rivers which derive their origin far up the country, are the Ems, the Weſer, and the Elb, the antient Amiſius, Viſurgis, and Albis.

Oppoſite to the mouth of the eſtuary of the Weſer and the Elb, INSULA SACRA, OR is the remnant of the Inſula, Caſtum Nemus, celebrated by Tacitus, with his uſual elegance, for the worſhip of HERTHUM, or MOTHER Earth, by the neighboring nations. Eſt in inſula oceani, CASTUM NEMUS, dicatum in eo vehiculum veſte contectum, attingere uni ſacerdoti conceſſum. Is adeſſe penetrali DEAM intelligit, vectamque bubus feminis multa cum veneratione proſequitur. Laeti tunc dies, feſta loca, quaecumque adventu hoſpitioque dignatur. Non bella ineunt, non arma ſumunt, clauſum omne ferrum. Pax et quies tunc tantùm nota, tunc tantùm amata. Donec idem ſacerdos ſatiatam converſatione mortalium Deam templo reddat. Mox vehiculum et veſtes, et, ſi credere velis, numea ipſum, ſecreto lacu abluitur. Servi miniſtrant, quos ſtatim idem lacus haurit. Arcanus hinc terror, ſanctaque ignorantia, quid ſit illud quod tantum perituri vidit *. The worſhip was continued very long after that period, and the iſland was diſtinguiſhed by the name of Foſtaland, Farria, Inſula Sacra, or Heilgeland, HEILGELAND. or the Holy iſle, from the ſacrifices made there to the goddeſs Foſta, or Foſeta, the ſame with Veſta, Herthum, or the EARTH. She was called by the Scandinavians, Goya. The victims to her were precipitated into a pit: if they ſunk at once, the ſacrifice was thought to be accepted: the reverſe if they ſwam any time on the ſurface. This iſland was viſited, out of reſpect to the goddeſs, by people of high rank. Radbothus I. king of the Friſians, was here in 690, when Winbertus, and other Chriſtian miſſionaries, landed, overthrew the temples, and put an end to the pagan rites. It had been an iſland of great extent; but by different inundations, between the years 800 and 1649, was reduced to its preſent contemptible ſize§. The great iſland of Nordſtrandt (one of the Inſulae Saxonum) not remote from this, in 1634 was reduced, by the ſame cauſe, from twenty pariſhes to one: fifty thouſand head of cattle, and between ſix and ſeven thouſand ſouls, were ſwept away. Such are the calamities to which theſe low countries are liable.

[LVIII] JUTLAND. Jutland and Holſtein, the antient Cimbrica Cherſoneſus *, and Cartris , terminating in the low point called the Skagen, or Scaw, ſtretches out in form of a peninſula, bounded by the North ſea and the Kattegatte, the oblique approach into the Baltic. It is a very narrow tract, and only the reſting-place of birds in their way from Scandinavia, and the farther north, the reſidence of numerous ſpecies. The rich marſhes, in a climate mild from its ſituation between two ſeas, afford numbers of wholeſome plants, the food of a remarkably fine breed of cattle. Beſides the home conſumption, theſe provinces ſend out annually thirty-two thouſand head. The nobility do not think it beneath them to preſide over the dairy: and their number of cows is princely. M. De Rantzau had not fewer than ſix hundred milch cows.

What the extent of this country might have been in very early times is unknown: it muſt have been prodigiouſly great, otherwiſe it never could have poured out that amazing number of people it did, in their eruption into France, when they were defeated by Marius, in 101 before CHRIST. Their army was computed to conſiſt of three hundred thouſand fighting men (including the Teutoni) beſides women and children.CIMBRIAN DELUGE. About ſeven years before, they had ſuffered a great calamity from an inundation of the ſea, which had deſtroyed great part of their country; and compelled the ſurvivors, then crouded in the narrow Cherſoneſus, to apply to the Romans for other lands. Tacitus ſpeaks of the veſtiges of this once mighty people, in the lines, viſible in his time, on each ſhore. I preſume that the inundations to which this coaſt is ſubject from the ſea, hath utterly deſtroyed every trace of them. The charts plainly point out their overwhelmed territories in Juts-riff, and the neighboring ſand-banks. The firſt might have been the continuation of land from the end of Jutland, beginning at the Skaw, and running out into the North ſea in form of a ſcythe, not very remote from land, and terminating a little ſouth of Bergen in Norway, leaving between its banks and that kingdom a deeper channel into the Baltic.

The Kattegatte lies between part of Jutland and the coaſt of Sweden: the laſt covered with iſles innumerable. It is almoſt cloſed at the extremity, by the low Daniſh iſlands of Seland and Funen, which had in old times been (with Sweden) the ſeat of the Suiones. THE SOUND. Between the firſt and the coaſt of Sweden, is the famous Sound, the paſſage tributary to the Danes by thouſands of ſhips. Theſe iſles were of old called Codonania §, and gave to the Kattegatte the name of Sinus Codanus. The proper Baltic ſeems to have been the Mare Suevicum of the antients; and the fartheſt part, the Mare Sarmaticum, and part of the Mare Scythicum. As a naturaliſt, [LIX] I muſt mention, that when LINNAEUS ſpeaks of the Mare Occidentale, he intends the Kattegatte. Its greateſt depth is thirty-five fathoms. It decreaſes as it approaches the Sound; which begins with ſixteen fathoms, and near Copenhagen ſhallows to even four.

The Roman fleet, under the command of Germanicus, ſailed, according to Pliny, VOYAGE OF THE ROMAN FLEET. round Germany, and even doubled the Cimbricum Promontorium, and arrived at the iſlands which fill the bottom of the Kattegatte *: either by obſervation or information, the Romans were acquainted with twenty-three. One they called Gleſſaria, from its amber, a foſſil abundant to this day on part of the ſouth ſide of the Baltic. A Roman knight was employed by Nero's maſter of the gladiators, to collect, in theſe parts, that precious production, by which he came perfectly acquainted with this country. I cannot ſuppoſe that the Romans ever ſettled in any part of the neighborhood, yet there was ſome commerce between them, either direct, or by the intervention of merchants. Many ſilver coins have been found at Kivikke, in Schonen in Sweden, of Hadrian, Antoninus Pius, Commodus, and Albinus . Among the iſlands, Pliny makes Norway one, under the name of Scandinavia incompertae magnitudinis, and Baltia another, immenſae magnitudinis, probably part of the ſame, and which might give name to the Sounds called the Belts, and to the Baltic itſelf. The geographer Mela had the juſteſt information of this great water, which he deſcribes with great elegance, Hac re mare (CODANUS SINUS) quod gremio littorum accipitur, nunquam latè patet, nec USQUAM MARI SIMILE verum aquis paſſim interfluentibus ac ſaepe tranſgreſſis vagum atque diffuſum facie amnium ſpargitur, qua littora attingit, ripis contentum inſularum non longè diſtantibus, et ubique poene tantundem, it anguſtum et par FRETO curvanſque ſe ſubinde, longo ſupercilio inflexum eſt. The different nations which inhabited its coaſts ſhall hereafter be mentioned.

I would, like Mela, THE BALTIC A GULPH. prefer giving to the Baltic the name of a gulph rather than a ſea; for it wants many requiſites to merit that title. It wants depth, having in no one place more than a hundred and ten fathoms.DEPTH. From the eaſtern mouth of the Sound to the iſle of Bornholm it has from nine to thirty: from thence to Stockholm, from fifteen to fifty: and a little ſouth of Lindo, ſixty. It has in this courſe many ſand-banks, but all in great depths of water. Between Alands Haff, amidſt the great archipelago, the Aland iſles, and the iſle of Oſel in the gulph of Riga, the depths are various, from ſixty to a hundred and ten. Many freſh-water lakes exceed it in that reſpect.

[LX] NO TIDES.It wants tides, therefore experiences no difference of height, except when the winds are violent. At ſuch times there is a current in and out of the Baltic, according to the points they blow from; which forces the water through the Sound with the velocity of two or three Daniſh miles in the hour. When the wind blows violently from the German ſea, the water riſes in the ſeveral Baltic harbours, and gives thoſe in the weſtern part a temporary ſaltneſs:NOT SALT. otherwiſe the Baltic loſes that other property of a ſea, by reaſon of the want of tide, and the quantity of vaſt rivers it receives, which ſweeten it ſo much as to render it, in many places, fit for domeſtic uſes. In all the Baltic, Linnaeus enumerates but three fuci *, plants of the ſea: in the gulph of Bothnia, which is beyond the reach of ſalt water, not one.

FEW SPECIES OF FISH.The fewneſs of ſpecies of fiſh in the Baltic is another difference between it and a genuine ſea. I can enumerate only nineteen which are found in this vaſt extent of water: and may add one cetaceous fiſh, the Porpeſſe. No others venture beyond the narrow ſtreights which divide the Baltic from the Kattegatte; yet the great Swediſh Fauniſt reckons eighty-ſeven belonging to his country, which is waſhed only by thoſe two waters. Let me mention the Herring as a ſpecies which has from very early times enriched the neighboring cities. There was, between the years 1169 and 1203, a vaſt reſort of Chriſtian ſhips to fiſh off the iſle of Rugen, the ſeat of the antient Rugii, inſomuch that the Danes cloathed themſelves with ſcarlet and purple, and fine linen.

The Hornſimpa, or COTTUS QUADRICORNIS, Faun. Suec. No 321, and the SYNGNATHUS TYPHLE, or Blind Pipe-fiſh, No 377, are unknown in the Britiſh ſeas: the firſt ſeems peculiar to the gulph of Bothnia, and is a fiſh of ſingular figure, with four flat hornlike proceſſes on the head.

LENGTH AND BREADTH OF THE BALTIC.The extent of the Baltic in length is very great. From Helſingor, where it properly begins, to Cronſtadt, at the end of the gulph of Finland, is eight hundred and ten Engliſh ſea miles. Its breadth, between Saltwic, in Smaland, and the oppoſite ſhore,OF THE GULPH OF BOTHNIA. two hundred and thirty-ſeven. The gulph of Bothnia, which runs due north, forms an extent almoſt equal to the firſt, being, from Tornea in Lapland, to [LXI] the ſhore near Dantzic, not leſs than ſeven hundred and ſeventy-eight: an amazing ſpace, to be ſo ill ſtocked with fiſhy inhabitants.

From the iſle of Rugen, the courſe of the Baltic is ſtrait and open, except where interrupted by the famous iſle of Gottland, ISLE OF GOTTLAND. the place of rendezvous from whence the Goths made their naval excurſions. In 811, on this iſland, was founded the famous town of Wiſbuy, the great emporium of the north: it was, for ages, the reſort of every Chriſtian nation. The Engliſh long traded here, before they ventured on the diſtant voyage of the Mediterranean. It became an independent city, and made its maritime laws the ſtandard of all Europe to the north of Spain. In 1361, Waldemar III. of Denmark, attacked, ravaged, and plundered it of immenſe riches; all which periſhed at ſea after they were ſhipped*. Its preſent inhabitants are huſbandmen and fiſhermen, ſecure from the calamities of war by the happy want of exuberant wealth.

Beyond Stockholm the Baltic divides into the gulphs of Bothnia and Finland: the firſt runs deeply to the north, and the country is compoſed chiefly of granite rock, or ſtrewed over with detached maſſes of the ſame. Its greateſt breadth is between Gefle and Abo, in Finland, where it meaſures a hundred and ſixty-two miles: its greateſt depth a hundred and ninety-five yards. It terminates in Lapland, LAPLAND. a country divided by the river Tornea, which runs navigable far up between a continued mountanous foreſt. It is ſuppoſed to have been peopled in the eleventh century by the Finni: a fact not eaſy to be admitted; for the Finni, or Fennones, are a brawny race, with long yellow hair, and brown irides. The Laplanders are, on the contrary, ſmall in body, have ſhort black hair, and black irides. It is certain that a party of Fins deſerted their native country, Finland, in the age before mentioned, rather than relinquiſh the brutality of heatheniſm. Their offspring remain converted, and in ſome meaſure reclamed, between Norway and Sweden ; but are a moſt diſtinct race from the Laplanders, who poſſeſſed their country long before. In the ninth century, the hero Regner ſlew its king or leader in battle§: at that period it was in a ſavage ſtate; nor was its conqueſt attempted by Sweden till 1277, when Waldemar added it to his kingdom, and in vain attempted its converſion. Scarcely two centuries have elapſed ſince it has ſincerely embraced the doctrines of Chriſtianity. In conſequence of which, cultivation and civilization have ſo well ſucceeded in the ſouthern parts, that many deſerts are peopled, moraſſes drained, and the reaſon of the natives ſo greatly improved, that they have united with the Swedes, and even ſent their repreſentatives to the [LXII] Houſe of Peaſants in the national diet*. But theſe were at all times the moſt cultivated of this diſtinct race. They trained the Rein-deer to the ſledge, domeſticated it from its wild ſtate, and made it the ſubſtitute for the Cow.

Their country, which penetrates even to the Northern ocean, conſiſts of ſavage mountains, woods, vaſt marſhes, rivers, and lakes, the haunts of myriads of waterfowl,BIRDS. which reſort here in ſummer to breed, free from the diſturbance of mankind. LINNAEUS, the great explorer of theſe deſerts, my venerated example! mentions them as exceeding in numbers the armies of Xerxes; re-migrating, with him, in autumn, eight entire days and nights, to ſeek ſuſtenance on the ſhores and waters of more favorable climates.

FISH.Their lakes and rivers abound in fiſh; yet the number of ſpecies are few. Theſe are the Ten-ſpined Stickle-back, Br. Zool. iii. No 130; Salmon, No 143, in great abundance, which force their way to the very heads of the furious rivers of Tornea and Kiemi, to depoſit their ſpawn; Char, No 149, are found in the lakes in great abundance; and Graylings, No 150, in the rivers; Gwiniads, No 152, are taken of eight or ten pounds weight; Pikes, No 153, ſometimes eight feet long; and Perch, No 124, of an incredible ſize§; and the Salmo Albula, Faun. Suec. No 353, cloſes the liſt of thoſe of the Lapland lakes and rivers.

ALAND ISLES.The mouth of the gulph of Bothnia is filled with a prodigious cluſter of little iſlands and rocks, dangerous to mariners. Aland is the chief, an iſland of ſurpriſing rockineſs, and with all the other aſpects as if torn from the continent by ſome mighty convulſion.GULPH OF FINLAND. The gulph of Finland extends from thence due eaſt, and has, on its northern coaſt, a chain of ſimilar iſlands, and a few ſprinkled over the channel. All the coaſt and all its iſles are compoſed of red or grey granite; and all the coaſts of Sweden are the ſame, mixed in places with ſand-ſtones. Finland and Carelia are the bounds of the gulph on this ſide: Livonia, the granary of the north, and Ingria, on the other. Theſe countries, with Ruſſia, made part of the European Scythia, or Sarmatia; and this part of the Baltic has been ſometimes ſtyled Mare Scythicum, and Mare Sarmaticum . The gulph decreaſes in depth from ſixty to five fathoms, as you advance towards Cronſtadt, the great naval arſenal of Ruſſia. PETERSBURG. From thence is twelve miles of ſhallow water to Peterſburg, that glorious creation of PETER the GREAT; the inlet of wealth and ſcience into his vaſt dominions, before his time inacceſſible to the reſt of Europe, unleſs by the tedious voyage of the White ſea; and a country unknown, but by the report of the ſplendid barbariſm of its tyrants. Peter was formed with a ſingular mixture of [LXIII] endowments for the purpoſe of civilizing a rude and barbarous people: his mind was pregnant with great deſigns, obſtinate perſeverance, and unrelenting ſeverity in the exertion of puniſhment on all who dared to oppoſe the execution of his ſyſtem for the good of the whole. A mind filled with the milkineſs of human nature, would never have been able to deal with the ſavage uninformed Ruſſians. Peter hewed his work into ſhape: for the laſt poliſh, Heaven formed another CATHERINE, the admiration of Europe, the bleſſing of an empire which forms at leſt one eleventh of the globe, extending from the northern point of Nova Zemlja, in the frozen latitude of near 78, to the influx of the Terek into the Caſpian ſea, in the warm latitude of about 43 and a half; or, to give it the ſhorteſt breadth, from the coaſt of the Frozen ocean, at the extremity of the country of the Tſchutki, lat. 73, to the mouth of the Aimakan, in the gulph of Ochotz, in lat. 54. Its length is ſtill more prodigious, from Peterſburgh as far as the Aſiatic ſide of the ſtreights of Bering.

In the following work, I have, by the aſſiſtance of that celebrated naturaliſt Doctor PALLAS, given a deſcription of the Quadrupeds and Birds of this vaſt empire, as far as was compatible with my plan, which was confined between the higheſt known latitudes of the northern hemiſphere, as low as that of 60. The remainder will be comprehended in the great deſign formed by the Imperial Academy, and executed by profeſſors whoſe glory it is to prove themſelves worthy of their illuſtrious and munificent patroneſs, under whoſe auſpices they have pervaded every part of her extenſive dominions in ſearch of uſeful knowledge.

To Peterſburg, this corner of the empire, is brought, as to a vaſt emporium, the commerce of the moſt diſtant parts; and from hence are circulated the European articles to ſupply even the remote China. The place of traffic is on the Chineſe borders, at Kjackta, a town without women; for none are allowed to attend their huſbands. By this route the furs of Hudſon's-Bay find their way to warm the luxurious inhabitants of Pekin, the animals of the neighboring Tartary and Sibiria being inadequate to the increaſed demand. The want of a maritime intercourſe is no obſtacle to this enterpriſing nation to the carrying on a trade with India. It has encouraged above a hundred Banians, all males, from Multan, to ſettle at Aſtracan; and their number is kept up by a ſupply of young unmarried relations from home. Theſe ſupport the moſt important trade of Aſtracan, by carrying through Aſtrabad to the inland parts of the Mogol empire. I ſtray a little from my plan; but it may be excuſed on account of the novelty of the relation, and becauſe it points out a more ſouthern inland road than was known in the middle ages, when the merchants went by the way of Bochara and Samarcand to the northern cities of India, Candahar and Cabul.

[LXIV] SAPMATAE.In my return to the German ſea, let me review the antient inhabitants of the Baltic. The wandering Sarmatae, of Scythian deſcent, poſſeſſed all the country from lake Onega to the Viſtula; and part of the vaſt Hercynian foreſt, famous of old for its wild beaſts, occupied moſt of this country. Biſons with their great manes: Uri with their enormous horns, which the natives bound with ſilver and quaffed at their great feaſts: the Alces, or Elk, then fabled to have jointleſs legs: and Wild Horſes, were among the quadrupeds of this tract*. I ſmile at the deſcription of certain birds of the Hercynian wood, whoſe feathers ſhone in the night, and often proved the guide to the bewildered travellerSolinus, c. 32. Plin. x. c. 47.. The reſplendent plumage of the Strix Nyctea, the Snowy Owl, No 121, might probably have ſtruck the eye of the benighted wanderer, and given riſe to the ſtrange relation.

ENINGIA. Eningia was the oppoſite ſhore, and the ſame with the modern Finland, inhabited by people of amazing ſavageneſs and ſqualid poverty; who lived by the chace, headed their arrows with bones, cloathed themſelves with ſkins, lay on the ground, and had no other ſhelter for their infants than a few interwoven boughs. They were then, what the people of Terra del Fuego are now. There is no certainty reſpecting the Oonae; OONAE. iſlanders, who fed, as many do at preſent, on the eggs of wild fowl and on oats; but moſt probably they were the natives of the iſles of Aland, and the adjacent archipelago; for Mela expreſsly places them oppoſite to the Sarmatae. HIPPOPODAE. We may add, that the Hippopodae and Panoti might be the inhabitants of the northern part of the Bothnian gulph; the firſt fabled to have hoofs like horſes, the laſt ears ſo large as to ſerve inſtead of cloaks. The Hippopodae were certainly the ſame ſort of people as the Finni Lignipedes of Olaus, and the Skride Finnus of Ohthere. They wore ſnow-ſhoes, which might fairly give the idea of their being, like horſes, hoofed and ſhod. As to the Panoti, they baffle my imagination.

The Bothnian and Finland gulphs ſeem to me to have been, in the time of Tacitus, part of his Mare pigrum ac immotum, which, with part of the Hyperborean ocean, really inſulated Scandinavia, and which he places beyond the Suiones, or modern Sweden. Pliny gives, I ſuppoſe from the relation of Britiſh or other voyagers, to part of this ſea, probably the moſt northern, the title of Morimaruſa, or Dead Sea, and Cronium. The learned Forſter, with great ingenuity, derives the word from the Gaelic and Celtic language. The firſt, from the Welſh, môr, ſea, and marw, dead; the other from the Iriſh, muir-croinn, the coagulated, i. e. congealed ſea. Tacitus adds to his account, that it was believed to encircle [LXV] the whole globe, and that the laſt light of the ſetting ſun continued ſo very vivid as to obſcure the ſtars themſelves. There is not a ſingle circumſtance of exaggeration in all this: every winter the gulph is frozen, and becomes motionleſs. Many inſtances may be adduced even of the Baltic itſelf being frozen*. The ſtars are frequently loſt in the amazing ſplendor and various colors of the aurora borealis. The Hilleviones, an antient people of Sweden, ſtyled Scandinavia, alterum orbem terrarum, and their deſcendants, long carolled the junction of the Bothnian gulph with the northern ocean, traditionally rehearſed in old Swediſh ſongs. Tacitus uſes the two laſt words to expreſs the world ſurrounded by this ſea. In the days of the geographer Mela, there certainly was a ſtrong tide in this upper part of the Baltic; for, ſpeaking of the iſlands off Finland, he ſays, ‘Quae Sarmatis adverſa ſunt, ob alternos acceſſus recurſuſque pelagi, et quod ſpatia queis diſtant, modò operiuntur undis, modò nuda ſunt; aliàs inſulae videntur, aliàs una et continens terra.’ With propriety, therefore, in another place, does he compare it to a ſtreight, par freto, notwithſtanding he was ignorant of its other entrance.ANTIENT STREIGHTS BETWEEN Doctor Pallas moſt juſtly aſcribes the formation of not only the Baltic, but its former communication with the White Sea, to the effects of a deluge. The whole intermediate country is a proof; the foundation being what is called the old rock, and that covered with variety of matter; ſuch as beds of pebble and gravel, and fragments of granite, torn from the great maſs.THE BALTIC AND WHITE SEA. Parts of the channel which formed the inſulation of Scandinavia, are the chain of lakes, from that of Ladoga to the White Sea, ſuch as Onega, and others, often connected by rivers, and lying in a low country, filled with the proofs above-mentioned. This was the ſtreight through which the tide poured itſelf from the Hyperborean ocean, and covered, at its flux, the iſlands deſcribed by Mela. This, like the other northern ſeas, was annually frozen over, and could be no obſtacle to the ſtocking of Scandinavia with quadrupeds. There is no fixing the period in which this paſſage was obſtructed. An influx of ſand, or an earthquake, might cloſe it up. As ſoon as this event took place, the Baltic felt the want of its uſual feed: it loſt the property of a ſea; and, by a conſtant exhalation, from that time decreaſed in the quantity of water. Modern philoſophers have proved the great loſs it has ſuſtained, and that it decreaſes from forty to fifty inches in a century: that, near Pithea, the gulph of Bothnia has retired from the land half a mile in forty-five years; and near Lulea, a mile in twenty-eight. Notwithſtanding its preſent ſtate, when we conſider the accounts given by the antients, the old Swediſh traditions, and the preſent veſtiges of the former channel, we can, without any [LXVI] force of fancy, give full credit to the inſulated form of Scandinavia, given in one of Cluverius's maps*; which, he ſays, is drawn from the erroneous accounts of the antients.

SUIONES.The Suiones poſſeſſed the modern Sweden, and extended even to the ocean, and were a potent naval power. Their ſhips were ſo conſtructed, with prows at each end, that they were always ready to advance. Theſe people, in after times, proved, under the common name of Nortmans, the peſt and conquerors of great part of ſouthern Europe; their ſkill in maritime affairs fitting them for diſtant expeditions. In the ſixth century they were called Suethans, and were famous for their cavalry. In their time, the Sable, No 30, was common in their country: Jornandes, therefore, obſerves, that notwithſtanding they lived poorly, they were moſt richly cloathed: he alſo informs us, that they ſupplied the Romans with theſe precious furs, through the means of numbers of intervening nations. Scandinavia, in that period, had got the name of Scanzia; and as it was then called an iſland, and by Jornandes , a native of the country, there is all the reaſon to imagine, that the paſſage into the Hyperborean ocean was not in his time cloſed.

After repaſſing the Sound, appear Schonen, Halland, and Bohuſtand, Swediſh provinces, bounded by the Kattegatte. Halland, from ſome ſimilitude of ſound, is ſuppoſed to have been the ſeat of the Hilleviones, a moſt populous nation; perhaps the ſame with the Suiones of Tacitus; for beyond them he places the Sitones, or the country of Norway, NORWAY. who were a great naval people; as the hiſtorian ſays that they differed not from the Suiones, except in being under a female government. The promontory of the Naze, THE NAZE. viſible at eight or ten leagues diſtance, with the low land of Bevenbergen in Jutland, forms the entrance into the German ſea. The Bommel, and the Drommel, high mountains to the eaſt of it; and the high land of Leſt, a vaſt mountain, gradually riſing from the ſhore, to the weſt, are noted guides to mariners. It is reaſonably ſuppoſed, that Pliny intended this vaſt region by his iſland of Nerigon, from whence, ſays he, was a paſſage to Thule. He ſpeaks alſo of Bergos, which, from agreement of ſound, is thought to be the preſent province of Bergen. The promontorium Rubeas is gueſſed to be the North Cape, between which and the Cimbri, Philaemon § places the Mare Morimaruſa, or the Dead Sea, ſo called from the clouded ſky that uſually reigned there.

Our firſt certain knowlege of the inhabitants of this country, was from the deſolation they brought on the ſouthern nations by their piratical invaſions. [LXVII] Their country had, before that period, the name of Nortmannaland, and the inhabitants Nortmans; NORTMANS. a title which included other adjacent people. Great Britain and Ireland were ravaged by them in 845; and they continued their invaſion till they effected the conqueſt of England, under their leader, Canute the Great. They went up the Seine as far as Paris, burnt the town, and forced its weak monarch to purchaſe their abſence at the price of fourteen thouſand marks. They plundered Spain, and at length carried their excurſions through the Mediterranean to Italy, and even into Sicily. They uſed narrow veſſels, like their anceſtors the Sitones; and, beſides oars, added the improvement of two ſails: and victualled them with ſalted proviſions, biſcuit, cheeſe, and beer. Their ſhips were at firſt ſmall; but in after times they were large enough to hold a hundred or a hundred and twenty men. But the multitude of veſſels was amazing. The fleet of Harold Blaatand conſiſted of ſeven hundred*. A hundred thouſand of theſe ſavages have at once ſallied from Scandinavia, ſo juſtly ſtyled Officina Gentium, aut certè velut vagina nationum . Probably neceſſity, more than ambition, cauſed them to diſcharge their country of its exuberant numbers. Multitudes were deſtroyed; but multitudes remained, and peopled more favorable climes.

Their king, Olaus, was a convert to Chriſtianity in 994; Bernard, an Engliſhman, had the honor of baptizing him, when Olaus happened to touch at one of the Scilly iſlands. He plundered with great ſpirit during ſeveral years; and in 1006 received the crown of martyrdom from his pagan ſubjects. But religious zeal firſt gave the reſt of Europe a knowlege of their country, and the ſweets of its commerce. The Hanſe towns poured in their miſſionaries, and reaped a temporal harveſt. By the year 1204, the merchants obtained from the wiſe prince Suer every encouragement to commerce; and by that means introduced wealth and civilization into his barren kingdom. England, by every method, cheriſhed the advantages reſulting from an intercourſe with Norway; and Bergen was the emporium. Henry III. in 1217, entered into a league with its monarch Haquin, by which both princes ſtipulated for free acceſs for their ſubjects into their reſpective kingdoms, free trade and ſecurity to their perſons. In 1269, Henry entered into another treaty with Magnus, in which it was agreed, that no goods ſhould be exported from either kingdom except they had been paid for; and there is beſides a humane proviſion on both ſides, for the ſecurity of the perſons and effects of the ſubjects who ſhould ſuffer ſhipwreck on their ſeveral coaſts.

This country extends above fifteen hundred miles in length,COASTS. and exhibits a moſt wonderful appearance of coaſt. It runs due north to Cape Staff, the [LXVIII] weſtern point of Sondmor, then winds north-eaſt to its extremity at the North Cape. SEA. High and precipitous rocks compoſe the front, with a ſea generally from one to three hundred fathoms deep waſhing their baſe*. Multitudes of narrow creeks penetrate deep into the land, overſhadowed by ſtupendous mountains. The ſides of theſe chaſms have depth equal to that of the adjacent ſea; but in the middle is a channel called Dybrendes, DYBRENDES. i. e. deep courſes, from fifty to a hundred fathoms broad, and of the diſproportionable depth of four hundred, ſeemingly time-worn by the ſtrength of the current from the torrent-rivers which pour into them. Fiſh innumerable reſort to their edges. Theſe creeks are, in many places, the roads of the country; for the vallies which traverſe it are often ſo precipitous as to be impervious, unleſs by water. Some, which want theſe conveniences, are left uninhabited by reaſon of the impoſſibility of conveying to and from them the articles of commerce.

CHAIN OF ISLANDS.Millions of iſlands, large and ſmall, ſkerries, or rocks, follow the greateſt part of this wondrous coaſt. The iſlands are rude and mountanous, and ſoar correſpondent to the Alps of the oppoſite continent. Thoſe of Loeffort, on the north ſide of the dreadful whirlpool Maelſtrom, engraven by Le Bruyn, give a full idea of the nature of the coaſts. The ſea near the iſlands is ſo deep and rocky, that the Norwegian kings cauſed vaſt iron rings to be faſtened with lead § to the ſides, to enable ſhips to moor in ſecurity, or to aſſiſt them in warping out. A few of the former give ſhelter to the fiſhermen and their ſmall ſtock of cattle; the reſt riſe in columns of groteſque forms. On the outſide of theſe natural counterſcarps, are multitudes of haubroe, or ſea-breakers, longitudinal banks of ſand, running north and ſouth, from the diſtance of four to ſixteen leagues from the continent, and from ten to fifteen fathoms below the ſurface of the water; the haunts of myriads of uſeful fiſh.

TIDES.The tides off the Naze, and moſt of the coaſts of Norway, are very inconſiderable. At the North Cape, the ſpring tides have been obſerved to riſe to the height of eight feet one inch; the neap to ſix feet eight inches. Mr. William Ferguſon, an able pilot, who had often the conduct of our fleets in the North ſea, informed me, that on the Naze, and many other parts of Norway, the tides were hardly perceptible, except with ſtrong weſterly winds, when they roſe two or three feet, and fell with the eaſterly winds.

RIVERS.Into the ends of moſt of the Dybrendes ruſh the furious rivers, or rather torrents, of the mountains; uſeleſs for navigation, but moſt ſingularly advantageous [LXIX] for the conveyance of the great article of commerce, the maſts and timber of the country, from the otherwiſe inacceſſible foreſts. The trees are cut down, and at preſent conveyed from ſome diſtance to the rivers, down which they are precipitated over rocks and ſtupendous cataracts,LENTZES. until they arrive at the Lentzes or booms*, placed obliquely in the ſtream in fit places. To them the owners of the timber reſort; and, on paying a certain rate to the proprietors, receive their pieces, which are all marked before they are committed to the water; but numbers are injured or deſtroyed in the rough paſſage.

The ſpecies which is of ſuch great value to Norway, is the Fyr or Fare, our Scotch Pine, and the Pinus Sylveſtris of Linnaeus. It grows in the drieſt places, and attains the vaſt age of four hundred years; and is of univerſal uſe in the northern world. Such trees as are not deſtined for maſts are ſquared, and arrive in England under the name of Balk: the reſt are ſawed on the ſpot, in hundreds of mills, turned by the torrents, and reach us in form of planks. An immenſe quantity of tar is made from the trees, and even from the roots, very long after they have been divided from the trunk. The Gran, Pinus Abies, or what we call Norway Fir, is in little eſteem. Thouſands are cut down annually by the peaſants, who feed their cattle with the tender ſhoots. It is the talleſt of European trees, growing to the height of a hundred and ſixty feet. In winter, the branches are depreſſed to the ground with ſnow, and form beneath them the dens of wild beaſts.

I muſt here mention the adventitious fruits,EXOTIC FRUITS FOUND ON THE SHORES. ſuch as nuts and other vegetable productions, which are brought by the waves to theſe ſhores, thoſe of Feroe, and the Orknies, from Jamaica and other neighboring parts. We muſt have recourſe to a cauſe very remote from this place.GULPH-STREAM. Their vehicle is the gulph-ſtream from the gulph of Mexico. The trade-winds force the great body of the ocean from the weſtward through the Antilles into that gulph, when it is forced backward along the ſhore from the mouth of the Miſſiſſipi to Cape Florida; doubles that cape in the narrow ſea between it and Cuba, and from Cape Florida to Cape Cannaveral runs nearly north, at the diſtance of from five to ſeven leagues from ſhore, and extends in breadth from fifteen to eighteen leagues. There are regular ſoundings from the land to the edge of the ſtream, where the depth is generally ſeventy fathoms; after that no bottom can be found. The ſoundings off Cape Cannaveral are very ſteep and uncertain, as the water ſhallows ſo quick, that from forty fathoms it will immediately leſſen to fifteen, and from that to four, or leſs; ſo that, without great care, a ſhip may be in a few minutes on ſhore. It muſt be obſerved, that, notwithſtanding the gulph-ſtream in general [LXX] is ſaid to begin where ſoundings end, yet its influence extends ſeveral leagues within the ſoundings; and veſſels often find a conſiderable current ſetting to the northward all along the coaſt, till they get into eight or ten fathom water, even where the ſoundings ſtretch to twenty leagues from the ſhore; but their current is generally augmented or leſſened by the prevaling winds, the force of which, however, can but little affect the grand unfathomable ſtream. From Cape Cannaveral to Cape Hatteras the ſoundings begin to widen in the extent of their run from the ſhore to the inner edge of the ſtream, the diſtance being generally near twenty leagues, and the ſoundings very regular to about ſeventy fathoms near the edge of the ſtream, where no bottom can be afterwards found. Abreaſt of Savannah river, the current ſets nearly north; after which, as if from a bay, it ſtretches north-eaſt to Cape Hatteras; and from thence it ſets eaſt-north-eaſt, till it has loſt its force. As Cape Hatteras runs a great way into the ſea, the edge of the ſtream is only from five to ſeven leagues diſtant from the cape; and the force and rapidity of the main ſtream has ſuch influence, within that diſtance, over ſhips bound to the ſouthward, that in very high foul winds, or in calms, they have frequently been hurried back to the northward, which has often occaſioned great diſappointment both to merchant ſhips and to men of war, as was often experienced in the late war. In December 1754, an exceeding good ſailing ſhip, bound from Philadelphia to Charleſtown, got abreaſt of Cape Hatteras every day during thirteen days, ſometimes even with the tide, and in a middle diſtance between the cape and the inner edge of the ſtream; yet the ſhip was forced back regularly, and could only recover its loſt way with the morning breeze, till the fourteenth day, when a briſk gale helped it to ſtem the current, and get to the ſouthward of the Cape. This ſhews the impoſſibility of any thing which has fallen into the ſtream returning, or ſtopping in its courſe.

On the outſide of the ſtream is a ſtrong eddy or contrary current towards the ocean; and on the inſide, next to America, a ſtrong tide ſets againſt it. When it ſets off from Cape Hatteras, it takes a current nearly north-eaſt; but in its courſe meets a great current that ſets from the north, and probably comes from Hudſon's Bay, along the coaſt of Labrador, till the iſland of Newfoundland divides it; part ſetting along the coaſt through the ſtreights of Belleiſle, and ſweeping paſt Cape Breton, runs obliquely againſt the gulph-ſtream, and gives it a more eaſtern direction: the other part of the northern current is thought to join it on the eaſtern ſide of Newfoundland. The influence of theſe joint currents muſt be far felt; yet poſſibly its force is not ſo great, nor contracted in ſuch a pointed and circumſcribed direction as before they encountered. The prevaling winds all over this part of the ocean are the weſt and north-weſt, and conſequently [LXXI] the whole body of the weſtern ocean ſeems, from their influence, to have what the mariners call a ſet to the eaſtward, or to the north-eaſt by eaſt. Thus the productions of Jamaica, and other places bordering on the gulph of Mexico, may be firſt brought by the ſtream out of the gulph, inveloped in the ſargaſſo or alga of the gulph round Cape Florida, and hurried by the current either along the American ſhore, or ſent into the ocean in the courſe along the ſtream, and then by the ſet of the ſtream, and the prevaling winds, which generally blow two-thirds of the year, wafted to the ſhores of Europe, where they are found*.

The maſt of the Tilbury man of war, burnt at Jamaica, was thus conveyed to the weſtern ſide of Scotland; and among the amazing quantity of drift-wood, or timber, annually flung on the coaſts of Iceland, are ſome ſpecies which grow in Virginia and Carolina . All the great rivers of thoſe countries contribute their ſhare; the Alatamaha, Santee, and Roanok, and all the rivers which flow into the Cheſapeak, ſend down in floods numberleſs trees; but Iceland is alſo obliged to Europe for much of its drift-wood; for the common pine, fir, lime, and willows, are among thoſe enumerated by Mr. Troille; all which, probably, were wafted from Norway.

The mountains of Norway might prove a boundleſs ſubject of ſpeculation to the traveller. Their extent is prodigious, and the variety of plants, animals,MOUNTAINS. and fiſhes of the lakes, are funds of conſtant amuſement. The ſilver mines,METALS. wrought ever ſince 1623, are ſources of wealth to the kingdom, and afford the fineſt ſpecimens of the native kinds yet known. Gold was found in a conſiderable quantity in 1697. Chriſtian V. cauſed ducats to be coined with it; the inſcription was the words of Job, VON MITTERNACHT KOMT GOLD, out of the north comes GOLD. Copper and iron are found in abundance; lead in leſs quantities: tin does not extend to this northern region. It is difficult to ſay which is the beginning of this enormous chain. In Scandinavia it begins in the great Koelen rock at the extremity of Finmark. It enters Norway in the dioceſe of Drontheim, bends weſtward towards the ſea, and terminates at a vaſt precipice, I think, the Heirefoſs, about three Norwegian miles from Liſter. Another branch of this mountain divides Norway from Sweden, fills Lapland, and riſes into [LXXII] the diſtinguiſhed ſummits of Horrikalero, Avaſaxa, and Kittis, and ends in ſcattered maſſes of granite, in the low province of Finland. It incloſes Scandinavia in form of a horſe-ſhoe, and divides it from the vaſt plains of Ruſſia. The antient name of this chain was Sevo mons, to this day retained in the modern name Seveberg. Pliny compares it to the Riphaean hills, and truly ſays, it forms an immenſe bay, even to the Cimbrian promontory*.

The mountains and iſlands break into very groteſque forms, and would furniſh admirable ſubjects for the pencil. Among the deſiderata of theſe days, is a tour into thoſe parts by a man of fortune, properly qualified, and properly attended by artiſts, to ſearch into the great variety of matter which this northern region would furniſh, and which would give great light into the hiſtory of a race,ROMANTIC VIEWS. to which half Europe owes its population. Among the views, the mountains of the Seven Siſters in Helgeland , and the amazing rock of Forg-hatten , riſing majeſtically out of the ſea, with its pervious cavern, three thouſand ells long, and a hundred and fifty high, with the ſun at times radiating through it, are the moſt capital. Not to mention the tops of many, broken into imaginary forms of towers and Gothic edifices, forts, and caſtles, with regular walls and baſtions.

HEIGHTS OF MOUNTAINS.I agree with the Comte De Buffon, in thinking that the heights of the Scandinavian mountains, given by Biſhop Pontoppidan, and Mr. Browallius, are extremely exaggerated§. They are by no means to be compared with thoſe of the Helvetian Alps, and leſs ſo with many near the equator. The ſober accounts I have received from my northern friends, ſerve to confirm the opinion, that there is an increaſe of height of mountains from the north towards the equatorial countries. M. Aſcanius, profeſſor of mineralogy at Drontheim, aſſures me, that from ſome late ſurveys, the higheſt in that dioceſe are not above ſix hundred fathoms above the ſurface of the ſea; that the mountains fall to the weſtern ſide from the diſtance of eight or ten Norwegian miles; but to the eaſtern, from that of forty. The higheſt is Dovre-fiael in Drontheim, and Tille in Bergen. They riſe ſlowly, and do not ſtrike the eye like Romſdale-horn, and Hornalen, which ſoar majeſtically from the ſea. In Sweden, only one mountain has been properly meaſured to the ſea. Profeſſor Ritzius of Lund, acquaints me, that Kinnekulle in Weſtro-Gothia is only eight hundred and fifteen Engliſh feet [LXXIII] above the lake Wenern, or nine hundred and thirty-one above the ſea. He adds, the following have been only meaſured to their baſes, or to the next adjacent waters: Aorſkata, a ſolitary mountain of Jaemtland, about four or five Swediſh miles from the higheſt Alps, which ſeparate Norway and Sweden, is ſaid to be ſix thouſand one hundred and ſixty-two Engliſh feet above the neareſt rivers: Swuckuſtol, within the borders of Norway, four thouſand ſix hundred and fifty-eight above lake Famund; and that lake is thought to be two or three thouſand above the ſea: and finally, Sylfiaellen, on the borders of Jaemtland, is three thouſand one hundred and thirty-two feet perpendicular, from the height to the baſe. Pontoppidan gives the mountains of Norway the height of three thouſand fathoms: Browallius thoſe of Sweden two thouſand three hundred and thirty-three, which makes them nearly equal to the higheſt Alps of Savoy, or the ſtill higher ſummits of the Peruvian Andes.

In Finmark, FINMARK. the mountains in ſome places run into the ſea: in others recede far, and leave extenſive plains between their baſes and the water. Their extreme height is on the Fiaell-ryggen, dorſum Alpium, or back of the Alps, a name given to the higheſt courſe of the whole chain: the ſummits of which are clad with eternal ſnow. Theſe are ſkirted by lower mountains, compoſed of hard ſandy earth, deſtitute of every vegetable, except where it is mixed with fragments of rock,PLANTS. on which appear the Saxifrages of ſeveral kinds; Diapenſia Lapponica, Fl. Lapp. No 88; Azalea Procumbens, No 90; the Andromeda Caerulea, No 164; and Hypnoides, No 165, thinly ſcattered. Lower down are vaſt woods of Birch, No 341, a tree of equal uſe to the Laplanders, and the northern Indians of America. On the lower Alps abound the Rein-deer Lichen, No 437, the ſupport of their only cattle; the Dwarf Birch, No 342, the ſeeds of which are the food of the White Grous beneath the ſnow, during the long and rigorous winter; the Arbutus Alpina, No 161; and Arbutu [...] Uva Urſa, No 162; and, finally, the Empetrum Nigrum, or Black Heath Berries, uſed by the Laplanders in their ambroſial diſh the Kappifiàlmas *.

The Scotch Pine, No 346, and Norway Fir, No 347, form the immenſe foreſts of Lapland, aſſociated with the Birch: the Pine affects the dry, the Fir the wet places, and grow to a vaſt ſize; but, being inacceſſible, are loſt to the great uſes of mankind. On their northern ſides they are almoſt naked, and deprived of boughs by the piercing winds; the wandering Laplander remarks this, and uſes it as a compaſs to ſteer by, amidſt theſe wilds of wood. Whole traits are oft-times fired by lightning; then proſtrated by the next ſtorm. The natives make, of the under part of the wood (which acquires vaſt hardneſs by length of time) their ſnow-ſhoes; and [LXXIV] form their bows for ſhooting the ſquirrel with pieces united with glue, made from the ſkin of the perch. Their fragile boats are formed of the thinneſt boards: their ropes of the fibrous roots: and finally, the inner bark, pulverized and baked, is the ſubſtitute for bread to a people deſtined to this rigorous climate. Theſe three trees, the Dwarf Birch, No 341, the Alder, No 340, and not leſs than twenty-three ſpecies of Willows, form the whole of the trees of Lapland. Every other Swediſh tree vaniſhes on approaching that country.

There is a great analogy between the plants of theſe northern Alps, and thoſe of the Scottiſh Highlands. A botaniſt is never ſurprized with meeting ſimilar plants on hills of the ſame height, be their diſtance ever ſo great. It may be remarked, that out of the three hundred and ſeventy-nine perfect plants which grow in Lapland, two hundred and ninety-one are found in Scotland; and of the hundred and fifty cryptogamous, ninety-ſeven are to be met with in North Britain.

QUADRUPEDS OF SCANDINAVIA.The Alps, the woods, and marſhes of the vaſt region of Scandinavia (for I will conſider it in the great) give ſhelter to numbers of quadrupeds unknown to Britain. Thoſe which brave the ſeverity of the extreme north of this country are diſtinguiſhed by the addition of the Lapland name. The Elk, No 3 of this Work, is found in many parts: the Rein, Godde, No 4, is confined to the chillieſt places: the Wolf, Kumpi, No 9, is a peſt to the whole: the Arctic Fox, Njal, No 10, ſkirts the ſhores of all the northern regions: the Croſs Fox, Raude, No 11. β, and the Black Fox, No 11. α. is ſcattered every where: the Lynx, Albos *, No 15, inhabits the thickeſt woods: the Bear, Guouzhia, No 20, and Glutton, Gjeed'k, No 21, have the ſame haunts: the Sable, No 30, which continued in Lapland till the middle of the laſt century, is now extinct: the Leſſer Otter, or Maenk, of the Swedes, is confined to Finland: the Beaver, Mejaeg, No 90, is ſtill found in an unſociable ſtate in ſeveral parts: the Flying Squirrel, p. 124, the Orava of the Finlanders, is found in their foreſts, and thoſe of Lapland: the Lemmus, Lumenik, p. 136, is at ſeaſons the peſt of Norway, iſſuing like a torrent from the Koelen chain: The Walrus, Morſh, No 71, is ſometimes found in the Finmark ſeas: the Harp Seal, Daelja, No 77, the Rough Seal, No 74, the Hooded, Oanide? No 76, and the Little Seal, Hiſt. Quad. ii. No 386, omitted by me in this Work, inhabit [LXXV] the ſame place*. The laſt, ſays Biſhop Gunner, is eaten ſalted, not only by the Laplanders, but by the better ſort of people in Finmark.

Of animals found in Britain, the Fox, Ruopſok, No 11; Pine Martin, Naette, No 27; Ermine, Boaaid , No 26; Weeſel, Seibuſh, No 25; Otter, Zhieonares, No 34; Varying Hare, Njaumel, No 37; Common Squirrel, Orre, p. 122. A; Mouſe, No 60; Field Mouſe, No 61; Water Rat, No 59; and the Shrew, Vandes and Ziebak, No 67, are ſeen as high as Finmark: the Common Seal, Nuorroſh, No 72, and the Great Seal, No 73, alſo frequent the ſhores. All the other quadrupeds, common to Scandinavia, ceaſe in Norway, and ſome even in Sweden. Scandinavia received its animals from the eaſt; but their farther progreſs was prevented by the intervention of the North ſea between that region and Britain. Our extinct ſpecies, the Bear, the Wolf, and the Beaver, came into this iſland, out of Gaul, before our ſeparation from the continent. Some of the northern animals never reached us: neither did the north ever receive the Fallow Deer, Br. Zool. No 7; the Harveſt Mouſe, No 29; the Water Shrew, No 33; nor yet the Brown Rat, No 57, of this Work; notwithſtanding it familiarly goes under the name of the Norway .

This great tract has very few birds which are not found in Britain. BIRDS. We may except the Collared Falcon, p. 222. G; the Scandinavian Owl, p. 237; Rock Crow, p. 252. F; Roller, p. 253; Black Woodpecker, p. 276; Grey-headed, p. 277; Three-toed, No 168; the Rehuſak Grous, p. 316. B; and the Hazel Grous, p. 316. F. The Ortolan, p. 367. D; the Arctic Finch, p. 379. A; and the Lulean F. p. 380. B. The Grey Redſtart Warbler, p. 417. C; the Blue Throat W. p. 417. E; Bogruſh W. p. 419. I; Fig-eater, 419. K; and Kruka W. p. 422. U. All the cloven-footed water-fowl, except the Spoon-bill, p. 441. A; the Crane, p. 453. A; White and Black Storks, p. 455, 456. C. D; Finmark Snipe, p. 471. D; Striated Sandpiper, No 383; Selninger, p. 480. C; Waved, p. 481. E; Shore, p. 481. F; Wood, p. 482. G; Alwargrim Plover, No 398; and Alexandrine, p. 488. B. And all the web-footed kinds, except the Harlequin Duck, No 490, and Lapmark, p. 576. M. are common to both countries; but during ſummer, Fieldfares, Redwings, Woodcocks, and moſt of the water-fowl, retire from Britain into Scandinavia, to breed in ſecurity: and numbers of both land and water-fowl quit this frozen country during winter, compelled, for want of food, to ſeek a milder climate.

[LXXVI]The fiſhes of this extenſive coaſt amount to only one hundred and eleven, and are inferior in number to thoſe of Britain by twenty-eight. The ſpecies of the North Sea which differ from the Britiſh, are not numerous. The depth of water, and the foreſts of marine plants which cover the bottom of the Norwegian ſeas, are aſſuredly the cauſe of the preference of certain kinds, in their reſidence in them. Infinite numbers of rare Vermes, Shells, Lithophytes, and Zoophytes, are found there,CURIOUS FISHES. ſeveral of which, before their diſcovery by Biſhop Pontoppidan, were the ſuppoſed inhabitants of only the more remote ſeas*. Among the fiſhes which have hitherto ſhunned our ſhores, are the Raia Clavata, Muller, No 309; Squalus Spinax, 312; Sq. Centrina, 313, which extends to the Mediterranean; Chimera Monſtroſa, 320, a moſt ſingular fiſh; Sygnathus Typhle, and Aequoreus, 324, 328; the Regalecus Gleſve, 335, Aſcan. Icon. tab. xi.; Gadus Broſme, 341; G. Dypterygius, or Byrke-lange, 346; Blennius Raninus, & Fuſcus, 359, 360; Echeneis Remora, 361; Coryphaena Novacula, & Rupeſtris, 362, 363; Gobius Jozo, 365; Plearonectes Cynogloſſus, Limanda, & Linguatula, 372, 375, 377; Sparus Erythrinus, 380; Labrus Suillus, 381; Perca Norvegica, and Lucio-perca, 390, 391; Scomber Pelagicus, 398; Silurus Aſotus, 404; Clupea Villoſa, 425.

THOSE OF USE.Theſe are not the fiſhes of general uſe. Providence hath, in theſe parts, beſtowed with munificence the ſpecies which contribute to the ſupport of mankind; and made thereby the kingdom of Norway a coaſt of hardy fiſhermen. The chain of iſlands, and the ſhores, are the populous parts. It is the ſea which yields them a harveſt; and near to it ſtand all the capital towns: the ſtaples of the produce of the ocean on one hand, and of the more thinly inhabited mountains on the other. The farther you advance inland, the leſs numerous is the race of man.

The Herring,HERRINGS. the Cod, the Ling, and the Salmon, are the maritime wealth of this country. The Herring has two emigrations into this ſea: the firſt is from Chriſtmas to Candlemas, when a large ſpecies arrives, preceded by two ſpecies of Whales, who, by inſtinct, wait its coming. The fiſhermen poſt themſelves on ſome high cliff, impatiently waiting for the cetaceous fiſh, the harbingers of the others. They look for them at the moon Torre, or the firſt new one after Chriſtmas, and the moon Gio, which immediately follows.

Theſe Herrings frequent the great ſand-banks, where they depoſit their ſpawn. They are followed by the Spring Herrings, a leſſer fiſh, which approach much nearer to the ſhore; after which arrive the Summer Herring, which almoſt literally fill every creek: the whole fiſhery is of immenſe profit. From January to October, [LXXVII] 1752, were exported, from Bergen alone, eleven thouſand and thirteen laſts; and it was expected that as many more would be ſhipped off before the expiration of the year. The Herrings which viſit this coaſt are only part of the vaſt northern army which annually quits the great deeps, and gives wealth and food to numbers of European nations.

THE Cod yields another fiſhery of great profit.COD. They firſt arrive immediately after the earlieſt Herrings, and grow ſo pampered with their fry, that they reject a bait; and are taken in vaſt nets, which are ſet down in fifty or ſeventy fathom water, and taken up every twenty-four hours, with four or five hundred great fiſh entangled in them. As the Herrings retire, the Cod grows hungry; and after that is taken with hook and line, baited with Herring. In more advanced ſeaſon, other varieties of Cod arrive, and are taken, in common with Turbot and other fiſh, with long lines, to which two hundred ſhort lines with hooks are faſtened: the whole is ſunk to the bottom; its place is marked by a buoy faſtened to it by another line of fit length. The extent of the Cod-fiſhery may be judged of on hearing that 40,000 tonder, of four buſhels each, of French and Spaniſh ſalt, are annually imported into Bergen for that purpoſe only.

The Ling is taken on the great ſand-bank during ſummer, by hook and line,LING. and, being a fiſh noted for being capable of long preſervation, is much ſought after for diſtant voyages.

The Salmon, SALMON. a moſt univerſal northern fiſh, arrive in the Norwegian rivers, and vaſt quanties are ſent, ſmoke-dried or pickled, into various countries.

The praefecture of Nordland, NORDLAND. is the fartheſt part of the kingdom of Norway. In it is the diſtrict of Helgeland, remarkable for that uncommon genius, Octher, OF OCTHER. or Ohthere, who, in a frozen climate, and ſo early as the ninth century, did ſhew a paſſion for diſcovery, equal perhaps with that of the preſent. His country was at that time the laſt in the north which had the leſt tincture of humanity. In the year 890 he was attracted by the ſame of our renowned ALFRED. He viſited his court, and related to him his voyages. He told the monarch that he was determined to prove if there was any land beyond the deſerts which bounded his country. It appears that he ſailed due north, and left, on his ſtarboard ſide, a waſte, the preſent Finmark, occaſionally frequented by the Finnas, or wandering Laplanders, for the ſake of fiſhing and fowling. He went as far as the Whale-fiſhers uſually ventured: a proof that the men of Norway practiſed that fiſhery many centuries before the Engliſh. He doubled the North Cape, and entered the Cwen Sea, or White Sea, and even anchored in the mouth of the Dwina. He was to theſe parts what Columbus was to America: but the knowlege of this country was loſt for centuries after the days of Octher. He mentioned the Seride Finnas, who lived to the north-weſt of [LXXVIII] the Cwen Sea, and who wore ſnow-ſhoes. The country about the Dwina was well inhabited by a people called Beormas, far more civilized than the Finnas. The map attending ALFRED's Oroſius places them in the country of the Samoieds, a race at preſent as uncultivated as mankind can be: we therefore muſt ſuppoſe thoſe Beormas to have been Ruſſians. Octher ſays, that in this ſea he met with Horſe-Whales (Walruſes) and produced to the prince ſpecimens of their great teeth, and of thong-ropes made of their ſkins; a mark of his attention to every thing curious which occurred to him*.

NORWEGIANS A FINE RACE.I muſt not leave Norway without notice of its chief of animals, Man. Scandinavia, in the courſe of population, received its inhabitants by colonies of hardy Scythians, who, under the name of Sarmatians, extended themſelves to the coaſts of the Baltic. In after-times their virtue was exalted by the arrival of their countryman, Odin, and the heroes he ſettled in every part of the country. The ſeverity of the climate has not checked the growth, or diſtorted the human form. MAN here is tall, robuſt, of juſt ſymmetry in limbs, and ſhews ſtrongly the human face divine. Their hair is light: their eyes light grey. The male peaſants of the mountains are hairy on their breaſts as Bears, and not leſs hardy: active in body: clear and intelligent in their minds.LONGEVITY. Theirs certainly is length of days; for out of ſix thouſand nine hundred and twenty-nine, who died in 1761, in the dioceſe of Chriſtiana, three hundred and ninety-four lived to the age of nintey; ſixty-three to that of a hundred; and ſeven to that of a hundred and one. The Norwegians juſtly hold themſelves of high value; and ſlightingly call their fellow-ſubjects, the the Danes, Jutes . The Danes tacitly acknowlege the ſuperiority, by compoſing almoſt their whole army out of theſe deſcendants of the all-conquering Normans.

I ſhall here ſupply an omiſſion in my account of the Scandinavian antiquities, p. xxxvi. by mentioning the famous tomb, about ſeven Swediſh yards long and two broad, found at Kivike, a pariſh of Schonen in Sweden, in the centre of a vaſt tumulus of round ſtones. It was oblong, and conſiſted of ſeveral flat ſtones, the inſide of which is carved with figures of men and animals, and the weapons of the age, axes and ſpears heads. A figure is placed in a triumphal car; cornets ſeem ſounding: captives with their hands bound behind, guarded by armed men; and figures, ſuppoſed to be female, form part of the conquered people. It is ſuppoſed that the Roman fleet made an accidental deſcent here, had a ſucceſsful ſkirmiſh with the natives, might have loſt their leader, and left this mark of their victory amidſt the [LXXIX] barbarous conquered. The tomb had been broken open by the country people, and whatſoever it might have contained was ſtolen away and loſt*.

Within the Arctic circle, begins Finmark, FINMARK. a narrow tract, which winds about the ſhores eaſtwards, and bends into the White Sea: a country divided between Norway and Ruſſia. The view from the ſea is a flat, bounded, a little inland, by a chain of lofty mountains covered with ſnow. The depth of water off the ſhore is from a hundred to a hundred and fifty fathoms. The inhabitants quit their hovels in winter, and return to them in the ſummer: and, in the middle of that ſeaſon, even the Alpine Laplanders viſit theſe parts for the ſake of fiſhing; and, like the antient Scythians, remove with their tents, their herds, and furniture, and return to their mountains in autumn. Some of them, from living near the ſea, have long been called Siae Finni, and Soe Lappernes.

In this country begins inſtantly a new race of men. Their ſtature is from four to four feet and a half: their hair ſhort, black, and coarſe: eyes tranſverſely narrow: irides black: their heads great: cheek-bones high: mouth wide: lips thick: their cheſts broad: waiſts ſlender: ſkin ſwarthy: ſhanks ſpindle. From uſe, they run up rocks like goats, and ſwarm trees like ſquirrels: are ſo ſtrong in their arms that they can draw a bow which a ſtout Norwegian can hardly bend; yet lazy even to torpidity, when not incited by neceſſity; and puſillanimous and nervous to an hyſterical degree. With a few variations, and very few exceptions, are the inhabitants of all the Arctic coaſts of Europe, Aſia, and America. They are nearly a diſtinct ſpecies in minds and bodies, and not to be derived from the adjacent nations, or any of their better-proportioned neighbors.

The ſeas and rivers of Finmark abound with fiſh. The Alten of Weſt Finmark, SALMON FISHERIES. after a gentle courſe through mountains and foreſts, forms a noble cataract, which tumbles down an immenſe rock into a fine baſon, the receptacle of numbers of veſſels which reſort here to fiſh or traffic for Salmon§. The Tana, and the Kola of the extreme north ſwarm with them. In the Alten they are taken by the natives in weirs built after the Norwegian model; and form, with the merchants of Bergen, a great article of commerce. Theſe fiſheries are far from recent: that on the Kola was noted above two centuries ago for the vaſt concourſe of Engliſh and Dutch, for the ſake of the fiſh-oil and Salmon.

The moſt northern fortreſs in the world, and of unknown antiquity††, is Wardhuys, WARDHUYS. [LXXX] ſituated in a good harbour, in the iſle of Wardoe, at the extremity of Finmark; probably built for the protection of the fiſhing trade, the only object it could have in this remote place.

SIR HUGH WILLOUGHBY.A little farther eaſtward, in Muſcovitiſh Finmark, is Arzina, noted for the ſad fate of that gallant gentleman, Sir Hugh Willoughby, who, in 1553, commanded the firſt voyage on the diſcovery by ſea of Muſcovia, by the north-eaſt; a country at that time ſcarcely known to the reſt of Europe. He unfortunately loſt his paſſage, was driven by tempeſts into this port, where he and all his crew were found the following year frozen to death. His more fortunate conſort, Richard Chancellor captain and pilot major, purſued his voyage, and renewed the diſcovery of the White Sea, or Bay of St. Nicholas; a place totally forgotten ſince the days of Octher. The circumſtances attending his arrival, exactly reſemble thoſe of the firſt diſcoverers of America. He admired the barbarity of the Ruſſian inhabitants: they in return were in amaze at the ſize of his ſhip: they fell down and would have kiſſed his feet; and when they left him ſpread abroad the arrival of 'a ſtrange nation, of ſingular gentleneſſe and courteſie*.' He viſited in ſledges the court of Baſilowitz II. then at Moſcow, and layed the foundation of immenſe commerce to this country for a ſeries of years, even to the remote and unthought-of Perſia.

I ſhall take my departure from the extreme north of the continent of Europe, or rather from its ſhattered fragments, the iſle of Maggeroe, and other iſlands, which lie off the coaſt,NORTH CAPE. in lat. 71. 33. At the remote end of Maggeroe is the North Cape, high and flat at top, or what the ſailors call Table-land . Theſe are but the continuation of the great chain of mountains which divides Scandinavia, and ſinks and riſes through the ocean, in different places, to the Seven Siſters, in about lat. 80. 30, the neareſt land to the pole which we are acquainted with.

Its firſt appearance above water, from this group, is at Cherie Iſland, CHERIE ISLAND. in lat. 74. 30. a moſt ſolitary ſpot, rather more than midway between the North Cape and Spitzbergen, or about a hundred and fifty miles from the latter. Its figure is nearly round: its ſurface riſes into lofty mountanous ſummits, craggy, and covered with perpetual ſnow: one of them is truly called Mount Miſery. The horror of this iſle to the firſt diſcoverers muſt have been unſpeakable. The proſpect dreary, black, where not hid with ſnow, and broken into a thouſand precipices. No ſounds but of the daſhing of the waves, the craſhing colliſion of floating ice, the diſcordant notes of myriads of ſea-fowl, the yelping of Arctic Foxes, the ſnorting of the Walruſes, or the roaring of the Polar Bears.

[LXXXI]This iſland was probably diſcovered by Stephen Bennet in 1603*, employed by Alderman Cherie, in honor of whom the place was named. The anchorage near it is twenty and thirty fathoms. He found there the tooth of a Walrus, but ſaw none of the animals, their ſeaſon here being paſt: this was the 17th of Auguſt. Encouraged by the hopes of profit, Bennet made a ſecond voyage the next year, and arrived at the iſland the 9th of July; WALRUSES. when he found the Walruſes lying huddled on one another, a thouſand in a heap. For want of experience, he killed only a few; but in ſucceeding voyages the adventurers killed, in 1606, in ſix hours time, ſeven or eight hundred; in 1608, nine hundred or a thouſand in ſeven hours; and in 1610, above ſeven hundred. The profit, in the teeth, oil, and ſkins, was very conſiderable; but the ſlaughter made among the animals frightened the ſurvivors away, ſo that the benefit of the buſineſs was loſt, and the iſland no more frequented. But from this deficiency originated the commencement of the Whale-fiſhery by the Engliſh.

It is remarkable that this iſland produces excellent coals;COALS. yet none are known nearer than the dioceſe of Aggerhuys, in the ſouth of Norway, and there in very ſmall quantities. Lead ore is alſo found,LEAD. both in Cherie Iſland and a little one adjacent, called Gull Iſland .

About a hundred and fifty miles almoſt due north, is South Cape, north lat. 76. 30, the extreme ſouthern point of Spitzbergen, SPITZBERGEN. the largeſt of the group of frozen iſlands which go under that name, or New Groenland. From this to Verlegan-hook, north lat. 80. 7, the northern extremity, is above three hundred miles; and the greateſt breadth of the group is from Hackluyt's Headland to the extreme eaſt point of North Eaſtland, comprizing from 9. to near 24. eaſt longitude. The ſhores are ragged and indented. A very deep bay runs into the eaſt ſide from ſouth to north; and a large trifurcated one from north to ſouth. Stat's Forland is a large iſland rent from the ſouthern part of the eaſt ſide. North Eaſtland is divided from the north-eaſt ſide by the Waygat and Hinlopen ſtraits, uſually blocked up with ice, and ſo ſhallow as to be, in one part, only three fathoms deep§. The long iſle of King Charles lies parallel to the weſt ſide. At the ſouthern end is Black Point; the coaſt high, black, and inacceſſible; in parts ſeeming ſoaring above the clouds; and the interjacent vallies filled with ice and ſnow. Fair Foreland, or Vogel-hook, is the northern headland, made by ſailors. And due north of it, at the weſtern point of Spitzbergen, is the ſmall lofty iſle of Hackluyt's Headland, another object of the mariners ſearch.

To the north of the great group is Moffen's Iſle, MOFFEN'S ISLE. in lat. 80, oppoſite to the mouth of Leifde bay. This iſland is very low, and ſuſpected to be a new creation, [LXXXII] by the meeting of the ſtreams from the great ocean, ruſhing along the weſt ſide of Spitzbergen, and through the Waygat, and forcing up the gravelly bottom of this ſhallow part, where the lead touches the bottom at from two to five fathoms water, at half a mile from its weſtern ſide*.

LOW ISLAND.To the eaſtward of this is another low iſland, almoſt oppoſite to the mouth of the Waygat: it is remarkable for being part of the Baſaltic chain,BASALTIC. which appears in ſo many places in the northern hemiſphere. The columns were from eighteen to thirty inches in diameter, moſtly hexagonal, and formed a moſt convenient pavement.PLANTS. The middle of the iſle was covered with vegetables, Moſſes, Sorel, Scurvy Graſs,ANIMALS. and Ranunculuſes in bloom on July 30th. Of quadrupeds, the Reindeer fattened here into excellent veniſon; the Arctic Fox; and a ſmall animal larger than a Weeſel, with ſhort ears, long tail, and ſpotted with black and white, were ſeen.BIRDS. Small Snipes, like Jack Snipes; Ducks, then hatching; and Wild Geeſe feeding, helped to animate this dreary ſcene.

The beach was formed of an antient aggregate of ſand, whale-bones, and old timber, or drift-wood.DRIFT-WOOD. Fir-trees ſeventy feet long, ſome torn up by the roots, others freſh from the axe, and marked with it into twelve feet lengths, lay confuſedly ſixteen or eighteen feet above the level of the ſea, intermixed with pipe-ſtaves, and wood faſhioned for uſe; all brought into this elevated ſituation by the ſwell of the furious ſurges.

The appearance of drift-wood is very frequent in many parts of theſe high latitudes: in the ſeas of Greenland, in Davis's ſtreights, and in thoſe of Hudſon; and again on the coaſts of Nova Zemlja. I have only two places from whence I can derive the quantity of floating timber which appears on the coaſt of Nova Zemlja and theſe iſlands: the firſt is from the banks of the Oby, and perhaps other great rivers, which pour out their waters into the Frozen ocean. In the ſpring, at the breaking up of the ice, vaſt inundations ſpread over the land, and ſweep away whole foreſts, with the aid of the vaſt fragments of ice; theſe are carried off, rooted up, and appear entire in various places. Such as are found marked into lengths, together with pipe-ſtaves, and other faſhioned woods, are ſwept by the Norwegian floods out of the rivers, on the breaking of a lentze , a misfortune which ſometimes happens, to the bankruptcy of multitudes of timber-merchants. At ſuch times not only the trees which are floating down the torrents, but the ſaw-mills, and all other places in which buſineſs is carried on, undergo the ſame calamity; and the timber, in whatſoever form it happens to be, is forced into the ocean, and conveyed by tides or tempeſts to the moſt diſtant parts of the north.

[LXXXIII]Let no one be ſtaggered at the remoteneſs of the voyage: I have before ſhewn [...]nſtances, but from a contrary courſe, from weſt to eaſt. Part of the maſts of the Tilbury, burnt at Jamaica, was taken up on the weſtern coaſt of Scotland; and multitudes of ſeed or fruits of the ſame iſland, and other hot parts of America, are annually driven on ſhore, not only on the weſtern ſide of Scotland P. 21. of this Work. , but even on thoſe of more diſtant Norway , and Iceland.

The iſlands of the Seven Siſters, laſt of known land, lie due north from North-Eaſtland: the extreme point of the moſt remote is in lat. 80. 42. They are all high primaeval iſles: from a high mountain on the fartheſt, the hardy navigators of 1773 had a ſight of ten or twelve leagues of ſmooth unbroken ice to the eaſt and north-eaſt, bounded only by the horizon; and to the ſouth-eaſt certain land laid down in the Dutch maps. Midway between theſe iſlands and North-Eaſtland, Lord Mulgrave, VOYAGE BY LORD MULGRAVE. IN 1773. after every effort which the moſt finiſhed ſeaman could make to accompliſh the end of his voyage, was caught in the ice, and was near experiencing the unhappy fate of the gallant Engliſhman, Sir Hugh Willoughby, who was frozen in 1553, with all his crew, in his unhappy expedition.

The ſcene, diveſted of the horror from the eventful expectation of change, was the moſt beautiful and pictureſque:—Two large ſhips becalmed in a vaſt baſon, ſurrounded on all ſides by iſlands of various forms: the weather clear: the ſun gilding the circumambient ice, which was low, ſmooth, and even; covered with ſnow, excepting where the pools of water on part of the ſurface appeared cryſtalline with the young ice: the ſmall ſpace of ſea they were confined in perfectly ſmooth. After fruitleſs attempts to force a way through the fields of ice, their limits were perpetually contracted by its cloſing; till at length it beſet each veſſel till they became immoveably fixed§. The ſmooth extent of ſurface was ſoon loſt: the preſſure of the pieces of ice, by the violence of the ſwell, cauſed them to pack; fragment roſe upon fragment, till they were in many places higher than the main-yard. The movements of the ſhips were tremendous and involuntary, in conjunction with the ſurrounding ice, actuated by the currents. The water ſhoaled to fourteen fathoms. The grounding of the ice or of the ſhips would have been equally fatal: the force of the ice might have cruſhed them to atoms, or have lifted them out of the water and overſet them, or have left them ſuſpended on the ſummits of the pieces of ice at a tremendous height, expoſed to the fury of the winds, or to the riſque of being daſhed to pieces by the failure of their frozen dock. An [LXXXIV] attempt was made to cut a paſſage through the ice; after a perſeverance worthy of Britons, it proved fruitleſs. The commander, at all times maſter of himſelf, directed the boats to be made ready to be hauled over the ice, till they arrived at navigable water (a taſk alone of ſeven days) and in them to make their voyage to England. The boats were drawn progreſſively three whole days*. At length a wind ſprung up, the ice ſeparated ſufficiently to yield to the preſſure of the full-ſailed ſhips, which, after laboring againſt the reſiſting fields of ice, arrived on the 10th of Auguſt in the harbor of Smeeringberg, at the weſt end of Spitzbergen, between it and Hackluyt's Headland.

It was the hard fortune of Lord Mulgrave, at this ſeaſon, to meet with one of thoſe amazing ſhoals of ice which cover, at times, theſe ſeas, for multitudes of leagues. He made the fulleſt trial, from long. 2 to 21 eaſt, and from about lat. 80. 40, as low as about 78. 30, oppoſed by a face of ice without the leaſt opening, and with all the appearance of a ſolid wall. It is well known, that the coaſts of Sibiria are, after a northern tempeſt, rendered inacceſſible for a vaſt extent, by the polar ice being ſet in motion. It is as well known, that a ſtrong ſouthern wind will again drive them to their former ſeats, and make the ſhores of the Frozen ocean as clear as the equatorial ſeas. A farther diſcovery on this ſide was denied to the noble navigator. His misfortune will for ever redound to his honor, as it proved his ſpirit, his perſeverance, and a ſoul fertile in expedients among the greateſt difficulties!

That navigators have gone into higher latitudes I cannot deny: the authenticated inſtances only ſhew their accidental good fortune, in having the ice driven towards the pole, and in making a retreat before they were enveloped in the returning ice. The Ruſſians, under vice-admiral Tſhitſhaghef, within theſe very few years, made an attempt to ſail to the pole by the eaſtern ſide of Spitzbergen; but after ſuffering great hardſhips, returned without effecting any diſcovery. Curioſity has been amply ſatisfied: and I believe we may reſt fully content with the common paſſage to India, on the conviction of this tract being totally impracticable.

ICE.The forms aſſumed by the ice in this chilling climate, are extremely pleaſing to even the moſt incurious eye. The ſurface of that which is congealed from the ſea-water (for I muſt allow it two origins) is flat and even, hard, opake, reſembling white ſugar, and incapable of being ſlid on, like the Britiſh ice. The greater pieces, or fields, are many leagues in length: the leſſer, are the meadows [LXXXV] of the Seals, on which thoſe animals at times frolic by hundreds. The motion of the leſſer pieces is as rapid as the currents: the greater, which are ſometimes two hundred leagues long, and ſixty or eighty broad*, move ſlow and majeſtically; often fix for a time, immoveable by the power of the ocean, and then produce near the horizon that bright white appearance, called by manners the blink of the ice . The approximation of two great fields produces a moſt ſingular phaenomenon; it forces the leſſer (if the term can be applied to pieces of ſeveral acres ſquare) out of the water, and adds them to their ſurface: a ſecond, and often a third ſucceeds; ſo that the whole forms an aggregate of a tremendous height. Theſe float in the ſea like ſo many rugged mountains, and are ſometimes five or ſix hundred yards thick; but the far greater part is concealed beneath the water. Theſe are continually encreaſed in height by the freezing of the ſpray of the ſea, or of the melting of the ſnow, which falls on them. Thoſe which remain in this frozen climate, receive continual growth; others are gradually wafted by the northern winds into ſouthern latitudes, and melt by degrees, by the heat of the ſun, till they waſte away, or diſappear in the boundleſs element.

The colliſion of the great fields of ice, in high latitudes, is often attended with a noiſe that for a time takes away the ſenſe of hearing any thing elſe; and the leſſer with a grinding of unſpeakable horror.

The water which daſhes againſt the mountanous ice freezes into an infinite variety of forms; and gives the voyager ideal towns, ſtreets, churches, ſteeples, and every ſhape which imagination can frame.

The Icebergs, ICEBERGS. or Glacieres of the north-eaſt of Spitzbergen, are among the capital wonders of the country; they are ſeven in number, but at conſiderable diſtances from each other: each fills the vallies for tracts unknown, in a region totally inacceſſible in the internal parts. The glacieres of Switzerland ſeem contemptible to theſe; but preſent often a ſimilar front into ſome lower valley. The laſt exhibits over the ſea a front three hundred feet high, emulating the emerald in color: cataracts of melted ſnow precipitate down various parts, and black ſpiring mountains, ſtreaked with white, bound the ſides, and riſe crag above crag, as far as eye can reach in the back, ground§.

At times immenſe fragments break off, and tumble into the water, with a moſt alarming daſhing. A piece of this vivid green ſubſtance has fallen, and grounded in twenty-four fathoms water, and ſpired above the ſurface fifty feet**. Similar [LXXXVI] icebergs are frequent in all the Arctic regions; and to their lapſes is owing [...] ſolid mountanous ice which infeſts thoſe ſeas.

Froſt ſports alſo with theſe icebergs, and gives them majeſtic as well as other moſt ſingular forms. Maſſes have been ſeen, aſſuming the ſhape of a Gothic church, with arched windows and doors, and all the rich tracery of that ſtyle, compoſed o [...] what an Arabian tale would ſcarcely dare to relate, of cryſtal of the richeſt ſapphirine blue: tables with one or more feet; and often immenſe flat-roofed temples, like thoſe of Luxxor on the Nile, ſupported by round tranſparent columns of caerulean hue, float by the aſtoniſhed ſpectator*.

Theſe icebergs are the creation of ages, and receive annually additional height by the falling of ſnows and of rain, which often inſtantly freezes, and more than repairs the loſs by the influence of the melting ſun.

SNOW.The ſnow of theſe high latitudes is as ſingular as the ice. It is firſt ſmall and hard as the fineſt ſand; changes its form to that of an hexagonal ſhield, into the ſhape of needles, croſſes, cinquefoils, and ſtars, plain and with ſerrated rays. Their forms depend on the diſpoſition of the atmoſphere; and in calm weather it coaleſces, and falls in cluſters§.

SEASONS.Thunder and lightning are unknown here. The air in ſummer is generally clear; but the ſky loaden with hard white clouds. The one night of this dreadful country begins about October 20th, O. S.; the ſun then ſets, and never appears till about the 3d of February : a glimmering indeed continues ſome weeks after its ſetting: then ſucceed clouds and thick darkneſs, broken by the light of the moon, which is luminous as that in England, and ſhines without intermiſſion during the long night. Such alſo is the caſe in Nova Zemlja **. The cold, according to the Engliſh proverb, ſtrengthens with the new year; and the ſun is uſhered in with unuſual ſeverity of froſt. The ſplendor of that luminary on the ſnowy ſummits of the mountains was the moſt glorious of ſights to the ſingle party who ſurvived to relate the account.BEARS. The Bears ſtalk forth at the ſame time from their dens,FOXES. attended by their young cubs. By the beginning of March, the chearful light grows ſtrong:FOWLS. the Arctic Foxes leave their holes, and the ſea-fowls reſort in great multitudes to their breeding-places††.

[LXXXVII]The ſun, in the height of ſummer, has at times heat enough to melt the tar on the decks of ſhips. It ſets no more after the third of May, DAY AND NIGHT. O. S. Diſtinction of day and night is loſt; unleſs it be fact what Fr. Marten alleges, that during the ſummer night of theſe countries, the ſun appears with all the faintneſs of the moon*. This is denied by Lord Mulgrave . From Auguſt the power of the ſun declines, it ſets faſt; in September day is hardly diſtinguiſhable; and by the middle of October takes a long leave of this country; the bays become frozen; and winter reigns triumphant.

Nature, in the formation of theſe iſlands,MOUNTAINS. preſerves the ſame rule which ſhe does in other places: the higheſt mountains are on the weſtern ſide; and they gradually lower to the eaſt. The altitude of the moſt lofty which has been taken by Lord Mulgrave, ſeems to have been one a little to the north of Black Point, which was found by the megameter to be fifteen hundred and three yards: that of a hill on the little iſle, the Norways, a ſmall diſtance to the north-eaſt of Spitzbergen, was two thouſand four hundred feet: one on Vogel Sang, ſixteen hundred and fifty; another, on the iſle near Cloven Cliff, in about lat. 80, eight hundred and ſixty-five; a third on that near Cook's Hole, ſeven hundred and eleven; and one on Hackluyt's Iſland, only three hundred and twenty-one§. Theſe are the moſt northern lands which ever were meaſured; and the experiments favor the ſyſtem of the decreaſe of the heights of the mountains toward the poles.

Earth and ſoil are denied to thoſe dreadful regions: their compoſition is ſtone, formed by the ſublime hand of Almighty Power; not frittered into ſegments by fiſſures, tranſverſe or perpendicular, but at once caſt into one immenſe and ſolid maſs; a mountain is but a ſingle ſtone throughout, deſtitute of fiſſures, except in places cracked by the reſiſtleſs power of froſt, which often cauſes lapſes, attended with a noiſe like thunder, ſcattering over their baſes rude and extenſive ruins. The ſtone is granite, moſtly grey and black; ſome red, white, and yellow. I ſtrongly ſuſpect, that veins of iron are intermixed; for the meltings of the ſnow tinge the rocks frequently with a ferruginous ochre. A potter's clay and a gypſum are to be met with on the eaſtern part of the iſlands.

The vallies,VALLIES. or rather glens, of this country, are filled with eternal ice or ſnow; are totally inacceſſible, and known only by the divided courſe of the mountains, or where they terminate in the ſea in form of a glaciere. No ſtreams water theſe dreary bottoms; even ſprings are denied; and it is to the periodical [LXXXVIII] cataracts of melted ſnow of the ſhort ſummer, or to the pools in the middle of the fields of ice, to which the mariners are indebted for freſh water.

HARBOURS.The harbours on the weſt ſide are frequent; penetrate deep into the iſland of Spitzbergen; and are the only channels by which the ſlight knowlege of the interior parts is attained. North Harbour is a ſcene of pictureſque horror, bounded by black craggy Alps, ſtreaked with ſnow; the narrow entrance divided by an iſland; and at ſeaſons affording a land-locked ſhelter to multitudes of ſhips.

TIDE AND SEA.The tide at the Vogel Sang flows only four feet, and the flood appears to come from the ſouth. The depth of the ſea is very irregular: near the ſhore it is generally ſhallow: off Low Iſland only from ten to twenty fathoms; yet ſuddenly deepens to a hundred and ſeventeen: off Cloven Cliff from fourteen to twenty-eight, and deepens to two hundred. The ſhallows are uſually on rock; the great depths on ſoft mud: the former I look on as ſubmarine iſlands; but, from the ſmall number of fiſh, the bottoms muſt be univerſally barren.

SOIL!The grit worn from the mountains by the power of the winds, or attrition of cataracts of melted ſnow, is the only thing which reſembles ſoil, and is the bed for the few vegetables found here. This indeed is aſſiſted by the putrefied lichens of the rocks, and the dung of birds, brought down by the ſame means.

PLANTS.Even here Flora deigns to make a ſhort viſit, and ſcatter over the baſes of the hills a ſcanty ſtock. Her efforts never riſe beyond a few humble herbs, which ſhoot, flower, and ſeed, in the ſhort warmth of June and July; then wither into reſt till the ſucceeding year.—Let me here weave a ſlender garland from the lap of the goddeſs, of ſuch, and perhaps all, which ſhe hath beſtowed on a country ſo repugnant to her bounty. Let the ſalubrious Scurvy Graſs, the reſource of diſtempered ſeamen, be remarked as providentially moſt abundant in the compoſition.

Let me firſt mention its only tree, the Salix Herbacea, or Dwarf Willow, deſcribed by Marten, p. 65, Phips, 202, which ſeldom exceeds two inches in height, yet has a juſt title to the name. The plants are, a new ſpecies of Graſs, now named Agroſtis Algida: Tillaea Aquatica, Sp. Pl. 186. Fl. Suec. 156: Juncus Campeſtris, Fl. Sc. i. 186: Sibbaldia Procumbens? Fl. Lap. 111.; Marten's Spitz. tab. H. fig. b: Polygonum Viviparum, Fl. Lap. 152; Marten's Spitz. tab. I. fig. a: Saxifraga Oppoſitafolia, Fl. Lap. 179, 222: Sax. Cernua, Sp. Pl. i. 577; Fl. Lap. 172: Sax. Rivularis, Sp. Pl. 577; Fl. Lap. 174: Sax. Caeſpitoſa, Sp. Pl. 578; Fl. Suec. 376: Sedum Annuum? Sp. Pl. 620; Marten's Spitz. tab. F. fig. c. Ceraſtium Alpinum, Sp. Pl. 628; Fl. Lap. 192: Ranunculus Sulphureus, Phips Voy. 202; Mart. Spitz. 58: R. Lapponicus, Fl. Lap. 461, 503: R. Nivalis? 232; Mart. Spitz. tab. F. fig. a: Cochlearia Danica, Sp. Pl. 903; Fl. Suec. 578, 579: [LXXXIX] Cochl. Groenlandica, Sp. Pl. 904: Polytrichum commune, Fl. Lap. 395: Bryum Hypnoides, Fl. Lap. 396: Bryum Trichoides? Dill. 391; Muſc. tab. 50, fig. 61: Bryum Hypnoides? Dill. Muſc. 394, tab. 50, fig. 64, C: Hypnum Aduncum, Sp. Pl. 1592; Fl. Succ. 879, 1025: Jungermannia Julacea, Sp. Pl. 1601: Jung. like the Lichenaſtrum Ramoſius, fol. trif. Dill. Muſc. 489, tab. 70, fig. 15: Lichen Ericetorum, Fl. Lap. 936, 1068: L. Iſlandicus, 959, 1085: L. Nivalis, 446: L. Caninus, 441: L. Polyrhizos, Sp. Pl. 1618; Fl. Suec. 1108: L. Pyxidatus, Fl. Lap. 428: L. Cornutus, 434: L. Rangiferinus, 437: L. Globiſerus, Lin. Mantiſſ. 133: L. Paſchalis, Fl. Lap. 439: L. Chalybeiformis, Sp. Pl. 1623; Fl. Suec. 988, 1127: and the Fucus Saccharinus? Fl. Lap. 460; Mart. Spitz. tab. F. fig. 6.

It is matter of curioſity to trace the decreaſe of vegetables from our own iſland to this ſpot, where ſo few are to be found. They decreaſe with the numbers of herbivorous animals, and the wants of mankind. The following catalogue may not be quite juſt, but is probably pretty near the truth:

 Perfect.Imperfect.Total.
England has1,1245901,714
Scotland8044281,232
The Orknies354144498
Sweden9333661,299
Lapland379155534
Iceland309233542

Thoſe of Spitzbergen are given above.

The three terreſtrial quadrupeds of theſe iſlands are confined here without poſſibility of migration.QUADRUPEDS. The Polar Bears paſs the greateſt part of the winter in a torpid ſtate: appear in numbers at the firſt return of the ſun, when, probably, they take to the ice, in queſt of their prey, Seals, or dead Whales.

It is difficult to account for the means which the Foxes find for ſupport, as the iſland is deſtitute of birds during the whole winter; and, the bays being totally frozen up, they can find no ſubſiſtence from the ſea. Perhaps they lay up proviſion for winter, on which they ſubſiſt till the arrival of the birds in March; at which ſeaſon they have been obſerved firſt to quit their holes, and appear in multitudes*. The Rein Deer have at all times their favorite lichen, which they can readily get at, by help of their palmated horns.

WALRUSES and Seals are found in great abundance; the latter are often the object of chace, for the ſake both of oil and ſkins: the Ruſſians make voyages on [XC] purpoſe. In 1743, four unhappy mariners of that nation were accidentally left on ſhore on North Eaſtland, called by the Ruſſians Maloy Broun. Here three (the fourth died in the laſt year) lived till Auguſt 15th 1749; when they were providentially relieved by the arrival of a ſhip, after paſſing ſix years, realizing in ingenious contrivances the celebrated Engliſh fable of Robinſon Cruſoe *.

In the year 1633 ſeven Dutch ſailors were left voluntarily on the weſtern part of Spitzbergen, to paſs the winter, and form their remarks. They were furniſhed with medicines, and every requiſite to preſerve life; but every one periſhed by the effects of the ſcurvy. In the next year, ſeven other unhappy men devoted themſelves, and died in the ſame manner. Of the firſt ſet, it appeared by his journal, that the laſt was alive the 30th of April 1634; of the ſecond, the life of the laſt ſurvivor did not continue far beyond the 28th of February 1635. Yet eight Engliſhmen, left in 1630 in the ſame country, by accident, and unprovided with every thing, framed themſelves a hut from ſome old materials, and were found by the returning ſhips, on May 28th 1631, in good health. Thus Ruſſian hardineſs and Britiſh ſpirit braved a climate, which the phlegmatic conſtitution of a Dutchman could not reſiſt.

BIRDS.To meet with the Snow Bunting, No 222, a bird whoſe bill, in common with the reſt of that genus, is calculated for granivorous life, is a kind of miracle. The country has a very ſcanty proviſion of ſeeds; the earth yields no worms, the air no inſects; yet theſe birds are ſeen in flocks innumerable, and that chiefly on the ice around Spitzbergen: as it breeds early, poſſibly the old and young may have quitted the land, and collected on the ice at the time of the arrival of the ſhips.

Of cloven-footed water-fowl, the Purre, No 390, alone is ſeen here.

Of web-footed, the Puffin Auk, No 427; the Razor Bill, No 425; the Little Auk, No 429; the Fooliſh Guillemot, No 436; the Black Guillemot, No 437; the Northern Diver, No 439; the Ivory Gull, No 457; the Herring Gull, No 452; the Arctic Gull, No 459; the Kittiwake, No 456; and the Greater Tern, No 448: theſe, with the Eider Duck, No 480, complete the ſhort liſt of the feathered tribe of Spitzbergen. All theſe breed in the froſt-rent cracks of the mountains, and appear even in theſe regions before the 16th of March §.

FISH.The Whale is lord paramount of theſe ſeas; and, like a monſtrous tyrant, ſeems to have terrified almoſt every other ſpecies of fiſh away. A few Coal Fiſh, Br. Zool. iii. No 78, and two of the unctuous Suckers, No 58, were the whole which were taken by Lord Mulgrave, after ſeveral trials by hook and by net. [XCI] I can never imagine that the ſhallow, barren, and turbulent ſhores of the polar regions receive, as is popularly thought, the immenſe ſhoals of Herrings and Cod which annually repair to other more ſouthern ſeas. Their retreat muſt be in the great depths before deſcribed*, where they are ſecure from the greateſt ſtorms, and probably enjoy a bottom luxuriant in plants and vermes.

The Whale which inhabits theſe ſeas, and occaſions the great reſort of ſhipping, is the common ſpecies, Br. Zool. iii. No 16. I have in that Work given its hiſtory; therefore ſhall add no more, than that during ſpring theſe animals keep near Greenland and the iſland of John Mayen; and towards ſummer they appear in the ſeas of Spitzbergen. The Fin Fiſh, Br. Zool. iii. No 18, is another ſpecies: on their appearance, the Common Whale makes its retreat. The Beluga or White Whale, p. 183 of this Work, is ſeen here in ſummer, and prognoſticates a good fiſhery.

The inſects, vermes, and ſhells, of Spitzbergen, are very few. The Prawn, Br. Zool. iv. No 28, and Sea Flea, No 33, are found there. The Cancer Boreas, Ampulla, and Nugax, are three new ſpecies, added to the genus by the noble navigator.

Of the known ſpecies of vermes, the Aſcidia Gelatinoſa, Lin. Syſt. 1087: the Aſcidia Ruſtica, 1087, 5: the Lernea Branchialis, 1092: and the Clio Helicina, the ſmall Slime Fiſh of Marten, p. 141, tab. Q. fig. e: and the Clio Limacina, the Sea May Fly of the ſame, p. 169, tab. P. fig. 5: the Sipunculus Lendix, a new ſpecies, Phips, 194, tab. xiii. are found here: the two laſt, the ſuppoſed food of the Common Whale, are met with in vaſt abundance: the Meduſa Capillata, the Aſterias Pappoſa, Lin. Syſt. 1098: Aſt. Rubens, 1099; Aſt. Pectinata, 1101; Br. Zool. iv. No 70: Aſt. Ophiura, 1100; Br. Zool. iv. No 62: and Aſt. Caput Meduſae, Lin. Syſt. 1101; Br. Zool. iv. No 73. And of Shells, the Chiton Ruler, 1107; Lapes Tintinnabulum, 1168: the Mya Truncata, 1112; Br. Zool. No 14: and Mytilus Rugoſus, 1156; Br. Zool. iv. No 72: the Buccinum Carinotum, a new ſpecies, Phips, 197, tab. xiii: Turbo Helicinus of the ſame, 198: the Serpula Spirorbis, Lin. Syſt. 1265; Br. Zool. iv. No 155: Serpula Triquetra, 1265; Br. Zool. iv. No 156: and the Sabella Fruſtuloſa, Phips, 198, complete the liſt of this claſs. Among the Zoophytes is the Millepora Polymorpha, Lin. Syſt. 1285; and Millep. 1286; and a moſt curious new genus, diſcovered in the voyage, named the Synoicum Turgens, 199, tab. xiii: the Fluſtra Piloſa, Lin. Syſt. and Fl. Membranacea, 1301, 3, 5: and, to conclude, that very curious Zoophyte, the foundation of the foſſil Encrini, [XCII] the Vorticella Encrinus, Lin. Syſt. No 1317, engraven in our Tranſactions, vol. xlviii. p. 305, and taken in lat. 79, off this coaſt: two of them being drawn up with the ſounding-line, in 236 fathom water.

DISCOVERY OF SPITZBERGEN.The priority of diſcovery of theſe iſlands has been a great matter of controverſy between the Engliſh and the Dutch. We clame it from the ſight which Sir Hugh Willoughby is pretended to have had of it in his unfortunate voyage; but if what he ſaw, in lat. 72, was not a fog-bank, we muſt ſuppoſe it to have been either John Mayen's iſle, or part of Eaſt Greenland. The abſurd zeal of the Engliſh compilers makes Stephen Boroughs the ſecond diſcoverer of this country, in 1556; but it is very certain, that he never got higher than lat. 70. 42, nor ever meant any diſcovery but a paſſage to the river Ob *. It doubtleſsly was firſt diſcovered by the Dutch Barentz; who, in his third voyage, in 1596, for the finding out the north-eaſt paſſage, met with a land in lat. 79 ½, and anchored in a good road, in eighteen fathom water. He afterwards ſailed as high as 80, and found two of the iſlands of which Spitzbergen is compoſed. Embarraſſed with ice, he took a ſouthern courſe, and was ſoon after wreeked on the coaſt of Nova Zemlja: but the Engliſh and Dutch purſued the hint; and the Whale-fiſhery, which before was chiefly carried on by the Biſcayeners in the bay of St. Laurence, was commenced here with great ſucceſs. So active were we, that our ſhips frequented the place within two years after its diſcovery.

I now return to the North Cape on the coaſt of Finmark; and after paſſing by the ſeveral places mentioned in pages lxxix. and lxxx. enter a ſtreight, bounded by Muſcovitiſh Finmark, conſiſting of low hills, and the flat province of Meſen, on the eaſt. This leads into the Biocle Mari, or White Sea, WHITE SEA. or, more properly, gulph; for its waters are ſhallow, its bottom full of mud, brought by the great rivers which diſcharge themſelves into it, which almoſt deprive it of ſaltneſs. This was the Cwen ſea of Octher; but had been forgotten ſince his time. The Dwina, or Double River, is the greateſt, which takes its name from being formed by the Suchona and the Yug, very remote from its mouth. It is navigable to a great diſtance, and brings the commodities of the interior parts of the empire to Archangel, ARCHANGEL. a city ſeated on its banks, about ſix miles from the ſea. It roſe from a caſtle built there by Baſilowitz II. to protect the increaſing [XCIII] trade brought here on the diſcovery of the White Sea by the Engliſh; for ſhips of all nations reſorted to this port, even as far as from Venice. Its exports, in 1655, amounted to three hundred and thirty thouſand pounds*. Peter the Great, intent on aggrandizing his creation, Peterſburg, prohibited all trade to Archangel, except from the neighboring provinces. Still its exports of tar were conſiderable: in 1730, to the amount of forty thouſand laſts, of eleven barrels each. It ſends, during winter, great quantities of the Nawaga, a ſmall ſpecies of three-finned Cod, to Peterſburg, frozen, as Kola does Herrings in the ſame ſtate.

The White Sea is every winter filled with ice from the Frozen ocean, which brings with it the Harp Seal, No 77; and the Leporine, No 75, frequent it during ſummer. Whoever ſurveys the maps of the provinces between this ſea and the gulphs of Bothnia and Finland, will obſerve them to be more occupied by lakes than land, and be at once ſatisfied of the probability of the once-inſulated ſtate of Scandinavia. As ſoon as theſe ſtreights were cloſed, the White Sea loſt its depth, and is at preſent kept open only by the force of its great rivers.

On the eaſtern ſide of the entrance into the ſtreight is the iſle of Kandinos, often ſpoken of by our early navigators in their way to the Waygatz, in their ſearch for a north-eaſt paſſage. Between it and the main land is a very narrow channel. After doubling the cape of Kandinos, the ſea forms two great bays. A conſiderable part of the ſhore to the eaſt conſiſts of low ſandy hills. Into the moſt remote bay flows, in lat. 68. 30, by many mouths, the vaſt river Peczora, a place of great trade before the time of Peter I. Thouſands of Samoieds and other ſavages reſorted to the town, with feathers of White Grous, and other birds; Sables, and the moſt valuable furs; ſkins of Elks and other deer; the oil from the Walrus, No 71, from the Beluga, p. 182; and different ſort of fiſh§. Here was, in 1611, a great fiſhery of Beluga: above fifty boats, with three men each, were employed to harpoon them. The entrance into the river is dangerous, by reaſon of a ſandy ſhoal. The tide riſes there only four feet.

The coaſts eaſt of Archangel, even as far as the river Ob, are inhabited by the Samoieds; SAMOIEDS. a race as ſhort as the Laplanders, more ugly, and infinitely more brutalized; their food being the carcaſſes of horſes, or any other animals. They uſe the Rein Deer to draw their ſledges, but are not civilized enough to [XCIV] make it the ſubſtitute for the Cow. Theſe are in fact the Hottentots of the north.

To the eaſt of the Peczora commences the continent of ASIA,

Which has moſt natural and ſtrongly-marked limits. Here appear the Werchoturian mountains, or famous Urallian chain,URALLIAN CHAIN. which begins diſtinctly (for it may be traced interruptedly farther ſouth) near the town of Kungur, in the government of Kaſan, in lat. 57. 20, runs north, and ends oppoſite to the Waygatz ſtreight, and riſes again in the iſle of Nova Zemlja. The Ruſſians alſo call this range Semennoi Poias, or the Girdle of the World, from a ſuppoſition that it encircled the univerſe. Theſe were the Riphaei montes: Pars mundi damnata a natura rerum, et denſa merſa Caligine *, of which only the ſouthern part was known to the antients, and that ſo little as to give riſe to numberleſs fables. Beyond theſe were placed the happy Hyperborei, a fiction moſt beautifully related by Pomponius Mela . Moderns have not been behind-hand in exaggerating ſeveral circumſtances relative to theſe noted hills. Yſbrand Ides, who croſſed them in his embaſſy to China, aſſerts that they are five thouſand toiſes or fathoms high: others, that they are covered with eternal ſnow. The laſt may be true in their more northern parts; but in the uſual paſſages over them, they are free from it three or four months.

ITS HEIGHT.The heights of part of this chain have been taken by M. l' Abbè d' Auteroche; who, with many aſſurances of his accuracy, ſays, that the height of the mountain Kyria, near Solikamſkaia, in lat. 60, does not exceed four hundred and ſeventy-one toiſes from the level of the ſea, or two hundred and eighty-ſix from the ground on which it ſtands. But, according to M. Gmelin, the mountain Pauda is much higher, being ſeven hundred and fifty-two toiſes above the ſea. From Peterſburg to this chain [XCV] is a vaſt plain, mixed with certain elevations or platforms, like iſlands in the midſt of an ocean. The eaſtern ſide deſcends gradually to a great diſtance into the wooded and moraſſy Sibiria, which forms an immenſe inclined plane to the Icy Sea. This is evident from all the great rivers taking their riſe on that ſide, ſome at the amazing diſtance of lat. 46; and, after a courſe of above twenty-ſeven degrees, falling into the Frozen ocean in lat. 73. 30. The Yaik alone, which riſes near the ſouthern part of the eaſtern ſide, takes a ſouthern direction, and drops into the Caſpian ſea. The Dwina, the Peczora, and a few other rivers in European Ruſſia, ſhew the inclined plane of that part: all of them run to the northern ſea; but their courſe is comparatively ſhort. Another inclination directs the Dnieper and the Don into the Euxine, and the vaſt Wolga into the Caſpian Sea.

The Altaic Chain, ALTAIC CHAIN. its ſouthern boundary, which begins at the vaſt mountain Bogdo, paſſes above the head of the Irtiſch, and then takes a courſe rugged, precipitous, cloathed with ſnow, and rich in minerals, between the Irtiſch and Ob; HOW DISTRIBUTED. then proceeds by the lake Telezkoi, the riſe of the Ob; after which it retires, in order to comprehend the great rivers which form the Jeneſei, and are locked up in theſe high mountains; finally, under the name of the Sainnes, is uninterruptedly continued to the lake of Baikal *. A branch inſinuates itſelf between the ſources of the rivers Onon and Ingoda, and thoſe of Ichikoi, accompanied with very high mountains, running without interruption to the north-eaſt, and dividing the river of Amur, which diſcharges itſelf into the eaſt, in the Chineſe dominions, from the river Lena and lake Baikal. Another branch ſtretches along the Olecma, croſſes the Lena below Jakoutſk, and is continued between the two rivers Tongouſka to the Jeneſei, where it is loſt in wooded and moraſſy plains. The principal chain, rugged with ſharp-pointed rocks, approaches and keeps near the ſhores of the ſea of Ockhozt, and paſſing by the ſources of the rivers Outh, Aldan, and Maia, is diſtributed in ſmall branches, which range between the eaſtern rivers which fall into the Icy Sea; beſides two principal branches, one of which, turning ſouth, runs through all Kamtſchatka, and is broken, from the cape Lopatka, into the numerous Kurile iſles, and to the eaſt forms another marine chain, in the iſlands which range from Kamtſchatka to America; moſt of them, as well as Kamtſchatka itſelf, diſtinguiſhed by fierce vulcanoes, or the traces of vulcanic fires. The laſt chain forms chiefly the great cape Tſchutſki, with its promontories and rocky broken ſhores.—I have ſo far pillaged the labors of my friend, to trace the boundaries of the vaſt region which has ſo amply furniſhed my Zoologic part.—To that, and the Table of Quadrupeds, I refer the ſeveral peculiarities of their ſituations.

[XCVI]At the northern end of the great Urallian chain, is the Waygatz ſtreight, which cuts them from Nowyia Zemlja, Nova Zembla, or the New Land. The paſſage is narrow, obſtructed by iſlands, and very frequently by ice. The flux and reflux is here uncertain, by reaſon of the winds; but the tide has been obſerved to riſe only four feet*: the depth from ten to fourteen fathoms. It was diſcovered by Stephen Boroughs, in 1556; and the navigation was often attempted by the Dutch, in hopes of a paſſage that way to China. Continual obſtructions from the floating ice baffled their deſigns, and obliged them to return.

Nova Zemlja conſiſts of five iſlands; but the channels between them are always filled with ice. It is quite uninhabited, but is occaſionally frequented by the people of Meſen, who go there to kill Seals, Walruſes, Arctic Foxes, and White Bears, the ſole animals of the place, excepting a few Rein Deer. Attempts have been made to find a way to the Eaſt Indies to the north of it; but with equal bad ſucceſs as through the Waygatz. Barentz juſt doubled the eaſtern end in 1596; ſuffered ſhipwreck there with his crew; and paſſed there a moſt miſerable winter, continually beſieged by the Polar Bears: ſeveral of the crew died of the ſcurvy or exceſs of cold; the ſurvivors made a veſſel of the remains of their ſhip, and arrived ſafe in Europe the following year; but their great pilot ſunk under the fatigue.

The ſouthern coaſts of theſe iſlands are in a manner unknown. Between them and the continent is the Kara ſea, which forms a deep bay to the ſouth, in which the tide has been obſerved to flow two feet nine inches. Fiſhing people annually come here from the Peczora through the Waygatz, for the ſake of a ſmuggling trade in furs with the Samoieds of the government of Tobolſki . In the reign of the Empreſs Anne attempts were made to double the great cape Jalmal, between the gulph of Kara and that of the Ob; one of which (in 1738) only ſucceeded, and that after encountering the greateſt difficulties§. Had the diſcovery of Sibiria depended on its approach by ſea, it might have ſtill remained unknown.

THE RIVER ON.The mouth of the Ob lies in a deep bay, which opens into the Icy Sea, in lat. 73. 30. This is the firſt and greateſt of the Sibirian rivers: it riſes from a large lake in lat. 52, has a gentle courſe through eight hundred leagues of country, navigable almoſt to its ſource: is augmented by the vaſt river Irtiſch, in lat. 61, which again receives on each bank a multitude of vaſt rivers in its extenſive progreſs. Tobolſki, capital of Sibiria, lies on the forks, where it takes in the Tobol. The [XCVII] banks of the Irtiſch and Ob, and other Sibirian rivers, are, in many places, covered with immenſe foreſts, growing on a ſoft ſoil; which being torn up by the reſiſtleſs force of the vaſt fragments of ice brought down by the torrents occaſioned by the melting of the ſnows, are conveyed into the Icy and other ſeas, and form the driftwood I have before ſpoken of. The channel of the Ob, from its ſource to the Ket, is ſtony: from that river to the mouth it runs through a fat land. After it has been frozen ſome time, the water grows foul and fetid.ITS ANNUAL STENCH. This is owing to the vaſt moraſſes it in ſome places goes through, to the ſlowneſs of the current, and to the earth-ſalt (erdſaltz) with which ſome of the rivers which run into it are impregnated. The fiſh therefore ſhun the waters of the Ob, and reſort in vaſt ſhoals to the mouths of thoſe rivers which ruſh into it from ſtony countries, and in ſuch places are taken in great abundance. This ſtench continues till the river is purified in the ſpring by the melting of the ſnow. The Taz, another river which empties itſelf into the eaſt of the gulph of Ob, is liable to the ſame impurity.

The Jeneſei next ſucceeds. Mr. Gmelin, as a naturaliſt,JENESEI RIVER. would conſider this as the boundary between Europe and Aſia. From its eaſtern banks every thing puts on a new appearance: a certain new and unuſual vigour reigns in every thing. The mountains, which to the weſtward, as far as the Urallian chain, appeared only ſcattered, now take full poſſeſſion, and are interſperſed with moſt beautiful vallies. New animals, ſuch as the Argali, p. 12, and Muſk, p. 34, and ſeveral others, begin to ſhew themſelves. Many European plants diſappear, and others peculiar to Aſia, gradually mark the alteration*. This river is ſcarcely inferior to the Ob. It riſes from the two rivers Ulu-kem and Bei-kem, in north lat. 51. 30, long. 111, and runs due north into the Icy Sea, forming a mouth filled with multitudes of iſlands: its channel for the moſt part ſtony or gravelly: its courſe ſwift: its fiſhes moſt delicate: its banks, eſpecially the eaſtern, mountanous and rocky; but from the fort of Saiaenes to the river Dubtches, rich, black, and cultivated. It is fed by numbers of rivers. The Tunguſca, and the lower Tunguſca, are the moſt noted. The firſt ruſhes, near Irkutz, out of the great lake Baikal, LAKE BAIKAL. under the name of the Angara, between two vaſt rocks, natural, but with all the appearance of being cut through by art, and tumbling over huge ſtones in a bed a mile wide, and for a ſpace nearly the ſame. The colliſion of the waters againſt the ſtones is attended with a moſt dreadful noiſe, which, with the magnificence of the ſcenery, forms the moſt awful approach imaginable to this ſacred water. A deity preſided over the lake; and no one dared call it by that degrading name, for fear of incurring the penalty of the diſreſpect. Inſtead of lake, the borderers ſtyle it the Holy Sea; and its vaſt mountains, the Holy Mountains. St. Nicholas preſides over them, and has [XCVIII] here his chapel. The mountains are cloathed with foreſts: of large trees on the lower parts; with fewer and leſſer as they gain the heights. Theſe are the retreat of the Wild Boar, and variety of game. Its depth of water is very great: its clearneſs perfect: free from iſlands, except the Olchon and Saetchia: navigable in all parts: and in ſtorms, the waves like thoſe of the ſea. Its length is a hundred and twenty-five common leagues: its breadth from four to ſeven*. The Common Seal abounds in this lake.SEALS. It is a ſmall variety, but ſo fat as to appear almoſt ſhapeleſs. Theſe animals muſt have been here aboriginally; for, beſides the vaſt diſtance from the ſea, their paſſage muſt have been entirely obſtructed by the cataracts which intervene. I am got eight degrees beyond my plan; but I could not reſiſt the deſcription of this prince of lakes.

TOWN OF MANGAZEA.The Angara runs nearly due north for a great way; then aſſumes the name of Tunguſca, turns weſtward, and joins the Jeneſei in lat. 58. The lower Tunguſca riſes far to the ſouth-weſt, approaches very near to the Lena, and falls into the Jeneſei in lat. 65. 40. Above its junction ſtands the town of Mangazea, celebrated for its great fair of furs of every kind, brought there by the ſurrounding pagans, who paſs the long winter in the chace. Many Ruſſians have alſo migrated, and ſettled here for the ſame purpoſe, and draw great profit from the ſpoils of the animals. This neighborhood is, during ſummer, the great reſort of multitudes of ſpecies of water-fowl. About the feaſt of St. Peter, here Flora begins to diſcloſe her beauties: the country is covered with the moſt beautiful Sibirian flowers; many of which enliven the gardens of our more ſouthern climate. The fowls now exult, and unite in emitting their various notes; none particularly melodious in themſelves, but together form a concert far from diſagreeable; perhaps from the hearer being conſcious that they are the notes of happineſs, at the enjoyment of the reviving rays of the ſun.

In antient times, Mangazea, or, as it was then called, Mongozey, and Mongolmy, was ſeated near the mouth of the Taz ; but was removed by the inhabitants into a milder climate, i. e. juſt to the ſouth ſide of the Arctic circle. Before that period it was a place of great trade, and was eagerly viſited from Archangel, through a complication of difficulties, by ſea, by rivers, by land, by rein-drawn ſledges, and by drawing the veſſels from river to river over frequent carrying-places. Theſe tracts were certainly Le pais preſque inacceſſible à cauſe de boües, & de glaces, and, Le pais de tenebres, ſpoken of by Marco Polo §, as the regions from whence the Chams of Tartary procured the richeſt furs.

CAPE TAIMURA.From the mouth of the Jeneſei, the immenſe promontory Taimura ſtretches [XCIX] fartheſt north of all this region into the Icy Sea, nearly into lat. 78. To the eaſt of it the Chatunga, Anabara, and Olenek, rivers little known, fall into the ſea, and have before the mouth of each a conſiderable bay. Remarks have been made on the tide which flows into the Katanga, that at the full and new moon it riſes two feet; at other times is much leſs*. We may conclude, that if it flows no higher in this contracted place, and that of the gulph of Kara, its encreaſe muſt be very ſmall on the open ſhores of the Icy Sea. The coaſts are in general ſhallow, which has proved a ſafety to the few ſmall veſſels which have navigated this ſea; for the ſhoalneſs of the water preſerves them from the montanous ice, which grounds before it can reach them.

BEYOND the Olenek, the vaſt Lena, which riſes near lake Baikal, RIVER LENA. after a gentle and free courſe over a ſandy or gravelly bottom, diſcharges itſelf by five great mouths, the eaſtern and weſtern moſt remote from each other. The middle, or moſt northerly, is in lat. 73. 20. To form an idea of the ſize of this river, I muſt remark, that at Iakutſk, in lat. 61, twelve degrees from its diſcharge, the breadth is near three leagues. Beyond this river the land contracts itſelf, and is bounded to the ſouth by the gulph of Ochotz. The rivers Jana, Indigirſka, and Kolyma or Kowyma, have a comparatively ſhort courſe. The laſt is the moſt eaſterly of the great rivers which fall into the Icy Sea. Beyond it is a woodleſs tract,ARCTIC FLATS WOODLESS. which cuts off the Beaver, the Squirrels, and many other animals to whom trees are eſſential in their oeconomy. No foreſts can exiſt farther north than lat. 68; and at 70, bruſh-wood will ſcarcely grow. All within lat. 68, form the Arctic Flats, the ſummer haunts of water-fowl; a bare heath or moor, mixed with rocky mountains: and beyond the river Anadyr, which in lat. 65. falls into the Kamtſchatkan Sea, the remainder of the tract between it and the Icy Sea has not a ſingle tree.

I ſhall now take a review of the vaſt extent of ſhore which borders on the Icy Sea. The Jouratzkaine coaſt, which lies between the Ob and the Jeneſei, is high but not mountanous, and almoſt entirely compoſed of gravel or ſand; but in many places there are low tracts. Not only on theſe, but on more elevated ſituations, are found great fragments of wood, and often entire trees, all of the ſame ſpecies; Fir, Larch, and Pine, green and freſh; in other places, elevated beyond the reach of the ſea, are alſo great quantities of floated wood, antient, dried, and rotting§. This is not the only proof of the loſs of water in the Icy as well as other ſeas; for in theſe places is ſeen a ſpecies of clay, called by the Ruſſians, Il, which is exactly like the kinds uſually depoſited by the water: and of this there is, in theſe parts, a bed about eight inches thick, which univerſally forms the upper ſtratum. Still farther to [C] the eaſt, it grows mountanous, covered with ſtones, and full of coal. On the ſummit of the chain, to the eaſt of Simovie Retchinoïe, is an amazing bed of ſmall Muſſels, of a ſpecies not obſerved in the ſubjacent ſea. I think them brought there by ſea-fowl, to eat at leiſure; for it is not wonderful that numbers of objects of natural hiſtory ſhould eſcape the eye in ſuch a ſea as this. Many parts again are low; but in moſt places the ſea near the ſhore is rugged with pointed rocks. The coaſt about the bay of cape Tſchutſki, the moſt eaſtern extremity of Aſia, is in ſome places rocky, in others ſloping and verdant; but within land riſing into a double ridge of high mountains.

FREEZING OF THE ICY SEA.About the end of Auguſt, there is not a day in which this ſea might not be frozen; but in general it never eſcapes later than the firſt of October. The thaw commences about the twelfth of June, at the ſame time with that of the mouth of the Jeneſei *. From the great headlands, there is at all times a fixed, rugged, and mountanous ice, which projects far into the ſea. No ſea is of ſo uncertain and dangerous navigation: it is, in one part or other, always abundant in floating ice. During ſummer, the wind never blows hard twenty-four hours from the north, but every part of the ſhore is filled for a vaſt diſtance with ice; even the ſtreights of Bering are obſtructed with it. On the reverſe, a ſtrong ſouth wind drives it towards the pole, and leaves the coaſt free from all except the fixed ice. During winter, the ſea is covered, to the diſtance of at leſt ſix degrees from land. Markoff, a hardy Coſſac, on March 15th, O. S. in the year 1715, attempted, with nine other perſons, a journey from the mouth of the Jana, in 71 north lat. to the north, over the ice, on ſledges drawn by dogs. He went on ſucceſsfully ſome days, till he had reached lat. 77. or 78: he was then impeded by moſt mountanous ice. He climbed to the ſummit of one of the Icebergs; and ſeeing nothing but ice as far as his eye could reach, returned on April 3d, with the utmoſt difficulty: ſeveral of his dogs died, and ſerved as food for the reſt.

I ſhall juſt mention ſome of the attempts made to paſs through the Icy Sea to that of Kamtſchatka. The firſt was in 1636, from the ſettlement of Yakutzk. The rivers from the Jana to the Kolyma were in conſequence diſcovered. In 1646 a company of Ruſſian adventurers, called Promyſchleni, or Sable-hunters, made a voyage from the Kolyma to the country of the Tſchutſki, and traded with thoſe people for the teeth of the Walrus. A ſecond, but unſucceſsful voyage was made in the next year; but in 1648 one Deſchnew, on the 20th of June, began his memorable voyage, was fortunate in a ſeaſon free from ice, doubled the Tſchutſki-noſs, arrived near the river Olutora, ſouth of the river Anadyr, where he ſuffered ſhipwreck, [CI] but eſcaped to enjoy the honor of his diſcovery. Many other attempts were made, but the moſt which the adventurers have done was to get from the mouth of one great river to another in the courſe of a ſummer. I find very few names, except of rivers, in a tract ſo vaſt as it is, on account of its being ſo little frequented. To the eaſt of the promontory Taimura, that of St. Transfigurationis bounds the eaſt ſide of the bay of Chatanga, in lat. 74. 40, long. from Ferro 125. Swaitoi-noſs, or the Holy Cape, in lat. 73. 15, is a far-projecting headland, and, with the iſles of the Lena, and another intervening headland, forms two vaſt bays. Out of the moſt eaſtern, into which the river Yana diſcharges itſelf, one Schalourof, a broken Ruſſian merchant, took his departure for an eaſtern diſcovery. He began his voyage in July 1760 from the Lena, but was ſo obſtructed with ice that he was forced into the Yana, where he was detained the whole winter, by the ſame cauſe, till July 29th, 1761. He doubled the Swaitoi-noſs September the 6th; according to ſome, ſaw to the north a montanous land, poſſibly an iſland. He was eight days in getting through the paſſage between the continent and the iſle of St. Diomede, which lies a little to the ſouth-eaſt of the Noſs. He paſſed with a favorable wind the mouths of the Indigirka and Alazeia, and getting entangled among the ice between the Medviedkie Oſtrova, or Bear Iſlands, was obliged to lay up his veſſel in one of the mouths of the Kolyma during winter, where he ſubſiſted on rein-deer, which frequented thoſe parts in great herds during the ſevere ſeaſon; and on various ſpecies of ſalmon and trout, which were puſhing their way up the river before it was frozen. After this he made two other attempts. In the year 1763 he paſſed the Peſzcanoi-noſs, and got into a deep bay, called Tſchaoûn Skaja Goûba, with the iſle of Sabedei at its mouth; the great Schalatſkoi-noſs to the eaſt; and at its bottom the little river Tſchaoûn, which diſcharges itſelf here out of the land of the Tſchutſki, ſome of whom he ſaw on the ſhore, but they fled on his appearance. He found no means of ſubſiſting in this bay, therefore was obliged to return to the Lena, and was greatly aſſiſted in his paſſage by the ſtrength of the current, which uniformly ſet from the eaſt. In 1764 he made his laſt attempt, and was, as is conjectured, ſlain by the Tſchutſki; but whether he doubled the famous cape of that name, is left uncertain. A MS. map, which Doctor PALLAS favored me with, places the montanous iſle before mentioned in lat. 75, oppoſite to the cape Schalatſkoi *. Thus cloſes all the accounts I can collect of the voyages along [CII] this diſtant coaſt. Part is taken from Mr. Coxe's Ruſſian Diſcoveries *, and part from a manuſcript for which I am indebted to the learned Profeſſor before mentioned.

The wind which paſſes over the ice of this polar ſea, has rendered Sibiria the coldeſt of inhabited countries: its effects may perhaps extend much farther. At Chamnanning, in Thibet, in lat. 30. 44. (according to Major Rennel's claſſical map) Mr. Bogle found, during winter, the thermometer in his room at 29° below the freezing point. In the middle of April the ſtanding waters were all frozen, and heavy ſnows perpetually fell. I have heard of ice even at Patna, in lat. 25. 35; and of the Seapoys who had ſlept on the ground being found in the morning torpid. Near the fort of Argun, not higher than lat. 52, the ground ſeldom thaws deeper than a yard and a half. At Iakutſk, in lat. 62, the ſoil is eternally frozen even in ſummer, from the depth of three feet below the ſurface. An inhabitant, who by the labor of two ſummers ſunk a well to the depth of ninety-one feet, loſt his labor, and found his fartheſt ſearches frozen§. Birds fall down, overcome with the cold; and even the wild beaſts ſometimes periſh. The very air is frozen, and exhibits a moſt melancholy gloom.

AURORA BOREALIS.The Aurora Borealis is as common here as in Europe, and uſually exhibits ſimilar variations: one ſpecies regularly appears between the north-eaſt and eaſt, like a luminous rainbow, with numbers of columns of light radiating from it: beneath the arch is a darkneſs, through which the ſtars appear with ſome brilliancy. This ſpecies is thought by the natives to be a forerunner of ſtorms. There is another kind, which begins with certain inſulated rays from the north, and others from the north-eaſt. They augment little by little, till they fill the whole ſky, and form a ſplendor of colors rich as gold, rubies, and emeralds: but the attendant phaenomena ſtrike the beholders with horror, for they crackle, ſparkle, hiſs, make a whiſtling ſound, and a noiſe even equal to artificial fire-works. The idea of an electrical cauſe is ſo ſtrongly impreſſed by this deſcription, that there can remain no doubt of the origin of theſe appearances. The inhabitants ſay, on this occaſion, it is a troop of men furiouſly mad which are paſſing by. Every animal is ſtruck with terror; even the dogs of the hunters are ſeized with ſuch dread, that they will fall on the ground and become immoveable till the cauſe is over.

FISH.I am ſlightly acquainted with the fiſh of the Icy ſea, except the anadromous kinds, or thoſe which aſcend from it into the Sibirian rivers. The Ob, and other [CIII] Sibirian rivers, are viſited by the Beluga Whale, the common Sturgeon, and the Sterlet or Acipenſer Ruthenus, Lin. Syſt. 403; but I am informed by Doctor Pallas, that they have neither Carps, Bream, Barbels, nor others of that genus, nor yet Eels, Silurus Glanis, Lin. Syſt. 501; Perca Lucioperca, 481; or common Trout: all which are found in the Amur, and other rivers which run into the eaſtern ocean: in the latter, our common Cray-fiſh is found. In return, the Sibirian rivers abound in vaſt variety of the Salmon kind, and many unknown to us in Europe, which delight in the chilly waters of theſe regions. The common Salmon, Br. Zool. iii. No 143, is one of the ſcarcer kinds: the Salmo Nelma, Pallas Itin. ii. 716, or Salmon Leucichthys of Guldenſtaedt, Nov. Com. Petrop. xiv. 531, is a large ſpecies, growing to the length of three feet: the head greatly protracted: the lower jaw much the longeſt: the body of a ſilvery white: ſcales oblong: tail bifid. P. D. Rad. 14. The Salmo Taïmen, or Hucho, Pallas, ii. 716, grows to the weight of ten or fifteen pounds, and the length of a yard and a half: the color of the back is duſky; towards the ſides ſilvery: the belly white: ſpotted with duſky on the back: anul fin of a deep red: tail bifurcated: fleſh white: Salmo Lavaretus, iii. 705, or Gwiniad, Br. Zool. iii. No 152: Salmo Albula, Lin. Syſt. 512: Salmo Schokur, Pallas Itin. iii. 705; a ſpecies about two feet long, not unlike the Gwiniad: the Salmo Pidſchian, Pallas Itin. iii. 705; about two ſpans long, broader than the Gwiniad, and with a gibbous back: Salmo Wimba, Lin Syſt. 512: and Salmo Naſus, Pallas Itin. iii. 705*, are extremely common in the Ob. Others ſhun that ſtill river, and ſeek the Jeneſei, and other rapid ſtreams with ſtony bottoms. Such are the Salmo Lenok, Pallas Itin. ii. 716: Salmo Oxyrhynchus, Lin. Syſt. 512: and Salmo Autumnalis, or Omul, Pallas Itin. iii. 705; SURPRIZING MIGRATIONS OF FISH. which annually force their way from the ſea, from lat. 73. to lat. 51. 40, into lake Baikal, a diſtance of more than twenty-one degrees, or near thirteen hundred miles. The Omul even croſſes the lake, and aſcends in Auguſt the river Selinga, where it is taken by the inhabitants in great quantities, and is preſerved for the proviſion of the whole year. After dropping its ſpawn in the ſtony beds of the river, it again returns to the ſea. The Salmo Arcticus, Pallas Itin. iii. 206; and S. Thymallus, or Grayling, Br. Zool. iii. No 150; may be added to the fiſh of the Sibirian rivers. The Salmo Cylindraceus, or Walok of the Ruſſians, is a fiſh very ſlender, and almoſt cylindrical, with a very ſmall mouth, large ſilvery ſcales, and the under fins reddiſh. This is found only in the Lena, the Kowyma, [CIV] and Indigirſka. M. Gmelin and the Abbé D' Auteroche aſſure us, that Pikes, Perch, Ruffs, Carp, Bream, Tench, Crucians, Roach, Bleaks, and Gudgeons, are alſo met with in the Ob, and different rivers of this country*. I cannot reconcile this to the former account given me by ſo able a naturaliſt, to whom I owe this hiſtory of the Arctic fiſh. The Salmo Kundſha, Pallas Itin. iii. 706, abounds in the gulphs of the Icy ſea, but does not aſcend the rivers; and the Pleuronectes Glacialis, Pallas Itin. iii. 706, is frequent on the ſandy ſhores.

To review the inhabitants of the Arctic coaſts, I ſhall return as far as Finmark. I refer the reader to p. LXXIX. for what I have ſaid of the Laplanders. The Samoieds line the coaſts from the eaſt ſide of the White ſea, as far (according to the Ruſſian maps) as the river Ob, and even the Anabara, which falls into the Icy ſea in lat. 73. 30; and poſſeſs the wildeſt of countries inland, as low as lat. 65. After them ſucceeds, to the eaſt, a race of middle ſize; and, extraordinary to ſay, inſtead of degeneracy, a fine race of men is found in the Tſchutſki, in a climate equally ſevere, and in a country equally unproductive of the ſupports of life, as any part of theſe inhoſpitable regions. The manners of all are brutal, ſavage, and nearly animal; their loves the ſame; their living ſqualid and filthy beyond conception: yet on the ſite of ſome of theſe nations Mela hath placed the elegant Hyperborei: and our poet, Prior, giving free looſe to his imagination, paints the manners of theſe Arctic people in the following beautiful fiction, after deſcribing the condition of the natives of the torrid zone.

And may not thoſe, whoſe diſtant lot is caſt
North beyond Tartary's extended Waſte;
Where, thro' the plains of one continual day,
Six ſhining months purſue their even way,
And ſix ſucceeding urge their duſky flight,
Obſcur'd with vapors, and o'erwhelm'd in night;
May not, I aſk, the natives of theſe climes
(As annals may inform ſucceeding times)
To our quotidian change of heaven prefer
Their own viciſſitude, and equal ſhare
Of day and night, diſparted thro' the year?
May they not ſcorn our ſun's repeated race,
To narrow bounds preſcrib'd, and little ſpace,
Haſt'ning from morn, and headlong driven from noon,
Half of our daily toil yet ſcarcely done?
May they not juſtly to our climes upbraid
Shortneſs of night, and penury of ſhade?
That, ere our weary'd limbs are juſtly bleſt
With wholeſome ſleep, and neceſſary reſt,
Another ſun demands return of care,
The remnant toil of yeſterday to bear?
Whilſt, when the ſolar beams ſalute their ſight,
Bold and ſecure in half a year of light,
Uninterrupted voyages they take
To the remoteſt wood, and fartheſt lake;
[CV]Manage the fiſhing, and purſue the courſe
With more extended nerves, and more continued force?
And when declining day forſakes their ſky;
When gathering clouds ſpeak gloomy Winter nigh,
With plenty for the coming ſeaſon bleſt,
Six ſolid months (an age) they live releas'd
From all the labor, proceſs, clamor, woe,
Which our ſad ſcenes of daily action know:
They light the ſhining lamp, prepare the feaſt,
And with full mirth receive the welcome gueſt:
Or tell their tender loves (the only care
Which now they ſuffer) to the liſt'ning Fair;
And rais'd in pleaſure, or repos'd in eaſe,
(Grateful alternates of ſubſtantial peace)
They bleſs the long nocturnal influence ſhed
On the crown'd goblet, and the genial bed.

With greater reality ſpeaks that juſt obſerver of nature, the naturaliſt's poet, of the inhabitants of this very country, as a true contraſt to the foregoing lines:

Hard by theſe ſhores, where ſcarce his freezing ſtream
Rolls the wild Oby, live the laſt of men;
And half enliven'd by the diſtant ſun,
That rears and ripens man as well as plants,
Here human nature wears its rudeſt form.
Deep from the piercing ſeaſon, ſunk in caves,
Here, by dull fires, and with unjoyous chear,
They waſte the tedious gloom. Immers'd in furs,
Doze the groſs race. Nor ſprightly jeſt, nor ſong,
Nor tenderneſs they know; nor aught of life,
Beyond the kindred bears that ſtalk without.
Till morn appears, her roſes dropping all,
Sheds a long twilight bright'ning o'er the fields,
And calls the quiver'd ſavage to the chace.
THOMSON.

This amazing extent of the Aſiatic Ruſſian dominions remained undiſcovered to a very late period. The Czars, immerſed in ſenſuality, or engaged in wars, had neither taſte or leiſure to explore new countries. A plundering excurſion was made into it in the reign of Baſilovitz I; a ſecond was made under his ſucceſſor: but a ſtranger, the celebrated Coſſac, Yermac, driven from his country on the ſhores of the Caſpian ſea, puſhed his way with a reſolute band as far as Orel, near the head of the Kama, on the weſtern ſide of the U [...]allian chain. There he met with one Strogonoff, a Ruſſian merchant, recently ſettled in thoſe parts for the ſake of the traffic of furs. He continued in that neighborhood the whole winter, and was ſupplied by the Ruſſians with all neceſſaries. In the ſpring he turned his arms againſt Kutchum Chan, one of the moſt powerful of the petty princes of the country which now forms part of the government of Tobolſki. In 1581, he fought a deciſive battle with the Chan, overthrew him, and ſeated himſelf on the throne. Finding his ſituation precarious, he ceded his conqueſts to Bafilovitz, who ſeized on the opportunity of adding this country to his dominions. He ſent Yermac a ſupply of men. But at length his good fortune forſook him. He was ſurprized by the Chan; and, after performing all that a hero could do, periſhed in attempting to eſcape.

[CVI]The Ruſſians, on the death of their ally, retired out of Sibiria; but they ſoon returned, recovered the conqueſts made by Yermac, and, before the middle of the following century, added to their antient poſſeſſions a territory fourteen hundred and ſeventy leagues in length, and near ſeven hundred in breadth (without including the Ruſſian colonies on the iſland of Oonalaſhka, on the coaſt of America *) yet is ſo thinly peopled, and with ſuch barbarians, as to add no ſtrength to the empire by any ſupplies to the army or navy. They are almoſt torpid with inaction; lazy to the higheſt degree, from their neceſſary confinement to their ſtoves during the long winter of the country. In that ſeaſon, the ground is clad with deep ſnow, and the froſt moſt tremendouſly ſevere. The ſpring, if ſo it may be called, is diſtinguiſhed by the muddied torrents of melting ſnows, which ruſh from the mountains, and give a ſea-like appearance to the plains. Miſts, and rain, and ſnow, are the variations of that ſeaſon, and they continue even to the fourth of June. The ſhort ſummer is hot, and favorable to vegetation. Corn may be ſeen a foot high by the 22d of June; and the graſs is moſt luxuriant. Culinary plants will ſcarcely grow about Tobolſki. Fruits of every kind, except a currant, are unknown. A ſingle crab-like apple, raiſed in a hot-houſe, was once produced there, ſliced in a large diſh, at a great entertainment, and ſerved up with as much oſtentation as we would in England a pine-apple.

The animals of Sibiria, the furs of which were the original object of its conqueſt, are now ſo reduced, that the Ruſſians are obliged to have recourſe to England for a ſupply from North America, which they add to their own ſtock of furs exported into China. Metals ſeem the ſtaple trade of the country. Thoſe of iron and copper are abundant and excellent. Gold and ſilver are found in ſeveral places, and in ſuch abundance, as to form a moſt important article in the revenues of Ruſſia. The copper mines of Kolyvan, from which thoſe pretious metals are extracted, employ above forty thouſand people, moſtly coloniſts. The ſilver mines of Nertſchinſk, beyond lake Baikal, above fourteen thouſand. The whole revenue ariſing from the mines of different metals, is not leſs than £. 679, 182. 13 s.

PLANTS.Next to the diſcovery of the new world, no place has added more to the entertainment of naturaliſts than Sibiria. As has been before obſerved, nature there aſſumes a new appearance in the animal world: it does the ſame in the vegetable; at leſt, very few trees are found common to Europe and Aſia. Let me juſt mention the nobler kinds: the Oak, frequent as it is in Ruſſia and in Caſan, is not to be ſeen in this vaſt region nearer than the banks of the Argun [CVII] and Amur, in the Chineſe dominions. The White Poplar, Populus alba; and the Aſpen, Populus tremula, are extremely common. The Black Poplar, Populus nigra; the Common Sallow, Salix caprea; Sweet Willow, Salix pentandra; White Willow, Salix alba, are very frequent. The Hazel, Corylus Avellana, is circumſtanced like the Oak. The Common Birch, Betula alba, is moſt abundant; and, as in all northern nations, of univerſal uſe. The Dwarf Birch, Betula nana, is confined to the neighborhood of lake Baikal. The Alder, Betula Alnus, is very frequent. The Pinaſter, Pinus Pinea; the Pine with edible ſeeds, or Pinus Cembra; and Larch, Pinus Larix; all trees of the firſt uſe, medicinal or oeconomical, cover many parts of the country. The Norway Fir, Pinus Abies, and the Silver Fir, Pinus Picea, form, in moſt parts of the country, great foreſts: the firſt grows in this country not farther north than lat. 60; the laſt not higher than lat. 58; yet the former flouriſhes in Europe, and compoſes in Lapmark, far beyond the Arctic circle, woods of great extent: a proof of the ſuperior rigour of cold in the Aſiatic north. Theſe form the ſum of European trees growing in Sibiria. Of other plants, common to both continents, M. Gmelin gives the reader, in p. xciv. of his Preface, a ſlender liſt of ſuch which fell under his obſervation.

The trees or ſhrubs peculiar to Sibiria and Tartary, are the Acer Tartaricum, Sp. Pl. ii. 1495: the Ulmus pumila, 327: Prunus Sibirica, Amman. Ruth. 272, tab. 29: Pyrus baccata, 274: Robinia Caragana, fruteſcens, and pygmaea, Sp. Pl. ii. 1044. I may alſo obſerve, that the Taccamahacca, or Populus balſamifera, 1463, common alſo to North America, abounds about the upper part of the Lena, the Angara, and Jeneſei, and between the Onon and Aga. An infuſion of its buds is uſed by the natives as an excellent remedy for an infamous diſorder, frequent in this great country.

EUROPE is obliged to Sibiria for that excellent ſpecies of Oat, the Avena Sibirica, Fl. Sib. i. 113. tab. 22. Lin. Sp. Pl. i. 117; and our gardens are in a moſt peculiar manner enlivened with the gay and brilliant flowers introduced from that diſtant and ſevere climate. I ſhall only ſelect a few out of the multitude*. Veronica Sibirica, Iris Sibirica, Fl. Sib. i. 28. Eryngium planum, i. 185. Lilium bulbiferum, i. 41. L. pomponium, i. 42. L. Martagon, i. 44. Delphinium grandiſtorum, Sp. Pl. i. 749. Erythronium Dens canis, i. 39. tab. 7. Hemerocallis flava, i. 37. Saxifraga croſſifolia, Sp. Pl. i. 573. Lychnis chalcedonica, Sp. Pl. i. 625. Pyrus baccata, Lythrum virgatum, Sp. Pl. 642. Amygdalus [CVIII] nana, Sp. Pl. 677. Poeonia tenuifolia, Sp. Pl. i. 748. Clematis integrifolia, Sp. Pl. i. 767. Adonis vernalis, Sp. Pl. i. 771. Aſtragalus alopecuroides, Sp. Pl. ii. 1064. Hypericum Aſcyron, Sp. Pl. ii. 1102. Echinops Ritro, Fl. Sib. ii. 100. Veratrum nigrum, Fl. Sib. i. 76.

TSCHUTSKI.After the conqueſt of Sibiria, the Tſchutſki were the firſt people diſcovered by the Ruſſians, who were indebted to the adventure of Deſchnew for the knowlege of them. They are a free and brave race, and in ſize and figure ſuperior to every neighboring nation; tall, ſtout, and finely made, and with long and agreeable countenances; a race inſulated ſtrangely by a leſſer variety of men. They wore no beards. Their hair was black, and cut ſhort, and covered either with a cloſe cap, or hood large enough to cover the ſhoulders. Some hung beads in their ears, but none had the barbariſm to bore either noſes or lips. They wore a ſhort and cloſe frock, breeches, and ſhort boots: ſome had trowſers. The materials of their cloathing was leather admirably dreſſed, either with or without the hair*. It is ſaid that at times they wear jackets made of the inteſtines of whales, like the Eſkimaux; probably when they go to ſea, for they excel their neighbors in fiſhing, and uſe open boats covered with ſkins, and like the women's boats of the Greenlanders. They have alſo the leſſer or kajak. They make uſe of ſledges, and have large fox-like dogs of different colors, with long ſoft woolly hair, which are probably deſigned for the draught. Some ſay that they uſe rein-deer, of which they have vaſt abundance, but neither milk them nor kill them for food, preferring the fleſh of ſea animals, except one dies by chance, or is killed by the wolves. They are a brave and warlike people; are armed with bows and arrows; the laſt pointed with ſtone or bone. They had ſpontoons headed with ſteel, procured by traffic from the Ruſſians; theſe they uſually ſlung over their right ſhoulder; and a leathern quiver of moſt elegant workmanſhip hung over the left§. The Ruſſians have often gained dear-bought victories over this brave people, but never were able to effect their conqueſt. They retained an high ſenſe of liberty, and conſtantly refuſed to pay tribute; and the ambitious European miſcalled them rebels. They will not on any conſideration part with their weapons: poſſibly a Tſchutſki may think a diſarmed man diſhonored. Captain COOK, in his three hours viſit to them, found their attachment to their arms, notwithſtanding they willingly parted with any thing elſe, and even without the proſpect of exchange. They treated him with great civility, but prudent caution: ſaluted him by bowing [CIX] and pulling off their caps, poſſibly a piece of politeneſs they learned from the Ruſſians. They treated him with a ſong and dance, and parted friends; but not without a moſt remarkable and conſequential event:—A year after the interview between Captain COOK and the Tſchutſki, a party of thoſe people came to the frontier poſt of the Ruſſians, and voluntarily offered friendſhip and tribute. Theſe generous people, whom fear could not influence, were overcome by the civility and good conduct of our illuſtrious commander: they miſtook him and his people for Ruſſians, and, imagining that a change of behaviour had taken place, tendered to their invaders a laſting league*. Poſſibly the munificent empreſs may bluſh at the obligation conferred by means of Britiſh ſubjects, in procuring to her empire a generous ally, at the inſtant her armed neutrality contributed to deprive us of millions of lawful ſubjects.

From the ſhortneſs of the interview little knowlege could be gained of their cuſtoms. I ſhall only obſerve, that they bury their dead under heaps of ſtones,TUMULI. or carnedds: ſeveral were ſeen here with the rib of a whale on the top inſtead of a pillar; a proof of the univerſality of theſe memorials of the dead.

The country of the Tſchutſki forms the moſt north-eaſterly part of Aſia. It is a peninſula, bounded by the bay of Tchaoûn, by the Icy Sea, the ſtreights of BERING, and the gulph and river of Anadir, which open into the ſea of Kamtſchatka. It is a mountanous tract, totally deſtitute of wood, and conſequently of animals which require the ſhelter of foreſts. The promontory Schalotſkoi, before mentioned, is the moſt weſterly part. Whether it extends ſo far north as lat. 74, as the Ruſſians place it, is very doubtful: there is the opinion of our great navigator againſt it. From his own reaſonings he ſuppoſed that the tract from the Indigirſka, eaſtward,CORRECTIONS IN GEOGRAPHY BY CAPT. COOK. is laid down in the maps two degrees to the northward of its true poſition. From a map he had in his poſſeſſion, and from information he received from the Ruſſians, he places the mouth of the Kowyma, in lat. 68, inſtead of lat. 71. 20, as the Peterſburg map makes it. It is therefore probable, that no part of Aſia in this neighborhood extends further than lat. 70, in which we muſt place the Schalotſkoi Noſs; and after the example of Mr. Campbell, who formed his map of this country chiefly from the papers of Captain BERING§, give the land which lies to the eaſt of that promontory a very ſouthern trend. As Captain COOK had cauſe to imagine that the former charts erred in longitude as well as latitude, it is probable that he reached within ſixty miles of the Schalotſkoi Noſs . There we find him on Auguſt 29th, 1778, and from this period are enabled, from his remarks, to proceed ſecurely accurate.

[CX]After croſſing the Icy Sea from the moſt extreme part of the coaſt of America which he could attain, he fell in with land. It appeared low near the ſea, and high inland; and between both lay a great lake. To a ſteep and rocky point, nearly in lat. 68. 56, and long. 180. 51, his ne plus ultra on the Aſiatic ſide, he gave the name of Cape North; CAPE NORTH. beyond which he could not ſee any land, notwithſtanding the weather was pretty clear. The ſea, at three miles diſtance from the ſhore, was only eight fathoms deep: this, with a riſing wind, approaching fog, and apprehenſion of the coming down of the ice, obliging him to deſiſt from farther attempts in theſe parts, he proceeded as near to the coaſt as he could with prudence,BURNEY'S ISLE. towards the ſouth-eaſt, and found it retain the ſame appearance. In lat. 67. 45, he diſcovered a ſmall iſle, about three leagues from the main, with ſteep and rocky ſhores, on which he beſtowed the name of Burney, in honor of one of his officers; gratefully immortalizing the companions of his voyage, in this and other inſtances. After paſſing the iſland, the continent inland roſe into mountains of conſiderable height, the termination of the great chain I before deſcribed.

In lat. 67. 3, long. 188. 11, he fell in with Serdze Kamen *,SERDZE KAMEN. a lofty promontory, faced towards the ſea with a ſteep rocky cliff. To the eaſtward the coaſt continues high and bold, towards the North Cape low, being a continuation of the Arctic flats. This was the northern limit of the voyage of another illuſtrious navigator, Captain VITUS BERING,CAPT. BERING. a Dane by birth, and employed on the ſame plan of diſcovery in theſe parts as our great countryman was in the late voyage. He was in the ſervice of PETER the GREAT; who, by the ſtrength of an extenſive genius, conceiving an opinion of the vicinity of America to his Aſiatic dominions, laid down a plan of diſcovery worthy of ſo extraordinary a monarch, but died before the attempt was begun; but his ſpirit ſurvived in his ſucceſſor. BERING, after a tedious and fatiguing journey through the wilds of Sibiria, arrived in Kamtſchatka, attended with the ſcanty materials for his voyage, the greateſt part of which he was obliged to bring with him through a thouſand difficulties. Several of the circumſtances of his adventures will be occaſionally mentioned. I ſhall only ſay here, that he ſailed from the river of Kamtſchatka on July 15th, 1728; on the 15th of Auguſt ſaw Serdze Kamen, or the heart-ſhaped rock, a name beſtowed on it by the firſt diſcoverer.

From Serdze Kamen to a promontory named by Captain COOK Eaſt Cape ,EAST CAPE. the land trends ſouth-eaſt. The laſt is a circular peninſula of high cliffs, projecting [CXI] far into the ſea due eaſt, and joined to the land by a long and very narrow iſthmus, in lat. 66. 6. This is the Tſchutſki Noſs of our navigators, and forms the beginning of the narrow ſtreights or diviſion of the old and new world.BERING'S STREIGHTS. The diſtance between Aſia and America in this place is only thirteen leagues. The country about the cape, and to the north-weſt of it, was inhabited. About mid-channel are two ſmall iſlands, named by the Ruſſians the iſles of St. Diomedes; neither of them above three or four leagues in circuit* . It is extremely extraordinary that BERING ſhould have ſailed through this confined paſſage, and yet that the object of his miſſion ſhould have eſcaped him. His misfortune could only be attributed to the foggy weather, which he muſt have met with in a region notorious for miſts; for he ſays that he ſaw land neither to the north nor to the eaſt§. Our generous commander, determined to give him every honor his merit could clame, has dignified theſe with the name of BERING'S STREIGHTS.

The depth of theſe ſtreights is from twelve to twenty-nine or thirty fathoms.DEPTH. The greateſt depth is in the middle, which has a ſlimy bottom; the ſhalloweſt parts are near each ſhore, which conſiſts of ſand mixed with bones and ſhells. The current or tide very inconſiderable, and what there was came from the weſt.CURRENT.

From Eaſt Cape the land trends ſouth by weſt. In lat. 65. 36, is the bay in which Captain COOK had the interview with the Tſchutſki. Immediately beyond is the bay of St. Laurence, about five leagues broad in the entrance, and four deep, bounded at the bottom by high land. A little beyond is a large bay, either bounded by low land at the bottom, or ſo extenſive as to have the end inviſible. To the ſouth of this are two other bays; and in lat. 64. 13, long. 186. 36, is the extreme ſouthern point of the land of the Tſchutſki. This formerly was called the Anadirſkoi Noſs. Near it BERING had converſation with eight men, who came off to him in a baidar, or boat covered with the ſkins of ſeals; from which BERING and others have named it the Tſchutſki Noſs. A few leagues to the ſouth-eaſt of this point lies Clerke's iſland, in lat 63. 15, diſcovered by Capt. COOK;ISLES OF CLERKE AND ST. LAURENCE. and immediately beyond a larger, on which BERING beſtowed the name of St. Laurence: the laſt, the reſort of the Tſchutſki in their fiſhing parties. Both of theſe conſiſt of high cliffs, joined by low land. A ſmall iſland was ſeen about nineteen leagues from St. Laurence's, in a north-eaſt by eaſt half eaſt direction; I ſuſpect it to be that which Capt. COOK named Anderſon's, in memory of his ſurgeon, who died off it, and from his amiable character ſeems to have well [CXII] merited this memorial. It lies in lat. 63. 4, long. 192. An anonymous iſlet, imperfectly ſeen, and lying in lat. 64. 24, long. 190. 31, in mid-channel, completes the ſum of thoſe ſeen remote from land between the ſtreights and the iſle of St. Laurence. As to thoſe named in the chart given by Lieut. Synd, who in 1764 made a voyage from Kamtſchatka towards BERING'S Streights, they ſeem to exiſt only in imagination, notwithſtanding the Ruſſian calendar has been exhauſted to find names for them. St. Agathon, St. Titus, St. Myron, and many others, fill the ſpace paſſed over by Capt. COOK, and which could not have eſcaped the notice of his ſucceſſor*.

The land from BERING'S Tſchutſki Noſs trends vaſtly to the weſt, and bounds on that ſide the vaſt gulph of Anadir, into the bottom of which the river of the ſame name empties itſelf; and limits the territory of the Tſchutſki.

From thence is a large extent of coaſt trending ſouth-weſt from Cape St. Thaddeus, in lat. 62. 50, long. 180, the ſouthern boundary of the gulph of Anadir, to Oljutorſkoi Noſs, beyond which the land retires full weſt, and forms in its boſom a gulph of the ſame name. Off Thaddeus Noſs appeared, on June 29th, abundance of walruſes and great ſeals; and even the wandering albatroſs was ſeen in this high latitude. Between this and the Penginſk gulph, at the end of the ſea of Ochotſk, is the iſthmus which unites the famous peninſula of Kamtſchatka to the main land, and is here about a hundred and twenty miles broad, and extends in length from 52 to 61, north lat. The coaſts are often low: often faced with cliffs, in many parts of an extraordinary height; and out at ſea are rude and ſpiring rocks, the haunts of leonine ſeals, whoſe dreadful roarings are frequently the preſervation of mariners, warning them of the danger, in the thick fogs of this climate. The coaſt has but few harbours, notwithſtanding it juts frequently into great headlands. The moſt remarkable are, the North Head, with its needle rocks, at the entrance of the bay of Awatcha (Voyage, vol. iii. tab. 58); Cheepoonſkoi Noſs, ſtill further north, engraven in vol. ii. tab. 84; and Kronotſkoi Noſs, with its lofty cliffs. The peninſula widens greatly in the middle, and leſſens almoſt to a point at Cape Lopatka, which ſlopes into a low flat, and forms the ſouthern extremity of the country. The whole is divided lengthways by a chain of lofty rocky mountains, frequently covered with ſnow, and ſhooting into conic ſummits,VULCANOS. often ſmoking with vulcanic eruptions. They have broken out in numbers of places: the extinct are marked by the craters, or their broken tops. The vulcano near Awatcha §, that of Tolbatchick, and that of the mountain of Kamtſchatka , are the modern. They burſt out ſometimes in whirlwinds of flames, [CXIII] and burn up the neighboring foreſts: clouds of ſmoke ſucceed, and darken the whole atmoſphere, till diſperſed by ſhowers of cinders and aſhes, which cover the country for thirty miles round. Earthquakes, thunder, and lightning, join to fill the horror of the ſcenery at land; while at ſea the waves riſe to an uncommon height, and often divide ſo as to ſhew the very bottom of the great deep*. By an event of this kind was once expoſed to ſight the chain of ſubmarine mountains which connected the Kuril iſles to the end of this great peninſula. I do not learn that they overflow with lava or with water, like the vulcanos of Europe. There are in various parts of the country hot ſprings,HOT SPRINGS. not inferior in warmth to thoſe of Iceland : like them they in ſome places form ſmall jets d'eaux, with a great noiſe, but ſeldom exceed the height of a foot and a half.

The climate during winter is uncommonly ſevere; for ſo low as Bolcheretſk, CLIMATE. lat. 52,30, all intercourſe between neighbors is ſtopped. They dare not ſtir out for fear of being froſt-bitten. Snow lies on the ground from ſix to eight feet thick as late as May; and the ſtorms rage with uncommon impetuoſity, owing to the ſubterraneous fires, the ſulphureous exhalations, and general vulcanic diſpoſition of the country. The prevaling winds are from the weſt, which paſſing over the frozen wilds of Sibiria and Tartary, add keenneſs and rigour to the winters of Kamtſchatka. Winter continues till the middle of June: from that month to the middle of September may be called ſummer, if a ſeaſon filled with rain, and miſts, and ungenial ſkies, merits that name. Rye, barley, and oats, are committed to the earth, but ſeldom come to perfection. The ſubſiſtence of the Ruſſians and Coſſacks depends therefore on importation from Sibiria. In ſome parts graſs grows to a great height, and hay of uncommon nutriment is harveſted for the fattening of cattle§. Grain is a luxury for the coloniſts only: the natives have other reſources, the effects of neceſſity. Excepting in few places, this is a land of incorrigible barrenneſs. As ſoon as the ſea otters and other pretious furs are exhauſted, Kamtſchatka will be deſerted by the Ruſſians, unleſs they ſhould think fit to colonize the continent of America, which the furs of that country, or the proſpect of mineral wealth, may induce them to attempt.

Few ores have as yet been diſcovered in this peninſula:ORES. not that it wants either copper or iron; but every neceſſary in thoſe metals is imported at ſo cheap a rate, that it is not worth while for a people ignorant in mining and ſmelting to ſearch for them in the almoſt inacceſſible mountains.

From the climate and the barren nature of Kamtſchatka, PLANTS. the reader need not be [CXIV] ſurprized at the poverty of its Flora. It muſt not be ſuppoſed that the ſcanty enumeration of its plants ariſes from a neglect of ſearch, or the want of a botaniſt to explore its vegetable kingdom. STELLER, a firſt-rate naturaliſt of Germany, who attended BERING in his laſt voyage, reſided here a conſiderable time after his eſcape from that unfortunate expedition, expreſsly to complete his remarks in natural hiſtory. The reſult of his botanical reſearches was communicated to Doctor Gmelin, another gentleman ſent by the Ruſſian government to examine into the natural hiſtory of its dominions. Europe has from time to time been ranſacked for men of abilities to perform this meritorious miſſion, and the fruits of their labors have been liberally communicated to a public thirſting for knowlege. The names of MULLER, GMELIN, STELLER, DE L'ISLE, KRASHANINICOFF, GUILDENSTAEDT, LEPECHIN, and PALLAS, will ever be held in reſpect, for adding to the ſtock of natural knowlege. But how much is it to be lamented that England wants a patron to encourage the tranſlation of their works, locked up at preſent in Ruſſian or German, concealed from the generality of readers, to the great ſuppreſſion of knowlege!

I here give a liſt of the plants of Kamtſchatka in ſyſtematic order; and from it annex an account of the uſes made of them by the natives of the peninſula. I muſt not omit my thanks to the Rev. Mr. Lightfoot, and the Rev. Mr. Hugh Davies of Beaumaris, for the great aſſiſtance I received from them. Let me premiſe, that the plants marked A. are common to America and Kamtſchatka; with B. to BERING'S Iſle; with E. to England or Scotland; and with Virg. thoſe which extend to Virginia, or the eaſtern ſide of North America *. It is remarkable, that the European plants, which had deſerted Sibiria about the Jeneſei, appear here in great abundance.

  • Veronica. Gmel. Sib. iii. 219. No 33.
  • V. incana.
  • V. ſerpyllifolia. E.
  • Iris ſibirica.
  • Iris. Gm. Sib. i. 30. No 28.
  • Dactylis. Gm. Sib. i. 130. No 68.
  • Bromus criſtatus. Amoen. Acad. ii. 312.
  • Triticum. Gm. Sib. i. 119. No 56.
  • Plantago major. A. E. Virg.
  • Pl. aſiatica.
  • Sanguiſorba canadenſis. A.
  • Cornus ſuecica.
  • Pulmonaria virginica. A. Am. Acad. ii. 310.
  • Cerinthe major. A.
  • Cortuſa Gmelini. Am. Acad. ii. 313.
  • Anagallis. Gm. Sib. iv. 87, 37.
  • Azalca procumbens. E.
  • Phlox ſibirica. Am. Acad. ii. 314.
  • Convolvulus perſicus. Ibid.
  • [CXV]Polemonium caeruleum. A. E.
  • Lonicera Xyloſteum. A?
  • L. caerulea.
  • Ribes alpinum. A. E.
  • R. rubrum. Virg.
  • R. groſſularia. A. Virg.
  • Claytonia virginica. A. Am. Acad. ii. 310.
  • Salſola proſtrata 318.
  • Anabaſis aphylla. 319.
  • Heuchera americana. 310.
  • Swertſia dichotoma. 317.
  • Sw. corniculata. ibid.
  • Gentiana amarella. E.
  • G. aquatica. Am. Acad. ii. 316.
  • Heracleum panaces. A.
  • Angelica archangelica.
  • Ang. Sylveſtris. E. Virg.
  • Cicuta viroſa.
  • Chaerophyllum Sylveſtre.
  • Chaer, aureum?
  • Sambucus racemoſa.
  • Tradeſcantia. Virg?
  • Allium urſinum. E. Virg.
  • Allium triquetrum.
  • Lilium martegon.
  • L. Camſchatcenſe. A. Virg. Am. Acad. ii. 320.
  • Uvularia perfoliata. 310.
  • Convallaria bifolia.
  • Juncus filiformis. E. Virg.
  • J. campeſtris. E.
  • Rumex acetoſa. Virg.
  • Melanthium ſibiricum. Am. Acad. ii. 320.
  • Trillium erectum. ii. 310.
  • Aliſma plantago aquatica. E.
  • Alſinanthemos. Gm. Sib. iv. 116. No 86.
  • Epilobium latifolium.
  • Vaccinium myrtillus. A. E.
  • Vaccinium uliginoſum. E.
  • Vac. vitis idaea. A. E.
  • Vac. oxycoccos. E. Virg.
  • Erica. Gm. Sib. iv. 130. No 21. B.
  • Er. Gm. Sib. iv. 131. No 22. A.
  • Bryanthus. Gm. Sib. iv. 133. No 23.
  • Polygonum biſtorta. E.
  • Pol. viviparum. E.
  • Adoxa moſchatellina. A. E.
  • Sophora Lupinoides. Am. Acad. ii. 321.
  • Ledum paluſtre.
  • Andromeda. Gm. Sib. iv. 121. No 9.
  • Chamaerhododendros. Gm. Sib. iv. 126. No 13. B.
  • Arbutus uva urſi. E. Virg.
  • Pyrola rotundifolia. E. Virg.
  • Tiarella trifoliata. Am. Acad. ii. 322.
  • Sedum verticillatum. ii. 323.
  • Prunus padus. E.
  • Sorbus aucuparia. E. Virg.
  • Crataegus oxyacantha. Voyage, iii. 334.
  • Spiraea hypericifolia. Am. Acad. ii. 310.
  • Sp. Sorbifolia. 324.
  • Spiraea. Gm. Sib. iii. 192. No 55.
  • Spiraea. 192. No 56.
  • Sp. aruncus.
  • Roſa alpina.
  • Rubus Idaeus. A. E. Virg.
  • R. Caeſius. E.
  • R. fruticoſus. E. Virg.
  • R. arcticus. Virg.
  • R. chamaemorus. E.
  • Fragaria veſca. A. E.
  • Potentilla fruticoſa. E.
  • Dryas pentapetala.
  • Actaea cimicifuga. Am. Acad. ii. 325.
  • Papaver nudicaule.
  • Aconitum napellus.
  • [CXVI]Anemone narciſſifolia.
  • Anem. ranunculoides.
  • Anem. Dichotoma. Am. Acad. ii. 310.
  • Thalictrum flavum. E.
  • Ranunculus.
  • Troillius europeus. E.
  • Helleborus trifolius. Am. Acad. ii. 327.
  • Bartſia pallida. ibid.
  • Pedicularis verticillata.
  • Linnaea borealis. Virg.
  • Myagrum ſativum. E.
  • Thlaſpi burſa paſtoris. E. Virg.
  • Arabis grandiflora.
  • Turritis hirſuta. E.
  • Geranium pratenſe. E.
  • Lathyrus. Gm. Sib. iv. 85.
  • Aſtragalus alopecuroides. Am. Acad. ii. 330.
  • Aſtr. alpinus.
  • Aſtr. Gm. Sib. iv. 44. No 58.
  • Aſtr. phyſodes. Am. Acad. ii. 329.
  • Hypericum. Gm. Sib. iv. 279. No 3.
  • Picris hieraciodes. E.
  • Sonchus. Gm. Sib. ii. 13. No 13.
  • Prenanthes repens. Am. Acad. ii. 331.
  • Serratula noveboracenſis. Virg.
  • Circium. Gm. Sib. ii. 69. No 49.
  • Cacalia ſuaveolens. Am. Acad. ii. 310.
  • Artemiſia vulgaris. A. E.
  • Gnaphalium margaritaceum. E. Virg.
  • Erigeron acre. A. E.
  • Tuſſilago. B. Gm. Sib. ii. 145. No 125.
  • Senecio. B. 136. No 118.
  • Aſter. A. B. Gm. Sib. ii. 175. No 145.
  • Aſter. 186. No 152.
  • Solidago virga aurea. A. B. E.
  • Solidago. Gm. Sib. ii. 170. No 190.
  • Cineraria ſibirica.
  • Pyrethrum. A. B. Gm. Sib. ii. 203. No 170.
  • Orchis bifolia. E. Virg.
  • Orchis latifolia. E.
  • Ophrys Camtſcatca. Am. Acad. ii. 332.
  • Drachontium Camtſcatcenſe. Am. Acad. ii. 332.
  • Carex panicea. E. Virg.
  • Carex. Gm. Sib. i. 139. No 77.
  • Betula alba. E.
  • Betula nana. E. Virg.
  • Betula alnus. A. E. Virg.
  • Urtica dioica. E.
  • Sagittaria latifolia. E.
  • Pinus cembra.
  • Pinus Larix. A. Virg.
  • Pinus picea.
  • Salix retuſa.
  • Salix viminalis. E.
  • Empetrum nigrum A. E. Virg.
  • Populus alba. E.
  • Juniperus communis. E.
  • Equiſetum hyemale. E. Virg.
  • Aſplenium Rhyzophyllum. Am. Acad. ii.
  • 311. Virg.
  • Lycopodium rupeſtre. Virg. ibid.
  • Lycop. Sanguinolentum. ii. 333.

USES.The Kamtſchatkans boaſt of their ſkill in the knowlege of the application of the vegetable kingdom to the uſes of mankind. The Sibirians cure the venereal diſeaſe by a decoction of the root of the Iris Sibirica, which acts by purging and vomiting. They keep the patient eight days in a ſtove, and place him in a bed of the leaves [CXVII] of the Arctium Lappa, or common Burdock, which they frequently change till the cure is effected.

The Heracleum Panaces, or Sweet graſs, was a plant of the firſt uſe with the Kamtſchatkans, and formerly made a principal ingredient in all their diſhes; but ſo powerful does the love of hot liquors ſway with the Ruſſians, that, ſince their arrival, it is entirely applied to diſtillation. The beginning of July the more ſucculent ſtalks and leaves are gathered; after the down is ſcraped off with ſhells, they are layed to ferment; when they grow dry, they are placed in bags, and in a few days are covered with a ſaccharine powder: only a quarter of a pound of powder is collected from a pood, or thirty-ſix pounds of the plant, which taſtes like liquorice. They draw the ſpirit from it by ſteeping bundles of it in hot water; then promote the fermentation in a ſmall veſſel, by adding the berries of the Lonicera Xyloſteum, Sp. Pl. i. 248, and Vaccinium uliginoſum, 499. They continue the proceſs by pouring on more water, after drawing off the firſt: they then place the plants and liquor in a copper ſtill, and draw off, in the common manner, a ſpirit equal in ſtrength to brandy*. Accident diſcovered this liquor. One year, the natives happening to collect a greater quantity of berries of ſeveral kinds, for winter proviſion, than uſual, found in the ſpring that a great quantity had fermented, and become uſeleſs as a food. They reſolved to try them as a drink, and mixed the juice with water. Others determined to experience it pure; and found, on trial, the Arctic beatitude, drunkenneſs. The Ruſſians caught at the hint, introduced diſtillation, and thus are enabled to enjoy ebriety with the production of the country.

The Moucho-more of the Ruſſians, the Agaricus muſcarius, Sp. Pl. 1640, is another inſtrument of intoxication. It is a ſpecies of Toadſtool, which the Kamtſchadales and Koriaks ſometimes eat dry, ſometimes immerſed in a fermented liquor made with the Epilobium, which they drink notwithſtanding the dreadful effects. They are firſt ſeized with convulſions in all their limbs, then with a raving ſuch as attends a burning fever; a thouſand phantoms, gay or gloomy (according to their conſtitutions) preſent themſelves to their imaginations: ſome dance; others are ſeized with unſpeakable horrors. They perſonify this muſhroom; and, if its effects urge them to ſuicide, or any dreadful crime, they ſay they obey its commands. To fit themſelves for premeditated aſſaſſinations, they take the Moucho-more. Such is the faſcination of drunkenneſs in this country, that nothing can induce the natives to forbear this dreadful potion!

[CXVIII]As a food, the Saranne, SARANNE. or Lilium Kamtſchatcenſe, is among the principal. Its roots are gathered by the women in Auguſt, dried in the ſun, and layed up for uſe: they are the beſt bread of the country; and after being baked are reduced to powder, and ſerve inſtead of flour in ſoups and ſeveral diſhes. They are ſometimes waſhed, and eaten as potatoes; are extremely nouriſhing, and have a pleaſant bitter taſte. Our navigators boiled and eat them with their meat. The natives often parboil, and beat it up with ſeveral ſorts of berries, ſo as to form of it a very agreeable confection. Providentially it is an univerſal plant here, and all the grounds bloom with its flower during the ſeaſon*. Another happineſs remarked here is, that while fiſh are ſcarce, the Saranne is plentiful; and when there is a dearth of this, the rivers pour in their proviſions in redoubled profuſion. It is not to the labors of the females alone that the Kamtſchatkans are indebted for theſe roots. The oeconomic Mouſe, p. 134. A. ſaves them a great deal of trouble. The Saranne forms part of the winter proviſions of that little animal: they not only gather them in the proper ſeaſon, and lay them up in their magazines, but at times have the inſtinct of bringing them out, in ſunny weather, to dry them, leaſt they ſhould decay. The natives ſearch for their hoards; but with prudent tenderneſs leave part for the owners, being unwilling to ſuffer ſuch uſeful caterers to periſh.

Let me add, that STELLER enumerates other ſpecies of the Lilly genus, which I believe are edible. Every ſpecies of fruit, except berries, is denied to this unkind climate; but the inhabitants uſe various ſorts of them as wholeſome ſubſtitutes, which they eat freſh, or make into palatable jams, or dreſs with their fiſh, either freſh or when preſerved for winter uſe: ſuch are thoſe of the Lonicera Xyloſteum or Gimoloſt, a ſort of Honeyſuckle: the Rubus Chamaemorus, Morochka, or Cloudberries: the Vaccinium Myrtillus, Uliginoſum, Vitis Idaea, and Oxycoccos, or Bilberries, Marſh Bilberries, Red Bilberries, and Cranberries: the Empetrum Nigrum, or Heathberries: the Prunus Padus, or Bird Cherry: Crataegus Oxyacantha, or White Thorn with red and with black berries: the Juniperus Communis, or Common Juniper: and finally, of thoſe of the Sorbus Aucuparia, or Common Service.

Of the Epilobium Latifolium, Sp. Pl. 494, or Kipri, is brewed a common beverage; and, with the aſſiſtance of the Sweet Plant, is made an excellent vinegar: the leaves are uſed as a tea, and the pith is mixed with many of the diſhes, and ſerved up green as a deſert. When the infuſion of it is mixed with the Sweet Herb in the diſtillation, much more brandy is procured than if water alone is uſed.

[CXIX]The Polygonum Biſtorta, Snake-weed, or Jikoum, is eaten freſh or dried, and often pounded with the Caviar. The Chaerophyllum Sylveſtre, Wild Chervil, or Cow-weed, the Morkavai of the natives, is eaten green in the ſpring, or made into ſour krout. The Solidago Itſchitſchu, Fl. Sib. ii. 170, is dried and boiled with fiſh; and the broth from it taſtes as if the fleſh of the Argali or wild ſheep had been ſeethed in it. The root of Kotkonnia, a ſpecies of Tradeſcantia, is eaten either freſh, or uſed with the roes of fiſh: the berries have an agreable acidity, like an unripe apple, but will not keep, therefore they muſt be eaten as ſoon as they are gathered. Allium Urſinum, Tcheremcha, our Wild Garlic, is very common, and uſeful in medicine as well as food; both Ruſſians and natives gather it in great quantities for winter ſervice: they ſteep it in water, then mix it with cabbage, onions, and other ingredients, and form out of them a ragout, which they eat cold. It is alſo the principal remedy for the ſcurvy. As ſoon as this plant appears above the ſnow, they ſeem to put this dreadful diſorder at defiance, and find a cure almoſt in its worſt ſtages. The Potentilla fruticoſa, Sp. Pl. i. 709, or Shrubby Cinquefoil, is very efficacious in the dyſentery, or in freſh wounds. The Dryas pentapetala, Sp. Pl. i. 717, or Ichagban, is employed in ſwellings or pains of the limbs. That dreadful poiſon the Cicuta viroſa, Sp. Pl. i. 366, Water Hemlock, the Omeg, is applied to uſe, by the bold practitioners of this country, in caſes of pains in the back. They ſweat the patient profuſely, and then rub his back with the plant, avoiding to touch the loins, which, they ſay, would bring on immediate death.

The trees of uſe are a dwarf ſpecies of Pinus Cembra, TREES. or Pine with edible kernels; it grows in great quantities on both the mountains and plains, covered with moſs. It never grows upright, but creeps on the ground, and is therefore called by the Ruſſians, Slanetz. The natives eat the kernels, with even the cones, which brings on a teneſmus; but the chief uſe of the tree is as a ſovereign medicine in the ſcurvy. BERING taught the Kamtſchatkans to make a decoction of it: but they have neglected his inſtructions, notwithſtanding they ſaw numbers of his people reſtored to health in a ſhort time, and ſnatched, as it were, from the jaws of death*. Even at this time the Ruſſian coloniſts periſh miſerably with the diſorder, notwithſtanding the remedy is before their eyes.

The Pinus Larix, or Larch-tree, grows only on the river of Kamtſchatka, and the ſtreams which run into it. This tree is of the firſt uſe in the mechanical ſervices of the country: with it they build their houſes, their fortifications, and boats. They make uſe of the Populus alba, or White Poplar, for the ſame purpoſes. [CXX] Of the Betula alba, or Common Birch, a tree ſo uſeful to theſe northern nations, they make their ſledges and canoes; and cut the freſh bark into ſmall ſlices like vermicelli, and eat it with their dried caviar: they alſo tap the trees, and drink the liquor without any preparation. With the bark of the alder they dye their leather; but that, and every tree they have near the coaſt, is ſtunted, ſo that they are obliged to go far inland for timber of proper ſize.

I muſt add, as a vegetable of uſe in oeconomics, the Triticum, Gm. Sib. i. 119, No 56, which grows in great quantities along the ſhores, which they mow, and work into mats, which ſerve for bed clothes and curtains; into mantles, ſmooth on one ſide, and with a pile on the other, which is water-proof. They alſo make with it ſacks, and very elegant baſkets; theſe, as well as the mats, they ornament with ſplit whale-bones, and work into variety of figures*. The Urtica dioica, or Common Nettle, is another plant of great uſe: this they pluck in Auguſt or September, tie in bundles, and dry on their huts: they tear it to pieces, beat, and clean it; then ſpin it between their hands, and twiſt the thread round a ſpindle. It is the only material they have to make their nets; which, for want of ſkill in the preparation, will rot, and laſt no longer than one ſeaſon.

QUADRUPEDS.In reſpect to the quadrupeds of this country, I have reaſon to think, from the great aſſiſtance I have received from the Ruſſian academiſts, or their labors, that my account of them, in my zoological part of this Work, can receive little addition. I requeſt that the Brown Bear, No 20, may be ſubſtituted inſtead of the Black, No 19, as the native of Kamtſchatka. I was led into the miſtake by the ſuſpicions of a moſt able naturaliſt. I am ſince informed, by the beſt authority (that of Captain KING) that it is the brown ſpecies which is found there; that they are carnivorous§, and prey at times on the Argali or wild ſheep; but do not attack man, except urged by extreme hunger, or provoked by wounds, or by the ſlaughter of their young; when nothing but their death can ſecure the ſafety of the perſons who fall in their way. In the firſt caſe, they will hunt mankind by the ſcent, and ſacrifice them to their want of food, which uſually is fiſh or berries.—The Kamtſchatkans never read Pope, but obſerve his advice: ‘Learn from the Beaſts the phyſic of the field.’ The Bear is their great maſter; and they owe all their knowlege in medicine and ſurgery, and the polite arts, to this animal. They obſerve the herbs to which he has recourſe when he is ill, or when he is wounded, and the ſame ſimples prove [CXXI] equally reſtorative to the two-legged Urſine race. The laſt even acknowlege the Bear as their dancing-maſter, and are moſt apt ſcholars in mimicking his attitudes and graces*. I was informed by one of the gentlemen who was on the voyage, that the Sea Otter, No 36, was ſeen on the firſt arrival on the American coaſt; but, as it is not mentioned in that excellent and magnificent work till the arrival of the ſhips in Nootka ſound, I will not inſiſt on the accuracy of its latitude.

The Argali yields a diſh of moſt excellent flavor.ARGALI. The natives work the horns into ſpoons, ſmall cups, and platters; and have frequently a ſmall one hanging at their belts, by way of a drinking horn, in their hunting expeditions.

The Dogs are like the Pomeranian, but vaſtly larger; the hair rather coarſer,DOGS. and the uſual color light dun, or dirty creme-color. Bitches are never uſed for the draught, but dogs alone; which are trained to it from their puppy-hood, by being tied with thongs to ſtakes, with their food placed at a ſmall diſtance beyond their reach; ſo that by conſtant laboring and ſtraining, they acquire both ſtrength of limb and habit of drawing.

The leonine and urſine Seals, and the Manati,SEALS. muſt have been on their migrations during the time the navigators viſited this peninſula; for they ſaw not one of thoſe curious animals. The common Seals, being ſtationary, were met with in great numbers. The bottle-noſed Seal, or Sea-Lion of Lord Anſon, is totally unknown in theſe ſeas. I refer the reader, for a view of the quadrupeds and birds of Kamtſchatka, to the catalogue which Captain KING honored with a place in the third volume of the Voyage§. I ſhall only add, that the claſs of Auks is far the moſt numerous of any, and contains ſix ſpecies unknown to Europe; that the only bird which has eſcaped me is a ſmall Blue Petrel , ſeen in numbers in about lat. 59. 48, off the northern part of the peninſula.

Kamtſchatka is deſtitute of every ſpecies of ſerpent and frog.REPTILES. Lizards are very frequent, and are deteſted by the natives, who believe them to be ſpies ſent by the infernal gods to examine their actions, and predict their deaths. If they catch one, they cut it into ſmall pieces, to prevent it from giving any account of its miſſion: if it eſcapes out of their hands, they abandon themſelves to melancholy, and expect every moment their diſſolution; which often happens through fear, and ſerves to confirm the ſuperſtition of the country.INSECTS. The air is very unfavorable [CXXII] to inſects, except lice and fleas, which are in all their quarters; and, filthy to relate! are eaten by theſe beaſtly people*. Bugs are acquiſitions of late years, imported into the bay of Awatcha.

FISH.The fiſh of Kamtſchatka are with difficulty enumerated. There does not ſeem to be any great variety of genera; yet the individuals under each ſpecies are found in moſt aſtoniſhing abundance. Providence hath been peculiarly attentive to the natives of this peninſula, by furniſhing them in ſo ample a manner, who for the greater part muſt for ever be deprived of ſupport derived from grain and cattle. The vegetables they have are ſufficient to correct the putreſcent quality of the dried fiſh, and often form an ingredient in the diſhes; which are prepared different ways. The Joukola is made of the ſalmon kind, cut into ſix pieces, and dried either in the open air or ſmoked: the roes are another diſh in high eſteem with them, either dried in the air, or rolled in the leaves of different plants, and dried before the fire. They can live along time on a ſmall quantity of this food, and eat with it the bark of birch or willow trees, to aſſiſt them in ſwallowing a food ſo very viſcid; but their ambroſial repaſt is the Huigul, or fiſh flung into a pit till it is quite rotten, when it is ſerved up in the ſtate of carrion, and with a ſtench unſupportable to every noſe but that of a Kamtſchatkan .

The Fin Whale,WHALE. Br. Zool. iii. No 18, is very frequent, and is of ſingular uſe to the inhabitants. They eat the fleſh; preſerve the fat for kitchen uſe and for their lamps; with the corneous laminae they few the ſeams of their canoes, and make nets for the larger ſort of fiſh; they form the ſliders of their ſledges with the under jaw-bones, and likewiſe work them into knives; with the blade-bones, worked down to a ſharp edge, they form ſcythes, and moſt ſucceſsfully mow the graſs. The Tſchutſki verify the relation of Pliny , and, like the Gedroſi of old, frame their dwellings with the ribs§; with the ligaments they make excellent ſnares for different animals; with the inteſtines dried, cleaned, and blown, they make bags for their greaſe and oil; and with the ſkins the ſoles of their ſhoes, and ſtraps and thongs for various purpoſes. The Tſchutſki take theſe animals by harpooning; the Oloutores, in nets made of thongs cut out of the ſkins of the Walrus; and the Kamtſchatkans, by ſhooting them with darts or arrows, the points of which, having been anointed with the juice of the Zgate, a ſpecies of Anemone and Ranunculus , are ſo noxious as to bring ſpeedy death from the ſlighteſt wound, like the celebrated poiſon of the Paragua Indians. The vaſt animals in queſtion, [CXXIII] when ſtruck with it, are infected with ſuch agonies that they cannot bear the ſea, but ruſh on ſhore, and expire with dreadful groans and bellowing.

The Kaſatka or Grampus,GRAMPUS. Br. Zool. iii. No 26, is very common in theſe ſeas: they are dreaded by the natives, who even make offerings to them, and entreat their mercy, leaſt they ſhould overſet their boats; yet, if theſe fiſh are thrown on ſhore, they apply them to the ſame uſes as the Whale*.

The Motkoïa or Akoul, or White Shark, Br. Zool. iii. No 42, is among the uſeful fiſh. They eat the fleſh, and form of the inteſtines and bladder, bags to hold their oil. In the chaſe of this fiſh they never call it by its name, for fear of provoking it to burſt its bladder.

Lampries, Br. Zool. iii. No 27; Eels, — 57; Wolf-fiſh, — 65; common Codfiſh? — 73; Hadock, — 74; and Hake, — 81, are found in the Kamtſchatkan ſea: and I alſo ſuſpect, that the three-bearded Cod, — No 87, is alſo met with: it is called there Morſkie Nalimi . An elegant ſpecies of Flounder, of excellent flavor, was taken here in abundance by our navigators: the back was ſtudded with prickly tubercles, and marked longitudinally with lines of black on a brown ground. The Jerchei, poſſibly our Ruffe, — No 127, is among the fiſh of the country; as is a ſpecies of the Engliſh Sticklebacks.

But the fiſh of the firſt importance to the Kamtſchatkans, SALMON. and on which they depend for ſubſiſtence, are the anadromous kinds, or thoſe which at ſtated ſeaſons aſcend the rivers and lakes out of the ſea. Theſe are entirely of the Salmon genus, with exception to the common Herring, which in autumn quits the ſalt water. It is ſayed, that every ſpecies of Salmon is found here. I may with certainty adjoin, that ſeveral of the Sibirian ſpecies, with variety peculiar to this country, aſcend the Kamtſchatkan rivers in multitudes incredible. The inhabitants dignify ſome of their months by the names of the fiſh. One is called Kouiche, or the month of Red Fiſhes; another, Ajaba, or that of Little White Fiſh; a third, Kaiko, or of the fiſh Kaiko; and a fourth, Kijou, or the month of the Great White Fiſh §. It is obſervable, that each ſhoal keeps apart from others of different ſpecies, and frequently prefers a ſeparate river, notwithſtanding the mouths may be almoſt contiguous. They often come up in ſuch numbers as to force the water before them, and even to dam up the rivers, and make them overflow their banks; inſomuch that, on the fall of the water, ſuch multitudes are left on dry ground, as to make a ſtench capable of cauſing a peſtilence, was it not fortunately diſperſed by the violence of the winds; beſides, the bears and dogs aſſiſt, by preying on them, to leſſen the ill effects.

[CXXIV]Every ſpecies of Salmon dies in the ſame river or lake in which it is born, and to which it returns to ſpawn. In the third year, male and female conſort together, and the latter depoſits its ſpawn in a hole formed with its tail and fins in the ſand; after which both ſexes pine away, and ceaſe to live. A fiſh of a year's growth continues near the place, guards the ſpawn, and returns to the ſea with the new-born fry in November *. The Salmons of this country ſpawn but once in their lives: thoſe of Sibiria and Europe, the rivers of which are deep, and abound with inſect food, are enabled to continue the firſt great command of nature during the period of their exiſtence. In Kamtſchatka the rivers are chilly, ſhallow, rapid, full of rocks, and deſtitute of nouriſhment for ſuch multitudes: ſuch therefore which cannot force their way to the neighborhood of the tepid ſtreams, or get back to the ſea in time, univerſally periſh; but Providence has given ſuch reſources, in the ſpawners, that no difference in numbers is ever obſerved between the returning ſeaſons. It is ſingular, that neither the lakes or rivers have any ſpecies of fiſh but what come from the ſea. All the lakes (for this country abounds with them) communicate with the ſea; but their entrance, as well as that of many of the rivers, is entirely barred up with ſand brought by the tempeſtuous winds, which confine the fiſh moſt part of the winter, till they are releaſed by the ſtorms taking another direction.

The ſpecies which appears firſt is the Tſhawytſcha. TSHAWYTSCHA. This is by much the largeſt; it weighs ſometimes between fifty and ſixty pounds, and its depth is very great in proportion to the length. The jaws are equal, and never hooked: the teeth large, and in ſeveral rows: the ſcales are larger than thoſe of the common Salmon;P. D. 12. P. 16. V. 10. A. 15. on the back duſky grey, on the ſides ſilvery: the fins bluiſh white, and all parts unſpotted: the tail is lunated: the fleſh, during its reſidence in the ſea, is red; but it becomes white in freſh waters. It is confined, on the eaſtern ſide of the peninſula, to the river of Kamtſchatka and Awatcha; and on the weſtern to the Bolchaia-reka, and a few others; nor is it ever ſeen beyond lat. 54. It enters the mouths of the rivers about the middle of May, with ſuch impetuoſity as to raiſe the water before it in waves. It goes in far leſs numbers than the other ſpecies; is infinitely more eſteemed; and is not uſed as a common food, but reſerved for great entertainments. The natives watch its arrival, which is announced by the rippling of the water; take it in ſtrong nets; and always eat the firſt they take, under a notion that the omiſſion would be a great crime.Numbers of rays in the dorſal, pectoral, ventral, and anal fins.

[CXXV]The Naerka is another ſpecies, called by the Ruſſians, Kraſnaya ryba, NAERKA. from the intenſe purpliſh redneſs of the fleſh. It is of the form of the common Salmon;P. D. 11. P. 16. V. 10. A. 15. but never exceeds ſixteen pounds in weight. When it firſt enters the rivers it is of a ſilvery brightneſs, with a bluiſh back and fins: when it leaves the ſea the teeth are ſmall, and jaws ſtrait; but after it has been ſome time in the freſh water, the jaws grow crooked (eſpecially in the male) and the teeth large. It begins to aſcend the rivers in vaſt numbers in June; penetrates to their very ſources; and returns in September to the ſea, firſt reſting for ſome time in the deep parts of the intervening lakes. It is taken in nets, either in the bays, as it approaches the rivers, or in the rivers, after it has quitted the ſea*.

The Kyſutch, KYSUTCH. or Bjelaya ryba, or White Fiſh of the Ruſſians, aſcends the rivers in July, particularly ſuch as are diſcharged from the inland lakes, and remain till December, when all the old fiſh periſh, and the fry take to the ſea.P. D. 11. P. 14. V. 10. A. 14. The upper jaw of the male, in its laſt period, becomes crooked. This ſpecies has the form of a common Salmon, but never attains three feet in length. It is of a ſilvery gloſſy color, ſpotted about the back; but in the rivers acquires a reddiſh caſt: the jaws are long and blunt: the teeth large: the fleſh is reddiſh before it quits the ſea; but in the freſh water grows white. It is reckoned the moſt excellent of the light-colored fiſh.

The Keta or Kayko, KETA. in form and ſize reſembles the laſt; but the head is ſhorter and more blunt: the tail is lunated: the fleſh white:P. D. 14. P. 15. V. 11. A. 18. the color of the ſcales a ſilvery white: the back greeniſh; and the whole free from ſpots. It aſcends the rivers in July, and the fiſhery continues till October. This ſpecies is found in great abundance; and is ſo common, that the Joukola made with it is called houſhold bread.

The Gorbuſcha, GORBUSCHA. or Hunch-back, arrives at the ſame time with the laſt. In form it reſembles the Grayling: never exceeds a foot and a half in length:P. D. 12. P. 15. V. 10. A. 15. is of a ſilvery color, and unſpotted: the tail forked: the fleſh white. After it has been ſome time in the freſh water it changes its ſhape (the male eſpecially) in a moſt ſurprizing manner. The jaws and teeth grow prodigiouſly long, eſpecially the upper, which at firſt is ſhorteſt, but ſoon ſhoots beyond the under, and grows crooked downwards; the body becomes emaciated, and the meat bad: but what is moſt characteriſtic, an enormous bunch riſes juſt before the firſt dorſal fin, to which it owes its name. Its fleſh is bad; ſo that this fiſh falls to the ſhare of the dogs.

[CXXVI]The Malma, MALMA. or Golet of the Ruſſians, grows to the weight of twenty pounds, and to the length of about twenty-eight inches.P. D. 12. P. 14. V. 8. A. 10. It is the moſt ſlender and cylindrical of all the genus. The head reſembles that of a trout: the ſcales are very ſmall: the back and ſides bluiſh, with ſcattered ſpots of ſcarlet red: the belly white: ventral and anal fins red: tail ſlightly forked. This and the two following are ſporadic, going diſperſedly, and not in ſhoals. It aſcends the rivers with the laſt, and attains their very ſources. It feeds on the ſpawn of the other ſpecies, and grows very fat. The natives ſalt thoſe they take in autumn, and preſerve frozen thoſe which are caught when the froſts commence*.

MILKTSCHITSCH.The Milktſchitſch is a ſcarce ſpecies, in form like a young Salmon; but the ſcales larger in proportion,P. D. 11. P. 14. V. 10. A. 13. and the body more flat: it never exceeds a foot and a half in length: is of a ſilvery white, with a bluiſh back: noſe conical: jaws equal: tail ſlightly forked.

The Mykiſs, MYKISS. appears at firſt very lean, but grows ſoon fat: it is very voracious: feeds not only on fiſh,P. D. 12. P. 14. V. 10. A. 12. but inſects and rats, while ſwimming over the rivers; and is ſo fond of the berries of vaccinium vitis idaea, that it will dart out of the water, and ſnatch at both leaves and berries, which hang over the banks. In ſhape it reſembles a common Salmon: ſeldom grows above two feet long: has large ſcales, blunt noſe, and numerous teeth: the back is duſky, marked with black ſpots; and on each ſide is a broad band of bright red: the belly white. It is a ſpecies of excellent flavor; but is ſcarcer than the other kinds. Its time of arrival is not known: M. STELLER therefore ſuſpects that it aſcends the rivers beneath the ice.

The Kunſha, KUNSHA. mentioned in page CIV, frequents the bays of this country, but never advances inland; and grows to the length of two feet: the noſe is ſhort and pointed: the back and ſides duſky, marked with great yellowiſh ſpots, ſome round, others oblong: the belly white: the lower fins and tail blue: the fleſh white, and excellent. It is a ſcarce fiſh in theſe parts; but near Ochotſk aſcends the rivers in great ſhoals.

I conclude this diviſion of the tribe with the common Salmon, which is frequent here, and, like the others, aſcends the rivers, equally to the advantage of the natives of the country.

Of the Salmon which LINNAEUS diſtinguiſhed by the title of Coregoni is the Inghaghitſh, INGHAGHITSH. P. D. 8, 9 P. 12. V. 10. A. 12. which has the habit of a ſmall carp, with very large ſcales: the jaws nearly of equal length: the eyes very great, and ſilvery: the teeth very minute: the body ſilvery, bluiſh on the back: tail forked: it does not exceed five inches [CXXVII] in length. It arrives in ſpring and autumn, and in both ſeaſons is full of ſpawn, and ſmells like a ſmelt.

The Innyagha is another ſmall kind,INNYAGHA. about five inches long, and not unlike the S. Albula of LINNAEUS. It is a rare ſpecies, and found but in few rivers. P. D. 9. P. 11. V. 8. A. 16.

The moſt ſingular is the Ouiki, OUIKI. or Salmo Catervarius of STELLER. It belongs to the Oſmeri of LINNAEUS. Swims in immenſe ſhoals on the eaſtern coaſt of Kamtſchatka, and the new-diſcovered iſlands, where it is often thrown up by the ſea to the height of ſome feet, upon a large extent of ſhore: is exceſſively unwholeſome as a food, and cauſes fluxes even in dogs. It never exceeds ſeven inches in length. Juſt above the ſide-line is a rough faſcia, beſet with minute pyramidal ſcales, ſtanding upright, ſo as to appear like the pile of ſhag: their uſe is moſt curious— while they are ſwimming, and even when they are flung on ſhore, two, three, or even as many as ten, will adhere as if glued together, by means of this pile, inſomuch that if one is taken up, all the reſt are taken up at the ſame time.

To conclude this liſt of Kamtſchatkan Salmon, I muſt add the Salmo Thymallus, or Grayling; the S. Cylindraceus, before deſcribed; the Salmo Albula, Lin. Syſt. 512; and the Salmo Eperlanus, or common Smelt, to thoſe which aſcend the rivers.— For this account I am indebted to Doctor PALLAS, who extracted it from the papers of STELLER, for the uſe of this Work.

The Herring,HERRING. both the common and the variety, found in the gulph of Bothnia, called the Membras, and by the Suedes, Stroeming, Faun. Suec. p. 128, viſit theſe coaſts in ſhoals, perhaps equal to thoſe of Europe. There are two ſeaſons, the firſt about the end of May, the ſecond in October. The firſt ſpecies are remarkably fine and large*; they aſcend the rivers, and enter the lakes: the autumnal migrants are cloſed up in them by the ſhifting of the ſand at the mouths of the entrance, and remain confined the whole winter. The natives catch them in ſummer in nets; and in winter in moſt amazing numbers, by breaking holes in the ice, into which they drop their nets, then cover the opening with mats, and leave a ſmall hole for one of their companions to peep through, and obſerve the coming of the fiſh; when they draw up their booty: and ſtring part on pack-thread for drying; and from the remainder they preſs an oil white as the butter of Finland .

The ſea,SEA. on which theſe people depend for their very exiſtence, is finely adapted for the retreat and preſervation of fiſh. It does not conſiſt of a level uniform bottom, liable to be ruffled with ſtorms, but of deep vallies and lofty [CXXVIII] mountains, ſuch as yield ſecurity and tranquillity to the finned inhabitants. We find the ſoundings to be moſt unequal: in ſome places only twenty-two fathoms, in others the lead has not found a bottom with a hundred and ſixty fathoms of line. On ſuch places the fiſh might reſt undiſturbed during the rage of the tempeſtuous winters. I do not find the leaſt notice of ſhells being met with in theſe ſeas: either there are none, or they are pelagic, and eſcape the eyes of the navigators. But nature probably hath made ample proviſion for the inhabitants of the ſea, in the quantity of ſea-plants which it yields; STELLER, the great explorer of this region, enumerates the following, many of which are of uncommon elegance:

  • Fucus peucedanifolius, Gm. Hiſt. Fucor. 76
  • Fucus turbinatus 97
  • Fucus corymbiferus, E. 124
  • Fucus dulcis, E. 189
  • Fucus tamariſcifolius*, E.
  • Fucus bifidus 201
  • Fucus polyphyllus 206
  • Fucus clathrus 211
  • Fucus myrica 88
  • Fucus roſa marina 102
  • Fucus crenatus 160
  • Fucus fimbriatus 200
  • Fucus anguſtifolius 205
  • Fucus agarum 210
  • Fucus quercus marina
  • Fucus veficuloſus, Sp. Pl. 1626, E.
  • Ulva glandiformis 232
  • Ulva Priapus 231

Of theſe the Quercus marina is uſed as a remedy in the dyſentery; and the females of Kamtſchatka tinge their cheeks with an infuſion of the Fucus tamariſcifolius in the oil of Seals.

TIDES.In the harbours of Sts. Peter and Paul the greateſt riſe of the tides was five feet eight inches at full and change of the moon, at thirty-ſix minutes paſt four, and they were very regular every twelve hours. The Ruſſian philoſophers obſerved here a ſingular phaenomenon in the flux and reflux of the ſea twice in the twenty-four hours, in which is one great flood and one ſmall flood; the laſt of which is called Manikha. At certain times nothing but the water of the river is ſeen within its proper channel; at other times, in the time of ebb, the waters are obſerved to overflow their banks. In the Manikha, after an ebb of ſix hours, the water ſinks about three feet, and the tide returns for three hours, but does not riſe above a foot; a ſeven-hours ebb ſucceeds, which carries off the ſea-water, and leaves the bay dry. Thus it happens three days before and [CXXIX] after the full moon; after which the great tide diminiſhes, and the Manikha, or little tide, increaſes*.

The rivers of the country riſe in the midſt of the great chain of mountains, and flow on each ſide into the ſeas of Ochotſk, or that of Kamtſckatka. They furniſh a ready paſſage in boats or canoes (with the intervention of carrying-places) quite acroſs the peninſula. As has been mentioned, the waters yield no fiſh of their own, but are the retreat of myriads of migrants from the neighboring ſeas.

This peninſula, and the country to the weſt,NATIVES. are inhabited by two nations; the northern parts by the Koriacs, who are divided into the Rein-deer or wandering, and the fixed Koriacs; KORIACS. and the ſouthern part by the Kamtſchatkans, properly ſo called: the firſt lead an erratic life,WANDERING. in the tract bounded by the Penſchinſka ſea to the ſouth-eaſt; the river Kowyma to the weſt; and the river Anadir to the north. They wander from place to place with their Rein-deer, in ſearch of the moſs, the food of thoſe animals, their only wealth. They are ſqualid, cruel, and warlike, the terror of the fixed Koriacs, as much as the Tſchutſki are of them. They never frequent the ſea, nor live on fiſh. Their habitations are jourts, or places half ſunk in the earth: they never uſe balagans, or ſummer-houſes elevated on poſts, like the Kamtſchatkans: are in their perſons lean, and very ſhort: have ſmall heads and black hair, which they ſhave frequently: their faces are oval: noſe ſhort: their eyes ſmall: mouth large: beard black and pointed, but often eradicated.

The fixed Koriacs are likewiſe ſhort, but rather taller than the others,FIXED. and ſtrongly made: they inhabit the north of the peninſula: the Anadir is alſo their boundary to the north; the ocean to the eaſt; and the Kamtſchatkans to the ſouth. They have few Rein-deer, which they uſe in their ſledges; but neither of the tribes of Koriacs are civilized enough to apply them to the purpoſes of the dairy. Each ſpeak a different dialect of the ſame language; but the fixed in moſt things reſemble the Kamtſchatkans; and, like them, live almoſt entirely on fiſh. They are timid to a high degree, and behave to their wandering brethren with the utmoſt ſubmiſſion; who call them by a name which ſignifies their ſlaves. Theſe poor people ſeem to have no alternative; for, by reaſon of the ſcarcity of Rein-deer, they depend on theſe tyrants for the eſſential article of cloathing. I cannot trace the origin of theſe two nations; but from the features may pronounce them offspring of Tartars, which have ſpread to the eaſt, and degenerated in ſize and ſtrength by the rigour of the climate, and often by ſcarcity of food.

[CXXX] KAMTSCHATKANS.The true Kamtſchatkans * poſſeſes the country from the river Ukoi to the ſouthern extremity, the cape Lopatka. They are ſuppoſed, by M. STELLER, to have been derived from the Mongalian Chineſe, not only from a ſimilarity in the termination of many of their words, but in the reſemblance of their perſons, which are ſhort. Their complexion is ſwarthy: their beard ſmall: their hair black: face broad and flat: eyes ſmall and ſunk: eye-brows thin: belly pendent: legs ſmall— circumſtances common to them and the Mongalians. It is conjectured, that in ſome very remote age they fled hither, to eſcape the yoke of the eaſtern conquerors, notwithſtanding they believe themſelves to be aboriginal, created and placed on the ſpot by their god Koutkou.

RELIGION.In reſpect to their deity, they are perfect minute philoſophers. They find fault with his diſpenſations; blaſpheme and reproach him with having made too many mountains, precipices, breakers, ſhoals, and cataracts; with forming ſtorms and rains; and when they are deſcending, in the winter, from their barren rocks, they load him with imprecations for the fatigue they undergo. In their morals they likewiſe bear a great ſimilitude to numbers among the moſt poliſhed rank in the European nations—they think nothing vitious that may be accompliſhed without danger; and give full looſe to every crime, provided it comes within the pale of ſecurity.

GENII.They have alſo their leſſer deities, or genii. Each of them have their peculiar charge; to theſe they pay conſiderable veneration, and make offerings to them, to divert their anger or enſure their protection. The Kamouli preſide over the mountains, particularly the vulcanic; the Ouchakthou, over the woods; Mitg, over the ſea; Gaetch, over the ſubterraneous world; and Fouila is the author of earthquakes. They believe that the world is eternal; that the ſoul is immortal; that in the world below it will be reunited to the body, and experience all the pains uſual in its former ſtate; but that it never will ſuffer hunger, but have every thing in great abundance: that the rich will become poor, and the poor rich; a ſort of juſt diſpenſation, and balance of former good and evil. But almoſt all theſe ſuperſtitions are vaniſhed by the attention of the Ruſſians to their converſion. There are few who have not embraced the Chriſtian religion. Churches have been built, and ſchools erected, in which they are ſucceſsfully taught the language of their conquerors, which has already almoſt worn out that of the native people.

NUMBERS OF PEOPLE.The country was very populous at the arrival of the Ruſſians; but, after a dreadful viſitation of the ſmall-pox, which in 1767 ſwept away twenty thouſand [CXXXI] ſouls*, at preſent there are not above three thouſand who pay tribute, the inhabitants of the Kuril iſles included. Here are about four hundred of the military Ruſſians and Coſſacks, beſides a number of Ruſſian traders and emigrants perpetually pouring in, who intermix with the natives in marriage, and probably in time will extinguiſh the aboriginal race. The offspring is a great improvement; for it is remarked, that the breed is far more active than the pure Ruſſian or Coſſack. Sunk in lordly indolence, they leave all the work to the Kamtſchatkans, or to their women; and ſuffer the penalty of their lazineſs, by the ſcurvy in its moſt frightful forms.

The Kamtſchatkans ſeem to retain the antient form of their dreſs;DRESS. but during ſummer it is compoſed of foreign materials; in the warm ſeaſon both ſexes uſe nankeen, linen, and ſilk; in winter, the ſkins of animals well dreſſed: the dreſs of men and women reſembles a carter's frock with long ſleeves, furred at the wriſts, the bottom, and about the neck. On their head is a hood of fur, ſometimes of the ſhaggy ſkin of a dog, and often of the elegant ſkin of the earleſs Marmot. Trouſers, boots, and furred mittens, compoſe the reſt. The habit of ceremony of a Toion or chieftain is very magnificent, and will coſt a hundred and twenty rubels: in antient times it was hung over with the tails of animals, and his furred hood flowed over each ſhoulder, with the reſpectability of a full-bottomed perriwig in the days of Charles II. The figure given in the Hiſtory of Kamtſchatka, tranſlated into French, exhibits a great man in all his pride of dreſs; but ſo rapidly has the preſent race of natives copied the Ruſſians, that poſſibly in ſo ſhort a ſpace as half a century, this habit, as well as numbers of other articles and cuſtoms, may be ranked among the antiquities of the country.

Bows and arrows are now quite diſuſed.ARMS. Formerly they uſed bows made of larch-wood, covered with the bark of the birch. The arrows were headed with ſtone or bone, and their lances with the ſame materials. Their armour was either mats, or formed of thongs cut out of the ſkins of Seals, and ſewed together, ſo as to make a pliable cuiraſs; which they fixed on their left ſide; a board defended their breaſt, and a high one on their back defended both that and the head.

Their ſavage and beaſtly hoſpitality is among the obſolete cuſtoms.HOSPITALITY. Formerly, as a mark of reſpect to a gueſt, the hoſt ſet before him as much food as would ſerve ten people. Both were ſtripped naked: the hoſt politely touched nothing, but compelled his friend to devour what was ſet before him, till he was [CXXXII] quite gorged; and at the ſame time heated the place, by inceſſantly pouring water on hot ſtones, till it became unſupportable. When the gueſt was crammed up to the throat, the generous landlord, on his knees, ſtuffed into his mouth a great ſlice of whale's fat, cut off what hung out, and cried, in a ſurly tone, Tana, or There! by which he fully diſcharged his duty; and, between heat and cramming, obliged the poor gueſt to cry for mercy, and a releaſe from the heat, and the danger of being choaked with the noble welcome: oftentimes he was obliged to purchaſe his diſmiſſion with moſt coſtly preſents; but was ſure to retaliate on the firſt opportunity*.

DWELLINGS.From the birds they learned the art of building their balagans or ſummer-houſes. They ſeem like neſts of a conic form, perched on high poles inſtead of trees; with a hole on one ſide, like that of the magpie, for the entrance. Their jourts, or winter reſidences, are copied from the oeconomic Mouſe, p. 134; but with leſs art, and leſs cleanlineſs. It is partly ſunk under ground; the ſides and top ſupported by beams, and wattled, and the whole covered with turf. In this they live gregariouſly, to the number of ſix families in each; in a ſtate intolerable to an European, by reaſon of ſmoke, heat, and ſtench, from their ſtore of dried or putrid fiſh, and from their lazineſs, in never going out to perform their offerings to Cloacina .

Inſtigated by avarice, the Ruſſians made a conqueſt of this ſavage country; and found their account in it, from the great value of its furry productions. They have added to their dominions this extremity of Aſia, diſtant at leaſt four thouſand miles from their capital.ROADS TO KAMTSCHATKA. The journey to it is ſtill attended with great difficulties, through wild and barren regions, over dreadful mountains; and poſſibly impracticable, but for the multitude of Sibirian rivers, which, with ſhort intervals of land, facilitate the paſſage. Travellers uſually take their departure out of Sibiria from Jakutz, on the river Lena, in lat. 62: they go either by water along the river, to its conflux with the Aldun, along the Aldun to the Mai, and from that river up the Judoma; and from near the head of that river to Ochotſk, the port from whence they embark, and croſs the ſea of Ochotſk to Bolſchaia-reka, the port of the weſtern ſide of Kamtſchatka. The whole journey uſually takes up the ſhort ſummer: that over the hills to Ochotſk (and which is moſt convenient) was performed by STELLER in thirty-four days, excluding ſeven of reſt.

The Kuril or Kurilſki iſles,KURIL ISLES. which probably once lengthened the peninſula of Kamtſchatka, before they were convulſed from it, are a ſeries of iſlands running [CXXXIII] ſouth from the low promontory Lopatka, in lat. 51; between which and Shoomſka, the moſt northerly, is only the diſtance of one league. On the lofty Paramouſer, the ſecond in the chain, is a high-peaked mountain, probably vulcanic*:VULCANIC. on the fourth, called Araumakutan, is another vulcano; on Uruſs is another; on Storgu two; and on Kunatir, or Kaunachir, one. Theſe three make part of the group which paſs under the name of the celebrated land of Jeſo . Japan abounds with vulcanoes§; ſo that there is a ſeries of ſpiracles from Kamtſchatka to Japan, the laſt great link of this extenſive chain. Time may have been, when the whole was a continuation of continent, rent aſunder before the laboring earth gave vent to its inward ſtruggles, through the mouths of the frequent vulcanoes. Even with theſe diſcharges, Japan has ſuffered conſiderably by earthquakes. Vulcanoes are local evils, but extenſive benefits.

The Ruſſians ſoon annexed theſe iſlands to their conqueſts. The ſea abounded with Sea Otters, and the land with Bears and Foxes; and ſome of them ſheltered the Sable. Temptations ſufficient for the Ruſſians to invade theſe iſlands; but the rage after the furs of the Sea Otters has been ſo great, that they are become extremely ſcarce, both here and in Kamtſchatka.

The iſlands which lie to the eaſt of that peninſula, and form a chain between it and America, muſt now engage our attention. They lie in the form of a creſcent, and are divided into three groupes; the Aleutian, the Andreanoffskie, and the Fox iſles: but mention muſt firſt be made of BERING'S iſle, and that of Mednoi, and one or two ſmall and of little note. Theſe lie about two hundred and fifty verſts to the eaſt of the mouth of Kamtſchatka river.BERING'S ISLE. BERING'S is in lat. 55, where that great ſeaman was ſhipwrecked in November 1741, on his return from his American diſcoveries; and, after enduring great hardſhips, periſhed miſerably. Numbers of his people died of the ſcurvy, with all the dreadful ſymptoms attendant on thoſe who periſhed by the ſame diſeaſe in Lord Anſon's voyage; the ſurvivors, among whom was the philoſopher STELLER, reached Kamtſchatka in Auguſt 1742, in a veſſel conſtructed out of the wreck of their ſhip. The iſle is about ſeventy or eighty verſts long; conſiſts of high granitical mountains, craggy with rocks and peaks, changing into free-ſtone towards the promontories. All the vallies run from north to ſouth: hills of ſand, formed by inundations of the ſea, floated wood, and ſkeletons of marine animals, are found at great diſtances from the ſhore, at thirty fathoms perpendicular height above the high-water level; which ſerve as a monument of the violent inundations that the vulcanoes before mentioned [CXXXIV] produce in theſe ſeas. Farther, the effect of the meteoric waters, and of the froſts, cauſes the rocks very ſenſibly to ſhiver and fall down, and precipitates every year ſome great maſs into the ſea, and changes the form of the iſland. The others are in the ſame caſe; ſo nothing is more probable than their gradual diminution, and, by conſequence, the more eaſy communication formerly from one continent to the other, before the injuries of time, the effects of vulcanoes, and other cataſtrophes, had inſenſibly diminiſhed the ſize, and perhaps the number of theſe iſles, which form the chain; and had eaten in the coaſts of Aſia, which every where exhibit traces of the ravages they have undergone*.

The iſland ſwarmed with Sea Otters, which diſappeared in March. The Urſine Seal ſucceeded them in vaſt numbers, and quitted the coaſt the latter end of May. The Leonine Seal, the Lachtach or Great Seal, and the Manati, abounded, and proved the ſupport of the wrecked during their ſtay. Arctic Foxes were ſeen in great multitudes, and completed the liſt of Quadrupeds. The ſame ſpecies of water-fowl haunt the rocks, and the ſame ſpecies of fiſh aſcend the rivers, as do in Kamtſchatka. The tides riſe here ſeven or eight feet. The bottom of the ſea is rocky, correſpondent with the iſland.

The few plants of this iſland, which have not been diſcovered in Kamtſchatka, are as follow:

  • Campanula, Gm. Sib. iii. 160, 28.
  • Leontodon taraxacum, A. E. Virg.
  • Hieracium murorum, β. E.
  • Tanacetum vulgare, E.
  • Gnaphalium dioicum, A.
  • Senecio, Gm. Sib. ii. 136, No 118.
  • Arnica montana.
  • Chryſanthemum leucanthemum, A. Virg.

Theſe, with a few creeping Willows, added to thoſe in the Kamtſchatkan Flora, form the ſum of thoſe obſerved in Bering's iſland.

Mednoi, MEDNOI. or the copper iſland, lies a little to the ſouth-eaſt. A great quantity of native copper is found at the foot of a ridge of calcareous mountains on the eaſtern ſide, and may be gathered on the ſhores in vaſt maſſes, which ſeems originally to have been melted by ſubterraneous fires. This iſland is full of hillocks, bearing all the appearance of vulcanic ſpiracles; which makes it probable, that theſe iſlands were rent from the continent by the violence of an earthquake. [CXXXV] Among the float-wood off this iſland is camphor, and another ſweet wood, driven by the currents from the iſle of Japan.

The Aleutian group lies in the bend of the creſcent,ALEUTIAN ISLES. THE NEAREST. nearly in mid-channel between Aſia and America, lat. 52. 30, and about two hundred verſts diſtant from Mednoi. It conſiſts of Attok, Schemija, and Semitchi. The firſt ſeems to ſurpaſs in ſize Bering's iſle; but reſembles it in its component parts, as do the other two. Attok ſeems to be the iſland which Bering called Mount St. John. Theſe are inhabited by a people who ſpeak a language different from the northern Aſiatics; they ſeem emigrants or coloniſts from America, uſing a dialect of the neighboring continent. They were diſcovered in 1745, by Michael Nevodtſikoff, a native of Tobolſki, who made a voyage, at the expence of certain merchants, in ſearch of furs, the great object of theſe navigations, and the leading cauſe of diſcoveries in this ſea. This voyage was marked with horrid barbarities on the poor natives. The marine animals muſt have ſwarmed about this period, and for ſome time after. Mention is made of adventurers who brought from hence to Kamtſchatka the ſkins of 1,872 Sea Otters, 940 females, and 715 cubs. Another, on a ſmall adjacent iſle, killed 700 old, and 120 cub Sea Otters, 1,900 blue Foxes, 5,700 black Urſine Seals, and 1,310 of their cubs*. The blue Foxes abound in theſe iſlands, brought here on floating ice, and multiply greatly. The blue variety is ten times more numerous here than the white; but the reverſe is obſerved in Sibiria. They feed on fiſh, or any carrion left by the tide. The natives bore their under lips, and inſert in them teeth cut out of the bones of the Walrus; and they uſe boats covered with the ſkins of ſea animals.

At a great diſtance from the firſt group is the ſecond, or fartheſt Aleutian iſles:ALEUTIAN ISLES. THE FARTHEST. of thoſe we know no more than that the natives reſemble thoſe of the firſt. By the vaſt ſpace of ſea which Doctor PALLAS allows between the two groups, Captain COOK is fully vindicated for omitting, in his chart, the multitude of iſlands which, in the Ruſſian maps, form almoſt a complete chain from BERING'S iſle to America. Dr. PALLAS'S information muſt have been of the beſt kind; and he and our illuſtrious navigator coincide in opinion, that they have been needleſsly multiplied, by the miſtake of the Ruſſian adventurers in the reckoning, or, on ſeeing the ſame iſland in different points of view, putting it down as a new diſcovery, and impoſing on it a new name. The Andreanoffskie, ANDREAN ISLES. ſo called from their diſcoverer (in 1761) Andrean Tolſtyk, ſucceed. On two of them are vulcanoes. Eaſtly, are the Fox iſlands, ſo called from the number of black, grey,FOX ISLES. and red Foxes found on them; the ſkins of which are ſo coarſe, as to be of little [CXXXVI] value. The natives bore their noſes and under lips, and inſert bones in them by way of ornament. Among the laſt in this group is Oonolaſcha, which was viſited by Captain COOK. This lies ſo near to the coaſt of America, as to clame a right to be conſidered as an appurtenance to it. I ſhall therefore quit theſe detached paths for the preſent, and, in purſuance of my plan, trace the coaſts of the northern diviſion of the great continent, from the place at which it is divided from South America.

CALIFORNIA.After traverſing obliquely the Pacific Ocean, appears California, the moſt ſoutherly part of my plan on this ſide of the new world. This greateſt of peninſulas extends from Cape Blanco, lat. 32, to Cape St. Lucas, lat. 23; and is bounded on the eaſt by a great gulph, called the Vermillion ſea, receiving at its bottom the vaſt and violent river Colerado. The weſt ſide is mountanous, ſandy, and barren*, with ſeveral vulcanoes on the main land and the iſles: the eaſtern, varied with extenſive plains, fine vallies watered with numbers of ſtreams, and the country abounds with trees and variety of fruits. The natives, the moſt innocent of people, are in a ſtate of paradiſaical nature, or at leſt were ſo before the arrival of the European coloniſts among them. The men went nearly naked, without the conſciouſneſs of being ſo. The head is the only part they pay any attention to; and that is ſurrounded with a chaplet of net-work, ornamented with feathers, fruits, or mother of pearl. The women have a neat matted apron falling to their knees: they fling over their ſhoulders the ſkin of ſome beaſt, or of ſome large bird, and wear a head-dreſs like the other ſex. The weapons of the country are bows, arrows, javelins, and bearded darts, calculated either for war or the chace. In the art of navigation, they have not got beyond the bark-log, made of a few bodies of trees bound parallel together; and in theſe they dare the turbulent element. They have no houſes. During ſummer they ſhelter themſelves from the ſun under the ſhade of trees; and during nights ſleep under a roof of branches ſpread over them. In winter they burrow under ground, and lodge as ſimply as the beaſts themſelves: ſuch however was their condition in 1697; I have not been able to learn the effect of European refinement on their manners. Numbers of ſettlements have, ſince that time, been formed there, under the auſpices of the Jeſuits. The Order was of late years ſupported by the Marquis de Valero, a patriotic and munificent nobleman, who favored their attempts, in order to extend the power and wealth of the Spaniſh [CXXXVII] dominions; and I believe with ſucceſs. The land and climate, particularly Monterey, in lat. 36, is adapted for every vegetable production; and a good wine is made from the vines introduced by the coloniſts.

The natives are a fine race of men, tall, brawny, and well made;NATIVES. with black hair hanging over their ſhoulders, and with copper-colored ſkins. We have a moſt imperfect account of the animals of this peninſula. It certainly poſſeſſes two wool-bearing quadrupeds. As to birds, I doubt not but the Jeſuits are right, when they ſay, that it has all that are found in New Mexico and New Spain. The capes of Florida and cape St. Lucas lie nearly under the ſame latitudes, and form the ſouthern extremities of North America; but our ignorance of the productions of the vaſt provinces of New Mexico, will leave ample ſubject to a future naturaliſt to ſupply my deficiencies.

This country was diſcovered under the auſpices of the great Cortez, and Don Antonio de Mendoça, cotemporary viceroy of the new conqueſts: each, actuated by a glorious ſpirit of emulation, ſent out commanders to advance the welfare of their country to the utmoſt; and Franciſco Ulloa, in 1539, and Fernando Alarchon, in 1540, ſoon diſcovered this peninſula, and other adjacent regions, ſources of immenſe wealth to their country*. The Spaniſh adventurers of theſe early times ſailed as high as lat. 42; and named, in honor of the viceroy, the fartheſt point of their diſcovery Cabo di Mendoça.

Our celebrated navigator, Sir Francis Drake, SIR FRANCIS DRAKE. on June 5th 1578, touched on this coaſt, firſt in lat. 43; but was induced, from the ſeverity of the cold, to ſail to lat. 38, where he anchored in a fine bay. He found the natives to be a fine race of men, naked as the Californians, with the ſame kind of head-dreſſes; and the females habited like their ſouthern neighbors. He was treated like a deity. The chief of the country, by the reſignation of his crown or chaplet, his ſceptre, i. e. calumet, and other inſignia of royalty, veſted in Sir Francis the whole land; which he named New Albion, from its white cliffs, and took formal poſſeſſion [CXXXVIII] of in the name of his royal miſtreſs. We may be thankful that we never clamed the ceſſion: it forms at preſent part of New Mexico; and probably is reſerved for future conteſts between the Spaniards and the offspring of our late coloniſts. Sir Francis found this country a warren of what he calls, ‘a ſtrange kind of Conies, with heads as the heads of ours; the feete of a Want, i. e. a Mole, and the tail of a Rat, being of a great length: under her chinne is on either ſide a bag, into the which ſhe gathereth her meat when ſhe hath filled her bellie abroad.’ The common people feed on them, and the king's coat was made of their ſkins*. This ſpecies is to be referred to the diviſion of Rats with pouches in each jaw; and has never been obſerved from that period to this.

CAPTAIN COOK.Exactly two hundred years from that time the coaſt was again viſited by an Engliſhman, who in point of abilities, ſpirit, and perſeverance, may be compared with the greateſt ſeaman our iſland ever produced. Captain JAMES COOK, on March 7th 1778, got ſight of New Albion, in lat. 44. 33 north, and long. 235. 20 eaſt, about eight leagues diſtant. The ſea is here (as is the caſe the whole way from California) from ſeventy-three to ninety fathoms deep. The land is moderately high, diverſified with hills and vallies, and every where covered with wood, even to the water's edge. To the moſt ſouthern cape he ſaw he gave the name of Cape Gregory, its latitude 43. 30: the next, which was in 44. 6, he called Cape Perpetua; and the firſt land he ſaw, which was in 44. 55, Cape Foul-weather. The whole coaſt, for a great extent, is nearly ſimilar, almoſt ſtrait, and harborleſs, with a white beach forming the ſhore. While he was plying off the coaſt, he had a ſight of land in about lat. 43. 10, nearly in the ſituation of Cape Blanco de St. Sebaſtian, diſcovered by Martin d' Aguilar in 1603. A little to the north, the Oregon, or great river of the Weſt, diſcharges itſelf into the Pacific Ocean. Its banks were covered with trees; but the violence of the currents prevented D'Aguilar from entering into it. This, and the river of Bourbon, or Port Nelſon, which falls into Hudſon's Bay; that of St. Laurence, which runs to the eaſt; and the Miſſiſipi, which falls into the bay of Mexico, are ſaid to riſe within thirty miles of each other. The intervening ſpace muſt be the higheſt ground in North America, forming an inclined plane to the diſcharges of the ſeveral rivers. An ill-fated traveller, of great merit, places the ſpot in lat. 47, weſt long. from London 98, between a lake from which the Oregon flows, and another called White Bear lake, from which the Miſſiſipi .

[CXXXIX]This exalted ſituation is part of the Shining Mountains, CHAIN OF ALPS IN AMERICA. which are branches of the vaſt chain which pervades the whole continent of America. It may be fairly taken from the ſouthern extremity, where Staten Land and Terra del Fuego riſe out of the ſea, as inſulated links, to an immenſe height, black, rocky, and marked with rugged ſpiry tops, frequently covered with ſnow. New Georgia may be added, as another, horribly congenial, riſing detached farther to the eaſt. The mountains about the ſtreights of Magellan ſoar to an amazing height, and infinitely ſuperior to thoſe of the northern hemiſphere, under the ſame degree of latitude. From the north ſide of the ſtreights of Magellan, they form a continued chain through the kingdoms of Chili and Peru, preſerving a courſe not remote from the Pacific Ocean. The ſummits, in many places, are the higheſt in the world. There are not leſs than twelve which are from two thouſand four hundred toiſes high, to above three thouſand. Pichincha, which impends over Quito, is about thirty-five leagues from the ſea, and its ſummit is two thouſand four hundred and thirty toiſes above the ſurface of the water; Cayambé, immediately under the equator, is above three thouſand; and Chimborazo higher than the laſt by two hundred. Moſt of them have been vulcanic, and in different ages marked with eruptions far more horrible than have been known in other quarters of the globe. They extend from the equator, through Chili; in which kingdom is a range of vulcanoes, from lat. 26 ſouth, to 45. 30*, and poſſibly from thence into Terra del Fuego itſelf, which, forming the ſtreights of Magellan, may have been rent from the continent by ſome great convulſion, occaſioned by their laborings; and New Georgia, forced up from the ſame cauſe. An unparalleled extent of plain appears on their eaſtern ſide. The river of Amazons runs along a level cloathed with foreſts, after it burſts from its confinement at the Pongo of Borjas, till it reaches its ſea-like diſcharge into the Atlantic Ocean.

In the northern hemiſphere, the Andes paſs through the narrow iſthmus of Darien, into the kingdom of Mexico, and preſerve a majeſtic height and their vulcanic diſpoſition. The mountain Popocatepec made a violent eruption during the expedition of Cortez, which is moſt beautifully deſcribed by his hiſtorian, Antonio de Soils . This, poſſibly, is the ſame with the vulcano obſerved by the Abbé d' Auteroche, in his way from Vera Cruz to Mexico, which, from the nakedneſs of the lavas, he conjectured to have been but lately extinguiſhed. From the kingdom of Mexico, this chain is continued northward, and to the eaſt of California; then verges ſo greatly towards the weſt, as to leave a very [CXL] inconſiderable ſpace between it and the Pacific Ocean; and frequently detached branches jut into the ſea, and form promontories; which, with parts of the chain itſelf, were often ſeen by our navigators in the courſe of their voyage. Some branches, as we have before obſerved, extend towards the eaſt, but not to any great diſtance. A plain, rich in woods and ſavannas, ſwarming with Biſons or Buffaloes, Stags, and Virginian Deer, with Bears, and great variety of game, occupies an amazing tract, from the great lakes of Canada, as low as the gulph of Mexico; and eaſtward to the other great chain of mountains, the Apalachian, which are the Alps of that ſide of northern America. I imagine its commencement to be about lake Champlain and lake George, with branches pointing obliquely to the river St. Laurence eaſtward, and riſing on its oppoſite coaſts: others extending, with lowering progreſs, even into our poor remnant of the new world, Nova Scotio. The main chain paſſes through the province of New York, where it is diſtinguiſhed by the name of the Highlands, and lies within forty miles of the Atlantic. From thence it recedes from the ſea, in proportion as it advances ſouthward; and near its extremity in South Carolina is three hundred miles diſtant from the water. It conſiſts of ſeveral parallel ridges*, divided by moſt enchanting vallies, and generally cloathed with variety of woods. Theſe ridges riſe gradually from the eaſt one above the other, to the central; from which they gradually fall to the weſt, into the vaſt plains of the Miſſiſipi. The middle ridge is of an enormous bulk and height. The whole extends in breadth about ſeventy miles; and in many places leaves great chaſms for the diſcharge of the vaſt and numerous rivers which riſe in the boſoms of the mountains, and empty themſelves into the Atlantic ocean, after yielding a matchleſs navigation to the provinces they water. In p. XCV, I have given a view of the immenſe elevated plain in the Ruſſian empire. Beyond the branch of the Apalachian mountains, called The Endleſs, is another of amazing extent, nearly as high as the mountains themſelves. This plain, (called the Upper Plains) is exceedingly rich land; begins at the Mohock's river; reaches to within a ſmall diſtance of lake Ontario; and to the weſtward forms part of the extenſive plains of the Ohio, and reaches to an unknown diſtance beyond the Miſſiſipi. Vaſt rivers take their riſe, and fall to every point of the compaſs; into lake Ontario, into Hudſon's river, and into the Delawar and Suſquehanna. The tide of the Hudſon's river flows through its deep-worn bed far up, even to within a ſmall diſtance of the head of the Delawar; which, after a [CXLI] furious courſe down a long deſcent, interrupted with rapids, meets the tide not very remote from its diſcharge into the ocean*.

Much of the low grounds between the baſe of the Apalachian hills and the ſea (eſpecially in Virginia and Carolina) have in early times been occupied by the ocean. In many parts there are numbers of ſmall riſings, compoſed of ſhells, and in all the plains incredible quantities beneath the ſurface. Near the Miſſiſipi again, in lat. 32. 28, from the depth of fifty to eighty feet, are always found, in digging, ſea-ſand and ſea-ſhells, exactly ſimilar to what are met with on the ſhores near Penſacola . This is covered with a ſtratum of deep clay or marle, and above that with a bed of rich vegetable earth. All this proves the propriety of applying the epithet of NEW to this quarter of the globe, in a ſenſe different to that intended by the novelty of its diſcovery. Great part of North America at leſt became but recently habitable: the vaſt plains of the Miſſiſipi, and the tract between the Apalachian Alps and the Atlantic, were once poſſeſſed by the ocean. Either at this period America had not received its population from the old world, or its inhabitants muſt have been confined to the mountains and their vallies, till the waters ceaſed to cover the tracts now peopled by millions.

The compoſition of the northern mountains agrees much with thoſe of the north of Aſia, and often conſiſts of a grey rock ſtone or granite,COMPONENT PARTS. mixed with glimmer and quartz; the firſt uſually black, the laſt purpliſh. Near the river St. Laurence, a great part of the mountains reſts on a kind of ſlaty limeſtone. Large beds of limeſtones, of different colors, are ſeen running from the granitical mountains, and are filled with Cornua Ammonis, and different ſorts of ſhells, particularly with a ſmall ſpecies of ſcallop, together with various ſorts of corals, branched as well as ſtarry. The ſtrata of limeſtone alſo appear near the baſe of different parts of the Apalachian chain. Without doubt, the ſchiſtous band, conſiſting of variety of ſtone, ſplit and divided by fiſſures horizontal and perpendicular (in Aſia the repoſitory of metallic veins) is alſo found attendant on the granitical mountains of North America, and like them will be found rich in ores§: but that country has not yet been ſurveyed by a philoſophical eye. The labor will be amply repayed to the proprietors, by the diſcovery of mineral ſources of wealth, perhaps equal to thoſe already diſcovered in the ſimilar ſecondary chains of mountains in the Ruſſian empire.

Captain COOK continued his voyage to the northward; but, by reaſon of ſqually weather and fogs for a few degrees, or from lat. 50 to 55. 20, was deprived [CXLII] of the opportunity of making the obſervations he wiſhed. In lat. 48. 15, he in vain looked for the pretended ſtreights of Juan de Fuca, DR FUCA'S PASSAGE. who impoſed on a Michael Lock, an Engliſhman he met with at Venice, an account of having found, in 1592, an entrance in this latitude, and ſailed through it, till he arrived in the North ſea, i. e. Hudſon's Bay *. Of equal credibility is the pretended paſſage of Admiral de Fontes, in 1640, which is placed in lat. 50. 1; and, according to one map, falls into that of De Fuca: according to another, into a vaſt inland ſea, called Mer de l'Oueſt . Diligent ſearch was alſo made after this in the Spaniſh expedition of 1775; which ended in diſproving theſe ſtrange fictions. It had likewiſe the farther importance of filling up the gap in the charts, by furniſhing us with a ſurvey of that tract of coaſt which Captain COOK was obliged to quit.

NOOTKA SOUND.In lat. 49, Captain COOK found a ſecure ſhelter in an harbor called by him King George's Sound; by the natives, Nootka. The ſhores are rocky§; but within the Sound appears a branch of the range I before mentioned. It is here divided into hills of unequal heights, very ſteep, with ridged ſides, and round blunted tops; in general cloathed with woods to the very ſummits. In the few exceptions, the nakedneſs diſcovers their compoſition, which is rocky, or in parts covered with the adventitious ſoil of rotten trees or moſſes.

The trees were the Pinus Canadenſis, or Canada Pine; the P. Sylveſtris, or Scotch Pine, and two or three other ſorts; Cupreſſus Thyoides, or the White Cedar. The Pines of this neighborhood are of a great ſize: ſome are a hundred and twenty feet high, and fit for maſts or ſhip-building; but the dimenſions of ſome of the canoes in Nootka Sound beſt ſhew their vaſt bulk—they are made of a ſingle tree, hollowed ſo as to contain twenty perſons; and are ſeven feet broad, and three deep. They are the ſame with the monoxyla of the antient Germans and Gauls , but conſtructed with much more elegance. The old Europeans were content if they could but float. They probably were formed on the ſame rude model as thoſe of the old Virginians **, or of the antient Britons, ſimilar to one I have ſeen dug up in a moraſs in Scotland, as artleſs as a hog-trough††. Thoſe of Nootka Sound are at the head tapered into a long prow, and at the ſtern they decreaſe in breadth, but end abrupt.

The day-tides riſe here, two or three days after the full and new moon, eight [CXLIII] feet nine inches. The night-tides, at the ſame periods, riſe two feet higher. Pieces of drift wood, which the navigators had placed during day out of the reach (as they thought) of the tides, were in the night floated higher up, ſo as to demonſtrate the great increaſe of the nocturnal flux*.

I have deſcribed, to the beſt of my power, the quadrupeds and birds of the American part of this voyage. In p. 12 I have given my ſuſpicions of certain animals of the Sheep kind being natives of this neighborhood and California; but am not ſufficiently warranted to pronounce them to be the ſame with the Argali or wild Sheep. Woollen garments are very common among the people of this Sound, and are manufactured by the women. The materials of many of them ſeem taken from the Fox and the Lynx; others, I preſume, from the exquiſite down of the Muſk Ox, No 2. The only peculiar animal of theſe parts is the Sea Otter, No 36: it extends ſouthward along the coaſt, as far as lat. 49, and as high as 60. The other quadrupeds obſerved by the navigators are common to the eaſtern ſide of North America.

I may mention, that ſmall Perroquets, and Parrots with red bills, feet, and breaſts, were ſeen by M. Maurelle about Port Trinidada, in lat. 41. 7; and great flocks of Pigeons in the ſame neighborhood. This was in June: BIRDS. poſſibly they were on their migration when our navigators reached the coaſts, which was on March 29th. As to the Parrots, it is poſſible that thoſe birds may not extend ſo far north as Nootka; for on the eaſtern ſide of the continent they do not inhabit higher, even in ſummer, than the province of Virginia, in lat. 39; or, in the midland parts, than lat. 41. 15, where they haunt in multitudes the ſouthern ſides of the lakes Erie and Michigam, and the banks of the rivers Illinois and Ohio. Another delicate ſpecies of bird was ſeen here in plenty, a kind of Honey-ſucker or Humming-bird, a new ſpecies; which I have deſcribed, No 177, under the title of the Ruffed. Among the water-fowl were ſeen the Great Black Petrel, p. 536. A. or the Quebrantahueſſos, or Bone-breaker of the Spaniards, which ſeems to be found from the Kuril iſles to Terra del Fuego; the Northern Diver, No 439; a great flock of Black Ducks with white heads; a large ſpecies of White Ducks with red bills; and Swans flying northward to their breeding-places: common Corvorants were alſo very frequent.

The inhabitants of this Sound alter in their appearance from thoſe who live more ſouthern. They are in general below the middle ſtature; plump,MEN. but not muſcular: their viſage round, full, and with prominent cheeks; above which the face is compreſſed from temple to temple: the noſtrils wide: noſe flat, with a rounded point; through the ſeptum narium of many is introduced a ring of iron, [CXLIV] braſs, or copper: eyes ſmall, black, languiſhing: mouth round: lips large and thick: hair of the head thick, ſtrong, black, long, and lank; that on the eyebrows very thin: neck ſhort and thick: limbs ſmall and ill-made: ſkin a pallid white, where it can be viewed free from dirt or paint. The women are nearly of the ſame form and ſize as the men, but undiſtinguiſhable by any feminine ſoftneſs. Many of the old men have great beards, and even muſtachios; but the younger people in general ſeem to have plucked out the hair, except a little on the end of the chin.

Their dreſs conſiſts of mantles and cloaks, well manufactured among themſelves, and either woollen, matting, or ſome material correſpondent to hemp. Over their other cloaths the men frequently throw the ſkin of ſome wild beaſt, which ſerves as a great cloak. The head is covered with a cap made of matting, in form of a truncated cone, or in that of a flower-vaſe, with the top adorned with a pointed or round knob, or with a bunch of leathern taſſels. Their whole bodies are incruſted with paint or dirt, and they are a moſt ſquallid offenſive race; ſilent, phlegmatic, and uncommonly lazy; eaſily provoked to violent anger, and as ſoon appeaſed. The men are totally deſtitute of ſhame: the women behave with the utmoſt modeſty, and even baſhfulneſs*. I ſhall not repeat what has been ſaid of the infinite variety of hideous maſques this nation poſſeſſes, and ſeems particularly fond of, was not the ingenious Editor of the Voyage at a loſs for their intent, whether for religious or for maſquerading purpoſes. Mr. Bartram proves that theſe maſques extend to the eaſtern ſide of the continent, and that their uſe was ſportive; for he was plagued part of a night with the buffoonery of a fellow, who came into his lodgings while he was on his travels, and, after playing a thouſand antic tricks, vaniſhed in a manner as if he meant to be taken for a hobgoblin. The Oſtiaks have exactly the ſame cuſtom§.

Figure 1. Tomahawk & Bow.

From lat. 55. 20, towards the north, the country increaſes in height, eſpecially inland, where a range of very lofty mountains, moſtly covered with ſnow, is ſeen nearly parallel with the coaſt, a branch of thoſe I have before mentioned. Above lat. 56 the coaſt is broken into bays and harbours.RUSSIAN VOYAGE. In this neighborhood Captain Tſchirikow, conſort to the great navigator BERING, who was ſeparated from his commander by a ſtorm, was ſo unfortunate as to touch on an open part of the coaſt, in about lat. 55, in which he anchored in a moſt dangerous ſituation, full of rocks. Having loſt his ſhallop, and after that his ſmall boat, with part of his crew, which he had ſent on ſhore to water, and which were deſtroyed by the natives, he was obliged to return from his ineffectual voyage* A vaſt conic mountain, called by Captain COOK Mount Edgecumbe ,MOUNT EDGECUMBE. riſes pre-eminent above all the others. This is in lat. 57. 3, long. 224. 7. Not remote from hence is the Bay of Iſlands, the ſame as the Port los Remedios, nearly the ne plus of the Spaniſh expedition of 1775. The adventurers comforted themſelves with having reached lat. 58, and having attained the higheſt latitude ever arrived at in theſe ſeas. This coaſt, as well as the reſt, continued covered with woods.

A high peaked mountain, Mount Fair-weather, and the inlet Croſs Sound, next appear. The firſt is the higheſt of a chain of ſnowy mountains, which lie inland about five leagues, in lat. 58. 52. The land between them and the ſea was very low, for the trees ſeemed to ariſe out of the water. Several ſea-birds, with a black ring round the head; the tip of the tail, and upper part of the wings, marked with black; the body bluiſh above, white beneath, came in view; and on the water ſat a browniſh Duck, with a deep blue or black head§.

In lat. 59. 18, is a bay, with a wooded iſle off its ſouth point, named by Captain COOK, BERING'S; in honor of the illuſtrious Dane who firſt diſcovered this part of America, and, as was conjectured, anchored there for a ſmall ſpace. The appearance of the country was terrific; it conſiſted of lofty mountains (in July) covered with ſnow: but the chain is interrupted near this port by a plain of a few miles in extent; beyond which the view was unlimited, having behind it a continuance of level country, or ſome great lake. He had not leiſure to make obſervations; he only named a cape, which advanced into the ſea, Cape Elias : this is not at preſent known; but the name of Mount Elias was beſtowed by Captain [CXLVI] COOK on a very conſpicuous mountain*, which lay inland to the north-weſt of the bay, in lat. 60. 15.

BERING, during the ſhort ſtay he made on the coaſt, ſent his boat on ſhore to procure water. That great naturaliſt, Steller, companion of the voyage, took the opportunity of landing. The whole time allotted him was only ſix hours; during which he collected a few plants, and ſhot that beautiful ſpecies of Jay, No 139, to which I have given his name. He returned on board with the regret a man of his zeal muſt feel at the neceſſity of ſo ſlight an examination in ſo ample a field, What he could have done, had circumſtances permitted, is evident from the excellent collection he formed of natural hiſtory reſpecting Kamtſchatka, and ſome of its iſlands.

PLANTS.Among the plants found by him on the American continent were, Plantago major, Sp. Pl. i. 163; Great Plantane, Fl. Scot. i. 117. K. Virg.: Plantago Aſiatica, Sp. Pl. i. 163. K.: Polemonium Caeruleam, Sp. Pl. i. 230: Greek Valerian, Hudſon, i. 89. K.: Lonicera Xyloſteum, Fl. Sib. iii. 129. K.: Ribes Alpinum, Sp. Pl. i. 291. Fl. Scot. i. 146. K.: Ribes groſſularia, Sp. Pl. i. 291; Gooſeberries, K. Virg.: Claytonia Virginica? Sp. Pl. i. 294. K. Virg.: Heuchera Americana? Sp. Pl. i. 328. K.: Heracleum Panaces, Sp. Pl. i. 358; or Cow Parſnep, K. which he found in one of the habitations of the natives, tied up in bundles ready for uſe. (I have mentioned, at p. CXVII. the application of it in Kamtſchatka, for the purpoſes of diſtilling an intoxicating liquor; but the Americans are fortunate enough to be ignorant of that art, and only uſe it as a food.) Vaccinium Myrtillus, Sp. Pl. i. 498; Bilberries, Fl. Scot. i. 200. K.: Vaccinium Vitis Idaea, Virg. Sp. Pl. i. 500; Red Whortle-berries, Fl. Scot. i. 202. K.: Erica, Fl. Sib. 131, No 22. K.: Adoxa Moſchatellina, Sp. Pl. i. 527; tuberous Moſchatel, Fl. Scot. i. 209. K.: Rubus Idaeus, Sp. Pl. i. 706; Raſberry-buſh, Fl. Scot. i. 263. K.: Fragaria Veſca, Sp. Pl. i. 708; Wood Strawberry, Fl. Scot. i. 267. Virg. K.: the Leontodon Taraxicum, Virg. B. Sp. Pl. ii. 1122; or common Dandelion, Fl. Scot. i. 433: Abſinthium, Sp. Pl. ii. 1188; or common Wormwood, Fl. Scot. i. 467: Artemiſia Vulgaris, Sp. Pl. ii. 1188; or Mugwort, Fl. Scot. i. 468: Gnaphalium Dioicum, Sp. Pl. ii. 1199; Mountain Cudweed, or Cat's-foot, Fl. Scot. i. 470. K.: Aſter ſeu potiùs Helenium fruticoſum, Fl. Sib. ii. 175, B. K. with beautiful yellow flowers: Erigeron acre, Sp. Pl. ii. 1211; Blue Fleabane, Fl. Scot. i. 474. K.: Chryſanthemum Leucanthemum, ii. 1251; Great Daiſy, or Ox-eye, Fl. Scot. i. 488. B. K. Virg.: Pyrethrum, Fl. Sib. ii. 203, No 170. B. K.: Achillea Millefolium, [CXLVII] Sp. Pl. ii. 1267; Milfoil or Yarrow, Fl. Scot. i. 490. K. Virg.: Empetrum nigrum, Sp. Pl. ii. 1450; Black-berried Heath, Crow-berries, Fl. Scot. ii. 612. K. Virg.: Meniſpermum Canadenſe? Sp. Pl. ii. 1468. K. Virg.—I retain the mark of Britiſh vegetables, to ſhew the vaſt dilatation of plants; and that of Virg. to ſhew thoſe which ſpread to the eaſtern ſide of America.

To theſe may be added a few trees and plants obſerved by our navigators; ſuch as the Pinus Strobus, Sp. Pl. ii. 1490, the white or Weymouth Pine, which grows to an enormous ſize; Pinus Canadenſis, Sp. Pl. ii. 1421, the Canada Pine; three or four other Pines, which we cannot determine; the Cupreſſus Diſticha? Sp. Pl. ii. 1422, the deciduous Cypreſs; Cupreſſus Thyoides, Sp. Pl. ii. 1422, or white Cedar; ſome Birch, Alders, and Willows; wild Roſe-buſhes; and ſeveral plants, the ſpecies of which are unknown to us. Probably that uſeful Lily, the Lilium Kamtſchatchenſe, or Saranne, extends to the continent, for it is found in abundance in the adjacent iſland Oonalaſchka, where it ſerves as a food, as it does in Kamtſchatka *.

In this neighborhood, in lat. 59. 49, about Kaye's iſland,KAYE'S ISLAND. off Cape Suckling, Captain COOK obſerved variety of birds; among them ſome Albatroſſes, the ſnowy Gulls, and the common Corvorant: and in the poor woods which encircled the iſland like a girdle, were ſeen a Crow, the white-headed Eagle, and another ſpecies equally large, of a blacker color, with a white breaſt, which proves to be the kind deſcribed by Mr. Latham, i. p. 33. No 72, under the name of the white-bellied Eagle .

After doubling a cape, called by our great navigator, Hinchinbroke §,PRINCE WILLIAM'S SOUND. he anchored in a vaſt ſound, named by him Prince William's, in lat. 61. 30, ſecured by a long iſland, called Mountague's, ſtretching obliquely acroſs from north-eaſt to ſouth-weſt. The land round this harbour roſe to a vaſt height, and was deeply covered with ſnow. Vegetation in theſe parts ſeemed to leſſen. The principal trees were the Canadian and Spruce Firs, and ſome of them moderately large.

Beſides the quadrupeds found at Nootka, QUADRUPEDS. there is a variety of Bear of a white color; I will not call it the Polar, as that animal inhabits only the ſevereſt climates, where it can find dens of ſnow and iſles of ice. An animal of the ermine kind, varied with brown, but the tail ſcarcely tipt with black. Wolverenes were here, of a very brilliant color; and the earleſs Marmot, No 47, was very common. None of theſe were ſeen living, but their ſkins were brought [CXLVIII] in abundance as articles of commerce. The ſkin of the head of the male leonine Seal was alſo offered to ſale: in the Voyage it is called the Urſine; but from the great ſhaggineſs of the hair I preſume I am not wrong in my conjecture. This is the only place in the northern hemiſphere in which it was found by the navigators*.

BIRDS.Among the birds were the black Sea Pies with red bills, obſerved before in Van Diemen's Land and New Zealand. A Duck, equal in ſize to our Mallard, with a white bill tinged with red near the point, and marked with a black ſpot on each ſide near the baſe: on the forehead a large white triangular ſpot, and a larger on the hind part of the neck: the reſt of the plumage duſky: the tail ſhort and pointed: the legs red. The female was of duller colors, and the bill was far leſs gay. Another ſpecies reſembled the ſmall one found at Kerguellen's Land. A Diver (Grebe?) of the ſize of a Partridge; with a black compreſſed bill: head and neck black: upper part of the body deep brown, obſcurely waved with black; the lower part duſky, ſpeckled minutely with white. Honey-ſuckers, probably migratory in this high latitude, frequently flew round the ſhips.

To give all the additions I am able to my zoologic part, I ſhall here mention certain ſpecies of Petrels, obſerved on the weſtern coaſt of North America: ſuch as numberleſs brown Petrels near the entrance of COOK'S river, flying round a remarkable ſugar-loaf hill. A ſpecies ſeen near Nootka Sound, about eleven inches long, with the noſtrils ſcarcely tubular: bill and plumage above duſky, beneath white: legs back. This is common to Turtle Iſle, lat. 19. 48, ſouth, long. 178. 2, weſt; and Chriſtmas Iſle, lat. i. 59, north, long. 202. 30, eaſt. Another, about thirteen inches long, with the forehead, ſpace between the eyes and bill, the chin, and throat, of a greyiſh white, varied with ſpecks of duſky: crown and upper part of the body duſky: under parts hoary lead-color: legs pallid§. I may add a fourth, ſeen off the coaſt of Kamtſchatka, which Mr. Ellis mentions as being ſmall, and of a bluiſh color.

MEN.MANKIND here ſhew a variation from the laſt deſcribed. The natives are generally above the common ſtature, but many below it: ſquare-built or ſtrong-cheſted; their heads moſt diſproportionably large; their faces flat, and very broad: their necks ſhort and thick: their eyes ſmall, in compariſon to the vaſt breadth of their faces: their noſes had full round points, turned up at the end: their hair long, thick, black, and ſtrong: their beards either very thin, or extirpated; for ſeveral of the old men had large, thick, but ſtrait beards: their countenances generally full of vivacity, good-nature, and frankneſs, not unlike the Criſtinaux, [CXLIX] a people who live far inland, between the little and the great lakes Ouinepique. On the contrary, the inhabitants of Nootka in their dulneſs reſemble the Aſſinibouels, who live on the weſtern ſide*: and theſe two nations may have been derived from a common ſtock with the maritime tribes whom we have had occaſion to mention. The ſkins of the natives of this ſound were ſwarthy, poſſibly from going often naked; for the ſkins of many of the women, and the children, were white, but pallid. Many of the women were diſtinguiſhable from the men by the delicacy of their features, which was far from the caſe with thoſe of Nootka.

In theſe parts, within the diſtance of ten degrees, is a change of both dreſs and manners. The cloak and mantle are here changed for a cloſe habit, made of the ſkins of different beaſts, uſually with the hair outwards; or of the ſkins of birds, with only the down remaining; ſome with a cape, others with a hood: over which, in rainy weather, is worn a garment like a carter's frock, with large ſleeves, and tight round the neck, made of the inteſtines probably of the whale, and as fine as gold-beater's leaf. On the hands are always worn mittens, made of the paws of a bear; and the legs are covered with hoſe, reaching to midway the thigh. The head is generally bare; but thoſe who wear any thing, uſe the high truncated conic bonnet, like the people of Nootka . In this place only was obſerved the Calumet; a ſtick about three feet long, with large feathers, or the wings of birds, tied to it. This was held up as a ſign of peace.

I leave the reader to amuſe himſelf in the Voyage, by the account of the ſtrange cuſtom of the natives in cutting through their under lip, and giving themſelves the monſtrous appearance of two mouths: in the orifice they place a bit of bone or ſhell by way of ornament. This cuſtom extends to the diſtant Moſquitos, and even to the Braſilians§, but ſeems unknown in other parts of America.—I endeavour to confine myſelf to paſſages which may lead to trace the origin of the people. Theſe paint their faces, and puncture or tattow their chins. They are moſt remarkably clean in their food, and in their manner of eating it, and even in the keeping of their bowls and veſſels. In their perſons they are equally neat and decent, and free from greaſe or dirt: in this they ſeem an exception to all other ſavages.

They have two kinds of boats; one large, open,BOATS. and capable of containing above twenty people. It is made of the ſkins of marine animals, diſtended on ribs of wood, like the vitilia navigia of the Britons, at the time in which they were on a level with theſe poor Americans; or like the woman's boat of the Greenlanders and Eſkimaux. The canoes are exactly of the ſame conſtruction with thoſe of the latter; and the difference of both is very trivial. The canoes of theſe [CL] Americans are broader than thoſe of the eaſtern ſide of the continent; and ſome have two circular apertures, in order to admit two men*. Every weapon which theſe people have for the chace of quadrupeds or fiſh, is the ſame with thoſe uſed by the Greenlanders: there is not one wanting.

From Prince William's found the land trends north-weſt, and terminates in two headlands, called Cape Elizabeth and Cape Bede; CAPT BEDE. theſe, with Cape Banks on the oppoſite ſhore, form the entrance into the vaſt eſtuary of COOK'S river; in the midſt of which are the naked iſles, diſtinguiſhed by the name of the Barren. Within, to the weſt, is a lofty two-headed mountain, called Cape Douglas; which is part of a chain of a vaſt height, in which was a vulcano, at the time this place was viſited, emitting white ſmoke: and in the bottom of a bay, oppoſite to it, is an iſland, formed of a lofty mountain, on which was beſtowed the name of Mount St. Auguſtine .MOUNT ST. AUGUSTINE. The eſtuary is here of a great breadth, owing to a bay running oppoſite to Mount Auguſtine deeply to the eaſt.

COOK'S RIVER.The eſtuary of COOK'S river is of great length and extent. The river begins between Anchor Point and the oppoſite ſhore, where it is thirty miles wide: the depth very conſiderable, and the ebb very rapid. Far within, the channel contracts to four leagues, through which ruſhes a prodigious tide, agitated like breakers againſt rocks. The riſe of the tide in this confined part was twenty-one feet. It was examined ſeventy leagues from the entrance, as far as lat. 61. 30, long. 210, and its boundaries were found to be flat, ſwampy, and poorly wooded, till they reached the foot of the great mountains. Towards the north, it divides into two great branches, or perhaps diſtinct rivers. That to the eaſt is diſtinguiſhed by the name of Turn-again river. The firſt is a league wide, and navigable, as far as was tried, for the largeſt ſhips, and continued very brackiſh; there is therefore the greateſt probability of its having a very long courſe, and being, in after times, of conſiderable uſe in inland navigation: that it is of ſome even at preſent is very certain; for here, as well as in Prince William's ſound, the Indians were poſſeſſed of glaſs beads and great knives of Engliſh manufacture, which the Hudſon's bay company annually ſend in great quantities, and exchange for furs with the natives, who travel to our ſettlements very far from the weſt. The company alſo ſend copper and braſs veſſels; but neither copper or iron in bars. There does not ſeem to be any direct dealings with the Indians of this coaſt: the traffic is carried on by intermediate tribes, who never think of bringing furs to a people ſo amply ſupplied as the Indians are who deal with our factories. Nations who uſe the moſt pretious furs merely as a defence from the cold, make no diſtinction of kinds: if they could get more beads or more knives for the ſkins of Sea Otters [CLI] than any other, they would inſtantly become articles of commerce, and find their way acroſs the continent to the European ſettlements.

From Turn-again river to the neareſt part of Hudſon's bay, is fifty-five degrees, or about ſixteen hundred miles; but from the moſt weſtern part of Arapatheſcow lake (which is intermediate) is only twenty-ſix degrees, or about ſeven hundred and fifty miles. There is no diſcharge out of that vaſt water but what runs into Hudſon's bay. We have ſome obſcure accounts of rivers * which take a weſtern courſe from the countries eaſt of this coaſt: ſome of which may be thoſe which have been ſeen by our navigators, and which, by means of lakes or other rivers falling into them, may prove a channel of intercourſe between theſe Indians and the Hudſon's bay company, as ſoon as our friendly Indians become acquainted with the value of theſe maritime furs.

The inhabitants of Cook's river differed very little from thoſe of Prince William's found. They had Dogs, which were the firſt ſeen on the coaſts; Sea Otters,DOGS. Martins, and white Hares: and they were plentifully ſupplied with Salmon and Holibut.

After leaving the entrance into the river, appears Cape St. Hermogenes, CAPE ST. HERMOGENES. diſcovered firſt by BERING. It proved a naked lofty iſland, about ſix leagues in circuit, and divided from the coaſt by a channel a league broad. This lies in lat. 58. 15, off the vaſt peninſula Alaſchka, ALASCHKA, CONTINENT OF AMERICA. which begins between the eſtuary of Cook's river and Briſtol bay, which bound its iſthmus. It points ſouth-weſt, and continues the creſcent formed by the iſlands which croſs the ſea from Kamtſchatka. Alaſchka is the only name given by the natives to the continent of America. The land to the weſt of COOK'S river riſes into mountains, with conoid tops thickly ſet together. The coaſt is frequently bold, and the rocks break into pinnacles of pictureſque forms: the whole is fronted by groups of iſles and cluſters of ſmall rocks. In a word, the country and ſhores are the moſt rugged and disjointed imaginable, and bear evident marks of having undergone ſome extraordinary change.

Among the iſles, thoſe of Schoumagin are the moſt important, which received their name from having been the place of interment of one of Bering's crew, the firſt which he loſt in theſe ſeas. The principal lies the fartheſt to the weſt, and is called Kadjak: it is about a hundred verſts long,KADJAK. and from twenty to thirty broad; and, from the account of Demetrius Bragin, who viſited it from Oonalaſhka in 1776, is very populous. The inhabitants ſpoke a language different from thoſe [CLII] of that iſland: it ſeemed a dialect of the Greenlanders. They called their wooden ſhields Kuyaky, probably becauſe they reſemble a kaiak, or a little canoe, a Greenland word for that ſpecies of boat; and themſelves Kanagiſt, as the others ſtyle themſelves Karalit. They have likewiſe the woman's boat, like the people of Prince William's ſound: in fact, they ſeem to be the ſame people, but more refined. They were armed with pikes, bows and arrows, and wooden ſhields. Their ſhirts were made of the ſkins of birds; alſo of the earleſs Marmot (Arct. Zool. i. No 47), Foxes, and Sea Bears, and ſome of fiſhes ſkins. Dogs, Bears, common Otters, and Ermines, were obſerved here. Their dwellings were made with timber, and were from fifteen to twenty fathoms long, covered with a thatch and dried graſs. Within they were divided into compartments for every family, and every compartment lined neatly with mats. The entrance was on the top, covered with frames, on which were ſtretched the membranes of dried inteſtines inſtead of glaſs*. Theſe people ſeemed to have made far greater progreſs in the arts than their neighbors. They worked their carpets in a very curious manner; on one ſide cloſe ſet with beaver wool. The Sea Otters ſkins which they brought for ſale were in ſome parts ſhorn quite cloſe with ſharp ſtones, ſo that they gliſtened and appeared like velvet. They ſhewed ſtrong proofs of genius in their invention to preſerve themſelves from the effects of the Ruſſian fire-arms. They had the ſpirit to make an attack, and formed ſkreens with three parallel perpendicular rows of ſtakes, bound with ſea-weeds and oſiers; their length was twelve feet, and thickneſs three: under the ſhelter of theſe they marched; but their ſucceſs was not correſpondent to their plan: a ſally of the Ruſſians diſconcerted them, and put them to the rout.

The iſland conſiſts of hills mixed with lowlands. It abounds with bulbs, roots, and berries, for food; with ſhrubs, and even trees ſufficiently large to be hollowed into canoes capable of carrying five perſons. In this kind of boat they differ from thoſe of the Greenlanders.

Off the extremity of the peninſula of Alaſchka is Holibut iſland,HOLIBUT ISLE. in lat. 54, riſing into a lofty pyramidal mountain, lying oppoſite to the narrow ſhallow ſtreight which lies between the iſle Oonemaka and Alaſchka. The chain on the continent is ſeen to riſe into ſtupendous heights, covered with ſnow: among them ſeveral of the hills appear to riſe inſulated, and of a conic form. One [CLIII] was a vulcano, flinging up volumes of black ſmoke to a great height*, then ſtreaming before the wind with a tail of vaſt length and pictureſque appearance. It often took a direction contrary to the point the wind blew from at ſea, notwithſtanding there was a freſh gale. It lies in lat. 54. 48 north, long. 195. 45 W. and is evidently a link in the vulcanic chain, which extends, in the ſouthern hemiſphere, as low at leſt as that of St. Clement in Chili, in lat. 45. 30.

The extremity of Alaſchka ends abrupt, and has oppoſite to it an iſland called Oonemak or Unmak, OONEMAK. of nearly a correſpondent breadth, ſeparated from it by a very narrow and ſhallow channel, ſituated in lat. 54. 30, and leading into Briſtol bay, pervious only by boats or very ſmall veſſels. The iſle is a hundred verſts long, and from ſeven to fifteen broad; and has in the middle a vulcano. In the low parts ſeveral hot ſprings burſt forth, to which the iſlanders carry the fiſh or fleſh they want to boil; and they are alſo fond of bathing in the temperate parts.

To the weſt are the ſmall iſles of Oonella and Acootan: at a ſmall diſtance from them is Oonalaſhka or Aghôun-alaiſka ,OONALASHKA. a name evidently referring to the continent. My MS. calls its length a hundred and twenty verſts, its breadth from ten to eighteen. It is the moſt remote of the Ruſſian colonies, who have now made ſettlements on moſt of the iſles between Aſia and America; all under the care of private adventurers. The voyage from Ochotſk or Kamtſchatka laſts three or four years; and is ſolely undertaken for the ſake of the ſkins of Sea Otters. Poſſibly other reaſons will, in a little time, induce them to attempt the colonization of the continent. Timber may be one; for their northern Aſiatic dominions and their iſlands yield none. I foreſee docks and timber-yards in all convenient places. At preſent, the natives of theſe iſles have only the ſkin-covered canoes§,NATIVES. and even for the ribs they are obliged to the chance of drift-wood. In theſe, in dreſs, and in weapons, they reſemble the Eſkimaux. The language is a dialect of the Eſkimaux. They are rather of low ſtature. They have ſhort necks, ſwarthy chubby faces, black eyes, and ſtraight long black hair. The faſhion of wearing feathers or bits of ſticks in their noſes is uſed in Oonalaſhka. Both ſexes cut their hair even over their foreheads: the men wear theirs looſe behind; the females tie theirs in a bunch on the top of their head: the firſt wear long looſe frocks, of the ſkins of birds; the laſt of the ſkins of Seals. The men fling over their frocks another, of the guts of the cetaceous animals, dried and oiled, to keep out the water; and, to [CLIV] defend their faces from the weather, they wear a piece of wood, like the front of the bonnet of an Engliſh lady*. Some uſe the bonnet in the form of the truncated cone. The women ſlightly tattow their faces, and often wear a ſtring of beads pendent from their noſes; both ſexes perforate their under lip, but it is very uncommon to ſee any except the females ſtick in it the ornamental bone. The noſe-ornaments extend far inland on the continent; for the Americans, who trade with the Hudſon's bay company, uſe them: but from the figures given by De Brie, they do not ſeem ever to have reached the people of Virginia and Florida. They inhabit jourts, or ſubterraneous dwellings, each common to many families, in which they live in horrible filthineſs: but they are remarkably civilized in their behaviour; and have been taught by the Ruſſians to pull off their caps, and to bow, in their ſalutations.

BARROWS.They bury their dead on the ſummits of hills, and raiſe over the ſpot a barrow of ſtones, in the manner cuſtomary in all the north of Europe in very early days.

On the north ſide of the promontory Alaſchka, the water decreaſes conſiderably in depth, and the mountains recede towards the bottom far inland, and leave a large tract of low land between them and the ſea. Here it forms a great bay, called Briſtol; BRISTOL BAY AND RIVER. with a vaſt river at the end, with an entrance a mile broad, ſeated in lat. 58. 27. Cape Newenham, lat. 58. 42, a rocky promontory, is the northern horn of the bay, eighty-two leagues from Cape Oonemak, its ſouthern: an univerſal barrenneſs, and want of vegetation, appeared in the neighborhood of the former. The Walruſes (No 71) began, the 15th of July, to ſhew themſelves in great numbers about this place: a proof that ice is not eſſential to their exiſtence. The inhabitants of this coaſt were dreſſed much more ſqualidly than thoſe before ſeen; but, like the others, deformed their noſes and lips. They ſhaved their head or cut the hair cloſe, and only left a few locks behind or on one ſide, ſomewhat in the Chineſe faſhion. From Cape Newenham, the continent runs due north. To the weſt is Gore's iſland,GORE'S ISLE. diſtinguiſhed by a vaſt cliff, in lat. 60. 17, long. 187. 30, called Point Upright; and near it a moſt rugged, high, rocky iſlet, named the Pinnacles . Myriads of the Auk tribe haunted theſe precipices. This ſeems the extreme northern reſort of the Sea Otter. SEA OTTERS.

From Shoal-neſs, in lat. 60, long. 196, there is a gap in the American geography, as far as Point Shallow Water, lat. 62. 50; and not far from thence were the ſymptoms of the diſcharge of ſome great river, from the uninveſtigated part. Beyond [CLV] Point Shallow, in lat. 63. 33, is Cape Stephens; CAPE STEPHENS. and before it, at a ſmall diſtance, Stuart's iſle. Theſe make the ſouthern points of Norton's Sound, formed by a vaſt receſs of the land to the eaſt. All the land near the ſea is low and barren, bounded inland by mountains. The trees, which were Birch, Alder, Willow, and Spruce, very ſmall; none of the laſt above ſix or eight inches in diameter: but the drift-wood, which lay in plenty on the ſhore, much larger; having been brought down the rivers from land more favorable to its growth. Towards the bottom of the ſound, Cape Denbigh juts far to the weſt into the water, and forms a peninſula. It has been an iſland; for there are evident marks on the iſthmus, that the ſea had once poſſeſſed its place: a proof of the loſs of the element of water in theſe parts, as well as in other remote parts of the globe.

The ſound, from Cape Denbigh, is ſuddenly contracted, and is converted into a deep inlet, ſeemingly the reception of a large river. The continent, in theſe parts, conſiſts of vaſt plains, divided by moderate hills; the former watered by ſeveral rivers meandering through them. Vegetation improves in proportion to the diſſtance from the ſea, and the trees increaſe in bulk. A promontory, called Bald Head, bounds the northern entrance into this inlet. Farther to the weſt Cape Darby, CAPE DARBY. in lat. 64. 21, makes the northern horn of this great ſound.

Numbers of people inhabit this coaſt.NATIVES. The men were about five feet two inches high; and in form and features reſembled all the natives ſeen by the navigators ſince they left Nootka Sound. They had, in their under lip, two perforations. The color of their ſkin was that of copper: their hair ſhort and black: the beard of the men ſmall: their language a dialect of the Eſkimaux. Their clothing is chiefly of Deer ſkins, with large hoods, made in the form of looſe jackets, ſcarcely reaching lower than half the thigh; where it was almoſt met by a great wide-topped boot. The Eſkimaux occaſionally ſtick their children in the top: the women of this country place them more commodiouſly within the upper part of the jacket, over one ſhoulder*. In language there ſeems conſiderable conformity. They had, like them, the woman's boat, and the Kaiack: the firſt they ſometimes made uſe of as a protection from the weather, by turning it upſide down, and ſheltering beneath. But their hovels were the moſt wretched of any yet ſeen; conſiſting of only a ſloping roof (without any ſide walls) compoſed of logs; a floor of the ſame; the entrance at one end, and a hole to permit the eſcape of the ſmoke.THEIR SENSIBILITY. Theſe poor people ſeem very ſuſceptible of feelings for the misfortunes of each other, which would do honor to the moſt poliſhed ſtate. A family appeared, one of which was a moſt diſtorted figure, with ſcarcely the human form: [CLVI] another, ſeemingly the chief, almoſt blind: the third, a girl: the laſt, the wife. She made uſe of Captain KING to act as a charm to reſtore her blind huſband to his ſight*. He was firſt directed to hold his breath; then to breathe on, and afterwards to ſpit on his eyes. We are not without ſimilar ſuperſtitions. The Romans applied the ſame remedy to diſeaſes of the ſame part: but I doubt whether they, or our poliſhed nation, ever expreſſed the ſame feelings as this poor woman did. She related her ſtory in the moſt pathetic manner; ſhe preſſed the hands of the Captain to the breaſt of her huſband, while ſhe was relating the calamitous hiſtory of her family; pointed ſometimes to the huſband, ſometimes to the cripple, and ſometimes to the poor child. Unable to contain any longer, ſhe burſt into tears and lamentation. She was followed by the reſt of her kindred in an uniſon, which, I truſt, filled the eyes of the civilized beholders, as their relation has mine.

From Cape Darby the land trends to the weſt, and ends in Point Rodney; low land, with high land far beyond, taking a northerly direction inland. Off this point, in lat. 64. 30, is Sledge iſland, ſo called from a ſledge being found on it, reſembling thoſe which the Ruſſians uſe in Kamtſchatka to carry goods over the ſnow. It was ten feet long, twenty inches broad, with a rail on each ſide, and ſhod with bone; all neatly put together, in ſome parts with wooden pins, but moſtly with thongs of whalebone: a proof of the ingenuity of the natives. Whether it was to be drawn with dogs or rein-deer, does not appear; for the iſland was deſerted, and only the remains of a few jourts to be ſeen. In lat. 64. 55, long. 192, is KING'S iſland, named in honor of the able and worthy continuator of the voyage. The continent oppoſite to it bends towards the eaſt, and forms a ſhallow bay; then ſuddenly runs far into the ſea, and makes the moſt weſtern extremity yet known, and probably the moſt weſtern of all. On it were ſeveral huts; and ſtages of bone, ſuch as had been obſerved in the Tſchutſki country. This cape forms one ſide of BERING'S ſtreights, and lies nearly oppoſite to Eaſt Cape, on the Aſiatic ſhore, at the ſmall diſtance of only thirty-nine miles. This lies in lat. 65. 46; is named Cape Prince of Wales; is low land, and the heights, as uſual, appeared beyond; among which is a remarkable peaked hill. It would be unjuſt to the memory of paſt navigators, not to ſay, that there is the greateſt probability that either this cape, or part of the continent adjacent to it, was diſcovered, in 1730, by Michael Gwoſdew, a land ſurveyor attendant on the Coſſack, [CLVII] Colonel Scheſtakow, in the unfortunate expedition undertaken by him to render the Tſchutſki tributary*.

Here begins the Icy Sea or Frozen Ocean. The country trends ſtrongly to the eaſt, and forms, in lat. 67. 45, long. 194. 51, Point Mulgrave; POINT MULGRAVE. the land low, backed inland with moderate hills, but all barren, and deſtitute of trees. From hence it makes a ſlight trend to the weſt. Cape Liſburn lies in lat. 69; and Icy Cape, the moſt extreme land ſeen by any navigators on this ſide, was obſerved in lat. 70. 29, long. 198. 20, by our illuſtrious ſeaman, on Auguſt 18th 1778. The preceding day he had made an advance as high as 70. 41; but, baffled by impenetrable ice, upon the juſteſt reaſoning was obliged to give up all thoughts of the north-eaſt paſſage: which reaſons were confirmed, in the following year, by his ſucceſſor in command, Captain CLERKE. All the trials made by that perſevering commander could not attain a higher latitude than 70. 11, long. 196. 15. He found himſelf laboring under a lingering diſeaſe, which he knew muſt be fatal, unleſs he could gain a more favorable climate; but his high ſenſe of honor, and of his duty to his orders, determined him to perſiſt, till the impoſſibility of ſucceſs was determined by every officer. He gave way to their opinion, ſailed towards the ſouthward on July 21ſt, and on Auguſt 22d honorably ſunk, at the age of thirty-eight, under a diſorder contracted by a continued ſcene of hardſhips, endured from his earlieſt youth in the ſervices of his country.

To ſuch characters as theſe we are indebted for the little we know, and probably all that can be known, of the ICY SEA.OF THE ICY SEA. The antients had ſome obſcure notion of its coaſts, and have given it the name of Scythicum Mare; a cape jutting into it was ſtyled Scythicum Promontorium; and an iſland at the bottom of a deep bay to the weſt of it, Scythica Inſula. It is following the conjectures of the ingenious to ſay, that the firſt may be the Cape Jalmal, and the laſt, Nova Zemlja, which ſome will make the Inſula Tazata of Pliny, as it reſembles in name the river Tas, which flows almoſt oppoſite to it into the gulph of Ob . The knowlege which the antients had of theſe parts muſt have been from traffic. The old Ladoga was, in very early times, a place of great commerce, by aſſiſtance of rivers and ſeas, even from the fartheſt parts of the Mediterranean; the coins of Syria, Arabia, Greece, and Rome, having been found in the burial-places adjoining to that antient city§. Another channel of knowlege was formed from the great traffic carried on by the merchants, from even the remote India, up the Volga and the Kama, and from thence to Tſcherdyn, an emporium on the river Kolva, [CLVIII] ſeated in the antient Permia or Biormia, and not far ſouth of the river Peczora. From thence the Biormas, who ſeem to have been the factors, embarked with the merchandize on that river, went down with it to the coaſts of the Frozen Sea; and, after obtaining furs in exchange, they returned and delivered them, at Tſcherdyn, to the foreign merchants*: and from them the antients might pick up accounts.

The ICY SEA extends from Nova Zemlja to the coaſt of America. We have ſeen how unable even the Ruſſians have been to ſurvey its coaſts, except by interrupted detail, notwithſtanding it formed part of their own vaſt empire. To our navigators was given the honor not only of ſettling parts of its geography with preciſion, but of exploring the whole ſpace between the moſt northern promontory of Aſia and the fartheſt acceſſible part of America. This was a tract of one hundred leagues. The traverſing it was a work of infinite difficulty and danger.DEPTH. The ſea ſhallow; and the change from the greateſt depth, which did not exceed thirty fathoms, to the leſt, which was only eight, was ſudden: the bottom muddy, cauſed by the quantity of earth brought down from the vaſt rivers which pour into it from the Aſiatic ſide. We ſuſpect that it receives but few from the American, their general tendency being eaſt and weſt. The Icy Sea is ſhallow, not only becauſe its tides and currents are very inconſiderable; but its outlet through the ſtreights of Bering very narrow, and even obſtructed in the middle by the iſlands of St. Diomedes: both which circumſtances impede the carrying away of the mud. The current, ſmall as it is, comes chiefly from the ſouth-weſt, and is another impediment. The land of each continent is very low near the ſhores, and high at a ſmall diſtance from them: the former is one inſtance of a correſpondent ſhallowneſs of water. The ſoundings off each continent, at the ſame diſtances from the ſhore, were exactly the ſame.

ICE.The ice of this ſea differs greatly from that of Spitzbergen. It probably is entirely generated from the ſea-water. The Icy Sea ſeems to be in no part bounded by lofty land, in the valleys of which might have been formed the ſtupendous icebergs, which, tumbling down, form thoſe lofty iſlands we had before occaſion to mention. The ice here is moveable, except about the great headlands, which are beſet with a rugged mountanous ice. It is notorious, that a ſtrong gale from the north in twenty-four hours covers the whole coaſt, for numbers of miles in breadth; will fill the ſtreights of BERING, and even the Kamtſchatkan ſeas; and in ſmaller pieces extend to its iſlands. In the Icy Sea it conſiſts chiefly of field ice. Some fields, very large, and ſurrounded with leſſer, from forty [CLIX] to fifty yards in extent, to four or five; the thickneſs of the larger pieces was about thirty feet under water; and the greateſt height of others above, about ſixteen or eighteen. It was tranſparent, except on the ſurface, which was a little porous, and often very rugged: the reſt compact as a wall. At times it muſt pack; for the mountanous ice which the Coſſack Morkoff aſcended (ſee p. c.) muſt have been of that nature. The deſtruction of the ice is not effected by the ſun, in a climate where fogs reign in far greater proportion than the ſolar beams; neither will the ſtreights of BERING permit the eſcape of quantity ſufficient to clear the ſea of its vaſt load. It muſt, in a little time, become wholly filled with it, was it not for the rage of the winds, which daſhes the pieces together, breaks and grinds them into minute parts, which ſoon melt, and reſolve into their original element.

The animals of this ſea are very few, and may be reduced to the Polar Bear, ANIMALS. No 18; the Walrus, No 71; and Seals. The firſt does not differ from thoſe of other arctic countries: it is beautifully engraven in tab. LXXIII. of the Voyage. Amidſt the extraordinary ſcenery in tab. LII. is given the only accurate figure of the Walrus I have ever ſeen. I cannot but ſuſpect it to be a variety of the ſpecies found in the Spitzbergen ſeas. The tuſks are more ſlender, and have a ſlight diſtinguiſhing flexure: the whole animal is alſo much leſs. The length of one (not indeed the largeſt) was only nine feet four inches; its greateſt circumference ſeven feet ten; weight, excluſive of the entrails, about eleven hundred pounds. They lay on the ice by thouſands; and in the foggy weather cautioned our navigators, by their roaring, from running foul of it. They are uſually ſeen ſleeping, but never without ſome centinels to give notice of approaching danger: theſe awakened the next to them, they their neighbors, till the whole herd was rouſed. Theſe animals are the objects of chace with the Tſchutſki, who eat the fleſh, and cover their boats and hovels with the ſkins. Whales abound in this ſea. Fiſh,FISH. the food of Seals, and partly of the polar Bears, muſt be found here, notwithſtanding they eſcaped the notice of the navigators. Shells and ſea-plants, the food of the Walrus, cannot be wanting.

Many ſpecies of birds (which will occur in their place) were ſeen traverſing this ſea. Geeſe and Ducks were obſerved migrating ſouthward in Auguſt; BIRDS. whether from their breeding-place in a circum-polar land, or whether from the probably far-extending land of America, is not to be determined. Drift-wood was very ſeldom ſeen here. Two trees, about three feet in girth, with their roots, were once obſerved, but without bark or branches; a proof that they had been brought from afar, and left naked by their conteſt with the ice and elements.

The ſea, from the ſouth of BERING'S ſtreights to the creſcent of iſles between [CLX] Aſia and America, is very ſhallow. It deepens from theſe ſtreights (as the Britiſh ſeas do from thoſe of Dover) till ſoundings are loſt in the Pacific Ocean; but that does not take place but to the ſouth of the iſles. Between them and the ſtreights is an increaſe from twelve to fifty-four fathom, except only off St. Thaddeus Noſs, where there is a channel of greater depth. From the vulcanic diſpoſition I am led to believe not only that there was a ſeparation of the continents at the ſtreights of BERING, but that the whole ſpace, from the iſles to that ſmall opening, had once been occupied by land; and that the fury of the watery element, actuated by that of fire, had, in moſt remote times, ſubverted and overwhelmed the tract, and left the iſlands monumental fragments.

Whether that great event took place before or after the population of America, is as impoſſible, as it is of little moment, for us to know. We are indebted to our navigators for ſettling the long diſpute about the point from which it was effected. They, by their diſcoveries, prove, that in one place the diſtance between continent and continent is only thirty-nine miles, not (as a celebrated caviliſt * would have it) eight hundred leagues. This narrow ſtreight has alſo in the middle two iſlands, which would greatly facilitate the migration of the Aſiatics into the New World, ſuppoſing that it took place in canoes, after the convulſion which rent the two continents aſunder. Beſides, it may be added, that theſe ſtreights are, even in the ſummer, often filled with ice; in winter, often frozen: in either caſe mankind might find an eaſy paſſage; in the laſt, the way was extremely ready for quadrupeds to croſs, and ſtock the continent of America. I may fairly call in the machinery of vulcanoes to tear away the other means of tranſit farther to the ſouth, and bring in to my aſſiſtance the former ſuppoſition of ſolid land between Kamtſchatka and Oonalaſcha, inſtead of the creſcent of iſlands, and which, prior to the great cataſtrophe, would have greatly enlarged the means of migration; but the caſe is not of that difficulty to require the ſolution. One means of paſſage is indiſputably eſtabliſhed.

But where, from the vaſt expanſe of the north-eaſtern world, to fix on the firſt tribes who contributed to people the new continent, now inhabited almoſt from end to end, is a matter that baffles human reaſon. The learned may make bold and ingenious conjectures, but plain good ſenſe cannot always accede to them. As mankind encreaſed in numbers, they naturally protruded one another forward. Wars might be another cauſe of migrations. I know no reaſon why the Aſiatic north might not be an officina virorum, as well as the European. The overteeming country, to the eaſt of the Riphaean mountains, muſt find it neceſſary to diſcharge its inhabitants: the firſt great wave of people was forced forward by the next to [CLXI] at, more tumid and more powerful than itſelf: ſucceſſive and new impulſes continually arriving, ſhort reſt was given to that which ſpread over a more eaſtern tract; diſturbed again and again, it covered freſh regions; at length, reaching the fartheſt limits of the Old World, found a new one, with ample ſpace to occupy unmoleſted for ages; till Columbus curſed them by a diſcovery, which brought again new ſins and new deaths to both worlds.

The inhabitants of the NEW do not conſiſt of the offspring of a ſingle nation: different people, at ſeveral periods, arrived there; and it is impoſſible to ſay, that any one is now to be found on the original ſpot of its colonization. It is impoſſible, with the lights which we have ſo recently received, to admit that America could receive its inhabitants (at leſt the bulk of them) from any other place than eaſtern Aſia. A few proofs may be added, taken from cuſtoms or dreſſes common to the inhabitants of both worlds: ſome have been long extinct in the old, others remain in both in full force.

The cuſtom of ſcalping was a barbariſm in uſe with the Scythians, CUSTOMS COMMON TO AMERICA AND THE NORTH OF ASIA. who carried about them at all times this ſavage mark of triumph: they cut a circle round the neck, and ſtripped off the ſkin, as they would that of an ox*. A little image, found among the Kalmues, of a Tartarian deity, mounted on a horſe, and ſitting on a human ſkin, with ſcalps pendent from the breaſt, fully illuſtrates the cuſtom of the Scythian progenitors, as deſcribed by the Greek hiſtorian. This uſage, as the Europeans know by horrid experience, is continued to this day in America. The ferocity of the Scythians to their priſoners extended to the remoteſt part of Aſia. The Kamtſchatkans, even at the time of their diſcovery by the Ruſſians , put their priſoners to death by the moſt lingering and excruciating inventions; a practice in fell force to this very day among the aboriginal Americans. A race of the Scythians were ſtyled Anthropophagi , from their feeding on human fleſh. The people of Nootka Sound ſtill make a repaſt on their fellow creatures§: but what is more wonderful, the ſavage allies of the Britiſh army have been known to throw the mangled limbs of the French priſoners into the horrible cauldron, and devour them with the ſame reliſh as thoſe of a quadruped.

The Scythians were ſayed, for a certain time, annually to transform themſelves into wolves, and again to reſume the human ſhape. The new-diſcovered Americans about Nootka Sound, at this time diſguiſe themſelves in dreſſes made of the ſkins of wolves and other wild beaſts, and wear even the heads fitted to their [CLXII] own*. Theſe habits they uſe in the chace, to circumvent the animals of the field. But would not ignorance or ſuperſtition aſcribe to a ſupernatural metamorphoſis theſe temporary expedients to deceive the brute creation?

In their marches the Kamtſchatkans never went abreaſt, but followed one another in the ſame track. The ſame cuſtom is exactly obſerved by the Americans.

The Tunguſi, the moſt numerous nation reſident in Sibiria, prick their faces with ſmall punctures, with a needle, in various ſhapes; then rub into them charcoal, ſo that the marks become indelible. This cuſtom is ſtill obſerved in ſeveral parts of America. The Indians on the back of Hudſon's bay, to this day perform the operation exactly in the ſame manner, and puncture the ſkin into various figures; as the natives of New Zealand do at preſent, and as the antient Britons did with the herb Glaſtum, or Woad§; and the Virginians, on the firſt diſcovery of that country by the Engliſh .

The Tunguſi uſe canoes made of birch-bark, diſtended over ribs of wood, and nicely ſewed together. The Canadian, and many other American nations, uſe no other ſort of boats. The paddles of the Tunguſi are broad at each end; thoſe of the people near Cook's river, and of Oonalaſcha, are of the ſame form.

In burying of the dead, many of the American nations place the corpſe at full length, after preparing it according to their cuſtoms; others place it in a ſitting poſture, and lay by it the moſt valuable cloathing, wampum, and other matters. The Tartars did the ſame: and both people agree in covering the whole with earth, ſo as to form a tumulus, barrow, or carnedd**.

Some of the American nations hang their dead in trees. Certain of the Tunguſi obſerve a ſimilar cuſtom.

I can draw ſome analogy from dreſs: conveniency in that article muſt have been conſulted on both continents, and originally the materials muſt have been the ſame, the ſkins of birds and beaſts. It is ſingular, that the conic bonnet of the Chineſe ſhould be found among the people of Nootka. I cannot give into the notion, that the Chineſe contributed to the population of the New World; but I can readily admit, that a ſhipwreck might furniſh thoſe Americans with a pattern for that part of the dreſs.

SIMILAR FEATURES.In reſpect to the features and form of the human body, almoſt every tribe found along the weſtern coaſt has ſome ſimilitude to the Tartar nations, and ſtill retain the little eyes, ſmall noſes, high cheeks, and broad faces. They vary in ſize, [CLXIII] from the luſty Calmucs to the little Nogaians. The internal Americans, ſuch as the Five Indian nations, who are tall of body, robuſt in make, and of oblong faces, are derived from a variety among the Tartars themſelves. The fine race of Tſchutſki ſeem to be the ſtock from which thoſe Americans are derived. The Tſchutſki again, from that fine race of Tartars, the Kabardinſki, or inhabitants of Kabarda.

But about Prince William's Sound begins a race,ESKIMAUX. chiefly diſtinguiſhed by their dreſs, their canoes, and their inſtruments of the chace, from the tribes to the ſouth of them. Here commences the Eſkimaux people, or the race known by that name in the high latitudes of the eaſtern ſide of the continent. They may be divided into two varieties. At this place they are of the largeſt ſize. As they advance northward they decreaſe in height, till they dwindle into the dwarfiſh tribes which occupy ſome of the coaſts of the Icy Sea *, and the maritime parts of Hudſon's bay, of Greenland, and Terra de Labrador. The famous Japaneſe map places ſome iſlands ſeemingly within the ſtreights of BERING, on which is beſtowed the title of Ya Zue, or the kingdom of the dwarfs. Does not this in ſome manner authenticate the chart, and give us reaſon to ſuppoſe that America was not unknown to the Japaneſe, and that they had (as is mentioned by Kaempfer and Charlevoix ) made voyages of diſcovery, and, according to the laſt, actually wintered on the continent? That they might have met with the Eſkimaux is very probable; whom, in compariſon of themſelves, they might juſtly diſtinguiſh by the name of dwarfs. The reaſon of their low ſtature is very obvious: theſe dwell in a moſt ſevere climate, amidſt penury of food; the former in one much more favorable, abundant in proviſions; circumſtances that tend to prevent the degeneracy of the human frame. At the iſland of Oonalaſcha a dialect of the Eſkimaux is in uſe, which was continued along the whole coaſt, from thence northward. I have before mentioned the ſimilarity in the inſtruments between the Americans of this ſide of the coaſt and the Eſkimaux, which is continued even to Greenland.

I cannot think the accounts well ſupported,WELSH. that America received any part of its firſt inhabitants from Europe, prior to the fifteenth century. The Welſh fondly imagine that our country contributed, in 1170, to people the New World, by the adventure of Madoc, ſon of Owen Gwynedd, who, on the death of his father, ſailed there, and colonized part of the country. All that is advanced in proof is, a quotation from one of our poets, which proves no more than that he had diſtinguiſhed himſelf by ſea and land. It is pretended that he made two voyages: that ſailing weſt, he left Ireland ſo far to the north, that he came to a land unknown, where [CLXIV] he ſaw many ſtrange things: that he returned home, and, making a report of the fruitfulneſs of the new-diſcovered country, prevaled on numbers of the Welſh of each ſex to accompany him on a ſecond voyage, from which he never returned. The favorers of this opinion aſſert, that ſeveral Welſh words, ſuch as gwrando, to hearken or liſten; the iſle of Croeſo or welcome; Cape Breton, from the name of our own iſland; gwynndwr, or the white water; and pengwin, or the bird with a white head; are to be found in the American language*. I can lay little ſtreſs on this argument, becauſe likeneſs of ſound in a few words will not be deemed ſufficient to eſtabliſh the fact; eſpecially if the meaning has been evidently perverted: for example, the whole Pinguin tribe have unfortunately not only black heads, but are not inhabitants of the northern hemiſphere; the name was alſo beſtowed on them by the Dutch, a Pinguedine, from their exceſſive fatneſs: but the inventor of this, thinking to do honor to our country, inconſiderately caught at a word of European origin, and unheard of in the New World. It may be added, that the Welſh were never a naval people; that the age in which Madoc lived was peculiarly ignorant in navigation; and the moſt which they could have attempted muſt have been a mere coaſting voyage.

NORWEGIANS.The Norwegians put in for ſhare of the glory, on grounds rather better than the Welſh. By their ſettlements in Iceland and in Greenland, they had arrived within ſo ſmall a diſtance of the New World, that there is at leſt a poſſibility of its having been touched at by a people ſo verſed in maritime affairs, and ſo adventurous, as the antient Nortmans were. The proofs are much more numerous than thoſe produced by the Britiſh hiſtorians; for the diſcovery is mentioned in ſeveral of the Icelandic manuſcripts. The period was about the year 1002, when it was viſited by one Biorn; and the diſcovery purſued to greater effect by Leif, the ſon of Eric, the diſcoverer of Greenland. It does not appear that they reached farther than Labrador; on which coaſt they met with Eſkimaux, on whom they beſtowed the name of Skraelingue [...], or dwarfiſh people, from their ſmall ſtature. They were armed with bows and arrows, and had leathern canoes, ſuch as they have at preſent. All this is probable; nor ſhould the tale of the German, called Turkil, one of the crew, invalidate the account. He was one day miſſing; but ſoon returned, leaping and ſinging with all the extravagant marks of joy a bon vivant could ſhew, on diſcovering the inebriating fruit of his country, the grape: Torfaeus even ſays, that he returned in a ſtate of intoxication§. To convince his commander, he brought ſeveral bunches, who from that circumſtance named the country Vinland. I do [CLXV] not deny that North America produces the true vine*; but it is found in far lower latitudes than our adventurers could reach in the time employed in their voyage, which was comprehended in a very ſmall ſpace. I have no doubt of the diſcovery; but, as the land was never colonized, nor any advantages made of it, it may be fairly conjectured, that they reached no farther than the barren country of Labrador.

The continent which ſtocked America with the human race, poured in the brute creation through the ſame paſſage. Very few quadrupeds continued in the peninſula of Kamtſchatka. I can enumerate only twenty-five which are inhabitants of land; for I muſt omit the marine animals, which had at all times power of changing their ſituation: all the reſt perſiſted in their migration, and fixed their reſidence in the New World. Seventeen of the Kamtſchatkan quadrupeds are found in America: others are common only to Sibiria or Tartary, having, for unknown cauſes, entirely evacuated Kamtſchatka, and divided themſelves between America and the parts of Aſia above cited. Multitudes again have deſerted the Old World, even to an individual, and fixed their ſeats at diſtances moſt remote from the ſpot from which they took their departure; from mount Ararat, the reſting-place of the ark, in a central part of the Old World, and excellently adapted for the diſperſion of the animal creation to all its parts. We need not be ſtartled at the vaſt journies many of the quadrupeds took to arrive at their preſent ſeats: Might not numbers of ſpecies have found a convenient abode in the vaſt Alps of Aſia, inſtead of wandering to the Cordilleras of Chili? or might not others have been contented with the boundleſs plains of Tartary, inſtead of travelling thouſands of miles, to the extenſive flats of Pampas?—To endeavour to elucidate common difficulties is certainly a trouble worthy of the philoſopher and of the divine; not to attempt it would be a criminal indolence, a neglect to ‘Vindicate the ways of God to man.’ But there are multitudes of points beyond the human ability to explain, and yet are truths undeniable: the facts are indiſputable, notwithſtanding the cauſes are concealed. In ſuch caſes, faith muſt be called in to our relief. It would certainly be the height of folly to deny to that Being who broke open the great fountains of the deep to effect the deluge—and afterwards, to compel the diſperſion of mankind to people the globe, directed the confuſion of languages—powers inferior in their nature to theſe. After theſe wondrous proofs of Omnipotency, [CLXVI] it will be abſurd to deny the poſſibility of infuſing inſtinct into the brute creation. DEUS eſt anima brutorum; GOD himſelf is the ſoul of brutes: His pleaſure muſt have determined their will, and directed ſeveral ſpecies, and even whole genera, by impulſe irreſiſtible, to move by ſlow progreſſion to their deſtined regions. But for that, the Llama and the Pacos might ſtill have inhabited the heights of Armenia and ſome more neighboring Alps, inſtead of laboring to gain the diſtant Peruvian Andes; the whole genus of Armadillos, ſlow of foot, would never have abſolutely quitted the torrid zone of the Old World for that of the New; and the whole tribe of Monkies would have gambolled together in the foreſts of India, inſtead of dividing their reſidence between the ſhades of Indoſtan and the deep foreſts of the Braſils. Lions and Tigers might have infeſted the hot parts of the New World, as the firſt do the deſerts of Africa, and the laſt the provinces of Aſia; or the Pantherine animals of South America might have remained additional ſcourges with the ſavage beaſts of thoſe antient continents. The Old World would have been overſtocked with animals; the New remained an unanimated waſte! or both have contained an equal portion of every beaſt of the earth. Let it not be objected, that animals bred in a ſouthern climate, after the deſcent of their parents from the ark, would be unable to bear the froſt and ſnow of the rigorous north, before they reached South America, the place of their final deſtination. It muſt be conſidered, that the migration muſt have been the work of ages; that in the courſe of their progreſs each generation grew hardened to the climate it had reached; and that after their arrival in America, they would again be gradually accuſtomed to warmer and warmer climates, in their removal from north to ſouth, as they had in the reverſe, or from ſouth to north. Part of the Tigers ſtill inhabit the eternal ſnows of Ararat, and multitudes of the very ſame ſpecies live, but with exalted rage, beneath the Line, in the burning ſoil of Borneo or Sumatra; but neither Lions or Tigers ever migrated into the New World. A few of the firſt are found in India and Perſia, but they are found in numbers only in Africa. The Tiger extends as far north as weſtern Tartary, in lat. 40. 50, but never has reached Africa. I ſhall cloſe this account with obſerving, that it could be from no other part of the globe except Aſia, from whence the New World could receive the animal creation.

The late voyage of the illuſtrious COOK has reduced the probable conjectures of philoſophers into certainty. He has proved that the limits of the Old and New World approach within thirteen leagues of each other. We know that the intervening ſtreights are frequently frozen up; and we have great reaſon to ſuppoſe, that the two continents might have been once united, even as low as the Aleutian iſlands, or lat. 52. 30. Thus are diſcovered two means of paſſage from Aſia to America; the laſt [CLXVII] in a climate not more rigorous than that which ſeveral animals might very well endure, and yet afterwards proceed gradually to the extreme of heat.

In fact, every other ſyſtem of the population of the New World is now overthrown. The conjectures of the learned, reſpecting the vicinity of the Old and New, are now, by the diſcoveries of our great navigator, loſt in conviction. The ſtrained ſyſtems of divines, laudably indeed exerted in elucidating SACRED WRIT, appear to have been ill-founded; but, in the place of imaginary hypotheſes, the real place of migration is uncontrovertibly pointed out. Some (from a paſſage in Plato) have extended over the Atlantic, from the ſtreights of Gibraltar to the coaſt of North and South America, an iſland equal in ſize to the continents of Aſia and Africa; over which had paſſed, as over a bridge, from the latter, men and animals; wool-headed Negroes, and Lions and Tigers*, none of which ever exiſted in the New World. A mighty ſea aroſe, and in one day and night engulphed this ſtupendous tract, and with it every being which had not completed its migration into America. The whole Negro race, and almoſt every Quadruped, now inhabitants of Africa, periſhed in this critical day. Five only are to be found at preſent in America; and of theſe only one, the Bear, in South America. Not a ſingle cuſtom, common to the natives of Africa and America, to evince a common origin. Of the Quadrupeds, the Bear, Stag, Wolf, Fox, and Weeſel, are the only animals which we can pronounce with certainty to be found on each continent. The Stag, Fox, and Weeſel, have made alſo no farther progreſs in Africa than the north; but on the ſame continent the Wolf is ſpread over every part, yet is unknown in South America, as are the Fox and Weeſel. I ſuſpect, beſides, that the Stag hath not advanced farther ſouth than Mexico. In Africa and South America the Bear is very local, being met with only in the north of the firſt, and on the Andes in the laſt. Some cauſe unknown arreſted its progreſs in Africa, and impelled the migration of a few into the Chilian Alps, and induced them to leave unoccupied the vaſt tract from North America to the lofty Cordilleras.—My promiſed Table of Quadrupeds will at once give a view of thoſe which inhabit North America, and are either peculiar to it, or are met [CLXVIII] with in other countries. It certainly will point out the courſe they have taken in their migration; and, in caſe miſnomers are avoided, will reduce to the ſingle continent of Aſia the original country from whence they ſprung. Men of the firſt abilities, and firſt in learning, who have neglected the ſtudy of natural hiſtory, will give Lions and Tigers to America, miſled by the ignorance of travellers, who miſtake the Puma, No 14 of this Work, for the firſt; and the ſpotted wild beaſts, allied to the Pantherine race, for the ſecond.

TABLE OF QUADRUPEDS.
HOOFED.
GENUS. OLD WORLD.NEW WORLD.
I. OX.Biſon, No 1.In parts of Lithuania, and about mount Caucaſus; except there, univerſally domeſticated.To the weſt of Canada, and as low as Louiſiana. In New Mexico, on the weſtern ſide of North America.
 Muſk, No 2.A variety in the interior parts of Guinea, and the ſouth of Africa. See Hiſt. Quad. i. No 9.To the north of Hudſon's Bay, from Churchil river to lat. 73, and among the Chriſtinaux, and in New Mexico.
II. SHEEP.Argali, p. 12.Sardinia. Corſica. Crete. North of India. Perſian Alps. About the Onon and Argun, in Sibiria. Mongalia, to lat. 60. Eaſt of the Lena, and quite to Kamtſchatka.Suſpected to be found in California; but not on the beſt authorities.
III. DEER.Mooſe, No 3.Norway. Sweden, to lat. 64. Ruſſia. Sibiria, as low as lat. 53. As far eaſt as Lake Baikal; and in the north of China to the north of Corea. lat. 45*.Hudſon's Bay. Canada. Nova Scotia. New England; and near the northern part of the river Ohio.
 Rein, No 4.Lapland. Norway. Samoiedea. Along the Arctic coaſts, to Kamtſchatka. In the Urallian mountains to Kungur, in lat. 57. 10. About Lake Baikal Spitzbergen. Greenland.Hudſon's Bay. Northern parts of Canada. Labrador Iſland of New-foundland.
 Stag, No 5.Norway, and moſt part of Europe to the ſouth. In the north of Aſia. China. Barbary. E.From Canada, over all parts of North America. Mexico.
 Virginian, No 6. From the province ſouth of Canada to Florida. Perhaps in Guiana.
 Mexican Roe, No 7. Interior north-weſtern parts of America? Mexico.
 Roe, N 8.Norway. Sweden. Moſt part of Europe, except Ruſſia. Scotland.According to Charlevoix, in Canada?
DIGITATED. DIV. I.
IV. DOG.Wolf, No 9.From the Arctic circle to the moſt ſouthern part of Europe. In Aſia, from the circle to Perſia. Kamtſchatka. All parts of Africa.From Hudſon's Bay to the moſt ſouthern parts of North America.
 Arctic Fox, No 10.Within the whole Arctic circle. Iceland. Spitzbergen. Greenland. Finmark. North of Sibiria. Kamtſchatka, and its iſles.Hudſon's Bay. The iſles in the high latitudes on the weſtern ſide of America.
 Common Fox, No 11.In all parts of Europe, and the cold and temperate parts of Aſia. Kamtſchatka, and its furtheſt iſles. Iceland. E.From Hudſon's Bay, croſs the continent to the Fox Iſles. Labrador. Newfoundland. Canada. Not further ſouth: a variety only, the Brandt Fox, in Penſylvania.
 Grey, No 12. From New England to the ſouthern end of North America.
 Silvery, No 13. In Louiſiana.
V. CAT.Puma, No 14. From Canada to Florida; thence through Mexico, quite to Quito in Peru.
 Lynx, No 15.Foreſts of the north of Europe. and many of the ſouth. Spain. North of Aſia, and the mountains in the north of India*.From Canada, over moſt parts of North America.
 Bay Lynx, No 16. In the province of New York.
 Mountain, No 17. Carolina, and perhaps other parts of North America.
VI. BEAR.Polar, No 18.Within the whole polar circle of Europe and Aſia.The ſame in America; alſo as low as Hudſon's Bay and Labrador.
 Black, No 19.Jeſo Maſima, north of Japan; perhaps in Japan.In all parts of North America.
 Brown, No 20.In moſt parts of Europe, north and ſouth. The ſame in Aſia, even as far as Arabia. Barbary Ceylon. Kamtſchatka.To the north-weſt of Hudſon's Bay, and on the weſtern ſide of America. About Nootka Sound. On the Andes of Peru
 Wolverene, No 21.North of Norway. Lapland. North of Sibiria. Kamtſchatka.As far north as the Copper River, and ſouth as the country between lake Huron and Superior. On the weſtern ſide of North America.
 Raccoon, No 22. From New England to Florida. Mexico. Iſles of Maria, near Cape Corientes, in the South Sea.
VII. BADGER.No 23.In the ſouth of Norway, and all the more ſouthern parts of Europe. In the temperate parts of Aſia, as far as China eaſtward. E.In the neighborhood of Hudſon's Bay. Terra de Labrador, and as low as Penſylvania.
VIII. OPOSSUM.Virginian, No 24. As far north as Canada, and from thence to the Braſils and Peru.
IX. WEESEL.Common, No 25.Moſt parts of Europe. Sibiria. Kamtſchatka. Barbary. E.Hudſon's Bay. Newfoundland. As far ſouth as Carolina.
 Stoat, No 26.All the northern parts of Europe and Aſia; and as far as Kamtſchatka and the Kuril iſles. E.Hudſon's Bay, and as low as Newfoundland and Canada.
 Pine Martin, No 27.North of Europe. Rare in France. Only in the weſt of Sibiria. In China. E.Northern parts of North America, quite to the South Sea.
 Pekan, No 28. Hudſon's Bay. Canada.
 Viſon, No 29. Canada.
 Sable, No 30.Sibiria. Kamtſchatka. Kuril iſles.Canada.
 Fiſher, No 31. Hudſon's Bay. New England. Penſylvannia.
 Striated, No 32. Penſylvania to Louiſiana.
 Skunk, No 33. From Hudſon's Bay to Peru.
X. OTTER.Common, No 34.Northern Europe and Aſia. Kamtſchatka. E.From Hudſon's Bay to Louiſiana.
 Leſſer, No 35.About the banks of the Yaik. Poland. Lithuania. Finland.From New Jerſey to Carolina.
 Sea, No 36.Kamtſchatka. Kuril iſles.Weſtern coaſt of America.
DIV. II.
XI. HARE.Varying, No 37.Scandinavia. Ruſſia. Sibiria. Kamtſchatka. Greenland. E.Hudſon's Bay. About COOK'S river.
 American, No 38. From Hudſon's Bay to the extremity of North America.
 Alpine, No 39.From the Altaic chain to lake Baikal; thence to Kamtſchatka.Aleutian iſles. Poſſibly the weſt of North America.
XII. BEAVER.Caſtor, No 40.Scandinavia. About the Jeneſei and Kondu. In Caſan, and about the Yaik.From Hudſon's Bay to Louiſiana.
 Muſk, No 41. From Hudſon's Bay to Louiſiana.
XIII. PORCUPINE.Canada, No 42. From Hudſon's Bay to Virginia.
XIV. MARMOT.Quebec, No 43 Canada.
 Maryland, No 44. From Penſylvania to the Bahama iſles.
 Hoary, No 45. North of North America.
 Tail-leſs, No 46. Hudſon's Bay.
 Earleſs, No 47.Bohemia. Auſtria. Hungary. From the Occa over the temperate parts of Sibiria. About Jakutz. Kamtſchatka.Weſtern ſide of North America.
XV. SQUIRREL.Hudſon, No 48. Hudſon's Bay. Labrador.
 Grey, No 49. New England to Peru and Chili.
 Black, No 50. New England to Mexico.
 Flying, No 51. From the ſouthern part of Hudſon's Bay to Mexico.
 Hooded, No 52. Virginia.
 Severn River, No 53. Hudſon's Bay.
XVI. DORMOUSE.Striped, No 54.Sibiria, as high as lat. 65.Hudſon's Bay to Louiſiana.
 Engliſh? No 55.Sweden, and all Europe ſouth. E. Carolina? 
XVII. RAT.Black, No 56.All Europe. Many of the South Sea iſlands. E.The rocks among the Blue Mountains.
 American, No 58.Mongolia.North America.
 Water, No 59.From Lapland to the ſouth of Europe. From Peterſburgh to Kamtſchatka, and as low as the Caſpian ſea, and Perſia. E.From Canada to Carolina.
 Mouſe, No 60.Univerſal. E.Among the rocks, with the Black Rat.
 Field, No 61.All Europe. Not beyond the Urallian chain. E.Hudſon's Bay. New York.
 Virginian, No 62. Virginia.
 Labrador, No 63. Hudſon's Bay. Labrador.
 Hudſon's, No 64. Same places.
 Meadow, No 65.Sweden. All temperate Ruſſia. In Sibiria only to the Irtiſch. E.Hudſon's Bay. Newfoundland.
 Hare-tailed? No 66.Sibiria.Hudſon's Bay.
XVIII. SHREW.Foetid, No 67.Europe. Sibiria. Kamtſchatka E.Hudſon's Bay. Carolina.
XIX. MOLE.Long-tailed, No 68. New York. Interior parts of Hudſon's Bay.
 Radiated, No 69. New York.
 Brown, No 70. New York.
DIV. III.
XX. WALRUS.Arctic, No 71.Spitzbergen. Greenland. Nova Zemlja. The coaſt of the Frozen Sea. And on the Aſiatic ſide, to the ſouth of Bering's ſtreights, as low as lat. 62. 50.Hudſon's Bay. Gulph of St. Laurence. On the weſtern ſide of America, as low as lat. 58. 42.
XXI. SEAL.Common, No 72.All the European and northern Aſiatic ſeas, even to the fartheſt north. Kamtſchatka. E.Northern ſeas of America.
 Great, No 73.Greenland and Kamtſchatka. E.Weſt of North America.
 Leporine, No 75.White Sea. Iceland. Spitzbergen. Kamtſchatka.There can be no doubt that every ſpecies of Seal is found on the American coaſt.
 Harp, No 77.Spitzbergen. Greenland. Iceland. White Sea. Kamtſchatka. 
 Urfine, No 79.Kamtſchatka. New Zealand.Weſt of America, and from the iſle of Gallipagos to New Georgia.
 Leonine, No 80.Kamtſchatka.Weſt of America. Streights of Magellan. Staten land. Falkland iſles.
XXII. MANATI.Whale-tailed, No 81.Bering's iſle, and near the iſle of St. Mauritius.Weſt of America.
 Sea Ape, p. 181. Weſt of America.
DIV. IV.
XXIII. BAT.New York, N 82.New Zealand.New York.
 Long haired, No 83. Carolina.
 Noctule, No 84.France. E.Hudſon's Bay.

[CLXXV]Some years ago a very important diſcovery was made,JOURNEY TO THE ICY SEA. not very remote from the place where Captain COOK was obliged to deſiſt from his northern voyage. Mr. Samuel Hearne, in the ſervice of the Hudſon's Bay Company, by direction of the governors, began a journey, on December 7th 1770, towards the northern limits of America. He went attended only by Indians, with whom he had been long acquainted. He ſet out from Prince of Wales fort, 58. 50, north lat. He for a long ſpace took a north-weſtern courſe, croſſed Meniſchtic lake, in lat. 61, a water thirty-five miles in breadth, full of fine iſlands, and joining with the river Namaſſy. He paſſed over Wiethen and Caſſed lakes, and from the laſt kept due weſt. In April he reached Thleweyaza Yeth, a ſmall lake in long. 19, weſt from Churchil fort, lat. 61. 30, near which he made ſome ſtay to build canoes, now requiſite againſt the breaking up of the froſt. From that lake he began a courſe due north, and croſſed a chain of lakes, of which Titumeg is one. In lat. 64. he went over Peſhew lake; after that, the great lake Cogeed, out of which iſſues a river pointing north-eaſt, which is ſuppoſed to fall into B [...]ffin's bay. About the middle of June he croſſed the great river Conge-cathawha-chaga, in lat. 68. 46; and from Churchil river weſt long. 24. 2. About thoſe parts are the Stoney Mountains, extending in longitude from 116 to 122 from London: craggy, and of a tremendous aſpect. On July 7th he arrived at Buffalo lake, in lat. 69. 30: here he firſt ſaw the Muſk Buffalo, No 2. Near the north end is Grizzle Bear-hill, in about lat. 70, ſo called from its being the haunt of numbers of thoſe animals. On July 13th he reached the banks of Copper River, COPPER RIVER. which runs due north into the Icy Sea. About the ſouth end is much wood, and very high hills. Its current is very rapid, and its channel choaked with ſhoals, and croſſed with ſtoney ridges, which form three great cataracts. Its banks are high, the breadth about a hundred and eighty yards; but in ſome places it expands into the form of a lake. In an iſland of the river unfortunately happened to be a ſummer encampment of five tents of Eſkimaux. ESKIMAUX. The Indians attendant on Mr. Hearne grew furious at the ſight of them. It is their firm opinion, that theſe ſavages are magicians, and that all the evils they experience reſult from their incantations. Mr. Hearne in vain ſolicited his Indians to forbear injuring theſe poor people. They, with their uſual cowardice, deferred the attack till night, when they ſurpriſed and murdered every one, to the number of between twenty and thirty. A young woman made her eſcape, and embraced Mr. Hearne's feet; but ſhe was purſued by a barbarian, and transfixed to the ground. He obſerved in their tents (which were made of deer-ſkins with the hair on) copper veſſels, and whale-bone, and the ſkins of Seals, wooden troughs, and kettles made of a ſoft ſtone (by his deſcription a lapis ollaris), and diſhes and ſpoons formed from [CLXXVI] the thick horns of the Buffalo. Their arms are ſpears, darts, and bows and arrows; the laſt pointed with ſtone or copper, but moſt rudely made, for want of proper tools. In their dreſs they much reſemble the Eſkimaux of Hudſon's Bay, but the tails of their jackets are ſhorter; neither do the women, like them, ſtiffen out the tops of their boots. Their canoes differ in not having long projecting prows, but in other reſpects are of the ſame conſtruction. In moſt circumſtances theſe people reſemble thoſe of the Bay; and differ materially only in one, for the men in theſe pull out by the roots all the hair of their heads.—Mr. Hearne firſt ſaw the ſea on July 16, at the diſtance of eight miles. He went to the mouth of the river (in lat. 72; weſt long, from London 121) which he found full of ſhoals and falls, and inacceſſible to the tide, which ſeemed to flow twelve or fourteen feet. The ſea was at this time full of ice, and on many pieces he ſaw Seals. The land trended both to the eaſt and to the weſt, and the ſea was full of iſlands. The land about Copper river, for the ſpace of nine or ten miles to the ſea, conſiſted of fine marſhes, filled in many places with tall Willow, but no ſort of berry-bearing ſhrubs. There are no woods within thirty miles of the mouth of Copper river; and thoſe which then appear, conſiſt of ill-ſhaped and ſtunted Pines.

The people who live neareſt to this river, are the Copper-mine Indians, and the Plat-cotes de Chiens, or Dog-ribbed Indians; theſe have no direct commerce with Hudſon's Bay, but ſell their furs to the more ſouthern Indians, who come for them, and bring them down to the ſettlements. The Dog-ribbed Indian; ſtill make their knives of ſtones and bones, and head their arrows with ſlate. The Copper Indians have abundance of native copper in their country; they make with it ice-chiſſels and arrow-heads. The mine is not known; but I find that an Indian chief, who had many years ago communication with a Mr. Froſt, one of the Company's ſervants, ſays, that the copper was ſtruck off a rock with ſharp ſtones; and that it lay in certain iſlands far to the northward, where was no night during ſummer*.

Mr. Hearne ſet out on his return the 22d of July. He took, in ſome places, a route different from what he did in going, and got to the ſettlements in June 1772. I have peruſed the journal, and had frequent converſation with Mr. Hearne the laſt year. I took the liberty to queſtion him about the waters he had croſſed during winter upon the ice; and whether they might not have been at that time obſtructed ſtreights, a paſſage to the Pacific Ocean? He aſſured me, that he could make no miſtake: that he paſſed over many of them in canoes during the ſummer, [CLXXVII] and that the others had large rivers running out of them, almoſt every one to the weſt: that the Indians, who croſſed them annually, in their way to the north to trade for furs, were exceedingly well acquainted with them, and knew them to be freſh-water lakes; and in particular uſed to fiſh in them for Pikes, fiſh notoriouſly known never to frequent ſalt-water.

I muſt now take a blind unguided courſe along the Icy Sea. GREENLAND. The charts give the land a turn to the ſouth, in lat. 81. long. 22 from London. This is the moſt northern extremity of the country called Greenland, if it reaches ſo far; but, beyond the diſcovery by Mr. Hearne, in lat. 72, the northern limits given in our charts appear to be merely conjectural. To the ſouth, on the eaſtern coaſt, in 1670, was ſeen land in lat. 79. Another part, in lat. 77. 30, called in the maps the land of Edam, was ſeen in 1655. The inlet named Gael-hamkes, in lat. 75, was diſcovered in 1664. A headland was obſerved, in 1665, a degree further ſouth: and in 1607 our celebrated Hudſon diſcovered what he named Hold with Hope, in lat. 73* Excepting the laſt, the reſt of the attempts were made by the Danes, for the recovery of Old Greenland. Gael-hamkes alone continues known to navigators, and is annually frequented by European Whale-fiſhers, who extend their buſineſs even to this coaſt. It is repreſented as a great ſtreight, twenty-five leagues wide, communicating with Baffin's Bay. A ſpecies of Whale, frequent in Davis's Streights, and not found on this ſide of the coaſts, is often ſeen here harpooned with the ſtone weapons of the inhabitants of the oppoſite country; which fiſh muſt have eſcaped through this paſſage. The land to the north of Gael-hamkes is level, and not very high; and within five or ſix leagues from it are ſoundings. That to the ſouth is very lofty, and riſes into peaks like that of Spitzbergen; and the ſea oppoſite to it is fathomleſs.

In lat. 71. long. 8. weſt from London, is John Mayen's iſland,JOHN MAYEN'S ISLE. formerly much frequented by Whale-fiſhers; but thoſe animals have now left the neighboring ſea. The north end riſes into a prodigious mountain called Beerenberg, or the Bears, from its being the haunt of numbers; but it is ſo ſteep as to be inacceſſible to all human creatures. The ſea, within muſket-ſhot from ſhore, was ſixty fathoms deep; a little farther the depth is paſt the reach of the line.

Oppoſite to Iceland begins the once-inhabited part of Old Greenland. OLD GREENLAND. A very deep ſtreight opens a little oppoſite to Snaefelnas, and runs acroſs Greenland, near Jacob's Haven, into Davis's Streights, ſo as quite to inſulate the country: it is [CLXXVIII] now almoſt entirely cloſed with ice, and annually fills the ſea with the greateſt icebergs, which are forced out of it. A little to the north of the eaſtern entrance are two mountains of a ſtupendous height, called Blaaſerk and Huitſerk, caſed in perpetual ice. The whole country, to the ſouthern end, conſiſts of ſimilar mountains: a few exhibit a ſtoney ſurface; but the greater part are genuine glacieres, PEOPLED BY NORWEGIANS. ſhooting into lofty peaks, or rugged ſummits: yet ſuch a country as this became the ſettlement of numbers of Norwegians during ſeveral centuries. The valiant Eric Raude, or the Red, having committed a murder in his own country (a common cauſe for ſeeking adventures, with the heroes of Greece as well as Scandinavia) fled here in the tenth century. Numbers of his countrymen followed him. Leif, his ſon, became a convert to Chriſtianity. Religion flouriſhed here: a biſhoprick was eſtabliſhed, and monaſteries founded. The cathedral was at Gardar, a little to the ſouth of the polar circle.

VOYAGE OF THE ZENI.In Hackluyt * is a relation of the voyage of the two Zeni (noble Venetians) who in 1380 viſited this country, and give evidence to the exiſtence of the convent, and a church dedicated to St. Thomas, poſſeſſed by friers preachers. It appears to have been built near a vulcano, and the materials were lava, cemented with a ſort of pulvis puteolanus, which is known to be a vulcanic attendant. A ſpring of boiling water was near the houſe, and was conveyed into it for all their culinary uſes. I am not averſe to giving credit to this account; there being no reaſon to deny the former exiſtence of burning mountains, when ſuch numbers are to be found in the neighboring Iceland; and at this very time there is a fountain of hot water in the iſle of Onortok, not remote from Cape Farewell . A ſtrange phraſeology runs through the voyage of theſe two brethren, and perhaps ſome romance; but ſo much truth is every where evident, that I heſitate not to credit the authenticity.

Torfaeus enumerates ſeventeen biſhops who preſided over the dioceſe. The laſt prelate was appointed in 1408. The black death had almoſt depopulated the country not long before that period. Probably the ſurviving inhabitants fell victims to want, or were extirpated by the natives: for, after that year, we hear no more of them. It certainly had been well inhabited: the ruins of houſes and churches evince its former ſtate. In the fifteenth century the kings of Denmark attempted to diſcover whether any of the antient race remained; but all in vain: the adventurers were driven off the coaſt by the ice with which it was blocked up, which remains an invincible obſtacle to re-ſettle the eaſtern coaſt, even were there the leſt temptation. All is a dreadful tract from lat. 81 to Staten Hook or Cape Farewell, its [CLXXIX] ſouthern extremity, on an iſle off that point, in lat. 59; on both ſides deeply indented with bays, bounded by icy promontories. Many of theſe bays had been parts of pervious ſtreights, which had divided the country into ſeveral iſlands; but are now totally obſtructed with ice. Beſides that I before mentioned, was one in lat. 63, called Bär-ſund; and that in 62. 50, immortalized by the name of our celebrated ſailor Frobiſher, who penetrated into it ſixty leagues,FROBISHER'S STREIGHTS. in his firſt voyage in 1576, in his ſearch for a paſſage to Cathaya; but imagined that Aſia bounded the right ſide, and America the left*. He met with inhabitants, deſcribes them and their oeconomy, and is particular about their great dogs, and their uſe of them in drawing their ſledges. In his ſecond voyage he found a Narwhal dead on the ſhore, and has given a figure of it. 'This horne,' ſays he, 'is to be ſeene and reſerved as a jewel by the Queens Majeſties commandemet, in her wardrop of robes.' — The original map of his voyages is a ſingular ſketch of erroneous ſuppoſition. He makes his ſtreights reach to the Icy Sea, oppoſite to what he calls Cathaya, juſt to the north of what is made to reſemble the new-diſcovered ſtreights of Bering; which, in the map, are called thoſe of Anian; and accidentally gives them a tolerably juſt form. Thoſe of Anian are equally fabulous with thoſe of de Fuca, but of prior invention; and, like them, were ſayed to have been a paſſage from the South to the North ſea. Queen Elizabeth beſtowed on his diſcoveries the name of Meta Incognita.

Greenland was re-ſettled with Norwegians in 1721,NEW GREENLAND. by the zeal of the Reverend Mr. Hans Egede, the Arctic apoſtle§. He continued, till 1735, preaching the Goſpel to the poor natives; and had not only the happineſs of ſeeing his labors bleſſed with effect, but his example followed by a numerous ſet of miſſionaries, who have formed (on the weſtern ſide only) many ſettlements, which flouriſh even to this day. Mr. Egede returned to Denmark, founded a ſeminary for ſtudents in the Greenland language, from which miſſionaries were to be drawn; and finiſhed his pious life in 1754.

At Cape Farewell begins the vaſt opening between Greenland and Terra de Labrador, which leads to Hudſon's Bay. Between the weſt ſide of Greenland and certain vaſt iſlands, are Davis's Streights, which lead to Baffin's Bay. Theſe iſlands [CLXXX] in different maps bear different names, and in one are even conſolidated; ſo little are theſe parts known*.

To deſcribe Greenland, would be to ring changes on ice, and ſnow, and lofty mountains (ſome, according to Mr. Crantz, a thouſand fathoms high) riſing into broken crags or ſharp ſpires, or vallies with no other garniture than moſs and ſome moor graſs; and in ſome parts are long flat mountains, clad with perpetual ice and ſnow. Where the birds, by their dung, have formed a little ſoil, ſome plants are found. Mr. Crantz enumerates about twenty-four ſpecies, beſides the cryptogamious kinds.TREES. Egede obſerved, in lat. 60 or 61, ſmall Junipers, Willows, and Birch; the laſt two or three yards high, and as thick as a man's leg; an amazing tree for this country. Davis alſo ſaw ſome low Birch and Willows as high as about lat. 65§. Nature here ſuffers the reverſe of melioration; the glacieres conſtantly gain on the vallies, and deſtroy all hopes of improvement.ICE-BLINCK. That amazing glaciere, the Ice Blinck or Ice Glance, on the weſtern coaſt, is admirably deſcribed by Mr. Crantz. I muſt refer to him for the account, after ſaying, that it is a ſtupendous aggregate at the mouth of an inlet, and of an amazing height; the brilliancy of which appears like a glory to the navigators at many leagues diſtance. It forms, beneath, a ſeries of moſt magnificent arches, extending eight leagues in length, and two in breadth; through theſe are carried, at the ebb of tide, great fragments of ice, which have fallen from various icebergs, and prove one ſupply to the ocean of its floating ice. The ſtreights, now obſtructed to navigation, are ſuppoſed to be open at bottom, by arches ſimilar to thoſe ſpoken of; for an immenſe quantity of ice is annually diſcharged from their mouths**.

I have mentioned the iſlands of ice at p. LXXXV; for thoſe of Spitzbergen have every thing in common with thoſe of Greenland. Perhaps the colors in the laſt may be more brilliant; the green being as high as that of the emerald, the blue equal to that of the ſapphir; the firſt, Mr. Egede attributes to the congelation of freſh, the latter to that of ſalt-water††. Here are frequent inſtances of the freezing of the ſea-water. The froſt often forms a pavement of ice from iſland to iſland, and in the confined inlets‡‡.

TIDES.The tides riſe at the ſouth of this country three fathoms, in lat 65; on the weſt ſide two, or in ſpring-tides three; at Diſco, about lat. 69, only one; further north it ſinks even to one foot. In great ſpring-tides, eſpecially in winter, is this ſtrange phaenomenon: ſprings of freſh-water are forced up on the ſhores in places where they were before unknown§§.

[CLXXXI]During the long day of the ſhort ſummer is conſiderable heat. The long winter is a little cheared by the Aurora Borealis, AURORA BOREALIS. which appears and radiates with unuſual brilliancy and velocity in the ſpring, about the time of the new moon. Fogs give a gloom to the ſummer, and froſt-ſmoke often adds horror to the winter. It riſes out of the opening of the ice in the ſea, and peels off the very ſkin from thoſe who venture to approach it. The effect of the froſt is very violent on the human body; but leſs ſo than in the north-eaſt of Sibiria, where at times it is fatal to ſtir abroad, even when protected with every guard of cloathing*.

The Greenlanders faſtidiouſly ſtyle themſelves Innuit, i. e. men, as if they were the ſtandard of the human race; yet few of them attain the height of five feet; but are well made. Their hair is long and black; their faces flat; their eyes ſmall. They are a branch of the Eſkimaux, the ſmall race which borders all the Arctic coaſts. They originated from the Samoied Aſiatics, who, paſſing over into the New World, have lined the coaſt from Prince William's Sound on the weſtern ſide, in lat. 61, quite to the ſouthern part of Labrador on the eaſtern. They crept gradually in their little canoes northward, and diminiſhed in ſize in their progreſs, till they attained their full degeneracy in the Eſkimaux and Greenlanders. Similar people, or veſtiges of them, have been ſeen in different places, from Prince William's Sound to the north of BERING'S ſtreights. They were again ſeen by Mr. Hearne in lat. 72. By report of the Greenlanders of Diſco bay, there are a few inhabitants in Baffin's bay, in lat. 78. Egede ſays, that the country is peopled to lat. 76; but the higheſt colonized ſpot is at Noogſook, in lat. 71. They are a race made for the climate, and could no more bear removal to a temperate clime, than an animal of the torrid zone could into our unequal ſky: ſeaſons, and defect of habitual food, would ſoon bring on their deſtruction. This race has been found to agree in manners, habits, and weapons, and in many inſtances in language, from Prince William's Sound to the end of Labrador, a tract extending near fifteen hundred leagues. They only line the coaſts; for the Indians perſecute them with mercileſs hatred, and almoſt puſh them into the ſea. They imagine theſe poor creatures to be magicians, and that to them they owe every ill ſucceſs in life§. The numbers of the Greenlanders are now amazingly diminiſhed. In 1730 there were thirty thouſand ſouls, at preſent only ten thouſand; a decreaſe chiefly owing to the ravage of the ſmall-pox.

Greenland has been moſt happy in its Zoologiſt. The Reverend Mr. Otto Fabricius, whom a laudable zeal for enlightening the minds of the groſs inhabitants, [CLXXXII] led to theſe parts, hath given a moſt ample and claſſical account of the animals. His Fauna Groenlandica is among the firſt works of the kind. I eagerly expect the performance of the promiſed remainder of the work.

QUADRUPEDS.The Quadrupeds of this country are, the Rein-deer, No 4, which are here merely conſidered as objects of the chace. Their number is leſſened greatly, and they are now only found in the moſt remote parts. The Ukalcrajek * is, I ſuſpect, an animal of imagination. It is ſaid, by the Greenlanders, to be longeared, hare-lipped, and to reſemble that animal; to have a ſhort tail; to be of a white color, with a dark liſt down the back, and of the ſize of a Rein-deer. The DOGS, p. 41, reſemble Wolves in figure, ſize, and nature. Left to themſelves, they hunt in packs the few animals of the country, for the ſake of prey. They exactly reſemble the Dogs of the Eſkimaux of Labrador. It is probable, that they might have been originally brought here by their maſters, who firſt fled that country, and populated Greenland. ARCTIC FOXES, No 10, abound here; and, with POLAR BEARS, No 18, infeſt the country. Had I not ſuch excellent authority, I ſhould have doubted whether the Wolverene, No 21, uſually an inhabitant of wooded countries, was found in Greenland; but it is certainly met with, yet rarely, in the ſouthern parts, where it preys on the Rein-deer and White Hares. It muſt have been originally wafted hither on the ice from Terra de Labrador, the neareſt place to this, of which it is an inhabitant. The VARYING HARE, No 37, is very common. The WALRUS, and five ſpecies of Seals, inhabit theſe ſeas: the Common, No 72; the Great, No 73; the Rough, No 74; the Hooded, No 76; the Harp, No 77; and an obſcure ſpecies, called by the Laplanders, Fatne Vindac, with a round head and long ſnout, bending like the proboſcis of an elephant. Mr. Fabricius adds to the marine animals, the Whale-tailed Manati, No 81, of which he once ſaw the head partly conſumed.

The Polar Bears, Seals, and Manati, were originally natives of theſe countries. The other Quadrupeds found their way here from either Hudſon's Bay or Labrador, on the iſlands of ice. The Arctic Fox found the ſame kind of conveyance from Greenland to Iceland as it did with the Rein-deer to Spitzbergen. To the laſt was wafted, probably from Labrador, the Common Weeſel, the Red or Common Fox; and the Mouſe, mentioned p. XLIX, miſſed Greenland, but arrived at and ſtocked Iceland; and the Common Bat was originally tempeſt-driven to the latter from Norway: the Wolverene and Varying Hare never reached farther than Greenland.—This ſeems the progreſs of Quadrupeds in the frigid zone, as high as land is found.

[CLXXXIII]The note * gives the ſum of the Birds, land and water.BIRDS.

The numbers of Fiſh which frequent theſe icy ſeas are very conſiderable.FISHES. They are, indeed, the great rendezvous of Whales. There is a fiſhery for them by the Dutch, in Diſko Bay, as early as April . The natives take them at other times, cut off the blubber in an awkward manner, and preſerve that and the whalebone as articles of commerce. It is certain that they do not drink train-oil, like the true Eſkimaux, and ſome other congenerous people. The ſpecies which frequent Greenland are, the MONODON MONOCEROS, or NARWHAL, Lin. Syſt. 105: the MONODON SPURIUS, Faun. Groenl. No 19; a rare ſpecies, with two teeth, about an inch long, projecting from the extremity of the upper jaw: the BALAENA MYSTECETUS, or COMMON WHALE, Br. Zool. iii. No 16: BALAENA PHYSALUS, or FINFISH, No 18; BALAENA MUSCULUS, or ROUND-LIPPED, No 19: the BALAENA ROSTRATA, Faun. Groenl. No 84; a very ſmall ſpecies with a long ſnout: PHYSETER MACROCEPHALUS, Faun. Groenl. No 25: PHYSETER CATODON, or ROUND-HEADED CACHALOT, Br. Zool. iii. No 22: PHYSETER MICROPS, or BLUNT-HEADED CACHALOT, [CLXXXIV] Br. Zool. iii. No 21: DELPHINUS ORCA, or SPEKHUGGER, Faun. Groenl. No 28; the tormentor of the greater Whales, whom they will [...]x on, as Bull-dogs will on a Bull, and tear out large pieces from their bodies: DELPHINUS PHOCA, the PORPESSE, Br. Zool. iii. N 25: DELPHINUS DELPHIS, or the Dolphin, No 24: the DELPHINUS TURSIO, or the GRAMPUS, No 26: and finally, the DELPHINUS ALBICANS, or BELUGA WHALE, p. 182 of this Work, which enlivens thoſe waters with its reſplendent whiteneſs.

Among the cartilaginous ſpecies are the RAIA FULLONICA, Lin. Syſt. 396: the WHITE SHARK, Br. Zool. iii. No 42, equally voracious from the equator to the Arctic circle; and, with fierceneſs unſubdued by climate, often bites in two the Greenlanders ſitting in their Seal-ſkin canoes: the PICKED SHARK, Br. Zool. No 40: the BASKING SHARK, No 41: the SQUALUS PRISTIS, or SAW SHARK, Lin. Syſt. 401: the LUMP SUCKER, Br. Zool. iii. No 57; a great article of food with the natives: CYCLOPTERUS SPINOSUS, or SPINY SUCKER, Faun. Groenl. No 93: CYCLOPTERUS MINUTUS, or the MINUTE, No 94: the UNCTUOUS SUCKER, Br. Zool. No 58.

Of the boney Fiſhes, the EEL, Br. Zool. No 63, is rarely found in the ſouthern rivers. The WOLF-FISH, No 65, appears here in the ſpring with the Lump Fiſh, and diſappears in autumn. The Greenland Fauniſt deſcribes a leſſer variety, in No 97, b. The LAUNCE, Br. Zool. iii. No 66: the OPHIDIUM VIRIDE, Faun. Groenl. No 99: the HADDOCK, Br. Zool. iii. No 74, is plentiful here in winter. GADUS CALLARIAS, or VARIED COD, Lin. Syſt. 436; and COMMON COD, Br. Zool. iii. No 73, frequent the coaſts in ſpring and autumn. The POUT, No 75: GADUS VIRENS, or GREEN COD, Lin. Syſt. 438: the HAKE, Br. Zool. No 81: the LING, No 85: and the GADUS BROSME, Faun. Groenl. No 107, are ſpecies of Cod-fiſh found in theſe ſeas. The SPOTTED BLENNY, Br. Zool. iii. No 93. A new ſpecies, the BLENNIUS PUNCTATUS, Faun. Groenl. No 110; and that curious fiſh the CORYPHAENA RUPESTRIS, No 111, Act. Nidr. iii. tab. 111.; the firſt rare, the laſt frequent in the deep ſouthern bays. The ARMED BULL-HEAD, Br. Zool. iii. No 98. The FATHER LASHER, No 99, is a moſt common fiſh, and ſingularly uſeful. COTTUS SCORPIOIDES, Faun. Groenl. No 114, or QUADRICORNIS, Lin. Syſt. 451; and the RIVER BULL-HEAD, Br. Zool. iii. No 97, are found here in ſalt-water. The ZEUS GALLUS, Lin. Syſt. 454, a fiſh of the hotteſt parts of South America, is ſuſpected to be found here. The HOLIBUT, Br. Zool. iii. No 102, is very common; as is the PLEURONECTES CYNOGLOSSUS, Faun. Groenl. No 118; and the new ſpecies, PL. PLATESSOIDES, No 119, is ſeen here in ſmall numbers near the mouths of rivers. LABRUS EXOLETUS, Faun. Groenl. [CLXXXV] No 120: STRIPED WRASSE? Br. Zool. iii. 119: PORCA NORVEGICA, Faun. Groenl. No 121: THREE-SPINED STICKLEBACK, Br. Zool. iii. No 129, not only in rivers but places overflowed by the ſea. The SALMON, No 143, is extremely ſcarce at preſent; yet in Davis's time, was among the preſents made to him by the ſavages; and Baffin * ſaw moſt amazing ſhoals of theſe fiſh in Cockin's Sound, on this weſtern coaſt, in lat. 65. 45. The SALMO CARPIO, Faun. Groenl. No 124, is one of the moſt common and uſeful fiſhes; is frequent in the lakes, rivers, and eſtuaries. The CHAR, Br. Zool. iii. No 149, conſorts with the other, and is as common. The SALMO STAGNALIS, Faun. Groenl. No 126, a new ſpecies, found remote in the mountain lakes, and caught only by the hunters of Rein-deer. The SALMO RIVALIS, No 127, is another, inhabiting ſmall brooks. The SALMO ARCTICUS, No 128, or CAPELIN of the Newfoundland fiſhers , is the laſt of this genus, but the moſt uſeful; the daily bread, and the fiſh in higheſt eſteem with the Greenlanders, and providentially given to them in the greateſt abundance. The COMMON HERRING, Br. Zool. iii. No 160, is a rare fiſh in theſe ſeas; as is the ANCHOVY, No 163.

The ſame indefatigable Zoologiſt hath diſcovered in this country (including cruſtaceous) not fewer than ninety-one Inſects, a hundred and twenty-ſix Vermes, fifty-nine ſhells, and forty-two Zoophytes.

JOHN DAVIS, a moſt able ſeaman, was the firſt who examined the weſt ſide of Greenland. Before his time the eaſtern coaſt was the only part known to Europeans. He made there three different voyages, in 1585, 1586, and 1587. After doubling Cape Farewell, he ſounded, and could not find bottom with three hundred fathoms of line. North of what he properly called the Land of Deſolation, he arrived in a filthy, black, and ſtagnating water, of the depth of a hundred and twenty fathoms. He found drift-wood in lat. 65, and one entire tree ſixty feet long, with its root; the ſpecies were Fir, Spruce, and Juniper, which came down from remote places on the banks of the rivers of Hudſon's Bay; for Mr. Hutchins aſſures me, that to this day, in certain years, vaſt quantities of timber are brought down with the ice at the opening of the rivers. He alſo met with black Pumices, whether from neighboring vulcanoes, burning or extinct, remains unknown; or whether, which is moſt probable, conveyed there from Iceland. The ſtone of the country is moſtly granitical. Some ſand-ſtone, and many ſorts of coarſe marble. The Lapis Ollaris is found here in abundance, and of great uſe to the natives for making of pots. Talc is frequent here, [CLXXXVI] Aſbeſtos, and Gypſum. Granates are not uncommon. Sulphureous Marcaſites which have more than once deceived the navigators with the opinion of their being gold*. The mineral ſymptoms of copper, ſuch as ſtains of blue and green, are ſeen on theſe rocks; but avarice itſelf will never tempt adventurers to make here a trial.

DAVIS got as high as lat. 72, and called the country London Coaſt. The ſtreight he paſſed, between the weſt of Greenland and the great iſlands, is honored by his name. He ſeems to have been engaged among the great iſlands; for he ſays he ſailed ſixty leagues up a ſound, found the ſea of the ſame color with the main ſea, and ſaw ſeveral Whales. He ſailed through another ſound to the ſouth-weſt, found ninety fathom water at the entrance; but within could not touch ground with three hundred and thirty. He had hopes of having found the long-ſought-for paſſage. The tides roſe ſix or ſeven fathoms; but, as is frequent among iſlands, the flood came from ſuch variety of places, that he could not trace its principal originHackluyt, iii. 102..

BAFFIN'S BAY.At lat. 72. 30, I muſt take as my pilot that great ſeaman William Baffin, who gave name to the great bay I now enter on. His firſt voyage was in 1613; his ſecond, in which he made the moſt effectual trial for the north-weſt paſſage, was in 1616. He paſſed through Davis's Streights. In lat. 70. 20, on the London Coaſt, he found the tides riſe only eight or nine feet. In Horn Sound, lat. 73. 45, he met with ſeveral peopleSame, 846.. To the north of that, in 75. 40, was a large and open bay; Cape Dudley Digges forms its northern point; within is Weſtenholme Sound; beyond that, Whale Sound; and in the extreme north, or bottom of this great bay, is that named by Baffin after Sir Thomas Smith, lying in 78 degrees. In thoſe three ſounds were abundance of Whales; but in the laſt the largeſt in all this bay. It is highly probable, that there are one or more communications from hence to the Icy Sea, through which the Whales paſs at certain ſeaſons; and this (if I may collect from their numbers) might be that of their migration ſouthward. The diſtance into the Icy Sea can be but very ſmall, but probably blocked up with ice; or if not, from the ſudden ſhifting of the ice in that ſea by the change of wind, the paſſage muſt be attended with too great hazard to be attempted. The ice prevented our great ſeaman from making trial of the tides in this bay, which would have brought the matter to greater certainty. He ſaw multitudes of Walruſes and Seals in theſe parts, but no ſigns of inhabitants. From hence the land trended weſterly, [CLXXXVII] to a ſound he called by the name of Alderman Jones, in lat. 76. 40. Here the land ran due ſouth to a great ſound in lat. 74. 20, which he called Sir James Lancaſter's. From this place the land took an eaſtern curvature, to the ſtreights between the continent and Cumberland iſland. Baffin took his courſe between that iſle and the iſle of Saint James, left his name to the ſtreight he paſſed, and arrived ſafe in Cockin's Sound, on the coaſt of Weſt Greenland, where he found the tide riſe eighteen feet: this, and ſimilar exceſſes, ariſing from the confined ſituation of places*.

This is the only voyage ever made into Baffin's Bay. Chriſtian IV. of Denmark, in 1619, ſent John Munck, a moſt able ſeaman, to make diſcoveries in theſe parts; but, notwithſtanding any ſurmiſes of his having reached this famous bay, he got no farther than Hudſon's Bay; to which, in honor of his maſter, he gave the name of Chriſtian Sea. He paſſed a miſerable winter in Churchill river, and returned home the next year, after loſing, during his ſtay on ſhore, every man but two.

Before I quit theſe frozen regions, I muſt once more return to Spitzbergen, to relate, what has but very lately been communicated to me, that the Ruſſians have of late attempted to colonize theſe dreadful iſlands. They have, for a few years paſt, ſent parties to continue there the whole year; who have eſtabliſhed ſettlements on the iſle of Spitzbergen, at Croon Bay, King's Bay, Magdalena Bay, Smeerenburgh, and Green Harbour; where they have built huts, each of which is occupied by about two boats crews, or twenty-ſix men. They bring with them ſalted fiſh, rye-flour, and the ſerum or whey of ſour milk. The whey is their chief beverage, and is alſo uſed in baking their bread. Each hut has an oven, which ſerves alſo as a ſtove; and their fuel is wood, which they bring with them from Archangel. The huts are above ground, and moſt ſurprizingly warm; placed alſo in ſituations which may guard them as much as poſſible from the keenneſs of the northern wind.

Mr. Erſkine Tonnach, ſurgeon of Dunbar (who, by the friendſhip of the worthy Mr. George Paton, of Edinburgh, favored me with this account) gives me the following particulars from his own knowledge.—"During our ſlay on the iſland, my curioſity prompted me to go on ſhore, that I might ſee the oeconomy of theſe arctic ſettlers; and had an opportunity of ſeeing them dine: and though their fare appeared coarſe, the diſpatch they uſe, ſaid a great deal for their health and [CLXXXVIII] appetite. They boil their fiſh with water and rye-meal: and this conſtitutes their diet during winter. In the ſummer they live chiefly on fowls, or their eggs; but in general they forbear fleſh, as the faſts preſcribed by their religion are ſo numerous. They are dreſſed in the ſkins of the animals they kill, which they uſe with the fur ſide next to their bodies: their bedding is likewiſe compoſed of ſkins, chiefly of thoſe of the Bear or Rein Deer. The ſkin of the Fox is the moſt valuable; but theſe are preſerved as articles of commerce in their own country. They catch the Beluga, or white Whale, in nets, being converſant in this ſpecies of fiſhery; but are ignorant of that of the great Whale. They were very ſolicitous to get information on that ſubject; which I endeavoured to inſtruct them in, in return for the information they ſo readily gave me. They are moſt excellent markſmen; but, what is peculiar, in preſenting their piece, they do not raiſe it to their ſhoulder, but place the butt-end between their arm and their ſide, fixing their eye on the object toward which they direct the barrel. I ſaw a Bear receive a conſiderable ſhot: it aſtoniſhed me greatly to ſee the animal apply great quantities of ſnow to the part (which was bleeding freely) as if conſcious of its ſtyptic powers. It retreated with much ſlowneſs; but at ſhort intervals looked behind, and, with much art, threw abundance of ſnow with its hind-paws into the wound. Few of the Ruſſians die from the ſeverity of the cold, but are often froſt-bitten, ſo as to loſe their toes or fingers; for they are ſo hardy as to hunt in all weathers. I naturally aſked them, Had they a ſurgeon? They replied, 'No! no! CHRIST is our doctor!' They quit the iſland in September, and are privileged to leave the place by the 22d of that month, whether they are relieved by a freſh party from Ruſſia or not."—Let me remark, that the great exerciſe uſed by theſe volunteer adventurers; their quantity of vegetable food; their freſhening their ſalt proviſion, by boiling it in water, and mixing it with flour; their beverage of whey; and their total abſtinence from ſpirituous liquors—are the happy preſervatives from the ſcurvy, which brought all the preceding adventurers, who periſhed, to their miſerable end*.

HUDSON'S BAY.We now proceed through a nameleſs ſtreight, between the main land and the two great iſlands on the eaſt; and, after doubling Cape Southampton, enter into Hudſon's Bay, in the gulph called the Welcome. This bay was diſcovered in 1610, by that able ſeaman Henry Hudſon, from whom it takes its name. His view, in the voyage he made, was the diſcovery of a paſſage to the Eaſt Indies. The [CLXXXIX] trial has been vigorouſly purſued ſince his days, but without ſucceſs. In 1742 an attempt was made, as low as the bottom of the Welcome, by Captain Middleton; and from the check he met with, he called that part Repulſe Bay. In ſubſequent trials Wager's Water was ſuſpected to be the paſſage into the Weſtern ocean; but in 1747 its end was diſcovered, and found to terminate in two navigable rivers. The romantic ſcenery which the adventurers met with in the way is moſt admirably deſcribed by the elegant pen of Mr. Henry Ellis.

Cheſterfield, or Bowden's Inlet, CHESTERFIELD INLET. was likewiſe ſuſpected to have been the deſired ſtreight; but in 1762 Meſſrs. Norton and Chriſtopher, in a ſloop and cutter belonging to the Company, went to the remoteſt end. At the diſtance of a hundred and twenty-eight miles from the mouth was ſcarcely any tide; thirty miles further it quite died away. The land here grew contracted into a very narrow paſſage. Here the adventurers entered with the cutter, and diſcovered that the end was in a magnificent freſh-water lake, to which was given the name of Baker's. The land was quite level, rich in graſs, and abounding with Deer. They found the end quite innavigable, and to terminate in a ſmall ſtream, with many ſhoals at its mouth, and three falls acroſs it. After finding the water decreaſe to the depth of two feet, they returned fully ſatisfied with their voyage.

Hudſon's Bay has been ſo frequently deſcribed, that I ſhall only give a general view of it and its adjacent parts. Its entrance from the ocean, after leaving to the north Cape Farewell and Davis's Streights, is between Reſolution iſles on the north, and Button's iſles, on the Labrador coaſt, to the ſouth, forming the eaſtern extremity of the ſtreights diſtinguiſhed by the name of its great diſcoverer. The coaſts very high, rocky, and rugged at top; in places precipitous; but ſometimes exhibit large beaches. The iſles of Saliſbury, Nottingham, and Digges, are alſo very lofty, and naked. The depth of water in the middle of the bay is a hundred and forty fathoms. From Cape Churchill to the ſouth end of the bay are regular ſoundings; near the ſhore ſhallow, with muddy or ſandy bottom. To the north of Churchill, the ſoundings are irregular, the bottom rocky, and in ſome parts the rocks appear above the ſurface at low water. From Mooſe river, or the bottom of the bay, to Cape Churchill, the land is flat, marſhy, and wooded with Pines, Birch, Larch, and Willows. From Cape Churchill to Wager's Water the coaſts are all high and rocky to the very ſea, and woodleſs, except the mouths of Pockerekeſko, and Seal rivers. The hills on their back are naked, nor are there any trees for a great diſtance inland.

The mouths of all the rivers are filled with ſhoals, except that of Churchill, in which the largeſt ſhips may lie; but ten miles higher, the channel is obſtructed with ſand-banks; and all the rivers, as far as has been navigated, are full of rapids [CXC] and cataracts, from ten to ſixty feet perpendicular. Down theſe rivers the Indian traders find a quick paſſage; but their return is a labor of many months.

As far inland as the Company have ſettlements, which is ſix hundred miles to the weſt, at a place called Hudſon Houſe, lat. 53. long. 106. 27, from London, is flat country: nor is it known how far to the eaſtward the great chain, ſeen by our navigators from the Pacific Ocean, branches off.

The climate,CLIMATE. even about Haye's river, in only lat. 57, is, during winter, exceſſively cold. The ſnows begin to fall in October, and continue falling by intervals the whole winter; and, when the froſt is moſt rigorous, in form of the fineſt ſand. The ice on the rivers is eight feet thick. Port wine freezes into a ſolid maſs; brandy coagulates. The very breath fell on the blankets of the beds in form of a hoar froſt, and the bed-cloaths often were found frozen to the wall*. The ſun riſes, in the ſhorteſt day, at five minutes paſt nine, and ſets five minutes before three. In the longeſt day the ſun riſes at three, and ſets about nine. The ice begins to diſappear in May, and hot weather commences about the middle of June; which, at times, is ſo violent, as to ſcorch the face of the hunters. Thunder is not frequent, but very violent. But there muſt be great difference of heat and cold in this vaſt extent, which reaches from lat. 50. 40, to lat. 63, north.

During winter the firmament is not without its beauties. Mock ſuns and halôs are not infrequent; are very bright, and richly tinged with all the colors of the rainbow. The ſun riſes and ſets with a large cone of yellowiſh light. The night is enlivened with the Aurora Borealis, which ſpreads a thouſand different lights and colors over the whole concave of the ſky, not to be defaced even by the ſplendor of the full moon; and the ſtars are of a fiery redneſs.

Hudſon's Bay is very ill ſupplied with Fiſh.FISH. The common Whale is frequent there. The Company have attempted to eſtabliſh a fiſhery; and for that purpoſe procured experienced people from the Spitzbergen ſhips, and made conſiderable trials between lat. 61 and 69; but, after expending twenty thouſand pounds, and taking only three fiſh, were, in 1771, obliged to deſiſt. The ice prevented the veſſels from getting to a proper ſtation in due time; and the hard gales, and quick return of winter, always deprived them of an opportunity of making a fair trial. The fiſhery of the Beluga, or White Whale, is attended with more ſucceſs. It haunts the mouths of rivers in June, as ſoon as they have diſcharged the ice, and are taken in great numbers. There are two varieties; one with a blue caſt, the other of a pure white. Theſe animals, probably, ſuperfete; a [CXCI] foetus of ſix inches in length having been extracted, at the ſame time that a young one has been ſeen (as is their cuſtom) mounted on the back of another.

Sturgeons of a ſmall ſize are ſound in the rivers, not far from the ſea. They appear to me to be of the ſame ſpecies with the Engliſh. Sturgeons are found in great plenty in the lakes far inland, and from the weight of ſix to forty pounds. I ſuſpect theſe to be the ſame with the Sturgeons of the great lakes of Canada, which, I am told, are ſmooth, or free from tubercles; and probably the Acipenſer Huſo of Linnaeus, and Hanſen of the Germans, a fiſh of the Danube and Wolga.

The Lophius Piſcatorius, or Common Angler, Br. Zool. iii. No 51, appears towards the ſurface only in windy weather; for which reaſon it is called by the natives Thutina-meg, or the Wind-fiſh.

The Gadus Lota, or Burbot, Br. Zool. ii. No 86, is common in the rivers, and is caught with hooks after nine o'clock at night. It is called here Marthy; grows to the weight of eight pounds; is ſo voracious as to feed even on the tyrant Pike; will devour dead Deer, or any carrion, and even ſwallow ſtones to fill its ſtomach: one of a pound weight has been taken out of a fiſh of this ſpecies. It ſpawns about February 8th, and is unhappily moſt prolific. Mr. Hutchins counted, in a ſingle fiſh, 671, 248 ovaria.

Allied to this is the Mathemeg of the natives, the Land Cod of the Engliſh, a fiſh abundant in the northernly lakes; it grows to the length of three feet, and the weight of twelve pounds: has three beards on the lower jaw; the middlemoſt the longeſt: the back is browniſh: the belly grey.

The Perca Fluviatilis, or common Perch, Br. Zool. iii. No 124, is found in the rivers, but not in plenty; and ſometimes grows to the weight of eight pounds. The Gaſteroſteus aculeatus, or three-ſpined Stickleback, Br. Zool. iii. No 129, is found here in great numbers.

Salmo Salar, or the common Salmon, Br. Zool. iii. No 143, is taken in plenty from June to Auguſt, in nets placed along the ſea-ſhores, and ſalted for uſe. Very few are caught to the ſouth of Churchill river.

The Namaycuſh, is a ſpecies of Trout, with the head, back, dorſal fin, and tail of a dark blue: the ſides duſky, marked with white and reddiſh ſpots: the belly ſilvery: the fleſh white, and very delicate. It is caught with the hook in lakes far inland; and ſometimes of the weight of thirty pounds. A Trutta lacuſtris generis, p. 1012. Wil. Icth. 198?

Salmo Alpinus, or Char, Br. Zool. iii. No 149, is common in the freſh waters, and weighs from two to ſix pounds.

The Salmo Lavaretus, or Gwiniad, Br. Zool. iii. No 152, is found here in vaſt abundance; and grows to a ſize far ſuperior to thoſe of Europe. There is a leſſer [CXCII] kind, called here the Sea Gwiniad: the head is not ſo duſky: eyes ſmaller; and back leſs arched. The noſe of the male is blunt; and the ſtomach muſcular, like a gizzard: the female has an arched noſe. They are very numerous in autumn, juſt when the rivers are frozen over, and are called here Tickomeg. The Salmo Arcticus, or Capelin, is obſerved to precede the Salmon, and is ſometimes thrown on ſhore in amazing quantities by hard gales.

The Omiſco Maycus is a new ſpecies of Trout, taken in May in Albany river, not exceeding four inches and a half long. It has five branchioſtegous rays: firſt dorſal fin has eleven rays, ventral eight, anal ſeven, pectoral thirteen: tail forked: in the jaws are minute teeth: back, as low as the lateral line, is of a pale color, marked with two longitudinal rows of black ſtelliform ſpots: below the lateral line the color ſilvery: the belly white.

The Pike, Br. Zool. iii. No 153, abounds in all the lakes. It by no means arrives at the ſize of the Engliſh. Mr. Hutchins does not recollect any above the weight of twelve pounds.

The Cyprinus Cataſtomus of Dr. Forſter *, or Sucker Carp, is a new ſpecies: of which there are two varieties; the Mithco-Mapeth of the Indians, marked with a broad ſtripe of red along the lateral line, and found on the ſea-coaſt; and the White, or Namapeth, with larger ſcales, and wholly of a whitiſh color: very ſcarce in the ſalt-water, but in ſuch plenty in the inland lakes and rivers, as to be even burdenſome to the nets. They grow to the weight of two pounds and a half. The form is oblong: the head boney, rugged, and decreaſing to the tip of the noſe: the mouth ſmall, and placed beneath: the body ſcaly: the tail lunated.

Shell-fiſh are very ſcarce in this ſea. Mytilus Edulis, the Edible Muſſel, Br. Zool. iv. No 73, alone are plentiful; but of Cockles, only the dead ſhells are ſeen. From the number of ſhells which are dug up, for the ſpace of ten miles inland of this flat muddy country, may be collected a proof of the great retreat of the water; but for want of inhabitants, the period of its loſs cannot be aſcertained.

Among the birds,BIRDS. which eſcaped my notice while I was writing the zoologic part of this Work, are two of the Eagle kind, found in this country: the firſt is the YELLOW-HEADED, with a duſky bill, cere, and irides: head and neck yellowiſh: back dark brown; each feather tipped with dirty yellow. This ſpecies appears in Hudſon's Bay in April. Builds its neſt in trees, with ſticks and graſs; and [CXCIII] lays one egg. It preys on young Deer, Rabbets, and Fowls. Retires ſouthward in October. Is called by the Indians, Etheneſue Mickeſue .

A variety of the GOLDEN EAGLE is alſo a native of the ſame place. The forehead is brown: crown and hind part of the neck ſtriped with brown, white, and ruſty yellow: lower part of the neck, breaſt, and belly, deep brown: coverts of the wings, back, ſecondaries, and ſcapulars, of the ſame color; the two laſt white towards their bottoms, and mottled with brown: primaries black: middle feathers of the tail brown, barred with two or three cinereous bands; exterior feathers brown, blotched with cinereous: legs cloathed with pale brown feathers to the toes, which are yellow. Length three feet. A ſpecimen of this was preſented to the Britiſh Muſeum.

To theſe may be added a genuine Falcon, communicated to me by Mr. Latham. The bill very ſharp, and furniſhed with a large and pointed proceſs in the upper mandible: cere yellowiſh: head, front of the neck, breaſt, and belly, white: each feather marked along the ſhaft with a line of brown, narroweſt on the head: the back and coverts of the wings of a dirty bluiſh aſh-color; the edges of the feathers whitiſh, and many of them tipped with the ſame: primaries duſky; exterior webs blotched with white; interior barred with the ſame color: tail of the ſame color with the back, barred with white; but the bars do not reach the ſhaft, and, like thoſe in the Iceland Falcon, oppoſe the dark bars in the adverſe web: the legs bluiſh. The length of this fine ſpecies is two feet two inches.

Multitudes of birds retire to this remote country, to Labrador, and Newfoundland, from places moſt remotely ſouth, perhaps from the Antilles; and ſome even of the moſt delicate little ſpecies. Moſt of them, with numbers of aquatic fowls, are ſeen returning ſouthward, with their young broods, to more favorable climates. The ſavages, in ſome reſpects, regulate their months by the appearance of birds; and have their Gooſe month from the vernal appearance of Geeſe from the ſouth. All the Grous kind, Ravens, cinereous Crows, Titmouſe, and Lapland Finch, brave the ſevereſt winter; and ſeveral of the Falcons and Owls ſeek ſhelter in the woods. The Rein Deer paſs in vaſt herds towards the north, in October, ſeeking the extreme cold. The male Polar Bears rove out at ſea, on the floating ice, moſt of the winter, and till June: the females lie concealed in the woods, or beneath the banks of rivers, till March, when they come abroad with their twin cubs, and bend their courſe to the ſea in ſearch of their conſorts. Several are killed in their paſſage; and thoſe which are wounded ſhew vaſt fury, roar hideouſly, and bite and throw up into the air even their own progeny. The females and the young, when not interrupted, continue their way to ſea. In June, the [CXCIV] males return to ſhore, and, by Auguſt, are joined by their conſorts, with the cubs, by that time of a conſiderable ſize*.

The eaſtern boundary of the bay is Terra de Labrador; TERRA DE LABRADOR. the northern part has a ſtrait coaſt facing the bay, guarded with a line of iſles innumerable. A vaſt bay, called the Archiwinnipy Sea, lies within it, and opens into Hudſon's Bay by means of Gulph Hazard, through which the Beluga Whales dart in great numbers. Here the Company had a ſettlement, for the ſake of the fiſhery, and for trading with the Eſkimaux; but deſerted it as unprofitable about the year 1758 or 1759. The eaſtern coaſt, ſo admirably deſcribed by that honored name, Sir ROGER CURTIS! is barren paſt the efforts of cultivation. The ſurface every where uneven, and covered with maſſes of ſtone of an amazing ſize. It is a country of fruitleſs vallies and frightful mountains, ſome of an aſtoniſhing height: the firſt watered by a chain of lakes, formed not from ſprings but rain and ſnow, ſo chilly as to be productive of only a few ſmall Trout. The mountains have here and there a blighted ſhrub, or a little moſs. The vallies are full of crooked ſtunted trees, Pines, Fir, Birch, and Cedars, or rather a ſpecies of Juniper. In lat. 60, on this coaſt, vegetation ceaſes. The whole ſhore, like that on the weſt, is faced with iſlands at ſome diſtance from land. The inhabitants among the mountains are Indians; along the coaſts, Eſkimaux. The Dogs of the former are very ſmall; of the latter, large, and headed like a Fox. Notwithſtanding they have Rein-deer, they never train them for the ſledge; but apply the Dogs to that uſe. Walruſes viſit a place called Nuchvûnk, in lat. 60, during winter; from thence they purchaſe the teeth, with which they head their darts. Davis ſuſpected that he had found a paſſage on this coaſt, in 1586, to the Weſtern ocean; but it proves no more than a deep bay.

The laudable zeal of the Moravian clergy hath induced them to ſend, in the year 1752, miſſionaries from Greenland to this country. They fixed on Niſbet's harbour for their ſettlement; but the firſt party was partly killed, partly driven away. In 1764, under the protection of our government, another attempt was made. The miſſionaries were well received by the Eſkimaux, and the miſſion goes on with ſucceſs. Theſe pious people, like the Jeſuits, have penetrated almoſt into every part of the known world; and, for the ſake of the Goſpel, dared the extremities of heat and cold. They endeavour to humanize the ſavages of Greenland, and improve the morals of the ſoft inhabitants of the unwholeſome coaſts of Bengal. They are not actuated by ambition, political views, or avarice. [CXCV] Here my compariſon with the once-potent order of the Roman church fails.

Terra de Labrador, at Cape Charles, in lat. 52, trends towards the ſouth-weſt. Between that cape and the iſle of Newfoundland begin the ſtreights of Belleiſle, a paſſage with from twenty to thirty fathoms water; but often choaked up with the floating ice from the north, even ſo late as the middle of June *. They open into the vaſt triangular gulph of St. Laurence, bounded to the north by Terra de Labrador; to the weſt by Nova Scotia; to the eaſt by Cape Breton and Newfoundland. In the weſtern corner, the vaſt river of St. Laurence diſcharges itſelf; ariſing from a thouſand ſtreams which feed the ſea-like lakes of Canada, and, after falling down the amazing cataract of Niagara, and darting down the ſlopes of numberleſs foaming rapids, tremendous to all but Britiſh battalions, forms a matchleſs navigation of many hundred miles. Jacques Cartier, a native of St. Maloes, had, in 1534, the honor of being the firſt diſcoverer of this noble river.

In the gulph are ſcattered ſeveral important iſlands,MAGDALENE ISLES. occupied by the Engliſh and French for the ſake of the fiſheries. The ſmall rocky iſles of St. Magdalene are ſtill frequented by numbers of Walruſes. There is an annual chace during the ſeaſon, and numbers are killed for the ſake of the oil and ſkins. The water round the Magdalenes is only from three to nine fathoms deep, and the ſhores ſlope moſt conveniently into it for the aſcent or deſcent of theſe animals. The water round the other iſles is of one depth, except on the north ſide of St. John's.

Newfoundland (a name, in the infancy of diſcovery, common to all North America) was diſcovered in 1496, by the celebrated Venetians, Sebaſtian Cabot and his three ſons; who, at their own charges, under a grant of Henry VII. giving them poſſeſſion (as vaſſals of his) of all lands they might diſcover§, coaſted from lat. 67. 30, to the capes of Florida, and thus indiſputably gave to ill-fated Britain the right, by pre-diſcovery, of the whole continent of North America. The ſhort-ſighted avaricious prince, under whoſe banners it was diſcovered, had not the heart to make the proper advantage. He had before neglected the offer of Columbus, which would have given him that ſpecies of right to the whole New World. 'But,' ſays the courtier-like Bacon , ‘it was not a refuſal on the king's part, but a delay by accident, which put by ſo great an acqueſt.’ The French ſoon found out the gold mine of the Newfoundland diſcovery, which offered itſelf in the fiſheries. Of all minerals (twice ſays the ſame noble philoſopher) there [CXCVI] is none like the fiſheries. In 1534 they were actually engaged in them. A private man, Sir Humphry Gilbert, brother-in-law to RALEIGH, or, what was better, animated by a congenial ſoul, ſailed in 1583 with every proviſion for ſettling this important colony. On his return he was ſwallowed up by the ocean. His love of improvement, and his piety, never forſook him. He was ſeen ſitting unmoved in the ſtern of his ſhip, with a book in his hand; and often heard to ſay, 'Courage, my lads! we are as near heaven at ſea as at land*.'

The iſle of Newfoundland is of a triangular form, and lies between lat. 46. 40, and 51. 30: viſited occaſionally, but not inhabited, by ſavages from the continent.

The boaſted mine of this iſland lies on the ſouthern and weſtern ſides, on the great bank, which ſtretches from north-eaſt to ſouth-weſt, about two hundred leagues. The water on the bank is from twenty-two to fifty fathoms; on the outſide from ſixty to eighty; on the leſſer banks much the ſame. A great ſwell and thick fog generally mark the place of the greater. The ſubject of the fiſhery has been often treated of; but the following ſhort though clear account of ſo intereſting a ſubject cannot fail being acceptable to the Britiſh reader.

NEWFOUNDLAND FISHERY."The boats or ſhallops are forty feet in the keel, rigged with a mainmaſt and foremaſt, and lugſails; furniſhed with four oars, three of which row on one ſide, and the other (which is twice as large) belays the other three, by being rowed ſideways over the ſtern, by a man who ſtands up for that purpoſe, with his face towards the rowers, counteracting them, and ſteering at the ſame time as he gives way to the boat.

"Each of the men in this boat is furniſhed with two lines, one at each ſide of the boat, each furniſhed with two hooks; ſo here are ſixteen hooks conſtantly employed; which are thought to make a tolerable good day's work of it, if they bring in from five to ten quintals of fiſh, though they have ſtowage for, and ſometimes bring in thirty. Two hundred quintals is called a ſaving voyage; but not under. The bait is ſmall fiſh of all kinds; Herring, Capelin, Lance, Tom Cod, or young Cod; the firſt of which they ſalt, and keep for ſome time, in caſe of ſcarcity of the reſt; but theſe are not near ſo eagerly taken by the fiſh when ſalted. In caſe ſmall fiſh cannot be got, they uſe ſea-fowl, which are eaſily taken in vaſt numbers, by laying nets over the holes in the rocks where they come to rooſt in the night. If neither ſmall fiſh nor birds are to be got, they are forced to uſe the maws of fiſh they catch, which is the worſt bait of any.

"When the fiſh are taken, they are carried to the ſtage, which is built with one end over the water for the conveniency of throwing the offals into the ſea, and [CXCVII] for their boats being able to come cloſe to diſcharge their fiſh. As ſoon as they come on the ſtage a boy hands them to the header, who ſtands at the ſide of a table next the water end; whoſe buſineſs it is to gut the fiſh and cut off the head, which he does by preſſing the back of the head againſt the ſide of the table, which is made ſharp for that purpoſe; when both head and guts fall through a hole in the floor into the water. He then ſhoves the fiſh to the ſplitter, who ſtands oppoſite to him; his buſineſs is to ſplit the fiſh, beginning at the head, and opening it down to the tail; at the next cut he takes out the larger part of the back-bone, which falls through the floor into the water. He then ſhoves the fiſh off the table, which drops into a kind of hand-barrow, which, as ſoon as filled, is carried off to the ſalt-pile. The header alſo flings the liver into a ſeparate baſket, for the making of train-oil, uſed by the curriers, which bears a higher price than Whale-oil.

"In the ſalt pile, the fiſh are ſpread upon one another, with a layer of ſalt between. Thus they remain till they have taken ſalt; and then are carried, and the ſalt is waſhed from them by throwing them off from ſhore in a kind of float called a Pound. As ſoon as this is completed, they are carried to the laſt operation, of drying them; which is done on ſtanding flakes made by a ſlight wattle, juſt ſtrong enough to ſupport the men who lay on the fiſh, ſupported by poles, in ſome places as high as twenty feet from the ground: here they are expoſed, with the open ſide to the ſun; and every night, when it is bad weather, piled up five or ſix on a heap, with a large one, his back or ſkinny part uppermoſt, to be a ſhelter to the reſt from rain, which hardly damages him through his ſkin, as he reſts ſlanting each way to ſhoot it off. When they are tolerably dry, which in good weather is in a week's time, they are put in round piles of eight or ten quintals each, covering them on the top with bark. In theſe piles they remain three or four days to ſweat; after which they are again ſpread, and when dry put into larger heaps, covered with canvas, and left till they are put on board.

"Thus prepared, they are ſent to the Mediterranean, where they fetch a good price; but are not eſteemed in England: for which place another kind of fiſh is prepared, called by them Mud Fiſh; which, inſtead of being ſplit quite open, like their dry fiſh, are only opened down to the navel. They are ſalted, and lie in ſalt, which is waſhed out of them in the ſame manner with the others; but inſtead of being laid out to dry, are barrelled up in a pickle of ſalt boiled in water.

"The train-oil is made from the livers: it is called ſo to diſtinguiſh it from Whale or Seal oil, which they call fat oil, and is ſold at a lower price (being only [CXCVIII] uſed for lighting of lamps) than the train-oil, which is uſed by the curriers. It is thus made:—They take a half tub, and, boring a hole through the bottom, preſs hard down into it a layer of ſpruce boughs; upon which they place the livers; and expoſe the whole apparatus to as ſunny a place as poſſible. As the livers corrupt the oil runs from them, and, ſtraining itſelf clear through the ſpruce boughs, is caught in a veſſel ſet under the hole in the tub's bottom."

CAPE BRETON.The barren iſland of Cape Breton forms one ſide of the great entrance into the gulph of St. Laurence. It is high, rocky, and dreary: rich in thick beds of coal, and may prove the Newcaſtle of America. This iſle was firſt diſcovered by Sir Humphry Gilbert, in his fatal voyage. It was ſoon after frequented, on account of the Walruſes, and the fiſhery of Whales. Among the earlieſt adventurers were the induſtrious Biſcayeners, who ſeem to have been our maſters in the art. Till of late years, it had been important by being the ſeat of the French fiſhery; but the ſtrong fortreſs of Louiſbourg is now demoliſhed, and the place deſerted.

NOVA SCOTIA.The great peninſula of Nova Scotia is ſeparated from Cape Breton by a narrow ſtreight. It was, in 1616, poſſeſſed by the French, who attempted to colonize it from their new ſettlement in Canada; but they were ſoon expelled by the Engliſh, who deemed it part of North Virginia; the whole continent, at that time, going under the name of Virginia, ſo called, originally, in honor of our virgin queen. The French had given it the name of Acadie. James I. made a grant of the country to Sir William Alexander in 1621, on condition that he would form there a ſettlement. It then received the title of Nova Scotia. In order to encourage Sir William, he planned the order of baronets, which is called after the country. To every knight who would engage to colonize any part, a grant was to be made of certain portions of land. The order was not inſtituted till 1625, when a number were created, and they held their lands from the crown of Scotland as a free barony, with great privileges to all who would ſettle in the country*. The deſign almoſt inſtantly failed, and the French were permitted to repoſſeſs themſelves of the province. Its value became known, and ſince that period it has frequently changed maſters. It never was effectually ſettled till the year 1749, when a large colony was ſent there under the auſpices of the Earl of Halifax.

CLIMATE.The climate of this province is, during the long winter, extremely ſevere, and the country covered with ſnow many months: the ſummer miſty and damp. The face of it is in general hilly; but can ſcarcely be called mountanous, [CXCIX] being the lowered continuation of the great chain which pervades the whole continent. The ground is not favorable to agriculture, but may prove excellent for paſturage. Due attention to the breeding of cattle will not only repay the induſtry of the farmer, by the home conſumption, but be an extenſive benefit to our iſlands. The country cannot boaſt, amidſt its vaſt foreſts, timber fit for large maſts, nor yet for the building of large ſhips; yet it will prove an inexhauſtible magazine for that ſpecies of timber called lumber, ſo eſſential to our ſugar plantations.

Its ſituation, in reſpect to the fiſheries,ITS FISHERIES. is ſcarcely inferior to that of Newfoundland. The vaſt banks, called Sable Iſland's, Brown's, and St. George's, with many others, are frequented by myriads of Cod-fiſh. It is the duty of the Parent State to encourage, with all diligence, this branch of commerce; and in a manner ſo expeditious and ſo frugal, as may anticipate and underſell foreign adventurers. Without that, our remnants of the New World will be but of little uſe. The fiſheries, the ſtaples of Nova Scotia and Newfoundland, are open to other nations; and if they are permitted to excel us in the articles expedition and frugality, our labors are truly vain. It is to the antient hardy coloniſts we muſt look up for the ſupport of the toils of the ſea, and the advantages we may expect to gain from them: they ſhould have their encouragement. But there is another ſet of men who of late (a public calamity) have made hither an involuntary migration, who with ſad hearts recollect their exiled land:

Nos Patriae fines, nos dulcia linquimus arva:
Nos Patriam fugimus.

Theſe ſufferers are in general unuſed to the fatigues of a maritime life, and ought to be foſtered, for their filial piety, at firſt, with a parental care; to be encouraged in the paſtoral life, or in ſuch arts as may ſupply the ſailor and the fiſherman with food, and with materials for their profeſſions. If the climate is fit for corn, for flax and hemp, let due rewards be given for the ſucceſsful efforts of their induſtry. The ſucceeding generation, hardened to the climate, and early habituated to another kind of life, may join the maritime adventurers, and give importance to themſelves, and ſtrength to the iſland from which they ſprung.

The harbours of this province are frequent and excellent.HARBOURS. The tides are in many places moſt uncommonly high. Thoſe of the bay of Fundy are the moſt remarkable; for they force themſelves into the great creeks with a bore or head [] from fifty to ſeventy-two feet high, and with moſt amazing rapidity. Hogs, which feed along the ſhores, are much more ſenſible of its approach than mankind: they are obſerved to liſten, to prick up their ears for ſome time, and then ſuddenly to run off at full ſpeed.

MAGNIFICENT VIEWS.The coaſts are, in general, rude and rocky, with ſome variations; but in many places exhibit moſt pictureſque ſcenery. All the northern ſide is high, red, and rocky. The iſles of Canſo are varied with many low white rocks. From them to Torbay is a ſeries of lofty coaſt, broken and white. Beaver Harbour is guarded by moſt pictureſque rounded iſles. South ſhore of Chebucto ſteep: the plaiſter cliffs in George Bay are remarkable for their precipitous face and whiteneſs. Sable or Sand Iſland is diſtinguiſhed (as the name imports) by amazing ſand-hills of a ſugar-loaf form. The iſle of Great Manan, on the weſtern ſide of the entrance of the bay of Fundy, is very lofty, the ſtrata divided, and the top wooded. St. Mary's Bay is nobly bounded by high rocks, cloathed on their ſummits with woods: the entrance into it are the Grand and Petit Paſſage; the ſides of the laſt are either covered with hanging woods, ſloping to the water-edge, or broke into ſhort precipices. The entrance into the fine harbour of Annapolis is moſt auguſt: a narrow gut, bounded by enormous precipices, with lofty hills ſoaring above, the tops of which are even and cloathed with woods. The approach to the baſon of Minas is not leſs magnificent. The columnar rocks of Cape Split are very ſingular. The iſle of Haute is lofty and ſteep on every ſide. The whole neighborhood abounds with views of the moſt ſublime and romantic caſt. This peninſula joins the great continent by a very narrow iſthmus, beyond which we retain a wretched barren remnant of near half of the New World; the ſad reverſe of the ſhort ſpace of twenty years!—My eyes withdraw themſelves from the mortifying ſight. BRITAIN, which ſate (by the wiſdom of one man) as the Queen of Nations, now deplores her folly; and ought to confeſs, that ‘thoſe things which were for her wealth, proved to her an occaſion of falling.’ She ſunk under the deluſion of proſperity, by falſe ſecurity, and the pride of victories. If ſhe makes a proper uſe of adverſity, ſhe ſtill may riſe into glory and wealth, by honeſt induſtry, and by the repreſſion of rapacity and ſordid ambition.—Once more, gracious Heaven, endeavour to ſave an ungrateful people! once more raiſe up ſome great inſtrument to execute thy mercies!—Pour with full meaſure into our youthful Miniſter the virtues of his father!—Emulate, young Man, his virtues, and then—

Si qua fata aſpera rumpas;
Tu MARCELLUS eris.

Appendix A INDEX TO THE INTRODUCTION.

[]
A.
  • ALPS of Great Britain, their courſe page XIX
    • Sibiria page XCIV
    • America page CXXXIX
  • Alaſhka promontory page CLI
  • Aland iſles page LXII
  • Archangel, its origin page XCII
  • America, from whence peopled page CLX
  • Arctic flats page XCIX
  • Antiquities Britiſh, in the Orknies and Schetland page XXXI
    • in Scandinavia page XXXVI
    • Roman in Schetland page XXXIII
    • Roman in Sconen, in Sweden page LIX
  • Altaic chain or mountains, its courſe page XCV
  • Arzina, where Sir Hugh Willoughby periſhed page LXXX
  • Aleutian iſles page CXXXV
  • Aurora Borealis, formerly ſuppoſed to be portentous page XXVIII
    • beautiful in Schetland page XXVII
    • moſt ſingular in Sibiria page CII
    • in Greenland page CLXXXI
    • in Hudſon's Bay page CXC
B.
  • Borve, an antient Scotch caſtle on a perforated rock
  • Baltic ſea, rather a gulph. Deſcribed by Tacitus page LIX
    • its depth ib.
    • no tides in page LX
    • once joined to the White Sea page LXV
    • very few fiſh in page LXII
  • Breton, Cape
  • Baikal, the greateſt of lakes in the Old World page XCVII
  • Birds in Britain and France
    • Orknies page XXVI
    • Feroe Iſles page XL
    • Iceland page LI
    • Scandinavia page LXXV
    • Spitzbergen page XC
    • Greenland page CLXXXIII
    • about Prince William's Sound page CXLVIII
    • about Nootka Sound page CXLIII
  • Briſtol Bay page CLIV
  • BERING, Captain, account of page CX
    • Iceland page CXXXIII
    • Streights page CXI
  • Birds omitted in the Zoological part page CXLVII
  • Biſcayeners early in the whale-fiſhery
  • Baffin's Bay page CLXXXVI
  • Baronets of Nova Scotia page CXCVIII
  • Bow of bone moſt curiouſly engraven by the Americans page CXLIV
  • Bear, black, error of mine concerning, corrected page CXX
    • white land page CXLVII
    • Polar, farther hiſtory of page CXCIII
C.
  • Caſtum Nemus, the modern Heilgeland page LVII
    • rites celebrated there to to the goddeſs Hertha ib.
  • Camp, Roman? in one of the Schetland iſles page XXXIII
  • California page CXXXVI
  • Cimbrian deluge, its conſequences page LVIII
  • Cimbrica Cherſoneſus ib.
  • Cwen Sea. See White Sea.
  • Cherie Iſland page LXXX
  • Chain of mountains in Aſia page XCIV
    • in America page CXXXIX
  • COOK, Captain page CXXXVIII
    • river page CL
  • Clerk, Captain, purſues Captain COOK'S diſcoveries
  • Copper Iſle page CXXXIII
  • Cuſtoms common to the Americans and northern Aſiatics page CLXI
  • Coals found in very high latitudes page LXXI, C
  • Cabot gave, by his diſcovery, an original to the Engliſh of North America page CXCV
D.
  • Dover Streights, not aboriginal page II
    • their depth page III
    • increaſe of ſoundings to eaſt and weſt ib.
  • Drift-wood, on the Iceland coaſt page XLIV
    • on the Spitzbergen and Nova Zemljean page LXXXII
    • in the Icy Sea page CLIX
    • in Hudſon's Bay page LXXXV
    • from whence brought page LXXXII
    • from whence the manufactured pieces ib.
  • DRAKE, Sir Francis, his diſcovery of New Albion page CXXXVII
E.
  • Eagles, new ſpecies page CXLVII
  • Eſkimaux, of the weſtern ſide of America page CXLIX, CLIII, CLV
    • maſſacre of, near Copper River page CLXXV
    • of Greenland page CLXXXI
    • of Labrador
  • Egede, Mr. the Arctic apoſtle page CLXXIX
F.
  • Foſta, a German deity, the ſame with Veſta page LVII
  • Flevo Lacus, now loſt in the Zuyder Zee page LVI
  • Flanders, antient ſtate of ib.
  • France, once joined to Britain page II
    • correſpondency of its coaſt and cliffs ib.
    • its number of Quadrupeds and Birds page V, VI
  • Feroe Iſles, their number page XXXIX
    • when diſcovered page XLII
  • Fowling, deſperate method in Feroe page XL
    • in Schetland page XXIX
  • Fruits or Nuts of the Weſt Indies, how wafted to Norway, &c. page LXIX
  • Fiſh of Iceland, moſtly common to Greenland
    • of the Baltic, very few page LX
    • of Lapland page LXXVI
    • of Norway page LXXVI
    • of Spitzbergen page XC
    • of the Sibirian rivers page CII
      • the Frozen Sea ib.
      • Kamtſchatka page CXXII
      • Greenland page CLXXXIII
      • Hudſon's Bay page CLXXXIX
  • Fabricius, Mr. Otto, a moſt able Zoologiſt page CLXXXI
  • Fleets, vaſt, of the northern nations page LXVII
  • Froſt-ſmoke, its danger page CLXXXI
  • Foſſils of Greenland page CLXXXV
G.
  • Gouberman, iſles off Iceland, ſuddenly abſorbed page XLVII
  • Gulph ſtream, an account of page LXIX
  • Guillemot, leſſer (omitted at p. 517, Zool.) page LII
  • Germanicus doubles the Cimbrium Promontorium page LIX
  • German Sea page XX
  • Gilbert, Sir Humphry, his gallantry and piety
  • Greenland, Old page CLXXVII
    • when firſt diſcovered page CLXXVIII
    • its antient colony of Norwegians ib.
    • when again colonized page CLXXIX
H.
  • Holland, its antient ſtate page LVI
  • Hervor, her magical invocation, a runic poem page XXXVII
  • Hecla, number of its eruptions page XLVI
    • the northern hell ib.
  • Huers, or jets-d'eaux of ſcalding water in Iceland page XLVI
  • Hoy, hill of, in Orkney, its height page XXV
  • Hyperborean, or northern ocean page XLV
  • Hyperboreans, a people deſcribed by P. Mela page XCIV
  • Herrings extend to Kamtſchatka page CXXVI
  • Hearne, Mr. his amazing journey to the Icy Sea page CLXXV
  • Hippopodae, what, probably page LXIV
  • Hilleviones, a people of Sweden page LXV
  • Hudſon's Bay page CLXXXVII
I.
  • Iceland, its diſcovery page XLII
    • almoſt a maſs of lava page XLIV
    • its plants page XLV
    • dreadful eruptions in page XLVI
    • enſlaved ſtate page XLVIII
    • antient commerce from Britain page LIV
    • wonderful jets-d'eaux page XLVI
    • Quadrupeds and Birds page XLIX
  • Iſlands newly raiſed out of the ſea page XLV
    • ſwallowed up in the ſea page XLVII
    • of ice, their amazing extent page LXXXVI
  • Icebergs (or Jokkeler) of Iceland page XLV
    • of Spitzbergen page LXXXV
  • Icy Sea page CLVII
    • attempts to paſſ it page C
    • very ſhallow page CLVIII
    • its time of freezing page C
  • Jeneſei river page XCVII
K.
  • Kara Sea page XCVI
  • Kandinos Iſland page XCIII
  • Kattegatte, the page LVIII
  • Kivikke in Sweden, Roman antiquities there page LXXVIII
  • Kamtſchatka page CXII
    • ſevere climate page CXIII
    • plants of page CXIV
    • marine plants page CXXVIII
    • religion page CXXX
    • former beaſtly hoſpitality page CXXXI
  • Kuril Iſles page CXXXIII
  • Koriacs, people page CXXIX
L.
  • Labrador
  • Lena, the river page XCIX
M.
  • Mountains, Scottiſh, their height page XIX
    • Scandinavian page LXIX, LXXIII
    • of Spitzbergen page LXXXVII
    • of Sibiria page XCIV
  • Magdalene Iſles, a great haunt of the Walruſes page CXCIII
  • Mangazea, a moſt antient Arctic mart page XCVIII
  • Mednoi, or Copper Iſle page CXXXIV
  • Montroſe pits, ſingular excavations in a ſand-bank page XXI
  • Mare, Scythicum vel Samarticum page LXIV
    • Pigrum ib.
    • Septentrionale page XX
    • Morimaruſa page LXIV
    • Chronium ib.
    • Suevicum page LVIII
  • Moravian clergy, their meritorious zeal page CXCIV
  • Markoff, his journey on the ice of the Icy Sea page C
  • Moucho More, a muſhroom, its dreadful effects page CXVII
N.
  • Nortmans, their ravages page LXVII
  • North Cape page LXXX
  • North Sea. See German.
  • Nova Zemlja, uninhabited page XCVI
  • Naturaliſts employed by the EMPRESS of RUSSIA, their great merit page CXIV
  • Norway page LXVI
    • its vaſt extent, and ſingular coaſts page LXVII, LXVIII
  • Norwegians, a fine race of men page LXXVIII
    • ſaid to have diſcovered America page CLXIV
  • Nootka Sound page CXLII
    • natives of, their feathers page CXLIII
  • Newfoundland page CXCVI
    • fiſhery ib.
  • Nova Scotia page CXCVIII
    • romantic views in page CC
O.
  • Octher or Ohthere, the Norwegian, a moſt able voyager page LXXVII
  • Oonalaſhka Iſland page CLIII
  • Ob, the river page XCVI
    • its annual ſtench page XCVII
P.
  • Peczora, once a place of great trade page XCIII
  • Packing of the ice, what page LXXXIII, LXXXV
  • Panoti, a fabulous people page LXIV
  • Pytheas of Marſeilles, a moſt antient voyager page XLII
  • Prior, his beautiful fiction of the Arctic life page CIV
  • Plants. See Vegetables.
  • Prince William's Sound page CXLVII
  • Port los Remedios, the moſt northern diſcovery of the Spaniards page CXLV
Q.
  • Quadrupeds of Britain and France page IV, V
    • of the Orknies and Schetland page XXX
    • of Iceland page XLIX
    • of Scandinavia page LXXIV
    • of Spitzbergen page LXXXVIII
    • of Kamtſchatka page CXXI
    • of Greenland page CLXXXII
    • Table of page CLXVIII
R.
  • Ruſſian empire, its vaſt extent page LXIII
  • Roman fleet ſail to the mouth of the Baltic page LIX
  • Ripraps, a ſubmarine hill, once part of the iſthmus between France and Britain page III
  • Raven, ſacred to Odin page LII
    • uſed by Floke, the pirate, to diſcover land page XLIII
  • Riphean hills page XCIV
  • Rublas Promontorium page LXVI
  • Ruſſians regularly winter in Spitzbergen page CLXXXVII
S.
  • Saxonum Inſulae page LVII
  • Sibiria, its diſcovery page CV
    • intenſe cold of page CII
  • Salmon ſpecies very numerous in Kamtſchatka page CXXXIII
  • Saranne, the moſt uſeful plant of Kamtſchatka page CXVIII
  • Schalourof, his diſcoveries page CI
  • Schalotſkoi Cape, its latitude erroneous page CI, CIX
    • probably never doubled page CI
  • Springs, hot in Iceland page XLVI
    • in Kamtſchatka page CXIII
    • in Greenland
  • Seven Siſters Iſles, the moſt remote of known land page LXXXIII
  • Seven Siſters in Norway, moſt ſingular mountains page LXXII
  • Seal little (omitted in its place) page LXXIV
  • Streights of Dover affected by the ocean page III
    • between the gulph of Finland and White Sea, now cloſed, but ſtill to be traced page LXV, XCIII
  • Samoieds page XCIII
  • Scalping in uſe with the Scythians page CLXI
  • Scandinavia, once inſulated page LXV
    • the Officina Gentium page LXVII
    • [...]avage, yet aſſiſt to people much of Europe ib.
  • Sand banks, off Britain, their utility page XII, XXI
    • which dangerous ib.
    • off Flanders and Holland page LV
  • Sevo Mons, Seveberg page LXXII
  • Sweet Plant, the, its great uſe in Kamtſchatka page CXVII
  • Spitzbergen page LXXXI
    • inſtances of people wintering there page XC, CLXXXVII
T.
  • Tides, height of, in the ſtreights of Dover page III
    • at Calais, and the coaſts of Flanders and Holland page LV
    • on the coaſt of Jutland ib.
      • of Norway page LXVIII
      • of the Frozen Sea Kamtſchatka page CXXVIII
      • weſtern coaſt of America page CLI, CXLII
  • Table of Quadrupeds page CLXVIII
  • Taimura Cape page CI
  • Torg-hatten, a ſingular pierced rock page LXXII
  • Tomahawk, a moſt tremendous page CXLIV
  • Thomſon, the poet, his real repreſentation of Arctic life page CV
  • Tſchutſki, laſt of Aſiatic people page CVIII
  • Tartarian idol, figure of, illuſtrating a paſſage in Herodotus page CLXI
U.
  • Urallian chain or mountains, its courſe page XCIV
  • Vulcanoes of Iceland page XLV
    • chain of in South and North America page CXXXIX
    • in Kamtſchatka page CXII
    • in the iſles of Aſia to North America page CXXXIV, V
  • Vegetables, numbers in Iceland page XLV
    • of Spitzbergen page LXXXVIII
    • comparative liſt of thoſe of northern Europe page LXXXIX
    • of Sibiria page CVII
    • of Kamtſchatka page CXIV
    • of the weſtern ſide of America page CXLVI
    • of Bering's Iſle page CXXXIV
W.
  • Weſtra, graves of in Schetland, their contents page XXXV
  • Weſtmony in Iceland, antiently a royal port page LIV
  • Whirlpools between Cathneſs and the Orknies page XXIII, XXIV
    • of Suderoe, near the Feroe Iſles page XLII
  • Willoughby, Sir Hugh, his diſcoveries and ſad fate page LXXX
  • Waygat ſtreights, Spitzbergen page LXXXI
    • the Nova Zemljean page XCVI
  • Wardhuys, the moſt northern fortreſs page LXXIX
  • Walruſes, where abundant page LXXXI, XCVI
  • Werchoturian mountains. See Urallian.
  • White Sea, early diſcovered page LXXVII, XCII
  • Welſh, their clame to the diſcovery of America page CLXIII
  • William's, Prince, Sound page CXLVII
Y.
  • Yaik river, its courſe page XCV
  • Yermac, a Coſſac, firſt conquers part of Sibiria for the Ruſſians page CV
Z.
  • Zuyder Zee, when formed page LVI

2.

ARCTIC ZOOLOGY.
CLASS I. QUADRUPEDS.

[]

DIV. I. HOOFED.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS II. I. OX.
American OX, Hiſt. Quad. p. 19. H.—Smellie, vi. 198.1. BISON.

OX. With ſhort, black, rounded horns; with a great ſpace between their baſes: on the ſhoulders a vaſt bunch, compoſed of a fleſhy ſubſtance, much elevated: the fore part of the body thick and ſtrong: the hind part ſlender and weak: tail a foot long, naked to the end, which is tufted: the legs ſhort and thick.

The head and ſhoulders of the BULL are covered with very long flocks of reddiſh woolly hair, falling over the eyes and horns, leaving only the points of the latter to be ſeen: on the chin, and along the dewlaps, is a great length of ſhaggy hairs: the reſt of the body during ſummer is naked, in winter is cloathed equally in all parts. The Cow is leſſer, and wants the ſhaggy coat, which gives the Bull ſo tremendous an aſpect.

It grows to a great ſize,SIZE. even to the weight of ſixteen hundred or two thouſand four hundred poundsLawſon, 116.. The ſtrongeſt man cannot lift the hide of one of theſe animals from the groundCateſby ii. App..

[2]The Biſon and Aurochs of Europe is certainly the ſame ſpecies with this; the difference conſiſts in the former being leſs ſhaggy, and the hair neither ſo ſoft nor woolly, nor the hind parts ſo weak. Both European and American kinds ſcent of muſk.

WHERE ANTIENTLY FOUND.In antient times they were found in different parts of the old world, but went under different names; the Bonaſus of Ariſtotle, the Urus of Caeſar, the Bos ferus of Strabo, the Biſon of Pliny, and the Biſton of Oppian, ſo called from its being found among the Biſtones, a people of Thrace. According to theſe authorities, it was found in their days in Media and in Poeonia, a province of Macedonia; among the Alps, and in the great Hercynian foreſt, which extended from Germany even into Sarmatia Ariſtot. Hiſt. An. lib. ii. c. 1.—Caeſar Bel. Gall. lib. vi.—Plinii Hiſt. Nat. lib. xv. c. 15.—Oppian Cyneg. ii. Lin. 160.. In later days a white ſpecies was a native of the Scottiſh mountains; it is now extinct in its ſavage ſtate, but the offspring, ſufficiently wild, is ſtill to be ſeen in the parks of Drumlanrig, in the South of Scotland, and of Chillingham Caſtle in Northumberland Br. Zool. i. No 3.—Voy. Hebrides, 124.—Tour. Scotl. 1772, Part ii. p. 285..

WHERE AT PRESENT.In theſe times it is found in very few places in a ſtate of nature; it is, as far as we know, an inhabitant at preſent only of the foreſts of Lithuania, EUROPE. and among the Carpathian mountains, within the extent of the great Hercynian wood, its antient haunts; and in Aſia, ASIA. among the vaſt mountains of Caucaſus.

It is difficult to ſay in what manner theſe animals migrated originally from the old to the new world; it is moſt likely it was from the north of Aſia, which in very antient times might have been ſtocked with them to its moſt extreme parts, notwithſtanding they are now extinct. At that period there is a probability that the old and the new continents might have been united in the narrow channel between Tchutki noſs and the oppoſite headlands of America; [3] and the many iſlands off of that promontory, with the Aleutian or New Fox iſlands, ſomewhat more diſtant, ſtretching very near to America, may with great reaſon be ſuppoſed to be fragments of land which joined the two continents, and formed into their inſular ſtate by the mighty convulſion which divided Aſia from America. Spain was probably thus disjoined from Africa; Britain from France; Iceland from Greenland; Spitzbergen from Lapland.

But that they paſſed from Aſia to America is far the more probable, than that they ſtocked the new world from the ſide of Europe, not only on account of the preſent narrowneſs of the ſtreight between the two continents, which gives a greater cauſe to ſuppoſe them to have been once joined; but that we are now arrived at a certainty, that theſe animals in antient days were natives of Sibiria: the ſculls, with the horns affixed, of a ſize far ſuperior to any known at this time, have been found foſſil not only on the banks of the Ilga, which falls into the Lena, but even in thoſe of the Anadyr, the moſt eaſtern of the Sibirian rivers, and which diſembogues north of Kamtſchatka into thoſe ſtreights: ſimilar ſkulls and horns have been diſcovered near Dirſchau, in Poland, alſo of a gigantic magnitude; and in my opinion of the ſame ſpecies with the modern Biſons*.

In America theſe animals are found in the countries ſix hundred miles weſt of Hudſon's Bay; this is their moſt northern reſidence.AMERICA. From thence they are met with in great droves as low as Cibole , in lat. 33, a little north of California, and alſo in the province of Mivera, in New Mexico ; the ſpecies inſtantly ceaſes ſouth of thoſe countries. They inhabit Canada, to the weſt of the lakes; and in greater abundance in the rich ſavannas which border the river Miſſiſipi, and the great rivers which fall into it from the weſt, in the upper Louiſiana Du Pratz, ii. 50. i. 116. 286.. [4] There they are ſeen feeding in herds innumerable, promiſcuouſly with multitudes of ſtags and deer, during morning and evening; retiring in the ſultry heats into the ſhade of tall reeds, which border the rivers of America.

TIMID.They are exceedingly ſhy; and very fearful of man, unleſs they are wounded, when they purſue their enemy, and become very dangerous.

CHASE.The chaſe of theſe animals is a favorite diverſion of the Indians: it is effected in two ways; firſt, by ſhooting; when the markſman muſt take great care to go againſt the wind, for their ſmell is ſo exquiſite that the moment they get ſcent of him they inſtantly retire with the utmoſt precipitation*. He aims at their ſhoulders, that they may drop at once, and not be irritated by an ineffectual wound. Provided the wind does not favor the beaſts, they may be approached very near,ANOTHER METHOD. being blinded by the hair which covers their eyes. The other method is performed by a great number of men, who divide and form a vaſt ſquare: each band ſets fire to the dry graſs of the ſavanna where the herds are feeding; theſe animals have a great dread of fire, which they ſee approach on all ſides; they retire from it to the center of the ſquare; the bands cloſe, and kill them (preſſed together in heaps) without the leſt hazard. It is pretended, that on every expedition of this nature, they kill fifteen hundred or two thouſand beeves.

The hunting-grounds are preſcribed with great form, leaſt the different bands ſhould meet, and interfere in the diverſion. Penalties are enacted on ſuch who infringe the regulations, as well as on thoſe who quit their poſts, and ſuffer the beaſts to eſcape from the hollow ſquares; the puniſhments are, the ſtripping the delinquents, the taking away their arms (which is the greateſt diſgrace a ſavage can undergo), or laſtly, the demolition of their cabins.

[5]The uſes of theſe animals are various.USES. Powder-flaſks are made of their horns. The ſkins are very valuable; in old times the Indians made of them the beſt targets*. When dreſſed,SKIN. they form an excellent buff; the Indians dreſs them with the hair on, and cloath themſelves with them; the Europeans of Louiſiana uſe them for blankets, and find them light, warm, and ſoft. The fleſh is a conſiderable article of food, and the bunch on the back is eſteemed a very great delicacy. The Bulls become exceſſively fat, and yield great quantity of tallow,TALLOW. a hundred and fifty pounds weight has been got from a ſingle beaſt, which forms a conſiderable matter of commerce. Theſe over-fed animals uſually become the prey of Wolves; for, by reaſon of their great unwieldineſs, they cannot keep up with the herd.

The Indians, by a very bad policy, prefer the fleſh of the Cows; which in time will deſtroy the ſpecies: they complain of the rankneſs of that of the Bulls; but Du Pratz thinks the laſt much more tender, and that the rankneſs might be prevented, by cutting off the teſticles as ſoon as the beaſt is killed.

The hair or wool is ſpun into cloth, gloves, ſtockings,HAIR. and garters, which are very ſtrong, and look as well as thoſe made of the beſt ſheeps wool; Governor Pownall aſſures us, that the moſt luxurious fabrick might be made of it. The fleece of one of theſe animals has been found to weigh eight pounds.

Their ſagacity in defending themſelves againſt the attacks of Wolves is admirable:DEFENCE AGAINST WOLVES. when they ſcent the approach of a drove of thoſe ravenous creatures, the herd flings itſelf into the form of a circle: the weakeſt keep in the middle, the ſtrongeſt are ranged on the outſide, preſenting to the enemy an impenetrable front of horns: ſhould they be taken by ſurprize, and have recourſe to flight, numbers of the fatteſt or the weakeſt are ſure to periſh.

[6] HARD TO BE TAMED.Attempts have been made to tame and domeſticate the wild, by catching the calves and bringing them up with the common kind, in hopes of improving the breed. It has not yet been found to anſwer: notwithſtanding they had the appearance for a time of having loſt their ſavage nature, yet they always grew impatient of reſtraint, and, by reaſon of their great ſtrength, would break down the ſtrongeſt incloſure, and entice the tame cattle into the corn-fields. They have been known to engender together, and to breed; but I cannot learn whether the ſpecies was meliorated * by the intercourſe: probably perſeverance in continuing the croſſes is only wanted to effect their thorough domeſtication; as it is notorious that the Biſons of the old world were the original ſtock of all our tame cattle.

Theſe were the only animals which had any affinity to the European cattle on the firſt diſcovery of the new world: before that period, it was in poſſeſſion of neither Horſe nor Aſs, Cow nor Sheep, Hog, Goat, nor yet that faithful animal the Dog. Mankind were here in a ſtate of nature; their own paſſions unſubdued, they never thought of conquering thoſe of the brute creation, and rendering them ſubſervient to their will. The few animals which they had congenerous to thoſe mentioned, might poſſibly by induſtry have been reclamed. This animal might have been brought to all the uſes of the European Cow; the Pecari might have been ſubſtituted for the Hog; the Fox or Wolf for the Dog: but the natives, living wholly by chaſe, were at war with the animal creation, and neglected the cultivation of any part, except the laſt, which was imperfectly tamed.

Such is the caſe even to the preſent hour; for neither the example of the Europeans, nor the viſible advantages which reſult from an attention to that uſeful animal the Cow, can induce the Indian to pay any reſpect to it. He contemns every ſpecies of domeſtic labour, except what is neceſſary for forming a proviſion of bread. Every [7] wigwam or village has its plantation of Mayz, or Indian corn, and on that is his great dependence, ſhould the chaſe prove unſucceſsful.

Domeſticated cattle are capable of enduring very rigorous climates; Cows are kept at Quickjock in Lecha Lapmark, LAPMARK. not far from the arctic circle; but they do not breed there, the ſucceſſion being preſerved by importation: yet in Iceland, ICELAND. a ſmall portion of which is within the circle, cattle abound, and breed as in more ſouthern latitudes: they are generally fed with hay, as in other places; but where there is ſcarcity of fodder, they are fed with the fiſh called the Sea-Wolf, and the heads and bones of Cod beaten ſmall, and mixed with one quarter of chopped hay: the cattle are fond of it, and, what is wonderful, yield a conſiderable quantity of milk. It need not be ſaid that the milk is bad.

Kamtſchatka, KAMTSCHATKA. like America, was in equal want of every domeſtic animal, except a wolf-like Dog, till the Ruſſians of late years introduced the Cow and Horſe. The colts and calves brought from the north into the rich paſtures of Kamtſchatka, where the graſs is high, grow to ſuch a ſize, that no one would ever ſuſpect them to be deſcended from the Ponies and Runts of the Lena *. The Argali, the ſtock of the tame Sheep, abounds in the mountains, but even to this time are only objects of chaſe. The natives are to this hour as uncultivated as the good Evander deſcribes the primary natives of Latium to have been, before the introduction of arts and ſciences.

Queis neque mos, neque cultus erat, nec jungere tauros,
Aut componere opes norant, aut parcere parto:
Sed rami atque aſper victu venatus alebat.
No laws they know, no manners, nor the care
Of lab'ring Oxen, or the ſhining Share;
No arts of gain, nor what they gain'd to ſpare:
Their exerciſe the chaſe: the running flood
Supplied their thirſt; the trees ſupplied their food.
Dryden,
2. MUSK.Muſk Ox, Hiſt. Quad. No 9. Le Boeuf muſqùe, de M. Jeremie, Voy. au Nord, iii. 314.—Charlevoix, N. France, v. 194.—LEV. MUS.
[8]

BULL. With horns cloſely united at the baſe; bending inwards and downwards; turning outwards towards their ends, which taper to a point, and are very ſharp: near the baſe are two feet in girth; are only two feet long meaſured along the curvature: weight of a pair, ſeparated from the head, ſometimes is ſixty pounds*.

The hair is of a duſky red, extremely fine, and ſo long as to trail on the ground, and render the beaſt a ſeeming ſhapeleſs maſs, without diſtinction of head or tail: the legs and tail very ſhort: the ſhoulders riſe into a lump.

SIZE.In ſize lower than a Deer, but larger as to belly and quarters. I have only ſeen the head of this animal; the reſt of the deſcription is taken from the authorities referred to: but by the friendſhip of Samuel Wegg, Eſq I received laſt year a very complete ſkin of the cow of this ſpecies, of the age of three years, which enables me to give the following deſcription:

Figure 1. Musk Bull & Cow No. 2

Space between the horns nine inches:HORNS. the horns are placed exactly on the ſides of the head; are whitiſh; thirteen inches and a half long; eight inches and a half round at the baſe; of the ſame ſort of curvature with thoſe of the Bull: the ears are three inches long,EARS. quite erect; ſharp-pointed, but dilate much in the middle; are thickly lined with hair of a duſky color, marked with a ſtripe of white.

The color of the hair black, except on theſe parts:COLOR.—from the baſe of one horn to that of the other, is a bed of white and light ruſt-colored hair: the mane is duſky, tinged with red, which is continued in a narrow form to the middle of the back; on which is a large roundiſh bed of pure white, and the hairs in that ſpace ſhorter than any of the reſt, not exceeding three inches in length, and of a pale brown towards their roots.

The hairs are of two kinds, the longeſt meaſure ſeventeen inches;HAIR. are very fine and gloſſy, and when examined appear quite flat: this is the black part, which cloaths moſt part of the animal.

The bed of hair between the horns, and that which runs along the top of the neck, is far finer and ſofter than any human hair, and appears quite round. The white bed is ſtill finer, and approaches to the nature of wool.

Beneath every part of the hair grows in great plenty,WOOL. and often in flocks, an aſh-colored wool, moſt exquiſitely fine, ſuperior, I think, [10] to any I have ſeen, and which might be very uſeful in manufactures if ſufficient could be procured. I give full credit to M. Jeremie, who ſays, that he brought ſome of the wool to France, and got ſtockings made with it, more beautiful than thoſe of ſilk*. The ſkin is thin.

SIZE.The length of the whole hide, from noſe to tail, is about ſix feet four inches: of the head alone fourteen inches. The legs could not be well meaſured, but were little more than a foot long.

The ſituation of theſe animals is very local. They appear firſt in the tract between Churchill river and that of Seals, on the weſt ſide of Hudſon's Bay. They are very numerous between the latitudes 66 and 73 north, which is as far as any tribes of Indians go. They live in herds of twenty or thirty. Mr. Hearn has ſeen in the high latitudes ſeveral herds in one day's walk. They delight moſt in the rocky and barren mountains, and ſeldom frequent the woody parts of the country. They run nimbly, and are very active in climbing the rocks. The fleſh taſtes very ſtrong of Muſk, and the heart is ſo ſtrongly infected as hardly to be eatable; but the former is very wholeſome, having been found to reſtore ſpeedily to health the ſickly crew who made it their food.

They are ſhot by the Indians for the ſake of the meat and ſkins, the laſt from its warmth making excellent blankets. They are brought down on ſledges to the forts annually during winter, with about three or four thouſand weight of the fleſh. Theſe are called Churchill Buffaloes, to diſtinguiſh them from the laſt ſpecies, which are in Hudſon's Bay called Inland Buffaloes, of which only the tongues are brought as preſents.

They are found alſo in the land of the Cris or Criſtinaux, and the Aſſinibouels: again among the Attimoſpiquay, a nation ſuppoſed to inhabit [11] about the head of the river of Seals *, probably not very remote from the South Sea. They are continued from theſe countries ſouthward, as low as the provinces of Quivera and Cibola; for Father Marco di Niça, and Gomara, plainly deſcribe both kinds.

Some of the ſkulls of this ſpecies have been diſcovered on the moſſy plains near the mouth of the Oby in Sibiria. It is not ſaid how remote from the ſea; if far, they probably in ſome period might have been common to the north of Aſia and of America; if near the ſhore, it is poſſible that the carcaſes might have floated on the ice from America to the places where the remains might have been found. Of this ſpecies was the head, and ſuch were the means of conveyance, from the coaſt of Hudſon's or Baffin's, mentioned by Mr. Fabricius, and which he ſaw ſo brought to Greenland ; for it could not have been, as he conjectures, the head of the grunting Ox, an animal found only in the very interior parts of northern Aſia.

SHEEP. Hiſt. Quad. GENUS III.
[12]
ARGALI: Wild Sheep, Hiſt. Quad. No 11. H. p. 38.—Smellie, vi. 205.— LEV. MUS.

THE Sheep, in its wild ſtate, inhabits the north-eaſt of Aſia, beyond lake Baikal, between the Onon and Argun, to the height of latitude 60, on the eaſt of the Lena, and from thence to Kamtſchatka, and perhaps the Kurili iſlands. I dare not pronounce that they extend to the continent of America; yet I have received from Doctor Pallas a fringe of very fine twiſted wool, which had ornamented a dreſs from the iſle of Kadjak; and I have myſelf another piece from the habit of the Americans in latitude 50. The firſt was of a ſnowy whiteneſs, and of unparalleled fineneſs; the other as fine, but of a pale brown color: the firſt appeared to be the wool which grows intermixed with the hairs of the Argali; the laſt, that which is found beneath thoſe of the Muſk Ox. Each of theſe animals may exiſt on that ſide of the continent, notwithſtanding they might have not fallen within the reach of the navigators in their ſhort ſtay off the coaſt.

Certain quadrupeds of this genus were obſerved in California by the miſſionaries in 1697; one as large as a Calf of one or two years old, with a head like a Stag, and horns like a Ram: the tail and hair ſpeckled, and ſhorter than a Stag's. A ſecond kind was larger, and varied in color; ſome being white, others black, and furniſhed [13] with very good wool. The Fathers called both Sheep, from their great reſemblance to them*. Either the Americans of latitude 50 are poſſeſſed of theſe animals, or may obtain the fleeces by commerce from the ſouthern Indians.

The Argali abound in Kamtſchatka; they are the moſt uſeful of their animals, for they contribute to food and cloathing. The Kamtſchatkans cloath themſelves with the ſkins, and eſteem the fleſh, eſpecially the fat, diet fit for the Gods.CHASE IN KAMTSCHATKA. There is no labor which they will not undergo in the chaſe. They abandon their habitations, with all their family, in the ſpring, and continue the whole ſummer in the employ, amidſt the rude mountains, fearleſs of the dreadful precipices, or of the avelenches, which often overwhelm the eager ſportſmen.

Theſe animals are ſhot with guns or with arrows; ſometimes with croſs-bows, which are placed in the paths, and diſcharged by means of a ſtring whenever the Argali happens to tread on it. They are often chaſed with dogs, not that they are overtaken by them; but when they are driven to the lofty ſummits, they will often ſtand and look as if it were with contempt on the dogs below, which gives the hunter an opportunity of creeping within reach while they are ſo engaged; for they are the ſhyeſt of animals.

The Mongols and Tunguſi uſe a nobler ſpecies of chaſe:IN MONGOLIA. they collect together a vaſt multitude of horſes and dogs, attempting to ſurround them on a ſudden; for ſuch is their ſwiftneſs and cunning, that if they perceive, either by ſight or ſmell, the approach of the chaſſeurs, they inſtantly take to flight, and ſecure themſelves on the lofty and inacceſſible ſummits.

Domeſticated Sheep will live even in the dreadful climate of Greenland. Mr. Fabricius ſays, they are kept in many places.SHEEP IN ICELAND. They are very numerous in Iceland. Before the epidemical diſeaſe which raged among them from 1740 to 1750, it was not uncommon for a [14] ſingle perſon to be poſſeſſed of a thouſand or twelve hundred. They have upright ears, ſhort tails, and often four or five horns*. They are ſometimes kept in ſtables during winter, but uſually left to take their chance abroad, when they commonly hide themſelves in the caves of exhauſted vulcanoes. They are particularly fond of ſcurvy-graſs, with which they grow ſo fat as to yield more than twenty pounds. The ewes give from two to ſix quarts of milk a day, of which butter and cheeſe is made. The wool is never ſhorn, but left on till the end of May, when it grows looſe, and is ſtripped entirely off in one fleece; and a fine, ſhort, and new wool appears to have grown beneath; this continues growing all ſummer, becomes ſmooth and gloſſy like the hair of Camels, but more ſhaggy. With the wool the natives manufacture their cloth; and the fleſh dried is an article of commerce.

In all parts of European Ruſſia are found the common Sheep. Thoſe of the very north, and of the adjacent Finmark, have ſhort tails and upright ears, and wool almoſt as rude as the hair of Goats; but are ſeldom polyceratous. They ſometimes breed twice in a year, and bring twins each time.

In the Aſiatic dominions of Ruſſia, from the borders of Ruſſia to thoſe of China, is a moſt ſingular variety of Sheep, deſtitute of tails, with rumps ſwelling into two great, naked, and ſmooth hemiſpheres of fat, which ſometimes weigh forty pounds: their noſes are arched: their ears pendulous: their throats wattled: their heads horned, and ſometimes furniſhed with four horns. Theſe are ſo abundant throughout Tartary, that a hundred and fifty thouſand have been annually ſold at the Orenburg fairs; and a far greater number at the fort Troizkaja, from whence they are driven for ſlaughter into different [15] parts of Ruſſia *. Sheep do not thrive in Kamtſchatka, by reaſon of the wetneſs of the country.

Sheep abound in New England and its iſlands: the wool is ſhort, and much coarſer than that of Great Britain; poſſibly proper attention to the houſing of the Sheep may in time improve the fleece; but the ſeverity of the climate will ever remain an obſtacle to its perfection. Manufactures of cloth have been eſtabliſhed, and a tolerable cloth has been produced, but in quantities in no degree equal to the conſumption of the country. America likewiſe wants downs; but by clearing the hills of trees, in a long ſeries of years that defect may be alleviated. As we advance further ſouth, the Sheep grow ſcarcer, worſe, and the wool more hairy.

GOAT. Hiſt. Quad. GENUS IV.
[16]
IBEX, Hiſt. Quad. No 13, * is ſuppoſed to extend to the mountains of the eaſtern part of Sibiria, beyond the Lena, and to be found within the government of Kamtſchatka.—LEV. MUS.

THE tame Goat inhabits northern Europe as high as Wardhuys, in latitude 71, where it breeds, and runs out the whole year, only during winter has the protection of a hovel: it lives during that ſeaſon on moſs and bark of Fir-trees, and even of the logs cut for fuel. They are ſo prolific as to bring two, and even three, at a time. In Norway they thrive prodigiouſly, inſomuch that 70 or 80,000 of raw ſkins are annually exported from Bergen, beſides thouſands that are ſent abroad dreſſed.

Goats are alſo kept in Iceland, but not in numbers, by reaſon of the want of ſhrubs and trees for them to brouze. They have been introduced into Greenland, even to ſome advantage. Beſides vegetable food, they will eat the Arctic trouts dried; and grow very fat.

The climate of South America agrees ſo well with Goats, that they multiply amazingly: but they ſucceed ſo ill in Canada, that it is neceſſary to have new ſupplies to keep up the race.

[figure]
DEER. Hiſt. Quad. GENUS VII.
[17]
Elk, Hiſt. Quad. No 42.—Smellie vi. 315.—LEV. MUS.3. MOOSE.

DEER. With horns with ſhort beams, ſpreading into a broad palm, furniſhed on the outward ſide with ſharp ſnags; the inner ſide plain: no brow antlers: ſmall eyes: long ſlouching aſinine ears: noſtrils large: upper lip ſquare, great, and hanging far over the lower; has a deep furrow in the middle, ſo as to appear almoſt bifid: under the throat a ſmall excreſcence, with a long tuft of coarſe black hair pendent from it: neck ſhorter than the head; along the top an upright, ſhort, thick, mane: withers elevated: tail ſhort: legs long; the hind legs the ſhorteſt: hoofs much cloven.

Color of the mane a light brown;COLOR. of the body in general a hoary brown: tail duſky above; white beneath. The vaſt ſize of the head, the ſhortneſs of the neck, and the length of the ears, give the beaſt a deformed and ſtupid look.

The greateſt height of this animal, which I have heard of,SIZE. is ſeventeen hands; the greateſt weight 1229 pounds.

The largeſt horns I have ſeen are in the houſe of the Hudſon's Bay Company; they weigh fifty-ſix pounds:OF HORNS. their length is thirty-two inches; breadth of one of the palms thirteen inches and a half; ſpace between point and point thirty-four.

The female is leſſer than the male, and wants horns.

Inhabits the iſle of Cape Breton, Nova Scotia, PLACE. and the weſtern ſide of the Bay of Fundy; Canada, and the country round the great lakes, almoſt as far ſouth as the river Ohio *. Theſe are its preſent northern and ſouthern limits. In all ages it affected the cold and wooded regions in Europe, Aſia, and America. They are found in all the woody tracts of the temperate parts of Ruſſia, but not on the Arctic flats, nor yet in Kamtſchatka. In Sibiria they are of a monſtrous ſize, particularly among the mountains.

[18] NAME.The Elk and the Mooſe are the ſame ſpecies; the laſt derived from Muſu, which in the Algonkin language ſignifies that animal*. The Engliſh uſed to call it the Black Mooſe, to diſtinguiſh it from the Stag, which they named the Grey Mooſe. The French call it L'Orignal.

RESIDENCE AND FOOD.Theſe animals reſide amidſt foreſts, for the conveniency of brouſing the boughs of trees, becauſe they are prevented from grazing with any kind of eaſe, by reaſon of the ſhortneſs of their necks and length of their legs. They often have recourſe to water-plants, which they can readily get at by wading. M. Sarraſin ſays, that they are very fond of the anagyris foetida, or ſtinking bean trefoil, and will uncover the ſnow with their feet in order to get at it.

In paſſing through the woods, they raiſe their heads to a horizontal poſition, to prevent their horns from being entangled in the branches.

GAIT.They have a ſingular gait: their pace is a ſhambling trot, but they go with great ſwiftneſs. In their common walk they lift their feet very high, and will without any difficulty ſtep over a gate five feet high.

They feed principally in the night. If they graze, it is always againſt an aſcent;RUMINATE. an advantage they uſe for the reaſon above aſſigned. They ruminate like the Ox.

They go to rut in autumn; are at that time very furious, ſeeking the female by ſwimming from iſle to iſle.YOUNG. They bring two young at a birth, in the month of April, which follow the dam a whole year. During the ſummer they keep in families. In deep ſnows they collect in numbers in the foreſts of pines, for protection from the inclemency of the weather under the ſhelter of thoſe ever-greens.

They are very inoffenſive, except in the rutting-ſeaſon; or except they are wounded, when they will turn on the aſſailant, and attack [19] him with their horns, or trample him to death beneath their great hoofs.

Their fleſh is extremely ſweet and nouriſhing. The Indians ſay,FLESH. that they can travel three times as far after a meal of Mooſe, as after any other animal food. The tongues are excellent, but the noſe is perfect marrow, and eſteemed the greateſt delicacy in all Canada.

The ſkin makes excellent buff; is ſtrong, ſoft, and light.SKIN. The Indians dreſs the hide, and, after ſoaking it for ſome time, ſtretch and render it ſupple by a lather of the brains in hot water. They not only make their ſnow-ſhoes of the ſkin, but after a chaſe form the canoes with it: they ſew it neatly together, cover the ſeams with an unctuous earth, and embark in them with their ſpoils to return home*.

The hair on the neck, withers,HAIR. and hams of a full-grown Elk is of much uſe in making mattraſſes and ſaddles; being by its great length well adapted for thoſe purpoſes.

The palmated parts of the horns are farther excavated by the ſavages, and converted into ladles, which will hold a pint.HORNS.

It is not ſtrange that ſo uſeful an animal ſhould be a principal object of chaſe. The ſavages perform it in different ways. The firſt,CHASE. and the more ſimple, is before the lakes or rivers are frozen. Multitudes aſſemble in their canoes, and form with them a vaſt creſcent, each horn touching the ſhore. Another party perform their ſhare of the chaſe among the woods; they ſurround an extenſive tract, let looſe their dogs, and preſs towards the water with loud cries. The animals, alarmed with the noiſe, fly before the hunters, and plunge into the lake, where they are killed by the perſons in the canoes, prepared for their reception, with lances or clubs.

The other method is more artful. The ſavages incloſe a large ſpace with ſtakes hedged with branches of trees, forming two ſides [20] of a triangle: the bottom opens into a ſecond encloſure, completely triangular. At the opening are hung numbers of ſnares, made of ſlips of raw hides. The Indians, as before, aſſemble in great troops, and with all kinds of noiſes drive into the firſt encloſure not only the Mooſes, but the other ſpecies of Deer which abound in that country: ſome, in forcing their way into the fartheſt triangle, are caught in the ſnares by the neck or horns; and thoſe which eſcape the ſnares, and paſs the little opening, find their fate from the arrows of the hunters, directed at them from all quarters*.

They are often killed with the gun. When they are firſt unharboured, they ſquat with their hind parts and make water, at which inſtant the ſportſman fires; if he miſſes, the Mooſe ſets off in a moſt rapid trot, making, like the Rein-deer, a prodigious rattling with its hoofs, and will run for twenty or thirty miles before it comes to bay or takes the water. But the uſual time for this diverſion is the winter. The hunters avoid entering on the chaſe till the ſun is ſtrong enough to melt the frozen cruſt with which the ſnow is covered, otherwiſe the animal can run over the firm ſurface: they wait till it becomes ſoft enough to impede the flight of the Mooſe; which ſinks up to the ſhoulders, flounders, and gets on with great difficulty. The ſportſman purſues at his eaſe on his broad rackets, or ſnow-ſhoes, and makes a ready prey of the diſtreſſed animals,

As weak againſt the mountain heaps they puſh
Their beating breaſt in vain, and piteous bray,
He lays them quivering on th' enſanguin'd ſnows,
And with loud ſhouts rejoicing bears them home.
THOMPSON.

SUPERSTITIONS RELATING TO THE MOOSE.The opinion of this animal's being ſubject to the epilepſy ſeems to have been univerſal, as well as the cure it finds by ſcratching its ear with the hind hoof till it draws blood. That hoof has been uſed in Indian medicine for the falling-ſickneſs; they apply it to the heart of [21] the afflicted, make him hold it in his left hand, and rub his ear with it. They uſe it alſo in the colick, pleuriſy, vertigo, and purple fever; pulveriſing the hoof, and drinking it in water. The Algonkins pretend that the fleſh imparts the diſeaſe; but it is notorious that the hu [...]ers in a manner live on it with impunity.

The ſavages eſteem the Mooſe a beaſt of good omen; and are perſuaded that thoſe who dream often of it may flatter themſelves with long life*.

Their wild ſuperſtition hath figured to them a Mooſe of enormous ſize, which can wade with eaſe through eight feet depth of ſnow; which is invulnerable, and has an arm growing out of its ſhoulder, ſubſervient to the purpoſes of the human: that it has a court of other Mooſes, who at all times perform ſuit and ſervice, according to his royal will.

I lament that I am not able to diſcover the animal which owned the vaſt horns ſo often found in the bogs of Ireland, FOSSIL HORNS NOT BELONGING TO THE MOOSE. ſo long and ſo confidently attributed to the Mooſe. Theſe have been found to be ſometimes eight feet long, fourteen between tip and tip, furniſhed with brow antlers, and weighing three hundred pounds: the whole ſkeleton is frequently found with them.

The fables delivered by Joſſelyn, of the Mooſe being thirty-three hands, or twelve feet, high; and by Le Hontan, of its horns weighing between three and four hundred pounds; occaſioned the naturaliſts of paſt times to call the foſſil horns thoſe of the Mooſe; and to flatter themſelves that they had diſcovered the animal they belonged to: but recent diſcoveries evince the error. I once entertained hopes that the Waſkeſſe § of the Hudſon's Bay Indians was the ſpecies; but by ſome late information I received from Mr. Andrew Graham, factor in the Bay, I find it to be no other than the common Mooſe.

4. REIN. Hiſt. Quad. No 43.—Smellie, vi. 316.—Hackluyt, iii. 114.—LEV. MUS.
[22]

DEER. With large but ſlender horns, bending forward; with brow antlers broad and palmated, ſometimes three feet nine inches long; two feet ſix from tip to tip; weight, nine pounds twelve ounces avoirdupoiſe. The body is thick and ſquare: the legs ſhorter than thoſe of a Stag: the height of a full-grown Rein four feet ſix.

Color of the hair, at firſt ſhedding of the coat, of a browniſh aſh; afterwards changes to a hoary whiteneſs. The animal is admirably guarded againſt the rigor of the climate by the great thickneſs of the hairs, which are ſo cloſely placed as totally to hide the ſkin, even if they are put aſide with ever ſo much care.

Space round the eyes always black: noſe, tail, and belly white: above the hoofs a white circle: hair along the lower ſide of the neck very long: tail ſhort.

Hoofs, and falſe hoofs, long and black; the laſt looſely hung, making a prodigious clatter when the animal runs.

FEMALE.The female is furniſhed with horns; but leſſer, broader, and flatter, and with fewer branches than thoſe of the male. She has ſix teats, but two are ſpurious and uſeleſs. They bring two young at a time.

PLACE.The habitation of this Deer is ſtill more limited than that of the former, confined to thoſe parts where cold reigns with the utmoſt ſeverity. Its moſt ſouthern reſidence is the northern parts of Canada, bordering on the territories of Hudſon's Bay. HUDSON'S-BAY. Charlevoix mentions a ſingle inſtance of one wandering as far as the neighborhood of Quebec V. 191.. Their true place is the vaſt tract which ſurrounds the [23] Bay. They are met with in Labrador, and again in Newfoundland, LABRADOR. NEWFOUNDLAND. originally wafted thither acroſs the narrow ſtraits of Belleiſle, on iſlands of ice.

They ſpread northerly into Greenland, GREENLAND. particularly on the weſtern coaſt, about Diſko *. I can find no traces (even traditional) of them in Iceland; which is the more ſurprizing, as that iſland lies nearer to Greenland than Newfoundland does to the Labrador coaſt. It is probable that they were deſtroyed in very early times, when that iſland was ſo infinitely more populous than it is at preſent; and the farther migration of theſe animals prevented by the amazing aggregate of ice, which in later ages blocked up and even depopulated the eaſtern ſide of Greenland. No vegetable, not even moſs, is to be found on that extenſive coaſt to ſupport theſe hardy animals. Their laſt migration was from the weſtern parts of Greenland, over unknown regions and fields of ice, to the inhoſpitable Alps of Spitzbergen. SPITZBERGEN. Theſe, with the Polar Bear and Arctic Fox, form the ſhort catalogue of its quadrupeds. They reſide there throughout the year; and by wondrous inſtinct do diſcover their food, the lichen rangiferinus, beneath the ſnow, which they remove to great depths by means of their broad and ſpade-like antlers; and thus find ſubſiſtence thirteen degrees beyond the Arctic circle.

To the weſtern ſide of Hudſon's Bay I trace the Rein as far as the nation called Les Plat-coté des Chiens , the remoteſt we are acquainted with in the parallel of that latitude. Beyond, are lands unknown, till we arrive at that new-diſcovered chain of iſlands, which extends to within a ſmall diſtance of Aſia, or the northern cape of Kamtſchatka, KAMTSCHATKA. where I again recover theſe animals. There is reaſon to imagine that they are continued acroſs the continent of America, but not on the iſlands which intervene between it and Aſia . But in the [24] iſle of Kadjak, and others of the eaſternmoſt Fox iſlands, the inhabitants have ſkins of them from the American continent, and border their bonnets with the white hairs of the domeſtic Rein-deers, ſtained red. They are found again in the countries which border on the Icy ſea*; from which they retire, at approach of winter, towards the woods, to feed on the moſs, not only that which grows on the ground, but the ſpecies pendulous from the trees. The whole north-eaſt of Sibiria abounds with them. They alſo are yet found wild in the Urallian mountains; along the river Kama, as far as Kungus; and about ſome ſnowy ſummits more ſouth: and again on the high chain bordering on Sibiria on the ſouth, and about lake Baikal. Towards the weſt they are continued in the land of the Samoieds; SAMOIEDEA. and finally among the well-known Laplanders. I here tranſgreſs the limits of my plan, to give a ſlight comparative view of the progreſs of civilization among the inhabitants of theſe frozen climes.

LAPLANDERS, THEIR USES OF IT.With the Laplanders this animal is the ſubſtitute to the Horſe, the Cow, the Sheep, and the Goat. Thoſe moſt innocent of people have, even under their rigorous ſky, ſome of the charms of a paſtoral life. They have ſubdued theſe animals to various uſes, and reclamed them from their wild ſtate. They attend their herds of Rein-deer, during ſummer, to the ſummits of their alps; to the ſides of their clear lakes and ſtreams, often bordered with native roſes. They know the arts of the dairy, milk theſe their cattle, and make from it a rich cheeſe. They train them to the ſledge, conſider them as their chief treaſure, and cheriſh them with the utmoſt tenderneſs.

SAMOIEDS.The brutiſh Samoied conſiders them in no other view than as animals of draught, to convey them to the chaſe of the wild Reins; which they kill for the ſake of the ſkins, either to cloath themſelves, or to cover their tents. They know not the cleanly delicacy of the milk or cheeſe; but prefer for their repaſt the inteſtines of beaſts, or the half-putrid fleſh of a horſe, ox, or ſheep, which they find dead on the high road.

[25]The Koreki, KOREKI. a nation of Kamtſchatka, may be placed on a level with the Samoieds: they keep immenſe herds of Reins; ſome of the richeſt, to the amount of ten or twenty thouſand; yet ſo ſordid are they as to eat none except ſuch which they kill for the ſake of the ſkins; an article of commerce with their neighbors the Kamtſchatkans: otherwiſe they content themſelves with the fleſh of thoſe which die by diſeaſe or chance. They train them in the ſledge, but neglect them for every domeſtic purpoſe*. Their hiſtorian ſays, they couple two to each carriage; and that the Deer will travel a hundred and fifty verſts in a day, that is, a hundred and twelve Engliſh miles. They caſtrate the males by piercing the ſpermatic arteries, and tying the ſcrotum tight with a thong.

The inhabitants about the river Kolyma make uſe of the ſoft ſkins of the Rein-deer, dreſſed, for ſails for a kind of boat called Schitiki, caulked with moſs; and the boards as if ſewed together with thongs; and the cordage made of ſlices of the ſkin of the ElkMuller's Summary, &c. xviii..

The ſavage and uninformed Eſkimaux and Greenlanders, ESKIMAUX AND GREENLANDERS. who poſſeſs, amidſt their ſnows, theſe beautiful animals, neglect not only the domeſtic uſes, but even are ignorant of their advantage in the ſledge. Their element is properly the water; their game the Seals. They ſeem to want powers to domeſticate any animals unleſs Dogs. They are at enmity with all; conſider them as an object of chaſe, and of no utility till deprived of life. The fleſh of the Rein is the moſt coveted part of their food; they eat it raw, dreſſed, and dried and ſmoked with the ſnow lichen. The wearied hunters will drink the raw blood; but it is uſually dreſſed with the berries of the heath: they eagerly devour the contents of the ſtomach, but uſe the inteſtines boiled. They are very fond of the fat, and will not loſe the leſt bitFaun. Groeul. p. 28.. The ſkin, ſometimes a part of their cloathing, dreſſed with the hair on, is ſoft and pliant; it forms alſo the inner lining of their tents, and moſt [26] excellent blankets. The tendons are their bow-ſtrings, and when ſplit are the threads with which they ſew their jackets*.

The Greenlanders, before they acquired the knowlege of the gun, caught them by what was called the clapper-hunt . The women and children ſurrounded a large ſpace, and, where people were wanting, ſet up poles capped with a turf in certain intervals, to terrify the animals; they then with great noiſe drove the Reins into the narrow defiles, where the men lay in wait and killed them with harpoons or darts. But they are now become very ſcarce.

MULTITUDES IN HUDSON'S BAY.On the contrary, they are found in the neighborhood of Hudſon's Bay in moſt amazing numbers, columns of eight or ten thouſand are ſeen annually paſſing from north to ſouth in the months of March and April , driven out of the woods by the muſketoes, ſeeking refreſhment on the ſhore,MIGRATION. and a quiet place to drop their young. They go to rut in September, and the males ſoon after ſhed their horns; they are at that ſeaſon very fat, but ſo rank and muſky as not to be eatable. The females drop their young in June, in the moſt ſequeſtered ſpots they can find; and then they likewiſe loſe their horns. Beaſts of prey follow the herds: firſt, the Wolves, who ſingle out the ſtragglers (for they fear to attack the drove) detach and hunt them down: the Foxes attend at a diſtance, to pick up the offals left by the former. In autumn the Deer with the Fawns re-migrate northward.

USES.The Indians are very attentive to their motions; for the Rein forms the chief part not only of their dreſs but food. They often kill multitudes for the ſake of their tongues only; but generally they ſeparate the fleſh from the bones, and preſerve it by drying it in the ſmoke: they alſo ſave the fat, and ſell it to the Engliſh in bladders, who uſe it in frying inſtead of butter. The ſkins are alſo an article of commerce, and uſed in London by the Breeches-makers.

CHASE.The Indians ſhoot them in the winter. The Engliſh make hedges, with ſtakes and boughs of trees, along the woods, for five miles in [27] length, leaving openings at proper intervals beſet with ſnares, in which multitudes are taken.

The Indians alſo kill great numbers during the ſeaſons of migration, watching in their canoes, and ſpearing them while paſſing over the rivers of the country, or from iſland to iſland; for they ſwim moſt admirably well.

Hiſt. Quad. No 45.—Smellie iv. 74.—LEV. MUS.5. STAG.

DEER. With long upright horns much branched: ſlender and ſharp brow antlers: color a reddiſh brown: belly and lower ſide of the tail white: the horns often ſuperior in ſize to thoſe of the European Stags, ſome being above four feet high, and thirty pounds in weight.

Inhabits Canada, particularly the vaſt foreſts about the lakes; are ſeen in great numbers grazing with the Buffaloes on the rich ſavannas bordering on the Miſſiſſipi, the Miſſouri, and other American rivers; they are alſo found within our Colonies, but their numbers decreaſe as population gains ground. An Indian living in 1748 had killed many Stags on the ſpot where Philadelphia now ſtands*.

They feed eagerly on the broad-leaved Kalmia; yet that plant is a poiſon to all other horned animals; their inteſtines are found filled with it during winter. If their entrails are given to Dogs, they become ſtupified, and as if drunk, and often are ſo ill as hardly to eſcape with life.

Stags are alſo found in Mexico, where they are called Aculliame: they differ not from thoſe of Spain in ſhape, ſize, or nature. South America is deſtitute of theſe animals: they can bear the extremes of heat but not of cold. They are found neither in Hudſon's Bay, [28] Kamtſchatka, nor in any country inhabited by the Rein—a line in a manner ſeparates them.

Their ſkins are an article of commerce imported * by the Hudſon's Bay company; but brought from the diſtant parts far inland by the Indians, who bring them from the neighborhood of the lakes. In moſt parts of North America they are called the Grey Mooſe, and the Elk; this has given occaſion to the miſtaken notion of that great animal being found in Virginia, and other ſouthern provinces.

The Stags of America grow very fat: their tallow is much eſteemed for making of candles. The Indians ſhoot them. As they are very ſhy animals, the natives cover themſelves with a hide, leaving the horns erect; under ſhelter of which they walk within reach of the herd. De Brie, in the xxvth plate of the Hiſtory of Florida, gives a very curious repreſentation of this artful method of chaſe, when it was viſited by the French in 1564.

Stags are totally extirpated in Ruſſia, but abound in the mountanous ſouthern tract of Sibiria, where they grow to a ſize far ſuperior to what is known in Europe. The height of a grown Hind is four feet nine inches and a half, its length eight feet; that of its head one foot eight inches and a half.

The ſpecies ceaſes in the north-eaſtern parts of Sibiria, nor are any found in Kamtſchatka.

6. VIRGINIAN. Hiſt. Quad. No 46.—LEV. MUS.

DEER. With round and ſlender horns, bending greatly forward; numerous branches on the interior ſides: deſtitute of brow antlers: color of the body a cinereous brown: head of a deep brown: belly, ſides, ſhoulders, and thighs, white, mottled with brown: tail [29] ten inches long, of a duſky color: feet of a yellowiſh brown. Are not ſo well haunched as the Engliſh Buck, and are leſs active*.

Inhabits all the provinces ſouth of Canada, PLACE. but in greateſt abundance in the ſouthern; but eſpecially the vaſt ſavannas contiguous to the Miſſiſipi, and the great rivers which flow into it. They graze in herds innumerable, along with the Stags and Buffaloes. This ſpecies probably extends to Guiana, and is the Baieu of that country, which is ſaid to be about the ſize of a European Buck, with ſhort horns, bending at their ends.

They are capable of being made tame; and when properly trained, are uſed by the Indians to decoy the wild Deer (eſpecially in the rutting ſeaſon) within ſhot. Both Bucks and Does herd from September to March; after that they ſeparate, and the Does ſecrete themſelves to bring forth, and are found with difficulty. The Bucks from this time keep ſeparate, till the amorous ſeaſon of September revolves. The Deer begin to feed as ſoon as night begins; and ſometimes, in the rainy ſeaſon, in the day: otherwiſe they ſeldom or never quit their haunts. An old Americam ſportſman has remarked, that the Bucks will keep in the thickets for a year, or even two.

Theſe animals are very reſtleſs, and always in motion, coming and going continually§. Thoſe which live near the ſhores are lean and bad, ſubject to worms in their heads and throats, generated from the eggs depoſited in thoſe parts. Thoſe that frequent the hills and ſavannas are in better caſe, but the veniſon is dry. In hard winters they will feed on the long moſs which hangs from the trees in the northern parts.

Theſe and other cloven-footed quadrupeds of America are very fond of ſalt, and reſort eagerly to the places impregnated with it.FOND OF SALT. They are always ſeen in great numbers in the ſpots where the ground [30] has been torn by torrents or other accidents, where they are ſeen licking the earth. Such ſpots are called licking-places. The huntſmen are ſure of finding the game there; for, notwithſtanding they are often diſturbed, the Buffaloes and Deer are ſo paſſionately fond of the ſavory regale, as to bid defiance to all danger, and return in droves to theſe favorite haunts.

The ſkins are a great article of commerce, 25,027 being imported from New-York and Penſylvania in the ſale of 1764.

The Deer are of the firſt importance to the Savages. The ſkins form the greateſt branch of their traffick, by which they procure from the coloniſts, by way of exchange, many of the articles of life. To all of them it is the principal food throughout the year; for by drying it over a gentle but clear fire, after cutting it into ſmall pieces, it is not only capable of long preſervation, but is very portable in their ſudden excurſions, eſpecially when reduced to powder, which is frequently done.

Hunting is more than an amuſement to theſe people. They give themſelves up to it not only for the ſake of ſubſiſtence, but to ſit themſelves for war, by habituating themſelves to fatigue. A good huntſman is an able warrior. Thoſe who fail in the ſports of the field are never ſuppoſed to be capable of ſupporting the hardſhips of a campaign; they are degraded to ignoble offices, ſuch as dreſſing the ſkins of Deer, and other employs allotted only to ſlaves and women.

When a large party meditates a hunting-match, which is uſually at the beginning of winter, they agree on a place of rendezvous, often five hundred miles diſtant from their homes, and a place, perhaps, that many of them had never been at. They have no other method of fixing on the ſpot than by pointing with their finger. The preference is given to the eldeſt, as the moſt experienced.

[31]When this matter is ſettled, they ſeparate into ſmall parties, travel and hunt for ſubſiſtence all the day, and reſt at night; but the women have no certain reſting-places. The Savages have their particular hunting countries; but if they invade the limits of thoſe belonging to other nations, feuds enſue, fatal as thoſe between Percy and Douglas in the famed Chevy Chace.

As ſoon as they arrive on the borders of the hunting country, (which they never fail doing to a man, be their reſpective routes ever ſo diſtant or ſo various) the captain of the band delineates on the bark of a tree his own figure, with a Rattleſnake twined round him with diſtended mouth; and in his hand a bloody tomahawk. By this he implies a deſtructive menace to any who are bold enough to invade their territories, or to interrupt their diverſion*.

The chaſe is carried on in different ways. Some ſurpriſe the Deer by uſing the ſtale of the head, horns, and hide, in the manner before mentioned: but the general method is performed by the whole body. Several hundreds diſperſe in a line, encompaſſing a vaſt ſpace of country, fire the woods, and drive the animals into ſome ſtrait or peninſula, where they become an eaſy prey. The Deer alone are not the object; Foxes, Raccoons, Bears, and all beaſts of fur, are thought worthy of attention, and articles of commerce with the Europeans.

The number of Deer deſtroyed in ſome parts of America is incredible; as is pretended, from an abſurd idea which the Savages have, that the more they deſtroy, the more they ſhall find in ſucceeding years. Certain it is that multitudes are deſtroyed; the tongues only preſerved, and the carcaſes left a prey to wild beaſts. But the motive is much more political. The Savages well diſcern, that ſhould they overſtock the market, they would certainly be over-reached by the European dealers, who take care never to produce more goods than are barely ſufficient for the demand of the ſeaſon, eſtabliſhing their prices according to the quantity of furs brought by the natives. The hunters live in their quarters with the utmoſt feſtivity, and indulgence [32] in all the luxuries of the country. The chaſe rouzes their appetites; they are perpetually eating, and will even riſe to obey, at midnight, the calls of hunger. Their viands are exquiſite. Veniſon boiled with red peaſe; turkies barbecued and eaten with bears fat; fawns cut out of the does belly, and boiled in the native bag; fiſh, and crayfiſh, taken in the next ſtream; dried peaches, and other fruits, form the chief of their good living*. Much of this food is carminative: they give looſe to the effects, and (reverſe to the cuſtom of the delicate Arabs ) laugh moſt heartily on the occaſion.

They bring along with them their wives and miſtreſſes: not that they pay any great reſpect to the fair. They make (like the Cathneſians) errant pack-horſes of them, loading them with proviſions, or the ſkins of the chaſe; or making them provide fire-wood. Love is not the paſſion of a Savage, at leſt it is as brief with them as with the animals they purſue.

7. MEXICAN.Mexican Roe? Hiſt. Quad. No 52.—Smellie, iv. 136.

DEER. With horns near nine inches long, meaſuring by the curvature; and near nine inches between tip and tip, and two inches diſtant between the baſes. About an inch and a half from the bottom is one ſharp erect ſnag. This, and the lower parts of the horns, are very rough, ſtrong, and ſcabrous. The upper parts bend forwards over the baſes; are ſmooth, flatted, and broad, dividing into three ſharp ſnags. Color of the hair like the European Roe; but while young are rayed with white. In ſize ſomewhat ſuperior to the European Roe.

Inhabits Mexico ; probably extends to the interior north-weſtern parts of America, and may prove the Scenoontung or Squinaton, deſcribed as being leſs than a Buck and larger than a Roe, but very like it, and of an elegant form§.

Hiſt. Quad. No 51.—Smellie, iv. 120.—LEV. MUS.7. ROE.
[33]

DEER. With upright, round, rugged horns, trifurcated: hairs tawny at their ends, grey below: rump and under-ſide of the tail white. Length near four feet: tail only an inch.

According to Charlevoix, they are found in great numbers in Canada. He ſays they differ not from the European kind: are eaſily domeſticated. The Does will retreat into the woods to bring forth, and return to their maſter with their young*. They extend far weſt. If Piſo's figure may be depended on, they are found in Brazil ; are frequent in Europe; and inhabit as high as Sweden and Norway §; is unknown in Ruſſia.

A. TAIL-LESS ROE, Hiſt. Quad. p. 109.

In its ſtead is a larger variety: with horns like the laſt, and color the ſame; only a great bed of white covers the rump, and extends ſome way up the back: no tail, only a broad cutaneous excreſcence around the anus.

Inhabits all the temperate parts of Ruſſia and Sibiria, and extends as far to the north as the Elk. Deſcends to the open plains in the winter. The Tartars call it Saiga: the Ruſſians Dikaja Roza.

B. FALLOW DEER, Hiſt. Quad. No 44.

Are animals impatient of cold: are unknown in the Ruſſian empire, except by importation: and are preſerved in parks in Sweden . The Engliſh tranſlator of Pontoppidan mentions them (perhaps erroneouſly) among the deer of Norway.

MUSK. Hiſt. Quad. GENUS X.
[34]
A. TIBET M. Hiſt. Quad. No 54.—Moſchus, Pallas Sp. Zool. faſc. xiii. LEV. MUS.

MUSK. With very ſharp ſlender white tuſks on each ſide of the upper jaw, hanging out far below the under jaw: ears rather large: neck thick: hair on the whole body long, upright, and thick ſet; each hair undulated; tips ferruginous; beneath them black; the bottoms cinereous: on each ſide of the front of the neck is a white line edged with black, meeting at the cheſt; another croſſes that beneath the throat: limbs very ſlender, and of a full black: tail very ſhort, and ſcarcely viſible. The female wants the tuſks and the muſk-bag.

The muſk-bag is placed on the belly, almoſt between the thighs. A full-grown male will yield a drachm and a half of muſk; an old one two drachms.

SIZE.The length of the male is two feet eleven; of the female, two feet three. The weight of a male from twenty-five to thirty pounds, Troy weight: of an old female, from thirty to thirty-five; but ſome young ones do not exceed eighteen.

PLACE.Inhabits Aſia, from lat. 20 to 60, or from the kingdoms of Laos and Tong-King, between India and China, and through the kingdom of Tibet * as high as Mangaſea. The river Jeneſei is its weſtern boundary, and it extends eaſtward as far as lake Baikal, and about the rivers Lena and Witim; but gradually narrows the extent of its reſidence as it approaches the tropic. Lives on the higheſt and rudeſt mountains, amidſt the ſnows, or in the fir-woods which lie between them: goes uſually ſolitary, except in autumn, when they collect in flocks to change their place: are exceſſively active, and take amazing [35] leaps over the tremendous chaſms of their alps, or from rock to rock: tread ſo light on the ſnow, with their true and falſe hoofs extended, as ſcarcely to leave a mark; while the dogs which purſue them ſink in, and are forced to deſiſt from the chaſe: are ſo fond of liberty as never to be kept alive in captivity. They feed on lichens, arbutus, rhododendron, and whortleberry-plants. Their chaſe is moſt laborious: they are taken in ſnares; or ſhot by croſs-bows placed in their tracks, with a ſtring from the trigger for them to tread on and diſcharge. The Tunguſi ſhoot them with bows and arrows. The ſkins are uſed for bonnets and winter dreſſes. The Ruſſians often ſcrape off the hair, and have a way of preparing them for ſummer cloathing, ſo as to become as ſoft and ſhining as ſilk.

The two other hoofed animals of the north of Aſia, CAMEL. the Two-bunched Camel, and the Wild Boar, do not reach as high as lat. 60: the firſt is found in great troops about lake Baikal, as far as lat. 56 or 57; but if brought as high as Jakutſk, beyond lat. 60, periſh with cold*.WILD BOAR. The Wild Boar is common in all the reedy marſhes of Tartary and Sibiria, and the mountanous foreſts about lake Baikal, almoſt to lat. 55; but none in the north-eaſtern extremity of Sibiria.

DIV. II. DIGITATED QUADRUPEDS. SECT. I. With CANINE TEETH.
[38] DIV. II. Digitated Quadrupeds.

[]
SECT I. With CANINE TEETH. Rapacious, Carnivorous.
DOG. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XVII.
9. WOLF. Hiſt. Quad. No 137.—Smellie, iv. 196.—LEV. MUS.

DOG. With a long head: pointed noſe: ears ſharp and erect: legs long: tail buſhy, bending down: hair pretty long. Color uſually of a pale brown, mixed with dull yellow and black.

Inhabits the interior countries ſouth of Hudſon's Bay; and from thence all America, as low as Florida. There are two varieties, a greater and a leſſer. The firſt uſually confines itſelf to the colder parts. The latter is not above fifteen inches high*. In the more uninhabited parts of the country, they go in great droves, and hunt the deer like a pack of hounds, and make a hideous noiſe. They will attack the Buffalo; but only venture on the ſtragglers. In the unfrequented parts of America are very tame, and will come near the few habitations in hopes of finding ſomething to eat. They are often ſo very poor and hungry, for want of prey, as to go into a ſwamp and fill themſelves with mud, which they will diſgorge as ſoon as they can get any food.

COLOR.The Wolves towards Hudſon's Bay are of different colors; grey and white; and ſome black and white, the black hairs being mixed with the white chiefly along the back. In Canada they have been found entirely black. They are taken in the northern parts in log-traps, or by ſpring-guns; their ſkins being an article of commerce.

In the LEVERIAN muſeum is the head and ſcull of a wolf: duſky and brown, formed by the natives into a helmet. The protection [39] of the head was the natural and firſt thought of mankind; and the ſpoils of beaſts were the firſt things that offered. Hercules ſeized on the ſkin of the Lion: the Americans, and ancient Latians that of the Wolf.

Fulvoſque Lupi de pelle galeros
Tegmen habet capiti.

Wolves are now ſo rare in the populated parts of America, that the inhabitants leave their ſheep the whole night unguarded: yet the governments of Penſylvania and New Jerſey did ſome years ago allow a reward of twenty ſhillings, and the laſt even thirty ſhillings, for the killing of every Wolf. Tradition informed them what a ſcourge thoſe animals had been to the colonies; ſo they wiſely determined to prevent the like evil. In their infant ſtate, wolves came down in multitudes from the mountains, often attracted by the ſmell of the corpſes of hundreds of Indians who died of the ſmall-pox, brought among them by the Europeans: but the animals did not confine their inſults to the dead, but even devoured in their huts the ſick and dying Savages*.

The Wolf is capable of being in ſome degree tamed and domeſticated. It was, at the firſt arrival of the Europeans, Doe. and is ſtill in many places, the Dog of the Americans . It ſtill betrays its ſavage deſcent, by uttering only a howl inſtead of the ſignificant bark of the genuine Dog. This half-reclamed breed wants the ſagacity of our faithful attendant; and is of little farther uſe in the chaſe, than in frightening the wild beaſts into the ſnares or traps,

The Kamtſchatkans, Eſkimaux, and Greenlanders, ſtrangers to the ſofter virtues, treat theſe poor animals with great neglect. The former, during ſummer, the ſeaſon in which they are uſeleſs, turn them looſe to provide for themſelves; and recall them in October into their uſual confinement and labor: from that time till ſpring they [40] are fed with fiſh-bones and opana, i. e. putrid fiſh preſerved in pits, and ſerved up to them mixed with hot water. Thoſe uſed for draught are caſtrated; and four, yoked to the carriage, will draw five poods, or a hundred and ninety Engliſh pounds, beſides the driver; and thus loaden, will travel thirty verſts, or twenty miles, a day; or if unloaden, on hardened ſnow, on ſliders of bone, a hundred and fifty verſts, or a hundred Engliſh miles*.

It is pretty certain that the Kamtſchatkan Dogs are of wolfiſh deſcent; for Wolves abound in that country, in all parts of Sibiria, and even under the Arctic circle. If their maſter is flung out of his ſledge, they want the affectionate fidelity of the European kind, and leave him to follow, never ſtopping till the ſledge is overturned, or elſe ſtopped by ſome impediment. I am alſo ſtrengthened in my opinion by the ſtrong rage they have for the purſuit of deer, if on the journey they croſs the ſcent; when the maſter finds it very difficult to make them purſue their way.

The great traveller of the thirteenth century, Marco Polo, had knowlege of this ſpecies of conveyance from the merchants who went far north to traffic for the precious furs. He deſcribes the ſledges; adds, that they were drawn by ſix great dogs; and that they changed them and the ſledges on the road, as we do at preſent in going poſt.

The Kamtſchatkans make uſe of the ſkins of dogs for cloathing, and the long hair for ornament: ſome nations are fond of them as a food; and reckon a fat dog a great delicacy§. Both the Aſiatic and American Savages uſe theſe animals in ſacrifices to their gods, to beſpeak favor, or avert evil. When the Koreki dread any infection, [41] they kill a dog, wind the inteſtines round two poles, and paſs between them.

The Greenlanders are not better maſters.GREENLAND. They leave their dogs to feed on muſſels or berries; unleſs in a great capture of ſeals, when they treat them with the blood and garbage. Theſe people alſo ſometimes eat their dogs: uſe the ſkins for coverlets, for cloathing, or to border and ſeam their habits: and their beſt thread is made of the guts.

The Dogs in general are large; and, in the frigid parts it leſt, have the appearance of Wolves: are uſually white, with a black face; ſometimes varied with black and white, ſometimes all white; rarely brown, or all black: have ſharp noſes, thick hair, and ſhort ears: and ſeldom bark; but ſet up a ſort of growl, or ſavage howl. They ſleep abroad; and make a lodge in the ſnow, lying with only their noſes out. They ſwim moſt excellently: and will hunt, in packs, the ptarmigan, arctic fox, polar bear, and ſeals lying on the ice. The natives ſometimes uſe them in the chaſe of the bear. They are exceſſively fierce; and, like wolves, inſtantly fly on the few domeſtic animals introduced into Greenland. They will fight among themſelves, even to death. Canine madneſs is unknown in Greenland *. They are to the natives in the place of horſes: the Greenlanders faſten to their ſledges from four to ten; and thus make their viſits in ſavage ſtate, or bring home the animals they have killed. Egede ſays that they will travel over the ice fifteen German miles in a day, or ſixty Engliſh, with ſledges loaden with their maſters and five or ſix large ſeals.

Thoſe of the neighboring iſland of Iceland have a great reſemblance to them. As to thoſe of Newfoundland, ICELAND. it is not certain that there is any diſtinct breed: moſt of them are curs, with a croſs of the maſtiff: ſome will, and others will not, take the water, abſolutely refuſing to go in. The country was found uninhabited, which makes it more probable that they were introduced by the Europeans; [42] who uſe them, as the factory does in Hudſon's Bay, to draw firing from the woods to the forts.

The Savages who trade to Hudſon's Bay make uſe of the wolfiſh kind to draw their furs.

It is ſingular, that the race of European Dogs ſhew as ſtrong an antipathy to this American ſpecies, as they do to the Wolf itſelf. They never meet with them, but they ſhew all poſſible ſigns of diſlike, and will fall on and worry them; while the wolfiſh breed, with every mark of timidity, puts its tail between its legs, and runs from the rage of the others. This averſion to the Wolf is natural to all genuine Dogs: for it is well known that a whelp, which has never ſeen a wolf, will at firſt ſight tremble, and run to its maſter for protection: an old dog will inſtantly attack it.

I ſhall conclude this article with an abſtract of a letter from Dr. Pallas, dated October 5th 1781; in which he gives the following confirmation of the mixed breed of theſe animals and Dogs.

I have ſeen at Moſcow about twenty ſpurious animals from dogs and black wolves. They are for the moſt part like wolves, except that ſome carry their tails higher, and have a kind of coarſe barking. They multiply among themſelves: and ſome of the whelps are greyiſh, ruſty, or even of the whitiſh hue of the Arctic wolves: and one of thoſe I ſaw, in ſhape, tail, and hair, and even in barking, ſo like a cur, that, was it not for his head and ears, his ill-natured look, and fearfulneſs at the approach of man, I ſhould hardly have believed that it was of the ſame breed.
10. ARCTIC.Arctic Fox, Hiſt. Quad. No —LEV. MUS.

DOG. With a ſharp noſe: ears almoſt hid in the fur, ſhort and rounded: hair long, ſoft, and ſilky: legs ſhort: toes covered above and below with very thick and ſoft fur: tail ſhorter than that of the common Fox, and more buſhy.

Inferior in ſize to the common Fox: color a blueiſh-grey, and [43] ſometimes white. The young, before they come to maturity, duſky. The hair, as uſual in cold regions, grows much thicker and longer in winter than ſummer.

Theſe animals are found only in the Arctic regions, a few degrees within and without the Polar circle. They inhabit Spitzbergen, Greenland, and Iceland *: are only migratory in Hudſon's Bay, once in four or five years: are found again in Bering's and Copper Iſle, next to it; but in none beyond: in Kamtſchatka, and all the countries bordering on the frozen ſea, which ſeems their great reſidence; comprehending a woodleſs tract of heath land, generally from 70 to 65 degrees lat. They abound in Nova Zembla : are found in Cherry iſland, midway between Finmark and Spitzbergen §, to which they muſt have been brought on iſlands of ice; for it lies above four degrees north of the firſt, and three ſouth of the laſt: and laſtly, in the bare mountains between Lapland and Norway.

They are the hardieſt of animals, and even in Spitzbergen and Nova Zembla prowl out for prey during the ſeverity of winter. They live on the young wild geeſe, and all kind of water-fowl; on their eggs; on hares, or any leſſer animals; and in Greenland, (through neceſſity) on berries, ſhell-fiſh, or whatſoever the ſea throws up. But in the north of Aſia, and in Lapland, their principal food is the Lemings . The Arctic foxes of thoſe countries are as migratory as thoſe little animals; and when the laſt make their great migrations, the latter purſue them in vaſt troops. But ſuch removals are not only uncertain, but long: dependent on thoſe of the Leming. The Foxes will at times deſert their native countries for three or four years, probably as long as they can find any prey. The people of Jeniſea imagine, that the wanderers from their parts go to the banks of the Oby.

[44]Thoſe found on Bering's and Copper iſles were probably brought from the Aſiatic ſide on floating ice: Steller having ſeen in the remoter iſlands only the black and brown foxes: and the ſame only on the continent of America. They burrow in the earth, and form holes many feet in length; ſtrewing the bottom with moſs. But in Spitzbergen and Greenland, where the ground is eternally frozen, they live in the cliffs of rocks: two or three inhabit the ſame hole. They ſwim well, and often croſs from iſland to iſland in ſearch of prey. They are in heat about Lady-day; and during that time continue in the open air: after that, retreat to their earths. Like dogs, continue united in copulation: bark like them: for which reaſon the Ruſſians call them Peſzti. They couple in Greenland in March, and again in May; and bring forth in April and in June *.

They are tame and inoffenſive animals; and ſo ſimple, that there are inſtances of their ſtanding by when the trap was baiting, and inſtantly after putting their heads into it. They are killed for the ſake of their ſkins, both in Aſia and Hudſon's Bay: the fur is light and warm, but not durable. Mr. Graham informed me, that they have appeared in ſuch numbers about the fort, that he has taken, in different ways, four hundred from December to March. He likewiſe aſſured me, that the tips of their tails are always black; thoſe of the common foxes always white: and that he never could trace the breeding-places of the former.

The Greenlanders take them either in pitfalls dug in the ſnow, and baited with the Capelin fiſh; or in ſprings made with whale-bone, laid over a hole made in the ſnow, ſtrewed over at bottom with the ſame kind of fiſh; or in traps made like little huts, with flat ſtones, with a broad one by way of door, which falls down (by means of a ſtring baited on the inſide with a piece of fleſh) whenever the fox enters and pulls at it. The Greenlanders preſerve the ſkins for traffic; and in caſes of neceſſity eat the fleſh. They alſo make [45] buttons of the ſkins: and ſplit the tendons, and make uſe of them inſtead of thread. The blue furs are much more eſteemed than the white.

European Fox, Hiſt. Quad. No 139.—Smellie, iv. 214.—LEV. MUS.11. EUROPEAN.

DOG. With a pointed noſe: pointed erect ears: body of a tawny red, mixed with aſh-color: fore part of the legs black: tail long and buſhy, tipt with white.

Inhabits the northern parts of North America from Hudſon's Bay, probably acroſs the continent to the iſlands intermediate between America and Kamtſchatka. Captain Bering ſaw there five quite tame, being unuſed to the ſight of man.

This ſpecies gradually decreaſes to the ſouthward, in numbers and in ſize: none are found lower than Penſylvania. They are ſuppoſed not to have been originally natives of that country. The Indians believe they came from the north of Europe in an exceſſive hard winter, when the ſeaſon was frozen. The truth ſeems to be, that they were driven in ſome ſevere ſeaſon from the north of their own country, and have continued there ever ſince. They abound about Hudſon's Bay, the Labrador country, and in Newfoundland and Canada; and are found in Iceland *. They burrow as the European foxes do; and in Hudſon's Bay, during winter, run about the woods in ſearch of prey, feeding on birds and leſſer animals, particularly mice.

New England is ſaid to have been early ſtocked with foxes by a gentleman who imported them from England, for the pleaſure of the chaſe; and that the preſent breed ſprung from the occaſion. This ſpecies is reckoned among the pernicious animals, and, being very deſtructive to lambs, are proſcribed at the rate of two ſhillings a head.

The variety of Britiſh fox, with a black tip to the tail, ſeems unknown in America.

[46]The ſkins are a great article of commerce: abundance are imported annually from Hudſon's Bay and Newfoundland. The natives of Hudſon's Bay eat the fleſh, rank as is it is.

This ſpecies abounds in Kamtſchatka, and is the fineſt red fur of any known: grows ſcarce within the Arctic circle of the Aſiatic regions, and is found there often white.

α BLACK.THIS variety is found very often entirely black, with a white tip to the tail; and is far inferior in value and beauty to thoſe of Kamtſchatka and Sibiria, where a ſingle ſkin ſells for four hundred rubles.

The beſt in North America are found on the Labrador ſide of Hudſon's Bay. They are alſo very common on the iſlands oppoſite to Kamtſchatka. The American black foxes, which I have examined, are frequently of a mixed color: from the hind part of the head to the middle of the back is a broad black line: the tail, legs, and belly, black: the hairs on the face, ſides, and lower part of the back, cinereous; their upper ends; black the tip white.

β CROSS.FOX. With a bed of black running along the top of the back, croſſed by another paſſing down each ſhoulder; from whence it took the name. The belly is black: the color of the reſt of the body varies in different ſkins; but in all is a mixture of black, cinereous, and yellow: the fur in all very ſoft: and the tail very buſhy and full of hair; for nature, in the rigorous climate of the North, is ever careful to guard the extremities againſt the injury of cold.

This is likewiſe a very valuable variety. It is remarked, that the more deſireable the fur is, the more cunning and difficult to be taken is the fox which owns it*. The Coſſacks quartered in Kamtſchatka have attempted for two winters to catch a ſingle black fox. The Croſs-fox, vulpes crucigera of Geſner, and Kors-raef of the Swedes , is found in all the Polar countries.

[47]In the new-diſcovered Fox iſlands theſe animals abound: one in three or four are found entirely black, and larger than any in Sibiria: the tail alſo is tipt with white. But as they live among the rocks, there being no woods in thoſe iſlands, their hair is almoſt as coarſe as that of the Wolf, and of little value compared to the Sibirian.

Brant Fox, Hiſt. Quad. p. 235.γ BRANT.

FOX. With a very ſharp and black noſe: ſpace round the ears ferruginous: forehead, back, ſhoulders, ſides, and thighs, red, cinereous, and black: the aſh-color predominates, which gives it a hoary look: belly yellowiſh: tail black above, cinereous on the ſides, red beneath.

About half the ſize of the common fox. Deſcribed from one Mr. Brooks received from Penſylvania, under the name of Brandt-fox; but it had not that bright redneſs to merit the name of either Brandt-fuchſe, or Brand-raef, given by Geſner and Linnaeus.

Corſak Fox, Hiſt. Quad. p. 236.δ CORSAK.

FOX. With upright ears: yellowiſh-green irides: throat white: color, in ſummer, pale tawny; in winter, cinereous: middle of the tail cinereous; baſe and tip black; the whole very full of hair: the fur is coarſer and ſhorter than that of the common fox.

I diſcovered this ſpecies among the drawings of the late Taylor White, Eſq who informed me that it came from North America. I imagine, from Hudſon's Bay.

This ſpecies is very common in the hilly and temperate parts of Tartary, from the Don to the Amur; but never is found in woody places: it burrows deep beneath the ſurface. It is alſo ſaid to inhabit the banks of the rivers Indigiſky and Anadyr, where the hills grow bare. In the reſt of Sibiria it is only known beyond lake Baikal; and from ſkins brought by the Kirghiſian and Bucharian traders. In Ruſſia it is found in the deſarts towards Crimea and Aſtracan, and alſo on the ſouthern end of the Urallian mountains.

12. GREY.Grey Fox, Hiſt. Quad. No 142.
[48]

FOX. With a ſharp noſe: long ſharp upright ears: long legs: color entirely grey, except a little redneſs about the ears.

Inhabits from New England to the ſouthern end of North America; but are far more numerous in the ſouthern colonies. They have not the rank ſmell of the red foxes. They are alſo leſs active, and grow very fat*. They breed in hollow trees: give no diverſion to the ſportſmen, for aſter a mile's chaſe they run up a tree. They feed on birds; are deſtructive to poultry; but never deſtroy lambs. The ſkins are uſed to line clothes: the fur is in great requeſt among the hatters. The greaſe is reckoned efficacious in rheumatic diſorders.

13. SILVERY.Silvery Fox, Hiſt. Quad. No 143.

FOX. With a fine and thick coat of a deep brown color, ove [...] ſpread with long ſilvery hairs of a moſt elegant appearance.

Inhabits Louiſiana, where their holes are ſeen in great abundance on the woody heights. As they live in foreſts, which abound in game, they never moleſt the poultry, ſo are ſuffered to run at large§.

They differ ſpecifically from the former, more by their nature in burrowing, than in colors.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XIX.CAT.
[49]
Hiſt. Quad. No 160.—Smellie, v. 197. 200.—LEV. MUS.14. PUMA.

CAT. With a ſmall head: large eyes: ears a little pointed: chin white: back, neck, ſides, and rump, of a pale browniſh red, mixed with duſky hairs: breaſt, belly, and inſide of the legs, cinereous: tail a mixture of duſky and ferruginous, the tip black.

The teeth of a vaſt ſize: claws whitiſh; the outmoſt claw of the fore feet much larger than the reſt: the body very long: the legs high and ſtrong. The length of that I examined was five feet three from head to tail; of the tail, two feet eight.

Inhabits the continent of North America, from Canada to Florida; and the ſpecies is continued from thence low into South America, through Mexico, Guiana, Braſil, and the province of Quito, in Peru, where it is called Puma, and by the Europeans miſtaken for a Lion: it is, by reaſon of its fierceneſs, the ſcourge of the country. The different climate of North America ſeems to have ſubdued its rage, and rendered it very fearful of mankind: the leſt cur, in company with his maſter, will make it run up a tree*, which is the opportunity of ſhooting it. It proves, if not killed outright, a dangerous enemy; for it will deſcend, and attack either man or beaſt. The fleſh is white, and reckoned very good. The Indians uſe the ſkin for winter habits; and when dreſſed is made into ſhoes for women, and gloves for men.

It is called in North America the Panther, and is the moſt pernicious animal of that continent. Lives in the foreſts. Sometimes purs, at other times makes a great howling. Is extremely deſtructive to domeſtic [50] animals, particularly to hogs. It preys alſo upon the Mooſe, and other deer; falling on them from the tree it lurks in, and never quits its holdCharlevoix, v. 189, who by miſtake calls it Carcajou, and Kincajou; two very different animals.. The deer has no other way of ſaving itſelf, but by plunging into the water, if there happens to be any near; for the Panther, like the Cat, deteſts that element. It will feed even on beaſts of prey. I have ſeen the ſkin of one which was ſhot, juſt as it had killed a wolf. When it has ſatisfied itſelf with eating, it carefully conceals the reſt of the carcaſe, covering it with leaves. If any other animal touches the reliques, it never touches them again.

15. LYNX. Hiſt. Quad. No 170.—Smellie, v. 207. 217.—LEV. MUS.

CAT. With pale yellow eyes: ears erect, tufted with black long hair: body covered with ſoft and long fur, cinereous tinged with tawny, and marked with duſky ſpots, more or leſs viſible in different ſubjects, dependent on the age, or ſeaſon in which the animal is killed: the legs ſtrong and thick: the claws large. About three times the ſize of a common Cat: the tail only four inches long, tipt with black.

Inhabits the vaſt foreſts of North America: is called in Canada, Le Chat, ou Le Loup-cervier , on account of its being ſo deſtructive to deer; which it drops on from the trees, like the former, and, fixing on the jugular vein, never quits its hold till the exhauſted animal falls through loſs of bloodLawſon, 118. Cateſby, App. xxv..

The Engliſh call it a Wild Cat. It is very deſtructive to their young pigs, poultry, and all kind of game. The ſkins are in high eſteem for the ſoftneſs and warmneſs of the fur; and great numbers are annually imported into Europe.

Bay Lynx. Hiſt-Quad. No 171.16. BAY.
[51]

CAT. With yellow irides: ears like the former: color of the head, body, and outſide of the legs and thighs, a bright bay, obſcurely marked with duſky ſpots: the forehead marked with black ſtripes from the head to the noſe: cheeks white, varied with three or four incurvated lines of black: the upper and under lip, belly, and inſides of the legs and thighs, white: the inſide of the upper part of the fore legs croſſed with two black bars: the tail ſhort; the upper part marked with duſky bars, and near the end with one of black; the under ſide white. In ſize, about twice that of a common Cat; the fur ſhorter and ſmoother than that of the former.

This ſpecies is found in the internal parts of the province of New York. I ſaw one living a few years ago in London. The black bars on the legs and tail are ſpecific marks.

Hiſt. Quad. No 168.17. MOUNTAIN. Cat-a-mountain? Lawſon, 118. Du Pratz, ii. 64.

CAT. With upright pointed ears, marked with two brown bars: head and upper part of the body of a reddiſh brown, with long narrow ſtripes of black: the ſides and legs with ſmall round ſpots: chin and throat of a clear white: belly of a dull white: tail eight inches long, barred with black. Length from noſe to tail two feet and a half.SIZE.

Inhabits North America. Is ſaid to be a gentle animal, and to grow very fat. Deſcribed originally in the Memoires de l'Academie; ſince which an account of another, taken in Carolina, was communicated by the late Mr. Collinſon to the Count de Buffon *. The only difference is in ſize; for the laſt was only nineteen inches long: the tail four; but the ſame characteriſtic ſtripes, ſpots, and bars, on the tail, were ſimilar in both.

[52] OBSCURE SPECIES.There ſtill remain undeſcribed ſome animals of the Feline race, which are found in North America, but too obſcurely mentioned by travellers to be aſcertained. Such is the beaſt which Lawſon ſaw to the weſtward of Carolina, and calls a Tiger. He ſays it was larger than the Panther, i. e. Puma, and that it differed from the Tiger of Aſia and Africa *. It poſſibly may be the Braſilian Panther, Hiſt. Quad. No 158, which may extend further north than we imagine. It may likewiſe be the Cat-a-mount of Du Pratz ; which, he ſays, is as high as the Tiger, i. e. Puma, and the ſkin extremely beautiful.

The Pijoux of Louiſiana, mentioned by Charlevoix , are alſo obſcure animals. He ſays they are very like our Wild Cats, but larger: that ſome have ſhorter tails, and others longer. The firſt may be referred to one of the three laſt ſpecies: the laſt may be our Cayenne Cat, No 163.

Domeſtic Cats are kept in Iceland and Norway Oluf. Iceland, i. Paragr. 80. Pontop. ii. 8.. Some of them eſcape and relapſe to a ſavage ſtate. In Iceland thoſe are called Urdakelter, becauſe they live under rocks and looſe ſtones, where they hide themſelves. They prey on ſmall birds. The moſt valuable of their ſkins are ſold for twelve Daniſh ſkillings, or ſix pence a-piece. Linnaeus, ſpeaking of the cats of Sweden, ſays, they are of exotic originFaun. Suec. No 9.. They are not found wild either in that kingdom, or any part of the Ruſſian dominions. Unknown in America.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XX.BEAR.
[53]
Hiſt. Quad. No 175.—LEV. MUS.18. POLAR.

BEAR. With a long narrow head and neck: tip of the noſe black: teeth of a tremendous magnitude: hair of a great length, ſoft, and white, and in part tinged with yellow: limbs very thick and ſtrong: ears ſhort and rounded.

Travellers vary about their ſize. De Buffon quotes the authority of Gerard le Ver * for the length of one of the ſkins, which, he ſays, was twenty-three feet. This ſeems to be extremely miſrepreſented; for Gerard, who was a companion of the famous Barentz, and Heemſkirk, a voyager of the firſt credit, killed ſeveral on Nova Zembla, the largeſt of which did not exceed thirteen feet in lengthSee Le Ver, p. 14. ed. 1606. Amſteld.. They ſeem ſmaller on Spitzbergen: one meaſured by order of a noble and able navigator, in his late voyage towards the Pole, was as follows: I give all the meaſurements to aſcertain the proportions.

 Feet.Inches.
Length from ſnout to tail71
from ſnout to ſhoulder-bone23
Height at the ſhoulder43
Circumference near the fore legs70
of the neck near the ear21
Breadth of the fore-paw07
Weight of the carcaſe without the head, ſkin, or entrails610 lb. 

This ſpecies, like the Rein and Arctic Fox,PLACE. almoſt entirely ſurrounds the neighborhood of the Polar circle. It is found within it, [54] far as navigators have penetrated; in the iſland of Spitzbergen, and within Baffin's Bay; in Greenland and Hudſon's Bay; in Terra di Labrador *; and, by accident, wafted from Greenland, on iſlands of ice, to Iceland and Newfoundland. It perhaps attends the courſe of the Arctic circle along the vaſt regions of America; but it is unknown in the groupes of iſlands between that continent and Aſia; neither is it found on the Tchuktki Noſs, or the Great Cape, which juts into the ſea north of Kamtſchatka . None are ever ſeen in that country. But they are frequent on all the coaſts of the Frozen Ocean, from the mouth of the Ob , eaſtward; and abound moſt about the eſtuaries of the Jeneſei and Lena. They appear about thoſe ſavage tracts, and abound in the unfrequented iſlands of Nova Zembla, Cherry, and Spitzbergen, where they find winter quarters undiſturbed by mankind. The ſpecies is happily unknown along the ſhores of the White ſea, and thoſe of Lapland and Norway. Poſſibly even thoſe rigorous climates may be too mild for animals that affect the utmoſt ſeverity of the Arctic zone. They never are ſeen farther ſouth in Sibiria than Mangaſea, nor wander into the woody parts, unleſs by accident in great miſts.

They are ſometimes brought alive into England. One which I ſaw was always in motion, reſtleſs, and furious, roaring in a loud and hoarſe tone; and ſo impatient of warmth, that the keeper was obliged to pour on it frequently pailfuls of water. In a ſtate of nature, and in places little viſited by mankind, they are of dreadful ferocity. In Spitzbergen, and the other places annually frequented by the human race, they dread its power, having experienced its ſuperiority, and ſhun the conflict: yet even in thoſe countries prove tremendous enemies, if attacked or provoked.

Barentz, in his voyages in ſearch of a north-eaſt paſſage to China, had fatal proofs of their rage and intrepidity on the iſland of Nova Zembla: his ſeamen were frequently attacked, and ſome of them [55] killed. Thoſe whom they ſeized on they took in their mouths, ran away with the utmoſt eaſe, tore to pieces, and devoured at their leiſure, even in ſight of the ſurviving comrades. One of theſe animals was ſhot preying on the mangled corpſe, yet would not quit its hold; but continued ſtaggering away with the body in its mouth, till diſpatched with many wounds*.

They will attack, and attempt to board, armed veſſels far diſtant from ſhore; and have been with great difficulty repelled. They ſeem to give a preference to human blood; and will greedily diſ-inter the graves of the buried, to devour the cadaverous contentsMartin's Spitzb. 102..

Their uſual food is fiſh, ſeals, and the carcaſes of whales.FOOD. On land, they prey on deer, hares, young birds, and eggs, and often on whortleberries and crowberries. They are at conſtant enmity with the Walrus, or Morſe: the laſt, by reaſon of its vaſt tuſks, has generally the ſuperiority; but frequently both the combatants periſh in the conflictEgede, 83..

They are frequently ſeen in Greenland, in lat. 76, in great droves; where, allured by the ſcent of the fleſh of ſeals, they will ſurround the habitations of the natives, and attempt to break in; but are ſoon driven away by the ſmell of burnt feathersFaun. Groenl. p. 23.. If one of them is by any accident killed, the ſurvivors will immediately eat itHeemſkirk, 51..

They grow exceſſively fat; a hundred pounds of fat has been taken out of a ſingle beaſt. Their fleſh is coarſe, but is eaten by the ſeamen: it is white, and they fancy it taſtes like mutton. The liver is very unwholeſome, as three of Heemſkirk's ſailors experienced, who fell dangerouſly ill on eating ſome of it boiledThe ſame. 45.. The ſkin is an article of commerce: many are imported, and uſed chiefly for covers to coach-boxes. The Greenlanders feed on the fleſh and fat; uſe the ſkins to ſit on, and make of it boots, ſhoes, and gloves; and ſplit the tendons into thread for ſewing.

[56]During ſummer they reſide chiefly on iſlands of ice, and paſs frequently from one to the other. They ſwim moſt excellently, and ſometimes dive, but continue only a ſmall ſpace under water. They have been ſeen on iſlands of ice eighty miles from any land, preying and feeding as they float along. They lodge in dens formed in the vaſt maſſes of ice, which are piled in a ſtupendous manner, leaving great caverns beneath: here they breed, and bring one or two at a time, and ſometimes, but very rarely, three. Great is the affection between parent and young; they will ſooner die than deſert one another*. They alſo follow their dams a very long time, and are grown to a very large ſize before they quit them.

During winter they retire, and bed themſelves deep beneath, forming ſpacious dens in the ſnow, ſupported by pillars of the ſame, or to the fixed ice beneath ſome eminence; where they paſs torpid the long and diſmal night, appearing only with the return of the ſun. At their appearance the Arctic Foxes retire to other haunts.

The Polar Bear became part of the royal menagery as early as the reign of Henry III. Mr. Walpole has proved how great a patron that deſpiſed prince was of the Arts. It is not leſs evident that he extended his protection to Natural Hiſtory. We find he had procured a White Bear from Norway, from whence it probably was imported from Greenland, the Norwegians having poſſeſſed that country for ſome centuries before that period. There are two writs extant from that monarch, directing the ſheriffs of London to furniſh ſix pence a day to ſupport our White Bear in our Tower of London; and to provide a muzzle and iron chain to hold him when out of the water; and a long and ſtrong rope to hold him, when he was fiſhing in the Thames §. Fit proviſion was made at the ſame time for the king's Elephant.

[57]The ſkins of this ſpecies, in old times, were offered by the hunters to the high altars of cathedrals, or other churches, that the prieſt might ſtand on them, and not catch cold when he was celebrating high maſs in extreme cold weather. Many ſuch were annually offered at the cathedral at Drontheim in Norway; and alſo the ſkins of wolves, which were ſold to purchaſe wax lights to burn in honor of the ſaints*.

Hiſt. Quad. No 174.—Smellie, v. 19.19. BLACK.

BEAR. With a long pointed noſe, and narrow forehead: the cheeks and throat of a yellowiſh brown color: hair over the whole body and limbs of a gloſſy black, ſmoother and ſhorter than that of the European kind.

They are uſually ſmaller than thoſe of the old world; yet Mr. Bartram gives an inſtance of an old he-bear killed in Florida which was ſeven feet long, and, as he gueſſed, weighed four hundred pounds.

Theſe animals are found in all parts of North America, from Hudſon's Bay to the ſouthern extremity; but in Louiſiana and the ſouthern parts they appear only in the winter, migrating from the north in ſearch of food. They ſpread acroſs the northern part of the American continent to the Kamtſchatkan ſea. They are found again in the oppoſite country, and in the Kurilſki iſlands, which intervene between Kamtſchatka and Japan , Jeſo Maſima, which lies north of Japan §, and probably Japan itſelf; for Kaempfer ſays, that a few ſmall bears are found in the northern provinces.

It is very certain that this ſpecies of bear feeds on vegetables.FOOD. Du Pratz, who is a faithful as well as intelligent writer, relates, that [58] in one ſevere winter, when theſe animals were forced in multitudes from the woods, where there was abundance of animal food, they rejected that, notwithſtanding they were ready to periſh with hunger; and, migrating into the lower Louiſiana, would often break into the courts of houſes. They never touched the butchers meat which lay in their way, but fed voraciouſly on the corn or roots they met with*.

Neceſſity alone ſometimes compels them to attack and feed on the ſwine they meet in the woods: but fleſh is to them an unnatural diet. They live on berries, fruits, and pulſe of all kinds; are remarkably fond of potatoes, which they very readily dig up with their great paws; make great havock in the fields of maize; and are great lovers of milk and honey. They feed much on herrings, which they catch in the ſeaſon when thoſe fiſh come in ſhoals up the creeks, which gives their fleſh a diſagreeable taſte; and the ſame effect is obſerved when they eat the bitter berries of the Tupelo.

They are equally inoffenſive to mankind, provided they are not irritated; but if wounded, they will turn on their aſſailant with great fury, and, in caſe they can lay hold, never fail of hugging him to death; for it has been obſerved they never make uſe, in their rage, of either their teeth or claws. If they meet a man in a path they will not go out of his way; but will not attack him. They never ſeek combat. A ſmall dog will make them run up a tree.

The bears of Kamtſchatka reſemble thoſe of America: they are neither large nor fierce. They alſo wander from the hills to the lower lands in ſummer, and feed on berries and fiſh. They reject carnivorous food, nor ever attack the inhabitants, unleſs they find them aſleep, when, through wantonneſs, they bite them ſeverely, and ſometimes tear a piece of fleſh away; yet, notwithſtanding they get a taſte of human blood, are never known to devour mankind. People thus injured are called Dranki , or the flayed.

The American bears do not lodge in caves or clefts of rocks, like thoſe of Europe. The bears of Hudſon's Bay form their dens beneath [59] the ſnow, and ſuffer ſome to drop at the mouth, to conceal their retreat.

The naturaliſt's poet, with great truth and beauty, deſcribes the retreat of this animal in the frozen climate of the north:

There through the piny foreſt half abſorpt,
Rough tenant of thoſe ſhades, the ſhapeleſs BEAR,
With dangling ice all horrid, ſtalks forlorn;
Slow pac'd, and ſourer as the ſtorms increaſe.
He makes his bed beneath th' inclement drift,
And with ſtern patience, ſcorning weak complaint,
Hardens his heart againſt aſſailing want.

Thoſe of the ſouthern parts dwell in the hollows of antient trees. The hunter diſcovers them by ſtriking with an ax the tree he ſuſpects they are lodged in, then ſuddenly conceals himſelf. The Bear is immediately rouzed, looks out of the hollow to learn the cauſe of the alarm; ſeeing none, ſinks again into repoſe*. The hunter then forces him out, by flinging in fired reeds; and ſhoots him while he deſcends the body of the tree, which, notwithſtanding his aukward appearance, he does with great agility; nor is he leſs nimble in aſcending the tops of the higheſt trees in ſearch of berries and fruits.

The long time which theſe animals ſubſiſt without food is amazing. They will continue in their retreat for ſix weeks without the leſt proviſion, remaining either aſleep or totally inactive. It is pretended that they live by ſucking their paws; but that is a vulgar error. The fact is, they retire immediately after autumn, when they have fattened themſelves to an exceſſive degree by the abundance of the fruits which they find at that ſeaſon. This enables animals, which perſpire very little in a ſtate of reſt, to endure an abſtinence of uncommon length. But when this internal ſupport is exhauſted, and they begin to feel the call of hunger, on the approach of the ſevere ſeaſon, they quit their dens in ſearch of food. Multitudes [60] then migrate into the lower parts of Louiſiana: they arrive very lean; but ſoon fatten with the vegetables of that milder climate*. They never wander far from the banks of the Miſſiſipi, and in their march form a beaten path like the track of men.

Lawſon and Cateſby relate a very ſurprizing thing in reſpect to this animal, which is, that neither European or Indian ever killed a Bear with young. In one winter were killed in Virginia five hundred bears, and among them only two females; and thoſe not pregnant. The cauſe is, that the male has the ſame unnatural diſlike to its offspring as ſome other animals have: they will kill and devour the cubs. The females therefore retire, before the time of parturition, into the depth of woods and rocks, to elude the ſearch of their ſavage mates. It is ſaid that they do not make their appearance with their young till March .

All who have taſted the fleſh of this animal ſay, that it is moſt delicious eating: a young Bear, fattened with the autumnal fruits, is a diſh fit for the niceſt epicure. It is wholeſome and nouriſhing, and reſembles pork more than any other meat. The tongue and the paws are eſteemed the moſt exquiſite morſels; the hams are alſo excellent, but apt to ruſt, if not very well preſerved.

Four inches depth of fat has been found on a ſingle Bear, and fifteen or ſixteen gallons of pure oil melted from it§. The fat is of a pure white, and has the ſingular quality of never lying heavy on the ſtomach, notwithſtanding a perſon drank a quart of it. The Americans make great uſe of it for frying their fiſh. It is beſides uſed medicinally, and has been found very efficacious in rheumatic complaints, achs, and ſtrains.

The Indians of Louiſiana prepare it thus:—As ſoon as they have killed the Bear, they ſhoot a Deer; cut off the head, and draw the ſkin entire to the legs, which they cut off: they then ſtop up every orifice, except that on the neck, into which they pour the melted fat [61] of the Bear; which is prepared by boiling the fat and fleſh together. This they call a Deer of oil, and ſell to the French for a gun, or ſomething of equal value*.

Bears greaſe is in great repute in Europe for its ſuppoſed quality of making the hair to grow on the human head. A great chymiſt in the Haymarket in London uſed to fatten annually two or three Bears for the ſake of their fat.

The ſkin is in uſe for all purpoſes which the coarſer ſorts of furs are applied to: it ſerves in America, in diſtant journies, for coverlets; and the finer parts have been in ſome places uſed in the hat manufacture.

The Indians of Canada daub their hands and face with the greaſe, to preſerve them from the bite of muſketoes: they alſo ſmear their bodies with the oil after exceſſive exerciſe. They think, like the Romans of old, that oil ſupples their joints, and preſerves them in full activity.

Black Bear, Hiſt. Quad. No 174.— Smellie, v. 19.20. BROWN.

BEAR. With long ſhaggy hair, uſually duſky or black, with brown points; liable to vary, perhaps according to their age, or ſome accident, which does not create a ſpecific difference.

α.A variety of a pale brown color, whoſe ſkins I have ſeen imported from Hudſon's Bay. The ſame kind, I believe, is alſo found in Europe. The cubs are of a jetty black, and their necks often encircled with white.

β.Bears ſpotted with white.

γ.Land Bears, entirely white. Such ſometimes ſally from the lofty mountains which border on Sibiria, and appear in a wandering manner in the lower parts of the country. Marco Polo relates, that they were frequent in his time in the north of Tartary, and of a very great ſize.

[62] δ.Grizzly Bears. Theſe are called by the Germans Silber-bar, or the Silver-bear, from the mixture of white hairs. Theſe are found in Europe, and the very northern parts of North America, as high as lat. 70; where a hill is called after them, Grizzle Bear Hill, and where they breed in caverns*. The ground in this neighborhood is in all parts turned by them in ſearch of the hoards formed by the Ground Squirrels for winter proviſion.

All theſe varieties form but one ſpecies. They are granivorous and carnivorous, both in Europe and America; and I believe, according to their reſpective palates or habits, one may be deemed a variety which prefers the vegetable food; another may be diſtinguiſhed from its preference of animal food. Mr. Graham aſſures me, that the brown Bears, in the inland parts of Hudſon's Bay, make great havock among the Buffaloes: are very large, and very dangerous when they are attacked and wounded.

BEARS VENERATED IN AMERICA.In all ſavage nations the Bear has been an object of veneration. Among the Americans a feaſt is made in honor of each that is killed. The head of the beaſt is painted with all colors, and placed on an elevated place, where it receives the reſpects of all the gueſts, who celebrate in ſongs the praiſes of the Bear. They cut the body in pieces, and regale on it, and conclude the ceremony.

CHASE.The chaſe of theſe animals is a matter of the firſt importance, and never undertaken without abundance of ceremony. A principal warrior firſt gives a general invitation to all the hunters. This is followed by a moſt ſerious faſt of eight days, a total abſtinence from all kinds of food; notwithſtanding which, they paſs the day in continual ſong. This they do to invoke the ſpirits of the woods to direct them to the place where there are abundance of bears. They even cut the fleſh in divers parts of their bodies, to render the ſpirits more propitious. They alſo addreſs themſelves to the manes of the beaſts ſlain in preceding chaſes, as if it were to direct them in their dreams to plenty of game. One dreamer alone cannot determine [63] the place of chaſe, numbers muſt concur; but, as they tell each other their dreams, they never fail to agree: whether that may ariſe from complaiſance, or by a real agreement in the dreams from their thoughts being perpetually turned on the ſame thing.

The chief of the hunt now gives a great feaſt, at which no one dares to appear without firſt bathing. At this entertainment they eat with great moderation, contrary to their uſual cuſtom. The maſter of the feaſt alone touches nothing; but is employed in relating to the gueſts antient tales of the wonderful feats in former chaſes: and freſh invocations to the manes of the deceaſed bears conclude the whole. They then ſally forth amidſt the acclamations of the village, equipped as if for war, and painted black. Every able hunter is on a level with a great warrior; but he muſt have killed his dozen great beaſts before his character is eſtabliſhed: after which his alliance is as much courted as that of the moſt valiant captain.

They now proceed on their way in a direct line: neither rivers, marſhes, or any other impediments, ſtop their courſe; driving before them all the beaſts which they find in their way. When they arrive in the hunting-ground, they ſurround as large a ſpace as their company will admit, and then contract their circle; ſearching, as they contract, every hollow tree, and every place fit for the retreat of the bear, and continue the ſame practice till the time of the chaſe is expired.

As ſoon as a bear is killed, a hunter puts into its mouth a lighted pipe of tobacco, and, blowing into it, fills the throat with the ſmoke, conjuring the ſpirit of the animal not to reſent what they are going to do to its body; nor to render their future chaſes unſucceſsful. As the beaſt makes no reply, they cut out the ſtring of the tongue, and throw it into the fire: if it crackles and runs in (which it is almoſt ſure to do) they accept it as a good omen; if not, they conſider that the ſpirit of the beaſt is not appeaſed, and that the chaſe of the next year will be unfortunate.

The hunters live well during the chaſe, on proviſions which they bring with them. They return, home with great pride and ſelf-ſufficiency; [64] for to kill a bear forms the character of a complete man. They again give a great entertainment, and now make a point to leave nothing. The feaſt is dedicated to a certain genius, perhaps that of Gluttony, whoſe reſentment they dread, if they do not eat every morſel, and even ſup up the very melted greaſe in which the meat was dreſſed. They ſometimes eat till they burſt, or bring on themſelves ſome violent diſorders. The firſt courſe is the greateſt bear they have killed, without even taking out the entrails, or taking off the ſkin, contenting themſelves with ſingeing the ſkin, as is practiſed with hogs*.

The Kamtſchatkans, IN KAMTSCHATKA. before their converſion to Chriſtianity, had almoſt ſimilar ſuperſtitions reſpecting bears and other wild beaſts: they entreated the bears and wolves not to hurt them in the chaſe, and whales and marine animals not to overturn their boats. They never call the two former by their proper name, but by that of Sipang, or ill-luck.

At preſent the Kamtſchatkans kill the bear and other wild beaſts with guns: formerly they had variety of inventions; ſuch as filling the entrance of its den with logs, and then digging down upon the animal and deſtroying it with ſpearsHiſt. Kamtſchatka, Fr. iii. 73.. In Sibiria it is taken by making a trap-fall of a great piece of timber, which drops and cruſhes it to death: or by forming a nooſe in a rope faſtened to a great log; the bear runs its head into the nooſe, and, finding itſelf engaged, grows furious, and either falls down ſome precipice and kills itſelf, or wearies itſelf to death by its agitations.

The killing of a bear in fair battle is reckoned as great a piece of heroiſm by the Kamtſchatkans as it is with the Americans. The victor makes a feaſt on the occaſion, and feaſts his neighbors with the beaſt; then hangs the head and thighs about his tent by way of trophies.

Theſe people uſe the ſkins to lie on, and for coverlets; for bonnets, gloves, collars for their dogs, ſoles for their ſhoes, to prevent them [65] from ſlipping on the ice. Of the ſhoulder-blades they make inſtruments to cut the graſs; of the inteſtines, covers for their faces, to protect them from the ſun during ſpring; and the Coſſacks extend them over their windows inſtead of glaſs. The fleſh and fat is among the chief dainties of the country*.

Superſtitions, relative to this animal, did not confine themſelves to America and Aſia, but ſpread equally over the north of Europe. The Laplanders held it in the greateſt veneration: they called it the Dog of GOD, becauſe they eſteemed it to have the ſtrength of ten men, and the ſenſe of twelve. They never preſume to call it by its proper name of Guouzhja, leaſt it revenge the inſult on their flocks; but ſtyle it Moedda-aigia, or the old man in a furred cloak .

The killing of a Bear was reckoned as great an exploit in Lapland as it was in America, and the hero was held in the higheſt eſteem by both ſexes; and, by a ſingular cuſtom, was forbid all commerce with his wife for three days. The Laplanders bring home the ſlain beaſts in great triumph. They erect a new tent near their former dwelling, but never enter it till they have flung off the dreſs of the chaſe. They continue in it three entire days; and the women keep at home the ſame ſpace. The men dreſs the fleſh of the Bear in the new tent, and make their repaſt, giving part to the females; but take great care never to beſtow on them a bit of the rump. Neither will they deliver to them the meat through the common entrance of the hut, but through a hole in another part. In ſign of victory, the men ſprinkle themſelves with the blood of the beaſt.

After they have finiſhed eating the fleſh, they bury the bones with great ſolemnity, and place every bone in its proper place, from a firm perſuaſion that the Bear will be reſtored, and re-animate a new body.

At the pulling off the ſkin, and cutting the body into pieces, they were uſed to ſing a ſong, but without meaning or rhyme; but the [66] antient Fins had a ſong, which, if not highly embelliſhed by the tranſlator, is far from inelegant.

Beaſt! of all foreſt beaſts ſubdued and ſlain,
Health to our huts and prey a hundred-fold
Reſtore; and o'er us keep a conſtant guard!
I thank the Gods who gave ſo noble prey!
When the great day-ſtar hides beyond the alps,
I hie me home; and joy, all clad in flowers,
For three long nights ſhall reign throughout my hut.
With tranſport ſhall I climb the mountain's ſide.
Joy op'd this day, joy ſhall attend its cloſe.
Thee I revere, from thee expect my prey:
Nor e'er forgot my carol to the BEAR*.
21. WOLVERENE. Hiſt. Quad. No 176, 177. Syn. Quad. Gulo, Pallas Spicil. Zool. Faſc. xiv. 25. tab. ii.—LEV. MUS.

BEAR. With ſhort rounded ears, almoſt concealed by the fur: face ſharp, black, and pointed: back broad, and, while the animal is in motion, much elevated, or arched; and the head carried low: the legs ſhort and ſtrong: claws long and ſharp, white at their ends.

The length from noſe to tail twenty-eight inches; of the trunk of the tail ſeven inches. It is covered with thick long hairs, reddiſh at the bottom, black at the end; ſome reach ſix inches beyond the tip.

The hairs on the head, back, and belly, are of the ſame colors, but much finer and ſofter. Before they are examined, the animal appears wholly black. The throat whitiſh, marked with black. Along the ſides, from the ſhoulders to the tail, is a broad band of a ferruginous color: in ſeveral of the ſkins, brought from Hudſon's Bay, I obſerved [67] this band to be white. The legs are black; the feet covered with hair on the bottom. On the fore feet of that which I examined were ſome white ſpots. On each foot were five toes, not greatly divided.

It hath much the action of a Bear; not only in the form of its back, and the hanging down of its head, but alſo in reſting on the hind part of the firſt joint of its legs.

This is one of the local animals of America. PLACE. I trace it as far north as the Copper river, and to the countries on the weſt and ſouth of Hudſon's Bay, Canada, and the tract as far as the ſtraits of Michillmakinac, between the lakes Huron and Superior.

I have reaſon to think that the Glutton of the old writers is the ſame with this animal;GLUTTON OF OLD WRITERS. and that in my Hiſtory of Quadrupeds I unneceſſarily ſeparated them. Since I have received the late publication of Dr. Pallas, I am ſatisfied that it is common to the north of America, Europe, and Aſia, even to Kamtſchatka; inhabiting the vaſt foreſts of the north, even within the Polar circle. The Kamtſchatkans value them ſo highly as to ſay, that the heavenly beings wear no other furs. The ſkins are the greateſt preſent they can make their miſtreſſes; and the women ornament their heads with the parts of the white banded variety. The Ruſſians call theſe animals Roſſomak; the Kamtſchatkans, Tymi, or Tummi.

It is a beaſt of uncommon fierceneſs,MANNERS. the terror of the Wolf and Bear; the former, which will devour any carrion, will not touch the carcaſe of this animal, which ſmells more fetid than that of a Polecat. It has great ſtrength, and makes vaſt reſiſtance when taken; will tear the traps often to pieces; or if wounded, will ſnap the ſtock from the barrel of the muſket; and often do more damage in the capture than the fur is worth.

It preys indifferently on all animals which it can maſter. It feeds by night, and, being ſlow of foot, follows the track of wolves and foxes in the ſnow, in order to come in for ſhare of their prey. It will dig up the carcaſes of animals, and the proviſions concealed by the [68] huntſmen deep in the ſnow, which it will carry away to other places to devour. About the Lena it will attack horſes, on whoſe backs are often ſeen the marks of its teeth and claws. By a wonderful ſagacity it will aſcend a tree, and fling from the boughs a ſpecies of moſs which Elks and Reins are very fond of; and when thoſe animals come beneath to feed on it, will fall on them and deſtroy them: or, like the Lynx, it aſcends to the boughs of trees, and falls on the Deer which caſually paſs beneath, and adheres till they fall down with fatigue. It is a great enemy to the Beaver*, and is on that account ſometimes called the Beaver-eater. It watches at the mouth of their holes, and catches them as they come out. It ſearches the traps laid for taking other beaſts, and devours thoſe which it finds taken. It breaks into the magazines of the natives, and robs them of the proviſions; whether they are covered with logs, bruſhwood, and built high between two or three ſtanding trees.

It lodges in clefts of rocks, or in hollows of trees, and in Sibiria often in the deſerted holes of Badgers; never digging its own den, nor having any certain habitation. It breeds once a year, bringing from two to four at a litter. Its fur is much uſed for muffs. Notwithſtanding its great fierceneſs when wounded, or firſt ſeizure, it is capable of being made very tame.

FUR.The ſkins are frequently brought from Hudſon's Bay, and commonly uſed for muffs. In Sibiria the ſkin is moſt valued which is black, and has leſt of the ferruginous band. Theſe are chiefly found in the mountanous foreſts of Jakutſk, and uſed by the natives to adorn their caps. Few of the Sibirian ſkins are ſent into Ruſſia, but are chiefly ſold to the Mongals and Chineſe.

The relations of the exceſſive gluttony of this animal; that it eats till it is ready to burſt, and that it is obliged to unload itſelf by ſqueezing its body between two trees; are totally fabulous: like other animals, they eat till they are ſatisfied, and then leave off§.

Hiſt. Quad. No 178.—Smellie, v. 46.—LEV. MUS.22. RACCOON.
[69]

BEAR. With upper jaw larger than the lower: face ſharp-pointed, and fox-like: ears ſhort and rounded: eyes large, of a yellowiſh green; the ſpace round them black: a duſky line extends from the forehead to the noſe; the reſt of the face, the cheeks, and the throat, white: the hair univerſally long and ſoft; that on the back tipt with black, white in the middle, and cinereous at the roots: tail annulated with black and white, and very full of hair: toes black, and quite divided: the fore-feet ſerve the purpoſes of a hand.

Theſe animals vary in color. I have ſeen ſome of a pale brown, others white. Their uſual length, from noſe to tail, is two feet: near the tail about one.

Raccoons inhabit only the temperate parts of North America, PLACE. from New England * to Florida . They probably are continued in the ſame latitudes acroſs the continent, being, according to Dampier, found in the iſles of Maria, in the South Sea, between the ſouth point of California and Cape Corientes. It is alſo an inhabitant of Mexico, where it is called Mapach .

It lives in hollow trees, and is very expert at climbing.MANNERS. Like other beaſts of prey, keeps much within during day, except it proves dark and cloudy. In ſnowy and ſtormy weather it confines itſelf to its hole for a week together. It feeds indifferently on fruits or fleſh; is extremely deſtructive to fields of mayz, and very injurious to all kinds of fruits; loves ſtrong liquors, and will get exceſſively drunk. It makes great havock among poultry, and is very fond of eggs. Is itſelf often the prey of Snakes§.

[70]Thoſe which inhabit places near the ſhore live much on ſhell-fiſh, particularly oyſters. They will watch the opening of the ſhell, dextrouſly put in its paw, and tear out the contents; ſometimes the oyſter ſuddenly cloſes, catches the thief, and detains it till drowned by the return of the tide. They likewiſe feed on crabs, both ſea and land. It has all the cunning of the Fox. Lawſon * ſays, that it will ſtand on the ſide of a ſwamp, and hang its tail over into the water: the crabs will lay hold, miſtaking it for a bait; which, as ſoon as the Raccoon feels, it pulls out with a ſudden jerk, and makes a prey of the cheated crabs.

It is made tame with great eaſe, ſo as to follow its maſter along the ſtreets; but never can be broke from its habit of ſtealing, or killing of poultry. It is ſo fond of ſugar, or any ſweet things, as to do infinite miſchief in a houſe, if care is not taken.

It has many of the actions of a Monkey; ſuch as feeding itſelf with its ſore feet, ſitting up to eat, being always in motion, being very inquiſitive, and examining every thing it ſees with its paws. Notwithſtanding it is not fond of water, it dips into it all ſorts of dry food which is given to it; and will waſh its face with its feet, like a Cat.

It is ſought after on account of the fur. Some people eat it, and eſteem it as very good meat. The Swedes call it Siup, and Eſpan; the Dutch, Heſpan; and the Iroqueſe, Affigbro. The hair makes the beſt hats, next to that of the Beaver. The tail is worn round the neck in winter, by way of preſervative againſt the cold.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXI.BADGER.
[71]
American Badger, Hiſt. Quad. p. 298. β.—Smellie, iv. 226.—LEV. MUS.23. COMMON.

BADGER. With rounded ears: forehead, and middle of the cheeks, marked with a white line, extending to the beginning of the back, bounded on each ſide by another of black: cheeks white: ſpace round the ears duſky: body covered with long coarſe hair, cinereous and white.

The legs were wanting in the ſkin which I ſaw; but I ſupply that defect from M. de Buffon's deſcription. They were duſky, and the toes furniſhed with claws, like the European kind. M. de Buffon obſerved only four toes on the hind feet; but then he ſuſpected that one was torn off from the dried ſkin he ſaw.

Theſe animals are rather ſcarce in America. PLACE. They are found in the neighborhood of Hudſon's Bay, and in Terra di Labrador; and perhaps as low as Penſylvannia, where they are called Ground Hogs*. They do not differ ſpecifically from the European kind; but are ſometimes found white in America .

I do not diſcover them in northern Aſia, nearer than the banks of the Yaik . They are common in China, where they are frequently brought to the ſhambles, being an eſteemed food. In northern Europe, they are found in Norway and Sweden §.

Le Comte de Buffon imagines this animal to be the Carcajou of the Americans, and not the Wolveren. The matter is uncertain: [72] yet I find that name beſtowed on the latter by La Hontan; by Dobbs, who makes it ſynonymous; and by Charlevoix, though the laſt miſtakes the animal, yet not the manners of that which he aſcribes it to. On the other hand, Mr. Graham and Mr. Edwards omit that title, and call it only Wolveren, or Queequehatch.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXII.OPOSSUM.
[73]
Hiſt. Quad. No 181.

OPOSSUM. With ten cutting teeth above, eight beneath:24. VIRGINIAN. eyes black, ſmall, and lively: ears large, naked, membranaceous, and rounded: face long and pointed; whiſkers on each ſide of the noſe, and tufts of long hairs over the eyes: legs are ſhort; the thumb on the hind feet has a flat nail, the reſt of the toes have on them ſharp talons: the body is ſhort, round, and thick: the tail long; the baſe is covered with hair for three inches, the reſt is covered with ſmall ſcales, and has the diſguſting reſemblance of a Snake.

On the lower part of the belly of the female is a large pouch, in which the teats are placed, and in which the young lodge as ſoon as they are born. The body is cloathed with very long ſoft hairs, lying uſually uneven: the color appears of a dirty white; the lower parts of the hairs duſky: and above each eye is a whitiſh ſpot: the belly tinged with yellow.

The length of one I examined was ſeventeen inches, of the tail fourteen.

This ſpecies is found as far north as Canada *,PLACE. where the French call it Le Rat de bois; from thence it extends ſouthward, even to the Braſils and Peru. The ſingularity of the ventral pouch of the female, and the manner of its bringing up its young, places it among the moſt wonderful animals of the new continent.

As ſoon as the female finds herſelf near the time of bringing forth, ſhe prepares a neſt of coarſe graſs, covered with long pieces of ſticks, near four feet high and five in diameter, confuſedly put together [74] *. She brings forth from four to ſix at a time. As ſoon as they come into the world they retreat into the falſe belly, blind, naked, and exactly reſembling little foetuſes. They faſten cloſely to the teats, as if they grew to them; which has given cauſe to the vulgar error, that they were created ſo. There they adhere as if they were inanimate, till they arrive at a degree of perfection in ſhape, and attain ſight, ſtrength, and hair: after which they undergo a ſort of ſecond birth. From that time they run into the pouch as an aſylum from danger. The female carries them about with the utmoſt affection, and would rather be killed than permit this receptacle to be opened; for ſhe has the power of contracting or dilating the orifice by the help of ſome very ſtrong muſcles. If they are ſurpriſed, and have not time to retreat into the pouch, they will adhere to the tail of the parent, and eſcape with her.

The Opoſſum is both carnivorous and frugivorous. It is a great enemy to poultry; and will ſuck the blood and leave the fleſh untouched. It climbs trees very expertly, feeding on wild fruits, and alſo on various roots. Its tail has the ſame prehenſile quality as that of ſome ſpecies of Monkies. It will hang from the branches by it, and by ſwinging its body, fling itſelf among the boughs of the adjacent trees. It is a very ſluggiſh animal; has a very ſlow pace, and makes ſcarcely any efforts to eſcape. When it finds itſelf on the point of being taken, it counterfeits death; hardly any torture will make it give ſigns of life§. If the perſon retires, it will put itſelf in motion, and creep into ſome neighboring buſh. It is more tenacious of life than a Cat, and will ſuffer great violence before it is killed.

The old animals are eſteemed as delicate eating as a ſucking pig; yet the ſkin is very foetid. The Indian women of Louiſiana dye the hair, and weave it into girdles and garters.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXIII.WEESEL.
[75]
Hiſt. Quad. No 192.—Smellie, iv. 257.—LEV. MUS.25. COMMON.

WEESEL. With ſmall rounded ears: beneath each corner of the mouth is a white ſpot: breaſt and belly white; reſt of the body of a pale tawny brown. Its length, from the tip of the noſe to the tail, is about ſeven inches; the tail two and a half.

Inhabits the country about Hudſon's Bay, Newfoundland, PLACE. and as far ſouth as Carolina *. Mr. Graham ſent ſome over, both in their ſummer coat, and others almoſt entirely white, the color they aſſume in winter. We meet with them again in Kamtſchatka, and all over Ruſſia and Sibiria; and in thoſe northern regions they regularly turn white during winter. One, which was brought from Natka Sound in North America, had between the ears and noſe a bed of gloſſy black, which probably was its univerſal color before its change. Dr. Irving ſaw on Moffen iſland, north of Spitzbergen, lat. 80. an animal, perhaps of this kind, ſpotted black and white.

Hiſt. Quad. No 193.—Smellie, vi. 262.—LEV. MUS.26. STOAT.

WEESEL. With ſhort ears, edged with white: head, back, ſides, and legs, of a pale tawny brown: under ſide of the body white: lower part of the tail brown, the end black.

In northern countries, changes in winter to a ſnowy whiteneſs, the end of the tail excepted, which retains its black color: in this ſtate is called an Ermine.

[76]Length, from noſe to tail, ten inches; the tail is five and a half.

PLACE.Inhabits only Hudſon's Bay, Canada, and the northern parts of North America. In Newfoundland it is ſo bold as to commit its thefts in open view. Feeds on eggs, the young of birds, and on the mice with which thoſe countries abound. They alſo prey on Rabbits, and the White Grous. The ſkins are exported from Canada among what the French call la menuë pelleterie, or ſmall furs*

It is found again in plenty in Kamtſchatka , the Kurili iſlands, Sibiria, and in all the northern extremities of Europe. It is ſcarce in Kamtſchatka; and its chaſe is not attended to, amidſt the quantity of ſuperior furs. But in Sibiria and Norway they are a conſiderable article of commerce.CAPTURE. In the former, they are taken in traps, baited with a bit of fleſh; in the latter, either ſhot with blunt arrows, or taken, as garden mice are in England, by a flat ſtone propped by a baited ſtick, which falls down on the leſt touch, and cruſhes them to death§. They are found in Sibiria in great plenty in woods of birch, yet are never ſeen in thoſe of fir. Their ſkins are ſold there on the ſpot from two to three pounds ſterling per hundred.

They are not found on the Arctic flats. The inhabitants of the Tſchuktſchi Noſs get them in exchange from the Americans, where they are of a larger ſize than any in the Ruſſian dominions.

The exceſſive cold of certain winters has obliged even theſe hardy animals to migrate, as was evident in the year 1730, and 1744.

27. PINE. MARTIN. Hiſt. Quad. No 200.—Br. Zool. i. No 16.—Smellie, iv. 245.—LEV. MUS.

WEESEL. With white cheeks and tips of ears; yellow throat and breaſt; reſt of the fur of a fine deep cheſnut-color in the male, paler in the female: tail buſhy, and of a deeper color than the body.

[77]Theſe animals inhabit, in great abundance,PLACE. the northern parts of America; but I believe the ſpecies ceaſes before it arrives at the temperate provinces. They appear again in the north of Europe, extend acroſs the Urallian chain, but do not reach the Oby.

They inhabit foreſts, particularly thoſe of fir and pine,MANNERS. and make their neſts in the trees. Breed once a year, and bring from two to four at a litter. They feed principally upon mice; but deſtroy alſo all kinds of birds which they can maſter. They are taken by the natives of Hudſon's Bay in ſmall log-traps, baited, which fall on and kill them. The natives eat the fleſh.

Their ſkins are among the more valuable furs, and make a moſt important article of commerce. I obſerved, that in one of the Hudſon's Bay Company's annual ſales, not fewer than 12,370 good ſkins, and 2360 damaged, were ſold; and in that year (1743) 30,325 were imported by the French from Canada into the port of Rochelle. They are found in great numbers in the midſt of the woods of Canada; and once in two or three years come out in great multitudes, as if their retreats were overſtocked: this the hunters look on as a forerunner of great ſnows, and a ſeaſon favorable to the chaſe*.

It is remarkable, that notwithſtanding this ſpecies extends acroſs the continent of America, from Hudſon's Bay to the oppoſite ſide, yet it is loft on the Aſiatic ſide of the ſtraits of Tſchuktſchi; nor is it recovered till you reach Catherinebourg, a diſtrict of Sibiria weſt of Tobolſk, and twenty-five degrees weſt longitude diſtant from America. The fineſt in the known world are taken about Ufa, and in the mountains of Caucaſus . It is known that the Tſchuktſchi procure the ſkins for cloathing themſelves from the Americans; their country being deſtitute of trees, and conſequently of the animals, inhabitants of foreſts, furniſhing thoſe uſeful articles.

The Houſe Martin, Hiſt. Quad. No 199, is found neither in America, or the Arctic countries.

28. PEKAN. Hiſt. Quad. No 204.—Smellie, vii. 307.—LEV. MUS.
[78]

WEESEL. With ears a little pointed: body and head covered with hair of a mixture of grey, cheſnut, and black, and beneath protected by a cinereous down: the lower jaw encircled with white: legs and tail black: on the breaſt, between the fore-legs, a ſpot of white, and another on the belly between the hind-legs: toes covered above and below with fur.

I ſaw this and the following animal at Paris, in the cabinet of M. Aubry, Curè de St. Louis en L'Iſle. They were in glaſs caſes, ſo I could get only an imperfect view of them. According to M. de Buffon, the length of this was a foot and a half French meaſure; the tail ten inches*. The fur is fine; and the ſkins were often imported by the French from Canada.

This ſeems to me to be very nearly allied to the European Martin, No 15. Br. Zool. vol. i. It agrees very much in dimenſions, and in the white marks. It is alſo the animal which Mr. Graham ſent to the Royal Society from Hudſon's Bay, under the name of Jackaſh, which he ſays harbours about creeks, and lives on fiſh. Brings from two to four young at a time. Is caught by the natives, who eat the fleſh and barter the ſkins.

29. VISON. Hiſt. Quad. No 205.—Smellie, vii. 307.

WEESEL. With a long neck and body: ſhort legs: head and body brown tinged with tawny: tail black: the down of a bright aſh-color.

[79]Length from head to tail one foot four inches, French; tail ſeven inches, or to the end of the hairs nine.

Inhabits Canada.

Hiſt. Quad. No 201, and p. 328.—Smellie, vii. 309.30. SABLE. Muſtela Zibellina, Pallas Sp. Zool. faſc. xiv. 54. tab.

WEESEL. With head and ears whitiſh: the ears broad, inclining to a triangular form, and rounded at top, in the Aſiatic ſpecimens; in the American, rather pointed: whole body of a light tawny: feet very large, hairy above and below: claws white.

Length, from noſe to tail, twenty inches; of the trunk of the tail, four inches; from the baſe to the end of the hairs eight: of a duſky color.

This deſcription is taken from a ſkin ſent from Canada: PLACE. but it extends acroſs the whole continent, being frequently found among the furs which the Americans traffic with among the inhabitants of the Tſchuktſchi Noſs *. The American ſpecimen, which I had opportunity of examining, was of the bleached, or worſt kind; probably others may equal in value thoſe of Aſia.

The great reſidence of theſe animals is in Aſia, beginning at the Urallian chain, and growing more and more plentiful as they advance eaſtward, and more valuable as they advance more north. None are found to the north-eaſt of the Anadir, nor in any parts deſtitute of trees. They love vaſt foreſts, eſpecially thoſe of fir, in which thoſe of moſt exquiſite beauty are found. They are frequent in Kamtſchatka, and are met with in the Kuril iſles. They extend from about lat. 50 to lat. 58.

They are very eaſily made tame: will attach themſelves ſo to their maſter, as to wander a conſiderable way, and return again to their home. [80] They abhor water: therefore the notion of their being the Satherion of Ariſtotle is erroneous.

CAPTURE.Another way of taking them, beſides thoſe which I before mentioned, is by placing a piece of timber from tree to tree horizontally; near one end of this is placed a bait: over the lower piece of wood is placed another, ſuſpended obliquely, and reſting at one end on a poſt very ſlightly: a rod extends from it to a nooſe, to which the bait is faſtened. As ſoon as the Sable ſeizes the meat, the upper timber falls, and kills the precious animal*. The hunting-ſeaſon always begins with the firſt ſnows: but they are now become ſo very ſcarce, as to be confined to the vaſt foreſts of the extreme parts of Sibiria, and to the diſtant Kamtſchatka. Such has been the rage of luxury!

FURS WHEN FIRST USED AS A LUXURY.It was not till the later ages that the furs of beaſts became an article of luxury. The more refined nations of antient times never made uſe of them: thoſe alone whom the former ſtigmatized as barbarians, were cloathed in the ſkins of animals. Strabo deſcribes the Indians covered with the ſkins of Lions, Panthers, and Bears; and Seneca , the Scythians cloathed with the ſkins of Foxes, and the leſſer quadrupeds. Virgil exhibits a picture of the ſavage Hyperboreans, ſimilar to that which our late circumnavigators can witneſs to in the cloathing of the wild Americans, unſeen before by any poliſhed people.

Gens effraena virum Riphaeo tunditur Euro;
Et pecudum fulvis velantur corpora ſetis.

Moſt part of Europe was at this time in ſimilar circumſtances. Caeſar might be as much amazed with the ſkin-dreſſed heroes of Britain, as our celebrated Cook was at thoſe of his new-diſcovered regions. What time hath done to us, time, under humane conquerors, may effect for them. Civilization may take place, and thoſe ſpoils of animals, which are at preſent eſſential for cloathing, become the mere objects of ornament and luxury.

[81]I cannot find that the Greeks or old Romans ever made uſe of furs. It originated in thoſe regions where they moſt abounded, and where the ſeverity of the climate required that ſpecies of cloathing. At firſt it conſiſted of the ſkins only, almoſt in the ſtate in which they were torn from the body of the beaſt; but as ſoon as civilization took place, and manufactures were introduced, furs became the lining of the dreſs, and often the elegant facing of the robes. It is probable, that the northern conquerors introduced the faſhion into Europe. We find, that about the year 522, when Totila, king of the Viſigoths, reigned in Italy, that the Suethons (a people of modern Sweden) found means, by help of the commerce of numberleſs intervening people, to tranſmit, for the uſe of the Romans, ſaphilinas pelles, the precious ſkins of the Sables*. As luxury advanced, furs, even of the moſt valuable ſpecies, were uſed by princes as lining for their tents: thus Marco Polo, in 1252, found thoſe of the Cham of Tartary lined with Ermines and Sables. He calls the laſt Zibelines, and Zambolines. He ſays that thoſe, and other precious furs, were brought from countries far north; from the land of Darkneſs, and regions almoſt inacceſſible, by reaſon of moraſſes and ice. The Welſh ſet a high value on furs, as early as the time of Howel Dda , who began his reign about 940. In the next age, furs became the faſhionable magnificence of Europe. When Godfrey of Boulogne, and his followers, appeared before the emperor Alexis Comnene, on their way to the Holy Land, he was ſtruck with the richneſs of their dreſſes, tam ex oſtro quam aurifrigio et niveo opere harmelino et ex mardrino griſioque et vario. How different was the advance of luxury in France, from the time of their great monarch Charlemagne, who contented himſelf with the plain fur of the Otter! Henry I. wore furs; yet in his diſtreſs was obliged to change them for warm Welſh flannel§. But in the year 1337 the luxury had got to ſuch a head, that Edward III. enacted, that all perſons who could not ſpend a hundred a year, ſhould abſolutely be prohibited the uſe of this ſpecies of finery. [82] Theſe, from their great expence, muſt have been foreign furs, obtained from the Italian commercial ſtates, whoſe traffic was at this period boundleſs. How ſtrange is the revolution in the fur trade! The north of Aſia, at that time, ſupplied us with every valuable kind; at preſent we ſend, by means of the poſſeſſion of Hudſon's Bay, furs, to immenſe amount, even to Turkey and the diſtant China.

31. FISHER. Hiſt. Quad. No 202.—Smellie, v. 297.—LEV. MUS.

WEESEL. With ears broad, round, and duſky, edged with white: head and ſides of the neck pale brown mixed with aſh-color and black: hairs on the back, belly, legs, and tail, brown at the baſe, and black at their ends: ſides of the body brown.

The feet very large and broad, covered above and below thickly with hair: on each foot are five toes, with white claws, ſharp, ſtrong, and crooked: the fore legs ſhorter than thoſe behind: the tail is full and buſhy, ſmalleſt at the end. Length, from noſe to tail, is twenty-eight inches; of the tail ſeventeen.

This animal inhabits Hudſon's Bay, and is found in New England, and as low as Penſylvania. About Hudſon's Bay they are called Wejacks, and Woodſhocks. They harbour about creeks, feed upon fiſh, and probably birds. They breed once a year, and have from two to four at a birth. The natives catch them, and diſpoſe of the ſkins, which are ſold in England for four or ſix ſhillings apiece. Such is the account I received from Mr. Graham.

The late worthy Mr. Peter Collinſon tranſmitted to me the following relation, which he received from Mr. Bartram:‘They are found in Penſylvania; and, notwithſtanding they are not amphibious, are called Fiſhers, and live on all kinds of leſſer quadrupeds.’ I do not know how to reconcile theſe accounts of the ſame animal (for ſuch it is) unleſs it preys indifferently on fiſh and land animals, as is often the caſe with rapacious beaſts, and that both Mr. Graham and Bartram may have overlooked that circumſtance.

Hiſt. Quad. No 207.—Smellie, v. 297.32. STRIATED.
[83]

WEESEL. With ſmall and rounded ears: the ground color of the whole animal black, marked on the back and ſides with five long parallel lines of white; one extending from the head along the top of the back to the baſe of the tail; with two others on each ſide, the higheſt of which reaches a little way up the tail: the tail is long, and very buſhy towards the end.

This ſpecies varies in the diſpoſition of the ſtripes, and I ſuſpect the male is entirely black, as deſcribed by M. Du Pratz *; who ſays, that the female has rings of white intermixed. If that is the caſe, the Coaſe, which M. de Buffon received from Virginia, is of this kind. It is of an uniform color; but what is a ſtronger proof of their differing only in ſex, is the agreement in number of toes in the fore feet, there being four on each; an exception to the character of this Genus.

In ſize it is equal to an European Pole-cat, but carries its back more elevated.

Theſe animals are found from Penſylvania as far as Louiſiana, where they are known by the name of the Pole-cat or Skunk; which is given indifferently to both of theſe foetid beaſts.

Nature hath furniſhed this and the following a ſpecies of defence ſuperior to the force either of teeth or claws. The French moſt juſtly call theſe animals enfans du Diable, or children of the Devil, and Bêtes puantes, or the ſtinking beaſts; as the Swedes beſtow on them that of Fiſkatta. The peſtiferous vapour which it emits from behind, when it is either attacked, purſued, or frightened, is ſo ſuffocating and foetid, as at once to make the boldeſt aſſailant retire with precipitation. [84] A ſmall ſpace is often no means of ſecurity; the animal either will turn its tail, and by a frequent crepitus prevent all repetition of attempts on its liberty; or elſe ejaculate its ſtiffing urine to the diſtance of eighteen feet*. Its enemy is ſtupified with the abominable ſtench; or perhaps experiences a temporary blindneſs, ſhould any of the liquid fall on his eyes. No waſhing will free his cloaths from the ſmell: they muſt even be buried in freſh ſoil, in order to be effectually purified.

Perſons who have juſt undergone this misfortune, naturally run to the next houſe to try to free themſelves from it; but the rights of hoſpitality are denied to them: the owner, dreading the infection, is ſure to ſhut the door againſt them.

Profeſſor Kalm ran the danger of being ſuffocated by the ſtench of one, which was purſued into a houſe where he was.

A maid-ſervant, who deſtroyed another in a room where meat was kept, was ſo affected by the vapour as to continue ill for ſeveral days; and the proviſions were ſo infected, that the maſter of the houſe was forced to fling them away.

Travellers are often obliged, even in the midſt of foreſts, to hold their noſes, to prevent the effects of its ſtench.

The brute creation are in like dread of its effluvia. Cattle will roar with agony; and none but true-bred dogs will attack it: even thoſe are often obliged to run their noſes into the ground before they can return to complete its deſtruction. The ſmell of the dogs, after a combat of this nature, remains for ſeveral days intolerable.

Notwithſtanding this horrible quality, the fleſh is eaten, and is eſteemed as ſweet as that of a Pig. The bladder muſt be taken out, and the ſkin flayed off, as ſoon as the animal is killed.

I ſhould think it a very diſagreeable companion: yet it is often tamed ſo as to follow its maſter like a Dog; for it never emits its [85] vapour unleſs terrified*. It ſurely ought to be treated with the higheſt attention.

The ſkin is neglected by the Europeans, by reaſon of the coarſeneſs of the hair. The Indians make uſe of it for tobacco pouches, which they carry before them like the Highlanders.

It climbs trees with great agility. It feeds on fruits and inſects. Is a great enemy to birds, deſtroying both their eggs and young. It will alſo break into hen-rooſts, and deſtroy all the poultry. It breeds in holes in the ground, and hollow trees, where it leaves its young, while it is rambling in queſt of prey.

Hiſt. Quad. No 218.—Smellie, v: 297.—LEV. MUS.33. SKUNK.

WEESEL. With ſhort rounded ears: ſides of the face white: from the noſe to the back extends a bed of white; along the top of the back, to the baſe of the tail, is another broad one of black, bounded on each ſide by a white ſtripe: the belly, feet, and tail, black. But the colors vary: that which is figured by M. de Buffon has a white tail: the claws on all the feet very long, like thoſe of a Badger: the tail very full of hair.

This inhabits the continent of America, from Hudſon's Bay § to Peru . In the laſt it is called Chinche. It burrows like the former, and has all the ſame qualities. It is alſo found in Mexico, where it is called Conepatl, or Boy's little Fox .

OTTER. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXIV.
[86]
34. COMMON. Hiſt Quad. No 226.—Br. Zool. i. No 19.—Smellie, iv. 232.—LEV. MUS.

OTTER. With ſhort rounded ears: head flat and broad: long whiſkers: aperture of the mouth ſmall: lips very muſcular, deſigned to cloſe the mouth firmly while in the action of diving: eyes ſmall, and placed nearly above the corners of the mouth: neck ſhort: body long: legs ſhort, broad, and thick: five toes on each foot, each furniſhed with a ſtrong membrane or web: tail depreſſed, and tapering to a point.

The fur fine; of a deep brown color, with exception of a white ſpot on each ſide of the noſe, and another under the chin.

Theſe animals inhabit as far north as Hudſon's Bay, Terra di Labrador, and Canada, and as low ſouth as Carolina and Louiſiana *; but in the latter provinces are very ſcarce. The ſpecies ceaſes farther ſouth. Lawſon ſays that they are ſometimes found, to the weſtward of Carolina, of a white color, inclining to yellow. Thoſe of North America are larger than the European, and the furs of ſuch which inhabit the colder parts are very valuable. Their food is commonly fiſh; but they will alſo attack and devour the Beaver

They are found again in Kamtſchatka, and in moſt parts of northern Europe and Aſia, but not on the Arctic flats: are grown very ſcarce in Ruſſia. The Kamtſchatkans uſe their furs to face their garments, or to lap round the ſkins of Sables, which are preſerved better in Otter ſkins than any other way. They uſually hunt them with dogs, in time of deep ſnow, when the Otters wander too far from the banks of rivers.

[87]The Americans round Hudſon's Bay ſhoot or trap them for the ſake of the ſkins, which are ſent to Europe. They alſo uſe the ſkins for pouches, ornamented with bits of horn; and eat the fleſh.

Otters are probably continued along the Arctic parts of America, weſtward; being found on the moſt eaſtern, or the greater Fox Iſlands, which are ſuppoſed to be pretty near to that continent.

Leſſer Otter, Hiſt. Quad. No 228.35. MINX.

OTTER. With a white chin: rounded ears:DESCRIPTION top of the head in ſome hoary, in others tawny: the body covered with ſhort tawny hairs, and longer of a duſky color: the feet broad, webbed, and covered with hair: the tail duſky, ending in a point. This animal is of the ſhape of the common Otter, but much ſmaller: its length being only twenty inches from head to tail; of the tail only four.

It inhabits the middle provinces of North America, AMERICA. from New Jerſey to the Carolinas. I did not diſcover it among the ſkins ſent by Mr. Graham from Hudſon's Bay; the animal deſcribed as one of this ſpecies differing from the many I have ſeen from the more ſouthern colonies: yet poſſibly it may be found in a more northern latitude than that which I have given it, if the Foutereaux, an amphibious ſort of little Polecats mentioned by La Hontan, be the ſame*.

It frequents the banks of rivers, inhabiting hollow trees, or holes which it forms near the water. It has, like the Skunks, when provoked, a moſt exceſſively foetid ſmell. It lives much upon fiſh, frogs, and aquatic inſects; dives admirably, and will continue longer under water than the Muſk-beaver: yet at times it will deſert its watery haunts, and make great havoke in the poultry yards, biting off the heads of the fowls, and ſucking the blood. At times it lurks amidſt [88] the docks and bridges of towns, where it proves a uſeful enemy to rats*.

It is beſides very deſtructive to the Tortoiſe; whoſe eggs it ſcrapes out of the ſand and devours: and eats the freſh-water muſcles; whoſe ſhells are found in great abundance at the mouth of their holes. It is capable of being made tame, and domeſticated.

ASIA.The ſpecies is ſpread in Aſia, along the banks of the Yaik, in the Orenburg government. None are ſeen in Sibiria; but appear again near the rivers which run into the Amur. Its fur is in thoſe parts very valuable,EUROPE. and eſteemed as next in beauty to the Sable. It is either hunted with dogs or taken in traps. In Europe it is found in Poland and Lithuania, where it is named Nurek; and the Germans call it Nurtz. It is alſo an inhabitant of Finland: the natives call it Tichuri; the Swedes, Maenk §, a name carried into America by ſome Swediſh coloniſt, and with a ſlight variation is ſtill retained.

36. SEA. Hiſt. Quad. No 230. Lutra Marina, Kalan. Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 367. tab. xvi. Caſtor Marin, Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 444. Sea Otter, Muller, 57, 58.—LEV. MUS.

DESCRIPTION.OTTER. With hazel irides: upper jaw long, and broader than the lower: noſe black: ears erect, conic, ſmall: whiſkers long and white: in the upper jaw ſix, in the lower four, cutting teeth: grinders broad: fore legs thick; on each four toes, covered with hair, and webbed: the hind feet reſemble exactly thoſe of a Seal: the toes divided by a ſtrong ſhagreened membrane, with a ſkin ſkirting the external ſide of the outmoſt toe, in the manner of ſome water fowl.

[89]The ſkin is extremely thick, covered cloſely with long hair, remarkably black and gloſſy; and beneath that is a ſoft down. The hair ſometimes varies to ſilvery. The hair of the young is ſoft and brown.

The length, from noſe to tail, is about three feet;SIZE. that of the tail thirteen inches and a half. The tail is depreſſed, full of hair in the middle, and ſharp-pointed. The weight of the biggeſt, ſeventy or eighty pounds.

Theſe are the moſt local animals of any we are acquainted with,PLACE. being entirely confined between lat. 44 and 60, and weſt longitude 126 to 150 eaſt from London, in the coaſt and ſeas on the north-eaſt parts of America; and again only between the Kamtſchatkan ſhores and the iſles which intervene between them and America. They land alſo on the Kuril iſlands; but never are ſeen in the channel between the north-eaſt part of Sibiria and America.

They are moſt extremely harmleſs,MANNERS. and moſt ſingularly affectionate to their young. They will never deſert them, and will even pine to death on being robbed of them, and ſtrive to breathe their laſt on the ſpot where they experienced the misfortune.

It is ſuppoſed that they bring but one at a time. They go between eight and nine months with young, and ſuckle it almoſt the whole year. The young never quits its dam till it takes a mate. They are monogamous, and very conſtant.

They bring forth on land: often carry the young between their teeth, fondle them, and frequently fling them up and catch them again in their paws. Before the young can ſwim, the old ones will take them in their fore feet, and ſwim about upon their backs.

They run very ſwiftly: ſwim ſometimes on their ſides, on their backs, and often in a perpendicular direction. They are very ſportive, embrace each other, and kiſs.

They never make any reſiſtance; but endeavour, when attacked, to ſave themſelves by flight: when they have eſcaped to ſome diſtance, they will turn back, and hold one of their fore feet over their [90] eyes, to gaze, as men do their hands to ſee more clearly in a ſunny day; for they are very dull-ſighted, but remarkably quick-ſcented.

They are fond of thoſe parts of the ſea which abound moſt with weeds, where they feed on fiſh, ſepiae, lobſters, and ſhell-fiſh, which they comminute with their flat grinders.

CAPTURE.They are taken different ways: in the ſummer, by placing nets among the ſea-plants, where theſe animals retire in the frequent ſtorms of this tempeſtuous coaſt.

They are killed with clubs or ſpears, either while they lie aſleep on the rocks, or in the ſea floating on their backs.

Thirdly, they are purſued by two boats till they are tired, for they cannot endure to be long at a time under water.

During winter they are brought in great numbers to the Kurilian iſlands, by the eaſtern winds, from the American ſhore.

The hunter goes with a dog, who points them. He knocks it on the head, and flays it, while the dog is beating about for another.

They are called in the Kamtſchatkan tongue Kalan, in the plural Kalani.

Their fleſh is preferred to that of Seals by the natives; but the unfortunate crew who were ſhipwrecked in the expedition in 1741, under Captain Bering, found it to be inſipid, hard, and tough as leather; ſo that they were obliged to cut it in ſmall pieces before they could eat it. Others pretend, that the fleſh of the young is very delicate, and ſcarcely to be diſtinguiſhed from young lamb.

FUR.But the valuable part of them is their ſkin. Few are brought into Europe; but great quantities are ſold to the Chineſe, at vaſt prices, from ſeventy to a hundred rubles apiece, or 14 or 25l. ſterling each. What a profitable trade might not a colony carry on, was it poſſible to penetrate to theſe parts of North America by means of the rivers and lakes! The acceſs to Pekin would be then eaſy, by ſailing up the gulph of Petcheli. At preſent, theſe valuable furs are carried by land above three thouſand miles to the frontiers of China, where they are delivered to the merchants.

[91]Theſe animals partake very much of the nature of Seals, in their almoſt conſtant reſidence in the water, their manner of ſwimming, fin-like legs, and number of fore teeth. In their ears they greatly reſemble the little Seal of my Hiſtory of Quadrupeds, No 386, and ſeem the animals which connect the genera of Otters and Seals.

They are ſeen very remote from land, ſometimes even at the diſtance of a hundred leagues.

DIV. II. SECT. II. DIGITATED QUADRUPEDS. Without CANINE TEETH: and with two CUTTING TEETH only in each jaw.
[94] DIV. II. SECT. II. Digitated Quadrupeds. Without CANINE TEETH: and with two CUTTING TEETH only in each jaw. Generally Herbivorous, or Frugivorous.
[]
HARE. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXVI.
37. VARYING. Hiſt. Quad. No 242.—Alpine Hare, Br. Zool. i. No 21.—LEV. MUS.

HARE. With the edges of the ears and tips black: the colors, in ſummer, cinereous, mixed with black and tawny: tail always white.

Mr. Graham ſays, that thoſe of Hudſon's Bay are of the ſame ſize with the common; but thoſe which I have examined in Scotland are much leſs, weighing only ſix pounds and a half: the common Hare weighs upwards of eight.

This ſpecies inhabits Greenland, where alone they continue white throughout the year*; and are very numerous amidſt the ſnowy mountains. They are uſually fat; and feed on graſs, and the white moſs of the country. They are found about the rocks at Churchill, and the ſtreights of Hudſon's Bay; but are not common. They breed once a year, and bring two at a time They change their color to white at approach of winter. They are met with in Canada and Newfoundland; after which the ſpecies ceaſes to the ſouthward, or at leſt I have no authority for its being continued; the Hare of New England ſeeming, by Joſſelyn's account, to be the following ſpecies.

[95]The Greenlanders eat the fleſh dreſſed, and the contents of the ſtomach raw. They uſe the excrements for wick for their lamps; and cloath their children with the ſoft and warm ſkins.

This ſpecies abounds from Livonia to the north-eaſt part of Sibiria and Kamtſchatka; and from Archangel to Saratof, on the banks of the Wolga, in eaſt lat. 49. 52, and even farther into the Orenburg government. In Sibiria they quit the lofty mountains, the ſouthern boundaries of that country, and, collecting in flocks innumerable, at approach of winter migrate to the plains, and northern wooded parts, where vegetation and food abound. Mr. Bell met with them daily in their progreſs*. Multitudes of them are taken in toils by the country people, not for the ſake of the fleſh, but the ſkins; which are ſent to Peterſburg, and from thence exported to various parts.

American Hare, Ph. Tranſ. lxii. 4. 376. Hiſt. Quad. No 243.38. AMERICAN.

HARE. With ears tipt with grey: neck and body ruſty, cinereous, and black: legs pale ruſt color: belly white: tail black above, white beneath.

The diſtinctions between this and the common Hares and varying Hares are theſe:—They are leſs, weighing only from three pounds eight ounces to four pounds and a half:SIZE. the length to the ſetting-on of the tail only nineteen inches. The hind legs are longer in proportion than thoſe of the common Hare or varying Hare; the length of this, from the noſe to the tip of the hind legs, extended, being two feet five: of a varying Hare, meaſured at the ſame time, in Hudſon's Bay, OF A VARYING HARE. only two feet ſeven and a half; but from the noſe to the tail was two feet: its weight ſeven pounds ſix ounces.

[96]Theſe animals are found from Hudſon's Bay to the extremity of North America; but ſwarm in countries bordering on the former. In the time of M. Jeremie, who reſided in Hudſon's Bay from 1708 to 1714, twenty-five thouſand were taken in one ſeaſon*. At preſent they are a principal winter food to our reſidents there. They are taken in wire ſnares, placed at certain intervals in ſmall openings made in a long extent of low hedging formed for that purpoſe; the animals never attempting to jump over, but always ſeek the gaps. Theſe hedges are removed, on the falling of the ſnows, to other places, when the Rabbets ſeek new tracks. Their fleſh is very good; but almoſt brown, like that of the Engliſh Hare.

From Hudſon's Bay, as low as New England, theſe animals, at approach of winter, receive a new coat, which conſiſts of a multitude of long white hairs, twice as long as the ſummer fur, which ſtill remains beneath. About the middle of April they begin to ſhed their winter covering.

From New England ſouthward they retain their brown color the whole year. In both warm and cold climates they retain the ſame nature of never burrowing; but lodge in the hollow of ſome decayed tree, to which they run in caſe they are purſued. In the cultivated parts of America, they make great havoke among the fields of cabbage, or turnips. In Carolina, they frequent meadows and marſhy places; and are very ſubject to have maggots breed in the ſkin§. In that province they breed very often, and even in the winter months, and bring from two to ſix at a time; but uſually two or four.

I know of no uſe that is made of the ſkins, excepting that the natives of Hudſon's Bay wrap them round the limbs of their children, to preſerve them againſt the cold.

**Without a tail.
Hiſt. Quad. No 248.—Blackb. Muſ. 39. ALPIN [...]
[97]

HARE. With ſhort, broad, rounded ears: long head, and whiſkers: fur duſky at the roots; of a bright bay near the ends; tips white: intermixed are divers long duſky hairs.

Length nine inches.

Found from the Altaic chain to lake Baikal, and from thence to Kamtſchatka. They dwell amidſt the ſnows of the loftieſt and moſt dreadful rocky mountains, and never deſcend to the plains. They alſo are ſaid to inhabit the fartheſt Fox or Aleutian iſlands: therefore poſſibly may be met with in America.

The manners are ſo amply deſcribed in my Hiſtory of Quadrupeds, that I ſhall not repeat an account of them.

BEAVER. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXVII.
[98]
40. CASTOR. Hiſt. Quad. No 251.—Smellie, v. 21.—LEV. MUS.

DESCRIPTION.BEAVER. With a blunt noſe: ears ſhort, rounded, and hid in the fur: eyes ſmall: very ſtrong cutting teeth: hair of a deep cheſnut brown: fore feet ſmall, and the toes divided: hind feet large, and the toes webbed: the tail eleven inches long, and three broad; almoſt oval, flat, and covered with thin ſcales.

The uſual length, from noſe to tail, is about two feet four; but I have meaſured the ſkin of one, which was near three feet long.

Beavers vary in color. They are ſometimes found of a deep black, eſpecially in the north. In Sir Aſhton Lever's muſeum is a ſpecimen quite white. As they advance ſouthward, the beauty of their fur decreaſes. Among the Illinois they are tawny, and even as pale as ſtraw color*.

PLACE.In North America theſe animals are found in great plenty all round Hudſon's Bay, and as low as Carolina and Louiſiana . They are not known in Eaſt Florida §. The ſpecies alſo ceaſes before it arrives in South America. To ſpeak with preciſion, it commences in lat. 60, or about the river of Seals, in Hudſon's Bay; and is loſt in lat. 30, in Louiſiana.

From Hudſon's Bay and Canada, I can trace them weſtward to 120 degrees of longitude, as far as the tract weſt of Lac Rouge, or the Red lake. The want of diſcovery prevents us from knowing whether they are continued to the weſtern extremity of this great continent oppoſite to Aſia: probably they are, for the Ruſſian adventurers got ſome of their ſkins on the iſle of Kadjak, which the natives muſt [99] have had from America. They certainly are not found in the iſlands of the new Archipelago; nor yet in Kamtſchatka *, by reaſon of the interruption of woods, beyond the river Konyma. From thence I doubt whether they are met with aſſociated, or in a civilized ſtate, nearer than thebanks of the river Jeneſei, or the Konda, and other rivers which run into the Oby: but they are found ſcattered in the woody parts of independent Tartary; alſo in Caſan, and about the Yaik, in the Orenburg government. In the ſame unſociable ſtate they inhabit Europe, and are found in Ruſſia, in Lapland, Norway, and Sweden.

Theſe are the moſt ſagacious and induſtrious of animals.SAGACITY. They live in ſociety, and unite in their labors, for the good of the commonwealth they form. They erect edifices, ſuperior in contrivance to the human beings. They uſually live near, and ſhew a dexterity in their oeconomy unequalled by the four-footed race.

In order to form a habitation, they ſelect a level piece of ground,DWELLINGS. with a ſmall rivulet running in the midſt. To effect their works, a community of two or three hundred aſſembles: every individual bears his ſhare in the laborious preparation.LABORS. Some fall trees of great ſize, by gnawing them aſunder with their teeth, in order to form beams or piles; others are employed in rolling the pieces to the water; others dive, and ſcrape holes with their feet in order to fix them; and another ſet exert their efforts to rear them in their proper places. A fifth party is buſied in collecting twigs to wattle the piles. A ſixth, in collecting earth, ſtones, and clay; others carry it on their broad tails to proper places, and with their feet beat and temper the earth into mortar, or ram it between the piles, or plaiſter the inſide of the houſes.

All theſe preparations are to form their dwellings within an artificial piece of water or pond,DAMS. which they make by raiſing a dam acroſs the level ſpot they had pitched on. This is done, firſt by driving [100] into the ground ſtakes, five or ſix feet long, placed in rows, and ſecuring each row by wattling it with twigs, and filling the interſtices with clay, ramming it down cloſe. The ſide next to the water is ſloped, the other perpendicular. The bottom is from ten to twelve feet thick; the thickneſs gradually diminiſhes to the top, which is about two or three. The centre of the dam forms a ſegment of a circle; from which extends, on each ſide, a ſtrait wing: in the midſt of the centre is uſually a gutter left for the waſte water to diſcharge itſelf. Theſe dams are often a hundred feet long, and nicely covered with turf.

HOUSES.The houſes theſe wiſe animals make, are placed in the water collected by means of the dam, and are ſeated near the ſhore. They are built upon piles, and are ſometimes round, ſometimes oval; the tops are vaulted, ſo that their inſide reſembles an oven, their outſide a dome. The walls are made of earth, ſtones, and ſticks, and uſually two feet thick. They are commonly about eight feet high above the ſurface of the water*, and are very neatly and cloſely plaiſtered on the inſide. The floor is a foot higher than the water. The houſe, ſometimes, has only one floor, which is ſtrewed with leaves or moſs, on which each Beaver lies in its proper place; at other times there are three apartments; one to lodge, another to eat in, and a third to dung in: for they are very cleanly, and inſtantly cauſe the filth to be carried off by the inferior Beavers.

M. Du Pratz ſays, that thoſe of Louiſiana form numbers of cells, and that each animal, or more probably each pair, poſſeſs one. He ſays, that he has ſeen no leſs than fifteen of theſe cells ſurrounding the centre of one houſe. He alſo acquaints us, that the Beavers of Louiſiana are a third leſs than the brown ſort; are covered with a cinereous down, which is covered with long ſilvery hairs.

In each houſe are two openings; one towards the land, the other is within, and communicates with the water, for the conveniency of [101] getting to their magazine of proviſion in froſty weather.MAGAZINES. This orifice is formed ſo as to be beyond the thickneſs of the ice; for they lodge their proviſions under the water, and dive and bring it into their houſe according as they want it.

Their food is laid in before winter by the tenants of each houſe;FOOD. it conſiſts of the bark and boughs of trees. Lawſon ſays that they are fondeſt of the ſaſſafras, aſh, and ſweet gum. In ſummer they live on leaves, fruits, and ſometimes crabs and cray-fiſh; but they are not fond of fiſh.

The number of houſes in each pond is from ten to twenty-five:NUMBER OF HOUSES; the number of animals in each, from two to thirty. They are ſuppoſed to aſſociate in pairs; are therefore monogamous: another proof of their advances towards civilization.

I think I have heard that every family conſiſts of an even number.OF INHABITANTS. Sometimes the community, within the precinct of a dam, conſiſts of four hundred; but I preſume this muſt be in places little frequented by mankind.

They begin to build their houſes, when they form a new ſettlement, in the ſummer; and it coſts them a whole ſeaſon to finiſh their work, and lay in their proviſions.

They are very attentive to their ſafety; and on any noiſe take to the water for their further ſecurity. They form vaults or burrows in the banks of the creek formed by the dam, into which they retreat in caſe of imminent danger.

They ſeem to be among quadrupeds, what Bees are among inſects. They have a chief, or ſuperintendant, in their works,OVERSEERS. who directs the whole. The utmoſt attention is paid to him by the whole community. Every individual has his taſk allotted, which they undertake with the utmoſt alacrity. The overſeer gives a ſignal by a certain number of ſmart ſlaps with his tail, expreſſive of his orders. The moment the artificers hear it, they haſten to the place thus pointed out, and perform the allotted labor, whether it is to carry wood, or draw the clay, or repair any accidental breach.

[102] CENTINELS.They have alſo their centinels, who, by the ſame kind of ſignal, give notice of any apprehended danger.

SLAVES.They are ſaid to have a ſort of ſlaviſh Beaver among them (analogous to the Drone) which they employ in ſervile works, and the domeſtic drudgery*.

I have mentioned before their ſagacity in laying in the winter proviſion.THEIR WOOD HOW CUT. They cut the wood they prefer into certain lengths; pile them in heaps beneath the water, to keep them moiſt; and, when they want food, bite the wood into ſmall pieces, and bring it into their houſes. The Indians obſerve the quantity which the Beavers lay in their magazine at approach of winter. It is the Almanack of the Savages; who judge from the greater or leſs ſtock, of the mildneſs or ſeverity of the approaching ſeaſon.

The expedition with which they cut down trees, for the forming their dams, is amazing. A number ſurrounds the body, and will in a few minutes gnaw through a tree of three feet in circumference; and always contrive to make it fall towards the ſpot they wiſh.

Beavers have in America variety of lakes and waters in which they might fix their ſeats; but their ſagacity informs them of the precarious tenure of ſuch dwellings, which are liable to be overthrown by every flood. This induces them to undertake their mighty and marvellous labors. They therefore ſelect places where no ſuch inconveniences can be felt. They form a dam to ſupport a reſervoir, fed only by a ſmall rill; and provide for the overflow of the waſte water by a ſuitable channel in the middle of their bank. They have nothing to fear but from land floods, or the ſudden melting of the ſnows. Theſe ſometimes make breaches, or damage their houſes; but the defects are inſtantly repaired.

During the winter they never ſtir out, except to their magazines of proviſion; and in that ſeaſon grow exceſſively fat.

They are ſtrongly attached to certain haunts, there being places winch they will not quit, notwithſtanding they are frequently diſturbed. [103] There is, ſays Charlevoix, a ſtrong inſtance on the road between Montreal and lake Huron, which travellers, through wantonneſs, annually moleſt; yet is always repaired by the induſtrious inhabitants.

In violent inundations they are ſometimes overpowered in their attempts to divert the fury of the water. In thoſe caſes they fly into the woods: the females return as ſoon as the water abates; the males continue abſent till July, when they come back to repair the ravages made in their houſes*.

Bearvers breed once a year, and bring forth the latter end of winter; and have two or three young at a birth.

There is a variety of the Beaver kind,TERRIER BEAVERS. which wants either the ſagacity or the induſtry of the others, in forming dams and houſes. Theſe are called Terriers. They burrow in the banks of rivers, and make their holes beneath the freezing depth of the water, and work upwards for a great number of feet. Theſe alſo form their winter magazines of proviſion. Beavers which eſcape the deſtruction of a community, are ſuppoſed often to become Terriers.

Strange animal ſeen by Mr. Phipps and others in Newfoundland, of a ſhining black: bigger than a Fox: ſhaped like an Italian grehound: legs long: tail long and taper. One gentleman ſaw five ſitting on a rock with their young, at the mouth of a river; often leapt in and dived, and brought up trouts, which they gave to their young. When he ſhewed himſelf, they all leapt into the water, and ſwam a little way from ſhore, put their heads out of the water and looked at him. An old furrier ſaid, he remembered a ſkin of one ſold for five guineas. The French often ſee them in Hare Bay.

Beavers have, beſides man, two enemies; the Otter,THEIR ENEMIES. and the Wolverene; which watch their appearance, and deſtroy them. The laſt is on tha [...] account called, in ſome parts of America, the Beaver-eater. They are very eaſily overcome; for they make no reſiſtance: and have no ſecurity but in flight.

[104]It is not wonderful that ſuch ſociable animals ſhould be very affectionate. Two young Beavers, which were taken alive and brought to a neighboring factory in Hudſon's Bay, were preſerved for ſome time; and throve very faſt, till one of them was killed by an accident. The ſurvivor inſtantly felt the loſs, began to moan, and abſtained from food till it died*.

HOW TAKEN.They are taken ſeveral ways: ſometimes in log-traps, baited with poplar ſticks, laid in a path near the water. The Indians always waſh their hands before they bait the traps, otherwiſe the ſagacious animal is ſure to ſhun the ſnare.

Sometimes they are ſhot, either while they are at work, or at food, or in ſwimming acroſs the rivers. But theſe methods are uſed only in ſummer, and not much practiſed; for the ſkins in that ſeaſon are far leſs valuable than in the winter. At that time they are taken in nets placed above and below their houſes, acroſs the creeks, on ſtakes. If the water is frozen, the ice is cut from ſhore to ſhore, in order to put down the ſtakes. When the net is ſet, the Indians ſend their women to the Beaver-houſes to diſturb the animals; who dart into the water, and are uſually taken in the net, which is inſtantly hauled up; and put down again with all expedition. If the Beaver miſſes the net, it ſometimes returns to its houſe, but oftener into the vaults on the ſides of the banks; but the poor creature ſeldom eſcapes, being purſued into all his retreats, the houſes being broke open, and the vaults ſearched by digging along the ſhores.

The value of the fur of theſe animals, in the manufacture of hats, is well known. It began to be in uſe in England in the reign of Charles I., when the manufacture was regulated, in 1638, by proclamation; in which is an expreſs prohibition of uſing any materials except Beaver ſtuff, or Beaver wool; and the hats called demi-caſtors were forbidden to be made, unleſs for exportation.

This cauſed a vaſt encreaſe of demand for the ſkins of the Beavers. The Indians, on the diſcovery of America, ſeem to have paid very [105] little attention to them, amidſt the vaſt variety of beaſts they at that time poſſeſſed, both for food and cloathing. But about the period of the faſhion of hats, they became an article of commerce, and object of chaſe. The ſouthern colonies ſoon became exhauſted of their Beavers; and of later years the traffic has been much confined to Canada and Hudſon's Bay. The importance of this trade, and the ravages made among the animal creation in thoſe parts, will appear by the following ſtate of the imports into the ports of London and Rochelle in 1743. I take that year, as I have no other comparative ſtate:

Hudſon's Bay company ſale, begun November 17th 1743.
  • 26,750 Beaver ſkins.
  • 14,730 Martins.
  • 590 Otters.
  • 1,110 Cats, i. e. Lynx.
  • 320 Fox.
  • 600 Wolverenes.
  • 320 Black Bears.
  • 1,850 Wolves.
  • 40 Woodſhocks, or Fiſhers.
  • 10 Minx.
  • 5 Raccoon.
  • 120 Squirrels.
  • 130 Elks, i. e. Stags.
  • 440 Deer.
Imported into Rochelle in the ſame year.
  • 127,080 Beavers.
  • 16,512 Bears.
  • 110,000 Raccoon.
  • 30,325 Martins.
  • 12,428 Otters and Fiſhers.
  • 1,700 Minx.
  • 1,220 Cats.
  • [106]1,267 Wolves.
  • 92 Wolverenes.
  • 10,280 Grey Foxes and Cats.
  • 451 Red Foxes.

This great balance in favor of the French ariſes not only from their ſuperior honeſty in their dealings with the ignorant Indians, but the advantageous ſituation of Canada for the fur trade. They had both ſides of the river St. Lawrence; the country round the five great lakes; and the countries bordering on the rivers flowing into them; and finally, the fine fur countries bordering on the Hudſon's Bay company, many of whoſe waters falling into the St. Lawrence, gave an eaſy conveyance of thoſe commodities to Montreal; where a fair is annually kept, with all the ſavage circumſtances attendant on Indian concourſe.

The traffic carried on in Hudſon's Bay is chiefly brought from the chain of lakes and rivers that empty themſelves into the bay at Nelſon's river, running ſoutherly from lat. 56 to lat. 45. Lake Pachegoia is the moſt northerly: there the Indians rendezvous in March, to make their canoes for the tranſportation of the furs; for at that ſeaſon the bark of the birch-tree ſeparates very eaſily from the wood.

41. MUSK. Hiſt. Quad. No 252.—Smellie, v. 260.

BEAVER. With a thick noſe, blunt at the end: ears ſhort, hid in the fur: eyes large: body thick, and in form quite reſembles that of the Beaver; its color, and that of the head, a reddiſh brown: breaſt and belly cinereous, tinged with ruſt-color: the fur is very ſoft and fine.

The toes on every foot are diſtinct and divided: thoſe of the hind feet fringed on both ſides with ſtiff hairs or briſtles, cloſely ſet together: tail compreſſed, and thin at the edges, covered with ſmall ſcales, with a few hairs intermixed.

[107]Length, from noſe to tail, one foot: of the tail nine inches.

Theſe animals are in ſome parts of America called the Little Beaver, on account of its form, and ſome parts of its oeconomy. From its ſcent it is ſtyled the Muſk Rat, and Muſquaſh. The Hurons call it Ondathra; from which M. de Buffon gives it the name of Ondatra *.

It is found from Hudſon's Bay to as low at leſt as Carolina . Like the Beaver, it forms its houſe of a round ſhape, covered with a dome, and conſtructed with herbs and reeds cemented with clay. At the bottom and ſides are ſeveral pipes, through which they paſs in ſearch of food; for they do not lay in a ſtock of proviſion, like the former. They alſo form ſubterraneous paſſages, into which they retreat whenever their houſes are attacked.

Theſe houſes are only intended for winter habitations; are deſerted, and rebuilt annually. During ſummer, they live in pairs, and bring forth their young from three to ſix at a time. At approach of winter, they conſtruct their houſes, and retire into them, in order to be protected from the inclemency of the ſeaſon. Several families occupy the ſame dwelling, which is oft-times covered many feet with ſnow and ice; but they creep out and feed on the roots which lie beneath. They are very fond of the Acorus Verus, or Calamus Aromaticus . This perhaps gives them that ſtrong muſky ſmell theſe animals are ſo remarkable for; which they loſe during winter, probably when this ſpecies of plant is not to be got. They alſo feed on the freſh-water Muſſels. They feed too on fruit; for Kalm ſays, that apples are the baits uſed for them in traps. We may add, that in winter they eat the roots of nettles, and in ſummer, ſtrawberries and raſberries, during which time it is rare to ſee the male and female ſeparate.

The fleſh is ſometimes eaten. The fur is made uſe of in the manufacture of hats. The Muſk-bag is ſometimes put among cloths, to preſerve them from worms or inſects

Theſe animals, as well as the Beaver, ſeem to have their Terriers, or ſome which do not give themſelves the trouble of building houſes, [108] but burrow, like Water-rats, in banks adjacent to lakes, rivers, and ditches*, and often do much damage, by admitting the water through the embankments of meadows. They continue in their holes, except when they are in the water in ſearch of food. They make their neſts with ſticks, placing a lining of ſome ſoft materials within. Charlevoix adds, that they ſometimes make uſe of a hollow tree for their reſidence.

When taken young, they are capable of being tamed; are very playful and inoffenſive, and never bite.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXVIII.PORCUPINE.
[109]
Hiſt. Quad. No 257.—LEV. MUS.42. CANADA.

PORCUPINE. With ſhort ears, hid in the fur: hair on the head, body, legs, and upper part of the tail, long, ſoft, and of a dark brown color; but ſometimes found white: on the upper part of the head, body, and tail, are numbers of ſtrong ſharp quils; the longeſt, which are thoſe on the back, are three inches long; the ſhorteſt are towards the head and on the ſides, and concealed in the hair; mixed with them are certain ſtiff ſtraggling hairs, at leſt three inches longer than the others, tipt with dirty white: the under ſide of the tail is white.

On each fore foot are four toes; on the hind five; all armed with long claws, hollowed on the under ſide.

The ſize of one, which Sir JOSEPH BANKS brought from Newfoundland, was about that of a Hare, but more compactly made; the back arched; and the whole form reſembling that of the Beaver: the tail is ſix inches long, which, in walking, is carried a little bent upwards.

This ſpecies inhabits America, from Hudſon's Bay to Canada *, Newfoundland, New England, and, but rarely, as far ſouth as Virginia . Lawſon makes no mention of it among the animals of Carolina. Du Pratz ſays, it loves the cold, and is found on the banks of the Illinois. It may therefore be ranked among the local northern animals.

They are found in great plenty about Hudſon's Bay, where the trading Indians depend much on them for food. They are reckoned excellent eating, even by the Europeans, taſting, when roaſted, like ſucking-pig. [110] The bones, during winter, are of a greeniſh yellow, owing, as is ſuppoſed, to their feeding during that ſeaſon on the bark of the pine. It is obſerved, that the bones of animals ſometimes take a tincture from their diet; for example, thoſe of beaſts which feed on madder become red*. They are alſo very fond of the bark of juniper. In ſummer, they live on the wild fruits, and lap water, but will not go into it. In winter, take ſnow by way of beverage.

They neſtle under the roots of great trees, and will alſo, in queſt of fruits, aſcend the boughs. When the Indians diſcover one in a tree, they cut it down, and kill the animal by a blow on the noſe.

They defend themſelves with their quills. They fly from their purſuer; but when they cannot eſcape, will ſidle towards their enemy, in order to puſh their quils into him: they are but weak inſtruments of offence; for a ſmall ſtroke with the hand againſt the grain will bring them from the ſkin, leaving them ſticking ſlightly in the fleſh. The Indians uſe them to make holes in their noſes and ears, for the placing their noſe and ear-rings, and other finery. They alſo trim the edges of their deer-ſkin habits with fringes of dyed quils, or make pretty linings with them for the bark boxes.

They are very indolent animals, ſleep much, and ſeldom travel a mile from their haunts.

M. de Buffon gives two figures of this beaſt, under the name of Le Coendou and L'Urſon. The firſt he makes an inhabitant of Braſil: the laſt, of Hudſon's Bay: but the Coendou is a very different animal§. The two figures he has exhibited are of our Porcupine in the winter and ſummer dreſs, the hair growing thinner as the warm ſeaſon approaches. His Coendou ſhews it in the firſt ſtate, his Urſon in the ſecond**.

They are ſaid to copulate in September, and to bring only one young, the firſt week in April; another, which it brings forth, being always dead††.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXIX.MARMOT.
[111]
Hiſt. Quad. No 259.43. QUEBEC. Mus empetra, PALLAS Nov. Sp. Quad. faſc. i. 75.

MARMOT. With ſhort rounded ears: blunt noſe: cheeks ſwelled, and of a cinereous color: end of the noſe black: top of the head cheſnut: the hair on the back grey at the bottom, black in the middle, and the tips whitiſh: the belly and legs of a deep orange, or a bright ferruginous color.

Toes black, naked, and quite divided: four toes, with the rudiments of another, on the fore feet, five on the hind feet: tail ſhort, duſky, and full of hair.

The ſpecimen which I ſaw formerly at Mr. Brook's, alive, appeared larger than a Rabbet; but the ſpecimen in the Royal Society's Muſeum * was only eleven inches long from noſe to the tail, and the tail three inches. This probably was a young one.

Hiſt. Quad. No 260.—Smellie, iv. 346.44. MARYLAND.

MARMOT. With prominent dark eyes: ſhort rounded ears: noſe ſharper-pointed than that of the laſt, and of a cinereous colour: head and body of a brown color, which is lighter on the ſides, and ſtill more ſo on the belly: the legs and feet duſky: toes long, and divided: claws long, and ſharp: tail duſky, and buſhy; half the length of the body: a ſpecific diſtinction from the other kinds.

Size of a Rabbet.

[112]Inhabits the temperate and warm parts of North America, from Penſylvania to the Bahama Iſlands. It feeds on fruits, berries, and vegetables. In the provinces it inhabits the hollows of trees, or burrows under ground, ſleeping for a month together. The European ſpecies continues dormant half the year: whether it takes a long deep in the warm climate of the Bahamas I am uncertain. It dwells there among the rocks, and makes its retreat into the holes on the approach of the hunters. In thoſe iſlands it is very fond of the berries of the Ehretia Bourreria, called there Strong Back. The fleſh is reckoned very good, but reſembles more that of a Pig than a Rabbet*.

It is called there the Bahama Coney. By Mr. Edwards, who figures one from Maryland, the Monax, or Marmot of America .

45. HOARY. Hiſt. Quad. No 261.—LEV. MUS.

MARMOT. With the tip of the noſe black: ears ſhort, and oval: cheeks whitiſh: crown duſky and tawny: hair in all parts rude and long; on the back, ſides, and belly, cinereous at the bottoms, black in the middle, and tipped with white, ſo as to ſpread a hoarineſs over the whole: legs black: claws duſky: tail full of hair, black and ferruginous.

Size of the preceding.

Inhabits the northern parts of North America.

46. TAIL-LESS. Hiſt. Quad. No —LEV. MUS.

MARMOT. With ſhort ears: color of the head and body a cinereous brown: the extremities of the hairs white: two cutting teeth above, four below: no tail.

About the ſize of the common Marmot.

Inhabits Hudſon's Bay.

Hiſt. Quad. No 263.—Smellie, viii. 234.47. EAR-LESS.
[113]

MARMOT. Without ears: face cinereous: back, and hind part of the head, of a light yellowiſh brown; ſometimes ſpotted diſtinctly with white, at others undulated with grey: belly and legs of a yellowiſh white: tail about four inches and a half long. Length, from noſe to tail, about nine and a half. But there is a pygmy variety wholly yellow, and with a ſhort tail, frequent near the ſalt lakes, between the mouths of the Yaik and the Jemba.

Inhabits Bohemia, Auſtria, and Hungary, and in the Ruſſian empire; begins to be common about the Occa, eaſt of Moſcow; extends over all the temperate and open parts of Sibiria, and about Jakutſk, and in Kamtſchatka. It is alſo on the iſland of Kadjak, and was ſeen in great numbers by Steller on Schamagin's iſles, almoſt cloſe on the ſhore of North America, which give it place in this part of the work.

They burrow, and ſink the pipes to their retreats obliquely,MANNERS. and then winding; and at the end is an arched oblong chamber, a foot in diameter, ſtrewed with dried graſs. The entrances, or pipes, of the males are of greater, and thoſe of the females of leſſer, diameters. Towards winter they make a new pipe to their neſt, but that only reaches to the turf; and with the earth which is taken out they fill up the ſummer pipe.

They live entirely in a ſtate of ſolitude, unleſs in the amorous ſeaſon, when the females are found in the ſame burrows with the males; but they bring forth in their own burrows, and by that means prevent the males from deſtroying the young, as they cannot enter by reaſon of the narrowneſs of the pipes, the males being ſuperior in ſize to their mates. They ſleep all night; but in the morning quit their holes, eſpecially in fine weather, and feed and ſport till approach of night. If the males approach one another, they fight ſharply. The females often ſet up a very ſharp whiſtle; the males are, for the moſt part, ſilent. At the ſight of a man, they [114] inſtantly run into their burrows; and are often ſeen ſtanding upright, and looking about them, as if on the watch: and if they ſpy any body, give a loud whiſtle, and diſappear.

They are very eaſily tamed, and become very ſportive and amuſing; and are very fond of being ſtroked and cheriſhed. In this ſtate they will eat grain, and many ſorts of herbs. In a wild ſtate they prey on mice, and ſmall birds, as well as vegetables. Gmeli [...] ſays, that in Sibiria they inhabit granaries; but I do not find it confirmed by Doctor Pallas. Gmelin adds, that thoſe who frequent granaries, ſeek for prey during the whole winter*: as to the others, they certainly remain torpid all the ſevere ſeaſon, and revive on the melting of the ſnows.

They bring forth from three to eight at a time. The young grow very quick, and deſert the maternal burrows in the ſummer.

Their enemies are all ſorts of Weeſels, which dig them out of their holes. More males than females periſh, as the latter are fiercer, and defend themſelves much better. During day they are ſnatched up by hawks and hungry crows.

In ſome places they are taken in ſnares, for the ſake of their ſkins, which are uſually ſent to China. The Kamtſchatkans make moſt elegant garments and hoods of them; ſpecimens of the latter are preſerved in the Leverian Muſeum. In Sibiria their fleſh is eſteemed a great delicacy, eſpecially in autumn, when they are a lump of fat.

The Ruſſians call them Suſlik; the Sibirians, Jevraſcha, and Jemuranka; the Kamtſchatkans, Syraeth.

A. BOBAK, Hiſt.Quad. No 262.—Smellie, vii. 198.
[115]

MARMOT. With ſhort oval thick ears: ſmall eyes: upper part of the body greyiſh, mixed with long black and duſky hairs, tipt with grey: throat ruſt-colored: reſt of the body and inſide of the limbs yellowiſh ruſt: four claws on the fore feet, and a ſhort thumb furniſhed with a ſtrong claw: five toes behind: tail ſhort, ſlender, and full of hair. Length ſixteen inches: of the tail five.

Inhabits Poland, the Ukraine, Tartary, Sibiria, and even in plenty in Kamtſchatka.

Its manners moſt amply deſcribed in the Hiſtory of Quadrupeds.

SQUIRREL. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXX. N. B. The ears of the American Squirrels have no tufts.
[116]
48. HUDSON.Hudſon's Bay Squirrel, Hiſt. Quad. No 274.—LEV. MUS.

SQUIRREL. Of a ferruginous colour, marked along the top of the back with a line of a deeper hue: belly of a pale aſh-color, mottled with black, and divided from the ſides by a duſky line: tail ſhorter and leſs buſhy than that of the European kind; of a ruſt-color, barred, and ſometimes edged with black.

Inhabits the pine-foreſts of Hudſon's Bay and Labrador: live upon the cones: keep in their neſts the whole winter. Are found as high as the Copper river; yet do not change their colors by the ſeverity of the winter, like the Petits gris of northern Europe and Aſia, from which they form a diſtinct ſpecies. I know of only one exception in change of color in thoſe of America, Sir Aſhton Lever being poſſeſſed of a ſpecimen of a milky whiteneſs; but he did not know from what part of the continent it came.

α. Carolina *. With the head, back, and ſides, grey, white, and ferruginous, intermixed: belly white: the color divided from that of the ſides by a ruſt-coloured line: lower part of the legs red: tail brown, mixed with black, and edged with white.

Both theſe are rather leſs than the European Squirrels.

49. GREY. Hiſt. Quad. No 272.—Smellie, v. 321.—LEV. MUS.

SQUIRREL. With hair of a dull grey color, intermixed with black, and frequently tinged with dull yellow: belly white. But they vary, the body being ſometimes of a fine uniform grey.

[117]This is the largeſt of the genus, and grows to half the ſize of a Rabbet.

In America I do not diſcover this animal farther north than New England *; from whence they are found in vaſt numbers as far ſouth as Louiſiana . Theſe, and the other ſpecies of Squirrels, are the greateſt peſts to the farmers of North America. They ſwarm in ſeveral of the provinces, and often deſcend in troops from the back ſettlements, and join the reſt in their ravages on the plantations of mayz, and the various nuts and maſt which that fertile country produces.

Thoſe which migrate from the mountains generally arrive in autumn; inſtantly clear the ground of the fallen acorns, nuts, and maſt, and form with them magazines for their winter proviſions, in holes which they dig under ground for that purpoſe. They are often robbed of their hoards; for the coloniſts take great pains to find them out; and oft-times the hogs, which rove about the woods, root up and devour their magazines. It is from theſe that they ſupply themſelves, from time to time, with proviſions, quitting their neſts, and returning with a ſufficient ſtock to laſt them for ſome ſpace; it being obſerved, that during winter they do not care to quit their warm retreat, unleſs on a viſit to their ſtorehouſes; therefore, whenever they are obſerved to run about the woods in greater numbers than uſual, it is a certain ſign of the near approach of ſevere cold; for inſtinct directs them to lay in a greater ſtock than uſual, leaſt the inclemency of the weather ſhould deprive them of acceſs to their ſubterraneous magazines.

The damage which they do to the poor planters, by deſtroying the mayz, is incredible. They come by hundreds into the fields, climb up the ſtalks, and eat the ſweet corn wrapt up in the heads, and will deſtroy a whole plantation in a night. For this reaſon they were proſcribed. In ſome places the inhabitants were, each, obliged annually to bring in four Squirrels heads. In others, a ſum was given, [118] about three pence, for every one that was killed. This proved ſuch an encouragement, as to ſet all the idle people in the province in purſuit of them. Penſylvania paid, from January 1749 to January 1750, 8000l. currency: but on complaint being made by the deputies, that their treaſuries were exhauſted by theſe rewards, they were reduced to one half. How improved muſt the ſtate of the Americans then be, in thirty-five years, to wage an expenſive and ſucceſsful war againſt its parent country, which before could not bear the charges of clearing the provinces from the ravages of theſe inſignificant animals!

It has been obſerved, that the Squirrels are greatly multiplied within theſe few years, and that in proportion to the encreaſe of the fields of mayz, which attract them from all parts; I mean not only the grey ſpecies, but all the others.

They are eaten by ſome people, and are eſteemed very delicate. Their ſkins, in America, are uſed for ladies ſhoes; and are often imported into England, for lining or facing for cloaks.

They make their neſts in hollow trees, with moſs, ſtraw, wool, and other warm materials. They chiefly inhabit trees of the deciduous kind; but ſometimes in pines, whoſe cones are an article of their proviſion. They keep their neſts for ſeveral days together, ſeldom ſtirring out, except for a freſh ſupply of food. Should a deep ſnow prevent them from getting to their ſtorehouſes, multitudes periſh with hunger.

When they are ſitting on a bough, and perceive a man, they inſtantly move their tails backward and forward, and gnaſh their teeth with a very conſiderable noiſe. This makes them deteſted by the ſportſmen, who loſe their game by the alarm they give. The GREY Squirrel is a difficult animal to kill: it ſits on the higheſt trees, and often between the boughs, and changes its place with ſuch expedition that the quickeſt markſman can ſcarcely find time to level his piece; and if it can once get into a hole, or into any old neſt, nothing [119] can provoke it to get out of its aſylum. They run up and down the bodies of trees, but very rarely leap from one to the other.

They are eaſily made tame; will even be brought to play with cats and dogs, which in a ſtate of domeſticity will not hurt them. They will alſo attach themſelves ſo far as to follow children to and from the woods.

They agree in their manner of feeding with the European kinds; and have all the ſame ſort of attitudes.

SQUIRREL. With coarſe fur,β. CAT. mixed with dirty white and black: the throat, and inſide of the legs and thighs, black: the tail is much ſhorter than is uſual with Squirrels, and of a dull yellow, mixed with black: in ſize equal to that of the Grey.

Inhabits Virginia. Mr. Knaphan, in whoſe collection I found it, informed me, that the planters called it the Cat Squirrel.

I ſuſpect that this animal is only a variety. Lawſon * ſays, that he has ſeen the Grey ſpecies pied, reddiſh, and black; but this point muſt be determined by natives of the countries which they inhabit, who, from obſervation, may decide by their manners, or their colors, in different ſeaſons, or periods of life.

Hiſt. Quad. No 273.—Brown's Zoology, tab. xlvii.—LEV. MUS.50. BLACK.

SQUIRREL. With white ears, noſe, and feet: the body totally black: the tail black, tipt with white: in ſize equal to the former.

Theſe ſometimes vary: there being examples of individuals which are wholly deſtitute of any white marks. The beautiful figure of one of theſe animals from Eaſt Florida, in Mr. Brown's Zoology, has ears edged with white, and a much longer tail than uſual.

[120]Inhabits neither Hudſon's Bay nor Canada, but is found in moſt other parts of America, as far as Mexico *. It is equally numerous, and as deſtructive to the mayz as the Grey Squirrel, but breeds and aſſociates in troops ſeparate from that ſpecies; yet makes its neſt in the ſame manner, and like it forms magazines of proviſion againſt the ſevere ſeaſon.

In Mexico, and probably in other parts of America, they eat the cones of pine-trees; and lodge in the hollows of the trees.

A. With membranes from leg to leg.
51. FLYING. Hiſt. Quad. No 283.—Smellie, v. 307.—LEV. MUS.

SQUIRREL. With large black eyes: round and naked ears: a membrane, covered with hair, extending from the fore to the hind legs: the hairs on the tail diſpoſed flatways on each ſide: are long in the middle, ſhort towards the end, which tapers to a point: that and the body of a browniſh cinereous: the belly white, tinged with yellow.

Inhabits all parts of North America, and as low as Mexico, where it is called Quimichpatlan . The natives of Virginia named it Aſſapanic .

They live in hollow trees. Like the Dormouſe, they ſleep the whole day; but towards night creep out, and are very lively and active. They are gregarious, numbers being found in one tree. By means of the lateral membranes, they take prodigious leaps, improperly called flying; and can ſpring ten yards at an effort. When they would leap, they extend the hind legs, and ſtretch [121] out the intervening ſkin, which producing a larger ſurface, makes the animals ſpecifically lighter than they would otherwiſe be: even with all this advantage, they cannot keep in a ſtrait line, but are urged downward with their weight. Senſible of this, they mount the tree in proportion to the diſtance of the leap they propoſe to take, leaſt they ſhould fall to the ground before they had reached a place of ſecurity.

They never willingly quit the trees, or run upon the ground, being conſtant reſidents of the branches. They go in troops of ten or twelve, and ſeem in their leaps, to people unaccuſtomed to them, like leaves blown off by the wind.

They bring three or four young at a time. They uſe the ſame food, and form their hoards like other Squirrels.

They are very eaſily tamed, and ſoon grow very familiar. They ſeem of a tender nature, and to love warmth, being very fond of creeping to the ſleeve or pocket of the owner. If they are flung down, they ſhew their diſlike to the ground, by inſtantly running up and ſheltering themſelves in his cloaths.

Hiſt. Quad. No 284.52. HOODED.

SQUIRREL. With the lateral ſkins beginning at the ears, uniting under the chin, and extending, like thoſe of the former, from fore leg to hind leg: the ears naked, and rather long: the hairs on the tail diſpoſed horizontally.

The color of the upper part of the body reddiſh: the lower part cinereous, tinged with yellow.

This ſpecies, according to Seba, who is the only perſon who has deſcribed or figured it, came from Virginia *. Linnaeus is very confuſed in his ſynonyms of this and the former kind; that of Mr. Edwards refers to the other ſpecies; and that of Seba, in his article of Sciurus Volans, to both.

[122]It is ſingular that there ſhould be only one ſpecimen ever brought of this ſpecies, from a country we have had ſuch great intercourſe with. It may perhaps be a monſtrous variety, by the extent of the ſkin into a ſort of hood. As to color, that is an accidental difference, which happens to numbers of other animals.

53. SEVERN RIVER. Hiſt. Quad. No 282. Greater Flying Squirrel, Ph. Tr. lxii. 379.

SQUIRREL. With the hair on the body and ſides of a deep cinereous color at the bottom; the ends ferruginous: breaſt and belly of a yellowiſh white: the whole coat long and full: the tail thick of long hairs, diſpoſed in a leſs flatted manner than thoſe of the European kind; brown on the upper ſide, darkeſt at the end; the lower part of the ſame color with the belly: the lateral ſkin, the inſtrument of flight, diſpoſed from leg to leg, in the ſame manner as in the firſt ſpecies, No 51.

In ſize it is far ſuperior to the common Flying Squirrel, being at leſt equal to the Engliſh kind.

This ſpecies is found in the ſouthern parts of Hudſon's Bay, in the foreſts of the country bordering on Severn river in James's bay.

A. COMMON. Hiſt. Quad. No 266.—Smellie, iv. 268.—LEV. MUS.

SQUIRREL. With tufted ears: head, body, and legs, ferruginous: breaſt and belly white: tail reddiſh brown.

This ſpecies inhabits the northern world, as high as Lapmark; is [123] continued through all the Arctic countries, whereſoever wood is found; abounds throughout Sibiria, except in the north-eaſt parts, and in Kamtſchatka, where it ceaſes, by reaſon of the ceſſation of foreſts.

In all theſe countries they are red in ſummer, but at approach of winter change to various and elegant greys. Their furs are of exquiſite ſoftneſs, and are the ſorts known to us by the name of Petit Gris. In the more ſoutherly parts of theſe cold climates, they retain a tinge of the ſummer red, and are leſs valuable. The change of color is effected gradually, as is its return in ſpring to its ferruginous coat.

It is very ſingular, that the alteration is not only performed in the ſeverity of the open air, but even in the warmth of a ſtove. Dr. Pallas made the experiment on one which was brought to him on the 12th of September, and was at that time entirely red. About the 4th of October many parts of the body began to grow hoary; and at the time it happened to die, which was on the 4th of November, the whole body had attained a grey color, and the legs, and a ſmall part of the face, had alone the reddiſh tinge*.

The varieties are as follow:—A blackiſh one, with the fur ſooty tipt with red, and full black gloſſy tail, are common about lake Baikal, and the whole courſe of the Lena. Sir Aſhton Lever is in poſſeſſion of one of a jetty blackneſs, with a white belly: its ears, as well as thoſe of all the Petit Gris, are adorned with very long tufts. Theſe change in winter to a lead-color, and are taken in the thick Alpine foreſts, where the Pinus Cembra, or Stone Pines, abound. The ſkins of theſe are neglected by the Chineſe, but greatly eſteemed in Europe, eſpecially the tails, for facings of dreſſes.

This variety is obſerved ſometimes to migrate in amazing numbers from their lofty alpine abodes, compelled to it whenever there happens to be a ſcarcity of proviſion. Swarms have appeared even [124] in the town of Tomſk, in deſerted houſes, and in the towers of the fortifications; where numbers are taken alive, and of great ſize, by the children of the place.

A beautiful and large variety, about the Baraba, called the Teleutian, is in great eſteem for its beautiful grey color, like a Gull's back, with a ſilvery gloſs, and finely undulated. Their ſummer color is uſually duſky red, and the ſides and feet black. Theſe are highly eſteemed by the Chineſe, and ſell at the rate of 6 or 7l. ſterling per thouſand*

A ſmall variety of this, leſſer even than the common kind, is met with about the neighborhood of the Kaſym and Iſet.

A variety is alſo met with which change to a white color; and others again retain a white color both in winter and ſummer.

The late navigators to the Icy ſea brought home with them from Pulo Condor, a knot of iſlands in north lat. 8. 40. on the coaſt of Cambodia, a Squirrel totally black.

B. EUROPEAN FLYING SQUIRREL, Hiſt. Quad. No 285.—Smellie, v. 307.—LEV. MUS.

SQUIRREL. With naked ears: flying membranes extending from the middle of the hind legs to the baſe of the fore feet, and ſpreading there in a rounded ſail: tail full of hair, and round at the end: color of the upper part of the body a fine grey, like that of a Gull's back: the lower part white.

Length to the tail four inches and a quarter; of the tail, five.

Inhabits the birch-woods of Finmark, Lapland, Finland, Lithuania, and Livonia. Is found in Aſia, in the woods of the Urallian chain, and from thence to the river Kolyma. Neſtles in the hollows of trees remote from the ground, where it makes its neſt of the ſofteſt moſſes. Is always ſolitary, except in the breeding-ſeaſon, and never appears [125] in the day-time. Lives on the buds and catkins of the birch, and on the ſhoots and buds of pines, which give its juices a ſtrong reſinous ſmell; and its excrements will burn ſtrongly, with a pitchy ſcent. The laſt are always found at the root of the tree, as if the animal deſcended to eaſe nature. It ſeldom comes out in bad weather; but certainly does not remain torpid during winter; for it is often taken in the traps laid for the Grey Squirrels. The ſkins are often put up in the bundles with the latter, ſo that the purchaſer is defrauded, as their fur is of no value. They leap at vaſt diſtances from tree to tree, and never deſcend but for the purpoſe before mentioned. By reaſon of ſimilitude of color between them and the birch bark, they are ſeen with great difficulty, which preſerves them from the attacks of rapacious birds.

They bring forth two, three, and rarely four, young at a time. When the parent goes out for food, ſhe laps them carefully up in the moſs. They are very difficult to be preſerved, and ſeldom can be kept alive, by reaſon of want of proper food. They are born blind, and continue ſo fourteen days. The mother pays them great attention; broods over them, and covers them with its flying membrane. The Ruſſians call them Ljetaga, or the Flying.

DORMOUSE. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXXI.
[126]
54. STRIPED.Ground Squirrel, Hiſt. Quad. No 286.—Smellie, v. 329.—LEV. MUS.

DORMOUSE. With naked rounded ears: the eyes full and black; about them a whitiſh ſpace: the head, body, and tail, of a reddiſh brown, deepeſt on the laſt: from neck to tail a black line extends along the top of the back: on each ſide run two others, parallel to the former, including between them another of a yellowiſh white: breaſt and belly white: the toes almoſt naked, and of a fleſh-color; long, ſlender, and very diſtinct; four, with the rudiment of a fifth, on the fore feet; five perfect toes on the hind.

SIZE.The length is about five inches and a half; of the tail, to the end of the hairs, rather longer.

Inhabits all parts of North America, I think, from Hudſon's Bay to Louiſiana; certainly from Canada, where the French call them Les Suiſſes, from their ſkins being rayed with black and white, like the breeches of the Switzers who form the Pope's guard*.

They are extremely numerous: live in woods, yet never run up trees, except when purſued, and find no other means of eſcape. They live under ground, burrow, and form their habitations with two entrances, that they may ſecure a retreat through the one, in caſe the other ſhould be ſtopped. Theſe little animals form their ſubterraneous dwellings with great ſkill, working them into the form of long galleries, with branches on each ſide, every one terminating in an enlarged apartment, in which they hoard their ſtock of winter proviſion. Their acorns are lodged in one, in a ſecond the mayz, in a third the hickery-nuts, and in the laſt their moſt favorite food, [127] the Chinquaquin, or cheſnut. Nature has given to them, as to the Hamſter *, a fine conveniency for collecting its proviſions, having furniſhed them with pouches within their cheeks, which they fill with mayz, and other articles of food, and ſo convey them to their magazines.

Thoſe of Sibiria live chiefly on ſeeds, and particularly on the kernels of the Cembra, or Stone Pine; and theſe they hoard up in ſuch quantities, that ten or fifteen pounds of the moſt choice have been found in a ſingle magazine.

They paſs the whole winter either in ſleep or in eating. During the ſevere ſeaſon, they very rarely ſtir out, at leſt as long as their proviſions laſt; but if by an unexpected continuance of bad weather their proviſions fail, they will then ſally out, and dig under ground in cellars where apples are kept, or into barns where mayz is ſtored, and make great devaſtations. They will even enter houſes, and eat undiſmayed, before the inhabitants, any corn they chance to meet with. The Cat makes great havock among them, being at all ſeaſons as great an enemy to them as to domeſtic Mice. It is hunger alone that tames them. They are naturally of a very wild nature, will bite moſt ſeverely, and cannot by any means be rendered familiar.

They are remarkably nice in the choice of their food, when the variety of autumnal proviſions gives opportunity. They have been obſerved, after having ſtuffed their pouches with the grains of rye, to fling it out when they meet with wheat, and to replace the rye with the more delicious corn.

Their ſkins, form a trifling article of commerce, being brought over among le menue pelliterie, the ſmall furs, and uſed for the lining of ladies cloaks.

In Sibiria they are killed with blunt arrows, or caught in fall-traps. About the Lena, the boys go out in the amorous ſeaſon of theſe little animals, and, ſtanding behind a tree, mimic the noiſe of the females, which brings the males within reach of their ſticks, with which [128] they kill them. The ſkins are ſold to the Chineſe merchants. About the Lena, a thouſand of their ſkins are not valued at more than ſix or eight rubles*.

Theſe animals are found in great numbers in Aſia, beginning about the river Kama , and from thence growing more and more frequent in the wooded parts of Sibiria; but theſe, and all the ſpecies of Squirrel, ceaſe towards the north-eaſt extremity of the country, by reaſon of the interruption of woods, which cuts them off from Kamtſchatka.

55. ENGLISH?Dormouſe, Br. Zool. i. No 234.—Hiſt. Quad. No 289.—Smellie, iv. 334.—LEV. MUS.

Mr. Lawſon ſays that the Engliſh Dormouſe is found in Carolina; but it has not as yet been tranſmitted to Great Britain. In order to aſcertain the ſpecies, I add a brief deſcription.

DORMOUSE. With full black eyes: broad, thin, ſemi-tranſparent ears: throat white: reſt of the body and the tail of a tawny red. Size of the common Mouſe; but the body of a plumper form, and the noſe more blunt: tail two inches and a half long, covered on every ſide with hair.

In Europe, inhabits thickets; forms its neſt at the bottom of a tree or ſhrub; forms magazines of nuts for winter food; ſits up to eat, like the Squirrel; lies torpid moſt of the winter; in its retreat, rolled up into the ſhape of a ball; retires to its neſt at approach of cold weather.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXXIII.RAT.
[129]
Br. Zool. i. No 25.—Hiſt. Quad. No 297.—Smellie, iv. 275.—LEV. MUS.56. BLACK.

RAT. With head and body of a very deep iron grey, nearly black: belly aſh-colored: legs almoſt naked, and duſky: a claw inſtead of a fifth thumb on the fore feet. Length, from noſe to tail, ſeven inches; tail near eight.

Inhabits North America, not only the ſettled parts, but even the rocks of the Blue mountains*, remote from all human dwellings. There they live among the ſtones, and in the ſubterraneous grottos frequent in thoſe hills. They lie cloſe during day, but at night come out, and make a moſt horrible noiſe amidſt theſe American alps. In violent froſts they lie torpid; and in the inhabited parts of the country they are obſerved to redouble their ſcreaks before ſevere weather, as if they had ſome preſage from their conſtitutions.

By Mr. Bartram's obſervations it appears very certain, that theſe animals are natives of America. They are found even at preſent in the moſt deſolate places, as well as in the houſes and barns of the inhabited parts. It is unknown in Europe, that either the common Rat or Mouſe ever deſerted the haunts of mankind, for rocks and deſerts: they therefore have been there from the earlieſt times. It is likely, that if ever the Blue mountains become inhabited, the wild Rats will quit their rocks, and reſort to thoſe places where they find harveſted food, and will quickly become perniciouſly domeſtic.

We are poſitively told, that South America was free from theſe troubleſome animals, till they were introduced there from Europe, by the means of ſhips, in 1544.

[130]We find none of the ſpecies in Kamtſchatka, nor any where to the eaſt of the Urallian chain. America muſt therefore have been ſtocked with them from the ſide of Europe. They are very common in Ruſſia. Towards Aſtracan they are very ſmall, but of the ſame color with the others.

57. BROWN. Br. Zool. i. No 26.—Hiſt. Quad. No 298.—Smellie, iv. 336.—LEV. MUS.

RAT. Above, light brown mixed with tawny, duſky, and cinereous: below, of a dirty white: four toes before, and a claw inſtead of a fifth toe.

I have no authority for giving this ſpecies a place here: but muſt ſuppoſe that the new world could not poſſibly eſcape the peſt, as it is univerſally become a moſt deſtructive inhabitant of European ſhips.

58. AMERICAN. Hiſt. Quad. No 299. Characho, Jike Cholqomac, or Great Mouſe of the Monguls.—LEV. MUS.

RAT. With the upper jaw extending very far beyond the lower: ears large and naked: tail rather ſhorter, in proportion, than that of the Black, to which it is rather ſuperior in ſize: color a duſky brown.

The ſpecimen, from which this deſcription is taken, was ſent from North America to Sir Aſhton Lever; but I am not informed, whether it only frequented the deſerts, or infeſted houſes.

59. WATER. Br. Zool. No 300.—Hiſt. Quad. No 300.—Smellie, iv. 290.—LEV. MUS.

RAT. With ſmall eyes: ears covered with the fur: teeth yellow: body covered with long hairs, black mixed with a few of a ruſt-color: belly of a deep grey.

[131]Length of the head and body ſeven inches; tail five, covered with ſhort black hairs. Weight nine ounces.

Inhabits North America, from Canada to Carolina *. In the firſt, varies to tawny and to white: feeds on the fry of fiſh, inſects, ſhell-fiſh, frogs, and roots; burrows on the banks of ponds and rivers; and dives and ſwims as well as an Otter, notwithſtanding it is not web-footed.

In northern Europe and Aſia it is extremely common; from Peterſburgh to Kamtſchatka in Sibiria, they are twice as large as in other places. They are found alſo from Lapland to the Caſpian ſea, and alſo in Perſia; and are one of the animals which endure the cold of the Arctic circle.

Br. Zool. i. No 30.—Hiſt. Quad. No 301.—Smellie, iv. 282.—LEV. MUS.60. MOUSE.

THIS common animal needs no deſcription. It is very abundant in the inhabited parts of America , and is to be found from Peterſburgh perhaps as far as Kamtſchatka.

Kalm imagines them to be natives of America; for he aſſures us that he has killed them in the crevices of the rocks in deſert places, far from the haunt of man.

Hiſt. Quad. No 302. α. AMERICAN.—Smellie, iv. 285.—LEV. MUS.61. FIELD.

RAT. With great, naked, and open ears: cheeks, ſpace below the ears, and ſides quite to the tail, orange-colored: back duſky and ruſt-colored, marked along the top, from head to tail, with a dark line: throat, breaſt, and belly, of a pure white: tail duſky above, white beneath: feet white: hind legs longer than thoſe of the Engliſh kind.

Length about four inches and a half; of the tail, four inches.

Inhabits Hudſon's Bay and New York.

62. VIRGINIAN. Hiſt. Quad. No 307.
[132]

RAT. With a black noſe: fur ſhort, and in all parts white: limbs ſlender: tail very thick at the baſe, tapering to a point, and cloathed with long hair.

Seba alone, vol. i. p. 76. tab. xlvii. fig. 4, deſcribes this ſpecies.

63. LABRADOR. Hiſt. Quad. No 295.

RAT. With a blunt noſe: mouth placed far below: upper lip bifid: ears large, naked, rounded: fore legs ſhort, furniſhed with four toes, and a tubercle inſtead of a thumb: HIND LEGS long and naked, like ſome of the Jerboas: toes long, ſlender, and diſtinct; the exterior toe the ſhorteſt: thumb ſhort.

SIZE.The whole length of the animal is eight inches, of which the tail is four and three quarters.

COLORS.Color above a deep brown, beneath white, ſeparated on each ſide by a yellow line.

Inhabits Hudſon's Bay and Labrador. Sent over by Mr. Graham.

**With ſhort tails.
64. HUDSON'S. Hiſt. Quad. No 319.—LEV. MUS.

RAT. With ſoft long hair, duſky at the bottom, whitiſh brown at the points: along the middle of the back, from head to tail, runs a duſky line: ſides yellowiſh: belly and inſide of the thighs of a dirty white.

Legs very ſhort: on the toes of the fore feet of the male only are four very large and ſharp claws, tuberculated beneath; in the female ſmaller and weaker: on the hind feet five toes with ſlender claws.

[133]Tail not three quarters of an inch long, terminating with long ſtiff hairs; it is ſcarcely viſible, being almoſt loſt in the fur.

Deſcribed from a ſkin which Doctor Pallas favored me with, which he received from the Labrador coaſt.

This is nearly a-kin to the Lemmus.

Short-tailed Field Mouſe? Br. Zool. i. No 31.—Hiſt. Quad. No 322?—Smellie, 65. MEADOW? iv. 293.—LEV. MUS.

RAT. With a blunt noſe: great head: prominent eyes: ears buried in the fur: head and upper part of the body of a ferruginous brown mixed with black: belly of a deep aſh-color.

Length, from head to tail, ſix inches; tail only one and a half, with a ſmall tuft at the end.

Inhabits Hudſon's Bay and Newfoundland, in the laſt very numerous, and does vaſt damage in the gardens; reſides under ground.

Hiſt. Quad. No 320.66. HARE-TAILED.

RAT. With ſmall and rounded ears: head broad; color duſky and tawny brown: the belly of a dirty white: a duſky line paſſes from between the eyes, and extends obſcurely along the back. Larger than the common Mouſe. Deſcribed from ſo mutilated a ſpecimen, ſent to the Royal Society from Hudſon's Bay *, that it was impoſſible to determine the ſpecies; only, by the dark line along the back, it ſeemed likeſt the HARE-TAILED, an inhabitant of Sibiria, whoſe manners are deſcribed in the Hiſtory of Quadrupeds.

A. OECONOMIC, Hiſt. Quad. No 313.—Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, Fr. ed. 392.
[134]

RAT. With naked ears, uſually hid in the fur: ſmall eyes: teeth tawny: limbs ſtrong: color, an intermixture of black and yellow, darkeſt on the back: under ſide hoary.

Length four inches and a quarter, to the tail; the tail one inch.

Inhabits in vaſt abundance Sibiria, from the eaſt ſide of the Urallian chain, even within the Arctic circle, and quite to Kamtſchatka. It is the noted Tegultſchitch of that country, diſtinguiſhed by its curious oeconomy and by its vaſt migrations.

They make their burrows with the greateſt ſkill, immediately below the ſurface of the ſoft turfy ſoil. They form a chamber of a flattiſh arched form, of a ſmall height, and about a foot in diameter, to which they ſometimes add as many as thirty ſmall pipes or entrances. Near the chamber they often form other caverns, in which they lodge their winter ſtores: theſe conſiſt of various kinds of plants, even ſome of ſpecies poiſonous to mankind. They gather them in ſummer, harveſt them, and even at times bring them out of the cells to give them a more thorough drying in the ſun. The chief labor reſts on the females. The males, during ſummer, go about ſolitary, and inhabit ſome old neſts; and in that ſeaſon never touch their hoards, but live on berries. They are monogamous, and the male and female at other times found in the ſame neſt. The female brings two or three young at a time, and breeds often in the year.

[135]No little animals are ſo reſpected by the Kamtſchatkans as theſe, for to them they owe a delicious food; and with great joy, about autumn, rob the hoards, and leave there many ridiculous preſents by way of amends: they alſo never take the whole of their proviſions, and leave beſides a little dried ovaries of fiſh for their ſupport.

But the migrations of theſe Mice, in certain years,MIGRATIONS. is as extraordinary a fact as any in natural hiſtory: I will only mention thoſe of Kamtſchatka. The cauſe is unknown. Doctor Pallas thinks it may ariſe from the ſenſations of internal fire in that vulcanic tract, or a preſcience of ſome unuſual and bad ſeaſon. They gather together in the ſpring in amazing numbers, except the few that are converſant about villages, where they can pick up ſome ſubſiſtance. This makes it probable that the country is over-ſtocked, and they quit it for want of food. The mighty hoſt proceeds in a direct courſe weſtward, and with the utmoſt intrepidity ſwims over rivers, lakes, and even arms of the ſea: many are drowned, many deſtroyed by waterfowl, or rapacious fiſh; thoſe which eſcape reſt awhile, to baſk, dry their fur, and refreſh themſelves. If the inhabitants find them in that ſituation, they treat them with the utmoſt tenderneſs, and endeavour to bring them to life and vigor. As ſoon as they have croſſed the river Penſchim, at the head of the gulph of the ſame name, they turn ſouthward, and reach the rivers Judoma and Ochot by the middle of July. The ſpace is moſt ſurpriſing, on conſulting the map of the country. The flocks are alſo ſo numerous, that an obſerver has waited two hours to ſee them all paſs. Their return into Kamtſchatka, in October, is attended with the utmoſt feſtivity and welcome. The natives conſider it as a ſure prognoſtic of a ſucceſsful chaſe and fiſhery: the firſt is certain, as the Mice are always followed by multitudes of beaſts of prey. They equally lament their migration, as the ſeaſon is certainly filled with rains and tempeſts.

B. RED, Hiſt. Quad. No 314.
[136]

RAT. With briſtly noſe and face: ears oval, riſing above the hair, naked, only tipt with fur: color, from forehead to rump, a bright red: ſides light grey and yellow: belly whitiſh: tail duſky above, light below.

Length not four inches; tail more than one.

Grow very common beyond the Ob, and live ſcattered over all Sibiria, in woods and mountains, and about villages; extend even to the Arctic circle. It is the Tſchetanauſtſchu, or Red Mouſe of the Kamtſchatkans. It is a ſort of drone: makes no proviſion for itſelf, but robs the hoards of the laſt ſpecies*. Lives under logs of trees; frequents houſes; dares the ſevereſt weather, and is abroad amidſt the ſnows; feeds on any thing, and is often caught in the traps ſet for Ermines, in attempting to devour the bait.

C. LEMMUS, Hiſt. Quad. No 317.—Godde Saeppan, Leems, 224.

RAT. With ſmall eyes and mouth: upper lip divided: ears ſmall, placed far backwards: four ſlender toes on the fore feet, and a ſharp claw, like a cock's ſpur, in place of a thumb: ſkin very thin. Color of the head black and tawny, of the belly yellow.

Length of thoſe of Scandinavian Lapland, above five inches; thoſe of the Ruſſian dominions not four.

The manners and wonderful migrations of the Lemmi of Europe, have been fully treated of in my Hiſtory of Quadrupeds.

They abound in the countries from the White Sea to the gulph of the Oby, and in the northern end of the Urallian chain; but differ in ſize and color from thoſe of Europe. Like them, they migrate at certain periods; and tend from the Urallian mountains, ſometimes towards Jeneſei, ſometimes towards Petzorah, and at thoſe times rejoice [137] the Samoieds with a rich chaſe of the animals which purſue the wanderers. The Samoieds aſſert, that the Rein-Deer will greedily devour them; perhaps they take them medicinally, as Sheep are known as greedily to ſeek and ſwallow Spiders.

D. LENA, MUS Gmelini, Pallas, Nov. Sp. an. 195.

RAT. With ſhort round ears: white whiſkers: thick broad body, in all parts nearly of equal breadth: tail ſhort, thickly covered with rude hairs: five toes on the fore feet, with claws very ſtrong and white: four on the hind feet, with claws much weaker: the fur pretty long; three parts of its length, from the roots, cinereous, the reſt white; ſo that the animal appears entirely white, except the cheeks, which are aſh-colored, and the chin, which is duſky.

The length is three inches one-fifth, the tail four-fifths of an inch.

They are ſeen in great numbers in autumn, on the borders of the Icy Sea, and about the parts of the Lena that fall into it. They appear ſuddenly, and depart as expeditiouſly. They feed on the roots of moſſes, and are themſelves the food of Arctic Foxes. Perhaps they extend to the Jeneſei: for it is ſaid that there are two ſorts of Mice found there; one wholly white; the other black, yellow, and white, which perhaps is the Lemmus *.

E. RINGED, Hiſt. Quad. No 205.

RAT. With a blunt noſe: ears hid in the fur: hair very fine: claws ſtrong and hooked: color of the upper part, ſometimes ferruginous, ſometimes light grey undulated with deep ruſt-color: a creſcent of white extends on each, from the hind part of the head towards the throat, bounded on each ſide by a bed of ruſt-color.

[138]Length to the tail little more than three inches; tail one, terminated by a briſtly tuft.

Found in the Arctic neighborhood of the Oby. Makes its neſt with rein-deer and ſnowy liver-worts, juſt beneath the turfy ſurface. Are ſaid to migrate, like the Lemmus.

F. TCHELAG, Deſcr. Kamtſchatha, 392.

THE author of the deſcription of that great peninſula ſays no more than that it is a very ſmall ſpecies; frequents houſes; and will go out and eat boldly any thing it has ſtolen. The natives call it Tchelagatchitch.

HIST QUAD. GENUS XXXIX.SHREW.
[139]
Br. Zool. i. No 32.—Hiſt. Quad. No 341.—Smellie, iv. 305.67. FOETID?

SHREW. With the head and upper part of the body duſky: ſides of a browniſh ruſt-color: eyes very ſmall, almoſt hid in the fur: ears ſhort: noſe very long and ſlender: upper mandible extends far beyond the lower.

Inhabits Hudſon's Bay, and probably Carolina, as Lawſon mentions a Mouſe found there which poiſons Cats * if they eat it. It is a notion in England that they are venomous: it is notorious that our Cats will kill, but not feed on them; probably thoſe of America have the ſame inſtinct: ſo that their deaths in the new world muſt ariſe from ſome other cauſe, and be falſely attributed to theſe animals.

Mr. Graham ſent over two other ſpecimens, beſides that deſcribed. They were of a duſky grey above, and of a yellowiſh white beneath: their ſize, rather leſs than the Engliſh kind; one being only two inches and a quarter long, the other only two inches; but they ſeemed not to differ ſpecifically from the other.

The common Shrew is found in Ruſſia; in all parts of Sibiria, even in the Arctic flats; and in Kamtſchatka.

MOLE. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XXXV.
[140]
68. LONG-TAILED. Hiſt. Quad. No 352.—LEV. MUS.

MOLE. With two cutting teeth in each jaw, and two ſharp ſlender canine: the grinders ſmall and ſharp: noſe long, the end radiated with ſhort tendrils: fore feet not ſo broad as thoſe of the Engliſh Mole, furniſhed with very long white claws: toes on the hind feet quite ſeparated: body not ſo thick and full as that of the common ſpecies: hair long, ſoft, and of a ruſty brown: tail covered with ſhort hair.

Length of the body four inches two-tenths; of the tail, two and a half.

Inhabits North America. Received from New York.

69. RADIATED. Hiſt. Quad. No 351.—Smellie, iv. 316.—LEV. MUS.

MOLE. With a long noſe, radiated like the former: the body ſhorter, and more full: hair duſky, very long, fine, and compact: fore feet reſembling thoſe of the preceding; but the toes of the hind feet are cloſely connected.

Length to the tail three inches three quarters: the tail ſlender, round, and taper, one inch three-tenths long.

Received from New York

MANNERS.This ſpecies forms ſubterraneous paſſages in the fields, running in various directions, and very ſhallow. Their courſe may be traced by the elevation of the earth on the ſurface, in form of a little bank, two inches high, and as broad as a man's hand. Theſe holes are unable to ſupport any weight, ſo that walkers find it very troubleſome [141] to go over places where theſe animals inhabit, the ground perpetually breaking under their feet*.

Theſe Moles have all the ſtrength in their legs as thoſe of Europe, and work in the ſame manner. They feed on roots, are very iraſcible, and will bite very ſeverely.

Hiſt. Quad. No 353.—LEV. MUS.70. BROWN.

MOLE. With a long and very ſlender noſe: two broad cutting teeth in the upper, four ſharp and ſlender in the lower, jaw; the two middlemoſt ſhort: the grinders very numerous, ſtrong, ſharp, and ſeparate: the fore feet very broad; thoſe and the hind feet exactly like thoſe of the European kind.

Length about ſix inches; tail one.

I received two ſpecimens of this animal from New York. PLACE. The hair in both ſoft, ſilky, and gloſſy: the hair in each duſky at the bottom; but in one, the ends were of a yellowiſh brown; in the other, brown: the feet and tail of both were white. I ſuſpect that they were varieties of the kind deſcribed by Seba , which he got from Virginia: it was totally black, gloſſed over with a moſt reſplendent purple. I may here note, the Tail-leſs Mole, figured by Seba in the ſame plate, is not a native of Sibiria, as he makes it; but is an inhabitant of the Cape of Good Hope.

Theſe three ſpecies agree pretty nearly with the Shrew in the fore teeth; for which reaſon Linnaeus claſſes the two he deſcribes among the Sorices. I call them Moles from their ſhape, which differs not from the European kind; but thoſe who chuſe to be very ſyſtematic, may divide the genus of Shrews, and ſtyle theſe Sorices Talpae-formes.

A. EUROPEAN, Hiſt. Quad. ii. No Br. Zool. i.
[142]

MOLE. With ſix cutting teeth in the upper; eight in the lower jaw; and two canine teeth in each: color of the fur black.

PLACE.Inhabits Sweden; but does not extend farther than the ſouth of Norway, where it is called Vond. Is frequent in the temperate parts of Ruſſia, and even in Sibiria, as far as the Lena. In Sibiria it is twice as big as thoſe of Europe. Is found there milk-white, but more uſually ſo in the Verchoturian mountains.

HEDGE-HOG, Hiſt. Quad. GENUS XXXVI.
B. COMMON, Hiſt. Quad. ii. No 355.—Br. Zool. i. No

HEDGE-HOG. With noſtrils bounded on each ſide by a looſe flap: ears rounded: back covered with prickles, white, barred with black: face, ſides, and rump, with ſtrong coarſe hair: tail an inch long.

PLACE.Is found in Sweden, in the dioceſe of Aggerhuys; and in that of Bergen, in Norway *. It is called, in the Norwegian tongue, Buſtedyvel. Is common in Ruſſia, except in the extreme northern and ſouthern parts. None in Sibiria, or very ſcarce at leſt.

DIV. III. PINNATED QUADRUPEDS; Or, with FIN-LIKE FEET.
[144] DIV. III. Pinnated Quadrupeds; Or, with FIN-LIKE FEET.

[]
WALRUS. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XLI.
71. ARCTIC. Hiſt. Quad. No 373.—Phipps's voy. 184. Roſmarus, Zimmerman, 330. Le Tricheque, Schreber, ii. 82. tab. lxxix. Cheval Marin, Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 427.—Smellie, vii. 354.—LEV. MUS.

DESCRIPTION.WALRUS. With a round head; ſhort neck; ſmall and fiery eyes, ſunk a finger's depth in the ſockets, and retractile from external injuries*: mouth very ſmall; lips very thick, beſet above and below with great whiſkers, compoſed of briſtles, tranſparent, and thick as a ſtraw: inſtead of ears are two minute orifices, placed in the moſt diſtant part of the head.

Body is very thick in the middle, leſſening gradually towards the tail. The ſkin in general is an inch thick, and two about the neck , and much wrinkled about the joints: it is covered with ſhort hair, of a mouſe-color; ſome with reddiſh, others with grey; others are almoſt bare, as if they were mangy, and full of ſcars.

The legs are very ſhort; on each foot are five toes, connected by webs, with a ſmall blunt nail to each. The hind feet, like thoſe of Seals, are very broad: the tail is very ſhort: the penis two feet long, and of a bony ſubſtance.

[145]In the upper jaw are two very long tuſks, bending downwards.TEETH. No cutting teeth; but in each jaw, above and below, four grinders, flat at top, and the ſurfaces of thoſe which I examined much worn. The length of the largeſt tuſk I have heard of, was two feet three inches, Engliſh meaſure, the circumference at the lower end, eight and a half; the greateſt weight of a ſingle tuſk twenty pounds: but ſuch are rarely found, and only on the coaſts of the Icy ſea, where they are ſeldom moleſted, and of courſe permitted to attain their full growth*.

The Walrus is ſometimes found of the length of eighteen feet,SIZE. and the circumference, in the thickeſt part, ten or twelve. The weight from fifteen hundred to two thouſand pounds.

Inhabits, in preſent times, the coaſts of the Magdalene iſlands,PLACE. in the gulph of St. Laurence, between latitude 47 and 48,AMERICA. their moſt ſoutherly reſidence in any part of the globe. They are not found on the ſeas of Labradore. The Eſkimaux purchaſe the teeth, for the heading their Seal-darts, from the Indians of Nuckvank, about lat. 60; who ſay, that they are annually viſited in the winter by multitudes of theſe animals. They are found in Davis's Streights, and within Hudſon's Bay in lat. 62. They alſo inhabit the coaſt of Greenland. I am uncertain whether they frequent Iceland; but they are found in great numbers near the iſlands of Spitzbergen, SPITZBERGEN. and on all the floating ice from thence to Cherry Iſle, CHERRY ISLE. a ſolitary ſpot intermediate between the laſt and the moſt northerly point of Norway. In 1608, they were found there in ſuch numbers, huddled on one another, like hogs, that a ſhip's crew killed above nine hundred in ſeven hours time§.

If they are found in the ſeas of Norway, NORWAY. it is very rare in theſe days. Leems, p. 310, ſays that they ſometimes frequent the ſea about Finmark; but about the year 980, they ſeemed to have been ſo numerous in the northern parts, as to become objects of chaſe and [146] commerce. The famous Octher the Norwegian, a native of Helgeland in the dioceſe of Drontheim, incited by a moſt laudable curioſity and thirſt of diſcovery, ſailed to the north of his country, doubled the North Cape, and in three days from his departure arrived at the fartheſt place, frequented by the Horſe-whale fiſhers. From thence he proceeded a voyage of three days more, and perhaps got into the White Sea. On his return he viſited England, probably incited by the fame of King Alfred's abilities, and the great encouragement he gave to men of diſtinguiſhed character in every profeſſion. The traveller, as a proof of the authenticity of his relation, preſented the Saxon monarch with ſome of the teeth of theſe animals, then a ſubſtitute of ivory, and valued at a high price. In his account of his voyage, he alſo added that their ſkins were uſed in the ſhips inſtead of ropes*.

NOVA ZEMBLA, AND ICY SEA.They are found again on the coaſts of Nova Zembla, and on the headlands which ſtretch moſt towards the north Pole; and as far as the Tſchutki point, and the iſles off that promontory. They ſcarcely extend lower than the neighborhood of the country of the Anadyr, but are ſeen in great abundance about cape Newnham, on the coaſt of America. The natives of the iſlands off the Tchutki Noſs ornament themſelves with pieces of the Walrus ſtuck through their lips or noſes; for which reaſon they are called by their neighbors Zoobatee, or large-teethed . The natives about Unalaſcha, Sandwich Sound, and Turn-again river, obſerve the ſame faſhion. I entertain doubts whether theſe animals are of the ſame ſpecies with thoſe of the Gulph of St. Laurence. The tuſks of thoſe of the Frozen Sea are much longer, more ſlender, and have a twiſt and inward curvature.

MANNERS.They are gregarious, and ſometimes have been found together in thouſands; are very ſhy, and avoid the haunts of mankind. They uſually are ſeen on the floating ice, preferring that for their reſidence, as their bodies require cooling, by reaſon of the heat which ariſes from their exceſſive fatneſs.

[147]They are monogamous; couple in June, and bring forth in the earlieſt ſpring*. They bring one , or very rarely two young at a time; feed on ſea-plants, fiſh, and ſhells, which they either dig out of the ſand, or force from the rocks with their great teeth. They make uſe alſo of their teeth to aſcend the iſlands of ice, by faſtening them in the cracks, and by that means draw up their bodies.

They ſleep both on the ice and in the water, and ſnore exceſſively loud.

They are harmleſs, unleſs provoked; but when wounded, or attacked, grow very fierce, and are very vindictive. When ſurpriſed upon the ice, the females firſt provide for the ſafety of the young, by flinging it into the ſea, and itſelf after it, carrying it to a ſecure diſtance, then returning with great rage to revenge the injury. They will ſometimes attempt to faſten their teeth on the boats, with an intent to ſink them, or riſe in numbers under them to overſet them; at the ſame time they ſhew all marks of rage, by roaring in a dreadful manner, and gnaſhing their teeth with great violence; if once thoroughly irritated, the whole herd will follow the boats till they loſe ſight of them. They are ſtrongly attached to each other, and will make every effort in their power, even to death, to ſet at liberty their harpooned companions.

A wounded Walrus has been known to ſink to the bottom, riſe ſuddenly again, and bring up with it multitudes of others, who united in an attack on the boat from which the inſult came§.

They fling the water out of their noſtrils, as the Whale does out of its head. When chaſed hard, they commonly vomit, and fling up ſmall ſtones. Their dung is like that of a Horſe, and exceſſively fetid, eſpecially where they are found in large companies.

The tongue, which is about the ſize of a Cow's, may be eaten,USES. if boiled freſh; but if kept, ſoon runs into oil. The teeth uſed to be applied to all the purpoſes of ivory; but the animals are now killed [148] only for the ſake of the oil. Seamen make rings of the briſtles of the whiſkers, which they wear as preſervatives againſt the cramp. The French coach-makers have made traces for coaches of the ſkins, which are ſaid to be ſtrong and elaſtic*. The Ruſſians formerly uſed the bone of the penis pulveriſed, as a remedy againſt the ſtone. Bartholinus recommends it, infuſed in ale, in fits of the ſtrangury. The Greenlanders eat the fleſh and lard, and uſe the laſt in their lamps. Of the ſkin they make ſtraps. They ſplit the tendons into thread; and uſe the teeth to head their darts, or to make pegs in their boats.

Their only enemies, beſides mankind, are the Polar Bears, with whom they have dreadful conflicts. Their feuds probably ariſe from the occupancy of the ſame piece of ice. The Walrus is uſually victorious, through the ſuperior advantage of its vaſt teeth. The effects of the battle are very evident; for it is not often that the hunters find a beaſt with two entire tuſks§.

"The Walrus, or Sea Cow, as it is called by the Americans," ſays Lord Shuldham , ‘is a native of the Magdalene iſlands, St. John's, and Anticoſti, in the gulph of St. Laurence. They reſort, very early in the ſpring, to the former of theſe places, which ſeems by nature particularly adapted to the nature of the animals, abounding with clams (eſcallops) of a very large ſize; and the moſt convenient landing-places, called Echoueries. Here they crawl up in great numbers, and remain ſometimes for fourteen days together without food, when the weather is fair; but on the firſt appearance of rain, they retreat to the water with great precipitation. [149] They are, when out of the water, very unwieldy, and move with great difficulty. They weigh from fifteen hundred to two thouſand pounds, producing, according to their ſize, from one to two barrels of oil, which is boiled out of the fat between the ſkin and the fleſh. Immediately on their arrival, the females calve, and engender again in two months after; ſo that they carry their young about nine months. They never have more than two at a time, and ſeldom more than one.’

‘The Echoueries * are formed principally by nature, being a gradual ſlope of ſoft rock, with which the Magdalene iſlands abound, about eighty or a hundred yards wide at the water-ſide, and ſpreading ſo as to contain, near the ſummit, a very large number of theſe animals. Here they are ſuffered to come on ſhore, and amuſe themſelves for a conſiderable time, till they acquire a degree of boldneſs, being at their firſt landing ſo exceedingly timid as to make it impoſſible for any perſon to approach them.’

‘In a few weeks they aſſemble in great multitudes: formerly, when undiſturbed by the Americans, to the amount of ſeven or eight thouſand. The form of the Echouerie not allowing them to remain contiguous to the water, the foremoſt are inſenſibly puſhed above the ſlope. When they are arrived at a convenient diſtance, the hunters, being provided with a ſpear ſharp on one ſide, like a knife, with which they cut their throats, take advantage of a ſide wind, or a breeze blowing obliquely upon the ſhore, to prevent the animals from ſmelling them, becauſe they have that ſenſe in great perfection. Having landed, the hunters, with the aſſiſtance of good dogs, trained for that purpoſe, in the night-time endeavour to ſeparate thoſe which are moſt advanced from the others, driving them different ways. This they call making a cut; it is generally looked upon to be a moſt dangerous proceſs, it being impoſſible to drive them in any particular direction, and difficult to avoid them; but as the Walruſes, which are advanced above [150] the ſlope of the Echouerie, are deprived by the darkneſs of the night from every direction to the water, they are left wandering about, and killed at leiſure, thoſe that are neareſt the ſhore being the firſt victims. In this manner have been killed fifteen or ſixteen hundred at a cut.

‘The people then ſkin them, and take off a coat of fat which always ſurrounds them, and diſſolve it into oil. The ſkin is cut into ſlices of two or three inches wide, and exported to America for carriage traces, and into England for glue. The teeth make an inferior ſort of ivory, and is manufactured for that purpoſe; but very ſoon turns yellow.’

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XLII.SEAL.
[151]
Br. Zool. i. No 71.—Hiſt. Quad. No 375.—Smellie. 72. COMMON. Kaſſigiak, Faun. Greenl. No 6.—LEV. MUS.

SEAL. With a flat head and noſe: large black eyes: large whiſkers: ſix cutting teeth in the upper jaw; four in the lower: two canine teeth in each jaw: no external ears: hair on all parts ſhort and thick: five toes on each foot, furniſhed with ſtrong ſharp claws, and ſtrongly webbed: tail ſhort and flat.

Uſual length of this ſpecies, from five to ſix feet. Their color differs; duſky, brinded, or ſpotted with white and yellow.

Inhabits all the European ſeas, even to the extreme north; and is found far within the Arctic circle, in both European and Aſiatic ſeas. It is continued to thoſe of Kamtſchatka *.

Theſe animals may be called the flocks of the Greenlanders, and many other of the Arctic people. I cannot deſcribe the uſes of them to the former more expreſſively than in the very words of Mr. Crantz, a gentleman very long reſident in their chilly country.

Seals are more needful to them than Sheep are to us,THEIR GREAT USE TO THE GREENLANDERS. though they furniſh us with food and raiment; or than the cocoa-tree is to the Indians, although that preſents them not only with meat to eat, and covering for their bodies, but alſo houſes to dwell in, and boats to fail in, ſo that in caſe of neceſſity they could live ſolely from it. The Seals fleſh (together with the Rein-deer, which is already grown pretty ſcarce) ſupplies the natives with their moſt palatable and ſubſtantial food. Their fat furniſhes them with oil for lamp-light, chamber and kitchen fire; and whoever ſees their habitations, preſently [152] finds, that if they even had a ſuperfluity of wood, it would not do, they can uſe nothing but train in them. They alſo mollify their dry food, moſtly fiſh, in the train; and finally, they barter it for all kinds of neceſſaries with the factor. They can few better with fibres of the Seals ſinews than with thread or ſilk. Of the ſkins of the entrails they make their windows, curtains for their tents, ſhirts, and part of the bladders they uſe at their harpoons; and they make train bottles of the maw. Formerly, for want of iron, they made all manner of inſtruments and working-tools of their bones. Neither is the blood waſted, but boiled with other ingredients, and eaten as ſoup. Of the ſkin of the Seal they ſtand in the greateſt need; for, ſuppoſing the ſkins of Rein-deer and birds would furniſh them with competent cloathing for their bodies, and coverings for their beds; and their fleſh, together with fiſh, with ſufficient food; and provided they could dreſs their meat with wood, and alſo new model their houſe-keeping, ſo as to have light, and keep themſelves warm with it too; yet without the Seals ſkins they would not be in a capacity of acquiring theſe ſame Rein-deer, fowls, fiſhes, and wood; becauſe they muſt cover over with Seal-ſkin both their large and ſmall boats, in which they travel and ſeek their proviſion. They muſt alſo cut their thongs or ſtraps out of them, make the bladders for their harpoons, and cover their tents with them; without which they could not ſubſiſt in ſummer.

Therefore no man can paſs for a right Greenlander who cannot catch Seals. This is the ultimate end they aſpire at, in all their device and labor from their childhood up. It is the only art (and in truth a difficult and dangerous one it is) to which they are trained from their infancy; by which they maintain themſelves, make themſelves agreeable to others, and become beneficial members of the community*.

[153]The Greenlanders have three ways of catching Seals:MANNER OF TAKING. either ſingly, with the bladder; or in company, by the clapper-hunt; or in the winter on the ice: whereto may be added the ſhooting them with a gun.

The principal and moſt common way is the taking them with the bladder. When the Greenlander ſets out equipped according to the 7th Section, and ſpies a Seal, he tries to ſurpriſe it unawares, with the wind and ſun in his back, that he may not be heard or ſeen by it. He tries to conceal himſelf behind a wave, and makes haſtily, but ſoftly, up to it, till he comes within four, five, or ſix fathom of it; mean while he takes the utmoſt care that the harpoon, line, and bladder, lie in proper order. Then he takes hold of the oar with his left hand, and the harpoon with his right by the hand-board, and ſo away he throws it at the Seal, in ſuch a manner that the whole dart flies from the hand-board and leaves that in his hand. If the harpoon hits the mark, and buries itſelf deeper than the barbs, it will directly diſengage itſelf from the bone-joint, and that from the ſhaft; and alſo unwind the ſtring from its lodge on the kajak. The moment the Seal is pierced, the Greenlander muſt throw the bladder, tied to the end of the ſtring, into the water, on the ſame ſide as the Seal runs and dives; for that he does inſtantly, like a dart. Then the Greenlander goes and takes up the ſhaft ſwimming on the water, and lays it in its place. The Seal often drags the bladder with it under water, though 'tis a conſiderable impediment, on account of its great bigneſs; but it ſo wearies itſelf out with it, that it muſt come up again in about a quarter of an hour to take breath. The Greenlander haſtens to the ſpot where he ſees the bladder riſe up, and ſmites the Seal, as ſoon as it appears, with the great lance deſcribed in the 6th Section*. This lance always comes out of its body again; but he throws it at the creature afreſh every time it comes up, till 'tis quite ſpent. Then he runs the [154] little lance into it, and kills it outright, but ſtops up the wound directly to preſerve the blood; and laſtly, he blows it up, like a bladder, betwixt ſkin and fleſh, to put it into a better capacity of ſwimming after him; for which purpoſe he faſtens it to the left-ſide of his kajak, or boat*.

In this exerciſe the Greenlander is expoſed to the moſt and greateſt danger of his life; which is probably the reaſon that they call this hunt, or fiſhery, kamavock, i. e. the Extinction, viz. of life. For if the line ſhould entangle itſelf, as it eaſily may, in its ſudden and violent motion; or if it ſhould catch hold of the kajak, or ſhould wind itſelf round the oar, or the hand, or even the neck, as it ſometimes does in windy weather; or if the Seal ſhould turn ſuddenly to the other ſide of the boat; it cannot be otherwiſe than that the kajak muſt be overturned by the ſtring, and drawn down under water. On ſuch deſperate occaſions the poor Greenlander ſtands in need of all the arts deſcribed in the former Section, to diſentangle himſelf from the ſtring, and to raiſe himſelf up from under the water ſeveral times ſucceſſively; for he will continually be overturning till he has quite diſengaged himſelf from the line. Nay, when he imagines himſelf to be out of all danger, and comes too near the dying Seal, it may ſtill bite him in the face or hand; and a female Seal that has young, inſtead of flying the field, will ſometimes fly at the Greenlander in the moſt vehement rage, and do him a miſchief, or bite a hole in his kajak that he muſt ſink.

In this way, ſingly, they can kill none but the careleſs ſtupid Seal, called Attarſoak . Several in company muſt purſue the cautious Kaſſigiak by the clapper-hunt. In the ſame manner they alſo ſurround and kill the Attarſoit in great numbers at certain ſeaſons of the year; for in autumn they retire into the creeks or inlets in ſtormy weather, as in the Nepiſet ſound in Ball's river, between the main land and the iſland Kangek, which is full two [155] leagues long, but very narrow. There the Greenlanders cut off their retreat, and frighten them under water by ſhouting, clapping, and throwing ſtones; but, as they muſt come up again continually to draw breath, then they perſecute them again till they are tired, and at laſt are obliged to ſtay ſo long above water, that they ſurround them, and kill them with the fourth kind of dart, deſcribed in the 6th Section. During this hunt we have a fine opportunity to ſee the agility of the Greenlanders, or, if I may call it ſo, their huſſar-like manoeuvres. When the Seal riſes out of the water, they all fly upon it, as if they had wings, with a deſperate noiſe; the poor creature is forced to dive again directly, and the moment he does, they diſperſe again as faſt as they came, and every one gives heed to his poſt, to ſee where it will ſtart up again; which is an uncertain thing, and is commonly three quarters of a mile from the former ſpot. If a Seal has a good broad water, three or four leagues each way, it can keep the ſportſmen in play for a couple of hours, before 'tis ſo ſpent that they can ſurround and kill it. If the Seal, in its fright, betakes itſelf to the land for a retreat, 'tis welcomed with ſticks and ſtones by the women and children, and preſently pierced by the men in the rear. This is a very lively and a very profitable diverſion for the Greenlanders, for many times one man will have eight or ten Seals for his ſhare.

The third method of killing Seals upon the ice, is moſtly practiſed in Diſko, where the bays are frozen over in the winter. There are ſeveral ways of proceeding. The Seals themſelves make ſometimes holes in the ice, where they come and draw breath; near ſuch a hole a Greenlander ſeats himſelf on a ſtool, putting his feet on a lower one to keep them from the cold. Now when the Seal comes and puts its noſe to the hole, he pierces it inſtantly with his harpoon; then breaks the hole larger, and draws it out and kills it quite. Or a Greenlander lays himſelf upon his belly, on a kind of a ſledge, near other holes, where the Seal [156] come out upon the ice to baſk themſelves in the ſun. Near this great hole they make a little one, and another Greenlander puts a harpoon into it with a very long ſhaft or pole. He that lies upon the ice looks into the great hole, till he ſees a Seal coming under the harpoon; then he gives the other the ſignal, who runs the Seal through with all his might.

If the Greenlander ſees a Seal lying near its hole upon the ice, he ſlides along upon his belly towards it, wags his head, and grunts like a Seal; and the poor Seal, thinking 'tis one of its innocent companions, lets him come near enough to pierce it with his long dart.

When the current wears a great hole in the ice in the ſpring, the Greenlanders plant themſelves all round it, till the Seals come in droves to the brim to fetch breath, and then they kill them with their harpoons. Many alſo are killed on the ice while they lie ſleeping and ſnoring in the ſun*.

Nature has been ſo niggardly in providing variety of proviſion for the Greenlanders, that they are neceſſitated to have recourſe to ſuch which is offered to them with a liberal hand.USES IN KAMTSCHATKA. The Kamtſchatkan nations, which enjoy ſeveral animals, as well as a great and abundant choice of fiſh, are ſo enamoured with the taſte of the fat of Seals, that they can make no feaſt without making it one of the diſhes. Of that both Ruſſians and Kamtſchatkans make their candles. The latter eat the fleſh boiled, or elſe dried in the ſun. If they have a great quantity, they preſerve it in the following manner:

They dig a pit of a requiſite depth, and pave it with ſtones; then fill it with wood, and ſet it on fire ſo as to heat the pit to the warmth of a ſtove. They then collect all the cinders into a heap. They ſtrew the bottom with the green wood of alder, on which they place ſeparately the fleſh and the fat, and put between every layer branches of the ſame tree; when the pit is filled they cover it with ſods, ſo that the vapour cannot eſcape. After ſome hours they take out both [157] fat and fleſh, and keep it for winter's proviſions, and they may be preſerved a whole year without ſpoiling.

The Kamtſchatkans have a moſt ſingular ceremony.SUPERSTITIOUS CUSTOM. After they take the fleſh from the heads of the Seals, they bring a veſſel in form of a canoe, and fling into it all the ſculls, crowned with certain herbs, and place them on the ground. A certain perſon enters the habitation with a ſack filled with Tonchitche, ſweet herbs, and a little of the bark of willow. Two of the natives then roll a great ſtone towards the door, and cover it with pebbles; two others take the ſweet herbs and diſpoſe them, tied in little packets. The great ſtone is to ſignify the ſea-ſhore, the pebbles the waves, and the packets Seals. They then bring three diſhes of a haſh, called Tolkoucha; of this they make little balls, in the middle of which they ſtick the packets of herbs: of the willow-bark they make a little canoe, and fill it with Tolkoucha, and cover it with the ſack. After ſome time, the two Kamtſchatkans who had put the mimic Seals into the Tolkoucha, take the balls, and a veſſel reſembling a canoe, and draw it along the ſand, as if it was on the ſea, to convince the real Seals how agreeable it would be to them to come among the Kamtſchatkans, who have a ſea in their very jurts, or dwellings. And this they imagine will induce the Seals to ſuffer themſelves to be taken in great numbers. Various other ceremonies, equally ridiculous, are practiſed; in one of which they invoke the winds, which drive the Seals on their ſhores, to be propitious *.

Beſides the uſes which are made of the fleſh and fat of Seals, the ſkins of the largeſt are cut into ſoles for ſhoes. The women make their ſummer boots of the undreſſed ſkins, and wear them with the hair outmoſt. In a country which abounds ſo greatly in furs, very little more uſe is made of the ſkins of Seals in the article of dreſs than what has been mentioned. But the Koriaks, the Oloutores, and Tchutſchi, form with the ſkins canoes and veſſels of different ſizes, ſome large enough to carry thirty people.

[158]Seals ſwarm on all the coaſts of Kamtſchatka, and will go up the rivers eighty verſts in purſuit of fiſh. They couple on the ice in April, and ſometimes on the rocks, and even in the ſea in calm weather. The Tunguſi give the milk of theſe animals to their children inſtead of phyſic.

CAPTURE.The Seals in this country are killed by harpooning, by ſhooting, by watching the holes in the ice and knocking them on the head as they riſe; or by placing two or three ſtrong nets acroſs one of the rivers which theſe animals frequent: fifty or more people aſſemble in canoes on each ſide of the nets, while others row up and down, and with great cries frighten the Seals into them. As ſoon as any are entangled, the people kill them with pikes or clubs, and drag them on ſhore, and divide them equally among the hunters; ſometimes a hundred are taken at a time in this manner.

The navigators obſerved abundance of Seals about Bering's iſland, but that they decreaſed in numbers as they advanced towards the ſtraits; for where the Walruſes abounded, the Seals grew more and more ſcarce.

I did not obſerve any Seal-ſkin garments among thoſe brought over by the navigators, ſuch as one might have expected among the Eſquimaux of the high latitudes they viſited, and which are ſo much in uſe with thoſe of Hudſon's Bay and Labrador. That ſpecies of dreſs doubtleſsly was worn in the earlieſt times. Theſe people wanted their hiſtorians;MASSAGETAE CLOATHED IN SEAL-SKINS. but we are aſſured that the Maſſagetae * cloathed themſelves in the ſkins of Seals. They, according to D'anville, inhabited the country to the eaſt of the Caſpian ſea, and the lake Aral; both of which waters abound with Seals.

Seals are now become a great article of commerce. The oil from the vaſt Whales is no longer equal to the demand for ſupplying the magnificent profuſion of lamps in and round our capital. The chaſe of theſe animals is redoubled for that purpoſe; and the ſkins, properly tanned, are in conſiderable uſe in the manufactory of boots and ſhoes.

Hiſt. Quad. No 382.73. GREAT. Phoca Barbata, Faun. Greenl. No 9.—Urkſuk. Greenl. Lakktak, Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 420.—LEV. MUS.
[159]

SEAL. With long pellucid white whiſkers with curled points: back arched: black hairs, very deciduous, and thinly diſperſed over a thick ſkin, which in ſummer is almoſt naked: teeth like the common Seal: fore feet like the human hand; middle toe the longeſt; thumb ſhort: length more than twelve feet.

The Greenlanders cut out of the ſkin of this ſpecies thongs and lines, a finger thick, for the Seal-fiſhery. Its fleſh is white as veal, and eſteemed the moſt delicate of any: has plenty of lard, but does not yield much oil. The ſkins of the young are ſometimes uſed to lie on.

It inhabits the high ſea about Greenland; is a timid ſpecies, and uſually reſts on the floating ice, and very ſeldom the fixed. Breeds in the earlieſt ſpring, or about the month of March, and brings forth a ſingle young on the ice, uſually among the iſlands; for at that ſeaſon it approaches a little nearer to the land. The great old ones ſwim very ſlowly.

In the ſeas of the north of Scotland is found a Seal twelve feet long. A gentleman of my acquaintance ſhot one of that ſize on the coaſt of Sutherland; but made no particular remarks on it. A young one, ſeven feet and half long, was ſhewn in London ſome years ago, which had not arrived at maturity enough even to have ſcarcely any teeth*: yet the common Seals have them complete before they attain the ſize of ſix feet, their utmoſt growth.

A ſpecies larger than an Ox, found in the Kamtſchatkan ſeas from 56 to 64 north latitude, called by the natives Lachtak . They weighed [160] eight hundred pounds: were eaten by Bering's crew; but their fleſh was found to be very loathſome*. The cubs are quite black.

STELLER has left behind him accounts of other Seals found in thoſe wild ſeas; but his deſcriptions are ſo imperfect as to render it impoſſible to aſcertain the ſpecies. He ſpeaks in his MSS. of a middle-ſized kind, univerſally and moſt elegantly ſpotted; another, black with brown ſpots, and the belly of a yellowiſh white, and as large as a yearling Ox; a third ſpecies, black, and with a particular formation of the hinder legs; and a fourth, of a yellowiſh color, with a great circle on it of the color of cherries.

74. ROUGH. Hiſt. Quad. No 383. Phoca Foetida, Faun. Greenl. No 8.—Neitſeck Greenl. Crantz, i.

SEAL. With a ſhort noſe, and ſhort round head: teeth like the common Seal: body almoſt of an elliptical form, covered with lard almoſt to the hind feet: hairs cloſely ſet together, ſoft, long, and ſomewhat erect, with curled wool intermixed: color duſky, ſtreaked with white; ſometimes varies to white, with a duſky dorſal line.

Does not exceed four feet in length.

Never frequents the high ſeas, but keeps on the fixed ice in the remote bays near the frozen land; and when old never forſakes its haunts. Couples in June; brings forth in January, on the fixed ice, which is its proper element. In that it has a hole for the benefit of fiſhing; near that it remains uſually ſolitary, rarely in pairs. Is very incautious, and often ſleeps on the ſurface of the water, yielding itſelf a prey to the Eagle. Feeds on ſmall fiſh, ſhrimps, and the like. The uſes of the ſkin, tendons, and lard, the ſame with thoſe of other Seals. The fleſh is red, and foetid, eſpecially that of the males, which is nauſeated by even the Greenlanders.

[161]The Seal-hunters in Newfoundland have a large kind, which they call the Square Phipper, and ſay weighs five hundred pounds. Its coat is like that of a Water-dog; ſo that it ſeems by the length of hair to be allied to this; but the vaſt difference in ſize forbids us from pronouncing it to be the ſame ſpecies.

Hiſt. Quad. No 381.75. LEPORINE. Phoca Leporina, Lepechin, Act. Acad. Petrop. pars i. 264. tab. viii. ix.— Hiſt. Quad. No 381.

SEAL. With hair of an uniform dirty white color, with a tinge of yellow, but never ſpotted; hairs erect, and interwoven; ſoft as that of a Hare, eſpecially the young: head long: upper lip ſwelling and thick: whiſkers very ſtrong and thick, ranged in fifteen rows, covering the whole front of the lip, ſo as to make it appear bearded: eyes blue, pupil black: teeth ſtrong; four cutting teeth above, the ſame below*: fore feet ſhort, and ending abrupt: the membranes of the hind feet even, and not waved: tail ſhort and thick; its length four inches two lines.

Length of this ſpecies, from noſe to tip of the tail, is ſix feet ſix;SIZE. its greateſt circumference five feet two. The cubs are milk white.

This kind inhabits the White Sea during ſummer, and aſcends and deſcends the mouths of rivers with the tide in queſt of prey. It is alſo found on the coaſts of Iceland, and within the Polar circle from Spitzbergen to Tchutki Noſs, and from thence ſouthward about Kamtſchatka.

Like the others, it is killed for its fat and ſkin. The laſt is cut into pieces, and uſed for ſtraps and reins. The ſkins of the young, which are remarkably white, are dyed with black, and uſed to face caps, in imitation of Beavers ſkins; but the hairs are much ſtiffer, and do not ſoon drop off.

76. HOODED. Hiſt. Quad. No 384. Phoca Leonina, Faun. Greenl. No 5.
[162]

SEAL. With four cutting teeth above, four below: fore feet like the human; the thumb long: the membranes on the hind feet extend beyond the claws: on the forehead of the male is a thick folded ſkin, ridged half the way up, which it can inflate and draw down like a cap, to defend its eyes againſt ſtorms, waves, ſtones, and ſand. The females and young have only the rudiment of this guard. It has two ſpecies of hair; the longeſt white, the ſhorteſt thick, black, and woolly, which gives it a beautiful grey color.

It grows to the length of eight feet. The Greenlanders call it Neitſek-ſoak *, or the Great Neitſek. It inhabits only the ſouthern parts of their country, where it inhabits the high ſeas; but in April, May, and June, comes nearer to the land. Is polygamous; copulates with its body erect. Brings forth in April one young upon the ice. Keeps much on the great fragments, where it ſleeps in an unguarded way. Bites hard: barks, and whines: grows very fierce on being wounded; but will weep on being ſurprized by the hunter. Fight among themſelves, and inflict deep wounds. Feed on all kinds of greater fiſh. The ſkins of the young form the moſt elegant dreſſes for the women. The men cover their great boats with thoſe of the old; they alſo cover their houſes with them, and when they grow old convert them into ſacks. They uſe the teeth to head hunting-ſpears. Of the gullet and inteſtines they make the ſea-dreſſes. The ſtomach is made into a fiſhing-buoy.

It is alſo found in Newfoundland. Our Seal-hunters name it the Hooded Seal, and pretend they cannot kill it till they remove that integument. The Germans call it Klap-Mutz, from its covering its face as if with a cap.

The moſt dreaded enemy which this ſpecies has in Greenland, is the Phyſeter Microps; on the very ſight of which it takes to the ice, [163] and quietly expects its fate*. The Greenlanders therefore deteſt this ſpecies of Whale, not only on account of the havock it makes among the Seals, but becauſe it frightens them away from the bays.

It is entirely different from the LEONINE SEAL, or from that of the South-ſea, called the BOTTLE-NOSE.

Hiſt. Quad. No 385.77. HARP. Phoca Oceanica, Krylatca Ruſſis, Lepechin, Act. Acad. Petrop. pars i. 259. tab. vi. vii. Phoca Greenlandica, Faun. Greenl. No 7.—Atak Greenl. Atarſoak, Crantz, i. 124.

SEAL. With a round head: high forehead: noſe ſhort: large black eyes: whiſkers diſpoſed in ten rows of hairs: four cutting teeth in the upper jaw, the two middlemoſt the longeſt; four alſo in the lower, leſs ſharp than the others: two canine teeth in each jaw: ſix grinders in each jaw, each three-pointed: hairs ſhort: ſkin thick and ſtrong.

Head, noſe, and chin, of a deep cheſnut color, nearly black; reſt of the body of a dirty white, or light grey: on the top of the ſhoulders is a large mark of the ſame color; with the head bifurcated, each fork extending downwards along the ſides half way the length of the body. This mark is always conſtant; but there are beſides a few irregular ſpots incidental to the old ones.

The female has only two, retractile, teats; and brings only one young at a time. The cub, the firſt year, is of a bright aſh-color, whitiſh beneath, and marked in all parts with multitudes of ſmall black ſpots, at which period they are called by the Ruſſians White Seals. In the next year they begin to be ſpotted; from that period the females continue unchanged in color. The males at full age, which Mr. Crantz ſays is their fifth year, attain their diſtinguiſhing ſpot, and are called by the Greenlanders Attarſoak ; by the Ruſſians, Krylatka, or winged.

[164]This inhabits the ſame countries with the Rough and Leporine Seal; but loves the coldeſt parts of the coaſt. Continues on the looſe ice of Nova Zembla the whole year; and is ſeen only in the winter in the White Sea, on the floating ice carried from the northern ſeas. It brings forth its young about the end of April, and after ſuckling it a ſufficient time departs with the firſt ice into the Frozen Ocean. The young remains behind for ſome time, then follows its parent with the ice which is looſed from the ſhore*.

It abounds in Greenland and about Spitzbergen, eſpecially in the bottoms of the deep bays. Migrates in Greenland twice in the year: in March, and returns in May; in June, and returns in September. Couples in July, and brings forth towards the end of March or begining of April: has one young, rarely two, which it ſuckles on fragments of ice far from land. It never aſcends the fixed ice; but lives and ſleeps on the floating iſlands in great herds. Swims in great numbers, having one for a leader, which ſeems to watch for the ſecurity of the whole. Eats its prey with its head above water. Swims in various ways; on its belly, back, and ſide, and often whirls about as if in frolick. Frequently ſleeps on the ſurface of the water. Is very incautious. Has great dread of the Phyſeter Microps, which forces it towards the ſhore. It is often ſurrounded by troops of hunters, who compel it even to land, where it is eaſily killed.

It is found alſo about Kamtſchatka, being the third ſpecies mentioned by Steller.

SIZE.It grows to the length of nine feet. The meaſurements of one deſcribed by Mr. Lepechin are as follow—The length, from the noſe to the tip of the tail, was ſix feet: the length of the tail five inches three lines: the girth of the thickeſt part of the body four feet eight.

USES.The ſkin is uſed to cover trunks; that of the young, taken in the iſle of Solovki, on the weſt ſide of the White Sea, is made into boots, and is excellent for keeping out water. The Greenlanders, in dreſſing the ſkins, curry off the hair, and leave ſome fat on the inſide to render [165] them thicker. With theſe they cover their boats, and with the undreſſed ſkins their tents; and, when they can get no other, make uſe of them for cloathing.

The oil extracted from the blubber of this Seal is far the moſt valuable, being ſweet, and ſo free from greaves as to yield a greater quantity than any other ſpecies. The fleſh is black.

The Newfoundland Seal-hunters call it the Harp, or Heart Seal, and name the marks on the ſides the ſaddle. They ſpeak too of a brown ſort, which they call Bedlemer, and believe to be the young of the former.

Hiſt. Quad. No 380. fig. at p. 513.78. RUBBON.

SEAL. With very ſhort briſtly hair, of an uniform gloſſy color, almoſt black: the whole back and ſides comprehended within a narrow regular ſtripe of pale yellow.

It is to Dr. Pallas I owe the knowlege of this ſpecies. He received only part of the ſkin, which ſeemed to have been the back and ſides. The length was four feet, the breadth two feet three; ſo it muſt have belonged to a large ſpecies. It was taken off the Kuril iſlands.

Hiſt. Quad. No 387.79. URSINE. Kot Ruſſis Gentilibus ad Sinum Penchinicum, Tarlatſchega, Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 331. tab xv. Sea Wolf*, Pernety, Engl. Tr. 167; tab. xvi.—Ulloa's voy. i. 226. Chat Marin, Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 433.

SEAL. With a high forehead: noſe projecting like that of a dog: black irides: ſmaragdine pupil: whiſkers compoſed of triangular hairs, thinly ſcattered: noſtrils oval, divided by ſeptum: lips thick; their inſide red, and ſerrated.

[166] TEETH.In the upper jaw four bifurcated cutting teeth; on each ſide of theſe a very ſharp canine tooth bending inwards; beyond theſe another, which, in battle, the animal ſtrikes with, as Boars do with their tuſks. Inſtead of grinders, in each upper jaw are ſix ſharp teeth reſembling canine, and very ſlightly exerted. In the lower jaw four cutting teeth, and canine like thoſe in the upper; and on each ſide ten others in the place of grinders. When the mouth is cloſed all the teeth lock into each other.

TONGUE, EARS.The tongue rough and bifid: the ears ſhort, ſmall, and ſharp-pointed, hairy on the outſide, ſmooth and poliſhed within.

FORE LEGS.Fore legs two feet long, not immerſed in the body, like thoſe of other Seals, but reſemble thoſe of common quadrupeds. The feet are furniſhed with five toes, with the rudiments of nails; but theſe are ſo entirely covered with a naked ſkin, as to be as much concealed as a hand is with a mitten. The animal ſtands on theſe legs with the utmoſt firmneſs; yet the feet ſeem but a ſhapeleſs maſs.

HIND LEGS.The hind legs are twenty-two inches long, and ſituated like thoſe of Seals; but are capable of being brought forward, ſo that the animal makes uſe of them to ſcratch its head: on each are five toes, connected by a large web;TAIL. and are a foot broad. The tail is only two inches long.

BODY.The body is of a conoid ſhape. The length of a large one is about eight feet; the circumference near the ſhoulders is five feet, near the tail twenty inches. The weight eight hundred pounds.

FEMALE.The female is far inferior in ſize to the male: it has two teats, placed far behind.

COLOR.The whole animal is covered with long and rough hair, of a blackiſh color; that of the old is tipt with grey; and on the neck of the males is a little longer and erect: beneath the hair is a ſoft fur of a bay color. The females are cinereous. The ſkin is thick and ſtrong.

PLACE.Theſe animals are found in amazing multitudes on the iſlands between [167] Kamtſchatka and America *; but are ſcarcely known to land on the Aſiatic ſhore: nor are they ever taken except in the three Kurilian iſlands, and from thence in the Bobrowoie More, or Beaver Sea, as far as the Kronoſki headland, off the river Kamtſchatka, which comprehends only from 50 to 56 north latitude. It is obſervable that they never double the ſouthern cape of the peninſula, or are found on the weſtern ſide in the Penſchinſka ſea: but their great reſort has been obſerved to be to Bering's iſlands. They are as regularly migratory as birds of paſſage.MIGRATORY. They firſt appear off the three Kurili iſlands and Kamtſchatka in the earlieſt ſpring. They arrive exceſſively fat; and there is not one female which does not come pregnant. Such which are then taken are opened, the young taken out and ſkinned. They are found in Bering's iſland only on the weſtern ſhore, being the part oppoſite to Aſia, where they firſt appear on their migration from the ſouth. They continue on ſhore three months, during which time the females bring forth. Excepting their employ of ſuckling their young, they paſs their time in total inactivity.LONG SLEEP AND FASTING. The males ſink into the moſt profound indolence, and deep ſleep; nor are they ever rouſed, except by ſome great provocation, ariſing from an invaſion of their place, or a jealouſy of their females. During the whole time they neither eat nor drink. Steller diſſected numbers, without finding the leſt appearance of food in their ſtomachs.

They live in families.LIVE IN FAMILIES. Every male is ſurrounded by a ſeraglio of from eight to fifty miſtreſſes; theſe he guards with the jealouſy of an eaſtern monarch. Each family keeps ſeparate from the others, notwithſtanding they lie by thouſands on the ſhore. Every family, with the unmarried and the young, amount to about a hundred and twenty. They alſo ſwim in tribes when they take to the ſea.

[168] AFFECTION TOWARDS THEIR YOUNG.The males ſhew great affection towards their young, and equal tyranny towards the females. The former are fierce in the protection of their offspring; and ſhould any one attempt to take their cub, will ſtand on the defenſive, while the female carries it away in her mouth. Should ſhe happen to drop it, the male inſtantly quits its enemy, falls on her, and beats her againſt the ſtones till he leaves her for dead. As ſoon as ſhe recovers, ſhe crawls to his feet in the moſt ſuppliant manner, and waſhes them with her tears; he at the ſame time brutally inſults her miſery, ſtalking about in the moſt inſolent manner. But if the young is entirely carried off, he melts into the greateſt affliction, likewiſe ſheds tears, and ſhews every mark of deep ſorrow. It is probable that as the female brings only one, or at moſt two cubs, he feels his misfortune the more ſenſibly.

Thoſe animals which are deſtitute of females, through age or impotence, or are deſerted by them, withdraw themſelves from ſociety, and grow exceſſively ſplenetic, peeviſh, and quarrelſome; are very furious, and ſo attached to their antient ſtations, as to prefer death to the loſs of them. They are enormouſly fat, and emit a moſt nauſeous and rank ſmell. If they perceive another animal approach its ſeat, they are inſtantly rouſed from their indolence, ſnap at the encroacher,CONFLICTS. and give battle. During the fight they inſenſibly intrude on the ſtation of their neighbor. This creates new offence; ſo that at length the civil diſcord ſpreads through the whole ſhore, attended with hideous growls, their note of war. They are very tenacious of life, and will live a fortnight after receiving ſuch wounds as would ſoon deſtroy any other animal.

CAUSES OF THEM.The particular cauſes of diſputes among theſe iraſcible beaſts are the following:—The firſt and greateſt is, when an attempt is made to ſeduce any of their miſtreſſes, or a young female of the family: a battle is the immediate conſequence of the inſult. The unhappy vanquiſhed inſtantly loſes his whole ſeraglio, who deſert him for the victorious hero.

[169]The invaſion of the ſtation of another, gives riſe to freſh conflicts; and the third cauſe is the interfering in the diſputes of others. The battles they wage are very tremendous; the wounds they inflict very deep, like the cut of a ſabre. At the concluſion of an engagement they fling themſelves into the ſea to waſh off the blood.

Beſides their notes of war, they have ſeveral others.NOTES. When they lie on ſhore, and are diverting themſelves, they low like a Cow. After victory they chirp like a Cricket. On a defeat, or after receiving a wound, mew like a Cat.

Common Seals, and Sea Otters,DREAD THE LEONINE SEAL. ſtand in great awe of theſe animals, and ſhun their haunts. They again are in equal awe of the Leonine Seals, and do not care to begin a quarrel in their ſight, dreading the intervention of ſuch formidable arbitrators; who likewiſe poſſeſs the firſt place on the ſhore.

The great and old animals are in no fear of mankind,FEAR NOT MANKIND. unleſs they are ſuddenly ſurprized by a loud ſhout, when they will hurry by thouſands into the ſea, ſwim about, and ſtare at the novelty of their diſturbers.

When they come out of the water, they ſhake themſelves, and ſmooth their hair with their hind feet: apply their lips to thoſe of the females, as if they meant to kiſs them: lie down and baſk in the ſun with their hind legs up, which they wag as a Dog does its tail. Sometimes they lie on their back, ſometimes roll themſelves up into a ball, and fall aſleep. Their ſleep is never ſo ſound but they are awoke by the leſt alarm; for their ſenſe of hearing, and alſo that of ſmelling, is moſt exquiſite.

They copulate, more humano, in July, COPULATION. and bring forth in the June following; ſo they go with young eleven months.GESTATION. The cubs are as ſportive as puppies; have mock fights, and tumble one another on the ground. The male parent looks on with a ſort of complacency, parts them, licks and kiſſes them, and ſeems to take a greater affection to the victor than to the others.

[170] SWIET SWIMMERS.They ſwim with amazing ſwiftneſs and ſtrength, even at the rate of ſeven or eight miles an hour, and often on their back. They dive well, and continue a great while under water. If wounded in that element, they will ſeize on the boat, carry it with them with great impetuoſity, and often will ſink it.

When they wiſh to aſcend the rocks, they fix their fore feet on them, arch their backs, and then draw themſelves up.

CAPTURE.The Kamtſchatkans take them by harpooning, for they never land on their ſhore. To the harpoon is faſtened a long line, by which they draw the animal to the boat after it is ſpent with fatigue; but in the chaſe, the hunters are very fearful of too near an approach, leaſt the animal ſhould faſten on and ſink their veſſel.

USES.The uſes of them are not great. The fleſh of the old males is rank and nauſeous; that of the females is ſaid to reſemble lamb; of the young ones roaſted, a ſucking pig. The ſkins of the young, cut out of the bellies of the dams, are eſteemed for cloathing, and are ſold for about three ſhillings and four pence each; thoſe of the old for only four ſhillings.

RE-MIGRATION.Their re-migration is in the month of September, when they depart exceſſively lean, and take their young with them. On their return, they again paſs near the ſame parts of Kamtſchatka which they did in the ſpring. Their winter retreats are quite unknown; it is probable that they are the iſlands between the Kurili and Japan, of which we have ſome brief accounts, under the name of Compagnie Land, States Land, and Jeſo Gaſima, which were diſcovered by Martin Uriel in 1642*. It is certain that by his account the natives employ themſelves in the capture of Seals. Sailors do not give themſelves the trouble of obſerving the nice diſtinction of ſpecific marks, we are therefore at liberty to conjecture thoſe which he ſaw [171] to be our animals, eſpecially as we can fix on no more convenient place for their winter quarters. They arrive along the ſhores of the Kurili iſlands, and part of thoſe of Kamtſchatka, from the ſouth. They land and inhabit only the weſtern ſide of Bering's, iſle, which faces Kamtſchatka; and when they return in September, their route is due ſouth, pointing towards the diſcoveries of Uriel. Had they migrated from the ſouth-eaſt as well as the ſouth-weſt, every iſle, and every ſide of every iſle, would have been filled with them; nor ſhould we have found (as we do) ſuch a conſtant and local reſidence.

Before I quit this article I muſt obſerve, that there ſeems to be in the ſeas of Jeſo Gaſimo another ſpecies of Seal, perhaps our little Seal, No 386. Hiſt. Quad. The account indeed is but obſcure, which I muſt give as related by Charlevoix in his compilations reſpecting that iſland. "The natives," ſays he, ‘make uſe of an oil to drink, drawn from a ſort of fiſh, a ſmall hairy creature with four feet.’ If this account is true, it ſerves to point out the fartheſt known reſidence of this genus, on this ſide of the northern hemiſphere.

Finally, the Urſine Seals are found in the ſouthern hemiſphere,URSINE SEAL IN THE SOUTHERN HEMISPHERE. even from under the line, in the iſle of Gallipagos , to New Georgia , in ſouth latitude 54. 15. and weſt longitude 37. 15. In the intermediate parts, they are met with in New Zeland , in the iſle of Juan Fernandez, and its neighbor Maſſa Fuera, and probably along the coaſts of Chili to Terra del Fuego, and Staten Land. In Juan Fernandez, Staten Land, and new Georgia , they ſwarm; as they do at the northern extremity of this vaſt ocean. Thoſe of the ſouthern hemiſphere have alſo their ſeaſons of migration. Alexander Selkirk, who paſſed three lonely years on the iſle of Juan Fernandez, remarks [172] that they come aſhore in June, and ſtay till September *. Captain Cook found them again, in their place of remigration, in equal abundance, on Staten Land and New Georgia, in the months of December and January ; and Don Pernety found them on the Falkland iſlands, in the month of February.

According to the Greenlanders, this ſpecies inhabits the ſouthern parts of their country. They call it Auvekaejak. That it is very fierce, and tears to pieces whatſoever it meets; that it lives on land as well as in water, ſwims moſt impetuouſly, and is dreaded by the hunters.

80. LEONINE. Hiſt. Quad. No 389. Beſtia Marina, Kurillis, Kamtſchadalis et Ruſſis, Kurillice nomine Siwutſcha dicta. Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 360. Lion Marin, Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 428.

SEAL. With a large head: noſe turning up like that of a pug Dog: eyes large; pupil ſmaragdine: the greater angle of each as if ſtained with cinnabar color. In the upper jaw four ſmall cutting teeth; the exterior on each ſide remote, and at ſome diſtance from theſe are two large canine teeth: in the lower jaw four ſmall cutting teeth, and the canine: the grinders ſmall and obtuſe; four on each ſide above, and five below: ears conic and erect: feet exactly like thoſe of the Urſine Seal.

Along the neck of the male is a mane of ſtiff curled hair; and the whole neck is covered with long waved hairs, ſuch as diſtinguiſh a Lion; the reſt of the animal cloathed with ſhort reddiſh hairs: thoſe of the female are of the color of ochre; the young of a much deeper. The old animals grow grey with age.

[173]The weight of a large male beaſt is ſixteen hundred pounds. Length of the males is ſometimes fourteen, or even eighteen feet*. The females are very diſproportionably leſſer, not exceeding eight feet.

Inhabits the eaſtern coaſts of Kamtſchatka, from cape Kronozki as low as cape Lapatka and the Kurili iſlands, and even as far as Matſmai, which probably is the ſame with Jeſo Gaſima. Near Matſmai Captain Spanberg obſerved a certain iſland of a moſt pictureſque form, bordered with rocks reſembling buildings, and ſwarming with theſe animals, to which he gave the name of the Palace of the Sea Lions . Like the Urſine Seals, they are not found on the weſtern ſide of the peninſula. They abound, in the months of June, July, Auguſt, and September, on Bering's iſland, which they inhabit for the ſake of quiet parturition and ſuckling their young. Steller alſo ſaw them in abundance in July on the coaſts of America.

They do not migrate like the former; but only change the place of reſidence, having winter and ſummer ſtations. They live chiefly on rocky ſhores, or lofty rocks in the ſea, which ſeem to have been torn away from the land by the violence of ſome earthquake. Theſe they climb, and by their dreadful roaring are of uſe in foggy weather to warn navigators to avoid deſtruction.

They copulate in the months of Auguſt and September; go ten months, and bring only one at a time. The parents ſhew them little affection, often tread them to death through careleſsneſs, and will ſuffer them to be killed before them without concern or reſentment. The cubs are not ſportive, like other young animals, but are almoſt always aſleep. Both male and female take them to ſea to learn them to ſwim; when wearied, they will climb on the back of their dam; but the male often puſhes them off, to habituate them to the [174] exerciſe. The Ruſſians were wont to fling the cubs into the water, and they always ſwam back to ſhore.

The males treat the females with great reſpect, and are very fond of their careſſes. They are polygamous, but content themſelves with fewer wives than the former, having only from two to four apiece.

FEAR MANKIND;The males have a terrible aſpect, yet they take to flight on the firſt appearance of a human creature; and if they are diſturbed from their ſleep, ſeem ſeized with great horrors, ſigh deeply in their attempts to go away, fall into vaſt confuſion, tumble down, and tremble in ſuch a manner as ſcarcely to be able to uſe their limbs. But if they are reduced to a ſtrait, ſo as not poſſibly to effect an eſcape, they grow deſperate, turn on their enemy with great fury and noiſe, and even put the moſt valiant to flight.

UNLESS HABITUATED.By uſe they loſe their fear of men. Steller once lived for ſix days in a hovel amidſt their chief quarters, and found them ſoon reconciled to the ſight of him. They would obſerve what he was doing with great calmneſs, lie down oppoſite to him, and ſuffer him to ſeize on their cubs. He had an opportunity of ſeeing their conflicts about their females; and once ſaw a duel between two males, which laſted three days, and one of them received above a hundred wounds. The Urſine Seals never interfered, but got out of the way as faſt as poſſible. They even ſuffered the cubs of the former to ſport with them without offering them the leſt injury.

This ſpecies has many of the ſame actions with the former, in ſwimming, walking, lying, and ſcratching itſelf. The old bellow like Bulls;NOTES. the young bleat like Sheep. Steller ſays, that from their notes he ſeemed like a ruſtic amidſt his herds. The males had a ſtrong ſmell, but were not near ſo fetid as the Urſine ſort.

FOOD.Their food is fiſh, the leſſer Seals, Sea Otters, and other marine animals. During the months of June and July the old males almoſt entirely abſtain from eating, indulge in indolence and ſleep, and become exceſſively emaciated.

[175]The voyagers made uſe of them to ſubſiſt on,USES. and thought the fleſh of the young very ſavoury. The feet turned into jelly on being dreſſed, and in their ſituation were eſteemed great delicacies. The fat was not oily; that of the young reſembled the ſuet of mutton, and was as delicious as marrow. The ſkin was uſeful for ſtraps, ſhoes, and boots.

The Kamtſchatkans eſteem the chaſe of theſe animals a generous diverſion, and hold the man in higheſt honor,CHASE. in proportion to the number he has killed. Even theſe heroes are very cautious when they attack one of the animals on ſhore: they watch an opportunity when they find it aſleep, approach it againſt the wind, ſtrike their harpoon, faſtened to a long thong, into its breaſt, while their comrades faſten one end to a ſtake, and that done, he takes to his heels with the utmoſt precipitation. They effect his deſtruction at a diſtance, by ſhooting him with arrows, or flinging their lances into him; and when exhauſted, they venture to come near enough to knock him on the head with clubs.

When they diſcover one on the lonely rocks in the ſea, they ſhoot it with poiſoned arrows: unable to endure the pain of the wound, heightened by the ſalt-water, which it plunges into on the firſt receiving it, it ſwims on ſhore in the greateſt agony. If they find a good opportunity, they transfix it with their weapons; if not, they leave it to die of the poiſon, which it infallibly does in twenty-four hours, and in the moſt dreadful agony*.

They eſteem it a great diſgrace to leave any of their game behind: and this point of honor they often obſerve, even to their own deſtruction; for it happens that when they go in ſearch of theſe animals to the iſle of Alait, which lies ſome miles ſouth-weſt of Lapatka promontory, they obſerve this principle ſo religiouſly, as to overload their boats ſo much, as to ſend them and their booty to the bottom; for they ſcorn to ſave themſelves, at the expence of throwing overboard any part.

[176]This ſpecies has been diſcovered very low in the ſouthern hemiſphere; but, I believe, not on the weſtern ſide. Sir John Narborrough * met with them on an iſland off Port Deſire, in lat. 47. 48. Sir Richard Hawkins found them on Pinguin iſle, within the ſecond Narrow of the ſtreights of Magellan. They abound in the Falkland Iſlands ; and were again diſcovered by Captain Cook on the New Year's Iſlands, off the weſt coaſt of Staten Land . In thoſe ſouthern latitudes they bring forth their young in the middle of our winter, the ſeaſon in which our late circumnavigators § viſited thoſe diſtant parts.

HIST. QUAD. GENUS XLIII.MANATI.
[177]
Hiſt. Quad. No 390. 81. WHALETAILED. Morſkaia Korowa, Ruſſorum. Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 294. Vaches Marines, Deſer. Kamtſchatka, 446.

MANATI. With a ſmall oblong ſquariſh head, hanging down: mouth ſmall: lips doubled, forming an outward and inward lip: about the junction of the jaws a ſet of white tubular briſtles, as thick as a pigeon's quil, which ſerve as ſtrainers to permit the running out of the water, and to retain the food: the lips covered with ſtrong briſtles, which ſerve inſtead of teeth to crop the ſtrong roots of marine plants: no teeth, but in each jaw a flat white oblong bone with an undulated ſurface, which being placed above and below, performs the uſe of grinders to comminute the food.

Noſtrils placed at the end of the noſe, and lined with briſtles: no ears, only in their place a ſmall orifice.

Eyes very ſmall, not larger than thoſe of a Sheep, hardly viſible through the little round holes in the ſkin; the irides black; the pupil livid: tongue pointed and ſmall.

The whole animal is of great deformity: the neck thick, and its union with the head ſcarcely diſcernible: the two feet, or rather fins, are fixed near the ſhoulders; are only twenty-ſix inches long; are deſtitute of toes, or nails, but terminate in a ſort of hoof, concave beneath, lined with briſtles, and fitted for digging in ſand.

The outward ſkin is black, rugged, and knotty, like the bark of an aged oak: without any hair; an inch thick, and ſo hard as ſcarcely to be cut with an ax; and when cut, appears in the inſide like ebony. From the nape to the tail it is marked with circular wrinkles riſing into knots, and ſharp points on the ſide. This ſkin covers the whole [178] body like a cruſt, and is of ſingular uſe to the animal during winter, in protecting it againſt the ice, under which it often feeds, or againſt the ſharp-pointed rocks, againſt which it is often daſhed by the wintry ſtorms. It is alſo an equal guard againſt the ſummer heats; for this animal does not, like moſt other marine creatures, feed at the bottom, but with part of the body expoſed, as well to the rays of the ſun as to the piercing cold of the froſt. In fact, this integument is ſo eſſential to its preſervation, that Steller has obſerved ſeveral dead on the ſhore, which he believes were killed by the accidental privation of it. The color of this ſkin, when wet, is duſky, when dried, quite black.

The tail is horizontally flat;TAIL. black, and ending in a ſtiff fin, compoſed of laminae like whale-bone, terminating with fibres near nine inches long. It is ſlightly forked; but both ends are of equal lengths, like the tail of a Whale.

It has two teats placed exactly on the breaſt. The milk is thick and ſweet, not unlike that of a Ewe. Theſe animals copulate more humano, and in the ſeaſon of courtſhip ſport long in the ſea; the female feigning to ſhun the embraces of the male, who purſues her through all the mazes of her flight.

The body, from the ſhoulders to the navel, is very thick; from thence to the tail grows gradually more ſlender. The belly is very large; and, by reaſon of the quantity of entrails, very tumid.

SIZE.Theſe animals grow to the length of twenty-eight feet. The meaſurements of one ſomewhat leſſer, as given by Mr. Steller, are as follow:

The length, from the noſe to the end of the tail, twenty-four feet and a half: from the noſe to the ſhoulders, or ſetting-on of the fins, four feet four. The circumference of the head, above the noſtrils, two feet ſeven; above the ears, four feet: at the nape of the neck, near ſeven feet: at the ſhoulders, twelve: about the belly, above twenty: near the tail, only four feet eight: the extent of the tail, from point to point, ſix feet and a half.

[179]The weight of a large one is eight thouſand pounds.WEIGHT. PLACE.

Inhabits the ſhores of Bering's and the other iſlands which intervene between the two continents. They never appear off Kamtſchatka, unleſs blown aſhore by tempeſts, as they ſometimes are about the bay of Awatſcha. The natives ſtyle them Kapuſtnik, or cabbage-eaters, from their food. This genus has not been diſcovered in any other part of the northern hemiſphere. That which inhabits the eaſtern ſide of South America, and ſome part of Africa, is of a different ſpecies. For the latter I can teſtify, from having ſeen one from Senegal. Its body was quite ſmooth; its tail ſwelled out in the middle, and ſloped towards the end, which was rounded*. To ſupport my other opinion, I can call in the faithful Dampier; who deſcribes the body as perfectly ſmooth: had it that ſtriking integument which the ſpecies in queſtion has, it could not have eſcaped his notice. Let me alſo add, that the ſize of thoſe which that able ſeaman obſerved, did not exceed ten or twelve feet; nor the weight of the largeſt reach that of twelve hundred pounds.

I ſuſpect that this ſpecies extends to Mindanao, for one kind is certainly found there. It is met with much farther ſouth; for I diſcover, in the collection of Sir JOSEPH BANKS, a ſketch of one taken near Diego Rodriguez, vulgarly called Diego Rais, an iſle to the eaſt of Mauritius; and it may poſſibly have found its way through ſome northern inlet to the ſeas of Greenland; for Mr. Fabricius once diſcovered in that country the head of one, half conſumed, with teeth, exactly agreeing with thoſe of this ſpecies§.

Theſe animals frequent the ſhallow and ſandy parts of the ſhores,MANNERS. and near the mouths of the ſmall rivers of the iſland of Bering, ſeemingly pleaſed with the ſweet water. They go in herds: the old keep behind and drive their young before them: and ſome keep on their ſides, by way of protection. On the riſing of the tide they [180] approach the ſhores, and are ſo tame as to ſuffer themſelves to be ſtroked: if they are roughly treated, they move towards the ſea; but ſoon forget the injury, and return.

They live in families near one another: each conſiſts of a male and female, a half-grown young, and a new-born one. The families often unite, ſo as to form vaſt droves. They are monogamous. They bring forth a ſingle young, but have no particular time of parturition; but chiefly, as Steller imagines, about autumn.

They are moſt innocent and harmleſs in their manners, and moſt ſtrongly attached to one another. When one is hooked, the whole herd will attempt its reſcue: ſome will ſtrive to overſet the boat, by going beneath it; others will fling themſelves on the rope of the hook and preſs it down, in order to break it; and others again will make the utmoſt efforts to force the inſtrument out of its wounded companion.

Their conjugal affection is moſt exemplary: a male, after uſing all its endeavours to releaſe its mate which had been ſtruck, purſued it to the very edge of the water; no blows could force it away. As long as the deceaſed female continued in the water, he perſiſted in his attendance; and even for three days after ſhe was drawn on ſhore, and even cut up and carried away, was obſerved to remain, as if in expectation of her return.

They are moſt voracious creatures, and feed with their head under water, quite inattentive of the boats, or any thing that paſſes about them; moving and ſwimming gently after one another, with much of their back above water. A ſpecies of louſe harbours in the roughneſs of their coats, which the Gulls pick out, ſitting on them as Crows do on Hogs and Sheep. Every now and then they lift their noſe out of the water to take breath, and make a noiſe like the ſnorting of Horſes. When the tide retires, they ſwim away along with it; but ſometimes the young are left aſhore till the return of the water: otherwiſe they never quit that element: ſo that in nature, as well as form, they approach the cetaceous animals, and are the link between Seals and them.

[181]They were taken on Bering's iſle by a great hook faſtened to a long rope. Four or five people took it with them in a boat,CAPTURE. and rowed amidſt a herd. The ſtrongeſt man took the inſtrument, ſtruck it into the neareſt animal; which done, thirty people on ſhore ſeized the rope, and with great difficulty drew it on ſhore. The poor creature makes the ſtrongeſt reſiſtance, aſſiſted by its faithful companions. It will cling with its feet to the rocks till it leaves the ſkin behind; and often great fragments of the cruſty integument fly off before it can be landed. It is an animal full of blood; ſo that it ſpouts in amazing quantities from the orifice of the wound.

They have no voice; only, when wounded, emit a deep ſigh.

They have the ſenſes of ſight and hearing very imperfect; or at leſt neglect the uſe of them.

They are not migratory; for they were ſeen about Bering's iſland the whole of the ſad ten months which Mr. Steller paſſed there after his ſhipwreck.

In the ſummer they were very fat; in the winter ſo lean that the ribs might be counted.

The ſkin is uſed,USES. by the inhabitants about the promontory Tchuktchi, to cover their boats. The fat,THE FAT. which covers the whole body like a thick blubber, was thought to be as good and ſweet as May-butter: that of the young, like hogs-lard. The fleſh of the old,LEAN. when well boiled, reſembled beef: that of the young, veal. The fleſh will not refuſe ſalt. The crew preſerved ſeveral caſks full, which was found of excellent ſervice in their eſcape from their horrible confinement*.

To this article muſt be added an imperfect deſcription of a marine animal ſeen by Mr. Steller on the coaſt of America, which he calls a Sea Ape. SEA APE. The head appeared like that of a Dog, with ſharp and upright ears, large eyes, and with both lips bearded: the body round and conoid; the thickeſt part near the head: the tail forked; [182] the upper lobe the longeſt: the body covered with thick hair, grey on the back, reddiſh on the belly. It ſeemed deſtitute of feet.

It was extremely wanton, and played a multitude of monkey-tricks. It ſometimes ſwam on one ſide, ſometimes on the other ſide of the ſhip, and gazed at it with great admiration. It made ſo near an approach to the veſſel, as almoſt to be touched with a pole; but if any body moved, it inſtantly retired. It would often ſtand erect for a conſiderable ſpace, with one-third of its body above water; then dart beneath the ſhip, and appear on the other ſide; and repeat the ſame thirty times together. It would frequently ariſe with a ſea-plant, not unlike the Bottle-gourd, toſs it up, and catch it in its mouth, playing with it numberleſs fantaſtic tricks*.

On animals of this ſpecies the fable of the Sirens might very well be founded.

SEA BELUGA.I ſhall conclude this article with a recantation of what I ſay in the 357th page of my Synopſis, relating to the Beluga; which I now find was collected, by the author I cite, from the reports of Coſſacks, and ignorant fiſhermen. The animal proves at laſt to be one of the cetaceous tribe, of the genus of Dolphin, and of a ſpecies called by the Germans Wit-Fiſch, and by the Ruſſians Beluga ; both ſignifying White fiſh: but to this the laſt add Morſkaia, or of the ſea, by way of diſtinguiſhing it from a ſpecies of Sturgeon ſo named. It is common in all the Arctic ſeas; and forms an article of commerce, being taken on account of its blubber. They are numerous in the gulph of St. Lawrence; and go with the tide as high as Quebec. There are fiſheries for them, and the common Porpeſſe, in that river. A conſiderable quantity of oil is extracted; and of their ſkins is made a ſort of Morocco leather, thin, yet ſtrong enough to reſiſt a muſquetball. They are frequent in the Dwina and the Oby; and go in ſmall families from five to ten, and advance pretty far up the rivers in purſuit of fiſh. They are uſually caught in nets; but are ſometimes [183] harpooned. They bring only one young at a time, which is duſky; but grow white as they advance in age; the change firſt commencing on the belly. They are apt to follow boats, as if they were tamed; and appear extremely beautiful, by reaſon of their reſplendent whiteneſs*.

It being a ſpecies very little known, and never well engraven, I ſhall give a brief deſcription, and adjoin an engraving taken from an excellent drawing communicated to me by Dr. Pallas.

The head is ſhort: noſe blunt: ſpiracle ſmall,DESCRIPTION. of the form of a creſcent: eyes very minute: mouth ſmall: in each ſide of each jaw are nine teeth, ſhort, and rather blunt; thoſe of the upper jaw are bent, and hollowed, fitted to receive the teeth of the lower jaw when the mouth is cloſed: pectoral fins nearly of an oval form: beneath the ſkin may be felt the bones of five fingers, which terminate at the edge of the fin in five very ſenſible projections. This brings it into the next of rank in the order of beings with the Manati. The tail is divided into two lobes, which lie horizontally, but do not fork, except a little at their baſe. The body is oblong, and rather ſlender, tapering from the back (which is a little elevated) to the tail. It is quite deſtitute of the dorſal fin.

Its length is from twelve to eighteen feet. [...]IZE. It makes great uſe of its tail in ſwimming; for it bends that part under it, as a Lobſter does its tail, and works it with ſuch force as to dart along with the rapidity of an arrow.

A full account of the fiſh of the Whale kind, ſeen by the Reverend Dr. Borlaſe between the Land's End and the Scilly iſlands, is a deſideratum in the Britiſh Natural Hiſtory. He deſcribes them as being from twelve to fifteen feet long; ſome were milk-white, others brown, others ſpotted. They are called Thornbacks, from a ſharp and broad fin on the back. This deſtroys my ſuſpicion of their being of the above ſpecies.

IV. WINGED.

[184]
BAT. HIST. QUAD. GENUS XLIV.
82. NEW YORK. Hiſt. Quad. No 403.—LEV. MUS.

BAT. With the head like that of a Mouſe: top of the noſe a little bifid: ears broad, ſhort, and rounded: in each jaw two canine teeth: no cutting teeth: tail very long, incloſed in the membrane, which is of a triangular form: the wings thin, naked, and duſky: bones of the hind legs very ſlender.

Head, body, and upper part of the membrane incloſing the tail, covered with very long hair of a bright tawny color, paleſt on the head, beginning of the back, and the belly: at the baſe of each wing is a white ſpot.

Length from noſe to tail two inches and a half: tail, one inch eight-tenths: extent of the wings, ten inches and a half.

Inhabits the province of New York; and diſcovered by Dr. Forſter * [...]n New Zealand, in the South Seas.

83. LONG-HAIRED.Mr. Clayton, in Ph. Tranſ. Abridg. iii. 594.

BAT. With long ſtraggling hairs, and great ears.

The above is all the account we have of this ſpecies; which is ſaid to be an inhabitant of Virginia.

Mr. Lawſon ſays, that the common Bat is found in Carolina .

Hiſt. Quad. No 407.—Great Bat, Br. Zool. i. No 38.84. NOCTULE?
[185]

BAT. With the noſe ſlightly bilobated: ears ſmall and rounded: on the chin a ſmall wart: body of a cinereous red.

Extent of wings fifteen inches: body between two and three in length: tail, one inch ſeven-tenths.

Brought from Hudſon's Bay in ſpirits. I ſaw it only in the bottle; but it appeared to be this ſpecies.

A. COMMON BAT, Hiſt. Quad. No 411.—Br. Zool. i. No 41.—LEV. MUS.

THIS ſpecies is found in Iceland, as I was informed by the late Mr. Fleiſcher, which is the moſt northernly reſidence of this genus. In Aſia I can trace them no farther eaſtward than about the river Argun, beyond lake Baikal.

Notes
*
Now reſident in London.
*
A quarto in Latin, containing 685 pages, printed at Leyden, 1777; ſold in London by Mr. Faden, Geographer, St. Martin's Lane.
A new edition of the map has been lately publiſhed by the learned Author; the geographical part is corrected according to the late voyages of Captain COOK, and great additions made to the zoological part. An explanation is given, in the third volume of the Zoologia Geographica, lately publiſhed in German by the Author.
*
Plato died about the year 347 before CHRIST, aged 81. Pythagoras, about 497, aged 90.
See this opinion farther diſcuſſed by Mr. Somner, Ph. Tranſ. Abridg. iv. 230.
*
All the intelligence reſpecting the tides, &c. in theſe parts, I received from Mr. James Hammond of the cuſtom-houſe, Dover, and Mr. William Cowly, a veteran pilot of the ſame place.
*
Six Wild Bulls were uſed at the inſtallation feaſt of George Nevil, archbiſhop of York. Leland's Collect. vi. 2.
Tours in Scotland.
Martial. Plutarch.
§
Raii Syn. Quad. 214.
*
Health's Emprovement.
Ecole de la Chaſſe, clxi.
The Common Seal, is common to the ocean and Mediterranean ſea. Poſſibly the Mediterranean Seal, Hiſt. Quad. No 376, may be ſo likewiſe.—This work is always intended, when the name of the work referred to is not added to the numbers.
*
Vita Agricolae.
Malmſbury, lib. iv. 294.
*
Compare Sir W. Dugdale's maps of this tract, in its moraſſy and drained ſtate. Hiſt. Embank. p. 375. 416.
Same, p. 375.
See Tour in Scotland, 1769; Lincolnſhire, where the fen birds are enumerated.
§
Deſcr. Britain, 108.
*
Madox. Ant. Exch. i. 422.
*
Soft near the top, and of a crumbling quality when expoſed long to the froſt. At the foot of the cliff it is hard, ſolid, and ſmooth. Boats are employed every ſummer in carrying great quantities to Sunderland, where it is burnt into excellent lime. Moſt of the lime-ſtone uſed at Scarborough is made from ſtones flung up by the ſea. It may be remarked, that whatſoever degree of hardneſs any limeſtone poſſeſſes in the quarry, the mortar made from it, by proper management, may be made as hard, but by no means harder. Moſt of the houſes in and about London are built with lime made of chalk; hence the many miſerable caſualties there, by the fall of houſes. The workmen, ſenſible of the weakneſs of that kind of mortar, endeavour to keep the walls together by lodging frames of timber in them; which being conſumed in caſes of fire, the whole building tumbles ſuddenly, and renders all attempts to extinguiſh the fire very dangerous.—Mr. Travis.
*
Conſult vol. iii. of the Br. Zoology for an account of the fiſh on this coaſt: alſo the Tour in Scotland, 1769. To Mr. Travis, Surgeon in Scarborough, I am indebted for the moſt curious articles.
*
Tour in Scotland, 1769; and fuller in Mr. Hutchinſon's Northumberland, ii. 176.
Adair. Hammond. Thompſon.
*
Mr. Hutchinſon, ii. 151.
*
See Tour in Scotland, 1772. part ii. p. 212.
Douglas's Eaſt Coaſt of Scotland, 14.
*
Theſe deſcriptions borrowed from my own Tours.
*
Antiquities and Scenery of Scotland, letter vi. plates ii. iii.
*
See Mr. Cordiner's beautiful view of a ſtack of this kind, tab. xv.
*
Mr. Cordiner's elegant deſcription, p. 85.
Mackenſie's Charts of the Orknies, p. 4, 5.
*
Murdoch Mackenſ [...].
*
Claudian.
Mela, lib. iii. c. 6. Plin. lib. iv. c. 16.
Tour Scotl. 1772. p. 70.
Same p. 25.
§
Claudian, de iv. Conſ. Honorii.
Torfaeus Rer. Orcad. lib. i. c. 3. p. 10.
*
Hiſt. Nat. lib. x. c. 3.
*
Phil. Tranſ. abr. xi. 1328.
*
Ariſtol. Meteorolog. lib. i. c. 5. Plin. Nat. Hiſt. lib. ii. c. 26.
See various accounts of them in the Phil. Tranſ. abr. iv. part ii. 138.
*
See my Voy. to the Hebrides, and Br. Zool. iii. for the hiſtory of the Herring.
Br. Zool. iii. No 89.
*
Debes, Hiſt. Ferroe Iſles, 154.
480 feet.
*
Torfaeus Rer. Orcad. lib. i. c. 7.
See Ihre Gloſſarium Sueo-Gothicum, where the word is defined, munimentum, derived from Berga cuſtodire, or Byrgia claudire.
Baxter. Gloſſ. Antiq. Brit. 109.
*
Ihre Gloſſ. Sueo-Goth. 1085.
Crit. Diſſ. by John Macpherſon, D. D. 325.
Torfaeus Rer. Orcad. 8.
§
Baxter, Gloſſ. Antiq. Brit. 109.
Information by letter from Mr. Suhm of Copenhagen.
Dalhberg, tab. 64.
**
The ſame, tab. 300.—For more ample accounts, ſee Mr. Cordiner's Letters, 73, 105, 118, and my Tours in Scotland.
Vegetius de re Milit. lib. iv. c. 10.
Mr. Low.
*
Antiq. Cornwall, 195.
*
See Mr. Low's account, and plate, Archaeologia, iii. 276. tab. xiii.
*
Wormii Mon. Dan. 50. Dalhberg Suecia Antiqua, et Hodierna, tab. 314.
Dahlberg Suecia Antiqua, tab. 322.
The ſame, 315.
The ſame, 323.
§
Saxo Gramm. 147.
*
Dahlberg, tab. 315.
The ſame, and tab. 281.
Olaus Magnus.
Wormii Mon. Dan. p. 63.
§
I do not well underſtand ſome of theſe diſtinctions; but give them from Olaus Magnus, lib. i. c. 18. Moſt of them are exemplified at Finſta in Sweden. See Dahlberg, tab. 104, and Perinſkiold Monum. Sueo-Goth. p. 216.
Wormii Monum. Dan. 64, & paſſim.
**
Dahlberg, tab. 314.
††
By my friend, the Reverend Mr. Williams of Vron.
*
Wormii Mon. Dan. p. 8.
Dalhberg, tab. 280.
The ſame, 105.
*
Theſe on the authority of Mr. Debes, who wrote the hiſtory of theſe iſles in 1670.
Brunnich, p. 46.
*
In Pontoppidan's Hiſt. Norway, ii. 61. is a plate expreſſive of this manner of fowling.
*
Olaus Magnus, Archb. of Upſal.
See his plan, p. 52.
Iſlands Landnamabok, 5.
*
The works of Pytheas had been read by Dicaearchus, a diſciple of Ariſtotle's. See Strabo, lib. ii. p. 163.
Plin. lib. ii. c. 75.
Same, p. 7.
§
Same, p. 8. Torfoeus. Hiſt. Norveg. ii. 97.
*
Hiſt. Norweg. i. 12.
*
Hiſt. Nat. lib. ii. c. 87.
Moſt admirably deſcribed in the Ph. Tranſ. Abridg. v. 196, &c.
Oſbeck's Voy. ii. 98. Forſter's Voy. ii. 575. 576.
Mallet, i. 15.
§
Kerguelin, 175.
See Olaffen, i. tab. xvii.
*
Bartholinus de Contemptu Mortis, 359.
Letter from Mr. Brunnich, dated October 31, 1783.
*
See Mr. Whiteburſt's Theory.
Sable noir comme la poudre a canon. Voyage au Nord, par M. de Kerguelin, 69.
The ſame, 65, 66.
*
Arngrim Jonas's Comment. Iceland, in Hackluyt, i. 556.
See Olaffen, i. tab. iii. Ponroppidan, ii. tab. p. 272.
*
Monfaucon Monum. de la Monarchie Fr. ii. tab. xlii.
Voy. Hebrides.
Confer. Olaffen. ii. 234. and Amoen. Acad. iv. 151.
*
Olaffen, as related to him.
Linnaeus, Klein, Rzaczinſki, Scheffer.
*
  • Sea Eagle, No 87.
  • Cinereous Eagle, p. 214, B.
  • Iceland Falcon, 216, D.
  • Gyrfalcon, 221, F.
  • Lanner, 225, K.
  • Short-ear'd Owl? No 116.
  • Raven, No 134.
  • White Grous, No 183.
  • Hazel Grous? p. 317, F.
  • Stare, p. 331. A.
  • Red-wing Thruſh, p. 342. D.
  • Leſſer Field-Lark, p. 395.
  • Snow Bunting, No 222.
  • White Wagtail, p. 396.
  • Wheat-ear, p. 420.
  • Wien, No 322.
Olaffen, ii. tab. xlvi. gives the figure of an Owl reſembling his ſpecies.
*
Iſland's Landnamabok, 172.
Bartholinus de Cauſis contemptae Mortis, &c. 429.
Mallot's Northern Antiq. ii. 132.
*
Voyage au Mer du Nord, 69.
Horrebow, 101.
Kerguelin, 31.
Troill, 48, 49.
§
Kerguelin, 20, 175.
See p. xlv.
*
Rymer's Foed. ix. 322.
Ibid. xvi. 443.
Ibid. xv. 443.
Cambden's Life of Queen Elizabeth, in the Complete Hiſt. of England, ii. 550.
*
Lord Mulgrave's Voy. towards the North Pole.
*
Anderſon's Dict. i. 225.
*
De Mor. German. c. 40.
Mallet's North. Antiq. Tranſl. i. 136.
Emmii Hiſt. Rer. Friz. 129. ed. Franck.
§
Buſching Geogr. i. 157.167.
*
Ptolem. lib. ii. c. 11.
Plin. Nat. Hiſt. lib. iv. c. 13.
§
Mela, lib. iii. c. 3.8.
*
Plin. lib. ii. c. 67. lib. iv. c. 13.
Lib. xxxvii. c. 3.
Forſſenius de Monum. Kivtkenſe, p. 27.
Ruſſian and other charts.
*
Flora Suec.
Flora Lapp.
  • Porpeſſe,
  • Sea Lamprey,
  • Sturgeon,
  • Lannee,
  • Sword-fiſh,
  • Striated Cod-fiſh,
  • Viviparous Blenny,
  • Beardleſs Ophidion,
  • Lump,
  • Hornſimpa,
  • Turbot,
  • Flounder,
  • Salmon,
  • Gar-fiſh,
  • Smelt,
  • Herring,
  • Sprat,
  • Little Pipe-fiſh,
  • Shorter P.
  • Blind P.

I find that the Aſinus Callarias is common to the Baltic and our ſeas, therefore muſt be added to the liſt of Britiſh fiſh.

Muſ. Fr. Adolph. i. 70. tab. xxxii. fig. 4.
*
Hiſt. Abregè de Nord. i. 206.
Prof. Ritzius of Lund.
Ph. Tr. Abr. vii. part. iv. p. 44.
§
Hiſt. Abregè du Nord. ii. 59.
The ſame, p. 3.
*
Anderſon, ii. 419.
Amoen. Acad. iv. 570. Fl. Lap. 273.
§
Scheffer's Lapland.
Ptolemy.
*
Caeſar Bell. Gall. lib. iv. Plin. lib. viii. c. 15.
Tacitus de Mor. Germ.
Forſter's Obſ. 96.
*
Forſter's Obſ. 80.
*
At the end of his ſecond vol. of Germania Antiqua.
Jornandes de Reb. Geticis, c. iii.
The ſame, c. iv.
§
As quoted by Pliny, lib. iv. c. 13.
*
Mallet's Introd. i. 257.
Jornandes, c. 4.
*
Pontoppidan, i.
The ſame, i. 68.
Le Bruyn's Voyages, i. tab. 1.
§
Olaus Magnus, Gent. Septentr. lib. ii. c. xi.
Mr. Bayley, in Phil. Tranſ. lix. 270.
*
Pontoppidan, i. 93. tab. vii.
Amoen. Acad. iv.
Voy. Hebrides.
*
For this curious account, I am indebted to Doctor Garden, who, by his long reſidence in Charlestown, is extremely well acquainted with the ſubject.
Troille's Voy. to Iceland, 47.
Doctor Garden.
Pontoppidan, i. 179. Muſeum Regium Havniae, pars ii. ſect. v. tab. xx. No 18.—With more truth, perhaps, our verſion has it, out of the north cometh COLD.
*
Sevo mons ibi immenſus, nec Riphaeis jugis minor, immanem ad Cimbrorum uſque promontorium efficit ſmum, qui Codanus vocatur. Lib. iv. c. 13.
Pontoppidan, i. 46. tab. iii.
The ſame, i. 47. tab. iii.
Of two Daniſh feet each.
§
Epoques de la Nature, Suppl. tom. vi. p. 136. edit. Amſterdam.
Of 18,000 feet each.
*
Fl. Lapp. p. 108.
*
I have no proof of this but the name. The Lynx inhabits Norway and Sweden, and all the woody parts of Sibiria; a circumſtance I omitted in p. 50, of this Work. I ſcarcely know whether I ſhould apologize for the omiſſion of the Fitchet, Hiſt. Quad. i. No 195; the Muſtela Putorius, No 16, Faun. Suec. LINNAEUS ſpeaks with uncertainty of its being found in Scania, and that is a latitude rather too far ſouth for my plan.
See Mr. Gabriel Bonſdorff's account of the animals of Finland, p. 24.
*
Conſult Leems Lapm. 214, 215, 216. Alſo for the Mouſe, &c. which want the Lapland names.
Leems, 220.
It is a native of the Eaſt Indies. See Hiſt. Quad. ii. No 44.
*
See the Plates in Pontoppidan's Hiſt. Norway.
In the Britiſh Zoology, iii. No 40. the trivial Spinax is inſerted inſtead of Acanthias.
*
The Tranſlation of Oroſius, by the Hon. Daines Barrington, p. 9, &c. and Hackluyt, i. 4.
Phil. Tranſ. vol. lix. 117.
Lord Moleſworth's Account of Denmark, 25.
*
See Mr. Forſſenius's curious diſſertation on this antiquity, printed at Lund, 1780.
Anth. Jenkinſon's Voy. in Hackluyt, i. 311.
Leems, 169.
Scheffer, 12, and Lin. Faun. Suec. 1.
§
Leems, 342.
Hackluyt, i. 416.
††
Torfaei Hiſt. Nerwegiae, i. 96.
*
Hackluyt, i. 246.
See a view of theſe iſland in Phil. Tranſ. vol. lix. tab. xiv.
*
Purchas, iii. 566.
The ſame, pp. 560. 565.
The ſame, 564.
The ſame, 558. 564.
§
Barrington's Miſcel. 35.
*
Phips, 54.
The ſame, 58.
Purchas, iii. 527.
Voy. to the Hebrides.
Amoen. Acad. vii. Rariore Norvegiae, 477.
Phips Voy. tab. iv.
§
Same, tab. iii.
See theſe diſtreſsful ſituations in tab. B. of Fr. Marten's Voyage, and Gerard le Ver, Voy. au Nord, p. 19, edition 1606.
*
Phips Voy. tab. v.
Same, tab. vi.
Crantz. i. 31.
*
Crantz, i. 31.
Phips, 72.
Ellis's Voy. 127.
Marten, 37. Crantz, i. 31.
§
See the beautiful plate in Phips's Voy. tab. vii.
**
Phips, p. 70.
*
Marten, 43.
The ſame.
The ſame.
§
The ſame, 51.
Relation of Eight Engliſhmen, &c. Churchill's Coll. iv. 818.—Relation of Seven Dutchmen, &c. Churchill, ii. 430.
Narrative of Four Ruſſian ſailors, 94.
**
De Ver, trois Voy. au Nord. 22, b.
††
Relation of Eight Engliſhmen, &c. 817, 818, 819.
*
Marten, 48.
Voy. 71.
Phips Voy. 33.
§
The ſame, on tab. viii.
Narrative of Four Ruſſian ſailors, 78, 89.
*
Churchill, iv. 819.
*
See the curious Narrative.
Churchill's Coll. ii. 415, 427.
The ſame, iv. 808.
§
The ſame, p. 818.
*
See p.
Phips Voy. 190, &c. tab. xii.
The ſame, p. 194, 195.
*
Hackluyt, i. 274, 280.
Trois Voyages au Nord, &c. par Girard de Ver, p. 14, 15.
*
Anderſon's Dict. i. 97.
The ſame, 328.
Nov. Com. Petrop. xiv. 484. tab. xii. Its length does not exceed eleven inches.
Hackluyt, i. 277.
§
Purchas, i. 546.
The ſame, 549.
*
Plinii Hiſt. Nat. lib. iv. c. 12.
In Aſiatico littore primi Hyperborei, ſuper aquilonem Riphaeoſque montes, ſub ipſo ſiderum cardine jacent; ubi ſol non quotidiè, ut nobis, ſed primùm verno Aequinoctio exortus, autumnali demum occidit; et ideò ſex menſibus dies, & totidem aliis nox uſque continua eſt. Terra auguſta, aprica, per ſe fertilis, Cultores juſtiſſimi, et diutiùs quam ulli mortalium & beatiùs vivunt. Quippe feſto ſemper otio laeti, non bella novêre, non jurgia; ſacris operati, maximè Apollinis; quorum primitias Delon miſiſſe, initio per virgines ſuas, deinde per populos ſubinde tradentes ulterioribus; moremque eum diu, & donec vitio gentium temeratus eſt, ſervaſſe referuntur. Habitant lucos ſylvaſque; et ubi eos vivendi ſatietas magis quam taedium cepit, hilares, redimiti ſertis, ſemet ipſi in pelagus ex certa rupe praecipiti dant. Id eis funus eximium eſt. Lib. iii. c. 5.
Voyage de la Siberie, ii. 605.
Preface to Flor. Sibir. i. 54.
*
Obſervations ſur la Formation des Montagnes, par P. S. PALLAS, p. 18.
Doctor PALLAS.
*
Hackluyt. i. 282.
Doctor PALLAS.
See this curious voyage, as related by De Veer.
PALLAS.
§
Coxe's Ruſſian Diſcoveries, 306.
Gmelin Introd. Fl. Sib. vii. xxx. By Leuca he ſeems to mean a Verſt, of which 104 ½ make a degree. See cxxiii. and Mr. Coxe's Ruſſian Diſcoveries, Introd. xiii.
*
Pref. Fl. Sibir. xliv.
Bell's Travels, 8vo. ed. i. 279.
*
Voyage en Siberie, i. 213.
Same, ii. 56.
Same, 57.
Same, and Purchas, iii. 539.
§
In Bergeron's Collection, 160, 161.
*
Voy. en Siberie, ii. 30.
Poſſibly Verſts. See Voy. en Siberie, i. 407.
Doctor PALLAS.
§
Voy. en Siberie, ii. 27, 28.
Same, ii. 362.
*
Voy. en Siberie, ii. 29.
PALLAS: Alſo Narrative of four Ruſſian ſailors caſt away on Eaſt Spitzbergen, 55.
Forſter's Obſ. 81.
*
This was ſuppoſed to have been part of the continent of America; but in 1768, M. Tchitſcherin, governor of Sibiria, put the matter out of doubt; for he ſent there three young officers in the winter, on the ice. They found ſome ſmall deſart iſles, without the leſt appearance of land on the north; but on one they met with a ſort of defence, formed of floating wood, on the ſide of a precipice, but by whom formed, or againſt what enemy, is hard to gueſs. PALLAS. MS.
*
P. 323 to 329.
Ph. Tranſ. lxvii. 471.
Pref. Flora Sib. 78.
§
Forſter's Obſ. 85. quoted from Gmelin.
Pref. Flora Sib. 73.
Voy. en Siberie, ii. 31, 52.
*
The Schokur and Naſus are two ſpecies of Coregoni, or Salmons, with very ſmall teeth.
Voy. en Siberie, i. 237. It alſo aſcends through the Jeneſei and the Tuba to the Madſhar, a lake an amazing diſtance in the mountains.
*
Voy en Siberie, par Gmelin, i. 84, 89, 241. ii. 167, 170, 219.—Voy. en Siberie, par l'Abbe D' Auteroche, i. 200. Engl. Ed. 231.
*
D'Auteroche, Voy. en Siberie, i. 83.
Coxe's Travels.
*
This liſt was communicated to me by an able botaniſt; but I think ſome of the plants are alſo ſound in Europe.
*
Voyage, ii. 450, tab. 51.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, Fr.
Voyage, ii. 452.
§
See tab. 51 of the Voyage.
*
Voy. iii. 217.
Ellis's Narrative, i. 332.
Voyage iii. 268.
§
In Harris's Voy. ii. 1016.
Voyage iii. 270.
*
See tab. 84 of the Voyage.
The account of the voyage is extremely worthy of peruſal, and is preſerved by the able Doctor Campbell, in Harris's Collection, ii. 1018.
See tab. 84 of the Voyage.
*
See the chart of them, Voyage, vol. ii. tab. 53.
Voy. ii. 445. iii. 243.
Voyage ii. 470. and Meteorolog. Tables, iii. App. 512, 513, 520, 521.
§
Harris's Coll. ii, 1020.
Muller's Voy. des Ruſſes, i. 148.
*
Caxe's Ruſſian Diſcovery Map, p. 300.—Voy. iii. 503.
Voyage iii. 241.
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 429.
§
See tab. 85, Voyage, vol. iii.; and deſcription of its eruption, p. 235.
See Deſcr. Kamſtchatka, tab. xv. p. 342.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſch. Fr. 340, 341.
Voyage iii. 206, 332.
Deſcr. Kamtſch. Fr. 348, and tab. iv. v. in which are given the courſe of the warm ſtreams.
§
Voy. iii. 327.
*
Taken from Doctor Forſter's FLORA AMERICAE SEPTENTRIONALIS. It is highly probable that many, not noted as ſuch, may be common to both ſides of the continent, notwithſtanding they eſcaped the notice of Steller or our navigators.
*
Voyage, iii. 337.
Gmelin, Fl. Sib. i. 217.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 99, 100.
*
Deſc. Kamtſch. 363.
PALLAS, Nov. Sp. Mur. 230.
Deſc. Kamtſch. 368.
*
Voyage, iii. 332.—Gm. Fl. Sib. i. 181.—Reſpecting the trees, conſult Voyage, iii. 332. Deſc. Kamtſchatka, 359, and the preceding catalogue.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 373.
Same, 375.
See Voy. iii. 304 to 308, where Mr. King gives a full account of the preſent method of hunting.
§
The reader is requeſted, at p. 58, l. 26, to change the word carnivorous into animal.
*
Voy. iii. 308.
Same, 344.
Same, 345.
§
By ſome typographical miſtake, the greater part of the webbed-footed birds are, in the firſt edition, placed under the diviſion of cloven-footed. The naturaliſt reader will eaſily ſee, that the birds, from CRANE, p. 357, to PIED OYSTER-CATCHER, ought to be placed in the diviſion of cloven-footed; and from GREAT TERN, p. 356, to RED-FACED CORVORANT, p. 357, ſhould be put after RED-THROATED DIVER, p. 358, the webbed footed.
Narrative, ii. 246.
Deſcr. Kamtſch. Fr. 509.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, Fr. 507.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, Engl. 194. Fr. 46.
Hiſt. Nat. lib. ix. c. 3.
§
Voyage, iii. 450.
I cannot diſcover the ſpecies. Gmelin, in his Flora Sibirica, does not give the leſt account of theſe plants.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 462.
Same, 466.
Br. Zool. iii. 261.
§
Hiſt. Kamtſch. 218.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 471.
*
This ſpecies is deſcribed (Voyage, iii. 351) under the name of Red Fiſh; the preceding, in p. 350, under that of Tchavitſi.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 482.
Same, 482.
Same, 482.
*
Voyage, iii. 350.
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 485.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 43.
Same, 124.
Voyage, iii. 323.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 510.
Hiſt. Kamtſch. 136.
See. p. 25 of this Work.
*
The moſt proper word for the natives of this country is Kamtſchadales; but as I have on many occaſions uſed this, I wiſh to continue it.
Hiſt. Kamtſch. 68, 71.
*
Voyage, iii. 366.
Same, 367.
See Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, tab. vi.—It differs much from the habit of ceremony deſcribed by Captain KING, iii. 377.
*
Hiſt. Kamitſch. 107 to 109.
Ellis's Nar. ii. 217.
Deſcr. Kamtſch. 602.
*
Voyage, iii. 388.
Decouvertes des Ruſſes, i. 113.
Theſe iſles are marked in a Ruſſian map, communicated to me by Doctor PALLAS, with MS. notes.
§
Kaempfer Hiſt. Japan. i. 305.
Same, 304.
Book i. ch. x. and Decouvertes, &c. ii. 293.
*
I am indebted to Doctor PALLAS for the whole account of this chain of iſlands, except where I make other references.—My extracts are made from a French Memoir, drawn up by my learned friend, and communicated to me.
*
Coxe's Ruſſ. Diſc.
*
Shelvoke, in Harris's Coll. i. 233.
Hackluyt, iii. 401.—Hiſt. California, i. 140.
This is the nobleman whom the writer of Lord Anſon's Voyage ſtigmatiſes with the epithet of munificent bigot. It was not by a reverend author, as is generally ſuppoſed, but by a perſon whoſe principles were unhappily in the extreme of another tincture.—Having from my youth been honored with the friendſhip of the Anſon family, I can give a little hiſtory of the compilation of the Voyage:—A Mr. Paman firſt undertook the work. It was afterwards taken out of his hands, and placed in thoſe of the reverend Mr. Walters, chaplain of the Centurion; but he had no ſhare in it, farther than collecting the materials from the ſeveral journals: thoſe were delivered to Mr. Benjamin Robins, a moſt able mathematician, and the moſt elegant writer of his time. He was ſon of a quaker-taylor at Bath, whom I have often ſeen: a moſt venerable and reſpectable old man. Mr. Robins unfortunately forgot that he was writing in the character of a divine; and it was not thought proper to affront Mr. Walters, by omitting his name in the title-page, as he had taken in ſubſcriptions: this, therefore, will account for the conſtant omiſſion of the word Providence, in a voyage which abounded with ſuch ſignal deliverances.
*
A full account of theſe voyages may be ſeen in Hackluyt, iii. 397, &c.
*
Hackluyt, iii. 738.
Hiſt. California, ii. 292.
Carver's Travels, 76, 121.—Mr. Carver, captain of an independent company, penetrated far inland into America; and publiſhed an intereſting account of his travels. This gentleman was ſuffered to periſh for want, in London, the ſeat of literature and opulence.
*
Ovalli, Hiſt. Chili, in Churchill's Coll. iii. 13.
Conqueſt of Mexico, book iii. ch. iv.
Voy. to California, 33.
*
Doctor Garden. See alſo Mr. Lewis Evans's Eſſays and map. Philadelphia, 2d ed. p. 6, &c.
Mr. Lewis Evans, p. 9, and map.
*
Mr. Lewis Evans, p. 9, and map.
J. Lorimer, eſq
Kalm, iii. 21, 198, 216.—Bartram's Travels, 10, 38.
§
In ſuch ſeem to be lodged the lead and ſilver ores found in Canada. See Kalm, iii. 212.
See Dr. PALLAS'S Obſ. ſur la formation de Montagnes, &c.
*
North-weſt Fox, 163.
See Jefferies's Obſ. on the Letter of Adm. de Fontes, and his map; alſo de L'Iſle's map.
Maurelle's Voy. in 1775, in Mr. Barrington's Miſcellanies, 508.
§
Voyage, ii. 290. tab. 86, 87.
Barrington's Miſcell. 290.
Polyaen. Stratagen. lib. v. c. 23.—Vel. Paterc. lib. ii. c. 107.
**
Brevis et fida Narratio Virginiae, in which are engraven the canoes of the country, taken from the drawing of John With; ſent there with Tho. Harriot for that purpoſe, by Sir Walter Raleigh, who communicated them to De Bry.—See tab. xii. and xlii. of the Account of Florida.
††
Tour Scotl. ii. p. 106.
*
Voyage, ii. 339.
In p. 89, for lat. 44, read 49.
See Barrington's Miſcell. 489, 502.
*
Voyage, ii. 319.
Same, 307.
Travels, 43.
§
Ruſſian Nations, i. 193.
*
Voy. & Decouvertes de Ruſſes, i. 250.
COOK's Voy. ii. 344, tab. 86.
Barrington's Miſcel. 507.
§
COOK's Voy. ii. 347.
Voy. & Decouvertes, i. 154.—COOK, ii. 347, 383.
*
COOK, ii. tab. 86.
Voy. & Decouvertes, i. 257.
Decouvertes faites par les Ruſſes, i. 256.—Voyage, ii. tab. 86.
*
Voyage, ii. 501.
Same, tab. 85.
Same, p. 352.
§
Same, tab. 86.
See the pictureſque view of Suecg Owner Cove, tab. 45.
*
Voy. ii. 377.
Same, 378.
Ellis's Narrative, i. 251.
§
This, and the preceding, in the LEVERIAN Muſeum.
Narrative, ii. 246.
*
Dobbs, 24.
Voyage, ii. 368, 369.
Same, 369, tab. 46, 47.
§
Dampier, i. 32, de Bry. Braſil, 165.
Voyage, ii. 374.
*
Voyage, ii. 371.
See the chart, ii. tab. 44.
*
Particularly from one Joſeph de la France, who in 1739 made a very long journey to the weſt, and was a very obſervant man. See Dobbs, Hudſon's Bay, 21, 34, 35.
*
From a MS. communicated to me by Dr. PALLAS, Bragin was commander of a veſſel which was fitted out by the merchants on a voyage to the new-diſcovered iſlands, and ſailed from Ochotſk in 1772. About ten years prior to this, another voyage was made to Kadjak by Stephen Glottoff.— See Coxe's Diſc. 108.
Coxe's Ruſſ. Diſc. 12.
MS.
*
See the plate, No 87, vol. ii. for the ſeveral views.
Bragin's Voy. MS.
Doctor PALLAS, MS.
§
See their boats, tab. 50.
See their dreſſes, tab. 48, 49, 56, 57.
*
Voyage, ii. 510.
Same, 521.
See tab. 87,
*
See tab. 54.
*
See Voyage, ii. 481.
Mulieris ſalivam quoque jejunae potentem dijudicant oculis cruentatis.—Plin. Hiſt. Nat. lib. xxviii. c. 7.
*
Decouvertes, &c. i. 166.
See the particulars of his ſervices, Voyage, iii. 280.
Strahlenberg Hiſt. Ruſſia, 113.
§
Same, 110.
*
Nichols's Ruſſian Nations, i. 176.
Voyage, iii. 277.
*
The author of Recherches Philoſophiques ſur les Americains, i. 136.
*
Herodotus, lib. iv.—Compare the account given by the hiſtorian with the Tartarian i [...]unculus, in Dr. PALLAS's Travels, i. tab. x. a.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 57.
Mela, lib. ii. c. 1.
§
Voyage, ii.
Colden's Five Indian Nations, i. 155.
Herodotus, lib. iv.
*
Voyage, ii. 311, 329.—A very curious head of a Wolf, fitted for this uſe, is preſerved in the LEVERIAN Muſeum.
Hiſt. Kamtſch. 61.
Bell's Travels, oct. ed. i. 240.
§
Herodian in Vita Severi, lib. iii.
De Bry, Virginia, tab. iii. 111.
Yſbrandt Ides, in Harris's Coll. ii. 929.
**
Compare Colden, i. 17; Lafitau, i. 416; and Archaeologia, ii 222. tab. xiv.
*
See Mr. Hearne's Diſcoveries.
Given by Kaempfer to Sir Hans Sloane, and now preſerved in the Britiſh Muſeum
Hiſt. Japan. i. 67.—Charlevoix, faſtes Chronologiques, ann. 168.
*
Powel's Hiſt. Wales, 228, 229.
Cluſ. Exot. 101.
Mallet's Northern Antiq. Engl. ed. i. 284.
§
Hiſt Vinlandiae antiq. per Thorm. Torfaeum, p. 8.
*
Glover's Account of Virginia, Phil. Tranſ. Abr. iii. 570.
*
Catcott on the Deluge, edit. 2d. p. 139, 15, &c.
On the reaſoning of Mr. Zimmerman (Zool. Geogr. 476), and the opinion of Mr. Erxleben (Syſt. Regn. An. 508), I give up my notion of the Panther (Hiſt. Quad. No 153), being a native of South America. It is moſt probable, that the ſkin which I ſaw at a ſurrier's ſhop, which was ſaid to have been brought from the Braſils, had originally been carried there from the weſtern coaſt of Africa, where the Portugueſe have conſiderable ſettlements, and a great ſlave-trade for their American colonies, and where thoſe animals abound.
Shaw's Travels, 243. Quere? whether exactly the ſame with the European.
*
Or lat. 42, according to Mr. Zimmerman's new Map.
*
As I have been aſſured by Doctor PALLAS, ſince the publication of my Hiſtory of Quadrupeds.
Shaw's Travels, 249.
Condamine's Travels, 82.—Ulloa's Voyage, i. 461.
*
Dobbs's Account of Hudſon's Bay, &c. 47.
*
Purchas, iii. 568.
Voyages par de Pagès, ii. 222.
Same.
Marten's Spitzb. 186.
*
Vol. iii. 123; and Purchas, iii. 610.
Crantz, i. 18.
*
‘A true Diſcourſe of the late Voyages of Diſcoverie for finding a Paſſage to Cathaya by the north-weſt, under the Conduct of Martin Frobiſher, General. Printed by Henry Bynnyman, 1578.’ Firſt Voyage, p. 48.
The Same, Second Voyage, p. 19.
In the ſame book.
See an account of theſe imaginary ſtreights in Drage's Voy. to Hudſon's Streights, vol. ii. 68.
§
Crantz, i. 279. 285.
*
Collate Mr. Middleton's map, and others.
Vol. i. 60.
Hiſt. Greenl.
§
Hackluyt. iii. 101.
Crantz. i. 21 to 24.
**
Same, 19.
††
Egede, 55.
‡‡
Crantz, i. 43.
§§
Same, 41.
*
Voyage en Siberie, i. 381.
As quoted in Green's map of America.
COOK'S Voy. i Pref. LXXIV.
§
Same, ii. 43.
*
Faun. Groenl. p. 26.
Same, p. 17.—Leems Lapm. 214, 215.
*
A.
Cinereous Eagle,
p. 214 B.
Greenland Falcon,
220 E.
Gyrfalcon,
221 F.
Collared Falcon,
222 G.
Long-eared Owl?
No 117
Snowy Owl,
No 121
Raven,
No 134
Ptarmigan,
p. 315 B.
Snow Bunting,
No 222
Lulean Finch,
p. 380 B.
Leſs Red-poll
No 262
Wheat-ear
p. 420 P.
Creſted Titmouſe?
p. 427 F.
B.
Common Heron,
No 433
Snipe,
No 366
Jadreka,
No 375
Striated Sandpiper,
No 383
Hebridal Sandpiper,
No 382
Dunlin Sandpiper,
No 391
Alwargrim Plover,
No 398
Ringed Plover
No 401
C.
Grey Phalarope
No 412
Red Phalarope,
No 413
D.
Great Auk,
No 424
Razor-bill,
No 425
Black-billed,
No 426
Puffin,
No 427
Little,
No 429
Black Guillemot,
No 437
Northern Diver,
No 439
Red-throated D.
No 443
Great Tern,
No 448
Black-backed Gull,
No 451
Cinereous G. (Lin. Syſt.)
224
Glaucous,
p. 532 B.
Ivory Gull,
No 457
Tarrock,
p. 533 D.
Arctic,
No 459
Fulmar Petrel,
No 461
Shearwater P.
No 462
Gooſander
No 465
Red-breaſted G.
No 466
Canada Gooſe?
No 471
Grey lag Gooſe,
No 473
Brant,
No 478
Bernacle,
No 479
Eider Duck,
No 480
King Duck,
No 481
Golden Eye
No 486
Pin-tail
No 500
Long-tailed,
No 501
Harlequin,
No 490
Mallard,
No 494
Morillon,
p. 573 F.

The fifth ſpecies is very doubtful. Except the Canada Gooſe? there is not a ſpecies of Bird which is not found in Europe. This induces me to place all thoſe of Greenland in the appendages to the genera, as they ſeem to have little clame to America.

Crantz, i. 118.
Egede, 134.—Crantz, i. 144.
*
Purchas, iii. 848.
See it well engraven in M. Du Hamel, Hiſt. de Poiſſons, part ii, tab. xxvi.
Davis's Voy. in Hackluyt, iii, 101.
Same, 111.
*
Purchas, iii. 833.—Egede, 32.
*
For the account of this curious voyage, ſee Purchas, iii. from p. 836 to 848.
Clerk of the California's Voy. i. 106.—For a further account of this unfortunate voyage, ſee Churchill's Collection, ii. 472.
*
See this ſubject amply treated by Doctor Aikin, in a Treatiſe on the ſucceſs, with reſpect to the health, of ſome attempts to paſs the winter in high northern latitudes.
*
Voy. to Hudſon's Bay, 1746, written by the Clerk of the California, i. 159. His name was Drage; his account is ſenſible and entertaining.
Ellis, 172.
*
By whom it is well deſcribed and figured, in vol. lxiii. p. 155. tab. vi. of Ph. Tranſ.
The deſcription and hiſtory of this ſpecies was communicated to me by Mr. Hutchins.
*
See an ingenious and laudable Calendar of Hudſon's Bay, publiſhed by Doctor Macfait, in his new Syſtem of General Geography, 348 to 354.
Ph. Tranſ. lxiv. 372.
Same, 386.
Crantz, Hiſt. Morav. 404, 608.
*
Barrington's Miſcel. 25.
Read the account of Lord Amherſt's deſcent down this river, in 1760.
See p. 148.
§
Rymer's Foed.
Hiſt. King Henry VII. Bacon's Works, iii. 89.
*
Hackluyt, iii. 159.
*
Collins's Baronets, iv. 330.
There is a very fine figure of the European Biſon in Mr. Ridinger's Jagbere Thiere.
*
Nov. Com. Petrop. xvii. 460. tab. xi. xii.—I am ſorry to diſſent from my eſteemed friend Doctor Pallas, who thinks them to be the horns of Buffaloes; which are longer, ſtraiter, and angular.
Purchas, iv. 1560, 1566.
Fernandez, Nov. Hiſp. x. c. 30.—Hernandez, 58.
*
Du Pratz, i. 49. ii. 227.
Charlevoix, N. France, v. 192.
Charlevoix, v. 192.
*
Purchas, iv. 1550.
Du Pratz.
Topeg. Deſcr. N. Am. 8.
Du Pratz, i. 288.
*
Kalm, i. 207.
*
Pallas, Sp. Zool. faſc. xi. 76.
*
M. Jeremie, in Voyages au Nord, iii. 315.
The ſame.
Drage's Voy. ii. 260.
*
Voy. au Nord, iii. 314.
The gentleman who undertook, in 1770, 1771, 1772, the arduous journey to the Icy Sea, from Prince of Wales's Fort, Hudſon's Bay. To him, through Mr. Wegg's intereſt, I am indebted for the ſkin and this information.
Drage's voy. ii. 260.
Mr. Graham's MS.
*
Dobbs's Hudſon's Bay, 19, 25.
Purchas, iv. 1561. v. 854.
Pallas, in nov. com. Petrop. xvii. 601. tab. xvii.
Faun. Groenl, 28.
*
Ph. Tranſ. abr. v. part ii. 195.
Faun. Groenl. p. 29.
*
Smellie, vi. 207, 219.
Horrebow, 46.
Troil's voy. 138.
Leems, 228.
*
Pallas, Sp. Zool. faſc. xi. 63. tab. iv.
*
Smellie, vi. 363.
Faun. Groenl. p. 29.
De Buffon, ix. 71.
*
Du Pratz, i. 301.
*
Kalm, i. 298. iii. 204.
Mr. Dudley's Phil. Tranſ. Abridg. vii. 447.
*
La Hontan, i. 59.
Charlevoix, v. 188.
*
Charlevoix, and La Hontan, i. 65.
*
Charlevoix, v. 186.
The ſame.
Wright's Louthiana, book iii. 20. tab. xxii.
§
Hiſt. Quad. 45.
*
Egede, 59. Crantz, i. 70.—The Canadians call it Le Caribou.
Marten's Spitzbergen, 99. Phipps's voy. 185.
Dobbs's Hudſon's Bay, 19.
Muller's voyages from Aſia to America, Preface xxv.
*
Barintz voy.
Le Bruyn, i. 7, 8.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 226, 227.—The Koreki exchange their Deer with the neighboring nations for rich furs.
*
Drage's voy. i. 25.
Crantz, i. 71.
Dobbs, 19, 22.
*
Kalm i. 336.
Kalm i. 338.
Hernandez, Nov. Hiſp. 325.
*
In the ſale of 1764, 1307 were entered.
*
The late ingenious Mr. Ellis ſhewed me a Bezoar found in one of theſe Deer, killed in Georgia. It was of a ſpheroid form, an inch and three quarters broad, half an inch thick in the middle; of a pale brown color; hard, ſmooth, and gloſſy.
Bancroft.
Doctor Garden.
§
Du Pratz, ii. 51.
Lawſon, 124.
Lawſon, 208.
Cateſby, App. xii.
*
Cateſby, App. ix.
*
Lawſon, 207.
D'Arvieux's travels, 147.
Lawſon, 207.
Hernandez.
§
Dobbs's Hudſon's Bay, 24.
*
Hiſt. Nouv. France, v. 195.
Dobbs's Hudſon's Bay, 24.
97.
§
Faun. Suec. No 43, and Pontop. Norway, ii. 9.
Du Pratz, ii. 54.
*
Correct in p. 113, Hiſt. Quad. 9. 44 or 45, read 20.
*
Zimmerman, 357.
*
Du Pratz, ii. 54.
Smellie, iv. 212.
*
Kalm, i. 285.
The ſame, 286. Lawſon, 119.
Smith's Hiſt. Virginia, 27. Crantz Greenland, i. 74.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 107. 197.
The ſame, 107.
The ſame.—There is a variety of black wolves in the Vekroturian mountains. The ſhe-wolves have been ſucceſsfully coupled with dogs in ſome noblemen's parks about Moſcow.
In Bergeron, 160.
§
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 231. The Americans do the ſame, Drage, i. 216.
Hiſt. Kamtſch. 226. Drage, ii. 41.
*
Faun. Greenl. p. 19.
Egede, 63. Crantz, i. 74.
*
Egede, 62. Marten's Spitzb. 100. Horrebow's Iceland, 43.
Mr. Graham.
Muller's Col. voy. 53.
Heemſkirk's voy. 34.
§
Purchas, iii. 559.
Of which I apprehend there are two ſpecies—the Lapland, Hiſt. Quad. No 317, and the Mus Migratorius of Pallas, or Yaik Rat, Hiſt. Quad. No 326. which inhabits the country near the Yaik.
*
Faun. Groenl. 20.
Crantz, i. 72.
*
Olaffen, i. 31.
Kalm, i. 283.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 95.
Geſner Quad. 967. Faun. Suec. No 4.
*
Lawſon, 125.
Cateſby, ii. 78. Joſſelyn, 82.
Kalm, i. 282.
§
Du Pratz, ii. 64. Charlevoix, v. 196.
*
Cateſby, App. xxv.
Lawſon, 118.
Charlevoix, v. 195.
*
Supplem. iii. 227.
*
Hiſt. Carolina, 119.
ii. 64. I wiſh to ſuppreſs the ſynonym of Cat-a-mount, as applied to the Cayenne Cat, as it ſeems applicable to a much larger ſpecies.
Hiſt. de le Nouv. France, vi. 158.
*
De Buffon, Suppl. iii. 200.
The Honorable Conſtantine John Phipps, now Lord Mulgrave.
*
Phil. Tranſ. lxiv. 377.
Muller, Pref. xxv.
Purchas's Pilgrims, iii. 805.
*
Heemſkirk's voy. 14.
The ſame, 18.
Faun. Groenl. p. 23.
The ſame, 60.
*
Marten's Spitzb. 102.
Egede, 60. Martens ſays, that the fat is uſed in pains of the limbs, and that it aſſiſts parturition.
Heemſkirk's voy. in Purchas, iii. 500, 501.
The ſame, 499.
§
Madox's Antiquities of the Exchequer, i. 376.
*
Olaus Magnus, lib. xviii. c. 20.
Journal of his travels into Eaſt Florida, 26.
Hiſt. Kamtſch. iii. 385.
The ſame, 287.
§
Voy. au Nord. iv. 5.
Hiſt. Japan, i. 126.
*
Du Pratz, ii. 57.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, iii. 386.
*
Du Pratz, ii. 61.
*
Du Pratz, ii. 60.
Lawſon, 117. Cateſby, App. xxvi.
Joſſelyn's voy: 91.
§
Bartram's journ. E. Florida, 26.
Lawſon, 116.
*
Du Pratz, ii. 62.
Lawſon, 117.
Kalm, iii. 13.
Doctor Pallas.
*
Mr. Samuel Hearne.
Charlevoix, Nouv. Fr. v. 443.
*
Charlevoix, v. 169 to 174.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, Fr. iii. 390.
Leems Lapmark, Suppl. 64.
The ſame, 502.
The ſame, Suppl.
*
Nichols's Ruſſian Nations, i. 50.
*
Dobbs, 40.
Mr. Graham.
The ſame.
Edw. ii. 103.
§
Hiſt. Kamtſch. 385.
*
Joſſelyn's voy. 85.
Account of Florida, 50.
Fernand. Nov. Hiſp. i.
§
Kalm, i. 97. ii. 63.
*
121.
Kalm, i. 208.
The ſame.
Kalm, ii. 97.
*
Kalm, i. 189.
Briſſon Quad. 185.
Pallas.
Bell's travels, ii. 83.
§
Pontoppidan, ii. 28. Faun. Suec. No 20.
Suppl. tom. iii. 242.
*
Charlevoix, v. 197.
*
Bartram's journal E. Florida, 30.
The ſame.
Du Pratz, ii. 65.
§
The ſame, 66.
Lawſon, 120.
Du Pratz, ii. 66.
*
Cateſby, App.
Phipps's voy. 58.
*
Charlevoix, v. 197.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 99.
Bell's travels, i. 199.
§
Pontoppidan, ii. 25.
Gmelin Ruſſ. Samlung, 516.
Nov. Sp. an. 188.
*
Charlevoix, v. 197.
Doctor Pallas.
Muller, Pref. xxix.
*
Le Pekan, tom. xiii. 304. tab, xlii. xliii.
*
Doctor Pallas.
Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, 275.
*
Decouvertes dans le Ruſſe, &c. iv. 237. tab. vi. vii.
Strabo, lib. xvii. p. 1184.
Epiſt. Ep. xc.
*
Jornandes di Rebus Geticis.
In Bergeron's Coll. 70. Purchas, iii. 86.
160, 161, 162.
Leges Wallicae.
§
Barrington on the Statutes, 4th ed. 243.
*
Vol. ii. 67.
xiii. Coaſe, p. 288. Le Conepute (the female) ibid. tab. xxxviii. xl.
Cateſby, ii. tab. 62.
*
Kalm, i. 275.
The ſame, 277.
Lawſon, 119. Kalm, i. 278.
*
Kalm, i. 278.
Cateſby, ii. tab. 62.
Kalm, i. 274.
§
Sent from thence by Mr. Graham.
Feuiliée Obſ. Peru, 1714, p. 272.
Hernandez, Mex. 382.
*
Lawſon, 119, and Du Pratz, ii. 69.
Dobbs, 40.
Hiſt. Kamtſ. 115, 116.
*
i. 62.
Kalm, ii. 62.
Letter from Mr. Peter Collinſon.
*
Kalm. ii. 61.
Lawſon, 122.
Dr. Pallas.
§
Fauna Suec. No 13.
I here inſert the ſynonyms; for in the Synopſis of Quadrupeds, following Linnaeus and Briſſon, I confound the Braſilian Otter of Marcgrave with this animal.
*
Crantz, i. 70. Egede, 62.
Mr. Graham.
*
Travels, octavo ed. i. 246.
*
Voyages au Nord, iii. 344.
Drage, i. 176.
Kalm, ii. 46.
§
Lawſon, 122.
Doctor Garden.
*
Charlevoix, v. 140.
Lawſon.
Du Pratz, ii. 69.
§
Account of Eaſt Florida, 50.
Dobbs, 35.
*
The Sea Beaver (as it is called) Sp. of this work, muſt not be confounded with this.
*
Clerk, i. 142.
Mr. Graham. Cateſby, App. xxx.
i. 241.
*
Mr. Graham.
Charlevoix, v. 151.
Cateſby, App. 30.
*
Charlevoix, v. 151.
*
Drage's voy. i. 151.
Rymer's Faedera, xx. 230.
*
x. 12.
Lawſon, 120.
Lawſon, 120.
Charlevoix, v. 158.
*
Kalm, ii. 56, and Charlevoix.
Kalm, ii. 58.
v. 158.
*
Charlevoix, v. 198.
Cateſby, App. xxx.
ii. 68.
*
Phil. Tranſ. lxii. 374.
Drage's voy. i. 177.
The ſame, 191.
Mr. Graham,
§
See Syn. Quad, No
Edw. Hiſt. Birds, i. 52.
**
Hiſt. Nat. xii. tab. liv. lv.
††
Mr. Graham.
*
Phil. Tranſ. lxii. 378.
*
Cateſby Carol. ii. 79. App. xxviii.
Hiſt. Birds, ii. 104.
*
Voyage en Sibirie, i. 378.
*
Leſſer Grey Squirrel, Hiſt. Quad. p.
*
Joſſelyn's voy. 86.
Boſſu, i. 361.
*
Hiſt. Carol. 124.
*
Is the Quauhtechallatliltic, or Tlilacotequillin, of the Mexicans. Fernandez, 8.
Cateſby, ii. 73.
Fernand. Nov. Hiſp. 8.
Smith's Virginia, 27.
*
Seb. Muſ. i. tab. xliv. p. 72.
Syſt. Nat. 85, where he calls it Mus Volans; and p. 88, where he ſtyles it Sciurus.
*
Nov. Sp. Quad. 373.
Nov. Sp. an. 188.
*
Mem. Ruſſ. Aſiat. vii. 124.
*
Charlevoix, v. 198.
Kalm, i. 322. 325.
*
Hiſt. Quad. No 324.
Pallas, Nov. Sp. an. 379.
Du Pratz, ii. 68.
*
Pallas, Nov. Sp. an. 380.
A river falling into the Wolga about forty miles below Caſau.
*
Bartram, as quoted by Mr. Kalm, ii. 47.
Garcilaſſo de la Vega, 384.
*
Lawſon Carolina, 122.
De Buffon, xiv. 401.
Kalm, ii. 46.
The ſame, 47.
*
Ph. Tr. lxii. 379. Sp. 15.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, 392.
*
Nov. Sp. an. 197.
*
Hiſt. Carolina, 125.
*
Kalm, i. 190.
P. 51. tab. xxxii.
*
Leems, 229. Pontoppidan, ii. 28.
*
Crantz, i. 126.
Crantz, i. 125.
Marten's Spitzberg.
*
Hiſt Kamtſchatka, 120.
Ph. Tranſ lxiv. 378.
[...]
§
Martens Spitzberg. 182.
Pontoppidan, ii. [...]5 [...].
*
Hackluyt, i. 5.
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 47.
Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 291.
*
Faun. Greenl. 4.
Barentz, 4.
Martens, 109.
Martens, 110.
§
Phipps's voy. 57.
*
De Buffon.
Worm. Muſ. 290.
As quoted in Muſeum Regium Hafniae, &c. pars. i. ſect. iii. 9.
Egede, 83.
§
Crantz, i. 126.
Phil. Tranſ. lxv. part. i. 249. The French call them Vaches Marines. Charlevoix, v. 216. That voyager ſays, that the Engliſh had once a fiſhery of theſe animals on the Iſle de Sable, a ſmall iſland ſouth of Cape Breton; but it turned out to no advantage.
*
This word is derived from Echouer, to land, or run on ſhore.
*
Steller, in Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 290.
*
Hiſt. Greenl. i. 130.
*
See the Sections referred to, and tab. v.
*
See vol. i. 150. tab. viii.
See No 77. of this work.
Ditto, No 72.
Ditto, a variety of No 77.
*
pp. 153, 4, 5, 6, 7.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, 425.
The ſame, 41, 42. 424.
*
Strabo, lib. xi. 781.
*
Ph. Tranſ. Abr. ix. 74. tab. v. xlvii. 120.
Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 290.
*
Muller's voy. 60.
Dr. Pallas, and Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, 420.
*
Mr. Lepechin compares the number of the teeth to that of another kind (our Harp Seal) which, he ſays, has only four teeth in the lower jaw.
The ſame.
*
Crantz, i. 25.
*
Faun. Greenl. p. 9.
The ſame, p. 45.
Crantz, i. 124.
*
Act. Acad. Petrop. pars 263.
*
The French generic name for the Seal is Loup Marin, and the Spaniſh, Lobo Marine.
*
They ſay that the Sea-Cat, or Siwutcha, is found in thoſe iſlands; but Siwutcha is the name given by the Kamtſchatkans and Kurilians to the Leonine Seal only. Northern Archipelago, &c. by Von Staehlen. Printed for Heydinger, 1774, p. 34.
*
He ſailed from the eaſt ſide of Japan in the ſhip Caſtricom, viſited the iſle of Jeſo, and diſcovered the iſlands which he called States Land and Company Land, the laſt not very remote from the moſt ſouthern Kurili iſland. Recueil de voy. au Nord, iv. 1.
The ſame, 12.
Woodes Rogers's voy. 265. He ſays that they are neither ſo numerous there, nor is their fur ſo fine as thoſe on Juan Fernandez, which is ſaid to be extremely ſoft and delicate.
Cook's voy. ii. 213.
Cook, i. 72. 86. Forſter's Obſ. 189.
Anſon's voy. 122. Cook, ii. 194. 213.
*
Selkirk's account in W. Rogers's voy. 136.
ii. 194. 213.
His voyage, Engl. Tr. 187.
Faun. Greenl. p. 6.
*
Narborough, 31. Penroſe Falkland Iſles, 28. Pernetti, voy. Malouines, 240. By his confounding the names of this and the Bottle-noſe Seal, No 288. Hiſt. Quad. he led me into a miſtake about the length of this.
Deſer. Kamtſchatka, 433.
Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 365.
Muller's voy. 60.
*
Deſcr. Kamtſchatka, 377.
Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 302.
*
Voy. 31.
Voy. 75.
Permety's voy. 188. tab. xvi.
Cook, ii. 194. 203. The months in which theſe animals were obſerved by the navigators, were January and February; but by Sir J. Narborough, in the ſtreights of Magellan, about the 4th of March, O. S.
§
Forſter's voy. ii. 514.
*
A figure of this ſpecies is given in De Buffon, xii. lvii. and Schreher, ii. tab. lxxx.
Voy. i. 33.
Ibid.
Dampier, i. 321.
§
Foun. Greenl. p. 6.
*
Muller's voy. 62. Nov. Com. Petrop. ii. 329.
*
Hiſt. Kamtſchatka, 136.
Pallas, Itin. iii. 84. tab. iv. Crantz Greenl. i. 114. Purchas's Pilgrims, iii. 549.
Charlevoix, v. 217.
*
Eaun. Greenl. 51.
Obſ. Scilly Iſlands, 3.
*
Obſervations, &c. 189.
Hiſt. Carolina. 125.
Distributed by the University of Oxford under a Creative Commons Attribution-ShareAlike 3.0 Unported License

Zitationsvorschlag für dieses Objekt
TextGrid Repository (2020). TEI. 4956 Arctic zoology pt 1. University of Oxford Text Archive. . https://hdl.handle.net/21.T11991/0000-001A-6146-8